summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-14 18:01:32 -0700
committerRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-14 18:01:32 -0700
commit1a45218f4e7e9a6cf1d73a47bdbe2b98e51bab10 (patch)
tree0a396dca6c692821b4f1c793161a1aa40781bcca
initial commit of ebook 76963HEADmain
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes3
-rw-r--r--76963-0.txt12000
-rw-r--r--76963-h/76963-h.htm14934
-rw-r--r--76963-h/images/cover.jpgbin0 -> 166736 bytes
-rw-r--r--76963-h/images/i_83.jpgbin0 -> 112264 bytes
-rw-r--r--76963-h/images/i_frontspiece.jpgbin0 -> 120349 bytes
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
8 files changed, 26950 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6833f05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+* text=auto
+*.txt text
+*.md text
diff --git a/76963-0.txt b/76963-0.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..aa2bd8e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/76963-0.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,12000 @@
+
+*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 76963 ***
+
+ This ebook was created in honour of
+ Distributed Proofreaders’ 25th Anniversary.
+
+
+
+
+[Illustration:
+
+ _From an Oil Painting._
+
+JOHN ERSKINE OF ALVA.]
+
+
+
+
+ THE
+ SILVER GLEN
+
+ A Story of the Rebellion of 1715
+
+ _AS TOLD BY BARBARA, LADY FLEMING, IN THE
+ YEAR 1755; AT THE REQUEST OF HER
+ KINSMAN, SIR HENRY ERSKINE._
+
+ BY
+ BESSIE DILL
+
+ AUTHOR OF
+ “MY LADY NAN,” “THE FINAL GOAL,” ETC., ETC.
+
+
+ LONDON
+ DIGBY, LONG & CO.
+ 18 Bouverie Street, Fleet Street, E.C.
+ 1909
+
+
+
+
+ To
+ MRS. ERSKINE-MURRAY AND HER FAMILY
+ This Book is affectionately
+ Dedicated
+ B. D.
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+
+ PAGE
+
+ INTRODUCTION. Telling of some old Letters, and the origin of the
+ writing of this Book 7
+
+ CHAPTER I. Shows how Barbara Stewart left school 12
+
+ ” II. How Barbara came home to Rosyth for the last time 18
+
+ ” III. Of my new Guardian, and the beginning of all her
+ kindness 24
+
+ ” IV. I go to Alva, and become a member of a very
+ charming household 30
+
+ ” V. I hear of the Silver Glen for the first time 37
+
+ ” VI. Introduces several characters who are all more or
+ less interesting 43
+
+ ” VII. I become aware that something important is afoot 55
+
+ ” VIII. I go to Dysart and there learn some Scottish History 64
+
+ ” IX. We meet one morning a very courtly gentleman, and
+ have news of the King’s coming 73
+
+ ” X. Back at Alva we become still more involved in
+ affairs 82
+
+ ” XI. Sir John prepares for action. Barbara goes out to
+ dine, and hears many strange things 90
+
+ ” XII. Tells of the only occasion upon which I met the Earl
+ of Mar, also of how my Lady Erskine stole down the
+ turret-stairs in answer to a knock 99
+
+ ” XIII. Shows how a woman’s actions are ofttimes
+ misunderstood, and how Betty signalled to a
+ passenger in a boat 108
+
+ ” XIV. Tells how Mistress Betty had a brilliant notion,
+ and how it was carried out 116
+
+ ” XV. In which Betty and Barbara behave very foolishly,
+ and the latter is introduced to Mr. Anthony Fleming 125
+
+ ” XVI. Tells of various matters to be found in the
+ History-books, and of a romantic tale which is not 136
+
+ ” XVII. Shows how we are swept into the stream of events 149
+
+ ” XVIII. Tells of a dark hour, and of a great awakening 160
+
+ ” XIX. Shows how the Cause suffers many reverses; and how
+ Mr. Anthony Fleming says “Thank you!” 171
+
+ ” XX. Mr. Fleming rides away from Alva; The King lands,
+ and Sir John returns to Scotland not quite in the
+ manner he intended 181
+
+ ” XXI. Tells of the coming of the King to Perth, and what
+ ensued thereafter 189
+
+ ” XXII. How we hear tidings that make our hearts ache, and
+ ill prepare us for the great surprise 197
+
+ ” XXIII. Tells of further sad doings, and of the beauty and
+ burden of the Spring 208
+
+ ” XXIV. My Lady hears from Sir John, and I pay my third
+ visit to Dysart 217
+
+ ” XXV. Tells of an unexpected meeting and a glad surprise
+ for Barbara 226
+
+ ” XXVI. Barbara is accused of cruelty and indiscretion 238
+
+ ” XXVII. Shows how slowly the time passes when the heart is
+ heavy 254
+
+ ” XXVIII. Tells of the good fortune for Betty and of the
+ evil deeds of the Parliament 268
+
+ ” XXIX. The Calamity falls, and my Lady attends her
+ sister’s wedding in very low spirits 282
+
+ ” XXX. The affair of the Mine in the Mountain is much
+ discussed in London, but with no comforting results 292
+
+ ” XXXI. The matter is still further delayed, but our
+ anxieties continue 300
+
+ ” XXXII. Shows something of the trials and perplexities of
+ our good Sir John over the business 308
+
+ ” XXXIII. The story ends in peace and sunshine, and I take
+ leave of my kind readers 314
+
+
+
+
+PREFACE
+
+
+The Letters of Lady Erskine of Alva which appear in this tale are at
+once its chief interest and the origin of its being; for my desire
+in writing “The Silver Glen” is to make known to a wider circle the
+vivid story of which they are the outcome. My conviction that they
+would prove as attractive to others as to myself induced the late Mr.
+Erskine-Murray, among whose family-papers they are preserved, to give
+me his kind permission to use them.
+
+To weave a romance around the names of persons who have really lived,
+and whose descendants are still in existence, is a liberty which calls
+for an apology on the part of the author. With the exception of Barbara
+Stewart, Anthony Fleming and the younger David Pitcairn none of the
+principal characters in the following story are wholly fictitious; but
+I trust, that as I have kept very closely to facts, no serious cause
+of offence can be found. Most of the incidents described are matters
+of history, and the narrative is purposely told in a plain and simple
+manner, as much as possible in keeping with the tone of the Letters.
+
+Among the books from which I have obtained information, and in some
+cases, borrowed freely, I may mention Professor Terry’s useful and
+interesting volume, _The Chevalier de St. George and the Jacobite
+Movements_; _The Memoirs of the Master of Sinclair_; Rae’s _History of
+the Rebellion_ (1718); _Scotland and Scotsmen of the 18th Century_, by
+Ramsay of Ochtertyre; and the _Calendar of the Stuart Papers belonging
+to His Majesty at Windsor Castle_ (Vol. II. and III.) In the Eighth
+Report of the Historical Manuscripts Commission also, there are
+numerous details on the subject of Sir John Erskine’s Silver Mines.
+
+In view of the new light recently thrown upon the Character of James
+(The Old Pretender), a fact very clearly brought out by Mr. Andrew Lang
+in his _History of Scotland_ (Vol IV.) it is particularly interesting
+to note the remark of Lady Erskine in Letter XVI.: “There is one
+advantage,” she writes to her husband, “of being with Kid (_i.e._,
+James), that you will live mighty regular and get no ill examples.”
+
+My warmest thanks are due, in the first place, to the late Mr.
+Erskine-Murray for his kind permission to use these Letters; I should
+also like to record my gratitude to Miss Johnstone of Alva, to the Rev.
+Robert Paul, F.R.S.A., Dollar, N.B., and to the Rev. A. Thomson Grant,
+Chaplain at Wemyss Castle, who have all in different ways assisted me,
+as well as to the Faculty of Advocates at Edinburgh for their courtesy
+in allowing me to read in their Library. Except for the punctuation,
+and the omission of a sentence occasionally where the meaning is
+obscure, Lady Erskine’s Letters are reproduced as they were written.
+
+ B. D.
+
+
+
+
+_NOVELS BY BESSIE DILL_
+
+
+MY LADY NAN
+
+“A daintily written eighteenth century romance. The story is thoroughly
+entertaining.”--_Daily Express._
+
+“A charming tale.”--_The Times._
+
+“A very pretty tale, written with a light and powerful touch.”--_The
+Guardian._
+
+“Written with a dainty efficiency which is very attractive. A charming
+tale.”--_Liverpool Courier._
+
+
+THE FINAL GOAL
+
+“As fascinating a romance as one could lay hands on, and will enhance
+the reputation of the writer. There is a genuine literary ring about
+the whole book. It is a book to read and enjoy.”--_The Scotsman._
+
+“An altogether delightful story.”--_Liverpool Daily Courier._
+
+
+THE LORDS OF LIFE
+
+“An excellent and well written book. ‘Van,’ the charming Scottish
+heroine, with that unfortunate possession, ‘a temperament,’ who leaves
+her northern home at the Manse, for Anglo-Indian life, is more than
+usually interesting.”--_Pall Mall Gazette._
+
+“The story of a governess’s life, artistically told, and with a
+fidelity to nature which makes it appear as if a slab out of the living
+world had been set before us, we were watching the actions and reading
+the thoughts of the people of it. The story is told with a tragic
+passion which reminds one of Jane Eyre.”--_Sheffield Daily Telegraph._
+
+“A grand story, the charm of the book is in the development of
+character, the refining of the gold of a girl’s joyful innocence in the
+fire of experience.”--_Leeds Mercury._
+
+
+THE STORY OF BELL
+
+“The story is simply and touchingly told, and retains the reader’s
+sympathy and interest to the end.”--_Pall Mall Gazette._
+
+“The story is a masterpiece ... a story with a great and noble purpose,
+which we cannot read without feeling all the better.”--_Christian
+Journal._
+
+
+
+
+THE SILVER GLEN
+
+
+
+
+INTRODUCTION
+
+
+A few days ago, as I sat in my pleasant parlour looking out on one of
+the fairest prospects in this our fair land of England, my cousin, Sir
+Henry Erskine, who hath been spending some days at our house, entered
+the room with his quick soldier-like step, and came to a halt, as he
+would say, at my side.
+
+“See here, cousin!” he cried, holding out to me a packet of papers,
+“there is something here that will interest you. These letters were
+given me by my Uncle Charles, my Lord Tinwald, t’other day when I was
+visiting at Alva House, and I have but just looked into them. They were
+written, I find, by my mother of blessed memory to Sir John, while he
+was abroad in exile for his misdeeds, as one may say now, in the year
+1716.”
+
+I caught at the papers with a cry, half of delight and half of tender
+sorrow, for if Henry’s voice had softened as he mentioned his mother’s
+name, ’twas no more than her due, who was ever the wisest and most
+loving of parents; and if to him, the thought of her represented all
+that is sweetest and best in womanhood--as one may suppose, seeing he
+hath not yet crowned perfection by taking unto himself a wife--to me
+it did no less, being as I was the object of her most tender care and
+kindness at a time in my life when I sorely needed both.
+
+The sight of those thin broad sheets, covered with the fine clear
+writing which had once been so familiar to me, brought the tears to
+my eyes. Sure they were well worn, those ancient letters, having been
+borne in Sir John’s wallet, no doubt, for many a weary month, and since
+lain by in some desk or chest at Alva House for safety; and at the
+sight of the seal on the back, so carefully broken that the wax still
+retained on many of the sheets its perfect imprint, a vision of my
+dear lady folding and sealing with trembling haste one of these same
+precious letters, came so clear to my mind, that almost I thought I
+heard her voice calling to me as in the days of old.
+
+“See, Henry,” I said softly, pointing to the seal, “how well I remember
+the ring she ever used. Too large for her slender hand, she wore it
+on a long gold chain around her neck. Your father, Sir John, had used
+it when writing to her before they were wed, and, sweet woman that
+she was, she would never have any other for the letters that passed
+between them. ‘For, Barbara,’ said she to me once, and I can still see
+her smile, ‘the legend is so true, that ’twould be folly to take to
+another.’”
+
+Together we bent over the faded wax, and Henry laid his lips upon it
+gently. There has ever been a spirit of poetry and chivalry in this
+stalwart soldier, whom as a little child I had so often held upon my
+knee.
+
+“A heart embossed, and round it the words, ‘_Vous y regnez seul_.’
+True, indeed!” said he with a smile; “Sir John reigned there alone,
+and even her children were in her heart but little subjects to their
+rightful king.”
+
+“Sure, my dear, you lost nothing by that,” I cried, “for happier
+children, or a kindlier home I never did see. The love that filled my
+lady’s heart was a bounteous fire that brightened and warmed all who
+approached her. Sweet soul! I thank God still for having known and
+loved her.”
+
+Saying this I turned my eyes again upon the letters in my hands, and so
+potent was the spell of the first few words I read, that my mind leapt
+back across a gulf of forty years, and left my body sitting blind and
+deaf in the chair in my sunny English parlour.
+
+A sudden laugh from Sir Henry brought my wits home again.
+
+“Cousin Barbara,” he cried, “I have been speaking to you for some
+minutes and not one word have you heard of my discourse. Nay, dear
+cousin, do not apologise. The love you bore my mother hath ever been a
+tie between her children and yourself, and I know well that your tender
+heart is filled with regretful memories at sight of these letters writ
+by her hand.”
+
+“She was indeed the dearest woman-friend I ever had,” said I. “Alas!
+too early lost.”
+
+“And for that very reason,” said he, “I made my bold request, which,
+as you did not hear it, I must needs repeat. Will you not, for the
+love you bore those that are passed away, and a little for the love
+of us who remain, write out for our instruction and profit, your
+recollections of that troublous time, with something also of your own
+romance, and the strange story of the Silver Glen which I have so often
+heard from you as a boy?”
+
+My gaze went past him out of the window, across miles of green pasture
+and softly waving foliage to the silver shining of the Severn beyond.
+Far, far away the hills of Wales rose into the sky, the day being clear
+and bright. Close to the house the flowers were blooming very sweet
+and fragrant, for the month was June, and in the shrubbery behind the
+garden, the blackbirds and thrushes sang their best.
+
+“Of course, if you should think it too great a labour--” Sir Henry
+broke in upon my musings, but I held up my hand to stop him.
+
+“Nay, cousin,” I cried, “’twould be what is called ‘a labour of love’
+surely. I was but thinking how little fit I am to be the chronicler of
+those exciting times. I will not be so mock-modest as to pretend to
+consider myself unfit in the matter of appreciating your dear mother’s
+character and conduct, for few had the opportunities to know and esteem
+her that I had. But I am truly no historian, and the tale will be
+written from my own point of view, which needs must be a narrow one.
+I have, I believe, upstairs hidden away in the corner of some ancient
+chest, a diary of that same year writ in a girlish hand. By help of
+this, and by reading, since you permit it, these sacred letters, I
+promise you I will do my best endeavour to give you a true and full
+account of the events that took place in your home, and among your
+family, when you were an innocent small boy of four or five years old.
+But consider a little how long a time has passed. My youth with all its
+fears and follies, its joys and sorrows, is far away. I have wandered
+back and forth upon the earth, knowing many changes and living in
+distant lands, for a wife, as you know, must ever be ready to follow
+her husband; and if now in the evening of my life I can sit placidly
+at this sunny window looking out upon the Severn Sea, and know that my
+dear and kind spouse is no further away than in the next room, or in
+the garden, or at the home-farm, I thank God very humbly in my heart,
+Who has brought me to this peaceful place by a way that I knew not,
+and little expected to find. Dear Henry, I am but a garrulous old
+woman, and what I want to say is, that if my memory of those distant
+days is grown a little dim, and certain things are gone from my mind
+never to return, I must pray you to forgive me, and put it down, not to
+foolishness, but to old age.”
+
+Whereupon Sir Henry rallied me upon my fears, and laughed at me for
+calling myself old, who am scarce more than a dozen years his senior,
+and kissing my hand in the gallant way he has, he left me sitting by
+the window with these old letters in my lap.
+
+And suddenly, after a long silence, a single mavis burst into song,
+and trilled and throbbed so exquisite a melody that I held my breath
+to listen. For there were many years of my life in which I did not
+hear that lovely music, and now a mavis never sings in the long sweet
+twilight but my thoughts fly out to my lost dear, Catherine, Lady
+Erskine (for a reason that I hope to tell you by-and-bye), and it
+seemed strange that when my mind was so full of her, the bird that I
+always think of as hers should start to make music beside me. But I
+have often noticed in my changeful life, the little happenings that
+link our minds with the past and the future, with facts on earth and
+aspirations in Heaven, with human hopes and divine longings, so that
+the scent of a flower, or a child’s laugh, or a glorious sunset, or a
+sudden happiness, may lift our hearts, before we know it, right into
+the presence of God.
+
+All letters it seems to me must in a greater or less degree be the
+exponents of the writer’s mind. Of some, indeed, we might say that they
+mirror very clearly the character and disposition of their authors,
+and more especially when exchanged between two close and loving
+friends without fear of outside criticism, or any thought of possible
+publicity. Most truly is this the case in the letters before me. So
+intimate and natural they are that I almost shrink from exposing them
+to the eyes of strangers, however kind and sympathetic these may be;
+and yet they can but excite the warmest affection and admiration in all
+minds, being the outpourings of a loyal, loving and courageous heart.
+They were written in haste oftentimes, in doubt and fear and terrible
+anxiety, but not once does the brave spirit falter nor the love in them
+grow cold or dim.
+
+Now it is true that, as I said to Sir Henry, my view of those far-off
+events of my girlhood, besides having grown somewhat dim, must be but
+a narrow one, for I lived as it were in the midst of the story, and
+could not know at the time many facts and results that were afterwards
+made plain to all. To such as may care to read my simple narrative,
+which, if plain and unstudied, is yet true and I think not wanting in
+interest, I must say at once that my sole reason in undertaking the
+task is my desire to make more widely known among her descendants,
+namely, my dear God-daughter, Barbara; her niece, Christian, poor
+Charles’s little girl, and Sir Henry, who will I hope marry and have
+a family of his own, as well as to my own dear daughter and her
+children--the character of the sweet and noble woman who was the friend
+of my youth.
+
+I therefore make no apology for leaving to the writers of history many
+details of that unhappy time; only so far as it touched upon the lives
+and happiness of those I loved does it concern me. And so, with no more
+than a humble regret that my skill is not more worthy of my theme, I
+take up my pen to begin this story of the so-called Rebellion in the
+year seventeen hundred and fifteen.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+SHOWS HOW BARBARA STEWART LEFT SCHOOL
+
+
+’Twas in the early hours of a dark December morning in the year 1714
+that I was awakened suddenly by the cautious opening of the chamber
+door, and saw with blinking eyes the bare room where I slept with three
+of my school companions. The wavering flicker of a candle carried by
+a cautious hand showed me the night-capped heads upon their pillows,
+the bare walls, the uncarpeted floor, the staring, black, uncurtained
+window, and, the sight arousing no interest in my mind, I closed my
+eyes against the intruding light. Little Miss Gordon, the youngest girl
+in the school, who slept in the bed with me, raised a protesting arm
+across her face, and called out in accents sleepy and petulant, “Oh,
+Betsy, take that horrid light away. ’Tis not morning yet, I am but just
+fallen asleep!”
+
+Now it has always been my custom to awake up instantly with all my
+senses on the alert. I say it not to boast, though the faculty hath
+served me well once or twice in my life, for some are born so, just
+as others are drowsy-heads from the cradle to the grave; but this
+being my habit, I had seen with the first opening of my eyes that
+it was not Betsy, the maid, who had entered our room, but no less a
+personage than Mistress Marget Lindsay, the younger of the two sisters
+who kept a boarding-school for young ladies in Paterson’s Court, off
+the Lawnmarket in Edinburgh. Now, Mistress Marget, besides being the
+younger of our school-mistresses, was the one least feared by their
+pupils; I had almost said the best loved, but in those days (I know not
+if it be so still), anything so gentle as love scarce entered into the
+training of young ladies at school. That she had a kind heart, however,
+I have been sure ever since that dark, winter morn, as, shading the
+candle with her hand, she came quickly to my bed-side and bent down to
+discover if I were still asleep.
+
+“Miss Stewart, my dear--Barbara. Are you awake?” she cried softly.
+
+I sat up in bed and untied my cap-strings, the better to hear what she
+had to say.
+
+“I am awake, madam; what is it you want of me? Sure, ’tis not time yet
+for me to be at my exercises!” said I, a little alarmed at the gravity
+of her face.
+
+She shook her head and sat down beside me on the bed.
+
+“No, no, child; do not be alarmed! And yet I fear I have news that will
+disquiet you. A man-servant has come from Rosyth to take you home. You
+must rise at once and attire yourself for the journey.”
+
+“A man-servant?” I repeated, obediently putting one foot out of bed.
+“Old Robert, belike. Oh, Mistress Marget!” I cried, stopping suddenly,
+“pray tell me at once what is wrong.”
+
+With the truest kindness the good woman did not attempt to turn my
+thoughts aside from their fear. She answered immediately and without
+circumlocution.
+
+“Your grandfather, Miss Stewart, has met with an accident, and ’tis
+feared he cannot live. He would see you, dear bairn, before he dies.”
+
+There may be some who think this stern announcement to a young maid
+of sixteen somewhat wanting in tenderness and compassion. They may
+consider that to hint at a possible calamity, mentioning a severe
+illness or the like, but holding out hopes of a speedy recovery, would
+have been the kinder way. If so, I cannot agree with them. The progress
+of “preparing the mind” of any poor creature to receive a blow hath
+always seemed to me both cruel and useless. In many cases, the more
+sudden the shock, the more strongly is the mind braced to bear it for
+the moment; and so it was in my own case. I leapt from my bed and began
+hurriedly to put on my clothes.
+
+“My grandpapa dying, and asking for me? Oh, Mistress Marget, I must
+hasten; I pray you, assist me with this lace. Will you not kindly tie
+these strings? Hath Robert brought the carriage? Ah no! the snow is
+too deep. I am to ride pillion? Yes, I must wear my thickest shawl and
+hood. Oh, do not hinder me, dear madam, I must be going now; I cannot
+keep Robert waiting another moment.”
+
+“My dear Miss Stewart,” said my mistress, quietly detaining me while
+she tied a thick veil over my face, and searched for scarf and mits,
+“Robert is in the kitchen being warmed and fed. The good creature was
+almost lifeless from the cold. And do you think, my dear girl, that
+my sister would suffer you to leave her house at this hour fasting?
+There is no speed in such senseless haste as you know, and while I
+admire your courage and fortitude, and the eagerness you exhibit to do
+your grandfather’s behest, I must counsel you, my dear, to remember
+that patience is one of the highest virtues a woman can possess, and
+self-control is another.”
+
+Tears rose in my eyes, not so much at the rebuke as in rebellion
+against it; for Barbara Stewart was ever hot and hasty in those young
+days, and indeed hath scarce yet learned to exercise the virtues
+extolled by good Mistress Marget in all the years that she hath lived.
+But chafe as I would at the delay, I was forced to go into the parlour,
+where the elder sister Lindsay, hastily attired, and with a shawl over
+her night-cap, waited for me in the candle-light with hot chocolate and
+buttered oatcake.
+
+I think the strangeness of that morning scene, and the unwonted
+consideration with which I was treated, took my mind a little from the
+gravity of the situation. I know that it was not till I was mounted
+behind Robert, and clinging to the broad belt he wore as we paced along
+the stony street, that it entered into my head to ask him for news of
+my poor grandpapa. It was then that I heard how, in riding not many
+days before, his horse had slipped upon a piece of ice, and had thrown
+the poor gentleman with such violence that an old wound, got near
+twenty years before at the siege of Namur, had opened, and inflammation
+having set in, the doctor now gave little hope of his recovery.
+
+“I’m thinkin’, mem, the Colonel’s juist waitin’ tae bid ye gude-bye,”
+said honest Robert very sadly.
+
+The news made me grave and sober enough--sorrowful, too, and fearful,
+for my good grandpapa had been indulgent beyond the common, and,
+besides him, I knew of no other relative that I possessed in the world.
+My father, his only son, had been one of Webb’s most gallant officers,
+and had married in Flanders, after the Peace of Ryswick, Mademoiselle
+Jeanne de St. Pierre, the orphan niece of the French admiral of that
+name; for, as you know, love and peace grew and flourished between
+private individuals of the rival nations even while their countries
+were at daggers drawn. My mother, besides possessing wit and beauty,
+had a small fortune of her own, and she and my dear father lived very
+happily together, sometimes in Brussels, in Paris, or in London. But
+he, dying of fever, induced by wounds which he received at the taking
+of Liège in 1702, left his young widow and little daughter to the care
+of Colonel Stewart of Rosyth House in the county of Fife. My mother,
+fragile and broken-hearted, survived his death little more than a year.
+Thus, before I had reached my sixth birthday, was I bereft of both my
+parents.
+
+Brought up with care and kindness in my grandpapa’s commodious house on
+the shore of the Forth, I had been sent at the age of thirteen to the
+Seminary for Young Ladies of Good Family, kept by the sisters Lindsay,
+and had just completed my third year in that select and fashionable
+school.
+
+Such in brief was the story of my life down to that dismal winter
+morning which found me riding behind Robert Guthrie, my grandfather’s
+old servant, along the bare road that leads from Edinburgh to the
+Queen’s Ferry. Very bleak and cold it was, for the sun was not yet
+risen, and a chill wind blew right in our faces out of the north-west.
+The ground was covered with snow, and, though at another time I might
+have noticed with pleasure the purity of its whiteness in contrast to
+the grey sky and the black waters of the Firth (for all my life I have
+had open eyes and heart to the beauties of the earth) this day my
+mind was too full of anxious cares to allow me any such consolation. I
+was cold and cheerless enough with the nine miles ride when we reached
+the Hawse Inn, where we alighted to wait for the ferry-boat to take
+us across to the coast of Fife, and the good landlady bustled out
+with a cup of hot spiced claret to take the chill out of my bones, as
+she said. She brought me in to the warm fireside, and with many kind
+commiserating words she sought, in the fulness of her heart, to lighten
+my gloom. She had heard from Robert Guthrie how Colonel Stewart lay at
+the point of death, and, in her motherly way, she pitied the poor girl
+who was so soon to be left alone in the world. I thanked her with what
+courage I could muster, but when she saw that I could scarce restrain
+the trembling of my lips, she very wisely left me to myself and busied
+herself about her household tasks.
+
+Almost at the moment when we stepped on board the ferry-boat, the sun,
+which was now some way above the horizon though wrapped in clouds,
+struggled forth from the enveloping mists, and in a very short time
+changed the aspect of the landscape from dismal gloom to sparkling
+radiance.
+
+Before we were half-way across the Frith I was so far roused from my
+abstraction to note this change, and whether it was that, the day being
+a sort of landmark between the old life and the new, all impressions
+received then upon my mind retained a peculiar distinctness, I know
+not; but this I know, that though I have made the same crossing many
+scores of times since, whenever I think of the passage of the Forth, I
+see it as I saw it that winter morning. The noble river flowing between
+its ever widening shores sparkled in the early light, reflecting on its
+bosom the blue of the sky, broken here and there by little white waves
+that seemed to laugh to each other as they raced out to sea. The grey
+stone houses of the little town we had just left, with their red-tiled
+roofs, looked picturesque, all huddled down together to the water’s
+edge. Westward as I gazed, the tall thin masts of vessels moored at
+Charlestown and Borrowstownness, stood up slender and distinct in the
+clear air; and far away as a dream-like background the peaks of the
+majestic mountains, Ben Lomond, Ben Ledi, Ben Muich Dhui, their summits
+crowned with gleaming snow, towered towards the pale blue sky. Near at
+hand, the fishing craft putting out from either coast, shot up their
+sails to catch the freshening breeze, and over all the sea-gulls flew
+restlessly, or dived into the water with wild, musical cries, their
+white wings gleaming in the sunlight.
+
+For a moment I forgot my grief in the freshness and beauty of the
+morning, and turned for a sympathetic word from my companion, but at
+sight of his face I refrained. The old man was standing not far from
+where I sat, one hand upon the bridle of his horse, his head drooping,
+and his dim blue eyes fixed on vacancy. His kindly, weather-beaten face
+was very sorrowful, and I knew that he was looking far back into the
+past, when he and his beloved master had been young, for Robert had
+followed my grandfather to the wars, and they had been through many
+hardships and shared some triumphs together. Into my light and girlish
+mind came the thought that here was a grief ten times greater than my
+own, and in presence of it I felt strangely small and insignificant.
+Sandy, the horse, too used to the ferry-boat to be disturbed by the
+crossing, seemed to divine his old friend’s trouble in the curious way
+dumb animals have, for he rubbed his soft cheek against the groom’s
+shoulder with an affectionate, caressing motion.
+
+My heart went out to the old man in his sorrow, and when two slow tears
+welled out of his eyes and rolled down his wrinkled face, I started up,
+impulsive as I too often was, and ran to his side to comfort him.
+
+“Dinna greet, Robbie!” I cried, though softly, that the boatmen should
+not hear. “Dinna greet! I canna bear to see ye. You and me’ll aye be
+friends!”
+
+He turned and smiled at my words, and I thought the smile was sadder
+than the tears.
+
+“Eh, my bonnie wee leddie!” he said, as if I had been still but a
+bairn, “it’s Robbie has got a sair heart the day.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+HOW BARBARA CAME TO ROSYTH FOR THE LAST TIME
+
+
+Rosyth House stood (for alas! it stands no longer, having been burned
+to the ground in the year 1727, on the very day that his present
+Gracious Majesty came to the throne), on the high ground above the
+Forth, about a mile and a half from the landing place at the North
+Ferry. A quarter of a mile further west, the ancient castle of the same
+name stands on a promontory stretching out into the sea, so near the
+water that at high tide it is wholly surrounded and cut off from the
+shore, except for an artificial stone causeway connecting it with the
+mainland.
+
+My grandfather, who was a distant cousin of the Laird of Rosyth, had
+got leave, upon retiring from active service, to build a house upon his
+land; but the latter, having some years before I was born disposed of
+his estate to a gentleman of the name of Drummond, it was understood
+that Colonel Stewart had only a life-rent of the same, his heirs being
+to receive a fair sum of money in lieu thereof at his death. This
+arrangement, though little to his liking at the time, grieved him less
+after the death of his son, my father, and although he could not feel
+the loving pride in keeping up the place that a man expends upon his
+own, still the cultivation of his grounds and garden had been a source
+of pleasure and solace to him in the latter years of his life. The
+house was comfortable and commodious, and sheltered from the winds, so
+that the shrubs and trees he had taken pains to plant had well grown up
+around it; and from the windows there was at all times a fair view of
+the waters of the Frith with the ships passing up and down, and beyond
+them the low green coast of the Lothians.
+
+Beautiful or plain, it was the only home I had ever known, and for
+that reason very dear to me; and as we rounded the bend of the road
+that skirts St. Margaret’s Hope, and the familiar landmarks came into
+view, the tears rushed to my eyes and ran down my cheeks, as I thought
+that in a few short days it would shelter me no more. The half-formed
+fears of extreme youth are perhaps harder to endure than our later
+forebodings, being intensified by the sharpness of imagination and the
+uncertainty of ignorance as well. With my outward senses I took in all
+the beauty of the morning: the blue sky and the dancing waves, the
+sparkle of the snow so dazzling in its country purity, and the wild
+glad cries of the sea-gulls never still; but my heart was cold and very
+heavy, because for the first time in my life I feared the future with
+the dull aching fear that I suppose only a helpless woman can ever know.
+
+At the door of Rosyth House, Robert dismounted stiffly and lifted me
+to the ground. The noise of Sandy’s hoofs could not have been heard on
+the snow-covered approach, but my feet had scarce touched the threshold
+when the door was pulled quickly open and I found myself in the arms of
+my kind old nurse.
+
+“What news, woman?” cried Robert Guthrie, hoarsely before I could
+speak, for Phemie was his wife, though many years his junior, and had
+been, as long as I could remember, the prop and stay of our household.
+She looked at him over my shoulder, and shook her head sadly.
+
+“Oh, wheesht, my bairn, wheesht!” she crooned above my head, for I had
+burst out crying, and she drew me into the lobby and softly shut the
+door. “There, there,” she went on tenderly, “I’ll no’ stop ye; just
+greet yer fill, and syne ye’ll feel a’ the better for’t.”
+
+As she spoke she led me into the parlour where was a bright fire
+burning, very pleasant to the chilled little traveller, and a basin of
+her own famous chicken-broth was steaming on the table. And very soon,
+warmed, fed and comforted by the excellent creature, I felt the deadly
+weight at my heart lighten, and the future, in spite of its impending
+bereavement, did not appear altogether hopeless. So wonderful is the
+power of human sympathy, and the touch of a warm, kindly hand upon our
+own.
+
+Upstairs in his chamber Colonel Stewart lay dying, and thither Phemie
+conducted me as soon as she considered me capable of bearing myself
+with dignity and self-control.
+
+“Be a woman, my dear lamb, for yer gran’pa’s sake!” she whispered, as
+she led me to his door. “The Colonel’s far through, his time is gey
+short.”
+
+The room was bare and empty for the bed-chamber of the master of the
+house, but the old soldier had ever treated himself with a certain
+austerity bred of early days of hardship in the field; and his wife,
+my grandmother, being long dead, there had been none to interfere with
+his love of simple things. His bed had neither tester nor hangings, and
+there was no carpet on the floor nor curtains at the window. One of the
+shutters was partially closed to soften the glare from the snow, but
+the winter sunshine brightened the room and showed me the face of my
+grandfather on the pillow, very white and worn, and with closed eyes.
+He opened them as we approached, and smiled as his glance fell on me.
+
+“Ah, Barbara, my child!” he cried, and my heart gave a hard throb at
+the weak tones of his voice. “You have come, I am glad you are here.
+’Tis a cold journey from Embro’ in the winter-time. Has the bairn had
+her noon-chin?” he enquired of Phemie, for he was ever kindly and
+courteous, and wondrous thoughtful about small things, unusually so
+for a man, as I now know. On being assured that I was neither cold nor
+hungry, he motioned me to sit by him, and signified to Phemie that he
+wished to be alone with me.
+
+“Go you and see to the comfort of your gudeman, and tell him I thank
+him for bringing the wee leddy home in time.”
+
+When she was gone, “My dear Barbara,” said he, “this is as unexpected
+as most of the blows of Fate, but as Fate is only another name for the
+Hand of God, it behoves us to bow to its dictates. I hope I know how
+to die as a soldier and a Christian should, but ’tis hard to leave a
+woman-bairn alone in the world.”
+
+The thin, tired voice with which my dear grandpapa spoke touched my
+heart with sorrow even more than the words he said. I laid my hand on
+his, so brown and wrinkled, and turned away my face that he might not
+see my tears.
+
+After a pause he went on.
+
+“You are, my dear girl, the only child of two only children, and I
+myself had neither brother nor sister. Your relatives are therefore few
+and distant. There are in France some cousins of your late dear mother,
+but seeing I know them not, I have no mind to send you so far seeking a
+home. Dost remember thy mother, dear bairn?”
+
+I nodded doubtfully.
+
+“I have mind of her face,” I said, “and how soft and white her hands
+were--much softer than my good Phemie’s, I always thought,--and I mind
+the way she kissed me and held me in her arms.”
+
+Colonel Stewart sighed.
+
+“Poor bairn, you were but a babe when she died. A great loss, Barbara!
+Your mother was a notable woman. But I’m wondering if you have any mind
+of a friend of hers--the Honourable Catherine Sinclair, to wit, from
+Dysart, that used to come a great deal about Rosyth at that time?”
+
+I peered far back into my childish memories, and then I smiled.
+
+“Was she a lady in a blue gown?” I cried, “with a string of pearls
+round her neck? She was very merry and kind, and talked French with my
+mother. She told me to call her Cousin Katie.”
+
+“Very like, very like,” said my grandfather, “though I cannot swear to
+the colour of her gown. But she was a blithe, happy creature, and very
+fond of your mother, Barbara.”
+
+“Yes, sir.”
+
+“It is to her that I look to befriend you, child, when I am gone. Your
+father and she were cousins in the fourth degree through their mothers,
+and her father, my Lord Sinclair, for old friendship’s sake, may be
+willing to give you a home at the Hermitage at Dysart, for so his house
+is called, until you are of an age to choose your own place of abode.”
+
+Here he stopped again and pointed feebly to a bottle of cordial that
+stood with a glass upon the table. I hastened to pour some out and held
+it to his lips, trembling inwardly lest he should faint from weakness,
+or die with me alone in the room. My fears, however, were not realised,
+for after a few minutes’ silence he spoke again.
+
+“The year after your dear mother died, Catherine Sinclair was wedded to
+Sir John Erskine of Alva, a gentleman of old and noble family, greatly
+respected in the country. His mother was Mistress Christian Dundas of
+Arniston, a clever and pious woman who is still living. Though the
+younger Lady Alva has not been here since her marriage, I have met
+her at her father’s house, where she comes frequently to stay, and
+have been greatly attracted by her kindliness and good sense. There
+are some wild tales abroad about her husband, Sir John, but though he
+is impulsive and reckless in certain directions, I take him to be as
+honest and kind-hearted as he is witty and pleasant in company.”
+
+Again he paused to gather strength, and I watched a sunbeam that had
+strayed to the wide fire-place, and seemed to play at fighting with the
+flames that flickered somewhat feebly round the half-charred log. I
+took no interest in sunbeam or fire at the time, and yet it all comes
+back to me as if I had seen it but yesterday.
+
+“Your fortune, Barbara,” said my grandfather, so suddenly that I
+started, “is not small. You are no penniless lass, thank God! and your
+affairs are safe in the hands of my good friends and lawyers, Messrs
+Carmichael & Dymock, Writers to the Signet in Embro’. Two days back I
+writ a letter to my Lady Erskine at the Hermitage, where I believe her
+now to be, giving her all particulars and information concerning my
+affairs. Her brother-in-law, Charles Erskine, a shrewd lawyer, will
+assist her in any difficulty, and I have appointed these two your
+guardians until the time you shall come of age, or marry.”
+
+“Yes, sir,” I murmured, as the low voice ceased; and as if he had come
+to an end of all that was in his mind, he turned his head aside and
+fell into a light slumber.
+
+During the night the inflammation and fever increased, and towards
+evening of the next day he died. His last look and words were for his
+faithful comrade and servant. He had been lying unconscious for some
+hours, or so it seemed, and we had thought that he would pass without a
+sign, but suddenly he opened his eyes and fixed them on Robert Guthrie
+standing at the foot of his bed.
+
+“It’s marching orders I’ve got, Rob,” he said, in a stronger voice than
+could have been expected, “and I maun leave you behind. But you’ll
+follow, my man, as soon as you’re able.”
+
+And Robbie, speechless with grief, brought his hand to the salute, and
+standing thus motionless he watched his old master die.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III
+
+OF MY NEW GUARDIAN, AND HER KINDNESS
+
+
+The snow was very deep and still falling on the day of my grandfather’s
+funeral, and many of his friends and neighbours who would willingly
+have honoured Colonel Stewart by following him to the grave, were
+unable to win through the drifts to Inverkeithing. Had the roads been
+more passable they would, Phemie told me, have thought little of riding
+twenty, thirty, or even fifty miles to foregather at Rosyth House,
+partly out of friendship for the dead man no doubt, but also because
+such meetings are a means of seeing friends and hearing news in a quiet
+and not over populous neighbourhood.
+
+For the honour of the house, our good Phemie saw to it that the board
+was well-spread in the dining-room, and that roast and boiled meats
+in plenty, and the best of my poor grandpapa’s cellar, were set forth
+before the hungry mourners. But out of pity for the orphan girl,
+whom they knew to be alone in the house, the gentlemen were wondrous
+considerate, and neither sat long over their meat, nor indulged freely
+in wine-drinking. The names of some of these kindly men, as retailed
+to me by Phemie, are still clear in my memory. There were Mr. Moubray
+of Culcarnie, or Cockairney as it is now called; Sir John Henderson of
+Fordell; and the Earl of Moray from Donibristle Castle. Sir Alexander
+Bruce, he that was now Earl of Kincardine, came from Broomhall; and
+Sir Robert Blackwood, that not long before had purchased the estate of
+Pitreavie, rode with him to show respect to the old Colonel’s memory.
+
+I was sitting in an upper chamber, disconsolate enough, and growing
+rather weary of the murmur of voices below, when I heard what seemed
+to be the bustle of an arrival at the front door.
+
+“Some late comer,” I was thinking, with girlish bitterness, “just in
+time to join the feast,” when my door opened, and I heard a pleasant
+voice say softly, “Nay, I thank you, I would see the young lady alone,”
+and rising from my seat I was confronted by a lady still wrapped in her
+travelling cloak, who came forward quickly, pushing back the hood from
+her face.
+
+“My poor Barbara,” cried she, “to think that a girl should be alone on
+such a day as this! I would have given twenty pound to have been with
+you earlier, my bairn, but I will explain the delay by-and-bye. Didst
+think thyself forsaken by all kind friends, my little Barbara, as well
+ye might?”
+
+Then putting her hands on my shoulders, and holding me from her, she
+smiled.
+
+“Nay! not little Barbara now, but tall Barbara, bonny Barbara, winsome
+Barbara. Even with so sad a face you mind me of your mother, child, but
+never, oh never, will you be as beautiful as she.”
+
+Without speaking I drew her to the settle by the fire. I knew very well
+who she was--my lady in the blue gown, with the merry voice and the
+kind smile, the “Cousin Katie” of my childhood, my new guardian, Lady
+Erskine. And then she fell to talking of my loss, and praised my dear
+grandpapa for a kindly and courteous gentleman, a brave and honourable
+soldier, a man of wisdom and intellect, polished and mellowed by
+contact with the world. I know not now all she said of him, but when
+she ended, I felt that it was a proud thing to be the granddaughter of
+such a man, even although he had borne no high-sounding title, nor held
+any great position as the world counts greatness.
+
+After a thoughtful silence between us, she took my hand in hers and
+smiled brightly.
+
+“And now for my explanation and apology, Barbara. I was indeed expected
+at the Hermitage a sennight since, as Colonel Stewart had heard, but
+alas! what should befall but that my youngest son should be ailing--no
+serious sickness, thank God! but one of those childish bouts of heats
+and chills, when the little head is heavy and the active limbs grow
+weak, and the poor bairn lacks nothing but to lie in its minnie’s lap.
+I fear you will blame me, Barbara; I am held by my own sisters to be a
+weak and foolish mother in that I let my children see how much I love
+them. Alack! I cannot hinder my love from having its way, and when a
+bairn is sick, and weak, and helpless, what better place can be found
+for it than its mother’s arms?
+
+“Ah, I see you agree with me, my dear, I have nothing to fear from your
+censure. Well, my little Harry held me in Alva with his tiny hands,
+though had I known the truth of what was happening here, I own I would
+have tried to break away a little sooner. I arrived at Dysart only
+last night, found your poor grandpapa’s letter awaiting me there, and
+learned the sad news that he was to be buried to-day. All my brothers
+are from home, and my lord is an old man unfit to venture out in such
+a storm; otherwise, my dear, some of my family would have been present
+at the funeral. But when I thought of you, poor child, alone and
+friendless in your sorrow, I could not wait another day before I came
+to you.”
+
+“Indeed, cousin,” I said, “I am most grateful and glad to see you. But
+I know not how your horses had power to drag you through the drifts.
+Did not the wheels stick often?”
+
+“I did not come on wheels, my dear, or I should never have reached you.”
+
+“What, did you ride then?” I cried, astonished.
+
+“No, no, I sat in my coach and kept as warm among my wraps as possible.”
+
+Then, seeing my perplexity, she added,
+
+“Have you never heard how in colder countries than Scotland the people
+ride about in winter in sleighs, that glide over the surface of the
+snow without making any deep ruts as wheels would? You must know
+that my husband’s youngest brother, Dr. Robert Erskine, is private
+physician to that great man, Peter, the Czar of all the Russias,
+and lives with him in Moscow, the capital of his kingdom. Well,
+when brother Robin writes about the sleighing and the comfort and
+convenience of it, and how smoothly they rush along, Sir John, my
+husband, claps his hand to his forehead and cries out, ‘Just the thing
+for Scotland! we’ll try it when the first snow comes!’ Oh, Barbara!”
+cried my lady with sparkling eyes, “there never was such a man as mine
+for trying new inventions, they are verily the delight of his life.
+So he writes to Russia for instructions as to the method, and gets a
+drawing from his brother how it’s done, and then when next the snow
+lies deep, off come the wheels of our lightest coach, and ’tis placed
+on runners and becomes a sleigh.”
+
+“And now, my dear Barbara,” said my lady, after I had asked many eager
+questions and received most kind replies, “now we must talk business.
+How old are you, my dear?”
+
+“I shall be seventeen, madam, in February.”
+
+“Why, you are a woman grown. Too old to go back to school, eh?”
+
+“Oh, madame!” I cried, “if only I need not return!”
+
+“Ah! you have not much love for the blackboard and the ruler; or is it
+the virginal and tambour-stitch that you are weary of?”
+
+“Nay, cousin, I love my lessons, and my dear grandpapa was, as you
+know, a learned gentleman. We read many books together that Mistress
+Lindsay and her sister, I am sure, never saw. He made me study French
+and talk it with him all my life, that I might not forget my mother’s
+tongue. The sisters Lindsay could teach me no more of that than I knew.
+I like to play on the virginal and sing, and my satin-piece and sampler
+were the best in the school. I can walk a minuet and sweep a curtsey
+with the best, and--and--in fact, madam, I know not what more they can
+teach me!”
+
+To this conceited speech, my lady replied with a smile and the quiet
+remark,
+
+“You had a more fortunate up-bringing than many country maids, my
+dear. Never forget what you owe to your good grandfather’s care. But
+still, I think,” she continued, “though not quite for the reasons you
+give, that you have been long enough at school, and now as to the
+question of a home.”
+
+“My grandpapa thought,” I ventured timidly, “that perhaps my Lord
+Sinclair, your father----”
+
+“Yes,” she interrupted, “he writ me of that in his letter. But the
+Hermitage is not the home I should choose for you. My lord is old, and
+my sisters are often away from home. You would scarce be happy at the
+Hermitage, Barbara; do you think you could be happy with me?”
+
+“With you, madam?” I cried.
+
+“At Alva,” she replied. “There are the two little boys, you know,
+Charles and Henry--very good-humoured children, though I, their
+mother, say it. They keep us stirring I can tell you, and dear little
+companions they are. Charles is not yet six years old, he is called
+after his paternal grandfather; little Henry, my father’s namechild, is
+just turned four. There was another, Barbara----”
+
+She paused, and her eyes took that deep, still look that I have seen in
+the eyes of other mothers of dead children.
+
+“Little Jamie, my bonnie baby! God only lent him to us for a few
+months, not quite a year, then He took him back again. Ah, Barbara,
+to see your baby lying dead--that makes a wound in a mother’s heart
+that the good God himself cannot wholly heal; indeed, I think He knows
+better than to try. But let us not speak of these sad things. Do you
+think you could live happy with us at Alva?”
+
+“Oh, very gladly indeed, madam,” I cried. “But Sir John--he has not
+been asked. He knows nothing as yet of my dear grandfather’s death.”
+
+“My dear,” said Lady Erskine, and the light in her face made even me,
+a young girl, wonder, “Sir John is my husband, and master in his own
+house truly, but he is still my lover, my best friend, my kindest
+companion, and no wish that I express doth he ever gainsay. Whether it
+be that I never wish for anything that could displease him I know not,
+but I am very sure that I have only to tell him the truth about you,
+and to say that I desire you to live with us, for him to receive you at
+Alva with the warmest, most fatherly of welcomes. His brother, Charles,
+is, as you know, appointed your other guardian, and it is meet and
+right you should share our home.”
+
+And so, in short, it was arranged, and more besides, for before she
+left Rosyth that day, my Lady Erskine had talked with Robert and
+Phemie, and prayed them in her gracious way, to accompany me to Alva
+House.
+
+“If Robert will take charge of the stables,” she said, “he will be
+doing Sir John a kindness, and find enough to occupy his time; and as
+for you, my good Phemie, I ask nothing better than to install you as
+head of my nursery, where you may keep an eye on my turbulent little
+lads, and watch over your own young lady as well.”
+
+Not all of her kind intentions were carried out, however, for alas! old
+Robert had contracted so grievous a chill standing bare-headed in the
+snow-storm by Colonel Stewart’s grave, that a mighty inflammation of
+the lungs set in, and before ten days were past the good old man was
+laid at the feet of his beloved master.
+
+“I kent weel hoo it wad be!” said Phemie sadly, yet with a certain
+pride in her tones. “Robbie was aye that set upon the maister, he just
+couldna bide wantin’ him!”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV
+
+I GO TO ALVA
+
+
+It hath often been a matter of surprise to me, as well as of great
+thankfulness, that a beneficent Providence should have cast my lot with
+friends so large-hearted and generous as Sir John Erskine and his dear
+lady. I might so easily have been compelled to find a home with people
+of a very different type, kind and excellent no doubt, but ignorant,
+narrow and obscure. It might have been my fate to live with a family
+of austere manners, of rigid life, of homely interests, like so many
+families at that time in Scotland, which indeed would have ill-accorded
+with my own disposition, and who knows what disastrous results might
+have ensued? With such people, and I have met with many in my life,
+’twould have been scarce possible for me to live happily, nor, I
+suppose, would they have found me to their taste any more than I them.
+For looking back upon my early life and character I know that I was
+but an undisciplined girl, needing firm but gentle guiding, spoiled by
+indulgence no doubt, impulsive, hot-headed, and rash, inheriting from
+my mother a strain of gaiety and light-heartedness calculated to lead
+me into temptation, and withal impatient of control. Still to be just
+to myself, I must allow that I was affectionate, honest, and fearless,
+and so capable of strong attachment to one whom I admired and loved
+as I did my Cousin Catherine, that any sacrifice made for her or hers
+seemed easy, and her simplest word was enough to check me, so eager was
+I at all times for her approbation.
+
+My dear husband, who knows me, I think, as no other human being ever
+did, tells me sometimes that one of my chief characteristics (he is
+too kind to call it a fault), is to idealise where I love. I believe
+he is right; but though it lays me open now and then to his friendly
+ridicule, I would not have it otherwise. It is a power (though some
+regard it as a weakness), which raises the standard of life for those
+who possess it. It closes their eyes to the mean side of human nature,
+for except where love and admiration are possible they take little
+concern; it gives wings to the hopeful heart that lift it high above
+the quagmires of despair, and it opens to faithful eyes a secret window
+in Heaven that lets a little of the holy light shine forth upon the
+dark things of the earth. And if we seldom realise our ideals, what
+then? Are we any the worse for having sought them? No more than is
+the lark, who, having mounted half a mile towards the sun, sinks back
+singing to his lowly nest, only to rise again to-morrow.
+
+I had no sooner set eyes upon Sir John Erskine, than I understood, in
+a dim and girlish way, the meaning of that light which I had seen upon
+his wife’s face when she spoke of him to me. There was that in his big
+and burly form, as he stood at the door of his house to welcome us,
+in the kindly lines of his face and the humorous gleam of his eye,
+in the hearty tones of his great manly voice that had yet a thrill
+of tenderness in them, that caused me to realise, as far as a young
+maid may, that here was a man that no woman and very few men could
+dislike. I have heard since that day, God knows, many evil things about
+Sir John, not one half of which I believe. I know him to have been a
+careless liver, gay, reckless and imprudent, more witty than wise, and
+as wild in his speculations and inventions as any foolish gambler. I
+know what misfortunes his conduct brought to his family, and I cannot
+but blame him for many things that he did, and yet with it all he was
+a much loved man, one whom his friends excused even while they accused
+him, a man who never did a cowardly action, nor, I firmly believe, ever
+spoke an unkind word--in short, a man of genius wanting ballast, but
+possessing a most generous nature, and a charm of manner that won all
+hearts, even those that were fain to reprove him.
+
+To me, Barbara Stewart, the orphan girl who had but little claim upon
+him, he was kind beyond all telling, and if my lenient view of his
+character be somewhat inspired by grateful remembrance, who can blame
+me?
+
+I can see him now as he appeared to me on that late winter afternoon,
+lifting his wife over the snow-sprinkled threshold into the lighted
+hall, and kissing her hands with tender courtesy while she clung to his
+arm for a moment, her sweet face raised to his. But before I had time
+to do more than cast a glance of timid curiosity round, she turned and
+drew me forward.
+
+“And this is Mistress Barbara Stewart,” cried Sir John, holding out his
+hand in kindest greeting. “I bid you welcome to Alva, my dear young
+lady, and trust you will find with us a happy home. Our family and
+yours have intermarried more than once in by-gone years, so I beg of
+you to look upon me now and always as your loving kinsman and faithful
+servant.”
+
+With that he made me a very low bow, which I answered with a deep but
+modest curtsey, trying in faltering, girlish words to express my thanks
+for his goodness. But the strangeness of my surroundings and perhaps
+the fatigues of the long, cold journey well-nigh overcame my composure,
+and I cast my eyelids down to hide the rising tears. My lady came to
+my rescue, and taking my hand in hers, began to lead me towards the
+staircase.
+
+“Poor Barbara,” said she, “is quite exhausted; her very lips are stiff
+with cold. She will answer your courteous speeches better, my life,
+when she hath drunk a cup of hot wine, and sat awhile beside the fire;
+and here are our little lads waiting to kiss her hand.”
+
+Looking up, I saw descending slowly towards us two of the bonniest boys
+it had ever been my lot to meet. The elder, whose fair face was lighted
+up with eager excitement, looked ready to fly to his mother’s arms, had
+it not been that his steps were hampered by the less active movements
+of his younger brother whose hand he carefully held. Golden-haired
+and blue-eyed, with strong and sturdy limbs, little Charles appeared
+to me a child to rejoice the hearts of parents and friends alike; but
+charming as he was, it was to the pretty baby, Hal, that my whole
+heart went out upon our first meeting. He looked at me from a pair of
+eyes so large and dark that I named him “Harold Beaux-yeux” on the
+spot, and after a moment’s grave contemplation of me, his little face
+broke into a winning and bewitching smile, and he suffered me, stranger
+as I was, to take him in my arms, with the most gracious air of dignity
+in the world.
+
+You may judge if Barbara did not speedily forget her loneliness and
+fatigue as she pressed the lovely child to her heart, and how soon the
+happy prattle of both the little lads gave her the blessed sense of
+feeling perfectly at home.
+
+Limited as my experience was, I very quickly discovered that the
+manner of living at Alva House was greatly in advance of the general
+rule in Scotland at that time. Not only was the restless genius of Sir
+John continually engaged in schemes for beautifying and embellishing
+his estate, but the appointments inside the house showed culture and
+refinement which could only have been acquired by contact with the
+world beyond our narrow borders. The walls of the public rooms were
+set in panels and hung with pictures, there were carpets and rugs upon
+the floors--a luxury by no means common even in the houses of the
+rich--curtains of foreign tapestry hung over the doorways and before
+the windows, and silken cushions and pieces of rich embroidery added
+beauty to the furnishings. My lady drank her tea at “the four hours”
+out of dainty chinay cups brought from overseas, and the house was full
+of beautiful and curious objects fetched home by Sir John and others
+from Paris, Holland and London, or things of stranger, wider interest
+sent by Doctor Robin Erskine from his far-off home in Moscow.
+
+The winter months went swiftly, and, when in the middle of February
+the snow had left the ground, Sir John was constantly employed with
+his men at the work so dear to his heart, namely: making walks and
+terraces about the house, improving the garden, and laying out the
+policies to the best advantage. Having gathered some small interest in
+such matters from my dear grandfather, I was ever ready to accompany
+my kind host in his tours of inspection, especially as my lady, having
+contracted a cold in the latter end of January which still confined her
+to the house, was unable to be his companion, a source of grief at all
+times to her whose happiest moments were those spent by her husband’s
+side.
+
+“Go you with him, Barbara!” she would cry with a smile. “Oh, go, and
+listen to his talk, but don’t forget the lonely and jealous wife who
+would fain be taking your place!”
+
+To say truth, Sir John proved himself an entertaining comrade, and
+since he was pleased to remark that I had an intelligence for outdoor
+matters beyond my years, he would discourse to me about his plans and
+schemes for hours together.
+
+“You must understand, Barbara,” he said one day, “that although I have
+little liking for the English or their manners, and, so far as seeking
+good company goes, would infinitely rather take ship and sail to
+France than step into my coach and be carried to London, yet I cannot
+but allow that in matters of agriculture and husbandry, in farming,
+forestry, and all country lore, our southern neighbours are many years
+ahead of us.”
+
+“Will you please to tell me about England, Sir John,” I said, partly
+from genuine interest in his talk, and partly, I doubt not, with
+unconscious feminine guile because I saw that it pleased him to have a
+listener.
+
+“Since 1707,” he went on, “the year, as you are aware, of the political
+union of the two countries, a union which has scarce yet proved very
+happy for Scotland, but which I have strong hopes may yet be the making
+of her commercial fortune, and aid greatly in the general amelioration
+of her people--well, since the Union, I and many others, as members of
+Parliament have been obliged to ride yearly to London; and passing as
+I do, so many of the seats of the nobility and gentry, I was at first
+struck with amazement, then with shame, and finally with envy that
+gave birth to emulation, to think that within a few hundred miles of
+these, our land--with far greater natural beauty to boast of--should be
+left so wild, so bare, so uncultivated. My kinsman and neighbour, the
+Earl of Mar, has indeed shown a noble example at his house at Alloa,
+and it will give my lady pleasure to take you there one day to see his
+gardens. They are laid out in the Dutch taste, and are modelled on
+those at Hampton Court, which, as you know, was the favourite residence
+of King William. My lord gives constant employment to something like
+a dozen men under a master-gardener, and he has of late years planted
+a large number of forest-trees. But though his zeal for this sort of
+work is great, and his taste remarkable, he cannot be persuaded to take
+so much interest in the enclosing of pastures, or the dressing and
+enriching of his fields, as I could wish.”
+
+“Is the cultivation in England finer than ours?” I asked.
+
+“Oh, beyond all comparison!” quoth Sir John. “It would astonish you, my
+dear Barbara, to see upon a June day, the rich waving foliage of trees
+that stretch for miles along the smooth and pleasant highways, the
+well-tilled fields divided by blossoming hedges, the comfortable inns,
+the neat cottages with their little gardens well filled with flowers
+and fruit. One receives an impression of peace, comfort and prosperity
+which is very pleasing, and as I said before, it seems strange to think
+that the two countries lie close to each other, and that their climates
+are not so very different. It irks me the more,” he went on, “in that
+Scotsmen themselves are acknowledged by all foreigners to be more
+learned, wise and polite than the English, and where many an English
+country squire would be barbarous, ignorant and rude, a Scotsman of the
+same station displays all the accomplishments of a well-bred gentleman.
+Yet in matters of such importance as those I have mentioned our country
+is not to be compared with theirs.”
+
+“Pray, Sir John,” cried I, “are not the farmers very grateful to you
+for instructing them in more civilised methods?”
+
+He laughed, a great merry laugh. “Indeed, my dear, they are not.
+They would fain dig up my trees and burn my hedges, as hath been done
+already on some estates, only I believe the love they bear to my lady
+holds them back. They grumble monstrously at ‘Sir John’s new-fangled
+ways,’ and say that the trees do but eat the good out of the land, and
+the hedges harbour birds that devour their grain. For some winters back
+I have fed my beasts on clover-grass, red clover made into hay, which
+the creatures relish and fatten on; but my tenants call it English
+weeds, and prefer their old method of crushed whin and dried bracken
+for winter fodder. Great and powerful is the old devil, Ignorance,
+Barbara, and most devoutly do some folk cling to his feet and worship
+him.”
+
+“And what, Sir John, will enlighten them?” said I.
+
+“Nothing but intercourse with the outside world, which, by degrees,
+will become easier and more general. Only by seeing others living in
+better condition than himself will the Scots peasant be moved to try to
+improve his own lot.”
+
+“I am glad you are planting trees,” cried I. “They are lovely and
+lovable, and their shelter and shade are most pleasant.”
+
+“Ay,” said Sir John, “but all do not think alike on this subject, for
+one of my tenants said to me but yesterday, ‘If the Lord had ettled tae
+hae trees in the carse, Sir John, wad He no’ hae planted them there
+Himsel’?’ And when I made answer that, as the Lord had not caused us
+to be born with houses on our backs like the snail, doubtless He meant
+us to dwell upon the bare hillside, the good old man looked at me
+sorrowfully, and humbly begged my honour not to blaspheme. Now, what,”
+said Sir John, with a shrug of his shoulders, “can you make of a mind
+like that, Barbara?”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V
+
+I HEAR OF THE SILVER GLEN FOR THE FIRST TIME
+
+
+I can bring to mind one morning when my lady, having recovered from
+her indisposition, called me to her and proposed that we should walk
+through the grounds and see what had been done about the place. The
+little boys, tired of the nursery in which they had been prisoners
+during a week of rain, came running and shouting by our side. The
+sunshine made the fresh world golden; the sky was blue and cloudless,
+and the wide carse seemed to be a cup filled with opal-tinted air,
+rimmed by the distant hills. The blackbird and the mavis led the
+concert with their love-songs, and frequently we stopped to listen
+to their notes. In the garden walks near the house the deep yellow
+crocuses opened their hearts to the sun, and the green spikes of the
+hyacinths pushed through the brown earth, giving promise of beauty and
+fragrance to come.
+
+“The spring is a lovesome time,” quoth my lady, smiling happily on
+flowers and birds and children. “When the earth renews herself after
+her winter torpor I want to live for ever. I feel that every year we
+ought to have the power like her to grow young and fresh again; but,
+alas!” she sighed, “this is not so. We fade like the leaves and drop
+off and are forgotten. Others arise in our place, but we ourselves
+return again never.”
+
+“You will live for fifty happy years, at least, cousin,” I cried, “and
+will come again in your children’s children for many generations. It is
+impossible that you can ever be forgotten!”
+
+She smiled at me and shook her head. “You must bear with my moods, dear
+bairn, for, when you know me better, you will find in me a strange
+commingling of light and darkness, of gaiety and gloom. Sir John, who
+by nature looks ever on the bright side of things, tells me that I
+love to contemplate the clouds only. I know not how it is, but even my
+happiness gives me pain, and I enjoy all pleasures so keenly that the
+very enjoyment ofttimes leaves me tired and sad.”
+
+I mind me of her words very well, because at the time they struck me
+with a great surprise. Of all the women I have seen and known my Cousin
+Catherine was the one with whom I most associated the idea of constant,
+gentle gaiety. The ready smile, the kindly word, with her were never
+wanting, and although I have seen her angry and disturbed enough when
+things went wrong and folks were stupid, or when any injustice done
+came to her knowledge, these moods were but the flashing of a summer
+storm that quickly passed and left the wonted serenity behind. That
+all her brightness covered unknown depths of seriousness, and that the
+spring of her laughter lay very near to tears, was an idea which, to my
+childish mind, was well nigh incomprehensible. Looking back across the
+years with wistful eyes--the years of chequered light and shade, of joy
+and pain, of strife and peace that have made up my life--I, grown older
+and wiser, know and understand the sweet, deep nature of my friend, as
+I never could have done while I was near her.
+
+“I have never seen you dumpish or melancholy, madam,” I murmured, half
+abashed by her words. “I took it that you were a very happy woman,
+cousin.”
+
+She laughed merrily at that.
+
+“Why, so I am, Barbara, one of the happiest in Scotland. Never heed my
+words, child; I was but dreaming aloud.”
+
+I looked into her face, relieved, (so sensitive are the young to the
+influences around them), and saw there a look that spoke of happiness
+indeed. The soft pink colour rose in her cheeks, and her eyes grew
+brighter and softer as she gazed in front of her. Following her glance,
+I caught sight of Sir John standing at the end of the long avenue,
+directing his men at their work.
+
+“Why, there is your papa, my little sons,” she cried. “Now, see who can
+reach him first to kiss his hand. If Barbara would run with little Hal,
+perhaps it would be safer for the small feet.”
+
+At this, nothing loth, we three children (for I was little better than
+a child when it came to a frolic) ran off down the broad walk with
+shouts of glee, and, because of Baby Harry’s lagging steps, to which
+I had to pay heed, the race was won by Master Charles, very proud and
+triumphant.
+
+“Mama is here! mama is coming, papa!” he cried, “and she bids me kiss
+your hand. Will you walk with us, if you please, Sir John, and show
+Barbara the mavis’s nest we found before the rain began?”
+
+With a parting word to his men and a kindly smile to me, Sir John
+lifted little Hal to his shoulder and walked back with us to meet my
+lady.
+
+And here I may say that what my Lady Erskine had told me of her
+method with her children was perfectly true. There were more love and
+confidence between these little lads and their parents than was at all
+common in most families; and yet I did not find that the conduct of the
+children needed censure, nor that their characters suffered in any way.
+How was it possible when their lives were made so bright that their
+minds should not expand more readily than when surrounded by dread
+and gloom? Was their obedience not more spontaneous, and therefore
+more precious, because given through love, than when forced by fear of
+punishment? And was not the frank exchange of thought with older minds
+a constant advantage to their growing intelligence? And yet I know that
+young Lady Alva was regarded by many as a lax and indolent mother,
+seeing that she spared herself the trouble of correcting her little
+sons by harsh discipline and stern reproof.
+
+“When my own life is filled with so much brightness, Barbara,” she
+said to me one day, after a visiting neighbour had tried to bring her
+to a sense of her imperfections, “how can I fail to make my children
+happy too?” And she added in her sweet and pious way, “I do most truly
+endeavour to lead my little ones to love their Heavenly Father through
+the love their earthly parents bare to them. But there are some folk,
+Barbara, who think it shame to talk of earthly love, and presumption to
+think of the heavenly, and with such I have no traffic in thought or
+sympathy at all.”
+
+Such, then, was the atmosphere in which these children were brought up,
+and I must own that two more innocent, sprightly, good-humoured little
+lads it would have been hard to find.
+
+But to return to the happy party on that sunny morning strolling in the
+broad walk. While little Hal was prattling from his father’s shoulder,
+my lady walking by her husband’s side, her hand locked in his, Charles
+skipping and running, now before, now behind, and Barbara as gay and
+careless as any, it suddenly occurred to me to make a somewhat forward
+remark.
+
+“Pray, Sir John,” I cried, “are you not a very rich man, to be able to
+give work to so many folk?”
+
+Looking back over my shoulder as I asked this question, I intercepted
+a glance between Sir John and my lady, which appeared to me full of
+mutual understanding. Instead of replying to me the gentleman said
+softly to his wife, “Shall we tell her the secret of the hills, my
+heart?” To which she replied in French,
+
+“I think she is to be trusted; but be careful of the children, my
+friend, for our eldest is ever ready to pick up information, and has
+not yet the discretion to withhold it from others.”
+
+“You must know, Barbara,” said Sir John in the same language, which he
+spoke with great fluency and address, “that what you say is true. I am
+indeed a wealthy man, so wealthy that all my schemes of policy for this
+place, though likely to cost a fortune, will not exhaust my resources.
+You have heard that I am the possessor of coal mines, which already
+yield me a good sum yearly; but now I am going to tell you of something
+more precious still to be found within the bowels of those dear,
+beautiful hills, of which you are so great an admirer. What do you say
+to silver, Mademoiselle, a vein of silver, forming a mine so rich that
+it seems as if neither I nor my sons will ever come to an end of it!”
+
+“Silver!” I exclaimed, more astonished than I ever expected to be.
+“Silver in Scotland, Sir John? Why, I never imagined such a thing
+possible.”
+
+“Not only possible, but actually here,” rejoined the knight, “and some
+day you shall be taken to see it in working. Now that the frost is like
+to be out of the ground if this thaw continues, we can set in motion
+the engineers and miners, who, during the winter months, are perforce
+kept idle. Oh, there is no end to my dreams and imaginings about this
+ore, and what may be done with it--Why do you pull so hard at my hand,
+my lady?”
+
+“Oh, my dear Sir John,” cried she, half laughing and half vexed; “your
+mine is like the milkmaid’s pail in the fable. Think of its fate, and
+of the disappointment of the poor dreamer, and do not let your hopes
+soar too high.”
+
+“Ta-ta-ta, my dear,” cried her husband, “now is not this just like you?
+No sooner do I begin about the glories of our future wealth, which is
+no dream, but founded on solid fact, than you tug at my hand, pull down
+your pretty lip, and cry, ‘Beware!’”
+
+“I care not for your scorn, dear husband,” said Lady Erskine seriously.
+“There is something within me stronger than I, which whispers
+forebodingly whenever this mine of yours is mentioned. I know not what
+it means, but if I believed these inner ghostly warnings, I should say
+that your silver is fated one day to bring us all ill-luck.”
+
+“But how many times, my life, have your warnings come to naught? Did
+you not say t’other day that you had a heavy presentiment of coming
+evil which concerned our eldest son, and the only thing that happened
+to him was the bruising of his fingers with the carpenter’s hammer.
+And when I was well-nigh lost in a storm crossing from France, two
+years since, were you not merry and gay in your father’s house, recking
+nothing of your poor spouse his danger?”
+
+My lady laughed, but she gave a little shiver. “Do not remind me of
+these horrors, I pray you. What I feel about the mine I cannot explain,
+and foolish though it may be, it has yet to be proved groundless. Look
+you, my dear, is it not possible for the precious metal suddenly to
+give out, and to leave you with all your projects on your hands, and
+nothing wherewith to meet them?”
+
+“Now, a truce to such gloomy forebodings!” cried Sir John gaily in
+English, and calling to Charles to lead the way to the mavis’s nest, he
+swung little Hal to the ground and bade him run with his brother, while
+their father would do his best to catch them.
+
+“Will you tell me, madam,” I said, as we walked more slowly behind,
+“why you bade Sir John speak French a little while back? Is the silver
+mine to be kept secret?”
+
+“Assuredly, my dear Barbara,” cried my lady in some alarm; “I
+understood you to have gathered as much from our method of talk. This,
+you must know, is one of our difficulties, and it is perhaps the chief
+reason why the subject lies so heavy on my mind. The affair is worked
+in secret, and kept private to our family, for should the knowledge of
+it slip out, there are not wanting those who could make trouble for
+Sir John. By an ancient act in Scots law, all ore found in the country
+must pay a heavy tax to the Crown; and as Sir John has no great mind
+to enrich the coffers of the Hanoverian, either in a public or private
+way, he hath hitherto managed to keep all knowledge of his mine well
+within his control, and the silver it yields in his own pocket. But
+alas! Barbara, a secret shared by many is no secret at all, and there
+is no end to the mischief that might ensue were you to let your tongue
+wag never so wisely on the matter.”
+
+“Believe me, dearest cousin,” I cried with some heat, “such a thing
+is far indeed from my intention. I would rather be dumb for the rest
+of my life than harm you or Sir John by one careless word. There is
+nothing I would not do to serve you and yours, madam, who have been so
+unspeakably kind to me. Pray, pray, believe me, and trust me as you
+would your own heart.”
+
+“What a fiery creature it is!” said my lady, smiling kindly, as she
+patted my flushed cheek. “Well--but all I ask of you, Barbara, is just
+a little discretion.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI
+
+INTRODUCES SEVERAL CHARACTERS
+
+
+“Aunt Betty returns home to-day!” cried Charles one morning, as I came
+into their room to give my good Phemie greeting, “and I am to ride with
+the coach to fetch her, my mama says, and to be her little escort.”
+
+Now I had heard much from my Lady Erskine of her favourite sister
+Betty, and was looking forward with girlish eagerness mixed with
+diffidence (being troubled with the fear that the engaging young
+lady might not find me to her taste), to making her acquaintance. I
+therefore turned quickly to the child and clapped my hands.
+
+“How glad I am to hear it!” I cried. “She is very bright, and gay and
+pretty, is she not, your Aunt Betty?”
+
+The boy stared at me for a moment in surprise, and then he broke into a
+laugh.
+
+“Why, no, Cousin Barbara,” he cried. “Aunt Betty is dull and sad,
+and--but my mama does not allow me to say it--sometimes a little
+ill-humoured. We must be very gentle with Aunt Betty because she is
+old, but I must own to you that I do not love her very much.”
+
+“She gives me sugar-drops,” cried little Hal stoutly, “and for that I
+love her--sometimes!”
+
+My perplexity grew as I looked from one bright face to the other.
+
+“Whither do you ride to meet her?” I asked of Charles.
+
+“Oh, all the way to Stirling!” he cried. “I may not be back till
+bed-time. I am a big lad now, cousin; I do not need to sleep during the
+day like my brother.”
+
+“But does not your Aunt Betty live at Dysart with my lord, your
+grandpapa?” I enquired, still much in a puzzle.
+
+“Oh, yes!” they cried together, “the other Betty does, dear Betty,
+kind Betty! She it is who is bright and gay. But great-aunt Betty
+Erskine--well, you will see!”
+
+“She hath been spending some months,” went on Charles, “with her
+brother the Colonel, who you know is Governor of the Castle of
+Stirling. I love to go with him round the ramparts, and he took me once
+down into the dungeons, but--” with a faint note of regret--“there were
+no prisoners in them.”
+
+“Perhaps there will be some before very long,” I said to console him,
+little dreaming how soon my careless words were to come true.
+
+“Well, be very careful of your great-aunt, Cha, and we must all
+endeavour to make her happier when she comes.”
+
+My good opinion of my dear lady, already great, was much increased when
+I beheld her bearing towards her husband’s aunt, for with the direct
+ways of children, her sons had spoken nothing but the truth.
+
+Mistress Betty Erskine, who made her home for some months of the
+year at Alva, was not a cheerful inmate for any house. Her age, her
+infirmities, and a certain habit of looking on the worst side of
+everything, rendered her querulous and gloomy; and I watched with
+admiration, learning gradually to curb my own impatience and follow
+the example of the house, the gentle toleration with which the poor
+lady was treated. Sir John had ever a cheerful word with which to greet
+her. My lady bore her complainings with quiet kindness, and the little
+boys, as you have seen, were taught to behave to her with deference
+and respect. And surely ’tis a beautiful thing to see this kindly
+treatment of the old, for age, beyond a doubt, is a great misfortune,
+and one from which there is no escape but death. Sure, no one would
+choose to grow old, but would prefer to keep their youth and vigour
+unimpaired; and though many (unlike poor Aunt Betty,) give us fair and
+sweet examples of a cheerful old age, even towards these some patience
+is required, and every sympathetic art should be used that can console
+them.
+
+At last, however, “the other Betty” did arrive, and what a rush
+of fresh gaiety entered the house with her! If my lady was the
+personification of peaceful cheerfulness, her sister was the very
+spirit of joyous merriment. The first made me think of a soft bright
+day in June, but the other was April and July in one, with at times
+a brisk touch of December. Such laughter, such kindness, such whims,
+such little tempers! And how the Honourable Betty contrived to be so
+charming with it all has puzzled wiser heads than Barbara’s.
+
+Even her own sister was sometimes astonished at her sayings and doings,
+her sudden gusts of anger, her sharp words, her fits of gloom, but
+before she had time to reprove her, Betty’s arms would be round her
+neck, and a gay laugh or a murmur of loving words would disarm her
+displeasure. Sir John watched them together, laughing at and with
+his sister-in-law, for they were fast friends and boon companions,
+although the knight teased her sometimes almost to the verge of tears.
+Her little nephews adored her, and any servant about the place would
+cheerfully have cut off a finger at her bidding. Even great-aunt
+Betty smiled a wintry smile at some of her gay sallies, and forgot to
+complain of the weather, or the country, or her own aches and pains,
+while Betty held the table at attention.
+
+I remember the day she came, a breezy, sunny, laughing April afternoon,
+when we were assembled in the parlour for “the four hours.” Suddenly
+there was a sound of horses’ feet stamping and scraping at the
+front-door, and a merry voice made itself heard above the din, calling
+out for Andrew, or Peter, to come and take the nags.
+
+“Why, tis Betty!” cried my lady rising, the pretty colour coming to her
+cheeks as it did so easily upon any excitement, and before I knew it
+we were both in the front-hall, watching the dismounting of a lady in
+a dark blue habit, assisted by a man in the garb of a gentleman, whose
+face I could not see. Another moment, and with a rush and a whirl she
+was in my lady’s arms, and saying a hundred merry, happy things in a
+breath.
+
+“I thought you would like me to take you by surprise, sister,” she
+cried, “and it was so long to wait till next week, and I longed
+to be with you and to see Sir John before his departure, and the
+travelling-coach lacks repairs; so as the roads are good and the
+weather fine, my lord permitted me to ride horseback with, as you see,
+our good friend David for escort.”
+
+At this she beckoned with her hand to the young gentleman who stood
+on the threshold, and Sir John, coming up at that moment, he gave him
+hearty greeting.
+
+“Welcome, friend David!” he cried, laying his hand upon the other’s
+shoulder, “and so this wild girl as usual bids you drop all other
+duties, and act as mounted guard in her ladyship’s journeyings. Oh, ho!
+Mistress Betty, art never happy but with a train of followers all ready
+to do thy bidding.”
+
+“Nay, Sir John,” cried Betty, pouting, but holding up her cheek for
+him to kiss, “my train of followers this time is modest enough, though
+to be sure David Pitcairn is, for kindness and quickness, a host in
+himself, as the saying is. But when a poor girl hath only brothers who
+are ever too busy to attend her, and a father, loving and tender but
+infirm, must she refuse herself the comfort of a gentleman’s company
+upon the road, and be content with serving-men?”
+
+“Indeed!” cried the young gentleman, who had meantime been paying his
+respects to my lady, “Mistress Betty knows how willing all her friends
+are to serve her, and Sir John is aware that no duties could possibly
+stand in the way of a gracious command to attend her.”
+
+Now I may say here that I have seen Elizabeth Sinclair in many dresses
+and in various surroundings--in the ballroom, swimming and languishing
+through the minuet with infinite grace; in the garden gathering roses;
+in the still room, her white arms bare and her pink fingertips daintily
+busy; laughing and romping with the children, her hair ruffled, and her
+breath coming quick through parted lips; at her spinning-wheel in the
+twilight, silent and absorbed; and seated at the virginal, singing some
+old French song, her round chin uplifted and the candle-light forming a
+halo round her head; but fair and attractive as she was in all these
+attitudes, I loved and admired the most to see her on horseback. Then,
+indeed, she appeared at her best--slim, graceful, joyous, a thing of
+life and motion swaying to every movement of the animal as though the
+same will inspired them both; and it is no marvel to me now to recall
+the adoring look with which young Mr. Pitcairn regarded her as he
+spoke. Even then, I, a girl but just waking up to the knowledge of
+life, thought ’twas writ plain in his face, how willingly he would ride
+with the lovely and seductive Betty through the wide world till life
+ended.
+
+But all this time I had been standing apart watching the newly
+arrived lady, shy, silent and doubtful, longing for a word, a look of
+recognition, but heavy at heart with the fear that she might find me
+too young, too trivial to notice; and then my lady’s kind voice said,
+“And this is Barbara.”
+
+Betty turned on me in her swift, light way.
+
+“Why, of course it is!” she cried, and her hands clasped mine, and
+her merry eyes were raised to my face, for she was several inches the
+shorter.
+
+“What a tall girl! and oh!--my dear Barbara, I swear it is not honest
+to steal a Scotswoman’s complexion of clear white and red, and add to
+it a foreigner’s charms of liquid dark eyes and hair nearly black.”
+Then pulling my face down, she whispered roguishly, “Dost know that
+thou art lovely, child, and I am almost jealous of thee?”
+
+So saying, she turned and followed her sister into the parlour, leaving
+me tingling with delight and confusion at hearing for the first time
+from the lips of another the thing that I had often hoped might be true.
+
+I think it was the next afternoon, for Mr. Pitcairn was with us, and
+I know that he had been bidden to lie at Alva for a couple of nights,
+that we made our excursion to the Silver Glen.
+
+There are, as you know, many lovely ravines in the Ochil Range,
+formed by the age-long working of the burns that, rising near the
+summit, tumble noisily down the sides by their self-made channels
+till they reach the quiet river that bears them to the sea. These
+mountain-streams were ever a delight to me, and I could sit for hours
+upon a mossy stone watching the ever-changing water as it slipped
+past, now lying at rest in a quiet brown pool, anon breaking over the
+stones with a gurgling ripple, and then flinging itself down the steep
+rocks in a foaming cascade. And as I watched I listened to the voices
+that for me were never silent--three voices there were that talked,
+separately and altogether--a deep roaring bass, a soft middle voice,
+and a high tinkling treble; and what they said to me I cannot tell you,
+but perhaps some young maid, who has sat dreaming vague dreams to the
+sound of falling water, reading this may remember and understand.
+
+The Silver Glen lies not far from Alva House, and though small is very
+beautiful; and on this April day when the young leaves of the birch
+trees were fast beginning to shake themselves out of their winter
+wrappings and toss their graceful beauty in the sun, when the ground
+smelt sweet with new life, and the pale primrose and frail anemone were
+beginning to appear in the grass, it seemed to my foolish young mind a
+grievous thing that the place should be filled with busy workers, that
+heaps of ore and broken rock should lie in confusion beside the burn,
+and that the sound of pick and hammer should almost drown the music of
+the water.
+
+As we began to climb the hillside, Betty had turned to her friend,
+David, with an impressive gesture, and cried gaily,
+
+“Remember, sir, the secret of the hills must be guarded inviolate. Are
+you strong enough to keep silent?”
+
+They were standing a little apart, and no one but myself heard his
+reply. Looking deep into her eyes, he said in a low voice,
+
+“Betty, do you need to ask me that? You know that I am!”
+
+Just for one moment a shadow fell on her face, and her eyelids dropped.
+Then she gave a little laugh.
+
+“David, you are cruel to be so serious over a trifle! What is it that I
+know? Can you hold your tongue, ay, even in the torture-chamber, about
+what you are going to see here? Remember the head of my dear Sir John
+is not safe should you or any of us babble, for is it not high treason
+to deprive the King of his revenues? Swear eternal silence, or else
+turn round and march straight home.”
+
+“Madam,” cried Mr. Pitcairn, becoming aware, as I think, of my
+presence, “I swear by the light of your own beautiful eyes never to
+divulge the secret of what you are about to show me.”
+
+With that we laughingly continued the ascent, and joined my lady who
+stood at the entrance of one of the long tunnels talking to a man whose
+back was turned to us. Sir John had gone on a little further to where
+some workmen were beginning to form a new opening.
+
+“Betty,” cried my lady on our approach, “here is James Hamilton
+returned. He hath been, as I told you, in Germany on an errand for Sir
+John, connected with the assaying of the ore. He is glad enough to get
+back, I trow.”
+
+I glanced at the man who stood smiling beside her. He was tall and
+had a handsome face, save that the eyes were too near together; and
+although he was dressed in the rough clothes of a common workman, he
+had the air and bearing of a gentleman. When he spoke his accent was
+refined, and his voice had a pleasant ring.
+
+“Yes, indeed, madam,” he answered, bowing low in reply to Betty’s
+greeting, and then to me as my lady pronounced my name. “I was not born
+for wandering. Travel in foreign lands does but endear my own the more
+to me.”
+
+“Tush, James!” cried Sir John, coming towards us, “what is this
+nonsense you talk? ’Tis but to make yourself acceptable in the eyes of
+the ladies, I dare swear. If Mr. Pitcairn and I were alone with you,
+doubtless we should hear another tale. Far be it from me to belittle
+Scotland, but there’s many a flaxen-haired Gretchen and blue-eyed Marie
+fair enough to delight the heart of man betwixt Rhine and Elbe, and I’m
+vastly mistaken if thou’rt the sort of fellow to go about with thine
+eyes shut to the beauties of nature.”
+
+“I vow,” cried Mr. Hamilton, laughing in his turn, “that I never, Sir
+John, in all my travels for the last two months, had the good fortune
+to light on anything so fresh, so beautiful, so entrancing, as the
+group before me at this moment.”
+
+He swept us a courteous bow which included all three, but it seemed to
+me that his eye rested longest on Betty, and a little wicked jealous
+pang pinched my heart. Should I ever, I wondered, be so attractive as
+to draw the eyes of all men to me as seemed to be the way with Betty.
+Alas! what foolish, useless thoughts we suffer to lodge in our minds
+when we are young, to the exclusion often of that which is wiser,
+higher and infinitely more worthy.
+
+“La, Mr. Hamilton,” cried Betty, “you are vastly polite. But as you
+have already told us that nothing in the country pleased you, the
+compliment you pay us is not so exalted as it seems.”
+
+Mr. Hamilton turned to my lady.
+
+“There is one thing, madam, with which I can never keep pace,” he said,
+“travel as hard as I may, and that is Mistress Betty’s tongue!”
+
+“I must own ’tis a very nimble one,” said my lady, smiling. “And now,
+James, I want you to show the working of the mine to Mistress Stewart,
+who hath but lately come to live here. Give Mr. Hamilton your hand, my
+dear, and trust yourself to his guidance.”
+
+It was a strange thing to me to leave the green and sunny world behind,
+and to walk straight into the heart of the hill, where, in the stifling
+darkness, by the dim light of lanterns, men toiled and sweated with
+pick-axe and spade to wrest from the very entrails of the earth the
+treasure that was enabling Sir John to beautify and improve his estate.
+The passage through which we walked was narrow--I could lay a hand
+upon the walls on either side, and the foot-way was rough and slippery
+and precarious, so much so that I could scarce attend to what my guide
+was saying, as he explained the method of finding and extracting the
+silver. Here and there water oozed through the rock and dripped upon us
+as we crept along, and presently we came upon a deep hole or pit, where
+looking down I saw the forms of men bending to their work. So weird
+and goblin-like they looked in that uncertain light that I shivered
+and drew hastily back. Upon that Mr. Hamilton caught me sharply by the
+arm with a quick word of warning, and glancing round I perceived with
+a thrill of horror that another opening or shaft, narrower but much
+deeper than the first, gaped darkly just behind me. So startled was I
+at the sight, that I clung to my companion’s arm in terror, and for a
+moment could neither speak nor move. Seeing this, Mr. Hamilton soothed
+me in a very kind and gentle way, and turning slowly he guided my
+footsteps back along the way we had come.
+
+“I must have your forgiveness, Mistress Barbara,” he said, “for having
+startled you by so suddenly clutching at your arm. But I feared that
+you might step too far the other way, and I did not, as you may
+imagine, wish to see the light of the loveliest eyes in all broad
+Scotland quenched in the darkness of the pit.”
+
+Now, had I been a few years older or more experienced, no doubt I
+should have treated this speech with the haughty displeasure it
+deserved, for the man was a stranger, and the young maid he addressed
+was the ward of his employers; but Barbara was in those days very
+young, very thoughtless and foolish, and the compliment pleased me,
+little feather-head that I was, because it was the first that I had
+ever received from one of the sterner sex. Here was a proof of the
+admiration that I longed for, and an opportunity of showing myself _the
+accomplished coquette_. The sunlight was glimmering on the dusky walls
+as we approached the entrance, so I tossed my head and replied in tones
+which I fondly hoped resembled those of the Honourable Betty,
+
+“La! Mr. Hamilton, you are monstrous kind, I am sure, to pay me such a
+pretty compliment. But how can your words be true, when you know that
+Mistress Betty is standing within a few yards of us?”
+
+“Mistress Betty!” he cried in low tones, and with a kind of soft
+amazement. “You cannot possibly think, madam, that any man of taste
+would glance at that charming lady while such an one as yourself was
+by?”
+
+Now I have said that Barbara was silly, which is true; but she was not
+for all that an absolute fool, and inexperienced as she was, she had
+sense enough to see that this time the compliment was too gross to be
+genuine. So she laughed very merrily, and begged Mr. Hamilton not to
+talk any more nonsense.
+
+We proceeded for some way in silence, but just as we neared the full
+daylight the gentleman turned and spoke quickly and gravely in my ear.
+
+“The truth, madam, can never be nonsense,” he said. “For my part I
+would sooner have one glance from your dark eyes, and a smile from your
+exquisite lips, than all the sparkle and charm of Mistress Betty’s
+beauty and wit, great as these are.”
+
+Alas! for my fleeting discretion, how his words set my heart a-beating!
+When we stepped out upon the hillside into the wind and the sunshine,
+I knew that my cheeks were glowing, and my eyes shining with unwonted
+light.
+
+“Why, Barbara,” cried my lady, “you look fey! What didst see and hear
+within the hill to give thee such a colour, child?”
+
+I was silent in confusion, but Mr. Hamilton came to my rescue.
+
+“I regret to tell you, madam, that Mistress Barbara narrowly escaped
+falling down the shaft, and the little incident has no doubt shaken her
+nerve.”
+
+“How strange!” scoffed Betty, with a keen glance at me. “Now when I am
+frightened, sister, I turn as white as chalk: but to be sure, Barbara’s
+way is the more becoming!”
+
+That night after Phemie had left me--for the good creature would
+always attend me to my couch as in the old days--I heard a light tap
+at my chamber door, and opening it, I found Betty, in night-rail and
+slippers, standing on the threshold, her fair hair demurely braided
+ready for her cap.
+
+“I am coming in, Barbara,” she said, and walking past me into the room
+she seated herself in a chair, and left me standing before her.
+
+“Now,” she cried, lifting a finger at me, “confess! What did that man
+say to you to-day in the tunnel!”
+
+Utterly taken aback I could only gaze at her, and gradually the
+remembrance of the words, which I had well-nigh forgotten, came back to
+me, and the colour deepened in my face.
+
+“Mistress Betty!” I cried, “what mean you?”
+
+“My good child,” she exclaimed, “do not try to deceive me, for it is
+useless. I know as well as if I had been by your side all the time
+that James Hamilton was saying something to you, as foolish as it was
+pretty, down there in the dark, and I wish to know what it was.”
+
+“But, madam,” I protested feebly, “I do not see why I should tell you!”
+
+“Hoity-toity!” cried she, “so the child has some spirit! And why not,
+pray? At so early a stage in the proceedings he can hardly have said
+anything you are ashamed to repeat.”
+
+This was attacking me upon another side, and finding it useless to
+fence with her, I weakly surrendered.
+
+“Ashamed!” I repeated, blushing hotly. “Why no, scarcely that; but
+standing here with you, Mistress Betty, the words seem to me senseless
+and vain, which by his side in the darkness yet gave me a certain
+pleasure.”
+
+“Ahem! I thought so. He praised your dark eyes, I suppose, and
+delicately gave you to understand that beauty such as yours is a new
+and rare thing in this country-side. Perhaps he told you that beside
+you I was not worth a glance. Was that it?”
+
+Amazed, I could only murmur. “But how, madam, could you know?”
+
+Betty lay back in her chair and laughed. “How do I know? Ah, Barbara,
+what an innocent you are. I know because I have been seventeen myself,
+though that was some time ago now; and because men are all cut out on
+one pattern, at least most of them; and because your eyes and your
+blushes called it aloud to all the world; and because compliments made
+to one maid are very much like compliments paid to another, and--oh,
+well, because I am a woman, and know a good many things without being
+told at all.”
+
+I stood, looking no doubt as much chagrined as I felt, till Betty had
+finished speaking, then I threw myself down on a settee a little way
+off, and cried petulantly.
+
+“But where is then the harm of a compliment, seeing they are so common?
+and why should I not be innocent in such matters--a girl but just out
+of school? ’Tis not quite kind of you to laugh so, Mistress Betty.”
+
+She was grave again at once, and answered gently.
+
+“Nay, child, it was wrong of me to mock, and having come to warn you, I
+have but succeeded in angering you. Forgive me, Barbara. James Hamilton
+is a handsome man, and a clever one; he is a scion of an old and noble
+house, and ’tis no shame to him but much to his credit that he works
+hard for his living. But, Barbara, I do not trust him; why, I know
+not. There is something in his nature antagonistic to my own. I mock
+and joke with him, but all the time my spirit is saying to his spirit,
+‘Keep off, we are not friends!’ and if we lived together fifty years,
+at the end of that time we should still be strangers.”
+
+She spoke so gravely that I could not be offended; here was no womanish
+jealousy, no idle fault-finding, no carping at a laggard lover. I was
+wise enough to comprehend this, and I answered with a gravity equal to
+her own.
+
+“In what do you distrust him, madam?”
+
+Betty spoke more lightly.
+
+“Nay, that I can hardly tell you; but look you, my dear, you are young,
+and fair, and a fortune. ’Twould not be detrimental to James Hamilton’s
+ambitions to win a bride like yourself; but you are destined, I trust,
+for better things than that. During the summer you will see a good deal
+of this gentleman, and I beg of you not to let yourself be drawn into a
+net, out of which you might, later, long in vain to escape.”
+
+Without waiting for a reply, she jumped up and made for the door,
+crying,
+
+“Good-night! Forget not the words of wisdom, but do not allow them to
+disturb your slumbers.”
+
+She vanished behind the closing door, and I retired to bed, not quite
+so convinced of her wisdom as I ought to have been.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII
+
+I BECOME AWARE THAT SOMETHING IMPORTANT IS AFOOT
+
+
+The days of spring fled swiftly and easily for me in my pleasant abode
+although nothing happened to mark their passage with any particularity.
+Less than a week after the arrival of Betty, Sir John, whose journey
+had already been delayed much beyond the usual time, by the state of
+the roads and the inclemency of the weather, took his departure for
+London, leaving behind him as I know now, though at the time I gave but
+little thought to the subject, a very lonely and disconsolate wife.
+
+Whatever burden that tender heart was forced to bear, it was hidden
+under an aspect of calm cheerfulness, and the healthful activity which
+so greatly distinguished my Lady Erskine. And indeed, I have often
+wondered how Alva House and estate would have held together, had its
+mistress given way to repining, or indulged herself in selfish grieving
+and idle brooding over her troubles. When, after a short stay, her
+sister returned to Dysart, she busied herself from morning till night
+both inside the house and about the place. I have often found her
+in the farm-yard before seven o’clock of a morning consulting with
+Mr. Rose, the grieve, as to the buying or selling of certain cattle,
+the condition of the young lambs, or the sowing of seeds in field
+or garden. Anxious to follow her husband’s lead in all things, she
+contrived with some trouble to keep the men at the walks which she
+longed to have completed before the knight’s return, and all questions
+regarding the planting of flowers or vegetables were submitted to her
+for arbitration. Besides all this, there were friends and visitors to
+be entertained, poor folk to be assisted, beggars to be fed; and sure
+never was house so famed for hospitality to rich and poor alike, for
+scarce a day passed without guests in the dining-room, or pensioners in
+the kitchen. Placed so near the high-road that runs between Stirling
+and Dunfermline, and night and day was thronged with passers-by, it
+served as a convenient house-of-call from which none were sent empty
+away; and though some might feel inclined to grumble at the vast
+expenditure which this open-heartedness entailed, it never seemed to
+enter the minds of Sir John and his lady that any other manner of
+living was possible.
+
+Among the neighbours who lived within a few miles of Alva were many
+friendly gentlemen who, with their ladies, appeared to enjoy nothing
+better than to ride over and dine or sup with us, in order as they
+said, to cheer my Lady Erskine in her loneliness; and right welcome
+did she make them all, though at times I have fancied she had been
+as well pleased to be left in peace and quietness with her children.
+Living in the centre of a large circle of relations, her own and her
+husband’s families being largely represented in that part of the
+country, there was a constant coming and going among them, and as the
+roads grew more fit for travelling, my lady would occasionally spend
+a night or two from home with one or other of her numerous relatives.
+At Stirling Castle lived her husband’s uncle, Colonel Erskine, a kind
+and jovial old officer, and a vast favourite with all the younger
+generation. Not far off lived her eldest sister-in-law, the widowed
+Lady Ardoch, whose son, Sir Harry Stirling, was a frequent visitor at
+Alva. Another sister-in-law, her namesake, Catherine, was Mrs. Patrick
+Campbell of Monzie; while a third, Helen, was the wife of Mr. Haldane
+of Gleneagles. My lady’s eldest sister, Grizel, was married to Mr. John
+Paterson of Prestonhall, and a younger, Margaret, had lately become the
+wife of Sir William Baird of Newbyth. So with her home at Dysart still
+occupied by a kind father, and several brothers and sisters, you can
+imagine that there was much pleasant intercourse between them in those
+days.
+
+Sometimes we took the road to Edinburgh, where we passed a day or two
+with the Dowager Lady Alva, at her house in Miln’s Square. The first
+time I went was when we carried Aunt Betty there on her yearly visit.
+It was then also I made the acquaintance of my guardian, Mr. Charles
+Erskine, one of the kindest men and most fascinating companions it has
+ever been my lot to meet. You will have come to the conclusion among
+yourselves that it is next to impossible for your cousin Barbara to
+have any word but of praise to say of any creature bearing the name
+of Erskine, and indeed it would ill become me to regard them in any
+other way. But the charm of manner, the kindliness and courtesy which
+distinguished Sir John, and his brothers, Charles and Robert, though
+of the last I can only speak from hearsay, were such as to have left
+a lasting impression, not only on the mind of a simple girl, but upon
+society in general.
+
+No words of mine are needed to establish the reputation of my Lord
+Tinwald, happily still among us; and though circumstances have
+prevented me seeing much of him since my marriage, I have heard from
+time to time of his honourable career, of his many virtues, and of
+the happy circle with which he is surrounded at Alva. Happy and
+kind and good, he was likewise in those far-off days busy with his
+work at the Bar, and rejoicing in the love of his pretty wife (his
+beloved Chrissy), and their baby daughter. I remember him very well
+as he appeared to me then, handsome and courtly, full of humour and
+liveliness, his face beaming with kindness, his manner winning, and
+his voice soft. He spoke with a slight natural lisp, which so became
+him that his brother, Sir John, often declared he would not part with
+it for a fortune, and of no man could it be said with more truth than
+of your Uncle Charles, that he knew how to suit his discourse to his
+audience; for among his colleagues in the courts, or with his little
+nephews in their nursery, he found ever the right words to speak, and
+the subject most congenial to his hearers.
+
+You will no doubt be wondering what effect the wise and kind words of
+Mistress Betty Sinclair, regarding modesty and discretion, had had
+upon the conduct of Barbara, and I am sorry to be obliged to tell you
+that although they were not forgotten, the impression they had made
+very soon slipped from her mind. Although it was but seldom she saw
+Mr. Hamilton, except in the presence of my Lady Erskine, I can well
+recall that even thus he was able to convey in silent and unobtrusive
+manner, many hints of his admiration and respect, which inflamed her
+silly vanity and set her heart a-fluttering. There is nothing on earth
+so foolish as a young girl in her first encounters with the other sex,
+if she be unaccustomed to flattery and somewhat inclined to frivolity.
+I must honestly own that I cannot recollect any great breach of
+modesty on my part towards my admirer, but there is no denying that I
+practised upon him all the little feminine arts (such as soft glances
+and coy blushes, sudden frowns and scornful smiles), that many women
+are skilled in from their cradles. It pleased me to see him come and
+go, and to hear his voice speak my name, for in some subtle way he
+continued to let me know that, however much he was occupied by affairs
+with my lady, mine was the presence he regarded, and mine the eyes that
+his own were anxious to meet.
+
+Partly on account, I imagine, of this senseless attraction, and partly
+because my life at Alva seemed the perfection of simple happiness, I
+heard with some dismay that my lady was about to leave home for several
+weeks, taking me with her to my Lord Sinclair’s house at Dysart. Just
+at first I felt moved to protest against the plan and to beg her to
+leave me behind, but a moment’s reflection showed me that not only
+would such a course savour of great ingratitude, but that the request
+would be both foolish and useless, as it was not seemly that I should
+live in the house protected only by the servants.
+
+It gave me a certain satisfaction, however, to meet Mr. Hamilton that
+same evening, as I walked in the garden with little Charles for my
+companion. It was near the middle of May, and the blossom was thick
+on the fruit-trees, and the flowering shrubs were gay. The air was
+fragrant with scent, and a cuckoo was calling loudly from some secret
+place among the trees. The sun was gone behind the hill, though it was
+a long way yet from setting, and a soft light breeze blew across the
+valley from the unseen river. I was chatting merrily with my little
+friend, when suddenly I heard a footstep behind me and turned to find
+James Hamilton close upon us. His hat was in his hand, and his eyes
+were full of a pleasant deference. Charles ran back a step or two to
+catch hold of his hand, and I must needs pause also, until they made up
+upon me.
+
+“This is sad news, Mistress Barbara,” he said in answer to my smile,
+“if it be true that we are to lose the light of life from Alva for a
+couple of weeks or more. Tell me if it is so, and give me, I pray you,
+some word of consolation.”
+
+“If by the light you prize so much, you mean my lady’s presence, Mr.
+Hamilton, ’tis true that you are to be left in darkness for some time,
+and the only consolation I can offer you is that I trust it will not be
+for ever.”
+
+He gave me a glance of half-comic reproach. “Cruel creature!” cried he,
+“’tis your pleasure to torment me. Great as is my respect and liking
+for her ladyship, ’twould be hypocritical to pretend that her absence
+will darken my sky. Do you not know, Mistress Barbara, who it is that I
+shall long for with a great longing?”
+
+I looked at him from under my eyelashes, and frowned as if perplexed.
+
+“Sure then there is only myself left,” I said slowly.
+
+“And I wish that you could be left!” he cried with fervour, “seeing
+that I am to remain at Alva. Well, Mistress Barbara Stewart,” he went
+on, as I declined to respond to this advance, “I wonder if you will
+find the Hermitage to your liking. There are gallants enough among my
+Lord Sinclair’s sons to please you, and if their time is not too much
+occupied with politics, they may even succeed in making you forget us
+altogether.”
+
+“Are the family at Dysart, then, so much interested in affairs of
+state?” I asked.
+
+Mr. Hamilton laughed.
+
+“Rather more than His Gracious Majesty, King George, would approve
+of. But I must be careful, madam, how I talk. Your inclinations and
+sympathies, no doubt, are in accord with your name.”
+
+“Nay, sir,” I cried, “I protest I know not what you mean. But as my
+lady is waiting for little Charles we must not linger now. Farewell,
+Mr. Hamilton; I daresay by the time we meet again you may have grown
+more serious-minded.”
+
+“Farewell, madam!” he replied, with a bow. “By the time we meet again
+we shall all, doubtless, have become wiser.”
+
+I scarce can tell you when it first dawned on my mind that, with regard
+to political matters, something stirring was afoot. I had heard since
+coming to Alva, some talk about the King in Lorraine and his chances of
+success, from the various visitors who frequented the house, and many
+a bowl of punch was brewed, from which we ladies were given a glass
+to drink to the downfall of the usurper, and the establishment of the
+rightful heir. I had listened in a vague way to the toasts and the
+jokes, for many a gay laugh was raised among them, and I, smiling too,
+had not thought it worth my while to discover if they were serious or
+no. But one afternoon when my lady had driven to Stirling to visit the
+wife of Sir Hugh Paterson of Bannockburn, I heard some talk that was
+grave enough to set me thinking.
+
+Lady Jean was, as you know, sister to my lord, the Earl of Mar, and
+at this time she had staying with her in the house, her nephew,
+Thomas--“Lordy Erskine” as we often called him--a boy of some eleven
+or twelve years old. To our little Charles he was of course a great
+hero, being twice his age, and tall and strong for his years, and the
+two were now at play in the garden while I sat with the ladies in
+the parlour to drink a dish of tea. My lady had been enquiring after
+the health of my Lady Frances, Tommie’s step-mother, and her young
+daughter, a babe of a few months old, and Lady Jean was lamenting the
+fact that they were not yet able to come to Alloa.
+
+“But indeed, my dear,” she said, “all things seem unsettled, and I am
+gravely anxious about my brother and his projects. You know that his
+sympathies jump with our own, and yet it seems to me he inclines to
+ingratiate himself with the enemy. Were he to turn cat-in-the-pan now,
+I know not how our friends could bear it.”
+
+I saw my Lady Erskine’s fair face flush with displeased surprise.
+
+“Nay, Lady Jean,” she cried, “I’ll not believe it! Such a thing is not
+possible from the Earl. Why, I know that it is his dearest hope to
+bring the King back from exile, and our husbands, madam, have as you
+know, not hesitated to put their fingers in the pie.”
+
+“From which they will be lucky if they extract anything but a
+scalding!” said Lady Jean with a rueful smile. “My dear creature, have
+patience with me! Are you never yourself tormented with forebodings of
+evil when all the rest of the world is prophesying prosperity? That is
+my condition whenever I think on the subject so near our hearts, but it
+is useless to speak of it. We women must nurse our fears in silence.”
+
+“Indeed!” cried my lady, “Barbara Stewart here will tell you how apt I
+am to look on the dark side of the cloud on many occasions, but this
+thing _cannot_ fail. We hear that the King of France is heart and soul
+for the Cause, and Charles of Sweden likewise, and with a General like
+the Duke of Berwick, and my Lord Bolingbroke for Councillor to King
+James, there is no fear this time of the project coming to naught.”
+
+“God grant it may be so!” sighed the other. “No woman in Scotland
+has the wish for the restoration of that family more at heart than
+I. Were it only for the sake of the poor, good, true-hearted Queen,
+who, blameless and innocent herself, has suffered so much and with
+such patience, I should desire it most warmly. But restoration means
+rebellion, and rebellion means war, and my woman’s heart trembles at
+the very thought.”
+
+“I try not to think too much of that,” Lady Erskine replied gravely.
+“As my father’s daughter I should be willing to give my best and
+dearest for the King, but if it means my parting with my husband, Lady
+Jean, or you with yours, then God help us both!”
+
+“Nay, nay!” cried Lady Jean, seeing the look in my dear lady’s eyes, “I
+meant not so to disturb your mind. We are both brave women, I take it,
+and can bear what Fate sends. But I dearly wish poor, foolish Anne had
+been reconciled to her brother before she died, when, despite the Act
+of Succession, I dare swear justice would have been done without our
+having to fight for it.”
+
+But here my lady thought it wise to send me from the room, on the
+pretext of finding Charles for our return home, and what further was
+said upon the matter I know not.
+
+Now I should like to say here that ’tis prodigiously uneasy for me to
+write of those days, and the events that happened, and the people that
+took part in them, without permitting the influence of later knowledge
+to colour my narrative. Therefore it must be forgiven me if my tale
+appears to halt in some places, and to be over-particular in others.
+More especially must this be the case in speaking of the characters of
+the actors in this drama I am endeavouring to describe, with some of
+whom I came in contact, though of many I can but speak from hearsay.
+
+After all, I would ask, how is it possible to know with accuracy the
+inner motives of any man’s actions? To his Maker alone, I am inclined
+to think, is this knowledge given. He, himself, is influenced by
+many happenings, urged on consciously and unconsciously by the words
+and even the thoughts of others, so that at times he regards his own
+doings with surprise, now astonished at his unlooked for success, now
+bitterly repenting his grievous mistakes; and if you tell me that by
+setting forth such a belief I try to rob men of their responsibilities
+to God and to their neighbours, I will only reply that it is possible
+we may not be so responsible for the good that we do and the evil that
+we commit, as we suppose. My dear grandpapa, who was a great admirer
+of the works of Mr. Shakespeare (a dramatist who has, I fear, gone
+somewhat out of fashion) was fond of quoting, among other of his wise
+sayings, that, “There is a Destiny that shapes our ends, rough-hew them
+how we will!” and to him, as also to me, this thought has oft brought
+comfort.
+
+It is a thought that is very apt to come to my mind in considering
+the character and conduct of the Earl of Mar. Saving once only, and
+for a short time, I never set eyes upon this gentleman, but his name
+was once as familiar in my ears as my own, and there is no man in the
+world of whom I have heard so much good and so much evil spoken. The
+kinsman and near neighbour of my guardian at Alva, of the same age,
+and with the same tastes, John Erskine, sixth Earl of Mar, was a man
+greatly beloved and trusted in his own country-side. By his opponents
+he has been called treacherous and shifty, by his rivals, ambitious and
+unscrupulous, and his conduct as statesman and as general has laid him
+open to the bitter attacks even of those whom he might have counted as
+his friends; but by his neighbours at home he was known to be affable
+and obliging, kind and helpful, never withholding assistance where it
+was desired in matters great or small, and doing all with so easy a
+grace as made his favours the more acceptable; for he asked nothing in
+return, and seemed to live only to gain the good-will and affection of
+all around him.
+
+At Alva House, as I can bear witness, he was admired and loved for his
+private, rather than for his public character. He hath long ago passed
+beyond the reach of human praise or blame, dying after long exile in a
+foreign land, and if his sins and mistakes were great, they brought him
+neither happiness nor reward. May his ashes rest in peace! I remember
+him as a kind and courteous gentleman; and his gardens at Alloa were a
+sight most beautiful to behold.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII
+
+I GO TO DYSART
+
+
+Far as I have travelled and beautiful as are the countries I have
+seen, the fairest pictures that hang in the galleries of my memory are
+pictures of bonnie Scotland. To me it seems that in those far-off days
+of which I write the sunshine was brighter, the air more limpid, the
+shadows bluer, and the trees of a softer green than any I have seen in
+later years. But well my foolish heart knows ’tis but the glamour of
+distance, that enhanceth all beauty, lingering round the scenes of my
+youth, and the magic strength of early impressions that keeps them ever
+fresh in my mind.
+
+And yet it would be hard to deny that the prospect seen from the coast
+of Fife, looking southward, is one of the fairest of its kind in the
+world. How blue and sparkling was the water of the Frith on that May
+morning, as my lady and I approached the little town of Dysart; how
+white the foam of joyous wavelets that broke upon the rocks! Far away
+the great Bass and Berwick Law rose like twin fortresses side by side,
+and against the opposite coast the white sails of ships and small
+boats shone in the sunlight. Westward, where the slender masts of the
+shipping rose thickest, the town of Leith was hidden in its own blue
+smoke, but behind it the Lion kept watch over Edinburgh Castle, and
+the Pentlands melted faintly into the soft summer sky. Our road had
+followed the coast for some miles, and it had pressed heavy on my heart
+to come so near to my own dear home, and yet to pass it by. My kind
+cousin had known very well what was in my mind, and had laid her hand
+on mine with a mute pressure of sympathy at sight of grey Rosyth, with
+the ripples breaking round its feet. But the beauty of the day forbade
+me to be sad, and as we reached the Hermitage, I broke out into cries
+of delight and admiration which pleased my lady well.
+
+Mistress Betty and her youngest sister, Mary, were waiting at the door
+to welcome us, and we were immediately shown into the presence of my
+Lord Sinclair, whose stately demeanour impressed, while his kindness of
+manner delighted me. His greeting of his daughter, Catherine, was all
+that a tender father’s could be, and her joy at seeing him again was
+as little restrained as if she had been still but a child. While she
+settled herself beside him for such converse as was most agreeable to
+them both, Betty and her sister bore me off between them, the former
+full of questions that awaited no answers, the latter, who was a
+delicate, gentle girl, silent and smiling and willing to be friendly.
+
+“We are a large family, my little Barbara,” cried the former, “and I
+trust that you have plenty of spirit to face it. Fortunately it is not
+here in full force at present, as Jamie is with his regiment abroad,
+and Matthew still at school; Grizel and Meg, as you know, are in homes
+of their own, so there remain only my eldest brother, John, Will, Harry
+and little Nannie here. Still, when we are met round the family-board,
+we make a goodly show; and as we are not silent people, it sometimes
+requires my lord’s sternest frown to quell the tempest of noise.”
+
+Later in the day, I met for the first time, that strange, and to me
+incomprehensible gentleman, your uncle, the Master of Sinclair. As his
+not too happy life came to a close some five years ago, he leaving
+no children to cherish his memory, I count myself free to make my
+comments upon his character, as otherwise I could not have done. It was
+difficult to believe when I looked upon this heavy, sullen-browed man,
+that he was the son of my handsome and courtly host, and brother to the
+sunny-faced ladies whom I loved. To me he ever appeared the one sour
+fruit upon a sweet and wholesome tree; and though seeing him in the
+bosom of his family, where his deference to my lord and his affection
+for his sisters predisposed me in his favour, there was about him, in
+his looks and in his words, such a scarce-veiled bitterness that I
+wondered at times they did not check him for it.
+
+My dear Elizabeth, I soon discovered, had a prodigious admiration for
+her brother, and took every occasion to extol or excuse him even to
+me, of whom as an insignificant girl he took but little notice, leaving
+me therefore the more at leisure to observe him.
+
+“The Master hath not been one of Fortune’s favourites, Barbara,” she
+told me one afternoon, as we sat on the rocks below the house and
+watched the sea-gulls wheeling about after their evening meal. “My
+father, proud of his learning, for indeed he is passing clever, and a
+scholar of no mean degree, was opposed to his going into the army--a
+thing upon which my brother had set his heart. He set out for the
+Continent with scarce any money, and many and great were the hardships
+he endured. But a soldier he would be, and by degrees he won the
+friendship and esteem of his Grace, the Duke of Marlborough, so that
+when sorely slandered and in danger of his life, he stood his friend;
+and through him also was gained the favour of the Queen, who, by
+granting my brother his pardon, showed very plainly that she considered
+him not in fault.”
+
+Now I had heard from Aunt Betty Erskine the doubtful story of the
+Master’s quarrel with Captain Schaw and his brother, of the trial
+by Court Martial of Captain Sinclair, of his escape out of camp
+after being sentenced to death--an escape assisted, as most people
+surmised, by the great duke himself--of his terrible night ride through
+the forest to the sea-coast and safety, and of his arrival at the
+Hermitage, where he had some difficulty in convincing his father, the
+most honourable of men, of the integrity of his conduct. All this is a
+matter of history, and, I thereby betray no secrets. But as the ancient
+lady who recounted these things to me, had added many caustic remarks
+of her own as to the bullying, quarrelsome nature of the Master, and
+the probability of his having been wholly in the wrong, I found it
+difficult to answer Betty with the enthusiastic agreement she seemed to
+expect.
+
+“Do you not admire my brother, Barbara?” she cried, looking sharply at
+my embarrassed face. “What have you in your mind against him, child?”
+she asked hastily, as I strove to find an answer.
+
+“I am displeased with him to-day,” I answered, with a childish
+petulance wholly feigned to cover my deceit, “because I heard him speak
+of my dear Sir John as--as an intolerable fool!”
+
+Betty laughed and sighed a little.
+
+“Oh, Barbara,” she said then, “one of the strangest things in the world
+is the amount of enmity that exists between those who might so easily
+be friends. My brother was abroad when Catherine was married to Sir
+John, and I think he resented finding him coming and going as a son
+of the house, when he returned _under a cloud_ as it were. That is
+the only reason I can think of in the beginning. He was also bitterly
+against the Union which Sir John supported, and now when more than half
+the country is anxious for its repeal, and my brother-in-law of Alva is
+strong for the Restoration which should bring it about, the Master, as
+you can understand, hath many a jibe ready to fling at those ‘waverers’
+as he calls them. It grieves me much that they are not better friends,
+for Catherine, of course, supports her husband and is not best pleased
+at my brother’s attitude.”
+
+“Your family is strong for the King?” I questioned, not wishing to
+discuss the Master further.
+
+“Oh, my dear,” cried Betty, clasping her hands, “that is another matter
+of dissension that hurts me to the very heart. You know that my lord
+was the only man of the Scottish nation who had courage to protest
+against the title of King William to the throne, and when none would
+listen to him he rose and left the Assembly. The matter goes very deep
+with him. For myself, I am willing to lay down my life almost for King
+James, and my sisters, Grizel and Catherine, are also of my mind. Of my
+brother James I cannot speak. He is Major in the Royal Scots Regiment
+of Foot and is a brave and able soldier, but I pray he may never have
+to use his gifts in fighting against the King. Will and Harry will
+do as my father bids them, and John is already deep in preparations
+among our neighbours. But many of those we know and love the best are
+bitterly opposed to our schemes, and we are obliged to be very secret
+regarding them.”
+
+“Your great-grandfather, I have heard, suffered imprisonment for King
+Charles,” I said.
+
+“Indeed he did; being taken at the Battle of Worcester, he was kept
+a prisoner for nine long years. But I rejoice to think the brave old
+man lived to see the Royal House restored and to rejoice in the King’s
+favour, who graciously made mention more than once of his gratitude to
+my lord.”
+
+“Ah!” cried I, “to suffer for those we love but binds the ties of
+affection closer. My dear Lady said this to me t’other day, but I
+scarce understood her words. ’Tis in the blood of your family to fight
+for the rightful King, and doubtless had my dear grandpapa lived I
+should have known more about it than I do now.”
+
+“He deemed you too young, child, to discuss such matters with you, but
+I know that he was one of the gentlemen, who, along with my father and
+many other noblemen, signed the memorial to the King of France, brought
+over to Scotland by one Captain Hooke, in the year 1707; and I have
+heard him tell how often and how longingly he had scanned the Frith
+from the windows of his house, hoping that early some summer morning
+he should see the King’s ships with sails full-set come boldly up the
+river to anchor in Leith harbour.”
+
+“And why came they not?” I asked, my heart beating at the tones of her
+voice, and the thought of my dear grandfather’s eagerness disappointed.
+
+“Alas! they came indeed, but after long delay. First ’twas promised
+for the month of August, and our hopes were very high, but the summer
+and the autumn passed, and we had to bear our anxieties in patience
+through the winter, which was hard. Letters were written by one and
+another of the loyal lords and gentlemen asking the meaning of the
+delay, and begging the King for God’s sake to come speedily; but little
+satisfaction did they get. At last, in the Spring, the French King
+ordered the expedition to sail from Dunkirk, but even then there arose
+confusion and many difficulties, owing, it was said, to dissensions
+between the ministers of War and Marine. The expedition was under
+command of the Comte de Forbin, an Admiral of skill and discretion, and
+into his careful charge the young King was delivered with all ceremony
+by the King of France. But if his own story is to be believed, and he
+hath spoken often with my brother of Alva on the matter, he had no
+great faith in his mission, nor in the sincerity of those who pretended
+to further it.”
+
+“What mean you by that, madam?” I asked.
+
+“Listen, my dear, and you shall hear. I suppose it is difficult for
+you, Barbara, to understand my heat and interest in this subject, but
+you have not been through it all as I was; you did not see and feel the
+fears and hopes, the sickening anxieties, the impatience and despair,
+and finally the wild and joyful exultation, when we heard that at last
+our young King was about to land on Scottish shores. My lord was kept
+supplied with the latest news by our good friend, Mr. Straton, in
+Edinburgh, who still works faithfully for the Cause, and you may be
+sure that, had the King landed, as was expected, close to our doors, my
+father would have been one of the first to welcome him. And to think
+that he actually came almost in sight of them, only to be snatched away
+again by a cruel fate!”
+
+“I can but dimly remember,” I cried, “the French ships in the Forth,
+and the firing of the guns, and how Phemie told me one morning that the
+King was come to his own. But I heeded it little at the time, being
+much taken up with a new puppy that Robert Guthrie had brought for me
+the day before, and after that it slipped from my mind and nothing
+occurred to bring it back again. I think shame now to be so ignorant
+and indifferent.”
+
+“Nay,” said Betty, “you were but a child, and Colonel Stewart was a
+discreet man. Indeed we were so much wounded and disappointed in our
+hearts that we spoke but little on the subject for years.”
+
+“But tell me more of the expedition, I beg, and why it failed and
+disappointed everybody,” said I.
+
+“Well, they set sail from France, in spite of stormy weather, and by
+God’s good Providence they eluded the English Fleet which was cruising
+about on the watch for them, and sailing before a favourable wind
+they overreached their mark, for instead of making the entrance of
+the Frith, they found themselves on the fourth day off the coast
+of Scotland opposite to Montrose. They immediately put about and
+endeavoured to enter the river, but meeting with contrary wind and
+tide, they were obliged to anchor out yonder, Barbara, near the Isle of
+May. In the meantime, as soon as the Fleet had been pronounced ready
+to sail, the King had dispatched from France a trusty messenger in
+the person of Mr. Charles Fleming, brother to the Earl of Wigton, to
+prepare us for his arrival. He landed in Aberdeenshire at the house
+of the Earl of Errol, who, upon receiving the King’s instructions,
+instantly sent off a messenger to our good neighbour, Mr. Malcolm of
+Grange, who was to have a boat and pilots ready to go on board the
+first vessel that should give the signal--five shots was what had
+been agreed upon--after entering the Frith. This indeed we did, but
+before any use could be made of his directions, the sound of the firing
+of cannon came from the South, and Sir George Byng with the English
+ships of war was upon them. Admiral Forbin, with his precious charge
+on board, thought only of saving him and the treasure, and with some
+difficulty he escaped capture, returning to Dunkirk with the loss of
+but one vessel, the _Salisbury_, which after three hours’ engagement
+with the English, struck her colours.”
+
+“And what happened then?” cried I, eagerly.
+
+“Ah! then we fell into great depression. Many noblemen and gentlemen
+who had mounted their horses so gaily to ride to Edinburgh to receive
+the King, turned their faces sadly home again. From universal joy the
+town passed to distraction. Consternation reigned in many hearts,
+for none knew what the Government might do in revenge. As a matter
+of fact, many of these gentlemen, my dear father among them, were
+clapped into prison, and there remained for some weary months. But I
+believe they felt that less than the humiliation of their Cause and the
+disappointment of all their hopes, for these had risen very high, and
+our hearts had been full of exultation.”
+
+We sat for some time watching the fair evening light settle down over
+the scene. The sun was setting far away behind the Highland hills, but
+the soft reflections tinged the opposite coast, and veiled the distance
+in a golden mist. The sea-birds were still crying up and down in front
+of us; the sound of the waves had grown fainter with the out-going tide.
+
+The lovely picture pleased only my outward eye to-night, for I was
+thinking deeply of the tale out of the past that I had just heard
+from my companion. Some tone in her voice, more earnest than her
+wont, proved to me without doubt how deeply she had been stirred at
+the remembrance; and I knew that this pure loyalty was in her heart’s
+blood, and that her love for the exiled King would leave her only with
+life.
+
+“But, Betty,” I ventured at last, very softly lest I should disturb her
+brooding thoughts, “why did they not land the King at Montrose when
+there were no English ships in pursuit? Would it not have been better
+to come ashore anywhere, seeing the county was expecting them and only
+too glad to welcome them? I think Mr. de Forbin was a very foolish
+person.”
+
+Betty laughed heartily, and turned an approving glance upon me.
+
+“Why, little Barbara, you are asking the very questions that our
+disappointed lords and gentlemen asked themselves and others, and to
+which no answers have ever been given. The conclusion the wisest of
+them--my father being among them--came to was this: that King Louis had
+no mind at that time to allow the King to land in Scotland, but if the
+attempt raised an insurrection in this country, and recalled the Duke
+of Marlborough and some of his army from fighting against the French,
+it would serve Louis pretty well. It did not even do that, as you have
+seen; it only served to pain and humiliate some loyal and faithful
+people.”
+
+“I fear King Louis is not a friend to trust to,” cried I, with youthful
+impulsiveness.
+
+“Oh, do not say that now, child,” cried Betty, “lest it be an omen
+of evil. It is to his help and succour we are looking at this present
+moment, when we are again on the tip-toe of expectation. Ah! Barbara,
+if it fails this time I think our hearts will break. None but God can
+tell what countless prayers are rising from thousands of hearts in
+Scotland every day, that the rightful King may be restored, and our
+land be at peace, and prosper as it has never done before. But alas!
+will the prayers avail us anything? We prayed earnestly enough seven
+years ago, but our petitions were not answered then.”
+
+“Perhaps the answer is but long delayed,” cried I, “and is now close at
+hand. The King is seven years older and seven years wiser; King George
+cannot be called our rightful sovereign, whatever Queen Anne may have
+been. Oh, indeed, the time seems more propitious now than ever, and
+I hope, I hope, Betty, that I may see something of the struggle. How
+excited I feel! You have filled me with enthusiasm and loyalty for King
+James.”
+
+“Hush! child,” said Betty rising, for it was time to go home, “’tis no
+matter for excitement, but very sober thoughts and much prudence are
+needed. As for me, I wish the Restoration might be made without the
+struggle at all. Sometimes I long to be a man, to scheme, and plan, and
+fight for the Cause; but even a woman can do something that may not be
+altogether despised.”
+
+When we had climbed the rocky path that led from the shore to the
+grounds round the house, she turned and looked away across the Frith,
+and kissed her hand towards the south with a pretty gesture.
+
+“Come quickly, my King!” she cried, softly. “Come quickly, and be wise!
+There are no hearts in all the world so true as Scottish hearts, no
+memories so faithful to the past, no love so tender! Come soon, my
+King, and prove them!”
+
+And though she spoke the words with a little laugh, I saw that there
+were tears in her eyes.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX
+
+WE HAVE NEWS OF THE KING’S COMING
+
+
+It pleased me to meet again at Dysart, Mistress Betty’s grave admirer,
+Mr. David Pitcairn, for that such he was I never hesitated in my mind
+to believe. I found that he was the nephew and adopted son of the
+worthy minister of the First Charge of Dysart (for there were then, as
+now, two churches in that place), who bore the same name. The elder
+Mr. Pitcairn was a man of great piety and learning, of most amiable
+character and uncommonly gentle manners. (I speak of him in the past
+tense, but I understand he is still living, though something over
+fourscore years of age.) He had previously been chaplain in Colonel
+Preston’s regiment, of which his elder brother was at one time an
+officer; and the latter being killed in action and leaving behind him
+a young widow and only son, the good gentleman had watched over them
+with tender kindness, and upon the death of the lady, ten years later,
+he made the orphan boy his own. Upon his being presented with the
+living by my Lord Sinclair, his nephew being then at the University
+of Edinburgh, his kind patron promised that when his education was
+completed the young man should have a post with him as overseer,
+or manager, of the workmen engaged in his lordship’s coal-pits and
+salt-pans round Dysart. This post he had now held for over five years,
+and living at the manse with his uncle, he had many opportunities of
+increasing his admiration for the fair Mistress Elizabeth. By her he
+was treated in a half familiar, half-cavalier manner, which aggravated
+even while it checked his ardour, and watching them both with bright,
+youthful eyes, I decided that love and liking were unequally armed for
+defence.
+
+One morning we had ridden towards Kirkcaldy, Betty having ordered Mr.
+Pitcairn to meet us thereabouts, and accompany us on our promenade.
+Just outside the town we halted to wait for him, and turning our
+horses’ heads towards the sea, she was pointing to the view of the
+opposite coast. Hearing a horse’s feet on the stones behind us, she
+cried over her shoulder, without looking round: “At last, David! You
+did not expect to find us here before you.”
+
+“Faith, no indeed, Mistress Betty!” a strange voice replied, “nor did I
+look for so friendly a greeting from your High Mightiness.”
+
+At the first word Betty had turned with a great start, and the colour
+mounting to her face as I had never seen it. A very gallant and
+handsome gentleman, somewhat past his first youth, sat on horseback
+facing us with his hat in his hand, and a smile of very pleasant humour
+in his eyes. His long brown curls hung about a face of which the
+features still retained much beauty, and the voice with which he spoke
+had in it the rich tones of a kind and hearty nature. My poor Betty
+looked more taken aback than ever I had seen her, and she even faltered
+as she answered.
+
+“Indeed, my lord, the address was not meant for you, as your lordship
+very well knows, seeing I did not suppose you to be within four hundred
+miles of me. What brings your lordship so early into Fife?”
+
+“Nay, Mistress Bess, why will you use this haughty tone with me?” said
+the gentleman, very mildly. “You do yourself injustice, believe me,
+ever to let yourself be seen in so shrewd a character. But will you not
+present me to your fair companion?” he continued, turning to me with a
+smile. “Mayhap she will enlighten me as to the identity of the happy
+swain who bears my name, and has more than double my privileges.”
+
+“Mistress Barbara Stewart,” cried Betty, now a little recovered, “let
+me make you acquainted with the most noble the Earl of Wemyss, our
+next neighbour, the champion of the people, the upholder of all Whig
+principles, and the most devoted subject of his Hanoverian Majesty,
+King George.”
+
+The Earl acknowledged my bow with charming courtesy, but he turned to
+my sarcastic companion with a laugh full of goodnature.
+
+“What!” said he. “Still the old grievance? Still as staunch a Jacobite
+as ever--”
+
+But Betty interrupted him with a flash of fire in her eyes, and I did
+not wonder at the admiration which was plain to be seen in his own.
+
+“As staunch a _loyalist_--yes!” she cried, “and ever will be, my lord.
+But upon that subject we shall never agree. There is but one rightful
+King, just as there is but one God, and if you say otherwise you are
+deceiving yourself for the sake of your political ambitions. You can
+afford to laugh and jeer to-day, but wait, my lord, only wait! Is there
+not a word in the Scripture that saith, ‘Woe unto you that laugh now,
+for ye shall mourn and weep!’”
+
+Utterly taken aback by her vehemence, I sat still on my horse gazing at
+her heated face, and in much uneasiness as to how his lordship would
+take her rudeness. He was looking at her gravely but very kindly, while
+the naughty creature stormed and scolded like a common wife in the
+fish-market. And yet that is a coarse and untrue simile; for Mistress
+Betty Sinclair, even in her anger, spoke like a high-born lady, and
+’twas but the fervour of her warm, true heart that made her words at
+once so free and so trenchant.
+
+The Earl moved his horse a step or two nearer, and, still uncovered,
+answered her gently.
+
+“If I tried to tell you how much I admire your loyal and faithful
+affection to that unfortunate house, Mistress Betty, you would but tell
+me I was mocking at you; and yet, believe me, no man could see and hear
+you and remain unmoved. Would to God I could think as you do upon the
+matter, for otherwise I fear you will never permit me to enjoy your
+friendship, though you know, I think, how much I desire it. But I have
+taken my stand upon the other side, and even you would not desire me to
+turn traitor.”
+
+I admired his brave and temperate words, and already he seemed to me a
+very perfect and chivalrous gentleman, but Betty tossed her head and
+turned her burning face away.
+
+“Why do you continually torment me?” she cried petulantly. “Why are you
+so sure that you are right? The day will come, and that speedily, when
+you may indeed want my friendship, and that of all the King’s faithful
+subjects, to put you right with His Majesty. Then, perhaps, you will
+find it easy to take the other side, my lord!”
+
+“Ah, Betty, Betty!” he cried, “why will you talk of such folly? King
+George is firm on the British throne, where the will of the people has
+placed him. The Chevalier de St. George had better remain where he is,
+for any attempt to dislodge the King will only prove disastrous to us
+all.”
+
+She fired up again.
+
+“The Elector of Hanover hath scarce had time to settle himself very
+comfortably on his stolen throne,” she answered, in a contemptuous
+tone, “and King James has more chance of regaining it than some may
+think. But, to be sure, my lord, ’tis not likely that you should
+believe this. You take no interest in our affairs, and ’tis as well
+that you should not.”
+
+And suddenly her own sunny smile broke through the clouds of petulance
+that had transformed her, and wheeling her horse beside that of the
+earl, she announced her intention of accompanying him along the road to
+Wemyss.
+
+“As for that lazy David,” she cried, “he does not deserve that we
+should wait for him!”
+
+Just at that moment Mr. Pitcairn joined us from a crossroad, and I
+judged he had some news to tell us, so eager was the expression of his
+face. He looked surprised at sight of his lordship, but greeted him
+very frankly and with great respect; and so we turned and rode back the
+way that we had come, Betty riding between the gentlemen, and chatting
+lightly in her wonted manner.
+
+Whatever had been the words upon David Pitcairn’s lips when he met
+us, it was plain they were not to be spoken in the present company. I
+noticed that he ever tried to meet Betty’s eye, and though that in
+itself was nothing out of the common, yet there was in his countenance
+and manner a sort of suppressed excitement which convinced me that
+something unusual was afoot. Whatever it was, it was evident he did not
+desire to rouse the curiosity of my Lord Wemyss, for he conversed with
+him quietly on commonplace topics, and presently fell silent to listen
+to Betty’s discourse.
+
+As for me, although I was not discourteously left out of the
+conversation, I was too busy with my own speculations about this new
+actor on the scene to care whether they addressed me or no. I tried
+to recollect all I had heard concerning the Earl of Wemyss, and I was
+bound to confess he presented a more gallant and interesting figure
+than I had expected. I knew that he was a widower for the second time,
+and the father of two tall lads, as fine and promising as any in
+Scotland. But hearing this, I had settled in my mind that he was old
+and dull, most likely grave and sad, as would become a man who had been
+twice bereft of the wife of his bosom--so ran my childish thought; yet
+here he was, scarce older in appearance than David Pitcairn, as brave
+and handsome a knight as the most exacting maiden could desire, riding
+in the sunshine by the side of a lady who, for all her merry speeches,
+had been ready enough to flout him when first he startled her by
+appearing at her side.
+
+I stole a look at his face, and was bound to confess to myself that if
+sorrow had left its traces there they did but add to the attractiveness
+of his beauty. No man of heart, I knew, could have come through the
+great tragedy of his lordship’s early years, and remain untouched to
+sympathy and tenderness. As often as I had heard the tale of the young
+Countess’s death, my heart had thrilled in pity for her husband’s agony
+of suffering. You have no doubt been told ere now of how that lady,
+gentle, lovely, and pious, retired to her praying-closet one evening
+to engage in private devotion; of how her dress caught fire at the
+candle while she was on her knees; and how, before help could reach
+her, she was so terribly burned that, though she lingered in great
+pain for some days, those who loved her best gave thanks aloud when
+they saw her eyes close in death. To be young, beautiful, and happy,
+adored by a tender husband, and the mother of two lovely babes, and
+yet to be torn from a life so bright by an accident so brutal, did
+it not require the fortitude of a good Christian to enable the young
+Earl to retain his reason when he remembered that this was the fate of
+the being he loved? Nothing, I think, but supreme faith in the Divine
+wisdom and love, which can somehow turn our cruellest sorrows into
+blessings, could have sustained any man under a trial so crushing. Yes,
+I felt certain my Lord of Wemyss was a good man, whatever Betty might
+think of his political errors, and deserved all the happiness that yet
+remained to him in life. Of his second Countess, an English lady from
+Northampton, I knew but little, save that, having no children of her
+own, she lavished all her tenderness on her husband’s little sons,
+bringing them up with such wisdom and kindness that they were regarded
+with admiration and delight by all who knew them.
+
+These thoughts and many more passed through my mind as we rode slowly
+along towards Wemyss Castle that bright May morning, but suddenly,
+when we were half-way between that place and Dysart, Mistress Bess
+took another whim, and pulling up abruptly, she bade his lordship
+good-morning, saying that she believed her father had need of her.
+
+Now, luckily for himself, the Earl appeared to have an abounding sense
+of humour and a vast amount of good temper to back it; for after the
+first moment, when a flicker of surprise crossed his face, he answered
+with placid courtesy the capricious young lady’s salute, adding, with a
+twinkle in his eyes which he did not try to conceal,
+
+“Ah, Mistress Betty, it is not every father who is so blest in his
+daughters as my Lord Sinclair.”
+
+Again the hot colour famed up in Betty’s cheeks, for the tone of his
+lordship’s address was unmistakable; but for once she had no words to
+answer him. Instead, she waved her hand as carelessly as she might, and
+turning round, urged her horse to a gallop, so that Mr. Pitcairn and I
+had some ado to catch her up. As soon as we were abreast, the gentleman
+began in a hurried way, “Mistress Betty, I have news!” Betty turned to
+him quickly.
+
+“David! News--of him? Are they good or bad?”
+
+He bent his head. “He has left Bar-le-duc, and was on his way to the
+coast when the messenger left St. Malo.”
+
+“Where got you the news?”
+
+“From Mr. Malcome who crossed last night to Burntisland, he having
+spent some hours in Edinburgh with Mr. Harry Straton.”
+
+Betty drew a long breath; she had grown quite pale.
+
+“God save the King!” she cried softly “Oh, David, Barbara, to think
+that in a day or two he may be with us. Does it not seem too good to be
+true?”
+
+Then, turning in her saddle and shaking her whip in the direction of
+Castle Wemyss, she cried, exultingly, “So, my lord! I was talking folly
+just now, was I? King George is fixed without fear of dislodgment on
+the British throne; the Chevalier must stay where he is. Ah ha! we
+shall see. Oh, I did not dream when we set out this morning, Barbara,
+how joyfully we should return home. Let us hasten to bring the good
+news to my lord and Catherine.”
+
+That night, as my little diary reminds me, there was a supper-party
+held at the Hermitage where many of the neighbouring gentlemen (of
+whom I recollect the names of three or four: Mr. Malcome of Grange,
+Mr. Bethune, the Laird of Balfour, Harry Balfour of Dunbog, brother to
+the Lord Burleigh, and the Laird of Orrock, a gentleman of old though
+inconsiderable family, and a stanch supporter at all times of the
+Master of Sinclair) met round my Lord Sinclair’s table and discussed
+the news from France. The Reverend Mr. Pitcairn was there, grave and
+courteous as was his wont, taking no part in the discussion, but making
+his presence felt when any wise advice was needed. His nephew David
+was my partner, but I cannot remember that he had time to address to
+me one word, for Betty sat opposite us, and her eyes, shining like
+stars, were bright enough to attract any man’s attention. The Master
+of Sinclair, more urbane than I had seen him, spoke much and with an
+air of authority, which, from his having seen service with the Duke
+of Marlborough, was allowed to him as his right. So far as we ladies
+could judge from the effect of his speeches on the other gentlemen,
+he seemed to have a certain military sense and knowledge, which was
+not unappreciated by them; and as for my dear Betty, she hung upon his
+words with affectionate admiration and regard.
+
+“’Tis hoped the King himself will land in Scotland, while the Duke of
+Ormond raises the West of England,” said Mr. Balfour.
+
+“I would rather, were it possible,” observed the Master, “that the
+Duke of Berwick headed the expedition. Let him land where he will, the
+young King is all unproved, and though his courage is well-known, his
+military skill would not advantage us much.”
+
+“Whoever may lead the affair,” said my lord, gravely, “let us be ready
+to receive them. The fault this time must not lie with us, and if
+the rising be but sufficiently advertised, I have little fear of the
+result.”
+
+“We mean to do our best in Fife, sir,” said his son, stoutly.
+
+“All Fife is ready to mount, my lord,” cried Mr. Malcome. “They do but
+need the assurance that the affair is genuine to bring them flocking to
+the King’s Standard.”
+
+“Perth likewise,” cried another, “and the Mearns and Aberdeen. As for
+the Clans, save the Laird of Grant with some thousand men, and the
+Laird of MacLeod, who is a young lad and not to be counted on, there
+is not a chieftain in the Highlands that is not against the present
+Government.”
+
+“All they want is a leader,” said Mr. Pitcairn, thoughtfully. “Courage,
+loyalty, self-sacrifice, these are there in plenty, but all may be
+useless for lack of the personal influence to weld them into the force
+that makes for victory.”
+
+“The Duke of Berwick would do it,” broke in the Master’s voice, “and I
+know not another who would. But, gentlemen, one part is clear before
+us: men, horse, arms and ammunition are all wanted, and cannot be
+got together at a day’s notice. Let us set about our preparations
+to-morrow, more especially with regard to providing the beasts, that
+whoever come among us we may have nothing to reproach ourselves withal.”
+
+This sentiment met with general acclamation, for the company was now
+in the mood to agree to anything that was proposed, and before a later
+stage was reached, which might prove a more disputatious one, my lady
+thought it well that we should withdraw.
+
+Before we departed, however, they insisted that we fill our glasses
+once more to honour the toast which Mr. Harry Balfour in a witty speech
+gave us.
+
+“Long life and success to the King!” he ended up gaily, raising his
+glass on high. “And dire confusion to all his enemies.”
+
+And I think I was the only one to notice how Betty drank but to the
+first part of that toast. As the second clause was added she gave a
+furtive glance at the speaker, and perceiving that no one regarded her,
+she softly replaced her glass upon the table.
+
+Now all that I have written about this one day might lead you to
+imagine that ’twas the beginning of great events, but alas! it is only
+given as an example of the many false hopes that were raised in us, and
+the many disappointments that ensued. In the words of Mistress Betty
+that morning, though she little meant them to express the truth, the
+news were “too good to be true.” The message was a false one; the King
+had not left France, and many weeks and months were to elapse before he
+landed upon Scottish shores.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X
+
+WE BECOME STILL MORE INVOLVED IN AFFAIRS
+
+
+My Lady Erskine was by this time mighty anxious to be back at Alva,
+not only for the sake of her children, from whom she could never bear
+to be long parted, but also because she was in expectation soon to be
+welcoming home Sir John from London. Yielding to the request of Betty,
+that I should be left at Dysart still some weeks, she took her leave
+of us, intending first to visit her sister; Margaret, my Lady Baird,
+in her home at Newbyth, and also to pass some days with the family of
+Sir Peter Wedderburn at Gosford House. I think I cannot do better than
+transcribe here two of the letters which she wrote to her husband on
+her return home. They are full of domestic concerns, and of but little
+interest to a stranger, but they are loving and dutiful as my lady
+herself ever was, and show in some degree the cheerful, diligent spirit
+she commonly displayed.
+
+[Illustration:
+
+ _From an Oil Painting._
+
+LADY ERSKINE OF ALVA.]
+
+
+LETTER I.
+
+ “MY DEAREST,
+
+ I cannot omitt writting every post tho’ I have but
+ little to say, except tell you thatt I begin now to be mighty
+ impatient to have you home. All the members of Parlyment that I know
+ I think is come already, and yett there is no word of your leaveing
+ London. Doe nott think I blame you in saying so for I make no doubt
+ of your coming as soon as ye can. Ye had need of a good coachman if
+ ye travell with four horse wanting a postilion. Your folks are busy
+ att the walks, butt since I came home, I find itt convenient to have
+ seven carts going and eighteen men, and will continue that number if
+ possible till itt’s ended. There is such a deepness of earth thatt
+ itt is no easy work.
+
+ I told you in my last I was going to Stirling. Your uncle looks
+ very well. He is surprised at your stay and longs to see you. I
+ presst Lady Jean and Lordy Areskine to come to Alva some days, and
+ the Colonel, butt they seemed to be so uncertain of their setting
+ out for London, they could not leave Stirling. You desire to know
+ what the Col. says about Meg’s marriage. He told me he wisht her
+ all happyness, and he thought Sir Wm. had been very lucky, and he
+ wondered my lord did not ask better terms. Sir Wm. said to me he
+ was sure you wold not goe close by his door, and not come in, and
+ they design to intercept you at Gosford if they can. Butt if I am to
+ meet you at Edinr. if ye please so to order itt, I will do itt att
+ Gosford, but if ye can come straight to Alva, I do not incline to
+ stir from itt. Your sons are perfectly well and are my only comrads
+ now. Dearest life, adieu.”
+
+ ALVA, _June 13_.
+
+In the next letter, as you will see, there is a veiled allusion to
+the project on which all our thoughts were fixed, and the uncertainty
+of which had already caused its partisans much uneasiness. It is
+impossible now to imagine what little breath of dissension had blown
+between my lady and her kind brother, Mr. Charles Erskine, but sure I
+am that the words set down in some mood of passing vexation were never
+meant to be preserved or remembered. How often and how eagerly my lady
+turned to Mr. Erskine for help and advice in the sad days when she was
+“so unhappy as to want” her husband, and how willingly and kindly he
+spent himself in service for her and hers, you will see presently in
+her later letters.
+
+
+LETTER II.
+
+ “MY DEAREST LIFE,
+
+ I did not writ last post in hope I wold gett one
+ from you forbidding mee to writ, but I got one of a different nature
+ telling me ye was just goeing to my Lord Mar’s country house, which
+ made me very thoughtful some hours after; that ye seem’d to have no
+ guess when ye wold take your journey. I regrate your uneasyness of
+ being obliged to wait so long upon what it seems is very uncertain,
+ and I begin now to fear will hardly be worth your while. I doe now
+ wish you at home att anyrate.
+
+ The black cattell is giving a great price here just now. The man that
+ brought your stots was here yesterday inquiring if ye was for any
+ this year. They held so well out att Aikenside last year he made no
+ doubt ye wold take more. I know not what number ye wold incline to,
+ so lett me know as soon as ye can. I am in uncertainty whether to buy
+ cows for killing, and we’ll be sure to buy them dear att the end of
+ the year if we want them. My being so undetermined will make things
+ of that kind mighty uneasy to me, butt I cannott help itt.
+
+ Your brother Charles has now been a fortnight in Edinr., and tho’
+ I writ to him to send mee your letter he wold not doe itt, nor any
+ reason for not doeing itt. I could hardly believe Charles wold have
+ been so indifferent of mee for I am sure I never gave him any reason;
+ but when he behaves after that manner comeing from you, I see what I
+ might expect if ever I were so unhappy (as) to want you, which I hope
+ in God will never bee.
+
+ I am afraid all the sheep mercats will be over before I gett any
+ account from you whether ye are to buy or not. The sheep is dear this
+ year, they talk. I have sent your Gelding this day to Perth Fair, and
+ bid them take ten Guineys for him before they bring him home. I was
+ advised to doe so by people that understand horse, and had seen him
+ at Edinr. He never look’t so well as he does att this moment, butt
+ there is no help, part with him ye must, for he will never bee of use.
+
+ I send you a letter from Gleneaglis. I am glad to hear from my
+ sister. She has a letter from your Brother Robin.
+
+ I am still fighting with John Harley and Mr Rose, to keep folks at
+ the walks, butt I no sooner turn my back, or has anybody here I am
+ oblig’d to wait on, butt something is done in opposition. The narrow
+ walk has all the earth laid thatt itt wants, and the brode walk is
+ pretty well advanc’d, butt the earth that was on the walks will not
+ serve to make them up at the other end. Your turnip seed is come, and
+ I will write to Monzie and get my directions how to use it. Dearest
+ life, adieu. Your sons are well. Yours.”
+
+ ALVA, _June 25_.
+
+As I read the clear faint writing I can see her sitting in the room at
+Alva at her own scrutoire, the sweet scents and sounds of summer coming
+in at the open windows, and a smile on her face while writing, as she
+thinks how soon might she be seeing the knight’s stalwart form and
+kindly face, and listening to the voice she loved. Alas! almost before
+the summer flowers were dead my lady had ceased to smile, and for many
+and many a weary month all thoughts of her husband were mingled with
+anxiety, grief, and dread.
+
+It was about the middle of July when Sir John came home, and although
+his wife received him with her wonted tender welcome, and the little
+boys made his appearance the occasion of much joyful outcry, it was
+evident from the first that his mind was preoccupied, and he scarce
+gave his usual genial attention to home matters. For some days he was
+busy and hurried in his movements, riding often from home, and when in
+the house, being closeted with Mr. Peck, his secretary. The neighbours
+came and went even more than before, but now it was only the men who
+rode hastily to the door, spent a private hour with Sir John in his
+own room, and rode away again with scarce more than a civil word to my
+lady and myself. There was no merry-making when they met, no pledging
+each other with jest and laughter, no toasts called for. If they took a
+stirrup-cup at parting, twas drunk for the most part in silence, while
+a meaning glance passed from eye to eye, that in some way stirred my
+girlish heart to deep excitement. I was left much to myself and to the
+children in those days, for my lady went about with a serious face,
+attending on her lord, upon whom I saw her cast many a wistful look,
+but refusing to answer my questions when I would have asked her what
+was toward.
+
+At last one evening--I remember it well--we were seated at supper in
+the long twilight, when the sound of a galloping steed arrested our
+attention. The day had been sultry, and doors and windows stood open.
+Sir John laid down the knife with which he was carving and rose to his
+feet, looking across the table at his wife. My lady, with her eyes
+upon his face, turned pale though she uttered no word, and I, Barbara,
+forgetful of ceremony, and moved by the strange thrill that seemed to
+touch us all, ran to the window and leaned out. A man upon a smoking
+horse before the door was wiping his heated face with a napkin, and
+Andrew Short, Sir John’s faithful attendant, had just reached his side
+and was calling out for news. Too breathless to speak, the messenger
+drew from his breast a packet, and rolled, rather than dismounted, from
+his beast, which stood with panting sides and fore-legs outstretched,
+the picture of exhaustion. A stableman ran up and led him slowly away,
+and the rider, still staggering and breathing hard, came up the steps
+leaning on Andrew’s arm, the papers grasped in his hand.
+
+“’Tis a messenger, Sir John,” I cried, for all this had passed in a few
+moments. “He enters the house with Andrew; he bears a packet, doubtless
+for you.”
+
+The knight strode from the room and met the man in the hall who, seeing
+the master of the house, dropped upon one knee, and holding out the
+packet, muttered in a thick, hoarse voice--“From my Lord, the Earl of
+Mar, to the hands of Sir John Erskine of Alva. God save the King!”
+
+With this strange address delivered, ’twas evident that the poor man
+felt his task was accomplished, for he incontinently fell forward in a
+heap upon the floor, and lay in a kind of stupor.
+
+Having ascertained that the good fellow suffered from nothing but want
+of sleep, he having posted from London with the utmost speed, taking
+scarce any rest on the way, Sir John bade Andrew see to him, and
+calling upon Mr. Peck to follow him, he went into his room and shut and
+locked the door. I wrung my hands with impatience, for I would have
+given a good deal at that moment to be able to see through the walls,
+and as I turned I found my lady standing near. Her eyes also were fixed
+upon the closed door, and were full of a strange, unhappy light that
+set my heart aching. I went to her and laid my arm round her waist.
+
+“Dear madam!” I cried, “what is’t you fear? Will you not tell Barbara,
+who longs to comfort you?”
+
+“Ah, little Barbara,” she answered, smiling sadly, “thou hast the will,
+but not the power to ease my heart. Something tells me that this,” and
+she glanced again at that baffling door, “is the beginning of sorrows,
+for whether we lose or win, my dear, there will be many tears shed and
+many hearts broken.”
+
+“Oh, cousin!” I cried eagerly, “could I but see the despatch what would
+I not give! Do you not wish to be in Mr. Peck’s place, reading those
+all-important papers?”
+
+“Nay, my dear,” she said, quietly, “you must exercise patience as I do.
+The letter, whatever it contains is in cipher, and some time must pass
+before Sir John can get at its meaning. Mr. Peck and he may be closeted
+there till midnight, and after all, Barbara, there may be nothing that
+can be told to you or me.”
+
+“The King was landed, madam, I feel sure of it, and my Lord Mar is
+joining him at once. Oh, will he come to Alva, think you? I do so long
+to see him. If he visits with the Earl at Alloa he may indeed come here
+also. I wonder greatly what he is like, cousin?” I cried,
+
+“If you believe Sir John’s report, child, you will perhaps find the
+King different from your expectations of him. I will tell you what I
+have gathered. He is well favoured in face and figure, of staid and
+quiet demeanour, unselfish, gentle, and reasonable, but neither affable
+nor merry. That he is conscientious and kind-hearted I am convinced,
+but his life has been too full of misfortune for him ever to have
+accomplished his desires. He is a devoted and affectionate son, we
+know, and adored his young sister, the Princess Louisa--a gay and
+charming creature, whose death three years since he sorely mourned.
+With good councillors to aid him he will make a wise and tolerant
+Ruler, of that I have no doubt, and I pray God he be not led away by
+ill advice.”
+
+We went into the parlour and sat down together in the dim light. The
+business-room, or study, where Sir John was, being next to us, we could
+hear a faint murmur of voices through the wall, and gradually all
+other sounds in the house ceased. My lady went on talking of the King
+in low tones, sometimes answering my questions, or telling me little
+anecdotes which she had heard and fondly remembered; for her husband
+being often in France, had met his Majesty more than once, besides
+hearing much concerning him from those who were continually about him.
+She spoke of his melancholy childhood, cast away in a foreign land;
+his elderly father, the poor exiled King, resigned to his fate and in
+ill-health; his mother, the Queen, devoted and patient, but perhaps not
+always wise; he, himself, now snubbed and restricted, now flattered
+and exalted, his hopes of restoration now raised to the highest pitch,
+and again laid low in the dust. Would it be strange, she asked, if
+the young man were indeterminate, timid, and depressed? For physical
+courage he certainly did not lack, as she reminded me how he charged
+repeatedly with his Cavalry in the battle of Malplaquet; and had it
+been left to his judgment, she thought the expedition under Admiral
+Forbin, in the year 1708, would not have been the failure it became.
+
+“I know it for a fact,” said my lady, “that his Majesty begged to be
+landed in Fife, in Aberdeen, anywhere, with but one attendant, as he
+would trust himself alone, he said, to the Scottish people; but he was
+not listened to. And yet I firmly believe that, had he come among us
+then in any guise, the country would have risen as one man, would have
+crowned him at Scone, and within a week he would have been dwelling as
+undisputed King in the Palace of Holyrood.”
+
+“That is what will happen now,” I cried eagerly. “Surely, oh surely,
+madam, this time he will succeed!”
+
+“Alas, Barbara, who can tell? It seems to me that in our party, for
+ten faithful men who have the King’s cause at heart, there are fifty
+to be found who care nothing for it, whose only thought is for power,
+or ease, or personal gain. They quarrel among themselves, they have
+jealousies that make their tempers childish; no man can trust his
+neighbour, and how can he then trust his country? If there were real
+love for the much wronged Prince away there in France in each Scottish
+heart, were it but the size of a grain of mustard-seed, sure that love
+would bind the whole nation together, and make it so strong that we
+could rise in a great army and chase the Hanoverian out of England.”
+
+I made no reply, but I remembered her words afterwards, and have often
+considered them since, and in considering them have wondered; for many
+of the best and bravest in Scotland and England have thought as my lady
+did, and yet, good and true as they were and are, God has seen fit to
+give them no victory, but only disaster upon disaster, bringing to
+nought their loyal designs, and furthering the cause of those whom they
+distrusted.
+
+When we had sat for perhaps ten minutes silent, scarce seeing each
+other in the dusk, for it must have been close on ten of the clock,
+we heard the door of the business-room open, and next moment Sir John
+appeared in the room. My lady, who had started up, ran forward with a
+little cry, and he caught her in his arms.
+
+“Tell me, my life, what news?” she cried.
+
+“What, sweetheart, art not in bed?” he answered. “And all alone?” for
+me he did not see. Then he bent his head and whispered in her ear. She
+gave an exclamation, half-amazed, half-triumphant; but a moment after I
+heard a sob, and saw her lay her face upon his breast.
+
+So I stole away unheeded, and went to bed and to sleep with my
+curiosity still unsatisfied.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI
+
+SIR JOHN PREPARES FOR ACTION, AND BARBARA HEARS MANY STRANGE THINGS
+
+
+Whatever tears bedewed the pillow of my dear Lady Erskine that night
+there was no sign of them in the morning. The household was early astir
+as usual, and at once the bustle of preparation seemed to spread from
+attic to cellar. Sir John was about to depart once more, and though I
+scanned my lady’s face for that look of foreboding and dissatisfaction
+that I expected to see, so well did she have her heart in control
+that no shadow of it appeared; indeed, there was an air of alertness
+about her manner of moving and speaking which took me by surprise.
+Instead of the fearful wife mourning over the prospect of her coming
+loneliness, there was the brave woman arming her husband, so to speak,
+for the battle, and sending him from her with words of cheer and glad
+prophecies of victory.
+
+At her request Sir John consented to make me a sharer of the news that
+had arrived the night before, and drawing me into his room he closed
+the door, and bidding me come close to him he said in a low voice, but
+with his wonted smile,
+
+“’Tis of vast importance, Barbara, this that we have heard. My Lord of
+Mar hath, only a few days back, got news from France; no less than a
+letter from the King, in which his Majesty tells him that for the sake
+of his honour he can no longer delay coming to Scotland. He will be
+at Dieppe the end of the month, a sennight from now, and the Rising,
+Barbara, the Rising is appointed for--nay, I will not name the exact
+date to you, child, but ’tis to be early in the coming month.”
+
+I held my breath and clasped my hands. “And will my Lord Mar fight?” I
+whispered.
+
+“I wouldn’t be surprised,” said the knight with a laugh, “but he may be
+Commander-in-chief of the King’s army.”
+
+“Then you, Sir John, will be in the thick of it,” cried I. “Oh, for my
+lady’s sake, be good to yourself and go not in the front of the battle,
+cousin.”
+
+“Silly child!” he answered, and, indeed, I knew that I was silly ere
+ever the words were uttered. “Who thinks of dangers at a time like
+this? A man’s life is no more secure for hiding behind a hay-stack,
+which might catch fire at his back, when he ought to be facing the
+bullets. Depend on’t, we none of us die before our time, nor can we
+preserve our lives beyond it. ’Tis best not to take account of death,
+my lass, but to do our duty just where we find it.”
+
+The smile had left his face as he laid a kind hand on my shoulder, and
+for a moment my heart was so full that I found means to relieve it by
+an unuttered prayer for his safety. Then, not wishing to appear moved
+before him, I said, “Is the Duke of Ormond ready, too, sir?”
+
+I thought his face fell.
+
+“Of that I can scarce speak,” he said. “My lord is somewhat uncertain
+on this point; but I doubt not all will be right once they hear the
+King’s Standard is raised in the north.”
+
+And, Mr. Peck coming at that moment to the door, Sir John dismissed
+me hurriedly, though with his wonted kindness. I flew to my lady, and
+finding her calm and occupied in the contemplation of her husband’s
+hose, “Dear cousin,” I cried, “I know all; and now tell me what I can
+do, for I am dying of eagerness to help you.”
+
+“Then go,” she said at once, “and see about the making up of your
+mails, for Phemie is busy with the children’s things. We start for
+Dysart to-morrow.”
+
+At my exclamation of surprise she smiled. “You must know,” she went
+on, “that every year, in the month of August, I take my sons to their
+Grandfather’s house for the benefit of the sea-air and bathing. To our
+neighbours who are not with us our departure has, therefore, nothing
+out of the common; but to you I can say a little more. Sir John
+believes that the Earl of Mar will land in Fife. If he does, he will
+meet him there and perhaps follow him north, and, seeing that my Lord
+Sinclair is a man of some standing, and my brother in the midst of this
+affair, ’twill be easier for me to get news at the Hermitage than here
+at Alva. So he desires me to go there for a time and await the result
+of the Earl’s arrival; and, though I love best, when deserted, to be in
+my own house, Barbara, where every stone and tree speaks to me of Sir
+John, still, as it is his pleasure, I am glad to go. You will see Betty
+again, my dear, and that will content you also.”
+
+So, in little more than a month from leaving it, I found myself again
+at Dysart.
+
+In spite of our anxiety and excitement, which, with all our will, ’twas
+impossible to hide, the week that followed was a happy one. My Lady
+Erskine had her husband and children with her, and as she tenderly
+loved her father and sisters, she was in the midst of all that were
+dearest to her. Her brother, the Master, was for once in good humour
+and forebore to vex her by his sarcastic speeches to her husband.
+Indeed, Sir John and he were almost on friendly terms, for the knight,
+partly to please his dear lady, and partly, as I think, from a genuine
+appreciation of the younger man’s gifts, deferred to him as the eldest
+son of his host in a manner both courteous and kindly. It is true
+that in the last few weeks the conduct of the Master had gone far to
+establish his reputation for caution and diplomacy among his neighbours
+in the country. You must know that an order had come from Court to the
+sheriffs throughout England and Scotland that they should make search
+among the gentry, how many horses they had and if there were any signs
+of disaffection among them, their animals should be confiscated in the
+name of King George, as well as any arms found in their possession.
+I understand that the Master, with some difficulty, persuaded the
+zealous magistrate that this order could not apply to Fife, where all
+was quiet and orderly, but must be intended for England which was ever
+in a state of disturbance. He bade them look round upon his neighbours
+and judge if they had among them all enough horses to form a troop,
+or indeed, any beasts fitted for war. No, he told them, nor had they
+even the proper saddles and bridles for fitting out Cavalry. It would
+be foolish, he warned them, to get themselves into disfavour by robbing
+poor, innocent gentlemen of their only means of getting about, and as
+for arms he could swear there were not two score of pistols in his
+corner of Fife.
+
+So skilful was his address, and so easy his manner, that for a time
+the good folk were persuaded to leave them in peace; but he suspected,
+as he told my lord, his father, that it could not be for long. All
+this Sir John Erskine knew and approved, and, indeed, he was generous
+enough to forget his brother-in-law’s ill-humours, and to take into
+consideration his military knowledge and real ability for management.
+
+But at last one night, early in the month of August, our tranquillity
+came to an end; and indeed, though we knew it not then, ’twas the end
+of all peace and happiness for many days to come.
+
+Sir John and my lady, the Master and Betty, were bidden to dinner to
+the house of Mr. Malcome of Grange; and his kind sister, Mistress
+Anne, seeing me at the Hermitage one day when she came to visit, and
+remembering my grandpapa and my parents, very cordially asked me to be
+of the party. The Master, who had business that day of a private nature
+some miles away, was late of arriving at the house, but late as he was
+our host was still later. Mistress Anne, having waited already for the
+guest, decided not to delay longer for the master, and telling us gaily
+that the dinner would be spoilt, not to talk of the cook’s temper,
+she made us sit down without him. I remember nothing about the meal
+except that when Mr. Malcome did arrive, which was not till we had been
+half-an-hour at table, he appeared to be in a very hilarious mood, and
+scarce eat anything, though he called for many toasts. His apologies
+for his discourtesy were vague though profuse, and he carried on his
+conversation in jerky phrases, quite unlike his wonted flowing style.
+
+What was in the air, however, we did not discover till the feast was
+ended and most of the guests departed. As the party from Dysart were
+to lie that night at Grange, we alone remained, and were seated with
+Mistress Anne in the parlour, when her brother who had been seeing his
+guests away from the front door, entered the room, accompanied by Sir
+John and the Master of Sinclair.
+
+At once Mr. Malcome shut to the door, closed the shutters with their
+heavy iron bar, and extinguished some of the candles. Then beckoning to
+us ladies to come round him, he began to talk in a low voice.
+
+“Great news to-day, my friends! My lord, the Earl of Mar, is landed.”
+
+Sir John, my lady and myself were all eagerness at this, but showed
+no surprise. Mistress Malcome threw up her hands in amazement, Betty
+appeared puzzled, but the face of the Master grew as black as thunder.
+
+“My Lord of Mar?” he cried out harshly.
+
+“Just so!” continued Mr. Malcome, “he landed last night at Elie, not
+far from this very house, having come all the way from London, so he
+tells me, in a coal-barque. He was disguised as a common sailor, and
+wrought like one too, as the ship possessed but three seamen.”
+
+“What need of so much theatrical display?” interrupted the Master with
+a sneer.
+
+“To baffle our friends at Court,” was the reply, “where my lord took
+care to attend a levee the very night that he sailed.”
+
+“Does he come alone?” inquired Sir John.
+
+“He is accompanied by General Hamilton and Colonel Hay, also disguised,
+my lord travelling as Mr. Maule. ’Twas cleverly arranged, and no mortal
+in London can as yet be aware of his movements. He has now gone to be
+with Bethune of Balfour, and from thence in a day or two he spurs north
+to Dupplin House.”
+
+“What means his coming, brother?” asked Mistress Malcome, still
+perplexed.
+
+“I will tell you, my dear; ’tis to pave the way for the coming of the
+Duke of Berwick--”
+
+“The Duke of Berwick!” cried Betty, with sharp displeasure in her
+tones, “and why not the King?”
+
+“Because, Mistress Betty, it is not yet quite certain that the King may
+not have to go to England, and join with the Duke of Ormond there.”
+
+“Is England ready also?” asked my lady.
+
+“Yes, madam, and so is France. King Louis, as you know, is eager to
+help us. He hath promised us ten thousand men, of whose landing either
+in England or Scotland we may hear any day, with great store of arms
+and ammunition.”
+
+Darker and darker grew the Master’s face as he listened, and now he
+burst forth in his harshest and most scornful tones:
+
+“And pray, what hath my Lord of Mar to do with all this? Is it to be
+supposed that he who hath thrown himself under the feet of the Elector
+of Hanover, only to be kicked away as he deserved, will be trusted as a
+leader by the leal gentlemen of Fife? I wonder to hear you, sir, speak
+thus complacently of a man of my lord’s temper, upon whom no reliance
+can be placed! Did he not betray us over the Union, and will he not do
+it again?”
+
+This speech had the effect of altering the aspect of the company as may
+well be imagined. My lady and our kind hostess looked alarmed; Sir John
+turned to the Master and bade him curtly be silent, in a tone I had
+never heard him use before; Betty jumped up, and running to her brother
+put her white arm round his neck, and begged him for her sake to have
+patience. Mr. Malcome seemed uncomfortable, as well he might, while as
+for myself, Barbara, I sat entranced, absorbed and interested as if I
+were beholding some drama that was being enacted before my eyes.
+
+At length Mr. Malcome answered soothingly:
+
+“I believe that there is no reason to doubt the Earl’s good faith
+seeing he is prepared to give himself wholly for the Cause. As for the
+Union, I spoke of that to his lordship, and he owned very frankly that
+he had been in the wrong to do what he did, but that he hoped by his
+future conduct to make amends to Scotland and to us, and in trusting
+him we should never repent it.”
+
+“Repent!” snarled the master, “and if we were ever such fools as to
+trust such a man, think you that repenting afterwards would retrieve
+it?”
+
+Again the other attempted to pacify him.
+
+“I have told him, my dear Master, of the daily fears we have been in,
+and of the struggle you have had to keep our horses; but I said also
+that the danger could not be staved off much longer.”
+
+“And what said he to that?” asked Sir John, who during the interview
+had spoken little, as one who scarce needed information on the subject
+in hand. “What said he to that?”
+
+“He said,” replied Mr. Malcome, “and I scarce know how to take
+it, ‘whenever they are pressed let them draw together and defend
+themselves.’”
+
+For a few moments there was dead silence and then the Master spoke,
+this time in a voice of icy coldness that had the sound of a sneer all
+through it. ’Twas this voice that so oft enraged and exasperated his
+brother, Sir John, and hearing it I justified my dear guardian for any
+expression of anger he had ever used towards Captain Sinclair.
+
+“Truly, we ought to thank my Lord of Mar for this precious piece of
+advice, for as such,” he said, “I regard it, seeing that in prospect
+of the coming of the Duke of Berwick, the Earl can scarcely consider
+himself in a position to _issue orders_. But I, for one, decline to
+take it. What! can it be imagined that the gentlemen of Fife are
+so rash and foolish as to gather themselves together like rats in
+a corn-yard, with the prospect of being worried by the terriers?
+Consider, sir, the facts that we already know. The Government are
+sending my Lord Duke of Argyle with his dragoons to Stirling, which
+alas! is but a few miles away. We hear that the Whig magistrates
+and burghers of Perth have made themselves masters of that town.
+Consequently, as they hold the Bridge of Earn, which is our only
+passage out of Fife, what is easier than to keep us prisoners here!
+My Lord Rothes, our worthy Sheriff, has armed the whole mob of the
+county, who could readily surround and take us, or if fortune favoured
+us so far as to let us escape, who could assure us of a refuge in the
+Highlands? Which of us would be bold enough to make our way through the
+Athole Country, whose Duke would have vast pleasure in seizing us and
+delivering us up to the Government?”
+
+But Sir John could keep silence no longer, and his full mellow voice
+fell like balm upon my ears, now aching from the Master’s grating tones.
+
+“The Master of Sinclair,” he said, “knows me too well to imagine that I
+could for a moment call in question his courage or his honour; but it
+seems to me that thus to conjure up so many difficulties, where in fact
+there are none, is scarce the act of a brave and experienced officer.”
+
+“No difficulties?” cried out the master. “Call you the want of arms
+nothing?”
+
+“But arms are coming from France,” persisted Mr. Malcome. “Are they not
+promised already, and indeed may now be on the way. Arms, ammunition,
+men, money, there will be nothing lacking; and it doth surprise me not
+a little to find so hardy a young gentleman as the Master of Sinclair
+naturally is, turning so backward in an adventure of the sort.”
+
+“Hardihood is not necessarily folly, my good friend,” growled the
+Master. “But, to be sure, you are known as ‘the honest laird,’ and what
+you say to the people they will stand by. But a day may come when not
+only Fife, but all Scotland, shall rue the landing of the Earl of Mar
+from his coal-barque at Elie last night.”
+
+This speech was followed by a prudent silence, and after a pause our
+host rose, and turning to the knight said courteously:
+
+“And now, Sir John, will you grant me a few minutes in private?”
+
+As they left the room, my lady and Mistress Anne followed to make some
+arrangement for the morrow, and thus we three, Betty, Barbara, and the
+Master were left alone.
+
+“You do not trust the Earl of Mar, brother?” said Betty, somewhat
+timidly.
+
+“No more than I would trust a serpent not to sting me, were I fool
+enough to warm it in my bosom,” was his contemptuous reply.
+
+“My brother, Sir John, thinks different,” quoth she.
+
+“I know it well, my dear, and though I acquit the knight of being so
+great a knave as his kinsman, he is in my opinion no less of a fool.”
+
+At this my face burned hot, and I called out from my corner.
+
+“You do not like Sir John, Captain Sinclair; you are ever unjust to
+him.”
+
+He turned at that, surprised to hear so bold a speech from the girl
+who had sat dumb for the past hour, but he smiled stiffly. With all
+his ill-humour I have never seen him discourteous to a woman; and
+seeing that in after years he was twice married, both times to good and
+sensible women, it may be that there was a side to his character to
+which the world was a stranger. If this were not so, as I have often
+thought, my dear Betty could not have loved him so tenderly.
+
+“Your heat, Mistress Barbara, does credit to your heart,” he said, “and
+I blame you not for disagreeing with me. Sir John is my brother-in-law,
+it is true; but the nearness of our relationship, while it assures me
+of his virtues as a husband and a friend, does not blind my judgment
+to his character. The darling passion of his life is the attempting of
+desperate projects, and no matter how often he should fail, there is
+that buoyancy in his nature which will not suffer him to be convinced
+of his own insufficiency. He hath still the misfortune to imagine he is
+born to be a Great Man, and when all fails, nothing but want of wings
+can hinder him from undertaking the voyage of the moon.”
+
+He was not without discernment, the Master of Sinclair; and although
+at the time I bitterly resented his words, and believed that he spoke
+thus out of jealousy, I have since had reason to think that, robbed of
+its extravagance, his estimate of my kind guardian’s character was not
+altogether wrong.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII
+
+TELLS OF THE ONLY OCCASION ON WHICH I MET THE EARL OF MAR
+
+
+Now I think it will be agreed that an idea which had sprung full-formed
+into my mind during my silent listening, with regard to the Master’s
+conduct, was not without weight. It seemed clear to me then, and grew,
+if possible, clearer in the light of after events, that his hatred
+and jealousy of the Earl of Mar were the cause of all his strange
+behaviour. He received the news of his landing, as we have seen, with
+surprise and scorn, and the first hint of that nobleman as a leader
+and commander roused his wrath to such a pitch, that from that moment
+he put little check upon his fury. Had the Duke of Berwick landed in
+place of the Earl, or had my Lord of Ormond arrived at the head of the
+expedition, it is my opinion that the Master of Sinclair would have
+raised no obstacles and seen no difficulties any more than our host of
+Grange himself. But his hatred of my Lord Mar was of old standing and
+well known to their friends, and his jealous spirit could not brook the
+notion of being under orders to the man he despised. From that day,
+although in obedience to my Lord Sinclair’s commands, he continued
+in the affair, his heart was not in it. He was thought to be but a
+lukewarm adherent, and when honour demanded that he should endeavour to
+hide his misgivings, support his Commander, and do nothing to foster
+dissensions in the camp, he made himself obnoxious to the Earl and his
+friends, raising up strife, frustrating plans, and sowing everywhere
+the seeds of mistrust and insubordination, which quickly sprang up and
+bore most bitter fruit.
+
+When it became known to him that Mr. Malcome had been charged with a
+private message from the Earl to Sir John, his jealous rage increased
+ten-fold, and from that day onward in spite of the knight’s efforts
+to pacify him, which for his lady’s sake he most generously made, his
+bearing towards his brother-in-law was marked by scorn and bitterness,
+which, while it merely provoked Sir John, deeply annoyed my Lord
+Sinclair and grieved his whole family.
+
+In consequence of my Lord Mar’s message, whatever it may have been,
+Sir John did not next morning return with us to Dysart, but rode
+straight to the house of Mr. Bethune of Balfour, to interview the
+nobleman, and hear from him of his plans. Secret messages were sent
+to all the _honest_ gentlemen in that part of the country to wait
+upon his lordship, but it was only by dint of stern commands from his
+father, and the loving entreaties of Betty herself, that the Master
+of Sinclair could be persuaded to attend on him. I believe that the
+Earl, from the first, treated Captain Sinclair with great kindness and
+deference, making inquiries of him about the state of feeling in the
+country, asking his advice, and otherwise behaving in a very frank
+and manly way. This, Sir John told my lady; and that at first the
+Master attempted to hide his gruffness and to respond in like manner,
+and Sir John, with his genial, sanguine nature, had great hopes that
+the rupture between them might be healed. As a further proof of his
+friendliness, my lord, in going to Dupplin House in Perthshire, the
+seat of the Lord Kinnoul, decided to come by Dysart in order to spend a
+few hours at the Hermitage, and pay his respects to my Lord Sinclair.
+
+This was the sole occasion upon which I saw the Earl of Mar, and I
+make no secret of the fact that his appearance, manners, and courteous
+behaviour quite won me over to the side of Sir John and my lady, who
+thought him one of the best and cleverest of men. As I have said
+before, I have no desire to dig too deep into the causes and motives of
+any man’s actions. All the world knows of the Earl’s mistakes, because
+the project he undertook failed; but so closely are we “bound up in the
+bundle of life,” as the Scripture saith, one with another, that it were
+impossible either at that time, or now, forty years after, to determine
+who else were at fault, or how many mistakes and errors went to make
+up the whole. I suppose, that if the King’s Cause had prospered, and
+if he were now seated upon the throne of his forefathers instead of
+living in sad exile, not much would be heard of the incapacity of the
+Earl of Mar, or the motives, good or bad, which urged him on. Truly, as
+it saith again in the Book of Proverbs, “The lot is cast into the lap,
+but the whole disposing thereof is of the Lord.” And to those of you
+who, ten years back, witnessed the triumph of that brave young Prince
+as he rode gaily up the High Street of Edinburgh, with strong hopes in
+his heart of winning back the kingdom for his royal father, and who,
+later, mourned with him over these same hopes utterly cast down, this
+assurance from the pages of Holy Writ is the only comfort you could
+have. For myself, I was at that moment far away with my dear husband in
+the East Indies, so that only the rumours of Prince Charles Edward’s
+coming and going reached our ears; but as I heard of his charm, his
+courage, his successes, and in the next breath of his sufferings, his
+disappointments, and his failure, my tears fell for pity of the Lost
+Cause, just as they had done so many years before.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+But what must you be thinking of this garrulous old woman, who lets
+her thoughts so wander from the path and her pen run away with her?
+I was telling you of the visit of the Earl to the Hermitage, and it
+all comes back to me very plain and clear. I had heard the Master say
+that my lord was a humpback, or at least deformed, but though I could
+perceive that one shoulder was slightly higher than the other, he
+carried himself with so much grace that it scarce detracted from his
+appearance. He was dressed very plain to avoid attention, but I thought
+for all that he looked the great gentleman he was. Upon my being
+presented to him, he saluted me very kindly on the cheek, as was then
+the custom, and told me that he knew my Grandpapa very well, saying
+also in a laughing tone that if I lived up to my name I must needs be
+happy to see him, and to know the reason of his coming. Upon which I
+told him that I was very glad and thankful that the King had so good
+a friend, and at this he looked pleased and made me a low bow. He
+talked respectfully with my Lord Sinclair of the coming Rising, rallied
+Mistress Bess gaily on her enthusiasm, and answered very cordially my
+lady’s enquiries as to the health of his Countess and the welfare of
+their infant daughter. He took little Henry upon his knee, and calling
+Charles to his side told him of his friend, Tommy, who, he said, was
+now considered the bully of Westminster, for to that famous school
+Lordy Erskine had lately gone.
+
+“I like Tommy,” cried Charles, “he’s a great friend of mine!”
+
+“And I like Tommy too,” lisped Harry, not to be outdone, “he gives me a
+pick-a-back!”
+
+My lady bade the children not be troublesome, and sent them away to
+Phemie; but when was a mother’s heart not warmed by small attentions
+to her children, or how could any woman think ill of a man who thus
+fondled her little sons? I am sure that if my lady’s faith in the Earl
+had been in any way dimmed by her brother’s cruel suspicions, it burned
+bright and steady again after this visit to Dysart.
+
+Before he left us, and his stay was but brief, he drew from his bosom a
+portrait done in miniature, and, smiling, offered it to each of us in
+turn. We looked at it in silence. It was the face of the King. A face
+singularly attractive in its youthful grace, for the high forehead, the
+long, gentle, hazel eyes, even the lack of power in the full mouth and
+rounded chin, all helped to give it an air of sweetness which yet had
+a tinge of sadness in it; and while my heart was filled with a sudden
+strange yearning, I was not surprised to see tears in Betty’s eyes, as
+she lifted the miniature to her lips and reverently kissed it.
+
+And so with kind adieux, and hearty wishes for Godspeed in his venture,
+and gay waving of the hand, my Lord of Mar rode off to join his
+friends; and we watched him long upon the winding road, with smiles on
+our lips and prayers in our hearts, little dreaming that not one of us
+should ever look upon his face again.
+
+Neither Sir John nor the Master of Sinclair was present at this
+interview, the latter having private affairs at the other side of the
+county, and my guardian being absent on one of the many secret missions
+which now occupied all his time. Several times he crossed to Edinburgh,
+returning the same day, for our agent there, Captain Harry Straton, was
+by now in the thick of business. On one of these occasions he brought
+back the discouraging news that the Duke of Ormond, had, on fear of
+being arrested, fled in haste from England, thus destroying our hopes
+in that direction; but it was thought that being now in France, he
+might combine with the King, and that on his return to England, the
+soldiers, by whom he was greatly beloved, would readily flock to his
+Standard. Sometimes Sir John was absent from Dysart many days together,
+being sent with important messages to gentlemen between Edinburgh
+and the Border, and even as far south as Dumfries and Galloway with
+despatches to the Earl of Nithsdale, and my Lord Kenmure.
+
+But that part of the business came to an end at last, and one night
+upon his return we learned the meaning of it all. My Lord Mar was
+holding a great _Tinchel_ or Hunting of the deer, in his forest of
+Braemar, on the 26th day of August, and from near and far his _invited
+guests_ were spurring north to join him. On the eve of departure, Sir
+John and the Master, though intending to ride together on the morrow,
+again broke out in dissension. ’Twas at supper, and some of our trusty
+neighbours were present. The Master, still smarting at the thought of
+Mar’s supremacy, threw doubts upon his wisdom in calling together so
+large a gathering which could not be kept private.
+
+“And what need for privacy,” cried Sir John, “when the country is ready
+to rise at our bidding?”
+
+“With the King still in France,” replied the Master, “Ormond fled from
+England, Argyle to take command in Scotland, and with six thousand
+Dutch troops ready to cross the sea to his assistance at a day’s
+notice, it seems to me that the quieter we make our plans the better.”
+
+“And to me it seems,” returned the other, “that enough time has been
+wasted, and the sooner the King’s Standard is openly raised, the more
+secure we shall stand.”
+
+And as all the company, including ourselves, were in agreement with
+this notion, and everyone weary of the repeated delays, the Master’s
+arguments were silenced, though I have no doubt his opinion remained
+the same.
+
+And now so many things crowd into my memory that I despair of setting
+the half of them down. I must leave it to history to tell you of that
+great meeting at Braemar, when noblemen and gentlemen from all parts of
+Scotland, from Caithness to the Border, and from Fife to the Western
+Isles, assembled to hear what the Earl of Mar had to tell them. What it
+was you know very well, and his manner of telling it. Also how, after
+enthusiastically agreeing to join the project--with, I fear, too little
+forethought or consideration--they dispersed to their homes in order to
+gather their forces together.
+
+Still the days went slowly by for us, hearing nothing from the north,
+and little from other sources, for in the absence of our men we saw,
+designedly, but little of our neighbours, and except for the two
+Pitcairns, uncle and nephew, had no communication with the outer world.
+
+My lady was growing anxious for news of her husband, and the strained
+look which I was to see so often in her kind eyes was beginning to show
+itself. When late one night, as we two were on our way to bed, after
+the rest of the household had retired, there came a sound of gentle
+knocking at the small door in the tower past which we must go to reach
+our rooms. The muffled sound at that hour, in the darkness (for we
+carried no light) was one to set our hearts beating, and I clutched at
+my cousin’s arm as we paused to listen. The knocking continued, and
+without a word my lady turned and began to go down the little flight of
+steps that led to the door.
+
+“Madam!” I cried softly, “be careful. Shall I call your brother, Mr.
+Will?”
+
+But my lady did not pause. She looked back at me up the winding stair,
+and the moonlight from the narrow window fell upon her face; it was
+white, but she was smiling. I knew that in those days there was no time
+for foolish fears, and secrets, however they were carried, were not to
+be trusted to servants. There was nothing for my lady to do, but what
+she was doing, so I stood in breathless suspense and listened. Surely
+she would not open without a question to those without.
+
+Down below a bolt was drawn, and the door creaked slightly as it was
+shoved back. Then I heard a cry, and after that--silence. Trembling
+with fear and uncertainty I strained my neck to peer down the twisting
+stairway, holding my skirt up with one hand, and descending slowly
+step by step. It was not far to go, and suddenly I saw in the patch of
+moonlight that shone through the open door two figures that looked like
+one. ’Twas my lady in her husband’s arms. I laughed for very relief and
+joy, and they both looked up and smiled. My good Sir John was dusty and
+travel-worn, and his eyes were heavy with fatigue. He had ridden fast
+and far, and the hand he held out to me trembled, while his voice was
+weak and husky.
+
+“Didst ever know such a wench as mine, Barbara?” he cried softly. “Here
+she comes stealing down the turret-stair in the moonlight to open the
+door to a lover belike, only to discover her husband!” and he laughed
+below his breath.
+
+“My dearest life!” cried my lady, her face all smiles, “would I not
+know your knock among a thousand? Come, come, we must close the door
+and get you something to eat, for you must be well-nigh starving.”
+
+“Drink first, sweetheart!” laughed the knight. “There’s no room in this
+throat of mine for meat to pass down till some of the dust has been
+washed out of it.”
+
+Softly he shut and bolted the door, and taking off his riding-boots to
+carry them in his hand, he stole behind us up the stairs and into the
+dining-hall on the left. Once there he flung himself into an arm-chair
+and stretched his weary limbs with a great sigh. In a few minutes we
+had collected food and wine from the buttery and the pantry, and it was
+with a feeling of relief, as intense as though the terrible thirst had
+been my own, that I watched the huge tankard filled and emptied.
+
+“And now, my dearest,” cried my lady, when her lord had demolished half
+a cold pasty and much bread and cheese, “why come you so late and in
+secret? What news do you bring? Are they good or bad?”
+
+Sir John’s face was grave. “Mayhap you have heard,” quoth he, “the King
+of France is dead.”
+
+“The King!”
+
+“Dead?”
+
+“Ay, dead as mutton! And the power in the hands of a Regent, who, I
+know well enough, whatever my Lord of Mar may say, is not well affected
+to our cause.”
+
+My lady seated herself beside him.
+
+“Nay, we have heard nothing. No news have come from Edinburgh this
+sennight. All our friends are from home as you know, and David Pitcairn
+has thought it well to bide quiet and attend to business.”
+
+“Betty’s business?” cried the knight, and my lady laughed.
+
+“Nay, my dear; Betty’s business would be the King’s, as you very well
+know, and if he is to be of use to us later, he must not draw suspicion
+on himself too soon.”
+
+“Right and true!” said Sir John. “He may help us all by-and-bye;
+David’s a wise lad and can hold his tongue.”
+
+“So we have heard nothing,” continued my lady. “But this death of King
+Louis is a terrible loss to us. What says the Earl?”
+
+“He insists,” said Sir John, “that the Duke of Orleans is as much in
+favour of the Restoration as the old King was, and that his death is no
+loss, but rather a gain to the cause. But I know the Regent better than
+he, and I hope for no help from him. Indeed, if he do nothing to hinder
+us, twill be less than I expect of him.”
+
+“And now, Sir John,” I cried, “will you not tell us why you come thus,
+in such haste and privacy, to tell us what all the world must know in a
+day or two?”
+
+He laughed and called me a “saucy minx.”
+
+“To say truth, Mistress Barbara, your humble servant is a bit of a
+coward, and I must own that I stole here to-night under cover of the
+darkness (though the moon shines cruelly bright for conspirators),
+because I hoped to avoid my eldest brother-in-law, whose jibes and
+sneers I can ill brook in my present disturbed state of mind. He left
+the north some days ago. Is he at home?”
+
+My lady smiled, and fondled his hand like one humouring a child.
+
+“No,” she said, “but he may return to-night, and you will see him most
+like at breakfast.”
+
+“That will I not,” cried he, “for by breakfast-time I must be far from
+here. Only a few hours’ sleep, and then up and off again. Come, my
+lady, this food has made a new man of me; now to bed, for I must be on
+the road by five o’ the clock, and ’tis now half on midnight.”
+
+A shadow fell over her face.
+
+“And whither now?” she asked. “I had hoped you could remain a few days
+with us.”
+
+“To Edinburgh,” he cried, “no less! For by the end o’ the week, I trust
+the Castle and all its supplies will be in my Lord Drummond’s hands.”
+
+My lady was again all eagerness and poured forth question after
+question as to the time and the method of taking so important a
+stronghold, but Sir John only kissed her and put her off in his usual
+light-hearted style, and soon after we crept stealthily up to our rooms.
+
+“I dreamed my papa came and kissed me in the night,” said little
+Charles to me next morning. “I thought it was true, and told Phemie
+that Sir John was returned, but when I asked my mama, she laughed and
+said I must have dreamed it.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII
+
+SHOWS HOW A WOMAN’S ACTIONS ARE OFTTIMES MISUNDERSTOOD
+
+
+The very next day, being the tenth of September, came Mr. Malcome to
+visit us, with news both good and bad. The Master had not yet returned
+home, so that we were ignorant of what had passed since Sir John left
+the north. Four days before, our visitor told us, the Earl of Mar
+had set up the King’s Standard at Braemar, proclaiming him King of
+Scotland, England, France and Ireland. They were making arrangements
+for doing likewise in many of the larger towns, such as Aberdeen,
+Dunkeld, Brechin, and Montrose, and hoped before long to take Perth
+out of the hands of the Whigs and make that place their headquarters.
+The affair, said Mr. Malcome, was spreading like fire in the heather
+(an ill-sounding simile, thought I) and he believed there would be a
+rousing welcome for King James when he arrived.
+
+“And what of Edinbro’?” asked my lady anxiously, for where her treasure
+was, there also was her heart.
+
+Mr. Malcome gave a long, slow whistle, and turned to my Lord Sinclair.
+
+“Have you not heard, my lord?”
+
+The old lord shook his head. “Nothing as yet,” he said.
+
+He drew a little nearer us, and sank his voice almost to a whisper.
+
+“A fiasco, my lord, an utter failure, the stupidest piece of bungling
+that ever was perpetrated.”
+
+“But how, sir, did it fail?” cried my lady, with wide, anxious eyes.
+
+“Strangely enough, madam, through the treachery of a woman,” sighed Mr.
+Malcome. “A woman got hold of the scheme, my lady, and, as was natural,
+the thing slipped out.”
+
+“For shame, sir!” cried Betty, her cheeks flaming. “Do you mean to
+insinuate that a woman cannot keep a secret--that women are more often
+traitors than men? How dare you speak so, Mr. Malcome?”
+
+Our guest was too old a friend to take umbrage at Mistress Betty’s
+wrathful tone. He sighed again but offered no apology.
+
+“Tell us all you know, sir, I beg,” said my lady.
+
+“Madam,” said he, “I name no names. If they are not known to you now,
+they will be public property soon. But ’tis reported that a certain
+young officer who had charge of this scheme, not satisfied to be alone
+in his family on our side, engaged his brother, a certain physician
+in Edinbro’, to join in with him. The latter, madam, has a wife, who
+seeing her husband very melancholy, as weighed down by his knowledge of
+the secret, begged him with wifely solicitude to unburden his mind to
+her. The gentleman not able to resist her wiles confessed his anxiety,
+whereupon the lady, whose sympathies unfortunately lay on the other
+side, sent an anonymous despatch to my Lord Justice Clerk. Sir Adam
+Cockburn, worthy man, communicated with Colonel Stuart, the Governor;
+the plot was frustrated, the Castle was saved, or rather--lost!”
+
+“And what of the conspirators?” we cried.
+
+“Most escaped, but two or three fell into the hands of the Town-band,
+which the Lord Provost had sent out to patrol the town.”
+
+“Tell me, sir, have you seen my husband, Sir John?” cried my lady. “Was
+he with Mr. Straton last night?”
+
+“Madam, he was, but this morning he rode north again with the news of
+our misfortune to the Earl of Mar.”
+
+She sighed even as she smiled.
+
+“Here is a woman,” she cried, laying her hand on her bosom, “who is
+traitor enough to the Cause to wish that her husband were not so useful
+a man. ’Tis mighty uneasy at times, my friend, to balance the scales
+betwixt love and honour; and though I am very sorry that our project
+has failed, I cannot as a wife, blame that lady who doubtless loves
+her husband as much as I do mine, and wished to save him in spite of
+himself.”
+
+“Madam,” said the discreet Mr. Malcome, “there are always two sides to
+a question, if not more; and besides, the story may not be true.”
+
+After this, many rumours came to our ears without greatly affecting
+our daily life, though my lady lived from hour to hour in the hope of
+despatches from her husband, and Betty and the rest of the household
+were never weary of gathering news from every conceivable source.
+
+One day the Rev. Mr. Pitcairn, having gone on some errand to Edinburgh,
+came back with the news that the Duke of Argyle had arrived from
+London, and was gone to Stirling to take up his quarters there.
+General Wightman had been for some weeks now in the Castle, and his
+troops, some 1800 strong, lay encamped in the King’s Park. Old Colonel
+Erskine had not yet been superseded as Governor of the Castle, it
+being well known that the majority of that family were in favour of
+the Government, though his affection for Sir John and my Lady of Alva
+drew his sympathies in the other direction. Old Lady Alva belonged to
+a staunch Whig family, and her son Charles at that time seemed in full
+sympathy with her, so that neither from them, nor from Aunt Betty did
+my lady, as she told me, look for help or pity did things go wrong with
+Sir John. But, as you know, in such affairs it is the common rule for
+families to be divided amongst themselves, and at present there was no
+thought of misfortune.
+
+The town of Perth fell into possession of the King’s men about the
+middle of September in a very simple manner, for the Tory burghers,
+having sent privately to Colonel Hay to let him know that they were
+ready to revolt against the magistrates, who were Whigs, if he could
+bring a sufficient force to back them up, that gentleman, with about
+forty horse, shortly afterwards appeared before the town (though on the
+wrong side of the river), and his friends, seizing the boats without
+any resistance from the town, brought them all across the Tay. The
+Whigs who were, we were told, terrified by the report of the approach
+of the Earl of Mar with some thousands of Highlandmen, very meekly gave
+up their arms to their adversaries, and took no more active part in
+opposition than to ride post to Edinburgh to inform the Government of
+what had happened.
+
+To Perth, therefore, by degrees came flocking the noblemen and
+gentlemen with their followers, who had agreed to join my Lord Mar.
+The young Earl of Strathmore, a fine and gallant gentleman, with two
+hundred of his men, was the first to arrive, and following him came
+the Earl of Southesk with about the same number. My Lord Panmure, that
+brave and staunch old hero, brought with him an hundred Highlandmen,
+and two hundred from the Lowlands. My Lord Nairne and his son came
+likewise; while the Master of Sinclair at the head of the Fifeshire
+gentlemen, of whom he had assumed a kind of unofficial command, rode
+away from home with our Godspeeds in his ears to join this gallant
+company.
+
+After the departure of that gentleman, we had more news from
+headquarters than most people, I suppose; for the Master, being a
+great scribe, thought little of penning more than one long letter of
+an evening. So that my lord, his father, and his sister Betty, were
+constantly receiving despatches. I cannot but own that the picture he
+drew was far from encouraging. The Earl of Mar was not yet come to
+Perth, nor General Hamilton with his troops, and every man did what
+seemed right in his own eyes. The lack of order and discipline to a
+man accustomed to the ways of tried soldiers must indeed have been
+vexatious, and even making allowance, as we all half laughingly did,
+for the trend of the Master’s temper and the _sharpness of his pen_
+there was much in his accounts to make my lord shake his head, and keep
+us all somewhat anxious.
+
+One thing that greatly annoyed him was the indifferent way in which
+some of the gentlemen, who ought not to have exposed themselves, rode
+about the country alone on the smallest excuse. They were constantly
+returning home on one pretext or another, generally on the plea of
+getting fresh supplies of money; spending perhaps a night or two
+away from camp, and returning with the utmost carelessness in broad
+daylight. Again and again the Master told us he had warned them
+that they would be kidnapped, and at last what he predicted really
+happened. Our friend, Sir Thomas Bruce, riding home on some such
+errand, was taken by a party of dragoons, under Lord Rothes, near to
+the town of Kinross, and carried prisoner to Leslie House.
+
+“And serve him right!” cried Betty indignantly, when we heard of it.
+“He should have listened to my brother’s warning.”
+
+About this time we heard that the Earl of Sutherland had landed at
+Leith from England, and had sailed north to his own county, of which
+he had lately been made Lord-lieutenant, to raise the Clans in that
+neighbourhood in favour of the Government. This dashed our spirits a
+little, but we had soon reason to be glad of it.
+
+One evening about six o’clock, we were walking in the wood that borders
+the shore between the Hermitage and the grim old Castle of Ravenscraig
+which was now being allowed to fall into decay. My lady walked in front
+with young Mr. Pitcairn at her side, and little Charles ran before her,
+Betty and myself following. It had been a still, bright day, such as we
+often get in the end of September in Scotland, and scarcely a ripple
+rose to break upon the rocks. The sun was out of sight behind us, but
+its full light shone upon the water, and the distant coast seemed very
+far away. Some boats were in the Frith, but the air was so light that
+their sails were almost useless; for though they filled enough to bear
+the little crafts gently onward, in most of them the boatmen had taken
+to the oars.
+
+Suddenly Betty stood still, her keen eyes fixed on one of these tiny
+barks, which seemed to be steering towards us; it was as yet too far
+off for me to make out its occupants, but my companion had the eyes of
+a hawk.
+
+“Sister!” she cried, “the boat, do you see it?”
+
+My lady turned and stood beside us, looking where she pointed.
+
+“Surely, Bess, I see it--what then? ’Tis but a fishing-boat going out
+for the night.”
+
+“Nay, my dear,” laughed Betty, “there you are wrong. Can you not see?
+They are making signals.” And snatching her kerchief from her neck she
+waved it above her head.
+
+“Take care, my woman!” cried her sister, catching at her arm, “that is
+a dangerous thing to do. You know not who it is, Betty. Do you want
+every Tom, Dick, and Harry to land at the Hermitage? One would take you
+for a child at times, so rashly do you act.”
+
+But Betty’s cheeks were red and her eyes bright with excitement, while
+she still gazed eagerly at the boat. Presently, when the little bark
+was heading for the harbour just below us, and we could all see in it
+the figure of a man in a travelling-cloak, she twisted her kerchief
+again round her neck and began to walk quickly forward.
+
+“You may trust me, my dear Catherine,” she said, “I know their signals.
+’Tis one of our party, though I know not who, as yet. Let us meet him
+at the stair-foot.”
+
+We passed down the rough-hewn stone steps that led to the harbour,
+David Pitcairn leading and Betty close behind. As the boat touched, the
+traveller, who was now on his feet, sprang out, and, with hat in hand,
+stood looking up at us.
+
+“Why?” cried my lady, “’tis Mr. James Murray! You were right, Bess,
+’tis a friend indeed. Welcome home, sir! Are you but newly from France?”
+
+The last words were added in a whisper, as the young man bent to kiss
+her hand. He nodded silently, and turned to fee his boatmen (very
+liberally, to judge from the satisfaction on their faces). They handed
+him up a box, which David with a laugh, and in spite of the other’s
+protest, swung upon his shoulder, and we all started again for the
+house.
+
+“Was it you, Mistress Elizabeth, who answered my signal?” asked the
+traveller. “I was surprised to find you could see mine from so far.
+Had I not caught sight of you ladies in the wood, I should not have
+ventured, I fear, to approach the house.”
+
+“Why not, Mr. Murray? My lord will be over-joyed to see you,” cried
+Betty. “’Tis many months since you left us. How is the King? Is this
+your first return?”
+
+“Yes, madam, I have been in France since April, and come now with
+good news for the Earl of Mar. I arrived in Edinburgh this morning,
+disguised, having travelled by way of England; but when I left France,
+his Majesty was well and in good spirits.”
+
+“Then, indeed, you are welcome to us all,” cried my lady, and with this
+we were come to the front door, and our guest was ushered in with every
+expression of hospitality.
+
+Supper was hurried forward, and entertainment of the best was bestowed
+upon the traveller. I had gathered that this Mr. Murray was second son
+to the Viscount of Stormont, and a trusted friend of King James. We
+learned now that his Majesty had appointed him Secretary of State for
+the affairs of Scotland, and while we knew that he carried the Royal
+Commission to the Earl of Mar, he whispered, under seal of solemn
+secrecy, that he brought also a Patent creating him a Duke. This news
+was greeted with all joy and approval, and we drank to the health of
+the Duke of Mar.
+
+“Pray, sir,” said the elder Mr. Pitcairn, for David had been sent in
+haste to bid his uncle to supper, “can you give us any news of the
+King’s movements?”
+
+“I give you my word, sir,” was the reply, “that his Majesty is resolved
+to cross very shortly; but the roads in France are all guarded, and it
+will not be without difficulty that he reaches the coast. My Lord Stair
+would not be grieved overmuch were his Majesty to fall into the hands
+of some convenient highwayman.”
+
+“Oh!” cried Betty, in horror, “you cannot mean, sir, that he wishes for
+his death?”
+
+“That, Mistress Betty, is a harsh manner of speaking, but the
+Ambassador certainly thinks that King James is in the way.”
+
+“God preserve him,” breathed the minister, “from the hands of wicked
+men.”
+
+“Amen!” cried my lord. “And what, sir, is being done in the way of
+material assistance, for of that we have heard a vast deal, though
+nothing has been seen.”
+
+“When I left France, my lord, there were ships in the ports of Havre,
+St. Malo, and other places, twelve ships of war in all, with several
+swift frigates being loaded with great store of ammunition--small arms,
+shells, bullets, and some pieces of artillery, while soldiers and
+officers in abundance only waited their orders to embark.”
+
+“God be praised!” cried my lord, “this sounds like reality at last. If
+only they do not delay, but strike, as the saying is, while the iron is
+hot.”
+
+“And what of the Duke of Berwick?” asked his younger son, William.
+
+Here Mr. Murray looked uncomfortable and made no reply for a moment,
+but presently he said he feared there had been trouble between the King
+and his half-brother, of which he could give no details, but he now
+believed the Duke would not take part in the expedition at all.
+
+“The more’s the pity!” he added, “for there is no doubt that he is a
+good and brave man, as well as a skilful general.”
+
+It is needless to say that we were all very much cast down at this
+news, for our opinion of the Duke had always been that of Mr. Murray,
+and we had been led to hope great things from his assistance. We talked
+the matter over, and again fell back upon the hope that the Duke of
+Ormond, though inferior in skill, might take his place in England. We
+discussed it far into the night, until my lady, rising, protested that
+Mr. Murray must have some rest, seeing he intended starting in search
+of the Earl of Mar, whose whereabouts was uncertain, early the next day.
+
+But on the morrow as we sat at breakfast a despatch was brought in
+from the Master of Sinclair, which saved the important messenger any
+unnecessary delay. The Earl, he said, had arrived at Perth with a
+large following of Highlanders the day before. The companies already
+in the town were drawn out on the North Inch to receive him, and our
+informant added that my Lord Mar had already begun to stick thorns in
+his (the Master’s) side, by his arrogant assumption of authority and
+infallibility. As her brother could not mention this nobleman’s name
+without some sign of irritation, my lady smilingly suppressed this
+addition, and assuring Mr. Murray of our delight in having had the good
+fortune to waylay and entertain him, we bade him a hearty adieu.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV
+
+TELLS HOW MISTRESS BETTY HAD A BRILLIANT NOTION, AND OF HOW IT WAS
+CARRIED OUT
+
+
+It seemed to us all in those days that Fortune was playing a game of
+_see-saw_ with us and our hopes. No sooner were we elated by some
+piece of good luck, than something happened of the reverse order to
+cast us down into the depths of depression. Two days after the visit
+of Mr. James Murray, news was sent to Mr. Harry Straton in Edinburgh
+that, following hard upon his track, came one, Mr. Ezekiel Hamilton to
+wit, with very evil tidings. The Regent, Orleans, to whom we had been
+told to look for help, had proved himself the very reverse, for he had
+caused the ships, of which Mr. Murray had spoken with such confidence,
+to be unloaded of all the arms and ammunition, and it was added that
+Admiral Byng had leave from him to search all ships coming from Havre
+and other ports to Scotland. Here was a blow to our hopes, and we were
+just where we had been, or perhaps a little lower in the scale of
+unhappiness in consequence of the severity of our disappointment.
+
+“Ah!” sighed my lady, “you see my dear Sir John was right. He
+mistrusted the Regent, and indeed feared he would do us harm. Was ever
+king so unjustly treated, or surrounded by so much treachery!”
+
+“Oh,” cried Betty, “would to God I could do something to help! How
+terrible it is to be a weak woman in times like these! Come, Barbara,
+let us at least get to horse, and ride out and hear some news. I shall
+go mad if I stay cooped in the house another hour.”
+
+Nothing loth, I did as she bade me, and we were soon upon the road. She
+had refused to take a servant, “for,” said she, “if we hear any secrets
+we must keep them to ourselves.”
+
+“We are not like to hear many, my dear,” said I, “for there is no one
+to tell them to us. See, as far as I can look along the road, there is
+not a soul in sight. How far shall we go? ’tis getting late to be out
+alone!”
+
+“Oh, fear not, child!” cried Betty, shortly. “Naught can happen to us
+here, where all the world knows us. Pray do me the favour to be silent.
+I wish to think.”
+
+It was a quiet bright evening, with the first touch of frost to make
+the air keen upon our faces. On and on we rode till the houses of
+Burntisland came in view. When we were near the town, Betty pulled her
+horse to a walk, and pointing to the harbour, bade me look at a little
+ship anchored in the roadstead.
+
+“I wonder whence it comes and what it contains,” said she idly; and
+I wondered at her interest, for there were several vessels in the
+harbour, and ships were constantly coming and going in the Frith, so
+that there was nothing to distinguish this in any particular way.
+
+Not deeming it prudent to go into the town, as the evening was
+darkening down and we two women alone, Betty stopped at a little inn at
+the entrance of the street, where the wife was one Janet Spiers, who
+had formerly been cook-maid at the Hermitage. Rapping on the door with
+her whip-handle, Betty soon brought the good woman out, who, on seeing
+the quality of her visitors, overwhelmed us with kind requests to come
+in and rest.
+
+“Why, Jenny,” said Betty, “we do not mean to alight; ’tis close on
+seven o’clock and the days are growing short. We did but ride this way
+to take the air, and being so near your house I stopped to ask for your
+gudeman.”
+
+“Thank ye kindly, Mistress ’Lizabeth,” said the woman, “he’s real weel.
+The hoast was sair on him a while back, but sin’ the hairst he’s ta’en
+up fine.”
+
+They chatted together for a few minutes, and upon my remarking on the
+number of ships in the harbour, Janet Spiers pointed to the very vessel
+which had attracted the attention of Betty a short while back, and
+asked her if she knew what it contained.
+
+“Why, no,” said Betty, “nothing very valuable I should say.”
+
+The woman tossed her head with a contemptuous smile.
+
+“Ye wad wonder!” she cried. “What think ye, Mistress Betty? There’s
+fire-arms intilt, and pouther and bullets and a’, and what for? To send
+awa’ north to my Lord Sutherland for him tae arm his men and gar them
+fecht for the English King. Set him up indeed! I’m for King Jamie, ye
+ken, my leddy, as ye are yersel’.”
+
+“Arms!” cried Betty, in great surprise, “arms and ammunition! But where
+do they come from, and what do they here?”
+
+“Weel, weel,” said Janet Spiers, “they were shipped at Leith frae the
+Castle at Edinbro’, but the chiel that’s maister o’ the ship is a
+Bruntisland man. He lives down bye in the close there, forenent the
+quay. He’s been awa’ this three weeks, and as he kent the gudewife was
+near her time, he couldna think tae sail awa’ north without spierin’
+for her. Aweel, she was brocht tae bed o’ a fine laddie this morn, and
+naethin’ wad satisfy the creatur (a spoilt quean she is), but keep her
+man by her for a wee. An’ he, honest man, was sweer tae leave her, and
+sae, there he is, and there’s his ship, and there’s nae hurry aboot
+sailing, that I can see.”
+
+“How long will he stay, think ye, Jenny?” said Betty, and I could hear
+a thrill of excitement in her voice.
+
+“Till the morn’s nicht at the full o’ the tide, onyway,” said the
+other, “an’ maybe langer.”
+
+“And how many stands of arms did they tell you the ship contained?” she
+asked.
+
+“Oh,” said Jenny, doubtfully, “twa-three thoosan’, maybe.”
+
+“Dear me!” cried Betty, “my Lord Sutherland will be lucky to get them.
+Well, Jenny, we must say good-night, and ride fast to get home before
+the darkness falls. Come, Barbara.”
+
+And away we went again upon the homeward road, while the land behind us
+darkened, and the first bright star shone out above us in the pale sky.
+
+So fast rode Betty that I was soon out of breath and called out to her
+to stop, but she only urged her beast to the utmost, and left me to
+follow some way behind. What had come to her I wondered; could she be
+afraid of the approaching night? But no, fear and Betty were not well
+acquainted, and I soon dismissed the thought. My dear friend was full
+of whims, and her mind I knew was greatly disturbed. I did my best to
+keep up with her, and bent my attention on the road we had to follow.
+It was almost dark when we came abreast of the Town-House of Dysart
+(for straight into the town we had ridden), and the place was nearly
+empty. Betty stopped abruptly and seemed to be considering what to do
+next. A man came out of Quality Street and turned towards us, and in
+the dim light we both recognised Mr. David Pitcairn.
+
+“David, oh, _David_!” cried Betty, not loud but with an intensity of
+feeling in her tone which would have carried her words much further,
+and in a few quick strides he was beside us.
+
+How clearly I remember his appearance as he stood there with his
+hand upon her horse’s neck, and his fine face lifted to hers in the
+twilight. So well I knew the devotion that filled his soul, though none
+had told me of it, that I felt sure, whatever she asked of him, he
+would then and there consent.
+
+“Dear David,” said Betty, “you are the very man I was hoping to see,”
+and my heart contracted at the words, knowing what they must mean to
+him. “I have a project, ’tis formed within the last half-hour. There is
+something you must do for me--nay, not for me, for the King, David--and
+if you love me you will not refuse.”
+
+Ah! Betty, was it kind to put it thus? But what woman would have
+refrained from using her sweetness as a lure in a like case?
+
+“If I love you, Betty!” said he, very gravely. “Have I ever refused you
+anything you required of me?”
+
+Even at that moment I saw her falter. Was she putting him to a test too
+hard?
+
+“Then walk with us along the shore, where no envious ears can overhear
+us. Oh! David, such a chance, such good fortune as never could have
+been expected! I can scarce restrain myself from laughing aloud. But
+we must be quiet. It must be kept secret; no one shall know but you,
+and Barbara, and my lord. ’Tis better so.” So fast she talked, and
+appeared so excited, that I almost feared her agitation would overcome
+her, but by-and-bye when we were beyond the houses she spoke more
+quietly.
+
+“Listen, David. There is lying outside the harbour of Burntisland at
+this moment, a ship filled with arms and ammunition intended for the
+Earl of Sutherland in the north. You can guess what he means to do with
+them. There they are now for anyone to take, for the master, poor fool,
+is grinning over the cradle of his new-born son; and the crew, I dare
+swear, are as pleasantly, if less innocently, employed about the town.
+Now we must, by hook or by crook, get those arms for our own. Three
+thousand stands, David, and much powder and bullets, think what a haul!
+Is it not splendid?”
+
+“Magnificent!” said David, smiling. “But do you propose my boarding the
+vessel alone in the night, and bearing them away on my back, Betty?”
+
+“Nay!” she cried, reproachfully, “I am not so foolish. But this I
+propose: my brother, the Master, must be told of it; he will know what
+to do. He will come with a troop from Perth, and take them by force
+if necessary. But it must be done at once, and in as secret a way as
+possible. The ship will sail to-morrow at midnight, with the tide.
+Someone--you, dear David, must go this night to Perth, carrying a
+despatch from me, which I will write presently; and you must ride in
+hot haste, so as to be there by daybreak, and lose no time in waking my
+brother and telling him of the matter. He may have to consult my Lord
+of Mar, but no one, I think, will be so mad as to neglect this great
+opportunity.”
+
+David walked along slowly, his eyes on the ground. He was between us,
+and I listened for his answer as eagerly as Betty. To my surprise it
+was long of coming, and my companion, still more astonished, broke out
+again impatiently.
+
+“You will not refuse, David! ’Tis not so hard a task. A night in the
+saddle cannot mean much to you. Why do you hesitate? I thought--”
+
+Then he lifted his head and looked at her in quiet wonder.
+
+“Do you mean to say you doubt me, Betty! I was but thinking out my best
+road. And my horse has been out all day.”
+
+So, I suppose, had he, but Betty did not notice the admission.
+
+“You shall have the best horse in my lord’s stables!” she cried,
+joyfully. “You shall choose for yourself. Oh no, I did not doubt you,
+David. I _knew_ you would do it. There is no one more faithful and
+true.”
+
+And she cast upon him a look so sweet and kind that I, not knowing the
+secrets of this wayward woman-heart, began to think for the first time
+that, for her patient squire, the reward he wished might not be quite
+impossible. He lifted the little hand that hung down beside him, and
+raised it to his lips.
+
+“And what shall my payment be?” he asked.
+
+But even as if he scorned his own question, he hurried forward to push
+open the gate, and Betty rode up to the house in silence.
+
+My Lord Sinclair was sitting down to supper when we entered the hall,
+but his daughter, in her impetuous way, swept him with her into a
+little room which stood empty, and beckoning to David and myself, she
+bade us enter and shut the door. It did not take long to acquaint my
+lord with our story, and he was heartily pleased to approve of Betty’s
+plan. The sole objection that he made was that nothing should be
+written; papers were dangerous, and Mr. Pitcairn might be waylaid, and
+even searched.
+
+“Let the message go by word of mouth,” said he. “David has brains
+enough to deliver it as you give it to him, and my son knows him too
+well to doubt that he comes from us.”
+
+So it was arranged. David was to sup at the Hermitage, going after
+to his uncle at the Manse to acquaint him with his intended venture.
+A good horse was to be provided for him, and as soon as it was dark
+enough, which would be by ten of the clock, he was to ride out of the
+town and make his way to Perth. By riding all night, but keeping to
+unfrequented ways, he would come there by five or six in the morning,
+and he had instructions to find out the Master’s lodging, and rouse him
+at once to receive the news.
+
+You may imagine, at supper there were at least two of us with little
+appetite, and my lady chid her sister for having ridden too far and
+tired both herself and me. As soon as possible I escaped upstairs, and
+right glad was I when my cousin joined me, to find that the secret had
+been imparted to her. Indeed, I believe it might have been discussed
+openly before all the house without any harm done, the entire household
+being too faithful to my lord’s interests to breathe a word that would
+endanger any of them.
+
+As we sat and talked in the half-dark, for the room was lighted but by
+one small taper, we heard the sounds of preparation in the stable-yard,
+for upon that my window looked. I opened the casement and we leaned
+out. A horse, ready saddled, stood there with a groom beside him! By
+the feeble light of the lanthorn hung on the wall we could see his
+grand form, and the proud lift of his head, as his nostrils snuffed the
+cold night air.
+
+“’Tis La Flèche!” my lady whispered, “the best horse my lord has left.”
+
+Out of the low doorway leading from the kitchens came David Pitcairn,
+booted and spurred, but with his hat in his hand. Behind him tripped
+Betty, and with a word dismissed the groom, who shuffled back into
+the stable. As Mr. Pitcairn stood ready to mount, Betty came close
+to him, and spoke in a tone so low that it did not reach us. When he
+answered her she took something from her bosom and held it out to him
+in her open hand. The light gleamed on a little gold heart, and I
+recognised a trinket that she was fond of wearing. With a smile she let
+him take it, and with a smile he raised it to his lips. Just then the
+town-clock struck ten. He caught hold of both her hands and kissed them
+lingeringly, swung himself into the saddle, and waving his hat with
+a cheerful “good-bye,” rode out into the darkness. For some minutes
+we listened to the sound of the horse’s hoofs growing fainter in the
+distance, and then we drew back into the room and closed the window.
+
+My lady sighed. “Poor David!” she said softly.
+
+“I wish,” cried I, “that Betty could be kinder to him, madam.”
+
+“Alas! child,” said she, “Bess is already far too kind, and yet I know
+she means no harm. She loves him in every way but one, and he worships
+her with body, heart, and soul, as it is not good for any woman to be
+worshipped.”
+
+“You think she would not marry him?” I asked. My lady laughed, but not
+unkindly.
+
+“Oh, no!” she said. “I do not always understand my sister (I think at
+times she scarce understands herself) but I am ready to wager my life’s
+happiness that she will never be David Pitcairn’s wife.”
+
+And at that moment the subject of our talk knocked at the door and
+entered.
+
+Her face was very pale, and her eyes burned bright with excitement. She
+came in quietly, and sat down by us in silence. My lady put out her
+hand, and laid it affectionately on her shoulder. By the glad, uplifted
+look upon her face, we knew that she was deeply moved.
+
+By-and-bye she spoke gravely, almost solemnly.
+
+“Sister! Barbara! is it not strange that, after all, my passionate
+desire to do something for the King has been gratified? Do you not
+see the hand of God in it? What led us to ride in the direction of
+Burntisland this evening, when we might as easily have gone the other
+way? What prompted me to ask for Janet Spiers’ gudeman, who, I knew,
+had lost his cough a month since; and above all, what induced the woman
+to talk to us about that little ship? Oh, will it not be wonderful if,
+by my means, the Government Army is defeated, and the Country turned
+so loyal that when the King comes home he will have nothing to do but
+ride to Holyrood and receive the loving homage of a united people.” She
+waved her hands in a sort of delighted ecstasy, and ended with a laugh
+so joyous that we were fain to join with her.
+
+“God grant your beautiful dream comes true, my Betty!” cried my lady,
+kissing her. “’Twas well thought out, your plan, and can hardly fail.
+My brother is the man to attempt the enterprise, and seeing that arms
+and ammunition are the things most needed, he will move heaven and
+earth to get them. Let us think now of David Pitcairn riding through
+the night, and pray that no harm may befall him.”
+
+“Dear, faithful David!” murmured Betty. “I would trust him with all I
+possess.”
+
+“Except yourself!” said my lady slyly.
+
+“I do not possess myself, sister!” said Betty, somewhat sharply. “Let
+us go to bed and try to sleep off some of our excitement. It will soon
+be Sunday morning, and I fear Mr. Pitcairn will have but an inattentive
+listener in me, if I am calm enough to go to Kirk to-morrow.”
+
+And soon after we parted, and went to bed with our various thoughts and
+dreams.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV
+
+IN WHICH BETTY AND BARBARA BEHAVE VERY FOOLISHLY
+
+
+And now I am going to relate an adventure so foolish and freakish that,
+looking back upon it from the standpoint of discreet years, I cannot
+but wonder how my friend Betty ever thought of proposing it, or how
+Barbara could be so ready to join in it. But I fear it has been in all
+ages, and will continue to be so, that young girls take delight in
+doing many things which in after years they regard as impossible, and
+which they would certainly prevent their own daughters from doing if
+they could. And so the world goes on, and each must sow her little crop
+of experiences, and reap her own harvest of wisdom, or mourn over the
+doubtful fruits of folly.
+
+That our folly brought forth no great bitterness was due to the
+kindness of Providence, rather than to any credit of our own. Indeed,
+while I condemn my own act in yielding to Betty’s request, I cannot but
+remember our adventure with a warm stirring at my heart, for a certain
+thing happened then that had an after-effect upon my whole life.
+
+It was upon Saturday night, you will remember, that David Pitcairn left
+us to ride to Perth, and the next day being Sunday, we had much ado to
+attune our hearts and minds to the sacred duties of the day, for our
+thoughts would fly to the Earl of Mar’s army, and back again to the
+little ship outside Burntisland harbour. While we all felt the strain
+of an anxious and almost sleepless night, my poor Betty’s nervous
+tremors were pitiful to behold, the more so that such a condition was
+very foreign to her nature, and quite unlike her wonted liveliness. My
+lady, who was ever a fragile, delicate woman, had so great a control
+over herself that she appeared at times the stronger of the two; but
+so sympathetic was she towards her sister that I feared at times they
+might betray themselves.
+
+Anxious or not, it behoved us all to go to church, and to bear
+ourselves as if nothing unusual were afoot. But I fear that the pious
+and learned discourse of good Mr. Pitcairn bore little fruit in our
+hearts that day. We were waiting we knew not for what, and even among
+ourselves had little to say save interjections of wonder and longing.
+
+It seemed as if the day would never pass. After dinner we took the
+little boys to the rocks below the wood, Phemie being gone to church,
+and there told them tales and let them play quietly. But as the
+afternoon waned, a strong wind rose and blew from the north-west, and
+as it grew colder and colder we made a retreat to the house.
+
+As I descended from my room to supper I heard the sound of the turret
+door opening, and light steps coming up the twisted stairway made me
+pause to see who was there.
+
+It was Betty, her cheeks rosy with the cold, her hair wind-tossed, her
+eyes bright. When she saw me she laughed and clutched my hand.
+
+“Come to my room directly after supper!” she whispered. “I have a
+little thing to tell you.”
+
+It was evident that something had happened to raise her drooping
+spirits, and my lord nodded approval when he heard her laugh as we sat
+down to table, while my dear lady looked pleased though surprised to
+see that her sister’s appetite had returned. For myself, I could scarce
+swallow a bite, being in a state of excitement half fearful, half
+pleasant, throughout the meal, not being able to fix in my mind upon
+any possible reason for her recovered gaiety. I waited with the utmost
+impatience till we were closeted together in Betty’s room, and then
+demanded eagerly what had happened.
+
+She laughed a gay, reckless little laugh, and drew me down upon the
+settee beside her. “Nothing has happened yet, my little Barbe,” she
+cried, “but something is going to happen soon. Look you, child,” she
+went on more seriously, “I am about to ask a great thing of you, and if
+you are doubtful, or afeared, tell me now and I will say no more. Can
+you undergo some discomfort, run some risks, and trust yourself to me
+for a few hours? Tell the truth sincerely.”
+
+“Why, Betty,” I cried, “you know I love you dearly, and would do a good
+deal to pleasure you, but is it fair to make me give my promise without
+telling me what you would be at?”
+
+She looked at me a moment in silence. “You do not answer me as David
+did,” she said slowly.
+
+“Frankly, dear Betty, is there anyone else in the world who would?” I
+asked smiling.
+
+“You are growing up mighty fast, Barbara,” was all she answered, and
+for a few moments she sat in silence.
+
+“Hark ye, my dear,” she roused herself to say, “I mean to trust you.
+I cannot bear one hour longer of this suspense than I can help, and I
+mean to ride forth at daybreak, and find out, if possible, what has
+taken place at Burntisland.”
+
+“At daybreak?” I cried, incredulous, “but why not wait till after
+breakfast?”
+
+“And have all the world know?” she answered. “Why, Barbara, we must
+not be seen. There is always the possibility that some wind may carry
+the news to Stirling, where my Lord of Argyle and his dragoons lie in
+wait. What would be easier for them than to intercept the Master and
+his Command, either on their way hither, or on the return journey?
+You see I know nothing, and this ignorance is torture to me. If David
+is returned he is probably as ignorant of what happened after he left
+Perth as I am. My brother may have started at once, and may be busy
+even now at the harbour, or he may have waited till the dusk fell,
+and be at this moment on the road. In that case I may just see him
+to-morrow, which would be a consolation in itself, and get a word of
+approbation from him for my part in this affair, which of course no one
+else must know.”
+
+I suppose I looked as doubtful as I felt, for she went on persuasively.
+
+“I only wish for your company, my dear; there is naught for you to
+do. Michael, the groom, will ride with us, and if necessary be our
+protector. I want to see for myself what has been done, and to find
+out about my brother. We shall wear masks and hoods, but indeed if any
+strangers are about the town they will be those busy with the boats,
+and the townsfolk would never think of molesting us.”
+
+“When do you mean to start?” I asked, with a sigh and a smile together.
+
+At that she kissed me and called me her dear, and her kind obliging
+friend, and promised me all manner of favours, including her abiding
+love, which was the only one I cared about. Then she told me how she
+had already arranged everything, hoping, nay believing, that I would be
+as agreeable as she had always found me. At four of the clock we were
+to rise and dress, and slipping down the turret-stair, let ourselves
+out by the door already mentioned. Michael was instructed to lead the
+horses quietly, one by one, outside the gate, so that those in the
+house should not be roused by the sound of our starting. She had placed
+a pitcher of milk outside her window on the sill to keep it fresh,
+and she had carried some bread up from the supper-table, so that in
+the morning we should not ride out fasting. When all was expounded,
+she promised to awaken me lest I should lie too late, and bade me go
+straight to bed, and to sleep soundly.
+
+In the dark chill hour before the dawn, with the stars still shining
+in the sky, and a cold wind stinging our faces and whipping the black
+waters of the Frith into foamy crests, I own I did not think so well of
+the expedition; but Betty possessed what few women have--determination
+enough to carry a project through in spite of every obstacle, and as I
+had committed myself to her guidance, I rode on beside her in dogged
+disregard of discomfort, while Michael, the groom, jogged in the rear.
+
+Just before we came in sight of the town she drew near to me and,
+speaking in her most persuasive tones, divulged what was really the
+most important part of her enterprise.
+
+“I have been thinking,” said she, “that were we to draw near the town
+on horseback, we should attract too much attention. Gentlewomen are not
+given to riding abroad at this hour; so, Barbara, if you do not mind,
+we will dismount by yonder dyke, and Michael will hold the horses under
+cover of it for half-an-hour or so, while we go quickly into the town
+to see and hear what we can. What say you, my dear?”
+
+Knowing that whatever I said ’twould make little difference, and being
+too loyal to allow her to go alone, as well as too timorous to stay
+behind, I murmured my agreement with her plan; and a few minutes later
+we dismounted, and adjusting our masks, and drawing our plaids about
+us, head and shoulders, in such a way that it were impossible for
+anyone to know us for gentle or simple, we advanced quickly towards the
+opening of the street which was at that moment silent and empty.
+
+As we came near a corner we heard the steps and voices of approaching
+men, and without a moment’s hesitation we drew into the shadow of a
+doorway and waited for them to pass. To our dismay, however, they
+paused close by our hiding-place, and continued their conversation in
+voices that betrayed to us that they were well-to-do townsfolk.
+
+“Ay!” said one, “’tis a sad mischance for poor Jock Wilson, but I would
+ha’ thought the loon had as muckle sense as to ken what he was aboot.
+It looks a’most as if he’d left his ship and a’ it contained, just for
+anyone that liked to help himsel’.”
+
+“Man!” said the other, “’twas a gran’ venture! To come a’ the way frae
+Perth in the night, and hae the work done afore folks were oot o’
+their beds. He’s a dour man, the Maister o’ Sinclair, but when there’s
+a thing tae be done, he’s the man for it. But I’m wonderin’, Andrew,
+hoo the deevil he cam’ tae hear o’ Jock Wilson’s boat. He hasna been
+at Dysart this week back and mair, and the thing wasna kent afore
+yestreen.”
+
+“Weel, weel!” said the first, “the Cause has its friends in the Kingdom
+o’ Fife if anywhere in Scotland, and there’s ways and means o’ getting
+knowledge. The Government made nae secret of what they were aboot, but
+they didna reckon on Mistress Wilson’s lyin’-in. That was the cause o’
+the mischief, Jamie; a wumman at the bottom o’t, as usual.” And with
+a laugh at his own jest the speaker moved on up the street, while his
+companion entered the house exactly opposite to our doorway. Betty drew
+near me and seized my arm.
+
+“You heard, Barbara,” she whispered; “the thing has succeeded. My
+brother came from Perth early this morning, and is even now busy at the
+harbour. Oh, how I wish I could see him, if only to tell him how proud
+I am of his achievement! Come, child, I must go on! No one will molest
+us, there will be other women about by this time, and I fancy the town
+is too excited over what has taken place to have room for notice of us.”
+
+Quickly we stole into the street and hurried on. We met some people and
+heard snatches of talk, but no one spoke to us, though one or two eyed
+us curiously. Suddenly, on rounding a corner, we found ourselves in
+an open space in which were a number of people, all talking excitedly
+and in loud voices. Involuntarily we stopped, and in turning round to
+retrace our steps we collided with a young gentleman who was moving in
+our direction. He was dressed in uniform, and looked as if he had but
+just staggered out of the adjoining tavern, as indeed he had.
+
+“Beg pardon, my dear,” he said in a thick voice, lurching near us and
+trying to peer under the folds of our plaids. “Hullo! masks, by Jove!
+Who’d ha’ thought it at this hour?” and he looked first at Betty and
+then at me, as if not certain whether to hold us or to let us pass.
+
+“Excuse me, sir,” said Betty, in her haughtiest tone. “Can you direct
+me to the Master of Sinclair?”
+
+“Sinclair, by gad! Direct you to Sinclair? No, I can’t, and I wouldn’t
+if I could. Blesh my life, why should I? Sinclair’s done nothing for
+me; rather keep you to myself, my chuck.”
+
+No words can express the horror that crept over me at this man’s look
+and tone. I had seen often enough a gentleman in his cups. ’Twas not
+thought so much of a disgrace as to be a matter of great concern to a
+woman. But though I instinctively shrank from any man when fuddled
+and bemused with wine, never in my life had the like condition aroused
+in me such a sense of loathing. His eyes were heavy, yet insolent; his
+face was flushed, and his loose lips wore a foolish smile. His words,
+as they dropped from his slippery tongue, now came in a rush, now
+halted painfully; and his breath, which was foul with wine, sickened me
+as he puffed it in my face.
+
+“If you cannot be civil, sir,” cried Betty, enraged, but not the least
+dismayed, “pray, let us pass.”
+
+“Don’ want to let you pass,” stammered our tormentor. “Too lovely, by
+half! Come, lift your mask, my dear. Ball’s over, ’s time to sup.”
+And with that he advanced to seize her; but Betty quickly slipping on
+one side, the creature lost his balance and fell prone in the mud. In
+falling, he clutched hold of my plaid, and, dragging it off my head,
+dislodged my mask, which broke from its fastening and fell at my feet.
+Not wishing to escape at the expense of leaving my warm covering in the
+hands of this wretch, and unable to wrench it from his grasp, I stood
+still and called piteously to Betty, who had sped a little way along
+the street, believing me close behind her. In terror lest she should
+get out of sight, and still more lest the man should succeed in rising
+to his feet, I was standing thus, my heart beating in my throat, my
+head bare, and tears of fright in my eyes, when another officer stepped
+out of the tavern-door, and stared in amazement at the figures before
+him.
+
+Only for a moment did he remain inactive (while I, with a curious throb
+of relief, realised that a helper was at hand), then, as if reading the
+whole in my white and horror-stricken face, he strode towards us, and,
+with a sharp rap of his cane, loosed the hold of those rude hands upon
+my dress. Standing stiff and tall above his recumbent comrade, he asked
+in a very stern voice, “What does this mean, Mr. Wallace?”
+
+The other struggled to his feet; but his fall, instead of sobering
+him, appeared to have left him still more fuddled, and also a little
+aggressive.
+
+“I say, Tony,” he muttered, “tha’s my prize. Wha’ d’ you want here? No,
+by Jove, ’s the other one I want--the brown-haired filly, where’s she
+gone? Asked for the Master of Sinclair, she did. Pretty game, that,
+for his Mastership to play, making assin--assig--nashus with lovely
+ladies--six ’clock in the morning--”
+
+“You fool!” broke in Betty’s voice, and I found her at my elbow. “The
+Master of Sinclair is my brother. Perhaps you, sir, if you are not also
+drunk at six o’clock in the morning, can direct me to him.”
+
+The officer saluted her with grave respect. “I have had the honour of
+being presented to you, Mistress Sinclair,” he said, “at the house of
+the Earl of Wigton. My name is Anthony Fleming, and I am very much at
+your service.”
+
+Betty gave a gasp of relief.
+
+“I remember you very well, Mr. Fleming,” she said, “now that I have
+time to look at you, and I am grateful to you for appearing thus
+opportunely to our help. Can you tell me whether my brother is still in
+the town? Having heard a rumour of his coming from Perth last night, my
+friend and I--let me present you to Mistress Barbara Stewart--rode over
+this morning to have speech with him, and I was asking this _gentleman_
+to direct me to him, when he forgot himself.”
+
+Mr. Wallace was now standing somewhat sheepishly with his back against
+the wall of the house, and Betty glanced at him scornfully and turned
+away. As for me, I was still trembling, and the tears which I had
+before restrained kept brimming to my eyes.
+
+“Madam,” said Mr. Fleming, and his eyes sought mine with a kind and
+pitying glance, “I cannot sufficiently express my regret for the
+annoyance and trouble you have had, and my brother-officer will, I am
+sure, think and say the same when he is come to himself. I can only,
+in his name, humbly beg your pardon. I fear your friend is still
+suffering. If there is anything I could do--”
+
+“If you will direct us to my brother,” cried Betty, impatiently, “’tis
+all I ask now.”
+
+“Madam,” said he, “I greatly regret that that is impossible. The Master
+of Sinclair, after some splendid work, which I should like to tell you
+of if there were time, quitted the town soon after four o’clock, and,
+having left Mr. Wallace and myself in command of some troopers he has
+installed in the Castle, is already well on his way back to Perth.”
+
+Betty’s face fell at this, although his words had pleased her. She was
+about to reply when a great crowd of turbulent people, sailors and
+fishermen, accompanied by women of the lowest sort, came reeling down
+the street with shouts and laughter. Some of the men hustled me rudely
+aside, whereupon Mr. Fleming sprang to my assistance, and, putting his
+arm round my shoulders, stood thus to protect me until the crowd had
+passed.
+
+“Pray, take us out of this, Mr. Fleming,” cried Betty imploringly.
+“Right sorry am I that I ever brought myself or my companion into
+such a mess; but I cannot be too thankful that you found us. Come,
+Barbara, I am ready to go home and confess my sins and eat any amount
+of humble-pie.”
+
+Mr. Anthony Fleming bent down to look at my face before he freed me
+from his protecting arm. “Are you able to walk, madam?” he enquired
+very kindly. “Will you not lean upon my arm?” But so comforting and
+strength-giving had been his support that I was able to smile back at
+him and assure him I felt perfectly well. He helped me to adjust my
+plaid, and upon Betty’s informing him where we should find our horses,
+in a very few minutes he had us clear of the town, and was walking
+between us along the open road.
+
+“Tell me now, if you please, sir,” cried Betty, “what my brother has
+been doing, and what brought him from Perth in such haste?” for, as she
+told me later, she did not wish it to be known that she had had a hand
+in the matter.
+
+“You must know, madam,” said our guide, “that yesterday, very early in
+the morning, the Master of Sinclair was called out to the South Inch
+to see a certain messenger, who had ridden all night from this place
+to inform him that there was a ship lying in the Frith containing arms
+and ammunition from the Castle of Edinburgh which had been shipped
+at Leith, to be sent north for the use of the Earl of Sutherland.
+The master of this vessel, he was told, was come ashore to see his
+family, and did not intend to put to sea for another four-and-twenty
+hours. Here was a chance, if the right man could be found, to supply
+ourselves with weapons and bullets, of which we stand greatly in need.
+Your brother was fired by the notion, and, bidding his friend rest,
+and return home privately, keeping the matter secret, he went off to
+the Earl of Mar and acquainted him with the story. I must own that
+my lord delayed some hours in issuing the order, and I, meeting the
+Master of Sinclair at one Hardy’s, a vintner in Perth, he told me what
+was toward, and said that if he got the Command he hoped that I would
+ride with him. Finally, the order being given in writing at last, we
+left the town by five o’clock, a company of fourscore horse. We came
+by cross-roads and by-paths, avoiding towns and villages, and got here
+a little after midnight. The Master posted sentries about the town to
+avoid surprises, and himself went to the harbour and very easily seized
+some of the boats there. In these we rowed out to the ship and, though
+the wind and tide were against us, succeeded in bringing her in. Your
+brother, madam, stood in the water up to the middle of the leg and
+received the arms into his own hands. Of these there were but three
+hundred--”
+
+“Three hundred!” cried Betty, so sharply that I feared she would betray
+herself.
+
+“Three hundred wanting one,” continued Mr. Fleming, “and we had
+expected two or three thousand. ’Twas a great disappointment I must
+own; but later we seized the arms of another big ship in the harbour,
+and took also those of the Town-guard, and as they are now lodged, with
+the ammunition we got, in the Castle which we are left to guard, I
+think you may be satisfied with your brother’s work, madam.”
+
+“I wish there had been more,” she murmured discontentedly.
+
+“Why, madam, so do we; but ’tis better than nothing, and when the news
+of the Master’s exploit is brought to the King, I’ll wager his Majesty
+will be prodigiously pleased.”
+
+By this we had reached the rough dyke behind which our steeds were
+ambushed, and were preparing to mount. Betty, who had listened to Mr.
+Fleming’s words with a smile of approval, gave him her hand with a
+grateful look.
+
+“His Majesty knows how to appreciate all his faithful subjects,” she
+said softly, “and among them I am glad to count Mr. Anthony Fleming.”
+
+He bowed over her hand before raising it to his lips. Betty was looking
+her brightest, I noticed, in spite of the cold, the agitation, the
+fatigue, while Barbara, I felt sure, was at her worst; and I remember
+regretting to have been seen at a disadvantage by this particular
+gentleman, who, although he had been unknown to me half-an-hour before,
+seemed more of a friend than many with whom I was well acquainted.
+
+“I count it a special mercy,” said Betty, as we rode away, “that we
+fell in with that young man. Do you not think there is something very
+attractive in his face?”
+
+“Why, yes,” cried Barbara, quickly. “I am sure it is the kindest face
+in the world.”
+
+And from that day to this she has seen no reason to alter her opinion.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI
+
+TELLS OF VARIOUS MATTERS TO BE FOUND IN THE HISTORY-BOOKS, AND OF A
+ROMANTIC TALE WHICH IS NOT
+
+
+I have often thought that our mad escapade would not have been passed
+over so lightly had the news we brought been less satisfactory. My lord
+was never, I believe, made aware of the depths of our folly, and only
+to my dear lady did I dare to relate our morning’s adventures, and
+from her received the chiding I so richly deserved. To one other was
+the affair confided by Betty, namely, to David Pitcairn. She told him
+in my presence the same afternoon, and greatly was I astonished to see
+him so much roused. For a moment or two he could scarcely speak, and
+it was some time before we were able to understand the reason of his
+displeasure. When at last ’twas explained, I felt that he had reason on
+his side, and even Betty appeared struck by his words.
+
+He had accomplished his task on the Saturday night without hindrance,
+arriving in Perth early on Sunday morning, and arranging, as we knew,
+an interview with the Master. He now told us that, after the latter had
+acquainted the Earl of Mar with the good tidings, my lord expressed
+a desire to see for himself the bearer of them, and the Master of
+Sinclair had followed Mr. Pitcairn about the town until he could set
+his lordship’s wishes before him. At first our friend David demurred,
+saying he could tell my lord no more than he had already divulged, but
+finally he consented, and was borne to the Earl’s presence; but beyond
+the fact that my lord had received him graciously, and asked him a
+number of questions as to the size of the ship and the quantity of arms
+on board, we got little out of him on that point.
+
+“He asked me,” said David, “if it were possible to ride from Perth
+to Burntisland avoiding towns and villages, and when I told him yes,
+‘Then,’ said he, ‘will you act as guide to the convoy?’ But upon my
+informing him that the Master of Sinclair and Mr. Malcome knew the
+country every whit as well as I, he said, ‘Very well, perhaps there was
+no need of a guide.’”
+
+David left Perth at ten o’clock, and having rested for some hours
+at the house of a friend about half-way home, was able to join the
+expedition when it was within three miles of its goal. He was full
+of praise for the Master and for one or two of the gentlemen who
+accompanied him, among whom it pleased me to hear him mention Mr.
+Fleming, but the rabble they commanded were, he said, some of the
+worst that could be imagined. Sentries were placed about the town, but
+no sooner were the officer’s backs turned, than these undisciplined
+Highlanders left their posts and scampered off to the taverns and
+wine-shops, and there had ensued such rioting and confusion as had made
+of the town a perfect pandemonium. How we had escaped much worse injury
+and insult than we suffered he could not imagine, “except,” as he said,
+with a look at Betty both angry and tender, “it was true that a special
+Providence guarded daft folk and bairns.”
+
+Indeed I shuddered at some of the things he told us, among them
+the fact that the drunken men, upon being called to order by their
+officers, the latter narrowly escaped being shot by these wretches,
+many of whom could not understand a word of any language but the Gaelic.
+
+“I thank my stars,” said David, “that I have nothing to do with such
+a crew, and since they left the town in the morning we have heard sad
+tales of their raiding the country-side, and plundering the poor folk
+on their way back to Perth.”
+
+I cannot but say that our spirits were much dashed by this
+intelligence, and our triumph did not seem quite so brilliant as it had
+appeared that morning. For some hours after it left me sad, and Betty
+very thoughtful.
+
+But events were hurrying forward, and in the next few days much was
+accomplished for the Cause. We heard with delight that the Master of
+Sinclair had been sent into Fife with a body of horse, both to seize
+any arms that could be found, and also to set up the King’s Standard
+in the small towns round the coast. This he accomplished with ease,
+beginning at Cupar, and going from St. Andrews to Kirkcaldy, he took
+possession of each town in the name of the King, thus making our party
+masters of the whole of the north coast of the Firth of Forth. To the
+grief and chagrin of Betty, her brother did not present himself at home
+for more than a passing call of a few minutes, so that she was not able
+to hear nor to give any news. But to our great joy, Sir John, who was
+riding in the Master’s Command, decided to return to Dysart instead of
+proceeding at once to Perth, and surprised us by appearing one evening
+about supper-time, well and hearty and with news to tell.
+
+It was from him that we learned of the designed project of sending a
+large body of men across the Frith to the Lothians, so that they might
+march south, and eventually join the rising in Northumberland.
+
+’Twould take too long were I to tell you of the exciting days that
+followed, while boats were chartered in all the small fishing villages,
+and secretly brought to Crail from whence the crossing was to start.
+Mr. Harry Crawford it was that had the bringing of the boats together,
+and as there were upwards of two thousand men to be conveyed, you can
+imagine that the task was no light one. Now as there were several ships
+of war lying at Leith, and the custom-house smacks were constantly
+moving about in the Frith, my Lord of Mar ordered that a small number
+of men should march to Burntisland and make a feint of embarking
+there, to attract the attention of the Government boats. Meanwhile,
+protected by a screen of Cavalry under the command of Sir John Erskine
+and Sir James Sharp, the main body got off under cover of night,
+from Crail and Elie and Pittenweem. As a certain number were obliged
+to wait till the next night, however, the design was made known by
+spies to the Government ships, which immediately set sail to intercept
+them. Fortunately a contrary wind detained them, so that only one of
+our boats was taken, but several were forced to return to the coast
+of Fife. One company of three hundred men under command of my Lord
+Strathmore, with the Laird of Barafield as his Lieutenant, was obliged
+to land on the Isle of May, where they were detained for several days.
+When threatened by the ships of war, they made a most determined stand,
+and the young earl, himself scarce more than a schoolboy, behaved in
+a heroic manner. Not only did he hold his men in check when some of
+them were for surrendering, but he exhibited the greatest courage and
+self-denial during their detention; and when the opportunity came at
+length of getting off in boats to return to Crail, he was the last to
+leave the island. How our hearts kindled when we heard of his brave
+conduct from the Master, who had for this young nobleman an unbounded
+admiration.
+
+The success of this project, and the landing of our men on the coast
+of Haddington, threw the good people of Edinburgh into such a state of
+panic that the Lord Provost at once ordered out the City Guards, the
+Trained Bands, and the new Levies of Volunteers for the defence of the
+city and the prevention of any disturbance therein. He also took the
+precaution to send an express to the Duke of Argyle at Stirling, who
+without delay marched post-haste to the Capital accompanied by three
+hundred chosen dragoons. As the Highlanders, under the brave Brigadier
+Mackintosh, had marched to Leith and entrenched themselves in the old
+citadel there, his Grace, who had left his cannons, gunners, mortars
+and bombardiers all behind at Stirling, could do little to dislodge
+them, save calling upon them as rebels to lay down their arms and
+surrender, upon pain of High Treason. This they very resolutely refused
+to do, and the Duke not being able to make a better of it, retired to
+Edinburgh to begin preparations.
+
+Mackintosh, however, having managed to send off two letters to my
+Lord Mar, by the cunning expedient of pretending to fire upon the
+boats that bore them, as though he mistook them for the enemy, that
+nobleman ordered a body of horse under command of my Lord of Drummond
+to march from Perth upon Stirling, so as to draw, if possible, the
+Duke of Argyle from pursuit of the Highlanders in the Lothians. As the
+Master of Sinclair was one of that party, we heard later of how the
+matter was carried out, how they rode in heavy rain and bitter cold to
+Dunblane, did nothing there, and marched back to Perth on hearing of
+the arrival of Argyle at Stirling. I have no doubt, knowing my lady’s
+brother so well, that he did his best to set them right in no very
+agreeable way; howbeit I have heard since then some trenchant remarks
+on the supine behaviour of the Earl of Mar on this occasion, so I am
+aware that the Master was not angry altogether without cause. A General
+with more self-confidence, it was said, would have occupied Stirling
+ere the Duke had time to reach it. As for Mackintosh of Borlum, he
+entrenched himself first at Seton House, where he remained some days;
+but shortly afterwards, having received answers to his letters from my
+Lord Mar, he pushed on towards Kelso, and later as you know, crossed
+over into England. An incident took place on his march south which,
+coming to the ears of my Lady Erskine, greatly grieved her. This was
+the plundering of Hermiston House, the seat of her uncle, Dr. Sinclair,
+who had incurred the resentment of the Jacobite party very early in the
+rising. The fierce old Brigadier would even have set fire to the place,
+but being dissuaded from this extreme measure by some of the gentler
+spirits, he gave permission to the Highlanders to sack the house, who
+readily plundered it of every valuable thing that could be carried
+away. Such strange and vexatious doings take place in a country when it
+is divided against itself.
+
+The events which I have mentioned took place rapidly one after another,
+but did not in any way affect our lives at Dysart, save that from early
+morn till late night we existed in a turmoil of excitement, never
+knowing what should transpire, and expecting all manner of wonderful
+things to happen, from the arrival at our door of King James himself,
+to the willing abdication of King George in London.
+
+One morning, however, a despatch was brought to my lady, which proved
+to be from Sir John in Perth, in which he recommended her to leave her
+father’s house and return to Alva, where, he said, were many things
+requiring her care. This my lady, at all times ready to obey her lord,
+was very willing to do, and although it grieved us all to leave our
+kind friends at Dysart, we knew that our visit, already lengthy, could
+not last for ever. By order of the Earl of Mar, as Sir John writ in
+his letter, an officer from the garrison at Burntisland Castle, with a
+small company, was to escort my lady’s carriage all the way to Alva,
+in order to prevent, as he said, any surprise or discourtesy from the
+Dragoons of Argyle who constantly patrolled the roads; and although the
+precaution turned out to be wholly unnecessary, my lady was flattered
+by the attention, and pleased at the kindness of the thought.
+
+The officer told off for this honorary duty was, to my great relief,
+our friend, Mr. Anthony Fleming.
+
+“What should I have felt,” I murmured to Betty, on his arrival at the
+door of the Hermitage, “had it been Mr. Wallace?”
+
+“Less confidence in the security of your journey than you do now, I
+suppose,” was her shrewd reply. “But I am grieved that our good friend
+should be soaked to the skin, while the other is warm and dry in
+barracks.”
+
+The season had indeed set in very wet, and our chief difficulty in
+returning to Alva lay in the badness of the roads which made our
+progress extremely slow. The rain poured down without ceasing, and
+several times our heavy coach stuck fast in the clogging mud; and our
+escort, instead of keeping the enemy at bay with swords and pistols,
+were obliged to dismount, and by dint of their united strength
+extricate us from the ruts. At such times we inside the coach could
+hear Mr. Fleming’s firm, pleasant voice as he directed and encouraged
+his men, and once he rode up to the carriage window to apologise to my
+lady for the delay.
+
+This civility struck her as so unnecessary that she laughed very
+heartily as she replied, “Nay, my dear Mr. Fleming, I feel rather that
+it is my place to apologise to you for obliging you to employ your
+soldiers in so trivial a manner. Confess that you would rather they
+should encounter half a hundred dragoons, and rout them at the point of
+the sword!”
+
+“Oh, madam,” he answered, with his kind eyes smiling at us both, “a
+soldier learns very early in his career to call nothing in the way of
+duty _trivial_. The rain is unavoidable, the roads are bad; let us
+trust the weather is too inclement to allow of Argyle’s scouts delaying
+us any further.”
+
+“That,” said my lady, as he turned away, “is a young man who will go
+far, if God spares his life through these turmoils. My lord speaks
+well of him, my dear husband regards him with affection, and even my
+brother, the Master, has nothing spiteful to say of him.”
+
+How my heart warmed at his praise perhaps it would be foolish to
+mention, for, as you will see, the young gentleman was at this time
+scarce even to be called an acquaintance. But ’tis true that some
+are our friends from the first look and word, and no thought but of
+kindness and sympathy ever enters our minds concerning them. Because of
+his timely help to me that morning in Burntisland, I looked upon Mr.
+Fleming with a peculiar feeling of respect and gratitude, with which
+was mingled an almost unconscious trust in his goodness and truth. That
+our instincts in these matters occasionally mislead us, many poor women
+have had bitter proof, but to you who know what my life has been, I do
+not require to say that in Barbara’s case no such mistake was made.
+
+“Mr. Fleming,” said I, “is kinsman to the Earl of Wigton, is he not,
+madam?”
+
+“Ay,” she answered, “he is, and but for an untoward accident would one
+day be in the Earl’s place.”
+
+“Indeed, madam,” cried I, more for the pleasure of hearing my friend
+spoke of, than from any great curiosity about his family. “What
+accident was that, pray?”
+
+“’Tis a romantic tale,” said my lady, “and sorrowful too, as romance is
+apt to be, but I will tell it you to beguile the tedium of this weary
+road, seeing we cannot fall asleep like Phemie and my little sons.” And
+she eyed the sleeping children fondly.
+
+“You must know,” she went on, “that the present Earl’s grandfather
+had seven sons, of whom five died unmarried. William, the fifth son,
+succeeded his eldest brother John, whose only child was a daughter,
+Lady Jean, married to Lord Panmure. But the fourth brother, Tom, who
+died nearly fifty years ago, left a son who is the father of our friend
+here, Mr. Anthony. This Thomas, I have heard my lord say, was one of
+those pleasing but irresponsible persons who are said to be no one’s
+enemy but their own. He was handsome, gay, and clever, but selfish,
+thoughtless, and wanting in ballast. It seems he made the acquaintance
+of a young lady, the daughter of a respectable merchant in London, and
+either by false representations, or specious promises, induced her to
+run away with him, intending, as he solemnly averred afterwards, to
+make her his lawful wife at his earliest convenience. He left her after
+a few months in a small village in Hampshire, while he returned to
+London, and entered again into all his social pleasures; but letters
+passed constantly between them, and the forsaken girl seems to have
+believed thoroughly in his integrity, for she made no complaint to her
+family, being satisfied to trust and be patient. At last, however, she
+knew it would be fatal to delay further, and for the sake of her unborn
+child she wrote to her lover a passionate appeal desiring him to return
+at once and right her in the eyes of the world. There must have been
+something in this letter that touched the heart of Thomas Fleming, for
+directly upon receipt of it, he set off post-haste for Hampshire. But
+alas! within twenty miles of London his chaise was overturned, and he
+himself so badly injured that he was unable to pursue his journey.
+Being carried into a friendly house upon the road, he learned from the
+surgeon that he had not many hours to live. His grief and sorrow were
+great, not so much, as he said, for his own sake, though life was sweet
+to him, as for the sake of the woman who had trusted him, and the child
+that he would never see. Whatever there was of good and noble in the
+poor man, came out in these last hours of his life. He implored those
+round him to send swift messengers first to his brother William, who
+fortunately at that time was living in London, and also to the father
+of the poor girl he had wronged. They obeyed the summons without delay,
+and were lucky enough to reach the house in time to hear his full
+confession, and to promise their help and protection to her who was in
+the sight of Heaven his wife. The poor father who was bowed down with
+grief ever since the loss of his daughter, was so touched with the
+genuine remorse and repentance of the dying man that he accorded him
+his forgiveness in a very Christian spirit, which allowed the other at
+least to die in peace.”
+
+“And what of the poor lady?” I asked, much moved by this tale of love
+and wrong. “Did she also forgive the wretch?”
+
+“Alas! my dear, she loved him,” said my lady.
+
+“But one is almost thankful to know that she did not live long to
+suffer the consequences of his perfidy. The shock of his death was too
+much for her, and three days after the birth of her little son she
+passed quietly away. She had the comfort, however, of knowing that
+her child was safe in the care of his grandfather and uncle. The old
+Earl also, who was still alive, acknowledged the boy, and sanctioned
+his bearing the name, though to be sure the bar sinister prevents him
+ever inheriting the title. He carries on the business of his maternal
+grandfather in London, and is now a man of wealth and standing.
+He married the only daughter of a Suffolk baronet--a beauty and a
+fortune--and Anthony Fleming is their son.”
+
+The close of this interesting tale brought us to Tillicoultry, the
+little village nearest to Alva on the eastern side, and soon afterwards
+we found ourselves at home.
+
+We were received at the door by Mr. Peck, John Harley and Mr. Rose,
+all very glad and thankful to see my lady returned, for many untoward
+events were happening, and they had been sore perplexed how to conduct
+themselves in her absence. The country-side was in a sad state it
+seemed, for the Government soldiers made free with the property of the
+inhabitants, no matter on which side their sympathies might be. Mr.
+Rose had already lost some considerable quantity of fodder, as well as
+numerous hens and ducks; also sheep and cattle not being safe in the
+fields, he had been obliged to drive them all within the enclosures
+near the house, and had men set to guard them night and day.
+
+“And indeed, my lady,” said Mr. Peck, “the enemy are so cautious and
+their plans so well-laid that the whole neighbourhood can do little
+against them, for they place their sentries so skilfully that not once
+have they been discovered nor surprised in their depredations.”
+
+This was not a cheerful aspect of things to be presented to us on our
+return home, and no doubt my lady’s heart sank as she realized what
+was before her. It was not however her way to sit down and bemoan her
+troubles, and she busied herself in giving orders for the comfort of
+our rain-drenched escort, who were to rest for some hours at Alva
+before taking the road back to Burntisland. Indeed, as the rain had
+somewhat abated and it promised to be a clear moonlight night, Mr.
+Fleming remarked that, with her ladyship’s permission, the later they
+were of starting the better. With this my lady agreed, and on her
+telling the young gentleman that she would be glad of his company at
+supper, we dispersed to our various occupations and duties.
+
+A little before the time for that meal, having arranged the things in
+my chamber, and assisted Phemie in getting the children’s affairs in
+order, I came downstairs and entered the dining-hall, expecting to find
+my lady already there. The table was set, but the room was lit only by
+the flames from the coal-fire, which threw long shadows across the wall
+and ceiling. On entering the room I thought it had been empty, but as
+I turned to leave it, a tall form rose from the seat at the corner of
+the hearth, and Mr. Fleming’s voice spoke my name. I came forward again
+slowly.
+
+“Will you not give me the pleasure of your company, Mistress Barbara,”
+he said, “for the few minutes before supper. Although this is the third
+time we have met, I do not think you have ever done me the honour to
+address me.”
+
+“Then, indeed, sir,” said I, forgetting my shyness, “you may well
+wonder at my manners. But it has been my great desire ever since our
+first troubled meeting, to offer you my heartfelt thanks for your kind
+assistance that morning.”
+
+He stood looking down at me very kindly, and yet his face bore an
+expression which I did not understand.
+
+“Were it not that it gave me the pleasure of an introduction to you,
+madam,” he said, “I could heartily wish that you had never needed it.”
+
+“Truly,” said I, “’twas not a pleasant experience, but I must own I
+brought it upon myself. ’Twas a madcap adventure at best, and since we
+have known more fully the risks we ran, both Mistress Betty and I have
+had the grace to be ashamed of our temerity.”
+
+“Indeed, the risks were much greater than you thought,” he answered
+gravely. “I can only be thankful that I arrived upon the scene when I
+did.”
+
+“I had never in my life been really frightened before,” said I, “but
+when I felt that man’s hot breath on my cheek as he fell, clutching my
+plaid with his hands, I thought I should have died of terror.”
+
+“Faugh!” exclaimed Mr. Fleming, “I cannot bear to think of it!”
+
+“And when I lifted my eyes and saw you,” I continued, but steps now
+sounded without, and a servant entered the room, bearing candles which
+he placed upon the board. I moved a little further from the fireplace,
+but Mr. Fleming made a step forward and stopped me.
+
+“Yes,” he said eagerly, “when you saw me--what then?”
+
+“I knew I need fear no longer,” said I simply.
+
+He took my hand and kissed it gravely.
+
+“That, madam, is a speech that any man may be proud to hear from a
+woman. I thank you, and I shall never forget it.”
+
+Among those bidden to supper by my lady on this first night came Mr.
+James Hamilton, and as at this moment he entered the room his eyes
+lighted immediately on me, and he came smiling up to greet me.
+
+“Welcome back to Alva, Mistress Barbara Stewart!” he cried, bowing
+before me. “The winter is approaching, ’tis true, but you bring the
+light and warmth of summer in your train.”
+
+Now a few months back this fulsome speech would doubtless have pleased
+me well, and set me trying to answer the gentleman in the same vein,
+but to-night it seemed mere empty compliment--too blatant to be in
+good taste--and it vexed me that Mr. Fleming, who was standing near,
+should hear it. I tried to answer coldly, but Mr. Hamilton was at once
+too good-humoured and too conceited to believe himself snubbed; he
+therefore took my scorn for coquetry, and redoubled his attentions.
+Mr. Fleming, after waiting for some minutes, as if wishing to continue
+our conversation, evidently considered himself dismissed and strolled
+off to the other side of the room. As he was placed on my lady’s right
+hand at supper, and I sat at the other end of the table, I had no
+further opportunity of speaking to him, and was obliged to conceal my
+chagrin as best I might. Mr. Hamilton plied me with friendly questions,
+to which I made random answers, and before the end of the meal I fell
+so silent that my lady, believing me worn out, withdrew as soon as
+possible, taking me with her from the room. In the hall outside she
+kissed me kindly and bade me go at once to bed.
+
+Half-an-hour later, while I still lingered over my disrobing, I heard
+below the sounds of our escort departing. Softly I opened my casement,
+and having extinguished the taper, I leaned out. The moon was hidden
+and I could see but little. I heard the trampling of the horses, the
+gruff tones of the men, the jingling of the bridles, and an occasional
+laugh. Next came the voice of Mr. Fleming bidding my lady adieu, and
+his quick spurs ringing on the stones of the court-yard. Then I heard
+the order to mount, the heavy swing of the men into their saddles,
+the horses’ hoofs striking the stones as the troop moved off into the
+night. The moon sailed out from behind the clouds, and just then their
+Captain turned and looked back at the house. In an agony of startled
+modesty I shrank away from the window, and crouched upon the floor
+until the sound of their going had died away. As I knelt to say my
+prayers, I remember wondering if I should ever see Mr. Anthony Fleming
+again--I believe I prayed that God would bless him whether I did or no.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII
+
+SHOWS HOW WE ARE SWEPT INTO THE STREAM OF EVENTS
+
+
+We had scarce been at home a day, when we seemed to be drawn into the
+current that was setting towards active warfare, whether we would or no.
+
+Not content with doing her best to guard her own property, my Lady
+Erskine was diligent to lend what help she could to our party in
+various ways. Having heard from her brother at Perth of an expedition
+being sent, under Major Graham, to levy a cess, as it was called,
+in Dunfermline, which, being a Whiggish town, was not too ready to
+pay taxes to King James, she sent out scouts from among her trusted
+servants, who were to pick up information in a private way, and had
+orders from her to act according to what they heard. My Lady Alva
+being much beloved by the country-folk, and on good terms with all
+her neighbours, her people had little difficulty in learning the
+doings of both parties, and acted with no little discretion in several
+emergencies. On this occasion the force from Perth made the mistake of
+taking their way among the hills so as to avoid the direct road, and in
+so doing passed “under the nose,” as the Master put it, of the small
+garrison placed by the Duke of Argyle in Castle Campbell above the
+little village of Dollar. The reason of this detour we were never able
+to understand, for, as a natural consequence, news of the expedition
+was immediately sent to the Duke at Stirling, who ordered Colonel
+Cathcart with a party of dragoons to start at once for the threatened
+town. This coming to my lady’s ears, she despatched a trusty servant on
+a fleet horse to warn Major Graham of the movements of the enemy; and
+we all awaited his return with some anxiety, which greatly increased
+when three days had passed and the worthy man had not returned home. My
+lady was making up her mind to send a second messenger after the first,
+when early in the morning of the fourth day, poor Andrew arrived at the
+house, hungry and cold and much crest-fallen. Upon my lady bidding him
+into her presence, and asking the reason of his tardy return, he told a
+tale which caused his mistress much chagrin, and covered the narrator
+himself with confusion.
+
+Colonel Cathcart, it seems, had reached the town before him, but not
+caring to enter it until the middle of the night, he with his dragoons
+lay without the walls in the dark, sending spies hither and thither to
+bring him word as to how things were within. Into this watchful company
+poor Andrew, all unwittingly, fell; and while they did not ill-treat
+him they took from him his horse, and by dint of threats compelled him
+to act as guide to those who would enter the town. This they did about
+two o’clock in the morning, and as it seems the gentlemen were all
+abed, and the watch very carelessly kept, the enemy were among them
+before they were aware. Some few were killed, and Colonel Cathcart took
+eighteen gentlemen prisoners. He did not wait to follow up his success,
+but the result was the same as if he had done so, for the startled
+invaders waited not to reason or to fight, but fled from the place on
+horse or on foot until all were escaped in various directions. Our poor
+Andrew was carried back to Stirling by the dragoons, kept in durance
+for two nights and a day, and on disclosing his name and occupation was
+liberated early on the second morning and bidden to make his way home.
+
+I think I have never seen my lady so angry as she became upon the
+recital of this shameful tale. The carelessness and indifference of
+the King’s officers, sent upon so important a mission, appeared to her
+criminal in a high degree. Such waste of life and loss of property,
+where a little foresight and military precision would have saved all,
+rankled in her mind and set her brain and heart on fire. But angry as
+she was, it did not prevent her making the attempt to save another
+party sent on a like errand, under Lord George Murray, a week or
+two later, and this time her interference was crowned with success.
+Our good Andrew was again her emissary; and he not only succeeded
+in reaching the town in time to warn Lord George of the approach of
+the dragoons, but made the attempt by his own observation to further
+benefit our party a little. He returned to Alva without delay, and in
+high disgust informed his mistress that his entry into Dunfermline had
+been all too easy, for not a single sentry was set, and no opposition
+was made, nor question put to the visitor. My lady shared the good
+man’s righteous indignation.
+
+“Are they _all_ fools in my Lord Mar’s army?” she exclaimed in great
+vexation. “Sure, never was so much negligence shown, or such ignorance
+allowed to flourish. I heartily wish we might take an example by the
+enemy, who, as you know, place sentries in all the passages of the
+hills within two miles of this house, when taking away my corn and
+straw. This news of their carelessness shall reach the Earl’s ears
+before many hours are over, for I shall write a letter to my brother
+this very day, with the request to have it shown at headquarters.”
+
+Which she accordingly did, and sent it to the Master by a sure hand;
+but whether it produced the effect she desired, we had no opportunity
+of judging.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+One afternoon in the beginning of November, having returned from
+walking abroad with Phemie and the little boys who were anxious to
+visit their favourite haunts before the winter set in, I found my dear
+Lady Erskine seated in her own room with a letter in her lap and the
+traces of tears upon her face. I ran to her, eager to know the reason
+of her grief, but she would not suffer me to condole with her.
+
+“Indeed, I am but a foolish woman, my dear,” she said with a smile,
+though her voice quivered, “and not fit to be the wife of an officer
+immersed in affairs. Here is Sir John sent off to France at very short
+notice, and Heaven knows when we shall see him again! I ought to feel
+glad and proud that he is trusted with business of so great moment; but
+I must own the thought of being without him for so many weeks is very
+bitter to me.”
+
+“Oh, and to me too, madam!” I cried foolishly. “The house is not the
+same without him. Pray, cousin, is this important business a secret, or
+may I know what it is?”
+
+“’Tis not to be talked of to all and sundry,” my lady replied, “but
+you may see here what he says for your own satisfaction,” and she gave
+me the letter, pointing to these words which Sir John had written.
+“_Having orders from Mar to presse the King’s coming, and the sending
+over officers, arms and ammunition, and in particular to inform Earl
+Bolingbroke how much all these are wanted._”
+
+“An onerous task truly,” sighed my lady, “and I pray God he may
+succeed; and above all that he may be kept from harm, and brought safe
+back to us who love him.”
+
+“Amen!” cried I fervently, greatly impressed by the importance of Sir
+John’s mission, and realising full well my lady’s sorrow at being thus
+parted from her husband.
+
+“I think the heaviest end of my burden,” said she, “lies in the fact
+that under the circumstances his letters to me may be long delayed,
+and mine may never reach him. You see here he was despatched upon the
+28th October, and ’tis now the 6th day of November, yet this letter has
+never left Britain. Situated as we are, Sir John being an agent in the
+Jacobite interests, he cannot trust his papers and despatches to the
+common post nor, can I address letters openly to him, who has reason
+for keeping his movements private. This, Barbara, I foresee, will
+constitute one of my worst troubles in the coming time. It is no little
+relief for one so indeterminate as myself to be able to pour out my
+difficulties on paper to him who is my best friend, and to be certain
+of receiving sympathy and counsel and safe advice in return.”
+
+“Sir John does not say when he will return, madam?” I asked.
+
+“Alas! child, he probably knows as little about that as we do. My only
+comfort is, that for the moment he is out of danger, should the Earl
+of Mar decide to give battle as my brother in his last epistle gives a
+hint of.”
+
+“He talked of the Earl coming south did he not?”
+
+“Ay, he intends to cross over the Forth above Stirling into the
+Lowlands, and so march into England to join the friends there. My
+brother, to be sure, sees a hundred difficulties and dangers, the
+chief being the impossibility of making use of the fords in face of
+the enemy, for the Duke of Argyle has them very well guarded, and as
+we heard yesterday has cut the bridge of Doune which is the only way
+to reach them; how it will end, I know not. The country is already
+bare and destitute, and the poor folk reduced almost to beggary. They
+tremble at the rumours of a horde of wild Highlandmen being let loose
+upon them, for brave and loyal as the clansmen are, Barbara, they
+are a rough and undisciplined set, and were it for nothing else but
+to satisfy their hunger they must needs make raids upon many of the
+peaceful farms and cottages.”
+
+“Truly,” said I soberly, “civil war is a grievous thing, and the
+working out of King James’s Restoration is not quite the exciting
+romance I foolishly pictured it.”
+
+“They are to march from Perth by Dunning, Auchterarder and Dunblane,”
+said my lady, “so that we are luckily not in the direct route. But
+with several thousand horse and foot sweeping along in one direction,
+many will spread out over the hills and may even be diverted into this
+road to reach the south, should their passage of the Fords of Forth
+prove impossible. We can but take all precautions for the safety of the
+stockin’, and be you very careful, child, to keep close to the house
+these days lest any harm befall you.”
+
+Not the least of the troubles for the country folk at this time was the
+wintry weather which now began, for a frost so severe and so continuous
+set in, that their privations were greatly increased. On the night of
+the tenth there was a slight sprinkling of snow, which was only the
+forerunner of the heavy storms that all that winter continued to fall.
+Aunt Betty Erskine, who was with us, suffered much from the cold,
+which with the sad state of matters in the country afforded her ample
+grounds for grumbling and discontent; but my lady bore it all with
+exemplary patience, her mind in truth being fully occupied with other
+matters.
+
+We were living in a state of expectation, not unmixed with dread, for
+no one knew what might take place next.
+
+My Lord Mar and his army could not, we judged, remain much longer
+inactive at Perth. Indeed there were already impatient voices heard
+condemning him for the lack of energy, or the excess of caution,
+which kept him from coming to issues with the Duke of Argyle. The
+latter nobleman was lodged in his own house at Stirling (the Earl of
+Stirling’s mansion, as it was still called, tho’ it had now belonged
+to the Argyle family for about fifty years) at the head of the Castle
+Wynd, and his forces lay in the King’s Park. His design was to prevent
+the Insurgents getting besouth Forth, and being a good General he kept
+himself well informed by his spies and scouts of all the movements
+going on at Perth.
+
+I need not tell you now, who are by no means ignorant of the history
+of your country, that the remembrance of those November days and all
+that occurred in them is fraught with humiliation to me. The Battle of
+Sheriffmuir has long ago become a word of scorn in the ears of Whig
+and Jacobite alike. The tears caused by its tragedy (for no battle is
+wanting in that element) were scarcely dried, ere the humour of it
+struck the common people, who, whatever our English friends may say
+(and I have often heard the Scots accused of melancholy and gloom) are
+not slow to perceive the comic side of a thing. It became the subject
+of much ribald rhyme, and the great men engaged on either side were not
+spared by the rhymsters. But without stopping to give you my comments
+on this unlucky affair, I will try to tell you what happened in our
+own small sphere, in which I well remember we experienced as much
+excitement, terror, anxiety and amazement, as if we had been witnesses
+of the entire drama.
+
+On Saturday afternoon, the 12th day of November, one of my lady’s
+messengers, who were posted secretly among the hills and on the roads,
+came in hot haste to say that a mighty host, horse and foot, was on
+the road between Auchterarder and Dunblane. Scarcely had we realised
+the significance of these tidings, when another arrived with the news
+that the Duke of Argyle had marched out from Stirling about noon, and
+was also approaching Dunblane from the other side. What consternation
+ensued among us! Were they each aware, we wondered, of the other’s
+proximity, or would they fall upon each other without warning? My
+lady, whose faith in my Lord Mar’s skill as a General was not so great
+as she could have wished, felt tolerably certain that the meeting,
+if it occurred, would come as a surprise to their side at least. She
+therefore sent off a trusty man, a shepherd, swift of foot and well
+acquainted with the hills, to find her brother who was with the Earl,
+and deliver him a letter in which she gave him as much information as
+possible of Argyle’s movements. This the shepherd, Allan Maclean, had
+orders to deliver to the Master of Sinclair only if he found the army
+dangerously near Dunblane and all unwarned. The messenger despatched,
+my lady set us all to work, preparing food, baking bread, brewing
+cordials, looking out old garments, and in every way she could think
+of making ready for emergencies should a battle be fought in our
+neighbourhood.
+
+It was quite dark and about nine of the clock when Allan returned, not
+having reached Lord Mar’s army. He had been told by several of the
+country folk upon the roads that my Lady Kippendavie had already sent
+to warn them early in the afternoon, and the leaders had decided to
+bivouack for the night in a hollow place near the little village of
+Kinbuck. Here, as we were told afterwards by the Master, eight thousand
+men were packed into so small a space, that “it could not,” he wrote,
+“be properly said they had a front or a rear, more than it can be said
+of a barrel of herrings.” By the kindness of Providence it did not
+occur to my Lord of Argyle to plan an attack that night, otherwise, as
+our informant told us, the entire force might have been slaughtered
+almost before they could defend themselves. The horses were picketted
+in the small kailyards of two farm-houses, while the officers found
+quarters where they could in house or barn. It was a bitter cold
+night, the frost being very hard, and many a time I waked to think
+of the poor men of both armies shivering under the stars. But such
+privations were common, I knew, in time of war, and worse would surely
+follow.
+
+The next day being Sunday, we rose with mingled feelings, not knowing
+what the day might bring forth. Very early came a lad with a message
+for my lady from the minister, to say that, “There wad be nae Sabbath
+the day.” This meant, as you know, that the church was not open, and
+that no services were held either at Alva or in any of the neighbouring
+parishes, the people all being gone out to _see the battle_. To my
+lady, ever of a serious and pious nature, this proceeding did not
+commend itself.
+
+“For where,” she asked, “was it more fitting we should spend our time,
+or carry our burdens on such a day, than into the House of God?”
+
+But as the ministers were gone after their flocks, no bells were rung
+and the church doors remained closed.
+
+As the hours wore on, we heard from time to time items of news which
+gave us some idea of the proceedings taking place within a few miles
+of the house. A spur of the Ochils, as you will remember, lies between
+Alva and Dunblane, but by climbing the hills a good view could be had
+of all the country round. On a clear winter day, such as this was, one
+could see for many miles, and it was plain to our watchers that about
+noon the two armies had met on the rising ground of Sheriffmuir and
+that the fighting had begun. The noise of the cannon and fusils was
+plain to be heard in the frosty air, and sent panic into our hearts,
+for we were new to the idea of war; and now that the worst had come,
+I, for one, was no more anxious for the destruction of the Government
+troops than of those on our own side. Oh, indeed I fear that little of
+the world’s fighting would have been done had it been left to the women
+to decide, and yet I know not in truth if they could have devised any
+better method for settling many difficulties.
+
+With my lady’s leave, I climbed the hill in company with Mr. Rose, the
+grieve, and sat there during the short afternoon, my eyes fixed upon
+the distant scene in a strange turmoil of hope and fear. Little could
+I see save the smoke of the guns, and masses of men moving or running
+among the undulating hills, in what seemed a very aimless way. But the
+noise of the firing, the clash of steel, the wild hoarse cries of the
+Highlanders as they rushed on their foes, made strange clamour in the
+peaceful upper air of that un-Sabbathlike Sunday afternoon. It would
+require the pen of a person skilled in warfare to explain the movements
+of both armies from so great a distance, for to me it was mostly
+confusion, and I scarce knew what I expected to see when I begged to
+be allowed to climb the hill. Perhaps I imagined a mighty host from
+the north rushing furiously upon the Government troops, so that in the
+course of an hour or so they should be completely annihilated, or only
+a remnant left to cry quarter, as the Earl of Mar pushed triumphant on
+to Stirling Castle. If so, I was mightily disappointed, for as dusk
+fell it seemed that the fighting ceased; both parties appeared to
+stand at gaze, motionless themselves, but watching for the movements
+of the other. Then Argyle’s men were seen to draw off along the road
+to Dunblane, and the Earl of Mar’s army marched slowly away northwards
+towards Ardoch.
+
+“Is it finished?” I cried to Mr. Rose, rising to my feet. “Is this all?
+Which side has won? Will they fight again to-morrow?”
+
+For so quickly had the end come, that I was plunged in amazement and
+perplexity, and could scarce realise that I had been witness of a
+genuine battle.
+
+The grieve shook his head doubtfully.
+
+“Deed, missy, I couldna say,” he answered. “But it’s time ye were back
+in the hoose wi’ my lady, I’m thinkin’.”
+
+And stiff with the cold, and burdened with a dull weight of
+apprehension which I did not understand, I made my way down the hill
+which was now shrouded in darkness.
+
+I found the house in the deepest gloom, for to my surprise not a
+lantern or taper had been lit, and as I mounted the stairs I heard the
+sound of loud weeping coming from one of the rooms of which the door
+was open. I entered quickly and a curious scene met my eyes. My lady
+was seated upon a couch, little Hal whimpering on her knees, while
+Charles leant against her side and gazed fearfully up in her face.
+Phemie stood silent and grim beside her, while all the other women of
+the house, some in attitudes of despair upon the floor, some supporting
+each other in their arms, were sobbing and wailing as if the last day
+had come. My lady’s face was a study, so white, so set, so stern, and
+with eyes fixed in a stare so fateful, that for a moment my heart was
+in my mouth, as the saying is, and I imagined nothing less than that
+the awful tidings of the death of Sir John had reached her. At the
+thought I rushed into the room, crying out,
+
+“For Heaven’s sake, madam, what is amiss? Pray, Phemie, bid those women
+hold their peace, and tell me what has happened. Is it Sir John? Why
+looks my lady so?”
+
+While Phemie tried to quiet the maids, my lady turned to answer me,
+and the effort seemed to break the frozen spell that held her, for the
+tears welled up in her eyes and rolled down her face.
+
+“Oh, Barbara, did you not see--have you not heard? The battle is over
+and Argyle hath vanquished Mar, whose army is broken and fleeing to the
+hills. The Cause is lost, my girl, and we are undone. The kindest thing
+to do now is to stop the King from coming over, and did I but know
+where to address Sir John, I would send a despatch to France this very
+night.”
+
+Utterly bewildered I tried to put into sane words what I had just
+witnessed from the hill, but as I spoke I felt that I was not
+convincing my audience.
+
+“A battle there was surely, madam,” I said, “but indeed there was no
+rout of my Lord Mar’s army. It drew off when the dusk fell as orderly
+as the other, and if I am not mistaken they have but retired for the
+night to fight again to-morrow.”
+
+Even while they looked at me, trying to take in my words of hope, a
+clamour arose in the courtyard, and a great voice shouted, “Hurrah!”
+I flew to the window, and opening it wide, leaned out. A group of men
+holding torches were round the door, and among them I could see the
+shepherd, Allan Maclean, who appeared to have but just arrived among
+them.
+
+“What news?” I cried. “What news, men? Is it Allan Maclean that has
+brought them?”
+
+The men looked up, and seeing that my lady had joined me, surrounded by
+the agitated women, they tossed their bonnets into the air, shouting,
+
+“Victory, my leddy, victory for my Lord Mar! A gran’ fecht, and
+Argyle’s beaten! Lang live King Jamie, and doun wi’ German Geordie.”
+
+Now on hearing these cries, my lady turned and caught my hand, and we
+looked in each other’s faces, perplexed; and there was something so
+whimsical in the occurrence (also the relief of the reaction was so
+great), that we both burst out laughing, and stood there swaying to and
+fro till we became exhausted with our mirth and were obliged to stop.
+
+“Sure,” said my dear lady, wiping her eyes, “this is the strangest
+battle that ever was fought, where both sides claim the victory, and
+neither has suffered defeat. For the Stirling folk, we are told, are
+rejoicing over their success as heartily as Allan Maclean, and have
+already spread abroad about the town that my Lord Mar’s forces are
+utterly broken.”
+
+“That,” cried I, “I am convinced they are not; but how far the rest
+is true or untrue I fear we must wait till the morrow to learn. Oh,
+madam, ’tis pity that the field lies so far from us--there must be many
+wounded and dying. To think of them lying out in this bitter cold nigh
+breaks my heart. Pray God none of your own people are among them!”
+
+“Alas!” she sighed, “if all is not well with them, they are either dead
+or taken prisoners. But I would fain succour the others, even as you
+would, Barbara, were we not too distant here. To-morrow we must see
+what can be done. Ah, my dear, how could we laugh so heartily just now,
+when some of our kindest neighbours and friends may be lying stark and
+stiff on Sheriffmuir?”
+
+And I hope you will not despise us when you hear that upon that we both
+sat down and wept.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII
+
+TELLS OF A DARK HOUR--AND OF A GREAT AWAKENING
+
+
+Tidings we had upon the morrow in plenty, but no great certainty, for
+Rumour, many-mouthed, roamed the country-side, and each mouth had a
+different tale to tell. One thing was sure--_part_ of each army had
+vanquished _part_ of the other; that is to say, Mar’s left wing was
+put to flight by Argyle’s right, while his centre column had routed
+Argyle’s left. That it was a well ordered battle no man on either side
+dare affirm, and the confusion, the bad discipline, and the lack of
+strategic skill on the part of the insurgents, prevented the Earl of
+Mar, whose numbers were by far the larger, from recording a complete
+victory over the Government troops. Had he even returned to give
+battle on the morrow all might have been well; but owing partly to the
+desertion of many of the Highlanders from his ranks, partly to the
+lack of victuals, and a little, I fear, to dissensions among his chief
+officers, he remained inactive, and gradually drew off towards Perth,
+claiming the victory on his part, and leaving Argyle to proclaim it on
+his own.
+
+In the meantime, on this dark Monday, we heard heavy enough tidings
+from time to time. Some were said to be dead who were only taken
+prisoners, and others were thought safe whose corpses were found upon
+the field. Upwards of eighty officers and gentlemen were lodged as
+prisoners in Stirling Castle, while many also on the other side were
+carried off to Perth. We heard in the course of the day with real
+sorrow, of the death of the gallant young Earl of Strathmore, and of
+the brave Chief of Clanranald; and how, sore wounded, that fine old
+hero, my Lord Panmure, was a prisoner. Many other ill tidings came to
+us, for, as you know, we had friends on both sides in the battle; and
+all day long the house was besieged by people of the poorer sort, with
+some tale to tell of death or disaster, of loss by battle, or by the
+thieving soldiers, making requests for meal or meat, clothing or money,
+or merely to pour into my Lady Alva’s ears some incident of harrowing
+importance.
+
+Soon after the noon-day dinner, little Charles called me to see a troop
+of some five hundred horse which were passing the house, going in the
+direction of Dunblane; and my lady desiring to know who they were, went
+cautiously to the gate, accompanied by her son and myself, and looked
+at the officers who passed to see if she might find any friends among
+them. Several went by without her recognising them, but at last came
+one who was well-known to her, namely, my Lord George Murray, who upon
+seeing my lady, saluted and came forward to speak with her. From him
+we learned that he, with the Laird of Inveruitie, had received orders
+to march from Burntisland with their battalions to join the Earl of
+Mar between Auchterarder and Stirling. They had come with what speed
+they could, but owing, I believe, to some delay in the message being
+delivered, they were arriving, as my lady told them, “a day behind the
+Fair.” Lord George questioned us eagerly upon what had taken place, and
+hoped that yesterday’s battle might only be the first of the campaign.
+He would not stop for refreshment, even though the servants were now
+appearing with jugs of small beer and bottles of claret, but must press
+on, as he said, in order to reach headquarters, wherever these might
+be, before the dusk fell. As my lady drew back she asked a question
+which I had so longed to put myself, that when the words fell from her
+lips I was startled by the quick throb of my heart.
+
+“Pray, is our friend, Captain Anthony Fleming, in your company?” she
+said. “We should like to salute him kindly.”
+
+Lord George was already riding off, and looked back to answer her.
+
+“Fleming? Anthony Fleming?” he called out. “No, madam, he left
+Burntisland on a special mission to my Lord Mar a week since, and is
+in all probability over there now with the army. Adieu.”
+
+And the heavy horses went thudding and pounding past us, and for no
+reason at all my heart sank low, and the blood ebbed in my cheeks.
+
+“Poor Anthony!” murmured my lady, as we turned away, “God grant he has
+come safe out of it!”
+
+I could neither answer nor look at her, for all at once it seemed to me
+I saw my friend lying wounded, or perhaps dead, out there on the frozen
+morass. So clearly I pictured his face turned up to the sky, his kind
+eyes closed to all earthly light for ever, his strong arm lifeless by
+his side, that it seemed to me like a prophetic vision, or like the
+strange knowledge of current events, which the Highlanders call “second
+sight.” I shivered with a sort of fear, and having entered the house
+crept away upstairs to the nursery, where little Hal was playing, and
+my good Phemie sat placidly spinning, as if no such things as battles
+had ever been heard of. I sat myself down on the floor beside her, as
+I was used to do as a bairn, and leaned my head against her while I
+listened to the drowsy humming of the wheel. She stopped for a moment
+to lay her kind hand upon my hair.
+
+“What ails my lamb the day?” she said, tenderly, and at the touch and
+tone, so truly motherly, the tears rose in my eyes and dropped down
+into my lap. Harry, who had stopped playing, came running up, and
+putting his soft arms round my neck, bade me “not to greet.”
+
+“She’s sorry about the battle, Phemie,” said the dear little fellow,
+“and the poor shotted soldiers and the hurt horse and all. How glad I
+am that my papa is not in Scotland--he would have been in the fight,
+and perhaps have got shotted too.”
+
+The baby speech, and the loving clasp of the little arms, comforted me
+strangely, and when a few minutes later I heard my lady’s voice calling
+me, I ran downstairs quite cheerful again, and asked what I could do
+for her. She stood in the hall with a basket in her hand, and Charles
+beside her wrapped in his winter cloak.
+
+“I have heard but now, Barbara,” said she, “that Alison Macdonald, the
+herd’s wife, is sick and in need of some comforts. She is alone in bed
+in the hut, but the key is hid in the thatch (you are tall and can
+reach it). So many are coming and going that I cannot spare one of the
+servants to send to her, yet I cannot let the poor woman starve, for
+her husband, you know, went to Dunfermline on an errand this morning,
+and cannot be back till late. I fear the snow will shortly be coming
+down heavily, so, although I scarce like to ask you to go a yard from
+the house to-day, if you keep to the road till you come to the glen,
+I do not think any one will molest you. ’Twill not take more than
+half-an-hour, going and returning, and my brave little Charles will be
+your protector.”
+
+“Why, yes, Cousin Barbara,” cried the child smiling, “I will not let
+anyone touch you, and I am to carry the can of broth.”
+
+The herd’s bothie stood about half-way up a small glen that lay
+parallel with and next to the Silver Glen. The stream which ran through
+it was a mere trickle, except when a great rain flooded the hills, and
+the trees and shrubs were mostly stunted and of little beauty. I left
+the house with few misgivings for the road was quiet, and if there were
+any fugitives hiding from the soldiers of Argyle they would, we knew,
+keep to the hills and not frequent the highways.
+
+We met no soul on our short journey, and found the poor woman, as my
+lady had said, alone in the hut and very thankful to see us. I did
+what I could for her comfort: built up the fire of coal and peat till
+it glowed cheerfully upon the hearth, gave her some of the broth, and
+under her directions placed the other things within her reach. Then
+promising that someone should come to her in the evening, in case her
+husband might be detained, we left her much cheered, and locking the
+door again, departed.
+
+It was now about four of the clock, and evening was approaching. In
+the glen it was darker because of the close growing trees, and we were
+obliged to walk carefully for the path was steep and narrow. A slight
+snow had fallen, and the frost held the ground like iron. Among the
+grasses at the edge of the burn were fringes of ice, though the running
+water itself was not yet frozen. A chill wind had sprung up and was
+moaning among the almost leafless trees.
+
+Suddenly little Charles, whose hand I held, stopped short, and
+shrinking nearer to me pointed, and whispered,
+
+“What is that, cousin?” I looked, and my heart stood still, for lying
+on the snowy ground a little way from the path, and half hidden by a
+low-growing bush, was the body of a man. My first impulse was to run,
+as far and as fast as possible from the dreaded object; but my second,
+I am glad to say, conquered my first, and bidding Charles stay where he
+was, I stepped over the frozen grass, and bending down, examined the
+recumbent figure. He was lying on his back, with his face upon his arm
+as if he slept, but it was turned towards me, and with a sharp cry I
+sprang back. Charles, in whom curiosity was ever greater than fear, ran
+to my side and seized my hand.
+
+“Is he dead, cousin? Is it a soldier? Oh, Heavens! ’tis Captain
+Anthony,” and without a pause the boy dropped on his knees and shook
+the shoulder nearest him with both hands.
+
+“Charles, Charles!” I cried, “stop for pity’s sake! Perhaps the poor
+man is dead. Oh, what shall we do if he is?”
+
+“He is not dead, cousin,” cried Charles. “He lives, I am sure of it.
+See, his chest moves as he breathes. But he is very cold, and oh look!
+there is blood upon his coat.”
+
+Half sick with terror I looked where he pointed. The officer had been
+wounded on the shoulder, and his sleeve being saturated with blood had
+frozen as stiff as a board. I touched his face, it was cold and very
+white, but sure enough I could see the feeble rise and fall of his
+chest, and I knew that Charles was right. A moment’s reflection showed
+me what I must do.
+
+“Would you be afraid, dear Cha, to run to the house alone,” I said,
+“and tell them to bring men to carry Mr. Fleming down. They must bring
+a board of some kind for he is badly wounded. Go straight to my lady
+and tell her the poor gentleman is unconscious--_unconscious_, Charles,
+will you remember that word? Say that Barbara is watching beside him;
+she will know what to order. Can you do this, my dear?”
+
+The little lad looked up in my face, then down the lonely path that was
+quickly growing darker, then at the wounded soldier in the grass.
+
+“Ay, Cousin Barbara, I can. Am I not your protector?” he said.
+
+“You are!” I cried, as I kissed him, “my brave protector and kind
+helper. And remember, dearest Cha, you are going to save Captain
+Anthony’s life.”
+
+With that he darted off, and left me alone in the darkling glen with
+my wounded friend and my anxious thoughts. I chafed his lifeless hands
+to bring some warmth to them, but with little result. I tried to raise
+his head, and succeeded in moving it a little and straightening out
+his unwounded arm; but the pallor of his face alarmed me much, for I
+knew not how long he had been lying there, nor how far his strength had
+ebbed. Oh, for a fire, for a surgeon, for brandy!
+
+At that thought I rose to my feet, and unwinding the plaid from my head
+and shoulders, I folded it over the unconscious man, and, regaining
+the path, began running up the glen as fast as the steepness and
+slipperiness of the way permitted. For among the comforts sent to
+Alison Macdonald, I had seen a little flask of the French brandy which
+my lady kept to dole out as medicine, and some of that brandy I was
+bound to have. I startled the poor woman half out of her wits by my
+abrupt entrance, but a few hurried words explained the matter, and she
+earnestly besought me to take the flask with me as the poor soldier
+needed it more than she. This I refused to do, but, pouring about half
+the contents into a cup, I locked the door once more, and for the
+fourth time retraced the narrow path.
+
+It was some time before I succeeded in forcing a little of the spirit
+between the poor pale lips, but in spite of the trembling of my hands
+(caused as much by nervousness as by the cold), I persevered, and was
+at last made happy by the knowledge that some had been swallowed.
+Anxiously I continued my ministrations, too much occupied with my
+task to have room for thought, and at last to my intense joy the eyes
+opened, and the lips seemed to form some inaudible words. Had he
+recognised me I wondered, did he know who was so eagerly tending him,
+would mine be the first name he uttered on regaining consciousness?
+Again I held the cup to his lips, and this time he drank more freely.
+As the life-giving cordial went down he stirred a little, and opening
+his eyes again vaguely, he murmured, “Mistress Betty Sinclair.”
+
+Now at this date it is easy to smile at the shock of dismay these
+words caused me, but at the time I remember very well ’twas no matter
+for smiling. It struck me with a kind of sad irony, that I had looked
+upon this gentleman as my peculiar property. I had found him in dire
+straits, I had ministered to him with my own hands, I had perhaps
+brought him back to life, and for what? To hear him, with his first
+conscious thought, call for Betty Sinclair! I sat by his head on the
+chilly ground, too numb to feel the cold. I still chafed his hands,
+and offered him brandy, but it was done _with a difference_. The warm
+feeling of motherly protection, which moves a maid towards the man who
+attracts her, had fled. I would nurse him and watch him, and save him
+if I could, but it was to be for another, and as I thought thereon, I
+wept.
+
+Ah, foolish Barbara! thus to torture herself because of three little
+words. Where was her reason gone, her modesty, her pride? For full five
+minutes, I verily believe, they had fled from the stronghold of her
+mind, and during that period she abandoned herself to cold despair and
+helpless, gnawing jealousy.
+
+The sound of steps and voices in the distance brought me to myself. I
+wiped the tears from my face, and redoubled my efforts with so much
+success that by the time the men approached, Captain Fleming was well
+enough to notice them, though of me he did not seem to be aware. Mr.
+Rose, and John Harley, Allan the shepherd, and Thomas, one of the
+stablemen, bearing a stretcher between them, came hurriedly up the
+glen, and with kind haste and skilful hands lifted the wounded man upon
+it. Mr. Rose carried a warm cloak which had been given him by my lady
+for the soldier’s use, but on catching sight of Barbara shivering in
+her house-dress he wrapped it round her shoulders, leaving her plaid
+where she had placed it.
+
+Just as they were starting Captain Fleming made an effort to speak, and
+Mr. Rose bent down to listen.
+
+“Whaur are we takin’ ye, sir? Just to Alva Hoose, whaur my leddy waits
+tae pit ye tae bed. You bide quiet, Mr. Fleming, ye’re in guid hands,
+and will be well cared for.”
+
+With a sigh of satisfaction the sick man closed his eyes, but as I
+walked soberly in the rear of the procession I was not able to see his
+face.
+
+My lady was too anxious as to the state of her unbidden guest to do
+more than lay her hand on my shoulder with a, “Well done, Barbara!”
+that warmed my heart. But upstairs in the nursery, to which I was
+at once dragged by Charles, we were regarded as hero and heroine by
+Phemie and little Hal. There I was treated to all sorts of petting and
+cossetting, to words of praise and wonder, to hot spiced wine, and a
+warm bath for my feet. So that, ere ten minutes had passed, I had well
+nigh forgotten my lonely vigil in the glen, and was ready to laugh at
+Harry’s wee face as he listened excitedly to his brother’s chatter. He
+told us of his quick run home, and how frighted he was at the dark;
+and how he had taken the grunting of a pig for a Highlander calling
+him, and had raced all the faster past the stye; and how Devon, the
+watch-dog, had seemed to know his step, for he stopped barking and
+crawled back into his kennel, and let my brave protector run straight
+in at the door.
+
+“And what did you do when I left you, Cousin Barbara?” he cried. “Were
+you terrible frighted without me?”
+
+Whereupon I had to add my chapter to the tale, and relate my
+adventures with the brandy, receiving great credit from Phemie for my
+thoughtfulness, as I had probably, she said, saved the poor gentleman’s
+life.
+
+“And did he not open his eyes and see you?” asked Hal, “and say, ‘Fank
+you, Mistress Barbara?’”
+
+“Indeed he did not, Harold Beaux-yeux!” said I. “Poor Barbara was not
+even noticed.”
+
+“But did he say nuffin at all?” persisted the child.
+
+I rose up laughing, for the foolish mood had passed, and lifted the boy
+in my arms.
+
+“Oh, yes, he did,” I cried. “He asked for your Aunt Betty Sinclair.”
+
+“Eh!” said Phemie grimly, “another of ’em!”
+
+And though this mysterious utterance pricked my heart, I laughed again,
+and joined in a game of romps with the children.
+
+But half an hour afterwards I stood outside a closed door, with my
+head against the panel, listening hungrily for a sound from within.
+The stillness terrified me, for I thought he must be dead. I longed to
+lift the latch and go in, but modesty and fear forbade me. How long I
+stood there I know not, but footsteps behind me in the passage made me
+turn my head, to see my lady approaching with a cup in her hand. She
+had not, as I was glad to know, perceived my attitude, and took it for
+granted that I had but just come. She signed to me to open the door,
+and we entered the room together. By the light of a dimly burning taper
+I caught sight of the form upon the bed. His head was bandaged, for
+there was a scalp wound under the hair which had started bleeding, and
+this made the pallor of his face more ghastly; his eyes were closed. I
+stole into the shadow of the curtain, and watched my lady as she bent
+over the bed and raised him on her arm to hold the cup of broth to his
+lips. He was not asleep, and thanked her gratefully as he drank it.
+
+“Are you in pain?” she asked, gently.
+
+“It will pass,” he answered in a weak voice, but cheerily. “’Twas worse
+upon the hillside.”
+
+“Mr. Peck, who is a clever surgeon, says you must not talk,” said my
+lady; “but if you have anything upon your mind, he thinks it will ease
+you to tell me if you are able.”
+
+His next words startled me, prepared as I was.
+
+“Is your sister Mistress Betty Sinclair, in the house with you, madam?”
+he asked.
+
+“Nay,” said my lady, “she is still at Dysart. Have you aught you wish
+me to tell her?”
+
+“’Twas your brother, the Master,” went on Mr. Fleming, “that told me
+she was here. He writ her a letter after the battle, a few lines only,
+thinking she and you, madam, would be anxious to know of his safety.
+When he found me wounded, he very kindly said that if I could find my
+way here I should be well cared for, and could join the army again in a
+few days when a little recovered from my wound. He gave me the letter,
+telling me to deliver it to Mistress Sinclair if she were here, or to
+you, madam, if she were not. He directed me how to come in order to
+avoid the enemy, but a small body of dragoons espied and chased me,
+and though I escaped them by great good luck, my horse was caught by
+a stray bullet, and shortly after the poor beast stumbled and fell,
+to rise no more. I came on foot, but missed my way in the dark and
+wandered far, and I know not how many hours I had been on the hillside
+when your searchers found me. The letter, madam, is in the inner pocket
+of my tunic, and that is all my task accomplished, save to offer my
+heartfelt apologies for giving you so much trouble.”
+
+Now this lengthy speech was faltered out, sentence by sentence, as the
+poor man’s strength allowed, but my lady waited patiently, believing
+rightly that when the tale was told his mind would be more at ease.
+Upon its conclusion she assured him that his apologies were unnecessary
+at such a time, and at his request she found the letter he had suffered
+so much in bringing.
+
+As for me, only one thing at that moment seemed important--the strange
+exclamation in the glen was accounted for. He had been bidden to find
+Betty Sinclair, and naturally her name came first to his lips. How
+simple it was! Already my heart felt lighter, and as my lady moved to
+the door after bidding her patient try to sleep, I slipped from the
+shadow of the curtain and passed close to the bed. For one moment I
+paused and looked down upon him, and our eyes met. Oh! the glad light
+that sprang into his as he recognised me.
+
+“Barbara!” he whispered, and that was all; but the word was so fraught
+with tender gladness that my heart vibrated like a harp-string touched
+to music, and I could scarce restrain my tears. I held out my hand
+impulsively, and for a lingering moment our fingers touched. What magic
+lay in that brief handclasp not even the wisest of the ancients, I
+believe, could explain, but in the twinkling of an eyelid it changed
+my life for me. With a smile and a backward glance I passed on, and
+an instant later I was standing outside the door, a heedless girl no
+longer, but a glad, startled, loving, anxious woman.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX
+
+SHOWS HOW THE CAUSE SUFFERS MANY REVERSES
+
+
+My dear Lady Erskine was so wrapt in the perusal of her brother’s
+letter that she neither noticed my delay in quitting the bedroom, nor
+my agitation when I joined her. For a moment it seemed to me that the
+overwhelming emotion I had experienced must have left its mark upon my
+face, that my eyes would betray it, and my lips tremble forth their
+confession, without her saying one word. But the next instant it came
+to me, as a woman, that the sweet and agitating secret was not mine
+own, that indeed ’twas so vague and impalpable I scarce had the right
+to regard its existence, and with the marvellous self-control that
+comes to our sex in such crises, I closed the door behind me and slowly
+followed my lady to her room.
+
+The letter from the Master told us little that we had not already
+heard, except that it gave us the names of many friends who were taken
+prisoners to Stirling. Lord Strathallan among others, and his brother,
+Mr. Thomas Drummond, Colonel Walkinshaw, the Laird of Barafield,
+and Mr. Murray, younger, of Auchtertyre. He found time to lament in
+touching words the sad death of young Lord Strathmore, than whom a
+truer gentleman, or a braver soldier, never bore a sword. I give his
+words as he wrote them--
+
+“On our left the brave young Strathmore was killed. I can’t help
+wishing he had kept his promise to me to honour me with being under
+my command, and joyning my squadron. When he found all turning their
+backs, he seized the Colours, and persuaded fourteen, or some such
+number, to stand by him for some time, which drew upon him the enemie’s
+fire by which he was wounded; and going off was taken and murdered by
+a dragoon--a mill-stone crushing a brilliant. He was the young man of
+all I ever saw who approached the nearest to perfection, and had a just
+contempt of all the little lyes and selfish tricks so necessary to some
+and so common among us.”
+
+He told us also that Mr. Irvine of Drum, “a young gentleman of good
+hopes, was ill wounded.” On the other side, my Lord Islay, the Duke’s
+brother, was sore hurt; and the Earl of Forfar was so badly wounded,
+that although he was taken prisoner by Mar, they could not carry him to
+Perth, but sent him back to Stirling, where alas! he died next day.
+
+The Master we learned in a later letter (and I beg you will forgive me
+if I confuse the information got at different times), toiled and moiled
+for hours with the cannon, wishing rather to bury them than to leave
+them a gift to the enemy; but eventually he was obliged to abandon most
+of them on the highroad to Ardoch, though some he did get to Perth. He
+lost his way in the darkness, and rode about the moor half the night,
+being indebted at last to the kindness of a gentleman, met by accident,
+who carried him to Urchell where he had a few hours’ sleep.
+
+Lord Panmure, of whose staunch courage I can never say enough, was,
+as I told you, taken prisoner, but being grievously wounded, was left
+in the hut of some peasants, where the good souls tended him kindly.
+He was but slightly guarded, and was soon rescued by his brother, Mr.
+Harry Maule, and taken to a safe place till he was a little recovered,
+when he rejoined the army at Perth.
+
+Indeed and indeed we had grounds enough for mourning, for not only were
+we grieved by all this loss and suffering, but our hearts were heavy
+because we knew not if the sacrifice was to bring its own reward; in
+other words, we had begun to fear that success was not to crown our
+efforts.
+
+“It is not, Barbara,” said my lady to me, “that I think the Cause
+unworthy, but it may be that God in His infinite wisdom has ordained
+that it shall not prosper.”
+
+And in how many minds this bitter doubt was growing up it would be
+difficult to tell, for except in the privacy of our own closets, no
+loyal tongue would give it voice.
+
+But all this time my lady had no word from Sir John, and this, as you
+may imagine, did not ease her burden. Our patient, too, was causing her
+great anxiety, and for many days had been so ill that, by Mr. Peck’s
+orders, no one but himself and one of the women appointed as nurse, was
+allowed to enter his chamber.
+
+The secretary went about with a troubled face, and for a little time we
+feared the worst.
+
+What this meant to me I cannot tell you; but in those days I first
+learned the meaning of patience, not the meek and lifeless resignation
+of the placid mind, but the discipline of soul which forces an outward
+quiet, while the spirit within consumes itself in an agony of waiting.
+Ah! how many times in her life has Barbara had to endure the same
+fear, anxiety, and helpless longing; but at that time her heart was
+fierce and wild, and her nature all unused to pain. I had grasped my
+inheritance of happiness, only to have it wrenched from my hand. I had
+stood and gazed into Heaven, and the door had been shut in my face.
+What wonder that I struggled with indignation and surprise against this
+blow of Fate, and that many secret tears bedewed my pillow?
+
+It was a merciful relief to find very soon my hands and thoughts so
+occupied that my private troubles must be pushed and hidden out of
+sight. You must not imagine that Mr. Fleming was our only patient,
+for in all the great houses round the scene of the battle, kind
+hearts were moved to set up hospitals for the wounded, and you will
+readily believe that Alva was not behind the rest in this work of
+mercy. The men were mostly of the rank and file, for the officers were
+made prisoners; and though on both sides there was much leniency and
+courtesy shown, it was not to be expected in a conflict of this sort
+that gentlemen of influence could be trusted in the houses of their
+friends and sympathisers. A few of the worst cases Lady Erskine caused
+to be brought into the house, but for the most part the men were
+provided with accommodation in the barns and out-houses; and being
+sturdy fellows, not used to lying soft, nor to delicate fare, they
+very quickly responded to the kindness of their rescuers, and were
+speedily healed of their wounds. One or two died, to our great sorrow,
+especially when, as in the case of two of the Highlanders, who had no
+English and could not make known to us more than their names, we were
+unable to learn their wishes or bear any message to their friends.
+
+I must not forget to tell you that outside our little world affairs had
+not been prospering. You will remember that after the battle the Earl
+of Mar drew off slowly to Perth, resting his exhausted army by the way,
+and taking three or four days to perform the journey. But, ere they
+reached the town, tidings were brought to the Earl of Seaforth that
+Inverness had fallen to my Lord the Earl of Sutherland, and he with
+General Gordon hurried north to prevent the victorious Earl from coming
+south to threaten Perth. Another bitter disappointment followed, for
+on Saturday the 19th day of November, my Lord Mar, having reached the
+town, received there a despatch from Brigadier Mackintosh at Preston
+in Lancashire, stating how they had taken that town, and hoped on the
+morrow to march to Manchester. The Earl of Mar gave orders for what
+proved to be premature rejoicings, for he set the bells a-ringing; and
+next day, being Sunday, was made the occasion of a public thanksgiving.
+But alas! in the midst of their jubilation another messenger arrived
+from the same quarter with very sorry tidings to tell, namely: the
+surrender of Preston to General Wills, and the complete collapse of the
+rising in the north of England. Many of our bravest and most important
+leaders were thus taken prisoners and carried to London, among them
+the brave old Mackintosh, Lords Kenmure and Nithsdale, Lord Nairn and
+the Earl of Wintoun, also of Englishmen, the young and popular Earl of
+Derwentwater, my Lord Widdington, and Mr. Thomas Forster, a gentleman
+of Northumberland. I leave you to imagine the effect of this dismal
+news upon the already disaffected army at Perth. It did not take long
+for the tidings to spread, though to us it was first conveyed in a
+letter from the Master of Sinclair to his sister. Following hard upon
+this disaster came rumours of the approach of English regiments from
+across the border, and of the arrival of the Dutch troops on our
+shores, and although these last did not come upon us for some weeks
+yet, the fear of their invasion filled our hearts with terror.
+
+In the midst of all this woe and trouble I can still recall two
+happy events which, oddly enough, fell upon the same day, the 5th of
+December, being just three weeks after the Battle of Sheriffmuir. Very
+early in the morning, my lady, coming to the door to give some order,
+descried in the wan light the figure of a man hurrying along the broad
+walk which gave upon the highroad. He was dressed in the rough garb
+of a common sailor, but his face when he came nearer was clean and
+intelligent, and he doffed his hat with a certain courtesy of manner
+not quite in keeping with the dress.
+
+My lady eyed him keenly, and demanded what she could do for him. He
+replied by taking a packet from his breast and holding it out before
+her eyes, but he did not utter a word. It was a letter addressed to
+herself, and in her husband’s writing. Most gladly did she seize it
+from him, asking eagerly how he had come by it, and a dozen other
+questions in a breath; but the man merely smiled and bowed, making
+signs as though he were dumb. Whether this was so or not, we were never
+able to discover, but all the time he was at Alva (and you may be sure
+he was well-fed and well-paid ere he left), he never spoke, nor made
+the least attempt at communicating with any. He departed as silently
+and mysteriously as he came, and we never, to my knowledge, heard of
+him again.
+
+Howbeit he had brought light and gladness into my lady’s heart and
+relief to the whole household, so that we were better attuned for the
+hearing of further good news in the assurance of Mr. Peck that Captain
+Fleming was now convalescent, and might receive visits from the inmates
+of the house. My lady, it is true, had seen him once or twice during
+the past week; but now she called me, and bidding me take Charles as
+companion, sent me into the sick-room with a cup of coffee for the
+invalid.
+
+Now you must know that ever since we had been escorted home by Mr.
+Fleming and his troopers, our little lads had talked incessantly of
+“Captain Anthony”--how brave he was, how tall; what a great horse he
+rode, and how kind he looked when he smiled. Since our adventure in the
+glen, Charles had enacted the interesting scene many times in his play,
+he, himself, being the wounded soldier, and little Hal taking now the
+part of Cha, running breathless down the dark road, now of Barbara,
+ministering to the unconscious man alone. It was with feelings,
+therefore, of great and awe-struck delight that the boy put his hand
+in mine as I stood before the door of the bed-room, and at my bidding
+knocked. Upon our entering, I was relieved to find the gentleman up and
+sitting in a chair by the hearth. His face was pale and thin, for the
+fever had been high; but his eyes were clear and bright, and he held
+out his hand with a smile.
+
+“Forgive me, Mistress Barbara,” he cried, “that I cannot rise to greet
+you; and accept my best thanks for the kindness of your visit.”
+
+Charles walked up to him and shook him gravely by the hand.
+
+“I am pleased to see you, sir,” he said in his old-fashioned way, “and
+Cousin Barbara and I are very glad that we found you in the glen.”
+
+“Hush, Charles!” cried I. “Remember your mama said you were not to talk
+too much.”
+
+“This is not ‘too much,’ Barbe,” returned the boy, “and you know we
+_are_ glad!”
+
+“Pardon me, madam,” said Mr. Fleming, when he had, at my bidding, drunk
+the coffee. “It will amuse me greatly and do me no harm if you permit
+your little cousin to explain himself. I imagined that I was found by
+some of my Lady Erskine’s men, sent out to look for stragglers in the
+hills.”
+
+I could only smile and give my permission, begging him at the same
+time to make all allowances for the childish narrator. I seated myself
+a little way off, and hoped that the child would say nothing I should
+regret; but at the same time I was not averse to the idea that my
+friend should know to whom, in all probability, he owed his life.
+
+“You see, sir,” said Charles, standing by the chair, and putting his
+little hand on Mr. Fleming’s knee, “my mama had sent my Cousin Barbara
+with some comforts to a poor woman in the glen, and I was sent with her
+as her protector. There was nothing, truly, to protect her from, but
+there might have been, you know! And I was of some use too--of a great
+deal of use, wasn’t I, Barbe? For ’twas I that saw you first, sir,
+under the bush.”
+
+“Yes, indeed,” I said, “your sharp little eyes descried Mr. Fleming
+before mine did.”
+
+“Then Cousin Barbe went and looked at you, and at first she thought you
+were dead, but I knew you weren’t for I saw you breathing. And then
+she said would I be frighted to run back to the house alone for help,
+and I said ‘no;’ but I was, you know, a good deal frighted--’specially
+when the pig grunted, and I thought ’twas a Highlander after me! But I
+runned very fast, and got to the house all safe.”
+
+He stopped for breath, and his listener patted him on the head.
+
+“Bravo, little comrade! That is the true courage, to be a good deal
+frighted but still to go on. And what of Mistress Barbara left alone?”
+
+“Oh,” said Charles, “I think Barbara was frighted too, for you wouldn’t
+wake up; and it was very cold and dark, and she took off her plaid and
+put it over you, and ran all the way back to the hut for brandy, and
+made you, _made_ you take some, and rubbed your hands, and--”
+
+“Come, that will do, my lad!” I exclaimed, my cheeks very hot, my heart
+beating quick, for my friend had turned to look at me, and there was
+that in his eyes which I found it not easy to meet.
+
+“Nay!” cried Charles, carried away by his own tale, “I have but one
+thing more to say. Do you know, Captain Anthony, she did all that, and
+you never--even--said ‘Thank you!’”
+
+At that we both laughed heartily till the boy, not comprehending,
+began to look uncomfortable, and Mr. Fleming, taking his hand, said
+seriously.
+
+“You must forgive me, Charles, as I can only hope your cousin does.
+But to make up for my rudeness, I mean to go on thanking her all my
+life--if she will let me!”
+
+The last words were uttered in a lower tone, and his eyes were again
+fixed on my face. Charles ran off to the window, some noise outside
+attracting him, and I took the opportunity to say as carelessly as I
+might,
+
+“You make too much, sir, of a trivial kindness, which any woman would
+have performed for a wounded man.”
+
+“No doubt, madam,” he answered gravely, leaning forward in his chair,
+“but that cannot lessen my gratitude, for my life is incomparably sweet
+and precious to me now. You gave it back to me, and were it not too
+early in our acquaintance, I would say I herewith offer it to you--nay,
+listen, madam! Ever since that first morning when I saw you, with your
+sweet face pale with terror, and your eyes appealing to any chivalry
+that was left in man, my one thought, outside my duty as a soldier, has
+been to be worthy to care for and protect you all through life, so that
+if my faithful love could shield you, you should never suffer fear or
+pain again.”
+
+I made no answer and my eyes were hid. “This, I know, is not the time
+to talk of such things,” he went on, “neither do I expect a prize so
+exquisite to fall into my hand at the first touch. Grant me but time,
+madam, to prove my honesty in the words of the motto of our house,
+‘_Let deed show_,’ and if Heaven be so kind as to preserve me in future
+dangers, give me leave to come to you again.”
+
+Did ever maid listen to such perfect wooing! Ah! Barbara, happy
+Barbara, did not that hour atone for all your pain? Even as I write,
+an old and faded woman, my heart gives a throb of bliss when I think
+of it. How good God is, how tender and loving, when He grants us, all
+undeserving as we are, our heart’s desire!
+
+I said not a word in answer, but rose and went to him and gave him both
+my hands. As he seized them and pressed them to his lips, a footstep
+sounded in the passage, and the next moment Mr. Peck entered, telling
+us in his kindly nervous way that he thought his patient would be the
+better of a rest.
+
+“Ah! Mr. Peck,” cried my dear Anthony gaily, “their visit has done
+me more good than all your medicines, though but for your kind and
+constant care, good friend, I should never have been able to profit by
+it.”
+
+Charles now came forward and looked at him inquisitively.
+
+“Are you going to be well very soon, Captain Anthony?” he said.
+
+“I hope so, little comrade,” was the reply. “You know there is much
+work to be done still for the King.”
+
+“Ay,” said Charles, “but I shall be sorry when you go away. My papa,
+Sir John, says in his letter that the King is coming to Scotland in a
+few days.”
+
+“God grant he be not too late!” groaned Mr. Peck, but we did not heed
+him, and taking a kindly leave of our friend we left the room.
+
+Four days later, my lady had the pleasure of another letter from Sir
+John, and wrote to him the following in reply. And here I may say that
+the fears she had expressed to me about their correspondence were
+justified, for this tender but cautious epistle missed Sir John at this
+time, and lay for two months at St. Germains, where he found it on the
+15th of February on his second visit to France.
+
+
+LETTER III
+
+ “MY DEAREST LIFE,
+
+ I received yours of the 20th and another of the
+ 29th of Nov., which were both most acceptable, but they had both
+ been long by the way, for it was the 5 of Dec. before I received the
+ first. You are much mistaken in thinking I was displeas’d with you
+ for leaveing this country. I doe assure you I thought it a lucky
+ providence, and, tho I was in fear from not hearing from you, yett
+ it was easy to bear in comparison of what terror I must have had if
+ you had been in the danger some other of our freinds have been in. I
+ suppose you know all our difficultys from better hands long ere now,
+ and by that you may guess the torment and fear and terrible horror I
+ must be in for you and many others. If I had known your adress I had
+ writ to you three weeks ago and beg’d of you to stay where you was
+ till you saw how things would be. I writ to your Brother in hopes he
+ would learn itt from some att Edinr., but he told me he could not,
+ and you was soon expected, and I was so far from wishing you soon
+ back, I was afraid to hear of your return. I pray God send a happy
+ end to all, for I am just where I was and my hops are still very
+ faint, that person you mention in yours not being come yett. Your
+ children are very well, and all your other friends. I doe not wish to
+ hear you are returned, but when you doe, pray God you may be saffe,
+ which is the earnest wish of her who is intirely
+ Yours.
+
+ Dec. 10.
+
+ I am better than could be expected, all things considered. If you can
+ have any reasonable pretence to stay, doe not come by any means. Mr.
+ Peck gives you his most humble service, so does Aunt B. and I.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX
+
+MR. FLEMING RIDES AWAY FROM ALVA. THE KING LANDS, AND SIR JOHN RETURNS
+TO SCOTLAND NOT QUITE IN THE MANNER HE INTENDED
+
+
+On the evening of the day upon which we had visited Captain Anthony,
+Mr. Peck, with an anxious face, sought my Lady Erskine (but this
+unknown to me), and told her that he was troubled about his patient as
+the fever was again high, and perceiving, as he thought, that there was
+something on his mind to disturb him, his kind attendant had offered to
+bring my lady to him in order that he might confide in her.
+
+Going at once to his chamber, my lady begged to know if she could help
+him, upon which Mr. Fleming, as he told me after, with many misgivings
+and humble requests for forgiveness, made confession of what had passed
+between us that afternoon.
+
+He told her how from the first hour he saw Barbara Stewart her image
+had remained in his mind, although he had never dreamed of betraying
+his feelings thus early in their friendship. But gladdened by her dear
+presence, touched and surprised on learning of all she had done for him
+in the glen, perhaps a little weakened by his illness, he had allowed
+himself to speak.
+
+“Scarcely had she left the room, madam,” he said, “when my heart
+misgave me sorely, for it seemed to me I had abused your hospitality,
+and taken advantage of Mistress Barbara’s innocence and youth; but
+I fear I repent too late. Tell me if in any way I can repair my
+indiscretion.”
+
+My lady sat silent some time and then asked, “And what said Barbara?”
+
+“Madam,” he cried earnestly, “she said not a word. But she put her
+little soft hands in mine, and looked at me out of her dark eyes with
+a look so deep and tender that for some moments I lost myself in the
+bliss of it, and forgot that she remained silent.”
+
+My lady sighed and smiled together.
+
+“Ah, dear heart!” she cried, “how well I remember!” And although he
+knew not what she meant, I know she was thinking of her own young days
+and the moment when Sir John first told her that he loved her.
+
+After a little she went on.
+
+“I am grieved that this should have happened at such a time. In a few
+days at most you must leave us, and what is before you, who can tell?
+My mind misgives me when I try to read the future, for after all, Mr.
+Fleming, wounds and death are not the only evils we have to fear.
+Barbara is so young--if you could have waited a while. However, there
+is no sense in crying over spilt milk, as the saying is, and what is
+done is done. Can I trust you, sir, to leave it where it is? I love
+the child as dearly as if she were my own sister,” (so my dear lady
+was kind enough to say) “and you may trust me to be tender with her;
+but it is not fitting there should be any formal contract between you.
+There is much to be considered, and the times are uncertain. You will
+not, therefore, see Mistress Stewart again except in my presence, but
+you take with you my fervent wishes for your health and happiness and a
+glad return.”
+
+Whatever Mr. Fleming’s desires might have been, he was forced to
+acknowledge my lady’s authority and bow to her decision in the matter.
+Nay, he could not but approve of the wisdom of her words, and the
+kindness of her interest in the motherless girl he loved. So, greatly
+comforted, and relieved of the burden of guilt that had oppressed him,
+he fell into a sound sleep, and awaked upon the morrow much refreshed
+and strengthened.
+
+To me, still lost in the wonder of my golden dream, and feeling
+strangely detached from the things of earth, my lady’s words were few.
+She touched lightly upon her knowledge of the position, and bade me not
+fear to confide in her, either now or at a future time, for, whatever
+happened, her love and sympathy were with me.
+
+“But,” she added, “you are scarce more than a child, Barbara, and
+know not your powers and capacity. You may be greatly taken with our
+friend, to whom I am also much attracted; but time alone will prove
+the strength of your attachment, and I will not have you tied and
+bound by the whim of a passing mood, engendered by the most romantic
+circumstances, to what you might regret for your whole life.”
+
+With that she kissed me and sent me about some household task; but
+during the next few days I saw little of Captain Anthony, and that only
+with others in the room.
+
+By the end of the week he pronounced himself fit for travel, and late
+one evening he presented himself before us, booted and spurred and
+ready for the road. The children, who had grown to love their hero
+dearly, were much distressed to lose him, and little Hal broke down and
+cried, clinging to his hand on one side and to mine on the other. My
+lady, with kindly tact, busied herself at the far end of the room, and
+but for the child we were alone.
+
+“A token, Mistress Barbara,” whispered my lover imploringly. “Give me
+something of your own to keep by me--not as a remembrance, for that
+I shall not need, but as a pledge that you will be glad to see me
+returned.”
+
+I tore a knot of red ribbon from my dress and pressed it into his hand,
+which closed upon mine as he took it. The tears were very near my eyes,
+and I longed to shed them openly like little Harry. But time pressed,
+and my lady came forward to bid our guest farewell.
+
+“God keep you, my beloved!” he murmured.
+
+“And keep you too--for me!” I whispered back with trembling lips;
+and any woman who has seen the man she loved ride out to war, will
+understand what my thoughts were as I said it.
+
+A few minutes later we were all assembled at the door. Charles stood
+outside in the frosty night, holding the stirrup, and struggling
+manfully with his grief which he judged it childish to show. Mr. Peck
+was giving a last look to the horse, which a few days back he had
+purchased for the traveller. My lady handed him a packet to bear to
+her brother, the Master, and pressed him again and again to be careful
+of his health. I stood with little Hal in my arms, and watched the
+scene as in a dream. Allan, the shepherd, who was to run by his side
+and show him the short cuts through the hills, now came forward, saying
+that it was time to start; and the next thing I remember is the sight
+of Captain Anthony in the saddle, his hat in his hand, a smile on his
+face, and a look in his eyes that I never forgot. A moment after he
+rode out of the court-yard, and the darkness swallowed him up.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+I take blame to myself that I have writ so much about my private
+affairs, which cannot be of the same interest to you as to myself, but
+you must of your kindness forgive me, for it would truly have been
+impossible for me to tell the story of that sorrowful winter, without
+some particulars of this portion of my own history.
+
+After our guest’s departure the days grew darker and darker, for the
+tidings that came to us seemed to crush our hopes rather than raise
+them up. My lady wrote to Betty, bidding her come if possible to
+Alva to spend Christmas with us, but she sent back word that she was
+occupied at the sick-bed of her young friend, David, eldest son to
+their neighbour, the Earl of Wemyss, for the hapless youth was ill of
+a fever, and his father was absent in London. A few days later came
+the news of the young gentleman’s death, over which my lady grieved
+with heart-felt sorrow, for, from a charming child, he had grown into a
+bright and promising lad, and his early death at the age of sixteen was
+deplored by all who knew him.
+
+Very ill news came also from Perth, and no comfort was to be had from
+France. The big men in the Earl of Mar’s army were so busy quarrelling
+among themselves, that they seemed to have lost sight altogether
+of the Cause that had brought them together; and not the least of
+the trouble, to my lady’s mind, lay in the fact that the Master of
+Sinclair was at the head and front of the dissensions. Indeed she was
+sick at heart when she heard of her brother’s conduct, for you may be
+sure that rumour did not fail to make the worst of it. It has always
+seemed to me that the Master, a man of strong character, and doubtless
+with an attractiveness of his own, might have influenced his friends
+to better issues, but instead of attempting the rôle of peace-maker,
+he did everything in his power to stir up strife. So many of the
+Fife gentlemen joined him, among them Sir James Kinloch, Sir Robert
+Gordon, Major Balfour, Mr. Ogilvie, and Mr. Smith of Methven, that
+they formed themselves into what was called the “Grumbling Club,” of
+which the Master of Sinclair was President. Their business was to find
+fault with everything that was done by my Lord Mar, to discourage the
+troops, to foretell disaster, and even privately, it was said, to open
+negotiations with the Duke of Argyle, with a view to capitulation.
+This last failed, for the letter written by the Master to the Duke was
+intercepted and brought to the Earl of Mar--an incident which, you may
+be sure, did not increase the love and confidence between these two.
+But later on, when the grumbling and the clamour grew louder, they went
+to their leader, and boldly demanded that he should carry out their
+design. This my lord, having news of the King’s coming, refused to do,
+and bade the grumblers have patience among themselves for a little
+longer. Indeed, I believe the poor gentleman was at his wit’s end what
+to do, not having the strength or capacity necessary to control his
+turbulent company.
+
+So ill did the Master behave that my Lord Sinclair, his father, having
+wind of the matter, writ him a very sharp letter, chiding him for his
+conduct and demanding an explanation; and when his son departed from
+Perth, in answer to this summons, ’tis said the grumbling ceased, but
+immediately upon his return it broke out again worse than ever. It
+appears that when at home he took solemn leave of his friends, making
+no secret of the fact that he expected nothing but defeat, and had no
+expectation of returning in triumph to Dysart.
+
+The Marquis of Huntly, who had never been very eager for the Cause,
+was “led by the nose” by this singular man, and seemed only too
+ready to enter into all his schemes. And although the Master told us
+proudly that Dr. Abercrombie, who had just returned from France, had
+brought him a personal message from the Queen, in which she thanked
+him for his services in seizing the ship at Burntisland, and promised
+that when she and her family could, she would not forget to show him
+favour, his heart remained untouched, and he made up his mind, coldly
+and deliberately, to desert the Cause. Granted that he believed it
+hopeless, that he disapproved the methods of his superiors, that he had
+come to the conclusion that the whole affair was a sad mistake, still
+his behaviour could not but alienate all loyal and honest men.
+
+The Duke of Argyle in the meantime, though the state of the roads
+kept him inactive at Stirling, for there was a prodigious deal of
+snow on the ground, did not altogether neglect his opportunities; for
+to our great distress we learned that he had bombarded and occupied
+Burntisland, and some of the Dutch troops having arrived he very soon
+had all the seaports of Fife in his hands. As most of the coal-pits lie
+in that district this was a serious loss, and added to the hardships of
+an already rigorous winter. The foreign soldiers over-ran the place,
+and food grew scarcer and dearer. Further north it was even worse; in
+the counties of Perth and Inverness, it was said, where the frost had
+stopped the working of the mills, there was scarcely a grain of meal to
+be had.
+
+In the midst of all this misery it is not to be supposed that we
+could eat our Christmas Goose with merry hearts, but sometime in the
+beginning of January a packet arrived for my lady, which in spite of
+everything could not fail to cheer us. It had been brought to Leith by
+ship, and sent forward by a safe hand, so that it had not been long
+delayed upon the road. It was a letter from her husband telling her
+that the King had sailed for Scotland at last.
+
+There had been many difficulties and hindrances placed in his way
+both by friends and enemies, the former being fearful for his safety,
+the latter desiring to intercept him. But after much delay, and being
+exposed to many hardships, he being obliged to travel the open roads
+on horse-back, and even to disguise himself in some of the towns, his
+Majesty embarked at Dunkirk in a small ship with a few attendants,
+and must by this time, Sir John opined, have landed in Scotland. For
+himself he was waiting at Calais, detained by stress of weather, and by
+fear of the English men-of-war, which filled the channel. He had, he
+said, on board, much precious material, including “two valuable young
+men,” and he designed to land upon the east coast somewhat north of the
+Forth to avoid the risk of cruisers in the Firth. He prayed my lady, if
+she could by any means find it convenient, to meet him at Dysart, where
+he said, it would be easier for him to come than to Alva, and she would
+be well advised to leave home immediately upon receiving his letter, as
+he hoped his arrival should not be much behind it.
+
+He went on to say that the winter, which he heard was severe in
+Scotland, was equally so on the Continent. In country places in France
+and in the north of Spain, the wolves and bears, made bold by hunger,
+were prowling round the villages and towns, and some of the poor
+peasants had died of starvation, being unable to come through the snow
+to the market-towns for food. He ended by saluting his household kindly
+each by name, and sending merry messages to his little sons.
+
+Now all again was bustle and excitement in the house, for waiting and
+uncertainty are the hardest things on earth to bear, and the hopeful
+tone of Sir John’s letter, as well as the good news it contained,
+seemed to put a different complexion on our affairs. Now it was
+possible to hold up our heads, to look forward, to plan, to be joyful,
+and as, for my lady, any disaster were easier to bear than separation
+from her husband, she made ready with all haste to go to her father’s
+house as he had ordered. It was not so pleasant to me to be left behind
+with Aunt Betty and the children, but as my lady made no proposal of
+carrying me with her, I must needs make the best of the situation. I
+begged of her to be very prompt and regular in writing to inform us of
+anything that took place, and promising on my part to keep her informed
+of all that happened with us, we bade her adieu, and watched her
+depart, accompanied by the faithful Andrew, with very mingled feelings.
+
+Before we had any news from Dysart, however, we heard through another
+source some very dismal tidings, which threw Aunt Betty into a state of
+great affliction, and brought my own spirits pretty low. Sir John, we
+heard, had indeed arrived on Scottish shores, but in a most untoward
+manner, for his ship had been wrecked not far from Dundee, and all the
+treasure and arms he was bringing were lost in the sea. Further, the
+messenger was not certain whether Sir John and his crew were alive or
+dead, and the consternation into which we were thrown for some hours
+was very great. Next day, however, came letters from my lady which went
+far to mitigate our grief. Sir John and all his companions were safe,
+and though much of the ammunition had been destroyed, for the ship was
+broke to pieces, the gold which he was bringing was safe. It was still
+in the hulk which lay on the sandbank where she stranded, and they had
+great hopes, if they could avoid the vigilance of the enemy, of getting
+all off.
+
+Sir John’s fellow-travellers, the “two valuable young men” he had
+mentioned, turned out to be the Marquis of Tynemouth (or Tinmouth),
+son to the Duke of Berwick, and therefore nephew to the King, and my
+Lord Talbot, an Irish peer. “The former,” wrote my lady, “is said
+by Sir John to be a very worthy young gentleman, and will recommend
+himself to all persons of merit.” As for herself, she was so thankful
+to Providence for preserving her husband’s life, that she had scarce
+time to mourn over his disaster, which nevertheless was a serious one.
+She told us that the King had arrived at Peterhead some weeks back, but
+promised to gather all news of the proceedings in the north from Sir
+John, and bring it home to Alva, whither she designed returning as soon
+after meeting with her husband as possible. Betty, she told us, had
+been very dumpish and melancholy all winter, being in great trouble and
+anxiety about the King’s affairs, and much exercised over the behaviour
+of her brother. She was now more cheerful, however, and would accompany
+her sister to Alva on her return, which she did some days later, when
+we welcomed them both, you may be sure, with great delight.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXI
+
+TELLS OF THE COMING OF THE KING TO PERTH, AND WHAT ENSUED THEREAFTER
+
+
+It will be well for me now to give you shortly some account of the
+proceedings at Perth, which I learned from Mr. Fleming’s own lips some
+time after, though it would, I know, be easy for you to gather the
+facts from the history-books written about that period. And because
+I fear I am becoming tedious in my narrative, I will pass over many
+details and give you the bare outline of what took place, in order to
+carry on the story of my dear friends at Alva in a way that you will
+understand.
+
+When Captain Anthony Fleming, upon his return to Perth, sought out the
+Master of Sinclair in order to deliver to him my lady’s letter, and
+give him news of the family, he found to his dismay that he was gone.
+Seaforth, as we know, had hurried north after Sheriffmuir, and, as was
+the custom of the Highlanders after a battle, many of them had returned
+home. Now my Lord of Huntly was gone to save his estates from the
+Earl of Sutherland, and to get back the town of Inverness, so it was
+said; but we know that nobleman had decided to play his cards another
+way, for he made a truce with my Lord Sutherland, and later sent in
+his submission to Argyle, asking for pardon or protection from the
+Government. The Master of Sinclair, shortly after he left, had followed
+him, saying as his excuse that “having given so much umbrage to certain
+people in Perth, he could be of no more use to the Cause, which now
+was not only desperate, but sunk.” And so he deserted the foundering
+ship, thinking most of his own danger and the necessity of saving his
+precious skin. Mr. Fleming, like all other loyal gentlemen, had his own
+opinion of such conduct, but though bitterly disappointed in the man
+who had ever been friendly to him, and to whom he felt he owed so much,
+he refrained from commenting upon it till long years after.
+
+In the midst of so much that was discouraging, an express one day
+arrived with the joyful news that the King was at hand, for a ship
+had appeared in the offing about the Height of Montrose, which had
+made _the signals_, viz., the raising and lowering of a white flag on
+the topmasthead, and, being answered from the shore, had passed on
+northwards. At once the Earl of Mar began his preparations for going
+to receive his Majesty, and great joy ran through the entire community
+from the highest officers to the common soldiers, for all were weary
+of the delay, and looked forward to large reinforcements, and a speedy
+meeting with the enemy. A few days later a young gentleman, Lieutenant
+Cameron by name, who had accompanied the King from France, rode into
+Perth with the acceptable tidings that our long-looked for Sovereign
+had landed at Peterhead, and was awaiting an interview with the Earl
+of Mar and his companions. By great good fortune my lord commanded Mr.
+Fleming to ride with him in the capacity of Captain of his Guard of
+Horse, and the same day he, with my Lord Marischal, General Hamilton,
+and about thirty other gentlemen of quality, set out to go and attend
+him. The King, having lodged one night at Peterhead, and another at
+Newburgh House, had passed _incognito_ through Aberdeen, and was now at
+Fetteresso, the principal seat of my Lord Marischal, and thither the
+party from Perth hastened, full of ardour and loyalty. I will give you
+Mr. Fleming’s own words as to his impressions upon first beholding his
+Majesty.
+
+“After having received the Earls of Mar and Marischal and the other
+noblemen within the castle, and conversed with them for some time, his
+Majesty expressed a desire to inspect the soldiers of the guard, who
+were drawn up in front of the house. You may imagine that, on being
+hurriedly prepared for this honour by General Hamilton, we sat our
+horses in great excitement, only restrained by discipline. For my own
+part my heart beat high in my bosom, and all the loyal and chivalrous
+sentiments that had been nurtured in my mind from childhood rose up
+to welcome my rightful and much injured King. When he appeared at the
+door, looking pale and young and very weary, there came into my throat
+something that caught my breath--a spasm of love and yearning that the
+sight of no other man on earth could possibly bring--and at the moment
+when I brought my sword to the salute I knew I would gladly lay down my
+life for King James. A few minutes after I heard the voice of my Lord
+Mar loudly proclaiming him at the gate of the house, and, following
+my impulse, I waved my sword above my head, and shouted with all my
+strength, ‘God save the King!’--a shout in which both my soldiers and
+all others present willingly joined. His Majesty bowed, and a faint
+smile came to his lips, but oddly enough, and quite beyond my own
+volition, I found myself, as I watched him, repeating some dreary
+words, ‘_A stranger in a strange land_!’ He did not look glad to be
+among us; there was no response in his eyes to the welcome we gave him.
+He came to his own, and though they received him joyfully, it was as
+though he knew them not.”
+
+Was this, I have often wondered, the reason of it all--of the
+disappointment, the disillusion, the tragedy of his coming? My heart
+aches still to think of it. He was worn out with hardships and anxiety
+(those who knew what his life had been for the last three months know
+that), the weather was bitterly cold, his country--our country--lay in
+the inhospitable grasp of winter, and he had a price set upon his head.
+He felt ill in body, for on the next day he was taken with an aguish
+distemper which kept him from moving for several days, and uneasy in
+mind, for already he had doubts of the wisdom of his undertaking. We
+know that he was not born “under a dancing star” as Mr. Shakespeare’s
+“Beatrice” hath it, and for that reason much is to be forgiven him;
+but oh! we in Scotland need to be melted by a merry smile, or a kindly
+word, or a genial manner, or we may be taken by storm by something
+more forcible than these; but let our coldness be met by coldness,
+our shyness by a greater shyness, or our enthusiasm by indifference,
+then the icy crust that covers our fire grows harder and harder, and
+the dour pride that oft makes the Scot a trouble to himself, as well
+as to others, forbids the breaking down of the barrier for ever. He
+lacked something, our poor King, that vital something which his uncle,
+King Charles II., and, as I understand, his son Prince Charles Edward
+(neither of them so just or so virtuous as himself), possessed to the
+full--the power to draw all hearts to him, to persuade the reluctant,
+to confirm the wavering, to inspire the doubtful with confidence--the
+personal human charm, without which no leader of men can achieve great
+things.
+
+Upon the recovery of his Majesty, he and his attendants came south by
+slow degrees to Brechin, to Kinnaird, to Glamis, and then to Dundee.
+At this place he was received with great enthusiasm by the populace,
+and sat for about an hour on horseback in the market-place, while the
+eager people flocked to kiss his hand. From Dundee he went to Fingask,
+the seat of Sir David Threipland, where he lay that Saturday night, and
+next day being Sunday he arrived at Scone, within two miles of Perth.
+
+Now, if the joy had been great at the news of the safe arrival of the
+King, with whom you must remember it was supposed were thousands of
+troops and much treasure, the disappointment and chagrin on learning
+that he came almost alone were great in proportion. And when it was
+discovered that neither he nor the Earl of Mar were moving actively
+in the matter of defending the town, or taking steps to meet the
+enemy, much discontent arose, and the whole place was in a state of
+dissatisfaction. My Lord Mar attempted to pacify them by spreading a
+fresh report of help coming from France; the presence of the young
+Lord Tinmouth, the Duke of Berwick’s son, was pointed to as a proof
+that the Regent was now inclined to the Cause; General Hamilton was
+again in Paris urging our necessity, and the Duke of Argyle’s men
+were wavering and deserting, it was said, day by day. The weather and
+the state of the roads were also given as a reason for inaction, and
+there was much talk of the coming Coronation at Scone. But all this
+availed little, and when it transpired on the arrival of one of our
+spies from Stirling, that Argyle was reconnoitring the roads, and
+making preparations for having them cleared of the snow, with a view
+to laying siege to Perth, the excitement rose to fever-heat while
+the dissatisfaction gave place to joy. Was it conceivable that they
+should remain, they said, to be slaughtered like badgers in their holes
+without making a fight for it? No, it was impossible; they could remain
+no longer inactive, and at once preparations were begun for defending
+the town, planting guns, digging trenches, throwing up breast-works and
+the like, which gave the impatient people something to occupy their
+thoughts, though, as you know, the work was quite ineffectual, for
+the town would have been very easily taken had the Government troops
+advanced upon it.
+
+And now comes one of the saddest incidents in all this sad history;
+an instance of the cruelty of war upon the innocent, who must often
+suffer, though guiltless of either crime or provocation. I know not in
+whose brain the unhappy thought first had birth, and indeed, as Sir
+Anthony now tells me, the idea itself, from a strategic point of view,
+was not altogether a mistake. But to us it came as a shock so grievous
+that for a long time we could scarce bear to talk of it, and in that
+way, perhaps, we did both the thought and the action injustice.
+
+Upon a second attempt of the Duke of Argyle to view the roads from
+Dunblane to Auchterarder, which he made accompanied by General Cadogan,
+who we heard had been sent down from London for the very purpose of
+hastening the Duke’s movements, the leaders at Perth became so alarmed,
+having thought themselves secure while the severe weather lasted, that
+an order was given out, signed alas! by the King, for the burning of
+the villages of Auchterarder, Crieff, Blackford, Dunning and Muthill,
+with all corn and forage which could not be carried off, so as to lay
+waste the country between Stirling and Perth, in order to embarrass the
+Government troops.
+
+Now to my mind, and to many others at the time, this cruel order was
+resultant of nothing but misery to those who had no right to suffer,
+for although it gave to Argyle’s men the inconvenience and discomfort
+of camping for two nights on the bare ground, it neither detained them
+in their progress, nor disordered their arrangements, seeing that on
+so short a march ’twas possible to carry both forage and vivers with
+them. We know that the King was most reluctant to sign the order, and
+that two days after he writ a letter to the Duke, begging him to employ
+a certain sum of money to be paid out of his own scant treasury, for
+compensating the unfortunate people so harshly deprived of their homes.
+The letter was, I am told, suppressed, but of the King’s regret and
+of his kind intentions I have never entertained the slightest doubt.
+Indeed, the Earl of Mar let it be widely known that his Majesty wished
+it given out, that if any of the poor folk pleased to come to Perth,
+they should be maintained and all care taken of them. Howbeit the deed
+was done, and many a long day would pass ere the memory of it should
+die away.
+
+And now in Perth the Council sat all night deliberating what should
+be done, and messengers were posting constantly between that place
+and Scone, for the great men could not come to an agreement. On one
+side was the military party, who, knowing the minds of the soldiers
+on the matter, were all for fighting and that at once. On the other
+side were the Earl of Mar and some of his friends, who said they were
+not willing thus to risk the safety of the King. It was suggested to
+the latter that the King’s presence was not necessary in a battle, and
+that if he were placed in security, his faithful adherents would prove
+their loyalty by fighting for him to the death. They were ready, they
+said, to die for him; but not to turn their backs like scoundrels and
+poltroons without striking a blow for him who had come so far to trust
+his person and his fortunes in their hands. Words ran high, and some
+of the Highlanders _ruffled_ the great men in the open streets, and
+told them in plain terms that they were betraying the King rather than
+helping him. One who was thus accosted, a friend of my Lord Mar’s,
+stopped to answer them, and Mr. Fleming heard this conversation pass
+between them.
+
+“Why, what would you have us do?” said the gentleman. “Do!” says the
+other. “What did you call us to arms for? Was it to run away? What did
+the King come hither for? Was it to see his people butchered by the
+hangman, and not strike a stroke for their lives? Let us die like men
+and not like dogs!” “What can we do?” cries the nobleman to these brave
+words. “Let us,” says the Highlander, “have a council of war, and let
+all the General Officers speak their minds freely, the King himself
+being present, and if it be agreed there not to fight, we must submit.”
+
+Some went further than this, for one bold chief threatened them,
+that the loyal clans would take the King from them, and then if he
+were willing to die like a Prince he should find that there were ten
+thousand gentlemen in Scotland who were not afraid to die with him.
+
+As some said one thing and some another, the tumult and disorder
+increased, till at last some of the wiser among the officers quieted
+the soldiers by assuring them there would be a council held that night,
+that the King begged them as his good friends to abide by what was then
+decided, as he was resolved himself to do: either to put it to the
+hazard and take his fate with them, or if otherwise advised to abide by
+that.
+
+Accordingly, the Grand Council met, and much was said on this side
+and much on that, but from what I was told by Mr. Fleming, it seemed
+that all the talk was only for show, for the meeting was adjourned
+without any decision having been come to. Next morning, however, a
+select number having been called together, the Earl of Mar confided to
+them in secret, that owing to many circumstances which he considered
+it inconvenient to divulge, he found it advisable not only to beat a
+retreat from Perth, but to put an end to their design for the time
+being. ’Twas whispered, he said, that there were traitors in the camp,
+men of high standing, who were already conspiring to seize upon the
+person of the King and deliver him up to the Duke of Argyle. It was
+almost incredible, said the Earl, that such a thing could be; but with
+a free pardon and £100,000, even an honest Scotsman might be tempted.
+Finally, as the Duke was now within a few miles of Perth, it was
+absolutely necessary that we should evacuate the town.
+
+After this, said my informant, there was nothing more left but to
+acquiesce in the decision, though by many it was done with a very bad
+grace. That the King himself was sorely grieved, I make no doubt, and
+it was with a heavy heart, I trow, that he consented to leave Scone,
+and to follow his army across the Tay. That river being frozen hard
+they were able, horse and foot, to pass over as if upon dry land, and
+quickly as they had acted they were but just in time, for, expresses
+having carried the news of the retreat to the enemy, a body of dragoons
+entered the town the very next day. To the majority of our officers
+no further instructions had been issued than that the army was to
+retire upon Aberdeen, so that what followed after came upon them as a
+cruel surprise, and by many of them, I feel sure, ’twas never either
+understood or forgiven.
+
+And now, if you please, I must leave Head-quarters, and return to Alva
+to let you know how things were going there.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXII
+
+HOW WE HEAR TIDINGS THAT MAKE OUR HEARTS ACHE, AND ILL PREPARE US FOR
+THE GREAT SURPRISE
+
+
+The short afternoon was closing in. The snow was falling steadily and
+soft, for there was no wind and the frost still held. We sat at work in
+the hall, being gathered there for warmth, for in this hard winter when
+so many poor were abroad, my lady thought shame to burn coal freely,
+choosing rather to give it away to her poorer neighbours, who, you may
+be sure, blessed her for the thought. She had bidden us bring our work
+and sit by her as she span, for she knew how restless and unhappy we
+were, and hoped perhaps to ease her own burdened heart by friendly and
+intimate talk.
+
+We had that day had news which moved my lady sadly. For General
+Cadogan, who shortly before had arrived at Stirling, having been sent
+from the Court in London to urge the Duke of Argyle to immediate
+action, had brought with him an order to deprive Colonel Erskine of
+the Command of the Castle, and to send him, together with his son,
+John, under a Guard to London, where he was to be lodged in the Fleet
+prison. The thought of the poor old gentleman being made to suffer the
+hardships of the long journey in this cruel winter weather, was very
+bitter to us all, and to be obliged to sit helpless and do nothing but
+talk, was, as Betty cried impatiently, the worst of it.
+
+“I am convinced,” my lady said, again and again, “that nothing can be
+found against them save their relationship to Sir John, and my Lord
+Mar’s friendship for the Colonel, and that, as you know, has lasted
+many years and is quite unconnected with this affair. ’Twould be
+unreasonable indeed to think it.”
+
+“Oh, sister,” cried Betty vehemently, “do you think those fools have
+any reason? If they had, would they not know that it is _they_ who are
+in the wrong, and stop all this cruel opposition? But for poor Colonel
+Erskine I agree with all you say, and I must own I hope the good
+gentleman may be treated with all the care and respect he deserves.”
+
+“’Tis done to spite the Earl of Mar,” said my lady, “you may be sure.
+The Governorship has been in his family for hundreds of years, and my
+uncle holds it for him as his Lieutenant. I am not so blind as not to
+see they are in the right to make a change at such a time, but ’tis
+neither kind nor just to send a harmless old man to prison at such a
+distance, in weather like this.”
+
+“Who will take his place, madam, think you?” asked I.
+
+“’Tis an open secret that the Government will offer it to Lord Rothes,”
+said Betty. “That has long been talked in Fife.”
+
+“Well,” said my lady, “he is a humane and generous enemy; we have
+little to fear from him. If only they had confined the Colonel in
+Blackness or Edinburgh Castle, and saved him the horrors of that long
+journey to London.”
+
+And again the tears came to her eyes, for there was a tender friendship
+between these two, and my lady would have guarded the old man with a
+daughter’s care.
+
+There was nothing to say to comfort her, and we sat silent, weaving our
+sad thoughts into our work as women will, for each of us had, as you
+know, our private weight of woe. My own heart was away with the King’s
+army, wondering and pondering over the welfare of one of his least
+important officers; poor Betty, I knew, was following her brother in
+his ignominious flight, and my dear lady, besides her other troubles,
+had ever the fear for Sir John’s safety upon her mind.
+
+It was while we were sitting thus, wrapped in gloom, that a messenger
+arrived with news for my lady. With a sigh she bade him enter, fearing
+that, like Job, she was about to hear of disaster upon disaster. And
+so, indeed, it proved. This man was come to tell us how his Grace of
+Argyle had set the country people to work, to the number of about two
+thousand, to clear the roads of the snow, so as to make it possible
+for his army to march to Perth; and scarcely was he finished speaking
+when there arrived one of our neighbours, Mr. Abercrombie of Tullibody
+I think it was, who broke to us the awful news of the burning of the
+villages. I will not shock you now by describing the way in which the
+deed was done, for officers, I suppose, are not wholly responsible
+for the actions of the soldiery, and sure I am that those who gave
+the order had no thought of thieving, or plundering from the poor
+people, whom they believed themselves obliged to render homeless; but
+neither was it necessary to take them by surprise at four o’clock in
+the morning, and turn them out of their beds in scant attire in the
+bitter cold. Long before Mr. Abercrombie, himself much moved, had come
+to an end of his recital, we sat horrified and with streaming eyes
+around him, seeing as he spoke the women with their infants, the feeble
+old men, the tottering children, hungry and naked, driven ruthlessly
+through the snow.
+
+“And who dare issue an order so monstrous?” cried Betty at last, being
+ever the first to find her tongue. “Who among our people could invent
+so diabolical a measure?”
+
+“Ah, madam,” said our guest sadly, “all is fair in war ’tis said, and
+if we can embarrass the enemy we think little of the means taken to do
+so. The order was signed by the Chevalier himself, as was necessary, he
+being at the head of his army.”
+
+“I’ll not believe it!” cried Betty. “He is a humane and gentle prince.
+I’ll never believe he understood what he wished them to do.”
+
+“Why, Bess, my dear,” said my lady, “’twas sure not by his good will
+’twas done; but can you not see that if his General Officers advised
+it, the King must put his name to the order?”
+
+“Ay, sister,” wailed Betty, “and can _you_ not see the folly of it,
+even apart from the cruelty? I say that they have betrayed their King.
+Who will believe in the reluctance of his Majesty? Who will ever know
+anything of it? Whatever happens now, this deed that has been done
+in his name will cling to the memory of the people. Whenever he is
+mentioned their hearts will burn within them at the thought of it.
+Never, never will they do him justice, but will remember him only as
+the cause of their misery and ruin for ever.”
+
+My lady bowed her head sadly, and I wept the more, for Betty’s burning
+words fell upon our ears like a solemn prophecy, and we knew that her
+words were true. ’Twas indeed a miserable and mistaken act, long, long
+to be rued among us.
+
+“I hear,” said Mr. Abercrombie, “that the barony of Dalreoch, belonging
+to Mr. Haldane of Gleneagles, is utterly destroyed; straw and corn and
+fodder being heaped around the houses and then set alight, and the
+servants and farm people having barely escaped with their lives. They
+looked to find horses and cattle for their use, but those have long ago
+been carried off.”
+
+“I am sorry for my sister,” said my lady, “but they suffer only with
+the rest; and she at least has the comfort of knowing that her husband
+is on the safe side of the fence. We are told, sir, that the Duke is
+pushing on towards Perth. Is it known in that town of his approach?”
+
+“Oh, without doubt,” replied our visitor, “and for some time they have
+been occupied fortifying the place; but I have private information,
+madam, that ’tis likely the army may retire to Aberdeen, rather than
+stay to be besieged in Perth. And after all this may be the safer
+method to draw Argyle further from his base.”
+
+“Why, indeed, I am glad to hear this,” cried my lady, (for since the
+departure of her brother from Perth, we had heard but little news from
+that quarter); “they will fight him further north, and for one thing
+they will be nearer the sea, so that the troops when they arrive from
+France may be able to join them without delay.”
+
+I thought that Mr. Abercrombie looked dubious at the mention of troops,
+but he did not discourage my lady, and after some more talk, which I am
+bound to say he endeavoured to lead into a more cheerful channel, he
+went away.
+
+But it was impossible to hide from ourselves, and from each other,
+that our hopes were very faint indeed and our fears greatly increased.
+We could talk and think of little save those poor, starving, suffering
+folk in the Stewarty of Strathearn, and many were the plans arranged
+by Lady Erskine to send them help of food and clothing, tho’ the poor
+about her own doors were numerous and necessitous enough.
+
+Meantime the enemy, having once begun to act, seemed bent on losing no
+more time. The great fall of snow, which was everywhere two or three
+feet deep, was followed by another hard frost, and the roads were thus
+rendered extremely difficult. But the Duke, urged on by his orders from
+Court, was only waiting for the arrival of some regiments from Glasgow,
+and artillery from Berwick and Edinburgh. The storm having delayed a
+train of artillery from England under Colonel Borgard, it arrived in
+the Roads of Leith late one Saturday afternoon, and marching with all
+possible speed to Stirling, reached that place in time to join the main
+army in its march northwards. Once again upon a Sunday could be seen
+the dark stream of horse, foot, and artillery winding slowly along
+the snowy road, and though the Duke went no further that day than to
+Dunblane, a detachment was sent forward to the Castle of Braco, which
+however they found deserted. And still we had to sit and nurse our
+fears in patience, and for a whole long week we suffered the martyrdom
+that women in all ages of the world have suffered, that of sitting at
+home and waiting.
+
+All sorts of rumours continued to fly about, and friendly neighbours
+came to discuss whatever they heard. There had been a battle--the
+King’s army was stricken--nay, the French troops had arrived in time
+and Argyle had had the worst of it. There had been no fight, but half
+the Highland chiefs had surrendered and asked for protection, indeed
+they had delivered the King’s person to his Grace of Argyle who was
+bringing him in triumph to Edinburgh; or again the King had been
+crowned at Scone, and upon hearing of it the greater number of Argyle’s
+soldiers, excepting always the Dutch troops, had deserted to the enemy.
+These and other wild stories were afloat, to be listened to, frowned
+at, laughed over, and, for the most part, rejected, but nothing so wild
+and improbable as the truth ever entered our heads.
+
+It was not until Tuesday, the 7th of February, that the final blow
+came, and again it was Mr. Abercrombie that brought the news. The
+King’s army had evacuated Perth, it is true, and under General Gordon
+had retired upon Aberdeen; but the King, accompanied by the Earl of
+Mar, and one or two other noblemen, had embarked at Montrose three days
+before, and were now well on their way back to France.
+
+It was impossible to palliate or disguise the bitter fact, and our
+informant blurted it out in the shortest and plainest words. What
+terror we were in, what surprise and disappointment, what shame and
+chagrin we suffered, I will leave you to imagine. By degrees we learnt
+that there had been no council held by the General Officers before
+taking this step, that only a few intimates of my Lord Mar knew of it,
+and that the rest were full of rage and indignation, considering that
+they had been betrayed and abandoned to the enemy. That the King had
+been persuaded it was the best and wisest thing he could do, believing
+that with his removal the Rising would collapse, the army disperse, and
+the country become quiet, we could not of course have any doubt. But
+when all was said and done, the vengeance of the Government was still
+to be reckoned with, and he had left them to face it alone. It was
+not by my lady nor her sister that any censure was passed upon their
+beloved King, nor did they voice their opinion of my Lord Mar in any
+way to blame him. But those outside the house were not so discreet, and
+indeed it added to our pain to hear the free comments that were made
+upon the affair.
+
+In the meantime, where was Sir John; what had become of the Master of
+Sinclair, whose wisdom and foresight Betty now extolled to the skies;
+and what, oh, what of Barbara’s lover, too insignificant to all but
+herself to be worthy of mention in the general reports? I can tell you
+there were three sorrowful women at Alva in those days, and the saddest
+of all perhaps was my Lady Erskine, who went about with folded lips
+and fear-haunted eyes, forcing herself to her daily tasks, as she told
+me after, “with a thousand pins and needles in her heart.”
+
+By degrees we heard fresh tidings: how General Gordon had abandoned
+Aberdeen, after occupying it for only two days; how the army, upon
+deciding that each man must shift for himself, had dispersed in various
+directions, promising however to come together again upon word received
+from the King; how many of the officers and noblemen had embarked in
+ships for France and Sweden; and how others, less fortunate, were
+hiding in the mountain-districts of the Highlands, expecting, as was
+natural, to be hunted by the Government troops, and waiting till they
+also could find ships to bear them to the Continent. But all this time
+not a word of our good Sir John. We watched my lady’s face grow whiter
+and more worn, and longed in our helplessness to comfort her.
+
+“Why, oh why, does he not contrive to send word to her?” cried Betty,
+the tears in her eyes. “He cannot be dead. I defy them to keep him
+prisoner; and if he be anywhere in Scotland he could surely have sent a
+messenger of some sort to Alva. But men are all alike, thoughtless and
+selfish, and have little care for the unfortunate woman at home once
+they have left them.”
+
+I forgave the bitterness of her tone knowing how her heart yearned
+after her eldest brother, for no news had been received for long, and
+her words applied equally to him. But the very next day relief came.
+
+We had but just finished dinner when a noise in the lobby attracted our
+attention, and Charles rising and running to the door called out: “’Tis
+Andrew! Oh, mama, Andrew Short is returned. And why did you not bring
+my papa home again, Andrew? Where is he?”
+
+Trembling and agitated we rose to greet him, for Andrew had been with
+Sir John, and we dreaded what his tidings might be. A sore-stricken and
+weary man was he that entered the room; so woe-begone his countenance,
+so shame-faced his mien that I for one feared the very worst. “Andrew,
+where is Sir John?” cried my lady, running up to him, and looking in
+his face with such haggard anxiety in her eyes as touched the good
+fellow to the heart.
+
+“Sir John is safe, my leddy!” he said quickly, in a hoarse voice, “or
+ye never wad hae seen me here. But does yer leddyship ken whaur the
+King is, an’ his freend, the Earl o’ Mar?”
+
+“Alas, yes! my good Andrew, and our hearts are heavy enough at the
+knowledge, and all it means to Scotland. But you are spent and hungry,
+and though you must satisfy me about Sir John, we will wait till you
+are warmed and fed before you give us further news. You have a letter
+for me, belike?”
+
+She looked at him eagerly, and her face fell when he shook his head.
+
+“Na, my leddy, nae letter. Sir John wadna trust a written line; but I
+was tae tell ye he sailed for France on the second day of this month,
+that was twa days _afore_ the ither folk took their leave, ye ken, mem.
+And landed safe he is, I mak’ nae doot, by this time.”
+
+My lady sank down upon a chair, and covered her face with her hands for
+a little space.
+
+“Thank God!” she said at length, “he is at least beyond danger. But can
+you not tell me more, Andrew? Who sent him away, and for what purpose?”
+
+“My leddy,” said the man, “I canna tell ye mair than Sir John tellt me,
+and that was that he had orders tae sail for France from Montrose on
+the Thursday nicht, wi’ despatches, he said, tae the Queen; that I was
+tae bide whaur I was for twa days, and then tae come hame as fast but
+as secret as I could manage it, and bring his love and kind respects
+tae yer leddyship, and tell ye he was gane awa’ tae France.”
+
+And though we questioned him closely he had no more to tell us of the
+matter. After he had been sent away to rest and be fed, my lady looked
+at us uneasily.
+
+“I must send an express to Charles Erskine this very night,” she said,
+“to give him news of his brother. But why has Sir John sent me no
+instructions as to what he wishes me to do?”
+
+“Indeed, sister,” said Betty, “it surprises me that Sir John did
+not acquaint you with his plans when you saw him at Dysart. It is
+impossible he did not know something of what was to happen, for he was
+ever in the confidence of my Lord Mar. Why did he not prepare you for
+this?”
+
+“God knows,” said my lady, in sad perplexity, gazing out of the window
+at the snow-clad world; “and He alone knows what will happen to us now.”
+
+“Perhaps if Sir John knew anything he was bound to secrecy,” cried I,
+who could not bear to hear my kind guardian blamed even by those who
+loved him. “But tell me, dear madam, what is’t you fear?”
+
+“Vengeance, Barbara,” she answered, with sombre earnestness, “the
+vengeance of the reigning house. Sir John is no longer a trusted agent
+of the rightful King, he is a Rebel, an Outlaw, an Exile; and who knows
+whether he may not be attainted, and all his estates forfeited to the
+Crown?”
+
+“What’s forfeited, mama?” cried little Charles. “Oh, I do want my papa
+to come home,” and at that my lady caught the boy to her breast, and
+broke into a fit of wild weeping, pouring out her anguish, poor soul,
+to us who wept with her, all the more freely that she had hitherto kept
+her feelings so well under control.
+
+But the express was sent that afternoon to Edinburgh, and the very
+next evening Mr. Erskine was with us. Kind and calm and cheerful,
+it is impossible to exaggerate the helpful influence he exercised
+upon us. He combated my lady’s fears, telling her that though it was
+impossible to know yet what parliament might or might not decide, he
+had great hopes that, as the Rebellion had not gone far, they would
+not act with extreme rigour. Again, he said, although Sir John had
+shown himself active in the Cause, he had many friends upon the other
+side, all of them in good odour with the Government; and everything
+that could be said or done in Sir John’s favour, to create a feeling of
+confidence, would, he knew, be willingly carried out. In the meantime
+he thought there was nothing to do but to wait quietly and see what
+should transpire. His one anxiety seemed to be that his brother, Sir
+John, in his impulsive way, might decide at once to settle abroad and
+desire his wife to come to him with their children, and this he thought
+would be unwise, as it would mean abandoning his estate to whoever
+might be ready to seize it. Patience and silence were the two things
+he recommended, besides promising my lady all the help in his power
+whenever she should desire it. The letter of the thirteenth of February
+was written while Mr. Erskine was in the house with us, and in it you
+will see that my dear lady had schooled herself to write quietly and
+moderately. The very day before she wrote, poor Betty had been somewhat
+comforted by receiving a letter from her brother, who wrote to her on
+the eve of his sailing for France.
+
+He had, after many hardships, got as far north as Kirkwall in the
+Orkney Islands, and from thence to Stromness, where, with several
+others, he seized a ship with a French pilot on board and set sail for
+Calais. Her mind was therefore at rest about his person, though like my
+lady she dreaded on his account the impending _vengeance_ which had all
+the horrors of the unknown.
+
+
+LETTER IV
+
+ MY DEAREST LIFE,
+
+ It was no small satisfaction to me in the present
+ state of affairs to hear you was gone. It is what I shall bless God
+ for while I live. Your servant’s return was the first account I had;
+ tho’ my grief was unexpressable the thoughts of your safety did
+ mitigate it very much. It was impossible but you did foresee what
+ wold happen when I was with you, and if you did, you were much to
+ blame not (to) tell me your thoughts of itt, and what methods should
+ be taken for your private affairs. Charles is here just now and most
+ kindly offers to doe all in his power, as I doubt not all your other
+ friends will; but he expected I wold have had a method from you.
+ Whether you did not imagin so suden an end, or would not give mee a
+ sore heart befor the time, I know not.
+
+ Now let me beg of you, as you regard me and your children, not to
+ have any uneasy thoughts about us. I am not afraid of want of sober
+ bread for them and myself; but as I told you the thoughts of your
+ being in pinches is very Bitter, and the prospect I must have of
+ being absent from you for some time, and perhaps for ever, is what
+ imploys my thoughts night and day. But why should I complain of what
+ God in his wise providence has ordered as a just punishment for the
+ abuse of many mercys. Let us then, my Dearest, submit with patience,
+ and trust in that mercyful Father who has hitherto preserv’d you
+ from so imminent dangers, that He will, in His own good time, give
+ us a comfortable meeting, and to live as becomes the children of
+ affliction, in endeavouring to set our hearts above the world and the
+ vanitys thereof.
+
+ I am most impatient to hear from you, and if ye knew what a relief it
+ wold be to have a letter, you wold (have) writ the moment you landed.
+ The person mine is directed to wold find a way to send one to me. I
+ was heartily sorry you was not better provided with money, but if
+ you please to take 100 pound from Mr. Gordon, and make him draw on
+ his correspondent at Edinr., I shall endeavour to have it ready on
+ some day’s sight. I am to beg (you) earnestly to let me know what
+ resolution you have taken as to the place of your abode, and not to
+ be sudden in resolving, but to let me know what you intend, and I hop
+ as you regard my quiet you will not doe anything till you have my
+ consent. I must see what shape things will take here, before I can
+ frame a resolution of seeing you.... There was a great consternation
+ amongst your freinds att the departure of two great men that followed
+ you, and I find the not acquainting them with it is thought hard. I
+ hear they keep still together, but that cannot doe long, God help
+ them! You are lucky in your misfortune that you have kind freinds
+ that are both willing and capable to serve you, and I am hopeful by
+ their means to be in a better state than many others, which is great
+ deal more than we deserve.
+
+ Now let me again beg of you to writ freely to me, and tell me every
+ uneasy thought you have, and make youself as easy as possible, and
+ put in practice the virtue of resignation which you have so often
+ talkt of to me. The more frequently you writ I will be the easyer.
+ Your children are well, but poor B. is in great affliction for her
+ brother and talks of leaveing me. Charls and all freinds here salute
+ you, and I am, my Dearest, Life,
+ Yours,
+
+ Fe. 13.
+
+ I must say Charls makes all the kind offers to me that you
+ can imagine.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIII
+
+TELLS OF FURTHER SAD DOINGS, AND OF THE BEAUTY AND BURDEN OF THE SPRING
+
+
+The relief of pouring out her heart to her husband was, as my dear
+lady once told me, very great, and I think it a real mercy that she
+could not foresee how long her letters were to be of reaching him. That
+they eventually did so, their presence before me is proof; but many
+of them are endorsed as having been received many weeks, nay, months,
+after they were written. My lady was so anxious to set Sir John’s mind
+at rest about herself and their children, so troubled on the score of
+money for his sake, and so uncertain as to what his next movements
+might be, that you can picture to yourselves her distress at not
+hearing either from or of him week after week. In spite of her care in
+seeking to provide him with money, Sir John seems at first to have been
+in straits for want of it, and it will interest you to know that among
+these papers there is a letter from the Queen’s Private Secretary, Mr.
+Dicconson, endorsed--“Came with the bill of 600 livres,” which I shall
+copy here.
+
+ St. Germain
+ Mar. ye. 6. 1716.
+ Sir,
+
+ I am ordered by the Queen to send you a small bill presuming you
+ may be at present want of a little money, which her Majesty is
+ troubled her circumstances will not permit her to make more
+ considerable, but hopes she may be better able hereafter and that
+ this might be a present supply. I beg you will please to do me the
+ justice to believe that I am with all imaginable sincerity and esteem,
+
+ Your most humble and most obedient servant,
+ (Signed) W. Dicconson.
+
+I remember that when my lady heard of this thoughtful kindness on the
+part of her Majesty, who out of her poverty endeavoured to help all who
+were suffering through their loyalty to her son, she could not refrain
+from shedding tears.
+
+But this information came to Alva many weeks later. In the meantime, we
+hoped for letters from day to day, and had pain and anxiety enough in
+hearing of the many calamities that every hour came to our knowledge.
+Our hearts were wrung by the news of the sentence pronounced against
+Lords Kenmure, Derwentwater, Nithisdale and others; and eagerly did we
+await the result of the many petitions presented to the King for their
+reprieve. How we prayed in private, and spoke in public about them and
+the heart-broken wives, Ladys Kenmure, Derwentwater, and Nithisdale,
+who, braving the King’s displeasure, and in the case of the last, his
+determined wrath, in order to beg for mercy for their beloved husbands,
+made every effort to save them from death. How bitterly we wept on
+hearing of the executions that took place on Tower Hill one dreary
+day in the end of February. But no tears were of any avail; only the
+memory of two brave and innocent men lived long in the hearts of Scots
+and English alike. My Lord Kenmure died professing his loyalty to
+King James; and the young Earl of Derwentwater, much loved and long
+lamented, gave to the Sheriff on the scaffold a paper containing his
+dying profession of innocence. Part of this paper I copied in my little
+diary, and here I reproduce it for those who never saw it.
+
+ “Wherefore if in this affair I have acted rashly it ought not to
+ affect the innocent; I intended to wrong nobody, but to serve my
+ King and Country, and that without self-interest, hoping by the
+ example I gave to have induced others to do their duty. And God, who
+ sees the secrets of my heart, knows I speak truth.... I die a Roman
+ Catholic.... I freely forgive such as reported false things of me;
+ and I hope to be forgiven the trespasses of my youth by the Father of
+ Infinite Mercy into Whose hand I commit my soul.
+
+ (Signed) JAS. DERWENTWATER.”
+
+Such brave, gentle, innocently touching words! Do you wonder that
+they dared not bring the poor, headless body openly from London to
+the north, but had it carried thither by night, bringing him home
+by stealth to his weeping and distracted people, who believed that
+the wrath of Heaven would surely fall upon the doers of this awful
+deed. It was said that the Duke of Argyle, travelling to London, met
+the mournful procession on its way, and was so struck by the grief
+and despair of the people that he represented to the Government the
+unwisdom of their act, and thereby helped to turn their hearts to
+clemency.
+
+It was with a shock of relief and joy that we heard immediately after
+this of the escape of my Lord Nithisdale out of prison. Long years
+afterwards I was told the whole story of his brave wife’s devotion:
+how she made the journey from Scotland to London mostly on horseback,
+the snow, which often reached to her horse’s girths, having stopped
+the Stagecoach, and even the Common Post, south of York. In spite of
+this she arrived safe and sound at London, only to find that no one to
+whom she applied could give her any hope, and that even the doors of
+her husband’s prison were closed against her, unless she consented to
+share his confinement. This, for reasons of her own, she refused to
+do, but by bribing the guards she contrived to see him several times
+and confided to him her plans. When she presented her petition to the
+King, the latter refused so much as to look at her, but treated her
+in a way not much to his honour or credit. However, on the very eve
+of the execution, as you know, she contrived by the help of her maid
+(a faithful woman) to dress my lord in female clothes, and bring him
+out of the prison under the very eyes of the guard. It happened that
+the coach of the Venetian Ambassador was to go that night to Dover
+to meet his brother, who was arriving as his guest in England. Lord
+Nithisdale, attired in the Ambassador’s livery, joined the retinue,
+and by help of friends at Dover hired a boat which landed him safe at
+Calais. His lady’s brave work was not yet finished, for she journeyed
+back to Scotland, accompanied by her maid and one servant, lying at all
+the smallest inns, and braving many hardships till she reached home.
+Before going to London, she had, with the help of the gardener, buried
+all the family papers; and knowing that search would soon be made,
+she contrived to secure every valuable document, and take them with
+her to Traquair, where her sister, the Countess, promised to preserve
+them. She then returned home, saw all her neighbours, and invited the
+magistrates to come and make the search for themselves; but next day
+before day-break she was off again to London as before. This conduct
+made the King so angry, that he said my Lady Nithisdale gave him more
+trouble and anxiety than any woman in all Europe. For a fortnight she
+lay concealed in London, and then escaped to France, where she joined
+her lord.
+
+These details, as you know, I only learned long after; but the happy
+fact of Lord Nithisdale’s escape, and the action of his heroic wife,
+were common talk among us at the time. My dear lady envied the latter
+her chance of doing and suffering for her husband, as what wife in like
+circumstances would not; for sure the harder part is to sit still and
+do nothing, with one’s heart alive for action.
+
+About this time came a letter from the dowager Lady Alva, offering
+a visit to her dear daughter-in-law, Catherine, which offer went
+exceedingly against my lady’s inclination. Not that she did not love
+her mother-in-law--and at another time would have welcomed her gladly
+to the house--but just now, with their political views so at variance
+from each other, she did not see how they could meet and talk with any
+show of cordiality and agreement. She could not bear, she said, to hear
+Sir John blamed, and she foresaw the dowager mourning over her son’s
+Rebellion, and drawing dark pictures of the future for herself and her
+little lads. At the same time she was resolved not to fail in duty to
+her husband’s mother, especially as by keeping friendly with her she
+might incline the favour of those in authority, for old Lady Alva was a
+determined Whig, and no shadow of doubt had ever touched her family.
+
+My lady’s brothers-in-law, Mr. Charles Erskine and Mr. Patrick
+Campbell of Monzie, were constant in their care and interest for all
+her concerns, and as she said herself, she was supported on all sides
+by the kindest of friends. To say truth, her bitterest trouble was the
+absence of her husband, and the uncertainty of the measures to be taken
+by Government against the Rebels. Then, too, she was sick at heart
+for the sufferings of others: the imprisonment of her uncle, Colonel
+Erskine; the grief of her sister Grizel, whose husband, Mr. Paterson,
+was also in exile; of Lady Kippendavie, Lady Keir, and many others; not
+forgetting poor Lady Jean, my Lord Mar’s sister, who besides her sorrow
+at her brother’s failure, was suffering from the like bereavement. No
+news came from the Master of Sinclair, but I think my lady’s heart was
+so turned against him by his conduct at Perth that she did not greatly
+care what became of him, though poor Betty spoke of him constantly with
+much affection and regret.
+
+And so the sad days went forward, and February wore to an end, and
+still my lady and poor Barbara had no word of cheer to lighten their
+hearts. The following letter is almost a repetition of the last, but I
+give it in its place, as to me it seems like my lady’s voice, alive and
+speaking.
+
+
+LETTER V
+
+ My Dearest Life,
+
+ I have good reason to hop you arriv’d safe, since
+ I hear all the three ships that went off at that time landed safely;
+ but I am surprised you do not fall upon some way to let me hear from
+ you. I cannot express my impatience to have a particular account
+ where you are and where you intend to make your abode. I writ to you
+ the 13th of this month; I hop it has come to your hand before this
+ time. I told you in it to take 100 pound from Mr. Gordon and cause
+ him to draw upon his correspondent in Edinr. for the money. I shall
+ doe all that’s possible to get more again you want it. I am very easy
+ as to my own particular or my boys; very sober things will serve us,
+ and if you be well and easy in your mind and have what is necessare,
+ I ought to be very thankfull. I must confess I have not minded my own
+ misfortune. The miserys of others ha’s so much affected me, and the
+ concern I am in for my poor Uncle and Mr. P. and many others does so
+ afflict me, I can think on nothing else, and whatever way I turn my
+ thoughts I have nothing but dismall prospects before me. God Almighty
+ support all of us under so bitter a calamity and give us the right
+ use of it. We ought to submit with patience and trust in the mercy of
+ Him who hath smitten us, and if we turn to Him as we ought, He will
+ heal us in his own good time.
+
+ I expect your mother here next week. You may imagine there will be
+ no harmony in our conversation; but I am resolv’d to make the best
+ I can of all things, and shal omit nothing that can be for your
+ interest however uneasy it may be to myself, in hops when the best
+ is made of your affairs the present circumstances can allow, we may
+ have something to live (on) together in some retir’d place, till kind
+ providence give a turn to bring us to our own; and if that never
+ happen, when we come to dye it will be all the same whether we have
+ liv’d in plenty or in more straitning circumstances.
+
+ I think if things continue as they are I would leave Britain with a
+ desire never to see it again. I am sometimes afraid you go to Moscoe
+ without acquainting me; let me beg of you as you regard my life doe
+ not think of it, at least for some time, and if after that you think
+ it convenient I will go very chearfully with you to any corner of the
+ earth; so I beg of you resolve to do nothing of that nature rashly,
+ nor must you do it without acquainting me, and get my consent before
+ you doe it. This I beg’d in my last, and I hope (for) your complyance
+ if you either wish or expect ever to see me again.
+
+ Your man, Andrew, came here some days ago, very well. I regrated he
+ was not with you, but if you please to let me know if you desire to
+ have him, I’ll endeavour to find some opportunity of sending him, and
+ in the meantime I shall imploy him here. Charles and P. C. will do
+ all in their power for manageing your affairs after the best manner,
+ butt I fear there can be little done by any, because all is done
+ by the folks who desire nothing so much as the utter ruin of this
+ country, and it will be a general measure. All your friends will be
+ at their country-seats, so if you write it must not be either to
+ Charles or P. C. My sister, Betty, is here and gives you her kind
+ service, as does poor Aunt Betty, who is in great affliction. Wishing
+ my dear all manner of happyness.
+
+ I am in all sincerity,
+ yours.
+
+ Fe. 26.
+
+ The friends you left together are all dispers’d; there is none
+ Prisoners but Mephon (Methvine) and some others who gave up
+ themselves. Your boys are very well.
+
+At last the snow began to melt under the bright spring sun, and a
+soft wind blowing from the south-west brought a gentle rain upon its
+wings, which hastened the thawing of the hard ground. After a winter
+of such length and severity, it was indeed a glad thing to behold the
+earth, (wondrous green and fresh) pushing aside her wintry mantle and
+laying bare her bosom to the sky. Small things began to force their way
+through the surface of the ground, tender buds showed upon the trees,
+and after the long silence the birds in garden and glen took up their
+music, and sang the gladsome Life-March of the Spring.
+
+I walked one afternoon with my dear lady alone under the bare branches,
+and tried to beguile her from her sad thoughts by talk of the opening
+season which, last year, she had told me she so loved; but her face
+was pale and worn, and she answered me absently, though with her
+wonted gentleness. I knew her very spirit was weary, and I had no word
+of comfort to give her. Presently we sat down upon a wooden bench
+which the westering sun made warm with his beams, and tired of my own
+listless efforts at cheerfulness, I fell into a wistful silence. All
+at once a mavis on a branch behind us broke into song so sweet and
+thrilling that my lady clasped my arm to hold me still. Sudden and
+clear and short was his lay, and then after a slight pause he sang it
+over again. In the silence and the sunlight, with the cool scent of the
+damp earth in our nostrils, the bird’s singing seemed like the voice of
+the spirit of gladness bidding us take joy in the renewal of life. But
+strange to say it was not joy but pain that wrung my heart-strings, and
+my dear lady laid her head upon my shoulder and wept.
+
+“Oh, Barbara,” she sighed at last, “that bird and his song, that
+last year I listened to so gladly, how it pierces my heart with its
+sweetness, and only makes my sadness and loneliness more grievous. It
+raises in me such a longing for the sight of my dear husband’s face,
+that I feel at times the pain of it will kill me! How is it possible to
+live with a heart so heavy? The burden of it is sometimes greater than
+I can bear.”
+
+“I know, I know,” I murmured; for her words did so fully express my
+feelings that they seemed to come from my own heart, and indeed I
+thought that I felt and suffered even as she did, knowing little, in my
+ignorance, of the difference between us. For, as the tiny mountain-burn
+that tinkles down the glen is to the broad, full, swiftly-flowing
+river, so is the love of a maid for her untried lover to the love of
+a wife for her husband, the father of her children. Something of this
+thought must have come to my lady’s mind, for she turned to me very
+kindly.
+
+“Poor little Barbara! I am sure you think you do; and I fear you must
+have found me selfish and hard, in that I have spoken no word to you of
+Mr. Fleming, but I deemed it best, my dear, to keep silent, hoping you
+were learning to forget, or at least that you did not grieve too much.”
+
+“Oh, cousin!” I cried, the barriers of my reserve breaking down before
+her sympathy. “He is ever in my thoughts. How could I forget? All day I
+think of him, and at night I dream such dreary dreams. If I could know
+where he is, or what has become of him, what would I not give? And I
+let him go so coldly, madam; he does not even know that I love him.”
+
+“Why, as to that, my dear,” cried my lady, cheerfully, now bent upon
+comforting me, “I do not think you need have any concern. Words are not
+everything, Barbara, and I am sure you did not flout him.”
+
+“Oh, madam,” I cried, “do you think I was too bold? I would not have
+him regard me too lightly, either.”
+
+My lady laughed. “Well, child, you are hard to please, and I must leave
+Mr. Fleming to tell you his opinion of you himself. I would we could
+have news of him again,” she sighed, “we know nothing since his return
+to Perth.”
+
+“Do you think, cousin, that he also will be in danger of ‘the
+vengeance?’” I asked timidly, for by this name we commonly spoke of the
+dreaded retribution.
+
+“I cannot say, my dear; but I hope as he is young, and has taken no
+prominent part, they will not make an example of him. His kinsman, the
+Earl of Wigton, is in Edinburgh Castle; but his father, as you know,
+is a rich and respected London merchant, who has probably friends at
+Court. I have asked my brother, Charles, to find out if possible what
+has become of him, but no news have reached him as yet.”
+
+I rose and turned my face away to hide my quivering lips.
+
+“It is hard to bear!” I cried.
+
+“My dearest,” she answered, “it _is_ hard; and I want to tell you how
+greatly I admire you for your brave silence, hiding your own grief lest
+you should burden me the more. I cannot thank you enough for all you
+have done, and been, to me and mine at this time, but if ever I have a
+daughter, Barbara, I shall name her after you.”
+
+With that she kissed me very kindly (though I knew of no reason for her
+gratitude), but almost immediately she broke out weeping again.
+
+“Oh, hark to my promises,” she sobbed, “foolish woman that I am! To
+talk of future children when I know not whether I be not already a
+widow--God forgive me! I scarce knew what I was saying.”
+
+And then I took to comforting her in turn (but you know she kept her
+promise three years later, when my dear god-daughter was born). Her
+second breakdown was so violent and so unusual, that at first I was
+alarmed for her health, but by-and-bye she quieted herself, and even
+smiled as she dried her eyes.
+
+“Just for this once, Barbara, I have let myself weep my fill, and now
+I feel the lighter for it. ’Twas the mavis set me going, and I suppose
+it is not the first time that a bird’s song has caused a full heart to
+overflow.”
+
+I never forgot the words, nor the scene; and that is the reason why
+always in my mind I connect the mavis’ singing with my dear Lady
+Erskine and her troubles, as I told you at the beginning of this story.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIV
+
+MY LADY HEARS FROM SIR JOHN, AND I PAY MY THIRD VISIT TO DYSART
+
+
+I have given you so much of woe and weeping that I begin to fear you
+must be weary of so dismal a tale, and I am quite glad to tell you now
+of a little lull in the tempest, and of a gleam of sunshine that shot
+through the clouds. It was a very little thing that caused it truly;
+nothing more important than a letter which arrived from Sir John at
+last, but it brought the colour back to my lady’s cheek, and the light
+to her eyes for a time.
+
+The whole household was gladdened by the news of his safety, for he was
+at Paris awaiting the bidding of the King to attend him at Avignon, in
+good health and spirits; and, though chagrined at the sudden ending
+of all their endeavours, was hopeful that at some future time their
+efforts should be crowned with success.
+
+I have here a small fragment of the journal which he kept on his voyage
+from Scotland, of which I will give you the first extract, and the last.
+
+ “Journal from the 2nd Feb., 1716.
+ Montrose.
+
+ 2nd “Att night received my orders for going to france with
+ dispatches to the Queen, the Regent, and E. Bolingbroke from
+ the King, and to the last also from the D. of Mar.
+
+ 9th “By 11 at night I gott to St. Germains. the Queen was not well
+ and laid to sleep. I delivered my letters and other commissions
+ to the Queen, who, about 12 o’clock, ordered me to goe
+ immediately to Paris and look after E. Bolingbroke.”
+
+Of his further movements at that particular time no record has been
+kept. The letter to his wife was like himself, frank and cheerful,
+hopeful and kind; with regrets for the sorrows and misfortunes of
+others, but no word of grudging or bitterness about his own lost
+labours. Even the servants imbibed courage from hearing of it, and the
+kind neighbours who asked discreet questions of my lady scarce needed a
+reply after looking at her face.
+
+To add to our comfort, Mr. Charles Erskine, who was again expected at
+Alva, being prevented coming for some days, wrote to my lady telling
+her of news he had got from the north of those whom my lady calls in
+her letters to her husband his “fellow-travellers.” These were my Lord
+Tinworth, the Duke of Berwick’s son, with his uncle, Colonel Bulkeley,
+my Lord Talbot and my Lord Edward Drummond; and as my lady had been
+exceedingly anxious on the score of the first-named, whom Sir John had
+praised much as a fine, modest, and engaging youth, we were relieved,
+though somewhat disturbed, to learn what was become of him. A company
+of gentlemen, including the above, and amongst whom were the Marquis of
+Tullibardine, Earls of Marischall, Southesk and Linlithgow, Viscounts
+Kilsyth, Kingston and Dundee, Lords Pitsligo, Rollo and Burleigh,
+having gone to Peterhead in hopes of finding a ship, were obliged to
+return owing to the presence of a man-of-war near at hand. They had
+then made their way westward towards the other coast, where ships were
+expected to take them off to France, and at present, it was supposed,
+were in hiding among the mountains. “Among the names,” wrote Mr.
+Erskine, “of the junior officers who accompanied them I find that of
+your late guest, for whom you were enquiring, Mr. Anthony Fleming.”
+
+So the worst part of our anxiety was passed. Sir John and my dear Mr.
+Fleming lived; and although months must pass before we could think of
+seeing them, or perhaps hearing aught of them, it was no longer agony
+to name them in our prayers, and ask God to protect them from further
+danger.
+
+My lady answered the welcome letter in a much more cheerful strain than
+before.
+
+
+LETTER VI
+
+ March 12.
+
+ Yours of the date 20 of Fe. was most acceptable to me. I delayed
+ answering my Dearest Life some days, expecting Charls here, that I
+ might learn a little from him what were people’s opinions as to our
+ present state ... but now I blame myself for delaying, and tho’ I
+ still expect Charls I have no longer patience. I hop by the letters
+ I have writ you will be easy as to me and your boys. I must own the
+ miserys of others has so much affected me that I did not think on my
+ own misfortune in such a manner as I wold at another time, and being
+ absent from you is what affects me most; but since God has been so
+ mercyfull to me in preserving your Life and giving you freedom and
+ liberty to enjoy yourself in a good country, and at the same time
+ affords what is needfull both for you and your family, I would be
+ very unworthy to complain. Let things come to the worst, I make no
+ doubt of getting a suitable allyment ... and there can nobody lose
+ a groat by you, so you may be easy on that score. Your servants are
+ all here, very well, which occasions me a greater family than is
+ convenient; but justice and gratitude obliges me to itt, and it’s
+ what I know you wold approve.... I have not heard of your drawing for
+ 100 pound as I have twice desir’d you. I can tell you there is a fund
+ for 200 more, so there is no need for you to straiten yourself or
+ denye yourself what is either convenient or proper for you. I think
+ you are in the right to go to a cheap place, but I could wish you had
+ some of your neighbours and friends, who by this time are in the same
+ country with you; it would make the time pass more agreeably.
+
+ There is no Prisoners yet except such as have given themselves up,
+ and I am in no pain about them. I have converst with some of your
+ neighbours since they were disperst; but there never were people so
+ much confounded nor in such despair as they were in when they knew of
+ the departure of these people, and all blame your friend, and think
+ they might have done the same thing, and done it with a better Grace.
+
+ All the Lords went to the Highlands, and the clans design to
+ defend themselves. I hear the forces are now ordered to go to the
+ Highlands. Many went to Orkney, and there ha’s taken ship. Your
+ fellow-travellers and others, of which number there were 70, went to
+ Peterhead, and could not get away, were obligt to return and join
+ with the clans. They will be exposed to hardships, but in such a case
+ there is no help.... You tell me you have something in your head that
+ could make us live easy, but it is not fit to write.... Well, I do
+ not doubt but we shall again live happy together, and in the meantime
+ I shall do all in my power for your interest, and shall denye myself
+ the pleasure of seeing you till my being here can be no longer of
+ use. I shall always prefer your interest to pleasing myself. Let me
+ know if you want A. S--t sent to you.... I forgot to tell you P.
+ C. is gone for London eight days agoe. There are some people here
+ afraid of a war breaking out with France, and in that case I wish
+ you had money remitted before that happened. I shall be uneasy for
+ not hearing from you, and in fear you should be sent messages to
+ Britain, which I beg of you, for God’s sake, as you regard my quiet
+ and life, not to undertake. I take Charls’ advice and P. C.’s in all
+ your concerns, and they are both in as great concern for you and
+ the interest of your family as it’s possible for you to imagine. I
+ believe all your other friends will do what’s in their power when
+ there is occasion. Let things come to the worst, I have no doubt but
+ we shall have a reasonable competence for us and our children without
+ being obligt to anybody. Ye know I always look to the dark side of
+ the cloud, and when I say so there is good grounds for believing it.
+
+ For some time past the singing of the mavis increast my grief, but
+ now I am come to take some pleasure in the fields, and to bless God
+ you have the same liberty and priviledge which is a great comfort
+ to me. I begin now to put things to rights about your Hedges and
+ Ditches, and shall take care to keep all right while I am here; and
+ if it should so happen I must leave it, I hope it will fall in a
+ friend’s hand. Mr. R.(ose) labours your own farm, so, in spite of
+ all, that will afford somewhat to my subsistance.
+
+ I am better now than I used to be when all things were more to my
+ mind. I mean as to my health; and since you express such concern
+ for me, and think my health for your interest, I shall doe what’s
+ reasonable to preserve it. Your children are well. Your mother will
+ be here this week.... May my Dearest be as happy as I wish him.
+ God grant him the right use of all his troubles, patience, and
+ submission, and preserve him from all evil.
+
+ Yours, Dear Life, Adieu.
+
+On the back of this letter I find a post-scriptum in Betty’s
+hand-writing; ’tis writ in the vein she used so often in speaking to
+Sir John--half serious, half flippant and wholly affectionate, for she
+too, was in better spirits since the arrival of my guardian’s letter.
+
+ “Dear Sir John,
+
+ Of all things I believe you least want my good
+ wishes; however, to please myself I offer them, and that with all the
+ sincerity and fervour, inclination and gratitude can oblige me to.
+ I thank God all my friends is not alike unlucky. I am in great fear
+ about them, if the divisions amongst the great people don’t do them
+ service. I pray God for a good meeting. In the meantime
+
+ I am, my Dr. Sir J.
+ Your most faithful
+ Female Counciler.
+ B.”
+
+I remember very well the day upon which the dreaded advent of the
+Dowager Lady Alva was expected. The snow was melted on the low-lying
+land, though it still lay on the hills, where however it was
+disappearing fast; and my lady came in her own travelling-coach from
+Edinburgh, having crossed the Forth at the Queen’s Ferry. I must own
+that I stood somewhat in awe of the stately dame, whom I had seen but
+seldom, and perhaps the anxiety of my dear lady communicated itself to
+me. As for Betty, who was a particular favourite of the dowager, she
+expressed no concern; but she told me after how unhappy she had felt on
+her sister’s account.
+
+At last a servant ran to tell us that the coach was approaching the
+house, and my lady, taking her boys one in each hand, went to the door
+and stood upon the threshold to welcome her with all honour. Aunt
+Betty, Betty Sinclair, and Barbara stood just behind, and the chief
+servants were grouped in the background, for nothing must be omitted
+of respect and observance in the reception of Sir John’s mother. When
+the carriage drew up, the men-servants having descended from the rumble
+and opened the door, little Charles at his mama’s bidding ran forward,
+and placing himself in front of the step begged his grandmother to lean
+upon his support in her descent. This the old lady very good naturedly
+did, and by the aid of her woman who rode with her, seemed to throw all
+her weight on the child’s shoulder, which pleased him very much. As she
+approached the door, my lady stepped forward and kissing her cheek,
+bade her kindly welcome to Alva.
+
+Whatever may have been Lady Erskine’s fears and doubts she hid them
+under a simple, natural manner, and it was not till the dowager was
+seated in the parlour, with Harry on a footstool at her feet, and
+Charles holding her mittened hand, that my lady ventured to say, and
+then her voice trembled a little,
+
+“I would rather, madam, as you know, that Sir John were here to welcome
+you himself, but in his absence you must let my little sons take his
+place.”
+
+“Indeed, my dear daughter,” said the old lady cheerfully, “I am aware
+that my son cannot be in two places at once, and as he has chosen to
+absent himself from Alva, I must e’en make the best of it; in the
+meantime you and the little lads will do very well.”
+
+Surprised and relieved my lady smiled.
+
+“It is good of you, madam, to come to us just now. Many would think it
+right to avoid the house of a Rebel.”
+
+“My dear Catherine,” said the dowager gravely, “my son is my son,
+and whatever he does he will never be less to me. I think it right,
+however, to say before my grandchildren, my sister Elizabeth, and your
+young friends, that I consider Sir John has acted wrongly, and I pray
+God he may be led to see the error of his ways; but for all that, I
+have no doubt but he is honest, and as he has been unfortunate, it ill
+becomes us to triumph. I do not wish to hear where he is, but I trust
+you have good news of him, my dear.”
+
+And so this dreaded meeting was over, and old Lady Alva by her
+kindliness and good sense set everyone at their ease. She would not
+listen to Aunt Betty’s complaints and mournings, nor did she allow her
+to prognosticate evil, as had been her depressing habit of late. The
+house increased in cheerfulness because of her presence, and my dear
+lady had in her a firm supporter through all her troubles.
+
+This being so, it was proposed that Betty should return to Dysart
+for a time taking me with her, as my lady was anxious to have news
+of her father. The old lord was grieving sorely over the downfall of
+his hopes; and the exile of his son, which, it was feared, might be
+permanent, added to his anxieties and cares. The state of Scotland was
+indeed to be deplored. From Stirling to Inverness there was nothing but
+desolation, for it was as if a marauding army had swept it bare. “The
+Dutch,” as one gentleman wrote, “have not left a chair, or a stool, nor
+a barrel, nor a bottle, _enfin_ nothing undestroyed, and the English
+troops very little more merciful.” General Cadogan had been ordered
+north to the Highlands to hunt for the Rebel Lords, and to bring the
+clans into subjection; but before going he sent out invitations to the
+ladies of Edinburgh to a Ball. Oh, how my poor Betty raged and stormed
+when she heard of this outrage, for so she considered it! “How,” she
+cried, “could women think of dancing when half the country was mourning
+in desolation?” They might rejoice that the Rising had failed, but to
+dance and play over its grave was a heartless and monstrous thing to
+do, and she longed to go straight to the General and give him her mind
+on the subject. She called him Nero from that day forward, and never
+could she hear him mentioned without some bitter word.
+
+The Duke of Argyle, “having gloriously finished the most laborious and
+hard campaign that ever was known” (so the prints had it) had set out
+for London, leaving Cadogan in command, but we did not know (nor he
+either, poor gentleman) that he was actually deprived of his post as
+Commander-in-Chief in favour of his subordinate; and even we, against
+whom he had fought, regretted this step, for his Grace had proved
+himself a very generous and tender enemy; and from all we could gather,
+his humiliation came through the jealousy of his rival, the Duke of
+Marlborough, in whom, as you know, we never put any great trust.
+
+It was in the coach on our road to Dysart that Betty spoke out to me
+of her terrible grief and disappointment. I had found her very unlike
+herself during this visit to Alva, silent and melancholy, but knowing
+what ample reason she had for low spirits, I had passed it without
+comment. It was when she caught sight of the ships in the Forth that
+she began to speak.
+
+“Oh, Barbara!” she sighed, “to think how high our hopes were when last
+I passed this way, and now it is all at an end. My heart is nearly
+broken!”
+
+I had no words to comfort her, I could only listen.
+
+“Do you remember last May how confident we were? What gay visions
+danced before our eyes! How we believed in those who have since proved
+so frail and feeble, and scorned those who spoke of dangers and defeat,
+and were bitterly angry if any hinted at failure! Why has God dragged
+us through such humiliation; what has been gained? Why did He let us
+attempt this thing if He meant only to overthrow us in the end? It is
+cruel--cruel, I say. I would not so have treated those who trusted me!”
+
+“Why, Bess, my dear, your words are wild!” I cried, but she went on
+unheeding.
+
+“And oh, that poor unhappy King, how my heart bleeds for him! He
+is innocent, but he will be blamed; honest, but they will call him
+a traitor; kind-hearted, but they will remember him as a monster;
+courageous, but he is already branded as a coward. No man was ever
+so bamboozled, so entangled, so misguided. And Barbara,” she added,
+darkly, “I know who led him astray. I know whom we have to thank for
+the humiliation, the anger, the bitter grief and suffering; and tho’ I
+will name no names, in my heart I feel that my poor brother was right,
+though he too is a sufferer in spite of his wisdom.”
+
+I knew very well what she meant, and told her I agreed with her, though
+it was hard, I said, to believe that all our trouble had come from
+_one_ man’s mismanagement.
+
+“Ay,” she answered doubtfully, “I catch your meaning, and perhaps the
+causes are numerous and far-reaching, but I keep my opinion of one
+man’s worth, and I could name a dozen who could have brought the affair
+to a more successful issue.”
+
+“Think you, Betty,” I asked, “that your brother, the Master, will be
+attainted, and poor Sir John, and Mr. Paterson and Lady Jean’s husband?
+I am in great grief for them.”
+
+“No one can tell yet what will be done,” she said, “but if it is so, I
+feel if I should like to leave Britain, and never see or speak to one
+of my Whig neighbours again. I used to like my Lord Rothes very well,
+but I love the old Colonel, and cannot bear to think of him in the
+Fleet, while my lord is Governor of Stirling Castle.”
+
+“What says my Lord Wemyss?” I ventured. “Have you seen him since the
+departure of the King?”
+
+“No,” cried Betty, very proudly. “He writ me a letter full of
+gratitude, thanking me in very kind words, I must own, for my care of
+his poor young son--oh, Barbara, I did so grieve to see him die! But
+’twas just after the King’s landing and my mind was fixed upon him.
+_Afterwards_ my lord wrote again asking if he could be of help to us in
+our misfortune, which so riled me (for my heart was very sore) that I
+answered him with hot and bitter words.”
+
+“Oh, Betty!” I cried, “I am sure he meant it kindly.”
+
+“Very likely,” she replied, “but there are times when even kindness is
+unkind. Let us not talk of my Lord Wemyss; there are other subjects
+more agreeable.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXV
+
+TELLS OF AN UNEXPECTED MEETING, AND A GLAD SURPRISE FOR BARBARA
+
+
+We found the household at the Hermitage very dull and dumpish; they
+seemed like people who had received a shock from which they had not
+yet recovered. My lord spoke little, and looked to my eyes many years
+older and feebler than when I saw him last. David Pitcairn came about
+the house as usual, making himself useful to the old man, whose younger
+sons, being engaged in affairs of their own, could not be much with
+him; and Mistress Mary, who was never very healthy, was staying with
+her sister at Newbyth.
+
+The only news of interest that reached us, consisted in the reports
+from time to time of the safe arrival in France, or Sweden, or Holland,
+of this or that fugitive about whom we had been in anxiety. But so
+far we had heard nothing of the Marquis of Tynemouth and his friends,
+and my mind was divided between fears of the hardships they must be
+enduring among the mountains, and hopes that they were already far
+away in a safe country. My Lord Huntly had given himself up and made
+terms for himself with the Government, but the Earl of Seaforth, whose
+name was coupled with his as a traitor to the Cause, had in reality
+withdrawn his submission, and was now retired to the Isle of Lewis with
+his men.
+
+A few days after our arrival at Dysart there was a great storm of rain,
+which lasted so continuously that the last shred of snow disappeared
+from the earth. It was in truth the ushering in of the summer, early
+though it was, for from that time the weather never went back, but
+continued bright, warm and genial, with light winds and occasional
+life-giving showers, all through that year. It seemed as if it had
+been sent to compensate us for the long and terrible winter, for the
+summer of 1716 proved one of the most bounteous seasons within the
+memory of man.
+
+While it lasted, however, the rain was dreary enough, and day after
+day we looked out upon a grey and sullen sea, shut in by mists and low
+hanging clouds from any view of the opposite coast; and night after
+night we listened to the rain beating on our window-panes, and thought
+of our friends, perhaps in want of shelter, and dreamed pitiful dreams
+which haunted us in our waking hours. It was a dreary week at Dysart.
+
+One night after supper, as I went to my chamber to fetch some work, I
+was stopped by the sound of low, continuous knocking at the door I have
+told you of at the foot of the turret-stair. It brought to my mind that
+night when my dear lady recognised her husband’s knock, and ran, in
+spite of my terror, to open to him; but so much had passed since then,
+that though I was startled, I had no sense of personal fear, knowing
+well that none but friends, and generally those in distress, would come
+to the house that way. For this reason I did not hesitate, but placing
+my taper in a niche of the wall, went hurriedly down the twisted stair,
+and paused for a moment at the back of the door. The rain was still
+falling though not so heavy, and behind the clouds there was a waning
+moon whose light came dimly through the grated window above me. I drew
+back the bolt cautiously and lifted the latch. The door was pushed open
+from without, and a man entered quickly, shutting it behind him.
+
+“Forgive me, madam!” he whispered, “but there is danger.”
+
+I fell back against the wall, dumbfoundered, for the man was none other
+than Anthony Fleming.
+
+For a few moments we gazed at each other in silence, and then without
+warning I flung my arms about him and lifted my face to his. He kissed
+me like one in a dream.
+
+“You!” I gasped. “You--and _here_! I thought you were over seas. Oh,
+thank God you are safe. Last night I dreamed that I found you again,
+wounded and nigh to death, and my pillow was wet when I awoke. Whence
+came you? You are not ill? Oh, how I have prayed that God would send
+you back, and now you are come, out of the mist and rain, straight to
+my arms. How good He is--how good! But you--you did not know I loved
+you, dear heart; I let you go so coldly. I have longed, oh longed, to
+tell you the truth; will you believe it now? I am yours for ever and
+ever; no one on earth shall ever come between us.”
+
+And then my breath gave out and the tears came, and I laid my face upon
+his breast, trembling and weeping.
+
+As for him he spoke no word; but he held me in his arms, closer and
+closer, as if he would keep me there for ever, and I felt his kisses on
+my hair, and heard the great throbs of his heart beating against my arm.
+
+At that moment there was no room in all my being for anything but joy
+and thankfulness; but sometimes in looking back upon this scene, I have
+been troubled and have blushed hotly, as a woman will even in solitude,
+remembering my bold and free surrender. Did Mr. Fleming hesitate to
+speak, because of it, deeming my conduct perhaps unmaidenly? I have
+never dared to ask him, but I trust he has forgotten it long ago.[1]
+
+ [1] I have not forgotten it, my sweet wife, nor shall, “while memory
+ holds her seat.” ’Twas a moment to thank God for, and only a sense of
+ my own unworthiness kept me silent. A. F.
+
+Whatever it boded I could not bear his silence. I have heard that women
+mostly love to voice their emotion, while with men it often renders
+them speechless.
+
+“Will you not speak to me, Anthony?” I said. “Will you not say you are
+glad to see me?”
+
+I had lifted my face to look at him, and though the light was dim, for
+the first and only time in my life I saw tears in my dear love’s eyes.
+
+“Glad, sweetheart?” he murmured, “’tis like getting into Heaven.”
+
+And after that I did not mind the silence. It lasted but a minute,
+and then he unclasped my hands, and putting me from him, gazed at me
+intently.
+
+“Is my Lady Erskine here?” he said. “Tell me, Barbara, who is with you
+in the house?”
+
+I told him, still speaking low, and then asked him what was the danger
+he feared.
+
+“Tis not for myself, dear love, though I suppose it extends to us all.
+But there is one whose life is infinitely precious, for whom I came
+to beg shelter. I know my Lord Sinclair is as safe as he is kind, and
+Mistress Betty is well reputed among us for her loyalty. It is--”
+
+“Stop!” I cried. “Do not tell me here. Let us hasten to Betty’s boudoir
+that she may hear the news first, whatever they are. Oh, come, I cannot
+bear to delay a moment.”
+
+Breathless with excitement and anxiety, I had almost forgotten my
+own share in the event, but stopped at the door of Betty’s room to
+give my friend a smile and a kindly look. Then I opened the door and
+entered hurriedly. Betty was sitting by the fire, and on seeing us
+rose quickly. Her face, which at first was fixed in surprise, flushed
+suddenly when she recognised her visitor, and she came forward to meet
+him with hands outstretched.
+
+“You, Mr. Fleming?” she cried. “How come you here, and whence? We have
+been much exercised about your safety, but thought you were gone to
+France some days ago. Are you alone?”
+
+“Madam,” said Mr. Fleming, “I am not, and I will tell you in a few
+words why I am here. It is the young Marquis of Tinmouth and his uncle
+for whom I beg shelter. They are in hiding in a wood about a quarter of
+a mile from the house. I am sent to acquaint my Lord Sinclair with the
+matter, and if it is safe I am to return at once and tell them.”
+
+Oh, how my dear Betty’s eyes lit up with joy! To think that there was
+still a chance for her to show her loyalty, and do some little thing
+for the Cause; to receive the King’s young relative and keep him safe,
+to plan and further his escape. All this appealed to her keenly and set
+her blood a-tingling with pleasure. Bidding us wait where we were she
+ran to give her father the news, and when we were alone, I was able to
+look at my dear with calmer eyes, and to see, alas! how worn and thin
+he had become.
+
+“Worse, far worse, than when you departed from Alva,” cried I.
+
+He laughed a little. “And small wonder, Sweet; when one has spent some
+weeks in the mountains, exposed to hunger and cold and wind and rain,
+and burdened by the dread of capture, it is not easy to keep flesh on
+one’s bones, or preserve a fresh and ruddy countenance.”
+
+“Have you been without proper shelter ever since the departure of the
+King?” I asked in amazement.
+
+“Most of the time,” he answered. “We could not get away from Peterhead,
+because of a man-of-war which kept watch to prevent us. We went to
+Castle Gordon, where we spent a few days, and then with the other lords
+withdrew westward. I will not tell you of all our trials, my dearest;
+but though our young master bore them all with a very cheerful spirit,
+we could see that they were telling on his strength. He is not much
+more than a boy, and has never known what hardship and exposure mean.
+At last it was decided that he should try to make his way south to
+Edinburgh, I being sent as guide; so, travelling by night and hiding by
+day, we were directed to this house, whence we hope to get shipped to
+France. I knew that if the family were at home we should be taken care
+of, but I little guessed the blessed welcome that was waiting here for
+me.”
+
+And with that he put his arm again around me, and we stood gazing into
+the fire in blissful silence, till Betty’s step was heard returning.
+
+I will leave you to imagine how the old house woke up that night from
+its melancholy. Very quickly Mr. Fleming was despatched to bring in
+the weary wanderers, and meanwhile rooms were made ready to receive
+them, great fires lighted to warm them, and garments brought from every
+wardrobe in the house to replace their worn and sodden clothing. A
+great supper was quickly prepared, for good-will made all hands work
+fast, and in the hearts of men and women alike pity for the fugitives
+brought the desire to help and comfort them. It was thought safer to
+let them enter by the turret-door; but my lord received them at the
+top of the winding stair, and himself conducted the young Marquis to
+his chamber, where with the aid of a warm bath and dry clothing, the
+young gentleman was able to make himself more comfortable than he had
+been, I should imagine, for many weeks past.
+
+When he entered the dining-room with his host, attired in a suit
+of purple velvet with ruffles of lace, belonging to one of Betty’s
+brothers, we could scarce take our eyes off his face, even in
+performing our lowest curtseys, so charmed were we with his gallant
+bearing and his modest and pleasant looks. When Betty very prettily
+bade him welcome to her father’s house, and said how honoured they
+were at the trust reposed in their family, he blushed like the boy he
+was, and stammered out that the honour was his alone. He looked at the
+well-spread board, the blazing fire, the lighted room, and giving a
+little laugh he said, with a slight foreign accent that rendered his
+speech very attractive,
+
+“If you could know the contrast, madam, of my surroundings this night
+with those of the last few weeks, you would understand very well that
+the gratitude is all on my side.”
+
+“What horrors you must have endured, my lord,” cried Betty. “Oh, I
+fear you will bear away with you but a bitter remembrance of our
+inhospitable country.”
+
+“Nay, madam,” he answered with a graceful gesture, “you have set aside
+that possibility for ever. But here,” he went on, “is my good uncle,
+Colonel Bulkeley, who has shared my vicissitudes; and I need not
+introduce to you our faithful friend, Captain Anthony Fleming, without
+whom we should, I fear, have been still longer in reaching this haven
+of refuge.”
+
+These gentlemen now entered the room, and it was with great joy that I
+noticed the improvement in Mr. Fleming’s looks, who, now that he had
+performed his toilette, seemed neither so ill nor so haggard as I had
+thought him. Thin he was and worn with his hardships, but the glad look
+in his eyes gave him an air of restfulness and satisfaction which had
+before been wanting.
+
+Colonel Bulkeley was a tall, stout man with a full, high-coloured face.
+’Twas difficult to believe that he had endured the same trials that had
+left the younger men so thin and pale. With my foolish woman’s caprice,
+I took an instant dislike to the brave Colonel, though he made his bow
+to us very low, and addressed Betty in a courteous and gentlemanly way.
+Still there was about him an air of dogged superiority, which, coupled
+with a somewhat hectoring manner, made him a man of uneasy temper for
+other men to deal with. And even that first night as we sat through
+supper, I found myself wondering how this person came to be related to
+the young Marquis of Tinmouth, than whom it would have been difficult
+to find a more sweet-tempered, modest and agreeable young man.
+
+They told us now more particularly of their adventures, taking the
+precaution to speak French while the servants were in the room, and
+gave us to understand that the country-people, in the districts through
+which they had passed, were all well-affected towards the King. Most of
+them, it must be owned, blamed the Earl of Mar for their misfortunes,
+and for the disastrous ending of our hopes; for they held a firm
+belief that King James could have recovered them from the troubles
+brought about by the Union, and caused Scotland to enjoy a peace and
+prosperity to which she had long been a stranger. The fugitives had
+been directed from one house or cottage to another, and the poor folk,
+as well as the rich, had, they said, given them ungrudgingly of their
+scant provisions, besides sheltering them from observation during the
+daylight.
+
+It was with a very thankful heart that Barbara laid her head upon her
+pillow that night, but for some time she could not sleep for joy of
+thinking of the safety of her friend, and wonder that the same roof
+should shelter them both. The rain still beat on the window, but she
+heeded it no longer, or only to give a passing thought of pity to any
+poor wanderers still abroad; and though she knew that in a day or two
+at most the dreaded parting must come again, she put the knowledge away
+from her as only the young can do, and hugged her present happiness
+close to her heart.
+
+On the following day we held a council as to the best manner of
+assisting our friends in their project of leaving Scotland. And though
+one would have thought that in the presence of his host, Colonel
+Bulkeley should have withheld his own opinion, and paid a graceful
+deference to what was proposed, I cannot tell you that it was so.
+Several times that gentleman contradicted my lord without apology, and
+was for insisting that his plan, namely, to go himself to Burntisland,
+and there charter a ship to carry them to France, was the best that
+could be thought on. This my lord denied, saying very truly that the
+Government was keeping strict watch on all the ports in the Forth, and
+in so small a place the risk he ran of being recognised was too great,
+and it was a relief to me when Betty very gently, but firmly backed his
+opinion.
+
+“You have placed yourselves in our care, sir,” said she with a smile,
+“and you must, if you please, leave it to us to get rid of you.”
+
+She spoke so sweetly that no man without rough discourtesy could have
+withstood her, and turning to my Lord Tinmouth she went on.
+
+“This, my lord, is our project. To send a trusted messenger to
+Edinburgh to acquaint Captain Straton of your lordship’s presence. He
+is in communication with all the honest seamen who traffic between this
+country and the Continent, and it is to him we must leave the final
+arrangements of your departure. The friend we have in view is one who
+has already aided the King’s Cause, and who, being often engaged in
+ordinary business for my father between this and Edinburgh, can go and
+come without suspicion being aroused.”
+
+“Madam,” said the young Marquis, when she had finished, “I am ready to
+put myself and my affairs in your hands, knowing well that your loyal
+and kindly concern for all the King’s friends will lead you to do the
+best you can for us, and I am sure that my uncle,” turning courteously
+to Colonel Bulkeley, “will be satisfied with any arrangements that you
+make.”
+
+The gallant Colonel was obliged for the moment to acquiesce and we
+heard no more of his objections at that time, but later we were told,
+both by Captain Straton and David Pitcairn, that he put forward many
+difficulties and found much fault even with those who were doing their
+best to be serviceable to him.
+
+The trusted messenger of whom Betty spoke was, of course, the faithful
+David, who, on arriving at the house the next morning, was informed
+of what had taken place, and readily consented to undertake the part
+allotted to him. Some days passed, however, before anything could be
+settled, for the authorities were very vigilant at that time to prevent
+the escape of any rebels, and the Marquis of Tinmouth was a prize
+worth capturing. Many projects were brought forward and abandoned, and
+several ships’ masters, being interviewed, either declined the job, or
+found themselves so closely watched that it was impossible for them to
+undertake it.
+
+You may be sure that Barbara, for one, did not chafe at the delay, for
+the presence of her lover in the house was like sunshine to her; and
+in the peaceful hours they spent together, the young love that was as
+yet but a tender plant was nurtured and cultivated between them, till
+it grew into the perfect thing that has comforted and beautified their
+whole lives. You must not forget that there was in our intercourse
+a strain of that pathetic doubt as to the ultimate fruition of our
+happiness, which chastened our joy and tinged it with a wild, sweet
+pain. We spoke of the future at times with confidence and faith, but
+would check ourselves sharply at the thought that it might never be
+ours. Still, for the most part, I think that the high spirits and
+hopes of youth forbade us to despair, and the shadow of parting for an
+indefinite time, while it wrung our hearts with grief, served to draw
+us more closely together, and make a grave and steadying back-ground to
+our present bliss.
+
+My dear Betty, who was in our confidence and greatly in sympathy with
+us both, spent her time in cultivating the acquaintance of my Lord
+Tinmouth, who, she assured me, amply fulfilled the expectations she
+had entertained of him. His manners were so modest and so charming, his
+conversation so sensible and diverting, as to make him a very pleasant
+inmate of the house. My Lord Sinclair found him also a companion to
+his mind, and was surprised at his knowledge of books, his youthful
+judgment, and his attention to business. In fact it would be impossible
+to describe the general favour he met with, from old and young of both
+sexes, for the qualities of his mind and person.
+
+We four spent many agreeable hours in Betty’s boudoir, while we ladies
+bent over our tambour-frames, and the gentlemen entertained us with
+an account of their adventures, or descriptions of the life in France
+and Holland. My Lord Tinmouth spoke one day, in his frank and boyish
+manner, of the match which was being arranged for him with a Spanish
+young lady of the highest quality and a great fortune, no less than the
+sister of the most noble Duke of Varagua. He told us that he had of
+course never seen the young lady, but was informed that she was pretty
+and amiable, and a portrait was being painted of her to send him for
+his gratification.
+
+Forgetting to whom I spoke, I raised my head sharply from my work.
+
+“And are you satisfied, my lord, to bind yourself for life to a lady
+whom you have never seen, and who may prove not at all to your taste?”
+
+“Why yes, madam,” he answered, smiling at me pleasantly: “the friends
+who have arranged the marriage are certain to have chosen well, and you
+must remember that the same doubt and uncertainty exist for Doña Inez
+as for myself. It is possible she may not be pleased with me.”
+
+“I think there is not much danger of that,” said Betty, looking at him
+very kindly, “and you forget, Barbara, _autre pays, autre mœurs_; young
+ladies in France and Spain are never allowed to choose for themselves
+in so weighty a matter as matrimony.”
+
+“Oh,” I sighed, with a look at my Anthony, who was watching me, “but I
+think it is by far the best way.”
+
+I saw a flicker of doubt pass over my lord’s young face, and his smile
+was a little wistful as he said, “It must be wonderfully pleasant, to
+be sure!”
+
+“Ay, but it has its disadvantages, my lord!” cried Betty, briskly.
+“Even young people are not always infallible. I prophesy that your
+marriage will be a very happy one, and I only wish I could think we
+might see you and Doña Inez together one day in Scotland.”
+
+“And I on my part, madam, can promise, that for any friend of yours
+who comes to Spain, my house will ever be open and my welcome of the
+warmest.”
+
+At last the summons came for our guests to be ready on the morrow,
+to go disguised into Edinburgh, and take up their abode in the house
+of a faithful servant of Captain Straton. The latter gentleman was
+indisposed, which added to the difficulties of the case; and being
+in great concern for the safety of the young Marquis (who, by the
+way, went by the name of Mr. Barnes), he spent many days and nights
+in nervous anxiety, till he could form a plan that would finally and
+quietly dispose of him and his friends. Our good David Pitcairn came
+and went, untired and undismayed, taking his commands from Betty as
+usual, making at the same time his own sagacious suggestions, and
+amply repaid for all his trouble by the kindness of her smile, and the
+gratitude in her eyes.
+
+The gentlemen were to cross the Firth under cover of the darkness,
+and my lord’s own boatmen were to row them over. My dear Anthony and
+I had made our adieux in private before the hour of starting, and
+nothing remained for us but the last embrace, a choking sigh, a few
+whispered words, and, on my part, I fear, some tears that would not
+be suppressed. The household, led by Betty, made no secret of their
+regret at parting with “Mr. Barnes,” who took leave of his host and
+hostess with words of the most courteous gratitude. We felt as sad as
+though parting with a long-loved friend, and for his sake even included
+Colonel Bulkeley in our affectionate lamentations. It was a still,
+moonless night. The three, accompanied by David, crept down the rugged
+steps to the water; and as we, watching from above, saw the boat,
+propelled by muffled oars in strong accustomed hands, steal out upon
+the black water and disappear in the darkness, I know not if Betty’s
+sigh or mine were the deepest.
+
+Three days later we hailed the return of David Pitcairn with relief.
+He had had orders from Betty to stay with our friends till the last,
+and early that morning he had seen them safe on board a Dutch ship,
+which sailed from Leith about one or two o’clock, and, as we learned
+later, landed them safely in Holland, from which they made their way to
+France. He did not forget to tell us that Mr. Straton had fallen under
+the spell of young “Mr. Barnes,” even as we did, while his dislike of
+poor Colonel Bulkeley appears to have exceeded our own.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVI
+
+BARBARA IS ACCUSED OF CRUELTY AND INDISCRETION
+
+
+The day after this we returned to Alva, bearing with us a request from
+my Lord Sinclair to his daughter Catherine, that she would come and
+make her abode with him in the meantime, and in the absence of his
+eldest son, help him in the management of his estate. This my lady,
+though greatly touched by the old gentleman’s trust in her, knew was
+impossible, for indeed her presence was required at Alva for many
+reasons, and she judged rightly that her first duty was to her husband
+and his affairs. So far as our own case was concerned things were
+growing easier, for after representing as strongly as she could, the
+wrongs she had suffered in the loss of cattle, fowls, and fodder, to
+those whose influence might be exercised in her favour, my lady was
+relieved of this burden in the surest way possible. Her brother-in-law,
+Mr. Haldane of Gleneagles, though strongly against the Rebellion, and
+keen about all measures for punishing the offenders, yet suffered his
+family affection to mitigate his severity in the case of Sir John’s
+family. It was by his means that General Cadogan was prevailed upon to
+grant a protection to my Lady Erskine to prevent her being plundered
+any further, and her nephew, Mr. James Haldane, arrived one day from
+Edinburgh to give notice of the same to Lord Rothes at Stirling Castle.
+This, as you can imagine, was a vast relief; and as the same privilege
+was extended to my Lady Jean at Bannockburn, and to Lady Keir, our
+hearts were set at rest on their account also.
+
+Now I must tell you that some time back, when she first began to have
+doubts of the wisdom and ultimate success of the Rising, my Lady
+Erskine had conceived a secret project which, with great good sense,
+she kept as much as possible to herself and a few friends. Since the
+Battle of Sheriffmuir the working of the Silver Mine had been given up,
+on account of the danger of discovery from any of Argyle’s men who then
+over-ran the hills. But after hearing from Sir John in the beginning of
+the year, my lady sent one day for Mr. Hamilton, and after pledging him
+to secrecy, and telling him she believed in his loyalty to her and her
+house, enough to trust him with an important matter, she divulged her
+plan for securing the riches of the Mine.
+
+She made him overseer of four miners (though up till now he had but
+superintended the smelting of the ore), and these he set to work in the
+mine, which work, being underground and well watched, was kept very
+private.
+
+As the ore was lifted it was stored in casks, hogsheads, or barrels,
+which were buried in a vast hole that my lady caused to be dug on the
+north-west side of the house just by the gate. They had managed in
+this way to hide some forty tons of ore, when one morning Mr. Hamilton
+appeared at the house to say that, so far as he could see, the vein
+they were working had given out, and he wished to know if Lady Erskine
+advised any further excavation to be made. As this would have entailed
+a good deal of expense, my lady, after consulting with Mr. Erskine,
+decided that at present the work should be given up, which she did with
+the more ease of mind that certain rumours had got abroad of untold
+riches to be found on Sir John’s estate. The great hole in the broad
+walk having attracted some attention, she made it known that ’twas only
+one of Sir John’s mad notions, which was not likely to be of much use,
+and this according with the country people’s opinion of my guardian’s
+projects, the gossip soon died down, and we hoped the danger was past.
+I believe that with the treasure they collected my lady had framed
+the notion of being able, when the time was ripe, to purchase Sir
+John’s full pardon from the King, and in this idea Mr. Erskine and Mr.
+Campbell encouraged her. It was necessary, however, to keep its very
+existence private, until all danger of the knight’s being attainted
+was past, seeing that, if his name appeared upon the Black List, his
+whole estate was forfeit to the Crown. In the event of this happening,
+my lady then designed to unearth the casks, and by disposing of the
+contents in a profitable manner, to be able to follow her husband to
+the Continent, where they might live comfortably with their children
+for the rest of their lives.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+About a week after our return from Dysart, I was walking one morning
+with little Hal down the glen, where by Heaven’s kind providence I had
+found my dear Anthony, when Mr. Hamilton met us, and accosted me with
+his usual cordiality. Now, to tell the truth, I had almost forgotten
+that I had ever had even a slight interest in this young gentleman;
+and though when we met we were friendly enough, my heart being fully
+occupied by the thought of another, it left me very indifferent to
+strangers. I was therefore surprised when he said rather abruptly,
+
+“I have something of a private nature to say to you, Mistress Barbara;
+can you not send the child away?”
+
+“What!” cried I, laughing, with no thought of what was coming, “have
+you a secret to divulge? Run, Hal, and gather some of those pretty
+anemones for Cousin Barbara.”
+
+“I suppose you have by now,” said Hamilton, “discovered the meaning of
+my words last summer as to your gaining wisdom about many things.”
+
+“Why, yes,” I answered slowly, thinking of all that I had gained since
+then, “I fancy we are all a year wiser.”
+
+“And sadder?” said he.
+
+“Ah, no!” I cried, softly, “not sadder.”
+
+“Are you then,” he exclaimed eagerly, “on the other side? Have you seen
+the folly of that mad attempt; do you realise the character of the man
+you imagined had come to rule us? Are you relieved at the issue of
+events? How glad I am, Mistress Barbara, to find you so sensible.”
+
+“Nay, sir,” cried I, quite startled out of my private thoughts; “I
+protest I do not understand you.”
+
+“Why, mistress,” said he, puzzled in his turn, “if you are not saddened
+by the failure of the Rising, it must needs be because you think it a
+lucky providence that it did not succeed. What else can you mean?”
+
+“The Rising! Forgive me, Mr. Hamilton, I was thinking of other things.
+But how,” said I, “can you possibly imagine that I am not grieved
+to the heart by the terrible happenings of the past six months, and
+bitterly disappointed at the departure of the King? Can I know of the
+sufferings and imprisonment of so many good friends, the deaths, the
+losses, the anxiety; can I watch my dear lady’s sad face day after day,
+with the knowledge of the pain she bears in her brave heart, and not be
+saddened myself? I should indeed be callous beyond belief were such a
+thing possible!”
+
+“Nay, madam,” he said, “I pray you to believe I had no such thought.
+I myself am grieved enough for the calamities that have been brought
+upon the country, both public and private; but I hoped that you did at
+last see how wrong and mistaken was the Rebellion, and what a miserable
+dastard is the man whom they sought to put upon the throne of Britain.”
+
+“Stop!” cried I, “I will not hear the King slandered. Misled,
+mismanaged, he certainly was, but dastard--no!”
+
+“But can you believe he would make a good king?” cried he. “Would not
+his accession plunge us into all the horrors of Romanism? You cannot
+deny, madam, that the Chevalier is a Papist at heart.”
+
+“Why, what else would you expect him to be?” cried I. “And Pretender
+as he is called, he has never pretended to be willing to give up his
+religion for the sake of a crown, as another might have done. He is
+honest, and devoted to his Church, as a good man should be; but he is
+no bigot either, for I have heard from Sir John that he has a very
+liberal and open mind towards his Protestant subjects, and I do not
+believe he would ever interfere with their religion were he reigning
+over us.”
+
+“I must beg leave to differ from you, Mistress Barbara,” replied
+Hamilton. “I have seen some friends who met the Chevalier in the north,
+and were bitterly disappointed in him. Did he not refuse to have
+_Grace_ said at his table by any but his own private chaplain, though
+there were both Presbyterian and Episcopalian clergymen present?”
+
+“Why,” returned I, “I think little of that. I doubt if his Hanoverian
+Majesty would tolerate the benediction of a Romish priest at the Royal
+table, though many of them are his subjects.”
+
+“Certainly he would not!” cried Mr. Hamilton. “’Twould be a monstrous
+wrong if he did!”
+
+“And if one man is to be upheld for his narrowness, because he acts
+from a sense of right, why not another?” cried I hotly. “Oh, I have no
+patience with such prejudice! This cry about Religions is used but to
+mask other things--politics, social ambition, party strife and personal
+rancour.”
+
+By this time, walking slowly, with little Hal running backwards and
+forwards round us, we had reached the garden, which lay bare and
+orderly in the sunshine, with only a few of the early spring flowers
+showing themselves in the borders. When I looked at Mr. Hamilton’s face
+after my last speech, I found he was smiling.
+
+“You are a brave and stout partisan, Mistress Barbara,” said he, “and
+I should find it difficult to move you. As it is, Providence hath
+ordained that the present dynasty be established in Britain--”
+
+“For the time being,” murmured I.
+
+“And we must needs bow to that decree,” he went on unheeding. “This,
+however, was not what I wished to talk of. Will you pardon me for
+allowing myself to wander so far from the subject at my heart, for
+indeed it is the chief thought in my life at present, and has been for
+long.”
+
+“Pray, go on,” said I, somewhat coldly, for I was ruffled by our
+discussion, and felt now more out of sympathy with my companion than
+before.
+
+“It is now a year since first I saw you, madam, and I make no secret
+of the fact that I was more struck by your appearance than by that of
+anyone I ever met. Since then all I have seen and heard of you confirms
+my first impressions. You are the most charming woman in the world,
+madam, and I beg you to be my wife.”
+
+Surprise, chagrin, and anger filled my breast, mingled with a certain
+shame that I should have permitted this man to go so far. I fear my
+reply was both pert and rude.
+
+“You must think a vast deal of yourself, sir, if you imagine you are
+worthy to be the husband of the most charming woman in the world!”
+
+He laughed good-naturedly; he was too dense to notice the disdain in my
+voice.
+
+“No one on earth is really worthy to hold that position, madam; but I
+beg you to believe that I shall count myself lucky should you dream of
+giving it to me.”
+
+“I fear,” said I shortly, “that that is impossible.”
+
+“Why impossible?” he cried, only half understanding. “My family, madam,
+is as good as yours; my present occupation is not to last for ever. I
+mean to establish myself well, and gain a position that even you will
+not disdain to share. Let me go to my lady this evening, Barbara, and
+get her consent to our union.”
+
+How different--ah, how different was this man’s wooing!
+
+“Pardon me, sir,” I answered, “I cannot be your wife. Oh, will you not
+understand and leave me in peace!”
+
+I spoke impatiently, for I wanted to be rid of him. He stood before me,
+his face very white and set.
+
+“Listen, Barbara Stewart,” he said. “There is more depending on your
+consent than you think. If you reject me thus you will regret it, not
+so much for your own sake as for some of the friends you love so well.
+Consider well, my girl, before you decide. You would not care to bring
+disaster upon this house. After to-day ’twill be too late.”
+
+Angry, but scarcely alarmed, I drew myself up.
+
+“Do you dare to threaten me, sir?” I cried. “What mean you? Or no, I
+do not care for your meanings; what you have said is enough. If you
+think Barbara Stewart would marry one who would stoop to injure any
+human-being of set purpose and design, you know her very little. I am
+indifferent to your threats, for I do not believe in your power to do
+much harm.”
+
+In scorn and indignation I turned away, and calling to little Henry I
+walked towards the house. James Hamilton followed.
+
+“Is it thus you despise an honest man’s love, mistress?” he said
+hoarsely. “Oh ho, my Lady Disdain, but the day may come when you will
+wish that you had listened more kindly. You think lightly of my power;
+you shall see by-and-bye what it can do. Barbara!” he said, and his
+voice broke as he laid his hand upon my arm. “You will not be so cruel!”
+
+“Sir,” said I, stopping and speaking more gently, “I have answered you,
+and I would beg you now to leave me. In that you have honoured me by
+your regard, I thank you. If I have hurt you, I ask your forgiveness;
+but a woman’s love is not to be won by methods such as yours, and I
+must own that your speeches this morning have put me greatly out of
+sympathy with you as a friend.”
+
+I looked in his face, but found it hard to read. There was an
+expression of regret certainly, mingled with discomfort and doubt; but
+my woman’s instinct told me well enough that behind this was no wounded
+heart of despairing lover, and not even his next words moved me to
+belief.
+
+“Then farewell, mistress,” he said in a low voice; “you have broken
+my life in two. Henceforth we go separate ways. Heaven grant you
+tenderness to know how cruelly you have used me!”
+
+Angered again by this accusation, I bowed to him without reply, and
+walked away towards the house with the child clinging to my hand.
+
+Seated at work next morning in the parlour, we were listening amused
+to the chatter of the little boys, when Charles gave a great sigh and
+exclaimed, “How I wish my papa would come home! I do weary to see him.”
+
+“So do I, too!” cried Henry, with a sigh to match his brother’s. “Tell
+me, mama, how many years is it since my papa went away?”
+
+My lady put down her work to pat the curly head at her knee, and sighed
+herself, though she laughed at the childish question.
+
+“The months are years to us who love him, are they not, Hal?” she said.
+“We must pray God to send him back to us very soon.”
+
+“I do,” cried Charles. “Last night I said in my prayers, ‘Please, God,
+let my papa come home before the trees are green.’ That will be very
+soon now, mama, will it not?”
+
+Just then came a knock at the door, and one entered to say that Mr.
+Hamilton waited without, desiring to speak to her ladyship.
+
+“Very well, bid him come in!” said my lady; but on hearing that he had
+something of a private nature to communicate, she rose with a perturbed
+look and hurried from the room.
+
+It was half-an-hour before she returned, and when she did so, ’twas
+with a vexed and ruffled countenance. She dismissed the children
+abruptly, and standing in front of me, cried,
+
+“Well, Barbara, do you know the mischief you have wrought?”
+
+Trembling and surprised, I dropped my needle and looked at her.
+
+“Madam,” I stammered, “I am sorry; but you know yourself, cousin, that
+I could not listen to Mr. Hamilton’s proposals.”
+
+“And yet you encouraged him; you led him to believe his suit was not in
+vain! You drew him on, only to have the triumph of rejecting him. Was
+this the part of a modest maiden, Barbara?”
+
+Wounded to the quick, and with the tears starting to my eyes, I yet
+answered her with some spirit.
+
+“If Mr. Hamilton has told you this, madam, he has done me great
+injustice. A year ago, I own, I wished him to admire me--foolish girl
+that I was, all new to intercourse with men--and accepted his small
+attentions with a kind of pleasure. But since our return from Dysart
+last October, I have never given him a look that he could construe into
+interest of the faintest sort. I beg you to believe, cousin, that Mr.
+Hamilton is a man it is not easy to flout. He thinks the whole world
+has as high an opinion of him as he himself has; and if he has made up
+his mind to establish himself in any woman’s favour, he would be so
+firm in the belief of his success that the news of his failure would
+come as a great shock to his pride.”
+
+I dried my eyes, for as I spoke my anger returned.
+
+“And even if his accusations were true, I take it, madam, that ’tis
+not the part of a chivalrous gentleman to blame a woman for his own
+conceited blunder. I have nothing but contempt for the man. I never
+wish to speak to him again.”
+
+“’Tis not likely that you will,” returned my lady, gloomily; “he leaves
+Alva to-day.”
+
+“Leaves Alva?” cried I. “But how can he go and abandon his work? How
+can he leave you alone?”
+
+“’Twill make it very uneasy for me,” she replied; “but there is no more
+to be said. He is like a man wrong in the head, and was neither to hold
+nor to bind, as the saying is. I talked till I was tired, but his mind
+was made up; he could not stay where he might see Mistress Stewart any
+day. His heart was broken, he repeated, his life spoiled.”
+
+“Pray, madam,” I entreated, “will you forgive me for my share in this
+new trouble, and say you believe I am not so much to blame! I cannot be
+happy to lie under such an imputation in your eyes. I regret more than
+I can say the annoyance it causes you, but I cannot heartily believe
+that Mr. Hamilton is so greatly afflicted as he pretends. All the time
+he was talking to me yesterday, I felt that his speech did not ring
+true; ’twas as if he were working himself into a passion to make an
+effect.”
+
+While I was speaking I was considering in my mind the wisdom of
+repeating to my lady the threatening language the man had used; but
+having no particular belief in it, and not wishing to disturb her
+unnecessarily, I held my peace. She pondered my last words for some
+time, and when she spoke again, her voice had lost its coldness.
+
+“Why, Barbara,” she said, “to say truth, I doubted the man myself. He
+was too violent, he talked too much. At first I was so put about at
+the prospect of his leaving me that I did not stop to reason, but now
+that I am calm again, I acknowledge you are right to despise the way
+James has behaved. So far as the Mine is concerned I can trust him to
+be silent, and for his work I have no doubt I shall find a successor.
+There is not much to be done at present in any case, so perhaps after
+all he will not be missed. Forget about him, child; he has taken
+himself out of our life in a pet. ’Tis not likely he will enter it
+again.”
+
+ * * * * *
+
+“Ah!” cried Betty when she heard of it, “do you not see now that I was
+right? Did I not warn you, Barbara, of what he was capable, and tell
+you to be on your guard with him? Well, thank heaven, he has done no
+harm, and as my sister says, I do not suppose we shall ever see him
+again. But, though I never liked the man, I am amazed, I must own, at
+his ingratitude.”
+
+And so James Hamilton departed from Alva, hiding his treachery under a
+very flimsy cloak, for, as you know, his love for Barbara was only a
+blind, and his despair a mere pretence to allow him to escape and work
+his wicked will.
+
+
+LETTER VII
+
+ I begin to be impatient to hear from my Dear Life. This is the
+ fourth letter I have writ, and I have got but one. If you are well
+ I am very happy, but I have many melancholy dreams about you which
+ is occasioned by anxious concern to have you easy in your mind, and
+ satisfied with your present state, which indeed is a great tryal but
+ such as God in His providence thinks fit to send us, and it is no
+ small mercy in so general a calamity that you are preserved and will
+ have what may make us live comfortably together. I must own it is not
+ easy for me to be at so great a distance from you, nor can I have any
+ prospect yet how soon I can be with you, until some settlements be
+ made in affairs here, which will take a considerable time. I am doing
+ in the meantime what is for your interest.
+
+ As for old W.’s work I am obligt to give it up yesterday, until we be
+ in a state of more freedom than we are at present, and people began
+ to suspect that there was something in it more than ordinary that I
+ continued it so long. My counsel determined me in doing so, and they
+ have some projects in vein to secure all. I hope they will not all
+ fail ... it’s lucky for us P.C. is at London, and will be there for
+ a great while. His wife is gone home to lye, and designs to take her
+ two eldest children to London with her against June.
+
+ Your mother is here and is very concerned about you, and is very
+ thankful you got so early off. In short, that supports her in all
+ the difficulties that occur, as it does me, for the violence cannot
+ always last, tho’ in the meantime it’s very hard upon those that are
+ in their hands. I am in great fear for J. Paterson, for I am told
+ that base wretch, Jock Muir, says his house was the place of their
+ meeting which makes his friends afraid. I pity my poor sister, and
+ when I think of her I think my own sufferings easy. In short I am
+ not to be pityed for anything but being absent from you, for your
+ friends have a particular regard and concern for me, and Charls omits
+ nothing that can be for your interest, and I believe your sister
+ Nell will make her spouse (Mr. Haldane) do all that’s possible for
+ you att Court, and I hear he is much in favour at present. But that
+ family distinguish themselves in violence at present, tho’ as to your
+ particular (case) I believe they will do all that’s possible. Your
+ nephew, James, was here the other day, and procured a protection for
+ my house and all things I am concerned in, which makes me easy. In
+ the meantime I believe there is some care taken to hinder your being
+ denounct, but I fear it will not doe, but if it could be done it
+ would be an advantage; but be it as it will there shall none of your
+ stockin’ be lost.
+
+ If your brother Robin come to Holland with his master, Charls has
+ some thoughts of coming there, and desiring you to meet them if you
+ can do it with safety. Some people here think it would be easy for
+ Robin’s master to procure your pardon, which I think should be done
+ if possible; tho’ you did not return to Britain for some time the
+ interest of your family and the present circumstances of your affairs
+ require it, but when your brothers and you meet you can talk freely
+ of that and other things.
+
+ Andrew (Argyle) has lost the command of the troops here, and Mr.
+ Beggar (Cadogan) has got it. I wish Andrew had known it sooner for
+ it’s talkt Beggar had it seven weeks before Andrew left this Country,
+ and yesterday Mr. Beggar went northwards. Perth, Aberdeen, and
+ Inverness are to be fortified. If the common people who are still
+ under arms will now come to surrender they are to be allowed to go
+ home, and I hear some of the Clans have done so. In that case their
+ Heads will doe well to take care of themselves.... Colonel Pary,
+ and Mr. Balfour have given up themselves, my Lord Rollo and several
+ others of like degree, which is very surprising. There came an order
+ to the common prisoners either to choose to stand their tryal or be
+ sold to the plantations. I hear that most have chosen rather to stand
+ their tryal than live slaves. Your fellow-travellers came south and
+ were taken care of. I doubt not you will hear of them soon. All our
+ neighbours are safe. Your boys are well and nothing shall be wanting
+ that’s fit for them; for their education I hop, one way or other, you
+ shall doe it to your own mind.
+
+ I am in great grief for Kid (the King) and your freind Mill (Mar),
+ tho’ I think he is the only cause for all my sufferings, but I find
+ he is blamed by all sides. How far it’s just I know not, but I shall
+ never blame him, tho’ in my heart I cannot but think he should not
+ have taken such an affair upon him without positive orders from Kid.
+ However, in the meantime, I could wish for your own sake you wold not
+ be near Kid or Mill, because that may be a hindrance to some projects
+ which we have in view; and since you may doe yourself and family
+ prejudice and can do them no service, it is but common prudence to do
+ so.
+
+ I long to hear from my Dearest Life. May you be happy always, and
+ remember the only way to be kind to me is to take care of yourself. I
+ got a proposal from my father to come to keep house to him, and bring
+ my boys with me, or he will come and board with me; but he wants me
+ to manage his estate in his son’s absence, both which proposals I
+ have rejected; and he says he will goe abroad. Where it will end I
+ know not.
+
+ Charles salutes you and Betty, and your sons offer their humble duty
+ to you, and
+ I am ever yours,
+ my Dearest Soul.
+
+
+LETTER VIII
+
+ _March 23._
+
+ MY DEAREST LIFE,
+
+ I received two of your letters this week which were
+ most acceptable, one without a date, and the last of the 16th of
+ March. By both I see all my letters have miscarry’d, which does not
+ a little vex me. You was not eight days out of Britain when I writ
+ first, and this is the fifth I have writ. I have been so lucky to
+ receive three letters from you, which is no small comfort; but by
+ your not receiving mine you have not drawn for 100 pound I desired
+ you to take from your factor, and that you should be straitened is
+ what I am very much afraid of. Pray doe not want what is fit for you,
+ for I hope in God I shall always have (means) to supply you till I
+ be so happy (as) to see you again, which is what I very much long
+ for; and my absence from you is the only suffering I have, but that
+ I ought to submit to with cheerfulness when you are well and out
+ of danger. I must own the thought of your safety has been a great
+ support to mee, and as to other particulars in my own affairs, the
+ grief and concern I had for others made me very easy about them, and
+ hitherto there has nothing happened in my little affairs that could
+ make me uneasy. I am still in my own house and looking carefully to
+ all things, and am so much of your mind, however dark things may look
+ at present, that both this place and the other (Cambuswallace) may
+ be possesst by you and yours, that I have planted trees this season,
+ and made up all the wants in your hedges, and shall not omit to doe
+ everything that can be for your interest.
+
+ Mr. R(ose) labours your own farms this year. As to your debts of all
+ kinds all care has been taken, and as I told you before not one can
+ lose a groat by you so you may be easy. My being so much a stranger
+ to your debts makes it a little uneasy, but a little time will put
+ that over. There is not a thing I doe were it never so trifling,
+ but I consult first whether my friend would approve of this; and I
+ daresay you would if you saw my actings approved of, the most part if
+ not all. Your brother has been twice here, and does in every respect
+ act the part of a kind friend, and does not omit the least thing that
+ can be either useful or agreeable to me.
+
+ I send you one enclosed from your mother. She is indeed a kind woman,
+ and tho’ she disapproves what you have done, yet she cannot bear to
+ have you blamed and reflected on, and is as cheerful as ever I saw
+ her, for she thinks there will be favour got one way or other, and
+ the family will be preserved. And she hopes this may be a means to
+ make you serious, which I pray God it may, for afflictions are not
+ sent in vain. I pray earnestly that we may all have the right use of
+ them, and that seeing the uncertainty of all human things we may seek
+ what is more lasting.
+
+ I am in hops our two good friends att London will not be in danger.
+ My poor sister writes they have few enemies, and if her spouse is
+ banished she will send for her children to goe with him. There is
+ many gentlemen given up themselves, which I wonder much at. I think
+ they have had no encouragement to do so. Your fellow-travellers
+ will be in their own country again by this time, and a great many
+ of your friends. Poor Polmaise is dead. All your servants are well.
+ Some people think the clans can keep out a year, others are afraid
+ of them. There is no accounts yet since Mr. Beggar went north. Your
+ servant, Andrew S----t, came safe here two months agoe; I writ to
+ you of him before, and desired to know if I should send him to you.
+ If anything can be done for you, it is not fit you be with Kid and
+ Mill; and since you cannot serve them, it’s but a reasonable prudence
+ not to give new provocations. P.C. is att London, and will not fail
+ to doe all that can be done, and your sister Nell’s spouse I hear
+ is much in favour. But they are very violent tho’ I doubt not their
+ good-will to you. Your children are well. There shall be nothing
+ wanting that’s fit for them, and as for their education, I hop you
+ shall do that yourself, for if ever I be put from this place, I’ll
+ come and bring them with me; but I must own I do not expect to leave
+ this place, and I rather think you will be allowed to return, for
+ things cannot always continue, as they have been violent long, so the
+ contrary may now be hoped for.
+
+ I blame you much that you do not tell me more of Kid, for I have a
+ great concern for him and great pity. As to my health I am rather
+ better than usual. The season is good, and I am much in the fields,
+ sometimes employed in business, and thinking on the unhappy state of
+ many different people at other times, and reflecting on the mercy’s
+ I daily meet with, which are such as I should never forget, for I am
+ not to be pitied for anything but my being absent from you, which if
+ I suffer patiently God may in a little time give me the comfort of
+ being with you again.
+
+ I think you should read much; I will recommend Monsieur Paskal’s
+ Thoughts to you, which I doubt not you will like. Wishing my dear
+ soul all manner of happiness, I am in all sincerity, Yours.
+
+ Your friend Bess salutes you kindly. Pray be so kind to me (as) to
+ take good care of your self, and write frequently when you see I doe
+ not miss one.
+
+ Apri. 4.
+
+
+LETTER IX
+
+ My Dearest Life,
+
+ I am uneasy you have never got any of my letters
+ and I am much afraid you are in want of money. I have writ six
+ letters since you left Britain, and in every one of them beg’d (you)
+ to cause your factor to draw upon his correspondent for 100 pound.
+ Pray do not want what is necessare nor be afraid of want, for I hop
+ we shall always have enough. I am told things have a better aspect of
+ late and I am hopfull our friends att London will be safe. As to the
+ fortunes, if things should come to the worst, I hop we shall still
+ have what will give us what is needful for Life. In the meantime I
+ am as easy at home as I can be when absent from you. I must own that
+ is the greatest part of my suffering but I dare not allow myself to
+ think of itt. When I consider how mercifully you have been preserved,
+ and that you have a good country and liberty, the sad state of many
+ good people has hitherto affected me so much, I thought myself happy
+ in comparison. Your friends have been very careful to doe me all
+ manner of kindness, and I am very sure I am to be as little pityed
+ as any in my state. I have had 3 of your letters which gave me great
+ comfort. I wish both of us may be thankful for every degree of mercy
+ we meet with, and submitt with chearfulness to what Providence orders
+ for us.
+
+ I was some time perfectly incapable of doeing anything being so much
+ overwhelmed with greif, but saw soon the folly and fault of giving
+ way to it, and am now doing all I can to be usefull to you in your
+ present circumstances. I hope God will bless my indeavors for I
+ shall endeavor to doe the best without anxiety which I have been too
+ long liable to. I shall be glad to hear you are well in your country
+ retreat, and are contented with your present state. Your mother has
+ been here, and writ to you in my last letter. She is both cheerfull
+ and easy. Her concern was great till you was gone, but she has none
+ now, for she does not doubt your family will be preserved and she
+ hopes this will make you good.
+
+ I told you in my last old W.’s work was given up; it went off, and we
+ thought it a good opportunity because of impertinent people talking,
+ and both Ch. and P.C. have several projects in vein to secure itt.
+ How or what way things will be no body can yett guess, but if you are
+ preserv’d I fear nothing. For your boys I have not the least concern
+ or fear they will ever want. They are young, and there may be many
+ changes before they are men.
+
+ I have planted trees and put all the hedges to rights, and shall not
+ fail to take all manner of care that nothing you have done be lost. I
+ find my Counsel think I have too much land in my own hand, and they
+ incline I should let out in Tenantry the place I do not live at. I
+ must own I think I have more to do than I can well manage, but I fear
+ you will lose all you have laid out, and it will not give so much now
+ to let it as it might do sometime afterwards; but I have no money
+ to lay out on improvements, but I would be glad to have your own
+ opinion. You will laugh at this way of writing, but I have some faint
+ hope you will never be attainted, having ’scapt the first brunt. You
+ will hear many of your friends is gone to Holand, some are yet in
+ this country.
+
+ I hear Rob Roy’s house is burnt and his cattle caryed off by a party.
+ He thought fit to wait for them in a wood, and, they talk, has killed
+ a great many. I am sorry for it. I have heard nothing of Mr. Beggar,
+ but nobody doubts but he will have work enough this summer.
+
+ Pray write often and oblige me, for all you have writ comes very safe
+ to my hand. I told you before P. C. is att London, and I believe you
+ may have no doubt but he will serve you. I hear his friend, Andrew,
+ is very great at Court and is a great Countryman. I hope God will
+ bless their endeavors.
+
+ I am angry you never mention Kid or Mill for I have a great desire
+ to hear of them, but I do not wish you to be with them in case it
+ would stop what your friends is earnest to have done for you here.
+ Your boys are well and want much to see you, and ask me how many
+ years it is since their Papa went away. Dearest Life, wishing you all
+ happiness.
+ Adieu.
+
+ Apr. 13.
+
+ I am very well in my health.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVII
+
+SHOWS HOW SLOWLY THE TIME PASSES WHEN THE HEART IS HEAVY
+
+
+You will notice, I have no doubt, a great sameness in these interesting
+letters, and frequent repetitions of the sentiments and facts they
+contain. The reason of this, as you will readily understand, was the
+fear my lady had that Sir John might not receive them, so that she
+felt compelled to inform him of whatever interested them most in every
+epistle she penned. It would be easy to curtail them, giving you only
+extracts, and so save you the tedium of reading the same things so
+often; but in reproducing them as they were writ I feel that I am only
+doing justice to my dear lady’s memory, for by this means alone can
+you, her descendants, realise the weariness of her life, the flagging
+of her hopefulness, the constant burden that weighed on her mind during
+those long, monotonous weeks. Her spirits, as you will see, varied, as
+a woman’s are apt to do with her varying moods. Some days she would
+be full of cheerfulness, saying that an end to all our troubles must
+soon be coming, and busying herself with her affairs as if her beloved
+husband were returning to Alva the very next week; at other times she
+would be heavy and sad, moving about the house in silence, and only
+by a great effort making answer to those who conversed with her. The
+news of Sir John’s safety and freedom did indeed lift a weight from her
+heart, and for some days she even laughed and sang as she made herself
+busy in her usual way; but this lightness could not long be maintained,
+and the prospect of seeing her husband grew more and more uncertain.
+
+Our fears for the good old Colonel and his son, still prisoners in the
+Fleet, were now allayed as nothing could be found against them, and
+there seemed to be every hope that after a time they would be released.
+Mr. Patrick Campbell, our kind and constant friend, had means of seeing
+them frequently, and kept my lady informed of their welfare.
+
+The news of the escape of the brave old Brigadier Mackintosh and
+several of his friends from Newgate, which reached us some time in
+May, was hailed with triumph, not unmixed with amusement, when we
+learned that this sturdy veteran had knocked down his gaoler with his
+fists; and after disarming the sentinel, they opened the gates and let
+themselves out into the streets, afterwards escaping (save one or two
+who were unluckily recaptured) to France. Some weeks later occurred the
+escape of Colonel Walkinshaw of Barafield from the Castle of Stirling,
+which we learned enraged the Earl of Rothes very much. But these things
+are matters of history, you will say, and enter not into our story.
+
+And all this time it may be asked where was Sir John and how was he
+faring?
+
+Excellently well, if we may believe the hints given us in the few
+extracts of letters from him which I have seen, and the scraps of news
+about him, confided to me at the time by my lady, and entered in my
+little day-book.
+
+You will see that his faithful wife believes that he is living
+quietly and privately, with no thought of further entangling himself
+in the King’s affairs; but she constantly urges him to leave the
+neighbourhood of his Majesty and the Earl of Mar, in order to prove
+to the authorities at home that he truly repents him of his misdeeds,
+and is therefore a fit subject for the clemency of King George. And
+all the time if we had but known it, Sir John was busily engaged in
+furthering his master’s interests by every means in his power, although
+I am certain he did not contemplate bringing disaster upon his wife and
+family.
+
+In the beginning of April, he, accompanied by his brother-in-law, left
+Paris by water-coach for a town called Auxerre, which was finally
+reached in a covered cart. From there, as it was quite out of the way
+of diligences or even ordinary post-road, they hired horses to ride
+to Beaune, a small village in a wine-growing district from which was
+obtained the excellent _vin de Pomar_, or _Beaune_, which is still
+famed among the wines of Burgundy. In one of his letters Sir John tells
+my lady how he drinks her health daily, though abstemiously, in this
+cheap and pleasant beverage; he also gives an amusing account of Mr.
+Paterson’s difficulties with the French language, the latter being
+almost a stranger to its use.
+
+After about three weeks in this place, Sir John, upon the King’s
+summoning him, repaired to Avignon where his Majesty held his meagre
+court, and from then onwards through the summer his time seems to have
+been occupied with political affairs. This, as you are aware, he kept
+from my lady’s knowledge, but rumours reached her from time to time
+through other sources, which greatly disturbed her and kept her in a
+state of constant anxiety.
+
+“What,” she said to me once, “is the use of all our endeavours to
+obtain Sir John’s pardon, and prevent his being attainted, if he
+continues to mix himself up in the affairs of the poor King? I cannot
+see that one man’s help, or the want of it, can make much difference
+at the present juncture; and I am convinced that if my husband were
+free to confide his private affairs to his Majesty, he would be told to
+consider his family interests rather than continue any longer in this
+employment.”
+
+“Perhaps the story of Sir John’s being sent to Spain is false,” said I,
+to comfort her.
+
+“Oh, ’tis very like!” she answered, “people must always be talking.
+But it shows us, Barbara, what I have ever felt, the strong difference
+between men and women. Were my dear life to express the lightest wish
+regarding my conduct, would I not hasten to do it, no matter how cross
+it might be to my inclination? But not all my pleadings, I fear, will
+have any effect on Sir John to make him alter his present way of
+living.”
+
+“Ah, madam!” I cried, eager as ever for my guardian’s justification,
+“’tis a hard thing to be torn by divided duties, especially when
+affection bears a part in each. But I do fervently believe our
+good Sir John will decide to give up the King, if this is the only
+alternative, rather than bring you and your children to misery.”
+
+“Would to God he would hesitate no longer!” she cried. “He may make up
+his mind too late, and end by falling between two stools, as the saying
+is.”
+
+“There is still,” she went on after a while, “the hope of help from his
+brother, Robin, who is very great with his master. I think ’twould be
+easy for him to move the Czar to ask for Sir John’s pardon; but this,
+as you know, would not alter the inclination of the Parliament if they
+were determined to have him attainted, and my fear is, that believing
+him still a servant of King James, they may hasten to do it. I pray God
+to have us all in his keeping, and order everything for our good; but
+my heart at times is very heavy, Barbara, and the waiting is long.”
+
+It was about this time that the little boys fell ill with the
+chincough, or whooping-cough, and though at first it seemed they were
+both to get pretty easy off, the trouble increased, and little Hal
+especially was brought very low. Fortunately the weather was mild and
+almost summer-like, though but the beginning of May, so that there was
+every chance for the children in that particular, and with Phemie’s
+care and skill to depend on, my lady did not allow herself to be unduly
+agitated about them. Still she was an anxious and tender parent, and
+the sight of her youngest child, with white face and heavy eyes,
+oppressed and spent after a fit of the cough, caused her many a pang, I
+trow, for to have anything serious happen to her precious little sons
+in the absence of their father, would have well-nigh broken her heart.
+
+Early in this month Betty was obliged to go back to Dysart, intending
+as she said to return very shortly, but this, as events turned out, she
+was unable to do. Old Lady Alva was still with us, as kind and pleasant
+a dame as it would be possible to find. Her cheerful, placid spirit was
+of the greatest benefit to her daughter at this time, and though she
+interfered in nothing that was being done, she was ever ready to give
+her help and advice when asked.
+
+As for Barbara, she had been made happy by receiving a letter from her
+friend, Mr. Fleming, who was safely arrived in France, and was now
+staying with some good friends of his father’s in Paris. He had great
+hopes, he said, of getting his pardon, through his parent’s friends
+in the Government, and was already contemplating falling in with his
+father’s suggestion that he should get him employment in the service of
+the East India Company. As this would entail his leaving Britain and
+living in a distant land for the most part of his life, he thought it
+proper to advertise me of his prospects, and get my mind on the matter.
+
+Glad and relieved as I was to know him safe and well, this news, as
+you can imagine, threw me into some agitation, for it implied the
+readjustment and arranging of my whole life, and my woman’s heart
+trembled at the notion. There is surely nothing in life so wonderful
+nor so beautiful, if we regard it rightly, as the simple trust
+displayed by a young maid in giving up herself to the sole care of the
+man she loves, forsaking all other to cleave to him, leaving friends
+and home and childhood’s scenes to accompany him to any corner of the
+globe, the future all unknown, alone, but for him, in the whole world.
+And yet I suppose that ever since Rebecca, trusting only to hearsay,
+came willingly to Isaac, it has been the way of women, and ordered by
+God; and men too often, I fear, regard it as a natural proceeding, and
+the faith that it implies no more than their due.
+
+However that may be, I did not feel it would be right to attempt to
+dissuade Mr. Fleming from falling in with his father’s wishes; for
+nothing was nearer to my heart, as you may guess, than the desire to
+stand well in the eyes of my Anthony’s parents, so that they might find
+nothing of which to disapprove in their dear son’s choice. He begged
+my permission and that of Lady Erskine, to make them acquainted with
+our mutual love, so that, upon his obtaining his pardon, our betrothal
+might at once be made public.
+
+To this, my lady, after consulting with Mr. Erskine (who was again at
+Alva), gave her consent, but added that in the event of Mr. Fleming’s
+going to the Indies, she must beg, for the sake of my youth, that he
+should not insist upon my accompanying him. In three or four years’
+time, she said, I would be of age, and being older, more fit to hold my
+own against the extremities of the Eastern climate; Mr. Fleming also
+would be accustomed to the country, and more fit to make me comfortable
+in my new life when I went out to him.
+
+I cannot say that Barbara, young, impulsive and not too patient, at
+once agreed to her kind friend’s proposals. Indeed it took some days of
+consideration and counsel to bring her to reason, and some nights of
+sleepless anxiety and not a few tears, before she could bring herself
+to face the prospect with equanimity. The sorrow of parting, the long
+absence from each other, the distance that would separate us, and the
+dangers and risks of the long voyage--all these combined to make a
+burden that was not easy to carry. But of this I said very little in
+my reply to my lover, knowing that his own heart would understand it
+too well. I only stipulated very strongly that I should see him once
+more, and talk over everything with himself, before his departure from
+Britain.
+
+And so with hopes and fears the days were intermingled, and the summer
+was at hand, and the trees were growing green, but there was no word
+yet of Sir John’s coming home.
+
+
+LETTER X
+
+ I think it very hard I can never hear my Dearest Life has got any
+ of my letters, tho’ this is the seventh I have writ, and in every
+ one desired you to draw a bill for 100 pounds. Your not doeing it
+ makes me conclude you have never got one, and since you left Paris
+ I have never heard from you at all. I must own my hearing from you
+ so seldom is a great uneasiness and occasions me many fears, tho’
+ I must own I should trust to the kind providence of God who has
+ hitherto wonderfully preserved you. All things as to the settling the
+ affairs of this unhappy country are still undetermined, and our own
+ countrymen cannot agree about it, which is our misfortune. What will
+ be the issue God knows, but we are not without fears of hard usage,
+ nor altogether without hop that in time they may relent and use us
+ more Christianly.
+
+ I hear of our friends att London frequently. I am hopful they are in
+ no danger as to their lives, and it’s generally talkt there will not
+ be much more blood taken. In the meantime I am living very easyily at
+ home managing as formerly, but have enough to do to keep all right,
+ and have great difficulty in getting up the rents, tho’ care must be
+ taken to pay the annual rents and prevent diligencies being done. I
+ am very lucky in two friends which take much of the burden off me,
+ and all is done that can be in the present circumstances. I am easy
+ in everything in comparison to the anxious care and concern I have
+ about your person, and the different thoughts you will have upon not
+ hearing what state I am in.
+
+ Your boys has had the chincoch but are better. The season here has
+ been extraordinary, for since the breaking of the storm there has
+ not been an ill day; the fields are much frequented by me, and how
+ to manage my ground to the best advantage is much my study. I shall
+ not fail to observe as much as possible all you have done in both
+ places....
+
+ Some of your friends are so unjust (as) to blame me for your going
+ out, and the reason they give for it is I should have acquainted the
+ Government with your design. But since I am innocent and never did
+ anything but what was my duty with regard to you, I must let them be
+ saying and bear that with other things. I cannot frame a notion to
+ myself what state we will be in, but in the general I have no fears
+ of want, and I am sure nobody will lose by you. These things I have
+ good ground to believe, let things come to the worst; but the longer
+ things are of being settled the longer I shall be deprived of the
+ happyness of seeing you, for my being here is absolutely necessare
+ till we see the utmost and procure something by help of friends for
+ me and my children if they do go to the Height of Rigour.
+
+ I have no other work in hand without doors but plowing, this two
+ months past, for some impertinent folks was like to be uneasy, and
+ P. C. is at London who has several schemes in vein; whether any will
+ succeed at this present juncture I cannot guess, but Providence will
+ preserve you and all your concerns, I hop, in spite of all your
+ enemies. All your friends here are well, some blaming you and others
+ pitying you, but all your near relations will do for you what lyes
+ in their power. Your sister Ca. has a son call’d after her father;
+ I am going to see her this week. I am very impatient to hear from
+ you. The three letters you writ before you left Paris came safe to my
+ hand, but I have had none since. My health is pretty good considering
+ how many difficult things I have to disturb me, but if you be
+ preserved I hop to get over all other difficulties in time.
+
+ As to the clans they are all coming in and giving up their arms.
+ There is none of your neighbourhood given up themselves.
+
+ Betty salutes you, and I am Dear, Soul, in all sincerity, May 1st.
+
+ Yours.
+
+
+LETTER XI
+
+ It is but three day since I wrote to my Dearest Life, but haveing
+ had the pleasure of one from you last night of 15 of Ap., new stile,
+ by another hand, I am resolved to lett no opportunity slip, hoping
+ that some one of my letters may come to your hand. This is the
+ eighth I have writ, and tho’ by your last you tell me you had not
+ heard from me, I am hopful they are not all mis-carryed, but by your
+ leaving Paris they are longer a-coming to your hand. It is no small
+ satisfaction to me that you are well and at freedom, and the thoughts
+ of it support me under every other difficulty. Tho’ I must own the
+ common misfortune has been so greivous that I cannot express it,
+ and then every particular person that I ever knew or heard of makes
+ deep impression upon me, so that I was not capable of having a right
+ thought. But after some time I found I could not live after that way,
+ and made myself incapable to serve you. I resolv’d to imploy myself
+ in doing in your affairs what was fit in the present juncture, and as
+ the old saying is, indeavour to make the best of an ill bargain. But
+ I have been many days without speaking, except when business obligt
+ me to it.
+
+ I told you in my last our friends att London are well, and we are
+ not afraid of their lives being in danger. What will come of all the
+ misfortunate people God knows, but many have foolishily given up
+ themselves and Glengary among the rest, who is now at Perth. It’s
+ talkt they are all to be tryed. I am still at home managing after
+ the old manner but with many difficultys, being perfectly a stranger
+ to your debts, and every frikish body arresting the rents, and one
+ difficulty no sooner off but another occurs; but I doubt not to get
+ over all these, and in time, which it’s probable I will have now, if
+ the Parlyment rise soon as it’s expected, without any more bills of
+ attainder, to get this year’s rent. Your farms are plowed and the
+ last of the Barley sow’d this day. I may ask you when you was so soon
+ done. There has been no other work without doors for two months past,
+ because upon many reasons it was inconvenient. I have planted trees
+ here, and if things go tolerably easy I intend to plant both here and
+ in the other place in the latter season. I tell you all this that you
+ may not think I despair of your having peaceable possession of your
+ own, tho’ I cannot yet see by what means. We hear of an interview of
+ many crown’d heads, and some people think your pardon may be easily
+ obtained by your Brother, the Dr., and his master’s means, but if
+ ever you obtain it that way, your abode must be in another place. Ch.
+ has some thoughts of going over to see his Brother, and wold appoint
+ you to meet him if ye could do it with safety. I must own if it be
+ practicable for your friends to obtain a pardon, you should accept of
+ it, however cross it may be to your own inclination. Consider your
+ children and me, and prevent the utter ruin of your family. And I
+ daresay neither Kid nor Mill will think it wrong for you, since you
+ cannot serve them in your present circumstances, to doe what is so
+ material for your interest.
+
+ Your boys have been very ill of the chincoch but are better. I hope
+ they will get over it very soon.... I expect to see Ch. soon here.
+ P. C. is at London, and your sister, Nell, is gone to the Bath. All
+ your friends are well. The uncertainty of my letters coming to your
+ hand makes me say less than I incline. Pray draw for money when you
+ please, but it seems you are in no want, for you never mention it.
+ Wishing you, my Life, all manner of happyness, I am in all sincerity
+
+ _May 4th._ Yours.
+
+
+LETTER XII.
+
+ I received one from my Dearest Life of the 17 Ap. which was most
+ acceptable. I am sorry you should be in such pain and uneasyness by
+ your not hearing from me, and I should never forgive myself if I had
+ occasioned it by my neglect, but I assure myself you will not think
+ me capable of omitting anything than can contribute to your quiet.
+ This is the tenth letter I have writ and all different hands, in
+ hops some wold be so lucky (as) to come your length. I have had the
+ pleasure of getting all yours, which I reckon no small mercy. I have
+ told you in all my letters to be easy about me and your children;
+ wee have what is necessare for us, and I have good ground to think
+ will always have; let things come to the worst we will have enough
+ and what we ought to be content with, in so general a calamity. My
+ greatest suffering is being absent from you; but when I think upon
+ the danger and imprisonment of many others, some of (them) my good
+ friends, I dare not complain. I must own your being at freedom and
+ out of the hands of your enemies, has supported me under the many
+ difficultys, and if you are well and easy in your mind, I shall
+ endeavour to submit chearfully to whatever God in his providence
+ shall order; and very often the fears of what may happen is greater
+ than the suffering itself, as I doubt not is the case with the
+ most part of the distrest people at this time. The delay and the
+ uncertainty occasions the most dreadful apprehensions their fancy can
+ suggest. Tho’ at other times I was too ready to put the dark side of
+ the cloud to my view, yet I think it’s impossible things can long
+ continue in so violent a way. I doe very much regret the suffering of
+ Kid and your freind, and of all the rest in generall; but God in his
+ wise providence has ordered it, and his visible hand in disappointing
+ all our hops should make us wait his time with patience, and
+ indeavour to make the best use of so great afflictions, which is most
+ justly sent us as a punishment for our many faults and abuses of many
+ mercys; and if this thought would make us live better lives, it’s
+ very probable our time of suffering might be shortened.
+
+ I am still at home managing after the old manner, have labour’d both
+ your farms, and getting in rents, tho’ with great difficulty. There
+ is nothing omitted that can be done for your interest, and I am very
+ lucky in two freinds who do all for me that’s in their power.
+
+ You are not yet attainted, and I hop will not be this session of
+ Parlyment; but I am afraid if you continue in that place where you
+ are now it will make them more violent, and tho’ your being in
+ another place will not be so agreeable to you, yet I persuade myself
+ you will cross your own inclination since you can do your friends no
+ service, and may ruin your family. I doe not let anybody know where
+ you are because I have some hop, with the help of Dr. Robin, your
+ brother, and his master, to get your pardon, that you may be allowed
+ to come home and live quietly. I believe the first thoughts of this
+ kind will be very disagreeable to you; but consider mee and your
+ children and every particular circumstance, and then I am sure you
+ must be of my mind. This is the opinion of those friends that did not
+ condemn your going out, and have your interest as much at heart as
+ their own. I wold not wish you to doe a mean or dishonorable thing,
+ and I am sure were it fit to be free with Kid and Mill in every
+ particular they wold desire you to accept, if ever that pardon could
+ be obtained by your freinds. Pray, write freely to me your opinion in
+ this particular, for I have greater fears you will not accept than
+ that itt will not be obtain’d, and if you are positive against itt I
+ will never attempt itt. I heard from London you was gone a message to
+ Spain, but they must always be talking.
+
+ I am doeing no work without doors just now. All our plowing is over
+ some weeks agoe, and our work is all laid aside except such as is in
+ and about the House. I have planted trees this season, and design to
+ plant them in the latter season.
+
+ Your children are just such as you wold wish them, very good-humor’d.
+ I am getting one to teach them. They have both the chincoch, but I
+ hop the worst is over. My friend, Bess, has left me. Your mother is
+ here just now; she is very concern’d about you, but has no such fears
+ for the family as I have seen her have for a trifle.
+
+ I cannot yet have any vein how or what way I am to doe; but if once
+ things were settled, if you doe not get home, I will certainly come
+ to you and bring my young folks with me, which will not doe so well
+ as that I mention in the other side. In the meantime, hope the best,
+ take good care of yourself, and let me hear frequently from you.
+
+ I writ in all my letters to make your factor draw for money on his
+ correspondent at Edinr. for your use. I hop I shall have to supply
+ you what you have use for. As to your servants, they have all been
+ here since you left the country, and Andrew came safe, so you need
+ not be uneasy. As to your debts of all kinds, due care is taken that
+ no body lose by you, and nobody can lose a grott. I wish everybody
+ had the same mitigations of their sufferings that I have; but the
+ hearing of the necessities of others, and not being in a condition to
+ help them, touches me very sensibly, which makes me wish I could be
+ far from hearing itt. Wishing you all manner of happyness, I am, my
+ Dearest, in all sincerity, Yours.
+
+ May 14.
+
+
+LETTER XIII
+
+ I received yours of the 26th of Ap., which my Dearest Life may
+ imagine was most acceptable to know you had once got some of my
+ letters, and that you was easy in your mind upon that score, which
+ you have all the reason in the world to be. You was much to blame
+ that (you) did not mention money in any of your former letters,
+ because if I had known the maner of sending money, you had got it
+ long ere now. Having some money att London, I have ordered your
+ Bill of 50 pounds that you have drawn to be pay’d there, and shall
+ write to my freind there to remitt the other 50 after the best and
+ cheapest manner. For all the money I could raise here out of your
+ estate, and otherways by the help of friends, will not satisfy uneasy
+ Debtors for annual rents and principal sums to prevent diligences
+ being done, and itt is done in such maner that the money laid out
+ that way will stand good upon the worst event that can happen. But if
+ you will please to let me know what sum you incline to have soon, it
+ shall be had as far as either your freinds or my credit can goe. In
+ a little time we hop to have your affairs put in a clear way, which,
+ so soon as it is done, you shall know, and shall be dispos’d of by
+ your order, or as you think most proper. Ch. A(reskine) is here just
+ now, and is thinking and laying out himself on every way that seems
+ most for your interest; and it’s his opinion, and it seems to him
+ the only way to make your affairs easy, to abstract yourself from
+ your freinds for some time, by which means you may scape the fury and
+ rage of the folks in present power; for you’ll not doubt but they
+ have good intelligence who are with, or makes their abode with----.
+ Nor is it impossible in a little time you may be at more freedom,
+ with less harm to your family, not being yet attainted, which gives
+ us a Breathing to put things in a better way. Your remaining at a
+ certain place will no doubt hasten a sentence which will put us out
+ of all capacity of medling with anything that belongs to you, but by
+ indirect and not so successful methods. So as you regard your own
+ interest and my quiet I expect your complyance in this matter; and if
+ it were not absolute necessity, you may be assured I wold not ask you
+ to cross your own inclination in anything, and much less in taking
+ you from company that must be agreeable to you in a strange country.
+
+ If you have got the rest of my letters you will know that Mr. Nabit
+ does not imploy old W. or any of his profession at present, because
+ it was likely to prove uneasy.... It is yet impossible to tell what
+ money Mr. Nabit will be worth; his reputation among the common sort
+ is so high that nobody credits it.... Your youngest boy is brought
+ very low with the chincoch which fears me, but I hope with tender
+ care ... he will get the better of it, for ye know I am easily
+ alarm’d. Nothing shall be wanting, and I hope in God the children
+ shall be preserved while they are under my care, and will give us
+ all a happy meeting which is the thing in the world I most earnestly
+ wish.... Your mother is here. She writ you some time agoe, and till
+ she knows that is come to your hand she will not write again. I am
+ pretty much imploy’d, which keeps me from thinking so much as my
+ temper and present state does incline me ... I heard from London last
+ Post. There can be no evidence got against our two friends that is in
+ the Fleet, which is no small mercy. Bess is at home, but will return
+ here. Be sure to write freely your mind as it comes in your head of
+ anything you would have done, and you will always find those two
+ friends I formerly mentioned and myself devoted to serve you in every
+ respect.
+ I am, Dr. Life, in all sincerity
+ Yours.
+
+ May 20.
+
+
+LETTER XIV
+
+ It is three weeks now since I heard from my Dearest Life and I begin
+ to be very impatient. I expect to hear from you every fortnight, and
+ when I doe not I am apt to fancy you are either gone some message, or
+ are not well, for all your friends in the Government has had you gone
+ to Sweden; and if I had not heard from your self I should have been
+ too ready to believe it. Your friend P. C. writ to me from London. He
+ was not a little uneasy he had not heard from you, by which I reckon
+ he has writ to you. I writ three posts ago to desire him to remit the
+ other 50 pound I mentioned in my last, and did incline to send more,
+ but as I told you at this term all had enough to doe. But I doubt not
+ in a little time to have more money at London for the effects are
+ gone from this, and it will be cheaper to send it from thence; and P.
+ C. being to stay there for a long time, when you think fit write to
+ him and he will be sure to answer you, for I doubt not he has let you
+ know how to direct him.
+
+ I have hitherto been pretty lucky in my little affairs, and in a
+ little time we will give you a good account of them, if they let me
+ alone from Bills of Attainder. I wold be glad to know your opinion
+ whether it’s proper for your Brother R. to cause his master interpose
+ with the present powers now when they are to have an interview,
+ or in what manner he should doe it; whether to ask a gift of your
+ Life-Rent, and a little article put in to secure all to yourself,
+ tho’ you did not come home for some time, for I fear you wold not
+ incline; but whether you do or not you will live the better (if) your
+ estate be secured. I am sure so far you will be of my mind, and if
+ this Act of Parlyment pass and you be attainted, no body can be sure
+ of anything; and it excluded the payment of all debts since the 24 of
+ June last, so that both for your own sake and others, if so fair an
+ opportunity offer it should not be neglected, and if it be agreeable
+ to you, and you signify your opinion to Charles, he will go over to
+ Holland on purpose. This I have often heard him say. I have writ to
+ you on this subject before, so, as soon as you can, let me have your
+ opinion.
+
+ Your nephew, James Haldane, is to be resident at that court where
+ your Brother R. is so great. Your mother is still here, and tho’ we
+ are of very different sentiments, we live in good friendship and
+ easy. Your boys are now perfectly recovered, which is no small mercy
+ to me, and if my Dearest is well and easy in his mind, I have more
+ than I deserve. Our friends are still in the Fleet, and there can be
+ no evidence got against them.
+
+ I must confess when I walk abroad and remember all your different
+ projects, and how pleased I have been to find you in some of these
+ walks, I cannot help being uneasy till I think you are at liberty
+ and well, and luckyer as to other circumstances than the most part
+ of people, then I blame myself for unthankfulness. Your old freind
+ Barafeild made his escape out of the Castle of Stirlin last week,
+ which enrag’d the new Governor very much. I shall be obligt to see my
+ father this week; but I cannot persuade myself to visit these great
+ folks, tho’ it certainly is fit for me to keep in with all, and they
+ profess great friendship for me and regret for your family, tho’ none
+ for yourself. I can at some times be a politician, so at present I
+ think interest will prevail with me to keep in with all.... Be so
+ kind to write frequently, for it’s impossible to express my anxiety
+ about you. Dearest Life, I am ever
+
+ June 4. 1716. Yours.
+
+ I am healthyer than you or anybody could expect.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVIII
+
+TELLS OF THE GOOD FORTUNE FOR BETTY, AND OF THE EVIL DEEDS OF THE
+PARLIAMENT
+
+
+Towards the end of May my lady, becoming alarmed at the weakness of her
+youngest son, determined, though somewhat against her inclination, to
+send him and his brother to their grandfather’s house for the benefit
+of the sea-air and the change. Not being at liberty just then to leave
+Alva, she arranged that the little boys should go in charge of myself
+and Phemie, knowing that every care would be taken of them, and that
+all love and attention would be shown them to make up to them for her
+absence.
+
+It was a great pleasure to me to revisit Dysart, where I had always
+met with such kindness; and little Charles, delighted as children are
+at the prospect of a change, skipped and shouted on his way to the
+carriage with no thought of regret at leaving his mother behind. When
+Phemie would have rebuked him for his seeming heartlessness, my lady
+merely smiled and bade her pay no heed.
+
+I found my dear Betty looking brighter and happier than I had seen her
+for many months, and though I could find no cause in my own knowledge
+to account for the change, I must confess I took great pleasure in the
+same.
+
+A light broke in upon my denseness, however, when I found that scarce
+a day passed without a visit from my Lord Wemyss, who on some pretext
+or other generally found opportunity to put himself in Betty’s way.
+Sometimes he came to bring her a flower grown in his garden, sometimes
+to consult with my lord on this subject or that, sometimes, I used to
+think, merely to tell us what a fine day it was; but, whatever the
+excuse, he made himself prodigiously agreeable when he came, and though
+Betty never suffered me to move from her side during his visits, I
+noticed that while she still sharpened her wit against him in playful
+scorn, she treated him with more gentleness and kindness than I had
+ever seen her use before.
+
+The weather was now most beautiful, and as much as possible we spent
+the days out of doors. Charles from the first showed himself perfectly
+recovered from his ailment, and very soon little Hal showed signs of
+picking up strength; and from watching with languid interest from
+Phemie’s arms his brother’s gambols, began to desire to join in them,
+and from day to day made rapid progress towards complete recovery.
+’Twas a great pleasure to be able to write the good news to Alva, and
+my lady promised shortly to come and see for herself the happy change
+that had taken place.
+
+One morning, as we sat idly on a bench in the narrow wood above the
+water and watched the children at play below us, our constant visitor
+joined us, and gave us a kindly good day. The pretty colour rose in
+Betty’s cheeks as she made room for him beside us, and my lord, who
+seemed as ever in a blithe and pleasant humour, made her a compliment
+on the return of her gay spirits and sprightly looks.
+
+“The winter is gone, Mistress Betty, with all its darkness and sadness,
+and you are blossoming again like the new summer flowers.”
+
+“The flowers that blossom now knew nothing of the winter,” sighed
+Betty, ever ready for an argument; “but we--can we ever forget?”
+
+“Why, yes!” cried my lord, “’tis the noble mind that rises above its
+disappointments, and sees in them only the working out of a wisely
+guided Destiny.”
+
+“Ah, my lord,” said Betty, “’tis easy for you to talk; but when the
+disappointment is our own, it is harder to soothe it with such bare
+philosophy.”
+
+For a moment he was silent, for he knew well of what she was thinking.
+
+“And did not I, too, suffer the loss of many hopes this last December?”
+he asked gently.
+
+The tears sprang to Betty’s eyes as she turned to him with an impulse
+of sympathy.
+
+“Pray, my lord, forgive me! You know how I feel for you there. But it
+was to the other subject I thought you referred.”
+
+“I know, I know,” he answered, “but ’tis all one. Neither public nor
+private sorrows are we fitted to bear without recourse to ‘such bare
+philosophy’ as you call it, madam; but I prefer the name of Christian
+resignation.”
+
+Then, turning to me, he said in a lighter tone, “And when, Mistress
+Barbara, will it please you to honour my house with a visit? There is
+some ancient armour which, if you care for such things, would please
+you, and the Castle itself is not without historic interest.”
+
+“Why, my lord,” cried I, greatly delighted with his suggestion, “I
+do assure you there is nothing I should more enjoy. Of all things I
+wish to see the room where Queen Mary first met my lord Darnley--the
+beginning of all her woes.”
+
+“And of many other people’s as well,” said Betty. “Who knows the
+difference it would have made to us all had the poor lady married some
+man more worthy of her?”
+
+My lord laughed.
+
+“She was a wilful woman, madam, and would have had her way in any case.
+But now, when will you bring Mistress Barbara to Wemyss? Will you both
+honour me by riding there to-morrow afternoon and drinking a dish of
+tea with me?”
+
+To this we readily assented, and after a little further talk my lord
+departed.
+
+“It seems, my dear Betty,” said I, when his footsteps had died away,
+“that you have forgiven his lordship.”
+
+She turned her face to me with a doubtful smile, “And does it seem to
+you, dear Barbara, that his lordship has forgiven me?”
+
+“Why, yes!” said I, laughing, “if you feel the need of forgiveness.”
+
+Nothing could exceed the kindness and courtesy of my Lord Wemyss
+next day as he conducted us over his great house, showing everything
+that he thought would please us, from the dungeons where the unhappy
+prisoners once had languished, to the beautiful portrait of his first
+wife painted in miniature. Tea was served to us in the historic chamber
+which I had expressed the curiosity to see, and while we were drinking
+it, the Earl turned suddenly to me.
+
+“Do you not think it a pity, Mistress Barbara, that a house like this
+should be without a mistress?”
+
+“Indeed, my lord, I do,” I responded readily; “but I make no doubt your
+lordship could find one without much difficulty.”
+
+“Alas!” said he, but with a twinkle in his eye, “the only one I want
+sees fit to raise a barrier around herself, through which I find it
+very hard to make myself seen or heard.”
+
+“Can I not help to remove it, my lord?” said I mischievously,
+attempting to rise from the couch whereon we sat facing him; but to my
+dismay I found my dress clutched firmly by the hand of Betty, who was
+looking into her empty tea-cup as if to read her fortune there.
+
+“Can two live together except they be agreed?” she asked in a low voice.
+
+My lord leant forward in his chair and looked at her earnestly. He
+seemed in no way embarrassed by my presence, and seeing that Betty
+desired my support, I thought it best to remain where I was.
+
+“The cause of disagreement,” he said, “is gone. You accused me once of
+triumphing over your distress; that, my dear Betty, I could not do. I
+grieved with and for you in every fresh disappointment. But the whole
+affair was a blunder, and seeing that it was so, I set my face against
+it. My heart is not unloyal to that unfortunate prince, and were it
+only a personal matter I should certainly prefer James to George as
+a King; but of the Rising I could not approve, and in that it failed
+I recognise the hand of a wise Providence. These are the words of an
+honest man, madam. Have you aught to object to in them?”
+
+Betty laid her cup and saucer on the table, and turned to look out of
+the window, so that I saw nothing but one rosy ear.
+
+“I shall always cherish the hope that he may return,” she said softly.
+
+“Be it so,” replied the Earl; “hope does no one any harm.”
+
+“I shall never pretend loyalty to the Hanoverian,” she cried, turning
+her face to us.
+
+“I have no doubt, madam, he will be able to live without it.”
+
+A smile curved her lips; his good humour was imperturbable.
+
+“You think me foolish, frivolous, fickle,” she sighed, “and easily led
+away.”
+
+“I think you loyal, and tender, and true!” he answered, “and what can a
+man want more?”
+
+With that he glanced at me, and seeing that my dress was now free I
+slipped away, and going through an open door and down a passage, found
+myself presently in the garden. Here I busied myself among the flowers
+till, some time later, hearing Betty’s voice I ran to meet her, and
+putting my arms about her whispered, “Was all well?”
+
+To this she replied, “He is to see my father to-morrow,” and my heart
+rejoiced, for the look in her eyes was one of peace.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+It was indeed a matter for rejoicing to all Betty’s friends, for
+my Lord Wemyss was, as you know, a man of sense and honour, very
+agreeable, and still remarkably handsome. An express was despatched
+by my Lord Sinclair to Alva begging my lady’s attendance, as in all
+things he relied upon her judgment and valued her opinions; and I make
+no doubt that her wise advice was asked and taken in the important
+matter of settlements. That she was as much surprised as pleased at
+the news, I saw clearly, for so effectually had Betty hid her feelings
+even from this tender friend and sister, that my lady had had no hope
+of any alliance so satisfactory for the capricious young madam. Even
+now she was inclined to think it merely a matter of convenience and
+worldly policy on the part of a woman disappointed in her ambitions,
+and feeling at war with Fate.
+
+Arrangements were made for the signing of the settlements, and Mr.
+Erskine was summoned from Edinburgh to look after the lady’s interests.
+The wedding was to take place in less than three weeks, and the future
+Countess very graciously asked me to stand as one of her bridesmaids.
+
+“If only Sir John were here,” she cried, “and my poor brother, I should
+be perfectly happy.”
+
+“Were Sir John here,” said my lady smiling, “you would have to bear
+some teasing upon various subjects. He would ask you, Bess, what you
+meant to do with all your other swains--David Pitcairn for one.”
+
+“I would bear that gladly,” said Betty, “for the pleasure of his good
+company; but since he is sure to think my choice a piece of caprice,
+you may remind him that I love to be comfortable and lazy, and that at
+Wemyss there are plenty of easy-chairs to lounge in, so that I expect
+to live very well, whatever my friends may say.”
+
+Her sister looked at her kindly but gravely. Her idea of happiness
+did not consist in bodily comfort, and fond of Betty as she was, she
+sometimes had doubts of her sincerity.
+
+When the latter left the room, she sighed.
+
+“I trust my poor Bess has some stronger reason for expecting a happy
+life than that she gives us, Barbara.”
+
+“Dear madam,” I assured her, yet surprised that she should need the
+explanation, “she was but jesting. Betty is, believe me, as much in
+love with my Lord Wemyss as I am with my Anthony, and I think has been
+for long. ’Twas the affair of the Rising that kept them apart, and
+since its failure she has been very sore; but at last her pride is
+broken down, and she allows herself to acknowledge the Earl’s goodness
+and patience.”
+
+“Why, if that is the case,” cried my lady, “no one can be more heartily
+glad than I. Poor Betty has suffered cruelly in this sad year, and she
+deserves some happiness as her reward for her faithful services to the
+King. I hope she will indeed be comfortable. But what, my dear Barbara,
+will become of the other David. ’Tis hard for him, and I know not what
+he will do.”
+
+Indeed this question had risen in my own mind often enough, and I
+had not been able to supply an answer, for David Pitcairn was one
+friend who could not be expected to rejoice at the prospect of Betty’s
+marriage. He came and went as usual, faithful, pleasant, and kind; and
+however much he suffered, he did not allow it to appear.
+
+Once, upon my lady offering him a word of sympathy, he threw up his
+head with a smile.
+
+“Oh, madam,” he said, “it is kind of you to think of me, but my love
+for Mistress Betty was not founded on hope. Long ago I realised that
+this day must arrive for me, and I am only glad that she has chosen
+where she is likely to find happiness.”
+
+My lady regarded him with secret admiration.
+
+“You think she will be happy?”
+
+“I have no doubt of it, madam, since she loves her husband,” he replied.
+
+But brave and unselfish as this good man was, it was not to be expected
+he should waste his life in contemplating his lost mistress’s happiness
+with another, and much as she valued his friendship, this was the last
+thing Betty desired. Before the end of the year, David Pitcairn did
+what many another gallant man has done, carried his wounded heart to
+the wars, and endeavoured to fill his life with fresh interests and new
+ambitions. He got a Commission in the 1st Royal Scots Regiment of Foot,
+of which my lady’s brother, James, was at this time Major, and in which
+in after years both Charles and little Hal became officers. He lived to
+see Betty’s grandson succeed his father as Earl of Sutherland at the
+age of fifteen, and died at London only four years ago, beloved and
+lamented by a large circle of friends. He never married.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+It had not taken me many minutes upon my lady’s arrival at Dysart
+to perceive that something far removed from Betty’s marriage was
+occupying her thoughts, and though for her sister’s sake she strove to
+be cheerful and put away her melancholy, it was impossible not to see
+that she was troubled in her mind. At last when the marriage contract
+had been drawn up, and all their plans talked over, she broke it to us
+that she was in much anxiety about her husband’s affairs. An Act of
+Parliament had been passed, which put it out of the King’s power to
+grant any portion of the forfeited estates to their unfortunate owners,
+so that should Sir John be attainted, a calamity that he had up till
+now very narrowly escaped, all their projects of private negotiations
+for his pardon must be abandoned. Besides this a Commission had been
+appointed to inquire into the particulars of every rebel family’s
+goods and chatels; to spy and probe their innermost affairs, with the
+power of citing anyone they pleased, whether closest friend or meanest
+servant, to appear and give information about the private property of
+each of these unfortunate gentlemen. All money got in this way, it was
+ordered, must go into the Treasury for the payment of the public debts;
+whereas anything owing to individuals by the owners of these same
+forfeited estates was to be ignored, and the poor people must suffer
+loss through no fault of their own, nor by the intention of their
+patrons.
+
+All this was a cause of great grief to poor Lady Erskine for many
+reasons. Not only was she keenly disappointed at the shattering of her
+hopes of buying her husband’s pardon, but she now lived in terror of
+the Commissioners discovering the value of the Silver Mine through some
+of those they examined, and this she felt would be the end of all. Then
+the thought of any having to suffer through her family was very bitter
+to her, and if she lost not only her estate but their secret source
+of wealth as well, how was this injustice to be avoided? Above all,
+her heart and soul were shaken by constant terrors for her husband’s
+safety. Placed as she was at a distance from him, and only too well
+aware of his light-hearted disregard of consequences, she longed to
+hear he was living anywhere away from the ill-fated King and his
+companions, believing this to be the first necessity for his safety.
+The uncertainty whether he would consent to this measure preyed upon
+her mind day and night, and between her fear of their enemies and her
+reluctance to force him against his inclination, her burden seemed at
+times like to weigh her to the earth.
+
+“I still hope,” she said to me, “that Sir John may escape being
+attainted, seeing that up to the present his name has been kept out of
+the Bills; and I know that Mr. Haldane and his brother, and certainly
+Patrick Campbell as well, are working in every possible way to prevent
+it. But when these Commissioners arrive at Alva, and make enquiries
+of all and sundry about this person and that, think you that should
+a rumour of the garden” (for so we spoke of the mine) “come to their
+ears, and what is to hinder it, seeing it is at the mercy of so many
+needy people, they will not find in this an excuse for seizing Sir
+John’s possessions and adding them to the list of forfeitures? My heart
+is very heavy, Barbara, and at times I feel ready to sink under my
+fears.”
+
+I would have given much to be able to comfort her, but could say very
+little to restore her confidence. I left her alone to pour out her
+heart in a letter to her husband, for faint as this consolation was, it
+was still the dearest she possessed.
+
+The next day being the 12th of June we left Dysart for Alva, and before
+we returned for the wedding, a still greater calamity had overtaken our
+affairs, and our hearts were heavier than ever.
+
+
+LETTER XV
+
+ (Dysart.)
+
+ I had the pleasure of hearing from my Dearest Life some days agoe,
+ but it had been long by the way, which gave me some pain about you;
+ and tho’ it was but three days writ after what I got last, it was
+ three weeks longer a coming to my hand. I must own you are most
+ kind and obliging in writing so frequently, and it is the only real
+ satisfaction I have at present, for tho’ I endeavor all I can to
+ make the best of my misfortune, yet at some times I am perfectly
+ like to sink under it; and the probability of so long and continued
+ afflictions, and which is most uneasy to me to be absent from you
+ without having any prospect of having it in my power to come to you,
+ together with the concern I have for my friends in the Fleet, and
+ many good people who are suffering; and I find the greatest favour
+ that’s expected is banishment.
+
+ As to your own particular you are not yet attainted, so I hop will
+ scape this session of Parlyment, but if ever you are attainted all
+ you could once call your own is irrecoverably lost. There is such
+ acts of Parlyment passing as people cannot expect to save anything;
+ nay, even old tailys are in danger, and yours the more (as) it is
+ not registrate. The King can give no gift to any without any act of
+ Parlyment, and all goes for the public Debts. And these persons that
+ are on the Commission have ample power to doe what they please, and
+ make such narrow inspection in the forfeit estates that they can call
+ any person they please before them, and take their oaths about the
+ particulars of every family, and if they doe not appear they can fine
+ them of a considerable sum.
+
+ I once expected your Brother R. and his master was to be at the
+ Hague, but now it’s believed they are to be att Isla Chapel (Aix
+ la Chapelle) but this act puts me out of any hop of a gift to him
+ of your Liberent, and to (have) had a little clause put in favour
+ of Mr. Nabit (the mine.) You see, my dear Soul, the present state
+ of affairs, and that all our projects that way is gone. I am told
+ by some you very narrowly missed being putt in the last Bill of
+ Attainder, and it’s affirm’d that your not being put in was owing to
+ P.(atrick) H.(aldane).
+
+ If you still remain where you are att present it’s impossible you can
+ scape being attainted as soon as the Parlyment sits down, whereas
+ if you were in another place, some of your friends might prevent
+ your being put in with a better countenance, and if you do not, I am
+ convinced they will never attempt it. You see by all this that no
+ other person can be interpos’d; that if Mr. Amond (Sir John) does
+ not incline to comply to any conditions that would be propos’d, let
+ him stay abroad and get his money remitted to him; and if either
+ his Brother R. by his master’s friendship, or any other way, can
+ be fal’n on to prevent his being attainted be done, until the term
+ of years mentioned by the Parlyment be expired, which is from this
+ present time till the year 1719.... I have not any hope now but by
+ preventing your being attainted if possible, which can never doe if
+ you persist in your resolution of staying where you are. It’s my
+ duty to let you know this and desire you may consider seriously what
+ sad state you will bring your family to, and to beg you may not do
+ what you may for ever repent. Some regard I think should be had to
+ me and your children, tho’ for my own particular I had rather suffer
+ hardships than desire you to do what is against your inclination;
+ but as a mother I must have regard to them so far as to let you know
+ my opinion, and if ye doe not follow it, I cannot help it, but shall
+ endeavour to submit with patience.
+
+ I am not a little sensible how far it’s uneasy to break off from so
+ agreeable a society, and when perhaps duty and inclination both bind
+ you; but in their present state I see not what any one man can doe,
+ and the fewer sufferers the better. And every body will not have
+ that hope or expectation you may have, but if your Brother Robin
+ doe come to Isla Chapel, it would be a good pretext to visit him.
+ This is sufficient on this head, and I shall be glad to have your
+ opinion as frankly and resolutely as I have given my advice.... I
+ came to my father’s some days agoe about a marriage which will not
+ be disagreeable to you. Bess is to be C----ess of W----ms, which
+ is a satisfaction to all her friends. The terms is this day agreed
+ on, and tho’ they are not what I either could a wisht or expected,
+ yet my father and other friends after making proposals of altering
+ found it would not doe, and has gone into what his tutors for the
+ time advised. She has not far to goe, and in case you should not
+ understand she has a great many easy chairs in which she may loll.
+ I goe home to-morrow and return here in a fortnight. You was very
+ kindly remembered by your new friend and he regrates he has you not
+ here at this time. You may be sure I am glad of the thing, but I am
+ in such a continu’d Dump I did not incline to be at the wedding, but
+ I cannot shun it. C. A. was here to be the Lady’s Lawyer.... Countess
+ Bess salutes you kindly and wishes you were here, tho’ she shou’d
+ bear all you could say now as to D. P. I see not what can become of
+ him.... God help me, for I labour under many difficultys and many
+ fears. I did not intend to let you know so much, but at some time it
+ will come out.
+
+ As to sending you money it’s agreed ... it’s cheapest from London,
+ and I hope soon to have effects there to answer your demands. Write
+ to P. C., who is there and will doe it. He writ to me he should remit
+ the 50 pound I mentioned in my last, and pray write to him for what
+ you have occasion, for he will answer you whether the effects be
+ come to his hands or not, but he cannot miss to have them soon.
+
+ I see so many difficultys in sending A. S(hor)t that it cannot doe.
+ I think I have answered all your questions in yours of the 22 of Ap.
+ Wishing my Dearest all manner of happyness I am ever,
+
+ Yours.
+
+ Your mother and sons are well. We drank Mr. Kid’s health yesterday
+ and all his friends. God preserve you.
+
+ June 11.
+
+Back at Alva we were forced to wait with what patience we possessed
+to see what would next befal, but a week later my lady wrote again to
+Sir John in much the same strain as her former letter, so that you can
+see nothing new had occurred so far. Having received one from him,
+dated 29th of May, she was now to be deprived of the comfort of hearing
+anything of her husband for several weeks, which as you can imagine did
+not lessen her fears nor lighten her burden.
+
+
+LETTER XVI.
+
+ My Dearest Life,
+
+ Yours of the 29 of May was forwarded by our friend
+ att London, which you may be sure was most welcome to me since there
+ can be nothing so agreeable as to hear you are well, and at the same
+ time to hear of two people whose welfare I am much interested in. I
+ went airly abroad this morning to visit my labourers, and it was so
+ hott I began to think how much more it must be so with you. I pray
+ God you may agree with it.
+
+ There is one advantage of being with Kid, that you will live mighty
+ regular and get no ill examples. I wish from my heart all had the
+ same thoughts of him you have, but I am not altogether without hope
+ that will come and justice be done him; tho, as things have been of
+ late I do not expect to see it. But who would a thought six months
+ agoe Andrew wold lose his post of being Commander-in-Chief in this
+ Country, and that Mr. Beggar wold have it. His Master has made him
+ very bad returns for his fidelity, but I hop he shall use all his
+ faithful servants after that manner.
+
+ I writ to you from my father’s house in relation to the Bill that’s
+ passing on the forfeitures. My friend writes from London he thinks
+ all personal Debts in danger. Some only thinks those since the 24 of
+ June last. I must own it is so horrid I can scarce believe it, but if
+ it is so it will ruin many, and to think that anybody will lose by
+ you is really terribly uneasy, particularly C.(harles) A.(reskine).
+ If it is so I shall do my endeavour to pay all so far as it can goe,
+ and trust to Providence who has hitherto been bountyful to us, and
+ I am sure you will agree with me. I was in hops things wold in time
+ have a more favourable aspect, but it’s impossible human invention
+ can contrive things worse than all the measures they have taken. I
+ find by the Ladys att London getting their jointure and daughters
+ provided, we may expect the same. If any here gets it, I make no
+ doubt of it, for I happen to be much in the Whig’s favour. I know
+ nothing I have done to merit it but being silent. In the meantime I
+ live in peaceable possession of all, haveing Mr. Beggar’s protection,
+ and by the advice of the above mentioned friend, by degrees I am to
+ sell all my Stock and prepare for the worst. I must own it was what I
+ was mighty unwilling to do, but I am now convinct it’s the best way
+ by much.
+
+ As to Mr. Nabit, I am sorry I have not writ so fully as you might
+ understand. His fame was like to rise high, and at the same time
+ there was never less ground for it. I make no doubt that going down
+ would have turn’d to account in time, but that was a certain giving
+ out of money ... it was thought by all the Counsell the saffest
+ course, and the only way to make people think it was an idle project
+ of Mr. Amond’s. How far it will be of use that way I know not, but
+ so many poor Dogs has it at their mercy it will be wonderful if it
+ do not break out. I am positive however it was right to give up.
+ James Hamilton went away three months agoe, for he turn’d wrong in
+ the head and would not stay.... I told you in my last of my sister
+ Bess’ marriage, which is to be very soon, and I must goe to it. It’s
+ to their neighbour W----ms. I hope she will be very happy, and I
+ take it as a reward for her faithful service to Kid. He is really a
+ good-humour’d man, but too much upon the easy lay. C. A. is to be at
+ the weddin’. I showed him your letter in relation to A. S----t, about
+ his coming but he did not think it proper to send him for the reasons
+ you mentioned.
+
+ As to my second Farm I still keep it, and am putting two lime-kilns
+ just now on it. I ride there frequently. Perhaps I may set up my
+ habitation there and farm it myself, but I think if ever I leave this
+ place I will not stay in Britain. Your children are well and in good
+ heart. Ha is perfectly recover’d. Your mother is well, and she and I
+ live easily together, tho’ none can be of more different sentiments;
+ but she disaproves all the violent measures, and is very concern’d
+ for you and thankful you are well; but she knows not where you are,
+ or she would be griev’d. I wish very often to be with you, my Dear
+ Soul, but as long as I can doe your service here I will never have
+ a thought of it; and I have saved more than any in my circumstances
+ has done, and never fail to represent when I am injur’d, which makes
+ me live easy, when many other good honest people are oppresst. My
+ paper sinks so much I fear you will have difficulty to read it....
+ P.(atrick) H.(aldane) is one of the comishioners on the forfeitures.
+ Buchan and Munroe of Faulds are the Scots. Wishing your good company
+ and you all manner of real happiness, I am, my Dearest, ever Yours.
+
+ As to remitting money, I told you before it’s easyest from London,
+ and I lay it on my friend entirely who would doe that as well as I
+ could wish and all things else, for he helps all in distress and it’s
+ his aim to do good
+
+ Dearest Life, Adieu.
+
+ June 18. Alva.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIX
+
+THE CALAMITY FALLS; AND MY LADY ATTENDS HER SISTER’S WEDDING IN VERY
+LOW SPIRITS
+
+
+The sweet June days went slowly past, and we, occupied in various
+ways, rejoiced in the hot bright weather and the growing beauty of the
+country. The garden was fair with flowers, and all the wide domain
+lay fresh and well-ordered under a cloudless sky. To be sure the
+faint cool breezes of morning, laden with the scent of growing and
+blossoming things, the hot, still noons, the tranquil evenings and the
+clear, tender twilights, stirred in my heart a longing so great as to
+be almost pain, that the one without whom my life would for ever be
+incomplete, should enjoy their beauty with me; and looking into the
+face of my dear Lady Erskine in those days and noting the wistfulness
+in her eyes, I felt that she shared my unrest. For the summer days
+brought no fresh news from France for either of us, and it was hard to
+be cheerful, with that great impenetrable silence closing us in.
+
+“He will write to me for his birthday, be sure,” said my lady. “I have
+never known him fail to send a few lines on that day when it happens
+that we have been parted. Were I sure of his welfare and safety,
+I should be easy at not hearing from him; but though he is a kind
+and tender husband, Barbara, he is a man of great energy and almost
+reckless courage, and you know I have many dark dreams of the dangers
+into which he may be thrusting himself on behalf of the beloved Cause.”
+
+“It is the waiting that is so hard to bear, madam,” said I, sadly, “and
+the lack of news. To write to one who is far off and to receive no
+reply, is like knocking at a closed door behind which is nothing but a
+silence that terrifies the heart.”
+
+“Poor child!” said she, kindly, “you are young to suffer such pain. But
+do not forget that all our ways are ordered by a wise Providence, and
+if we bear our trials with patience, they will surely turn to blessings
+when the time of probation is past. I can see before me a long and
+happy life for my dear Barbara, who for all her courage and sweetness
+deserves an ample reward.”
+
+“Oh, madam!” cried I, “you are too good to say so. I constantly remind
+myself how light is my trial compared with yours; but after all it does
+not comfort me much to know that my dearest friend is sadder than I.”
+
+“Truly,” she answered, “my burden must needs be the heavier, for the
+thought of the children’s loss is added to my own, were anything to
+happen to their father. And since I think there is no fear of death
+or dishonour for Anthony Fleming, a little further patience and brave
+hopefulness are all that are needed to support you, my dear. As for Sir
+John, God help us! for I know not what is to happen next.”
+
+It was truly with more pain for her than for myself that I saw each
+post arrive bringing no packet from France, and though Mr. Campbell
+wrote frequently, and gave my lady all the news that was going in
+London, the longed-for letter failed to arrive, and fear was added to
+anxiety.
+
+The morning of Sir John’s 41st birthday dawned as fair and as full of
+promise as all that had gone before. A few white clouds in the sky only
+made the blue more deep and perfect, a light breeze from the south blew
+across the fields between us and the river, the distant mountains were
+veiled in silver mist that by-and-bye the sun would disperse; it was
+impossible to feel wholly sad on such a summer day.
+
+We walked in the garden, the Dowager leaning on her daughter’s arm,
+the children running races and shouting in pure glee. I had plucked
+a large cabbage-leaf, and having gathered a number of the first ripe
+strawberries to fill it, I brought them to my lady for her approval.
+
+“Why,” she cried, “this is good luck! The first strawberries to be
+gathered on Sir John’s birthday, that is what we have always desired.
+Come, children, and taste them; they are your Papa’s favourite fruit.”
+
+Seating themselves on a garden-bench the ladies proceeded to feed the
+children, who, nothing loth, devoured the luscious berries with smiles
+of pleasure.
+
+“Oh,” cried Charles, at last, “how I wish Sir John were here to taste
+them! Do you remember, mama, I used to think my papa would be home
+before the trees were green, and now the roses are here, and the
+strawberries are ripe. Oh, why doesn’t the King send him back?”
+
+“Courage, my grandson,” said the old lady, cheerfully, “let us hope he
+will be here at the time of the Barley Harvest.”
+
+“Or before the leaves are off the trees,” cried I.
+
+“Or at least before the snow comes,” sighed my lady.
+
+“Then he will be here for _my_ birthday!” cried little Hal
+triumphantly, his beautiful eyes alight with joy; and his mother kissed
+the eager face uplifted to her, and murmured, “God grant it!”
+
+At that moment we heard the distant sound of a horse galloping towards
+the house, and instantly our interest quickened, for the pace spoke of
+haste, and in those days haste meant news of importance.
+
+“’Tis an express!” cried I, with a wild but foolish hope that it
+brought tidings of my lover.
+
+“’Tis a letter from Sir John!” cried my lady. “He has remembered--he
+must have directed Patrick Campbell to express it from London being
+anxious I should receive it this day.”
+
+Her colour rose and her eyes sparkled. She went hurriedly from us
+to secure the precious missive without delay, looking back over her
+shoulder with a joyous smile! Alas! it was many weeks before I saw her
+look so happy again.
+
+“God bless her, and grant the news be good!” said the dowager, as she
+took my arm and followed slowly. “My son’s wife is indeed a lovable
+woman, Barbara.”
+
+“Why, madam,” cried I, “there is not a thought in her heart that is
+not good and sweet. How glad I am the letter has come to-day!”
+
+Before ten minutes were passed, I retracted my eager words, for by that
+time my dear lady, and with her the whole household, were plunged in
+the most distracting grief.
+
+Having followed her to the house we arrived in time to see her standing
+in the hall, eagerly tearing open the letter which had just been put
+into her hand, the little boys clinging to her skirts, and waiting for
+the tit-bits of news she often doled out to them from their father’s
+letters.
+
+As we entered she gave a loud cry, and crushing the letter in her hand,
+she raised her face and gazed at us for an instant with a look so wild
+and terrified that it made my heart stand still. The next moment she
+turned and went into the parlour, where we found her seated by her
+scrutoire, looking the picture of despair.
+
+Sick with anxiety I dropped the old lady’s arm and ran to embrace
+her, begging her in the tenderest way to let us know the cause of her
+misery. Old Lady Alva, though trembling in every limb, carefully shut
+the door, and managed to reach a seat near her daughter-in-law, into
+which she sank, pale and breathless.
+
+With her usual thought for others, my lady, seeing how much she was
+moved, put out a shaking hand towards her and said, though her lips
+were white and stiff, “Sir John is safe, madam, so far as I know. This
+letter is not from France.”
+
+“Can you let us know the cause of your agitation, my daughter?” said
+the old lady, gently. “Thank God my son is not concerned! But if you
+are at liberty to divulge the tidings you have received I shall be
+further gratified.”
+
+“Indeed, madam,” sighed my lady, “I see no reason why they should be
+kept secret. They are, alas! but too widely known. Oh, woe is me! that
+I should have been so grossly deceived by that villain. Ah, Barbara,
+would that we had never trusted him!”
+
+“Whom do you mean, cousin?” cried I, still too frighted to think
+clearly. “Who has betrayed us?”
+
+“Who, but that base wretch, James Hamilton, whom I trusted with all the
+knowledge and information about the Mine that I had myself. Did I not
+make him overseer in my latest transactions, and did he not know I was
+trusting him with the most precious things in life--my husband’s safety
+and honour? Oh, that such baseness should exist, and in a man, too,
+with good blood in his veins!”
+
+“Why, what hath he done?” cried I trembling.
+
+“Listen, my dear, and you shall hear,” said my lady, taking up the
+letter in her lap, and smoothing it out. “‘I am bound to tell you some
+news,’ says Mr. Campbell, ‘which I know will greatly disturb you, and
+which in an unexpected way bids fair to upset our plans. You will be
+surprised to hear that there is lately come from Scotland, one, James
+Hamilton, who, though I have not yet seen him, I take to be the same
+who was lately employed by Sir John in his _garden_. This fellow,
+through cupidity, or desire of fame, I imagine, though I take it he
+is acting a very treacherous part, brought with him to London some
+specimens of ore; and having made inquiries as to the best method of
+proceeding, and fearing I presume to employ his friends in such a
+matter, went straight to my Lord Mayor, and there made an affidavit of
+what he knew about the Mine. I am credibly informed that he made no
+secret of anything. He spoke frankly of his position at Alva, saying
+that he was at first employed only in smelting the ore, but he saw it
+brought up from the mine in great abundance, and he believes there are
+still several rich veins unexplored. He further said that after Sir
+John went out in the Rebellion, he was employed by his lady in digging
+out as much ore as possible, stowing it in old barrels, etc., and
+burying it within the grounds of the house--the very spot is located.
+In fact there is nothing wanting in his tale, and the reason he gives
+for this disclosure is, forsooth, that he knew it must come out when
+the Commissioners came down to Alva, and he believed it right that
+His Majesty’s Ministers should have previous knowledge, and be able
+to deal with so important a business as it deserves. You will see now
+that all our plans have been knocked on the head, and other strings
+must be pulled in order to work the affair in a suitable manner. I beg
+of you not to let yourself be too downcast, for I do not yet despond
+of arranging some settlement, which, with Sir John’s consent must work
+to his and your advantage. I have written to him and trust he will be
+brought to see the matter in the same light as myself. In the meantime,
+you, my dear lady, will, I know, have many qualms of doubt, but of one
+thing you may be certain, that both I and all your friends will do our
+best to extricate our good Sir John from the difficulties into which,
+through no fault of his own, nor of yours, he has fallen.’”
+
+My lady dropped the letter, and for some minutes we sat staring at each
+other in blank dismay. A thought struck me sharply.
+
+“Oh, cousin,” I cried, “I believe I am to blame in not telling you of
+Mr. Hamilton’s threats that day before he left, but they seemed to me
+so idle I thought them not worth repeating. Perhaps--oh, perhaps if you
+had known them, you might have foreseen this calamity.”
+
+“Tell us now, child, what he said,” exclaimed the dowager.
+
+“Why, madam, his words were wild. He asked me very abruptly to be his
+wife, and upon my informing him that such a thing was impossible, he
+spoke in a violent way: said I would regret it for ever if I did not
+give my consent. More was depending upon it than I thought, but not
+so much on my own account as for the sake of the friends I loved. Oh,
+madam, do you think he would have abandoned his wicked scheme had I
+accepted him?”
+
+My lady was thinking deeply.
+
+“’Tis just possible,” she replied, “if, as I take it, he was actuated
+by a desire for gain. Had he been sure of you and your fortune,
+Barbara, he might have foregone his wicked betrayal of us.”
+
+“Oh!” cried I, the tears pouring down, “would to God I could have given
+him my fortune, if it would have saved him from this terrible crime.
+But how could anyone foresee such villainy, or dream of such an end as
+this?”
+
+For a time I wept, unrestrained, fearing that in her heart my dear
+lady was blaming me for helping to bring about this disaster, but after
+a few minutes she bade me kindly to dry my tears.
+
+“Comfort yourself, my dear girl,” she said, “I do not believe you are
+so much to blame as you think. James Hamilton must have nursed his
+deceit for many months, and worked well in secret to carry out his
+wicked scheme. His frenzy about you three months ago was, I feel sure,
+worked up to give him the excuse he desired of leaving Alva; for once
+Satan had entered his heart to make him play the part of Judas, no
+influence could have softened him, no love restrained him. Alas! alas!
+to think how Sir John trusted him, and now he is ready to betray his
+master, as the other Judas did, for paltry silver.”
+
+And with that the full tide of her fear and anguish swelled in her
+heart, and she bowed her head upon her hands and wept.
+
+Over this terrible event we talked long and earnestly, but little
+satisfaction could be gained. The future was all uncertain, for what
+the Parliament would decide to do was still unknown, and though we
+suggested to each other various ways out of the difficulty, not one
+seemed wholly satisfactory. As we were due at Dysart that week for the
+wedding, my lady looked forward to meeting Mr. Erskine and taking his
+counsel on the matter. But I must own that the gaiety of the occasion,
+which ought to have been without stint, was greatly dimmed by the
+heavy anxiety we carried about in our breasts. Try as we would to be
+light-hearted and careless, “Mr. Nabit’s affair,” as my lady calls it,
+was the uppermost thought in our minds, and the treachery of Hamilton
+cast a cloud over all our pleasure.
+
+My lady, being much occupied, sent me with the children and Phemie to
+Dysart a couple of days in advance, she herself arriving with Aunt
+Betty on the very morning of the wedding-day. My dear Betty made a
+beautiful and happy bride, and my Lord Wemyss with his handsome person
+and pleasant manners won great favour from all her friends.
+
+I was somewhat surprised to see David Pitcairn among the guests (his
+Reverend uncle performing the ceremony), his grave courtesy as genuine
+as ever, his kind eyes following Betty just as of yore. I think he
+had steeled himself to this last encounter as a kind of sacrificial
+farewell, for the very next day he left Dysart, and though he returned
+there from time to time, I, for one, never saw him again.
+
+A few days after the wedding the Earl and Countess invited us all to
+Wemyss, where we spent a week very happily, for it was impossible not
+to be affected by company so merry and good-humoured. On the night
+before we left we were sitting at supper, the servants having left the
+room, and stories were told and toasts drunk with much gaiety, for as
+it was but a family party there was little reserve required.
+
+My lord stood up with a full glass, and gave “The King!”
+
+The young Countess rose to her feet, her face flushed, her eyes
+sparkling. There was a crystal water-jug before her on the table, and
+with a graceful movement she passed her glass above it.
+
+“Ay, the King!” she cried, “with all my heart--God bless him!”
+
+With a little laugh my lady followed her example, and I, nothing loth,
+did likewise. The Earl looked amused but disapproving.
+
+“What, ladies, treason at my table? Tut, tut, this will never do.”
+
+“My lord,” said Betty, smiling at him very sweetly, “in the brightest
+moment of our hopes last year, I would not drink confusion to the
+King’s enemies because you, my lord, were one of them. You would not
+have me less loyal now to the unfortunate Prince over the water, who is
+far from being the enemy of any of us?”
+
+“Why, Betty,” replied my lord, “as to that you must please yourself.
+I wish the poor man no ill, so ’tis no harm to drink his very good
+health. But you must forgive me, madam, if I say I cannot but rejoice
+at his failure, for had he succeeded in his design, your adorable head
+would have been so turned that you would never have looked my way
+again.”
+
+And then in quieter tones he gave the toast of “Absent Friends,” and
+smiles died away and the light laughter was hushed, for there was not a
+soul in the room that night that was not yearning over loved ones far
+away.
+
+
+LETTER XVII
+
+ (Wemyss.)
+
+ MY DEAREST LIFE,
+
+ I delay’d writing in hops to have heard from you,
+ butt it is more than a month since I had that pleasure, and it was
+ just when you was 41, so you may judge what a pain it is to me. Now
+ that our London friend can convey our letters, it surprises me there
+ is none. I pray God you may be well.
+
+ I had a letter from our friend at London, and he tells me he has writ
+ to you of the discovery James H. has made of Mr. Nabit’s affair. It
+ has griev’d me very much, and it is no small satisfaction that it
+ has not failed by any neglect of mine, but he certainly designed to
+ commit the villainy and went away with that veiu, for nothing I could
+ do could make him stay. God in his wise providence has order’d it,
+ and I must submit, but it is a great tryal. I have done already what
+ was fit to do upon such ane exigence, and my friend will doe all in
+ his power at London, but what will be the end of it God knows! I
+ am not altogether without hope, tho’ I must own my grounds are but
+ small. I dare not write so plainly to you of it as I incline, lest it
+ should mis-carry and doe ane injury on that particular, but I think
+ it a lucky providence it went off, and I hope it shall never come on
+ till it do it (with) the right owner. God in wise providence thinks
+ fit to try us many different ways. I pray God make us both have the
+ right use of them, and seeing the vanity and emptiness of all things
+ in this world, we may seek what is more lasting and durable.
+
+ Bess was married Wednesday last, and after I had order’d my unlucky
+ affair the best I could, I came to my father’s that morning. Now I
+ am at her own house, where I could have been merry and blithe, but
+ now melancholy prevails so much that I cannot express it. And yet
+ I cannot help thinking this cannot last; but at another time I am
+ ready to despair, and my being absent from you without any prospect
+ of meeting is the bitterest part of all. But I ought to be resigned
+ in that and every other particular, and wait the Lord’s time with
+ patience.
+
+ Your boys are well and my health is better now than it used to be,
+ tho’ my toyl has been great and my mind much disturbed. The earl and
+ his wife salutes you and wishes often for you here, and remembers
+ with great respect your good company.
+
+ I cannot frame a notion now but everything will be unlucky, but that
+ is a fault. Aunt Betty is here and is in great concern for all that
+ may affect you. Hope the best and trust in God, for what he sends
+ is certainly best for us. Dearest Life, let me hear from you, and
+ endeavor to make your misfortuns as easy as possible. I can say no
+ more just now but that I hope the person who comes shall never see
+ far in Mr. Nabit, but you shall know. Write to our friend at London
+ when you want money, for that is the only way I can supply you.
+ Melancholy increases when I either write or speak on this subject, so
+ I’ll end. Wishing you all patient submission and intire trust in God,
+ who is able and ready to help us if we be not wanting to ourselves.
+ May (He) ever preserve you and send you His blessing is the earnest
+ wish of her who is ever
+
+ Yours.
+
+ July 8.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXX
+
+THE AFFAIR OF THE MINE IN THE MOUNTAIN IS MUCH DISCUSSED AT LONDON, BUT
+WITH NO COMFORTING RESULTS
+
+
+I have now to tell you of a period of great heaviness and anxiety to
+all those concerned in Sir John’s affairs. Many a time in after days
+have I heard my dear lady say, that these three months which followed
+our return from Dysart were the longest and darkest of all that weary
+year.
+
+The danger of my kind guardian’s ruin now seemed tenfold more imminent,
+for public attention having been brought to bear upon his affairs
+and himself placed in a position too prominent to be secure, it
+was impossible to know what would next befall. At first we at Alva
+scarcely realised how much was being made of the affair at London, but
+as the days went on, bringing my lady many letters from Mr. Campbell
+describing the development of events, it was soon made clear that the
+matter was considered a very serious one indeed. Mr. Charles Erskine
+was much with us, and many a long and serious talk my lady had with
+him. Sir Harry Stirling of Ardoch, who was also in her confidence,
+frequently added his counsel to these discussions, and being a sensible
+and energetic man, greatly in favour with Sir John, his presence gave
+my lady courage, and helped a little to ease her burden.
+
+The story of the “Silver Mine in the Mountain,” as it was called, had
+excited a huge interest among the authorities, for you may be sure
+that not only were the reports of its wealth exaggerated, but it was
+seriously affirmed that the whole range of the Ochils was teeming with
+precious metals, and it only needed a skilled engineer of mines to
+discover the treasure. As, by an old Scots Act of 1592, a tenth part
+of all ore found in Scotland belonged by right to the Crown, there
+was some reason in the eagerness of the Government to learn the truth
+of the matter, and the affair was mentioned in the House of Commons,
+discussed in the Cabinet, and indeed brought before King George himself
+by my Lord Townshend, the Secretary of State.
+
+The King, who had had some knowledge of mining in his native country,
+where silver was found to some extent, was monstrously interested
+in the news, and demanded that my Lord Townshend should bring him
+an exact report, first of the value of the ore, and secondly of the
+extent and richness of the veins yet to be worked. The ore having been
+submitted to Sir Isaac Newton, the Master of the Mint, he sent in a
+report to my lord, which though satisfactory in its way, only served
+to inflame their greedy desires, for Sir Isaac affirmed that “the ore
+was exceeding rich, a pound weight avoirdupois holding 4/2 in silver;”
+moreover he added that the silver was of the purest quality, holding
+neither gold nor copper.
+
+As to a knowledge of the mines themselves, my Lord Townshend informed
+the King that he had no means of gaining this without sending someone
+into Scotland to examine the locality, and as Sir John was not yet
+attainted, and the property still in the hands of his lady, that, said
+my lord, would be a doubtful proceeding. Upon this his Majesty asked if
+there were no other way of getting the information, whereupon it was
+proposed to send for Mr. Haldane of Gleneagles, who, being connected
+with Sir John’s family, and at the same time much in favour at Court,
+would be a likely person to supply them with what they needed.
+
+The result of this combination was that one morning my lady received
+an express from Mr. Haldane, which, when she had perused it, threw
+her into the utmost consternation. Indeed her rage and grief were
+like to make a breach between them for good, for he wrote to her in a
+way which, instead of furthering his ends, helped to frustrate them
+altogether. I am willing to believe that this gentleman meant nothing
+but kindness to Sir John, and was indeed rather proud of his part
+in the affair, thinking he was serving the family in the best manner
+possible; but he and my lady did not see the thing in the same light.
+He told her that the King had graciously commanded him to write to her
+instead of sending down officers to ask her questions; that it was
+therefore absolutely necessary she should inform him of all particulars
+connected with the mine, its probable extent, what they had got out
+of it, and particularly what knowledge she had of any acts connected
+with its possession, with which Sir John may have acquainted her.
+His Majesty, he said, was inclined to clemency, and were her reports
+satisfactory he had promised to sign a pardon permitting Sir John to
+return to Scotland and resume occupation of his estates, provided the
+mines were worked openly, and a proper share of the precious metal
+confirmed to the Crown. This Mr. Haldane considered a fair and merciful
+concession, and he advised my lady to keep nothing back but to rely on
+his Majesty’s generosity; for if she failed to comply with his demands
+in every particular, the King would cause Sir John’s name to be put in
+the next bill of attainder, and my lady and her family would be treated
+with the height of rigour.
+
+Now you can well understand that to a person of my lady’s spirit such
+a letter would but act as an incentive to defiance. I can remember to
+this day how proudly she drew herself up, her eyes flashing and the
+ready colour rising to her cheek.
+
+“Is it to be imagined,” she cried, “that I shall comply with such a
+demand as that? If Sir John is not yet attainted he is a free man, and
+an honest gentleman, with full right to do what he will with his own.
+No creature on earth, be he King or Prime Minister, has any title to
+call him to account for any part of his possessions; no, nor any right
+to peer and pry into his affairs. Let them send their officers, vile
+wretches, to make enquiries, I care not, but ’tis little they will get
+out of me! Comply, indeed! As soon would I give up my house to the
+first comer and beg my bread, with a child in each hand, from door to
+door!”
+
+“What will you tell him?” I asked.
+
+“I shall tell him, Barbara, nothing but the truth, you may be sure of
+that. But it will not be all the truth,” she added, with a laugh that
+betrayed her bitterness. “Do they deserve open dealings from me? Is
+it not a fine thing to write to a woman behind her husband’s back,
+ordering her to betray his interests without a word to or from himself?
+Oh, I shall never forgive Gleneagles for this! I could not have
+believed him capable of such treachery. I am certain his good wife, my
+sister Nell, can know nothing of it; but how can I ever be friendly
+again with her spouse?”
+
+“Will you consult Mr. Erskine,” I said, “before you write?”
+
+My lady remained for some time gazing thoughtfully on the ground.
+
+“I think,” she said at length, “it will be wiser to write at once
+having consulted no one. Who knows what dangers lurk for those who
+befriend us as well as for ourselves? If Charles were here, or Harry
+Stirling, I would talk the matter over with them, but I cannot conceive
+that anything they might say would alter my mind, and if the King is
+angry it were better not to involve my friends.”
+
+“Oh, dear madam,” cried I, in childish fear. “You will not say aught to
+anger the King?”
+
+“Why, Barbara, as to that we must take our chance, but I fear my reply
+will scarce appear conciliatory to him and his friends. I shall say
+that ’tis true Sir John has found silver on his estate (that fact can
+no longer be concealed), but to no great amount; indeed the vein he
+was working hath already given out, and I am in doubt whether any more
+will be found. I shall say that I can give him no information of any
+kind, that I know nothing of acts or treaties, but that I should esteem
+it a truly unfriendly action if any were sent down here to investigate
+matters in the absence of Sir John. I will remind him that my husband
+is not yet attainted, and in the meantime I have full control of all
+his property and estates, so that no steps can be taken without my
+consent.”
+
+Some such reply as this was forthwith written and despatched that
+day, my lady still burning with indignation and full of wrath. But I
+think she repented her haste and heat--though not her decision--when,
+a few days later, she heard from Mr. Campbell. Her letter, he told
+her, had greatly enraged the others, and Mr. Haldane, acting always in
+the King’s interest, agreed with my Lord Townshend that nothing now
+remained but to make out the order of inquiry and send a Commission
+from the Government to Scotland without delay. To ease my lady’s
+mind on this score, Mr. Campbell assured her that he had in his mind
+something which would delay this scheme, hoping, indeed, to prevent it
+altogether.
+
+Sick at heart as my lady was, and torn with fears of all kinds, she yet
+believed so strongly in Mr. Campbell’s good sense and kindness that his
+promises comforted her not a little, and enabled her to bear with some
+semblance of patience the uncertainty and delay of the next few weeks.
+Mr. Erskine, as I said, came frequently from Edinburgh to see her, and
+nothing could exceed his kindness and diligence on her behalf.
+
+She was now busily employed in removing from their hiding-place near
+the house the barrels and casks of ore, and bestowing them safely in a
+spot, of which none but herself, and Mr. Erskine, and the men employed
+had any knowledge. As the strictest secrecy was to be preserved, the
+work was done during the night, and great ingenuity must have been
+used, for not a creature ever discovered nor attempted to divulge the
+matter.
+
+On our asking what means Mr. Campbell was employing to delay the
+sending of the Commission, Mr. Erskine told us that by the advice
+of Sir David Dalrymple, the Lord Advocate, he had brought to their
+notice the old Scots law which enacted that minerals found on any
+man’s estate were not to be included in confiscated property; so that,
+even supposing Sir John were attainted, the Government would have no
+more interest in his mines than a small share in the profits. This
+consideration made them pause, for they were determined to get the
+most out of it that they could, and yet were reluctant about ignoring
+the law in a way that would probably enrage all Scotland. However,
+the delay was precious to our interests, and when one day Mr. Erskine
+informed my lady that he had decided to go to Holland next month to
+meet with his brother, Dr. Erskine, and learn what could be done for
+Sir John by the influence of the Czar, her heart was greatly lightened
+and hope again asserted itself.
+
+Mr. Erskine was to go first to his country house, Tinwald, in
+Dumfriesshire, and from there to London, that he might consult with Mr.
+Campbell before setting out for the Hague. As it turned out, this step
+was the best he could have taken, for, as you will see later, he also
+was instrumental in delaying the Commission, although, owing to the
+zealousness of Mr. Haldane, and some others, to serve the King, it was
+found impossible to dispose of it altogether.
+
+Not having had any word of Sir John for nigh two months, my lady was
+getting very downcast as to what had become of him, and her fears were
+not lessened by reading in the papers that my Lord Duffus had been
+arrested at Hamburg, and was now in prison. Thoughts of her husband’s
+danger haunted her night and day, and we were all greatly relieved when
+one evening towards the end of July two letters reached her from Sir
+John, which set her immediate fears to rest. More than anything else
+was she thankful to hear that her husband was no longer in the company
+of the exiled King, though if she could have known the business he was
+then employed in, I warrant she would have thought she had room enough
+for fears.
+
+In her reply to those letters you will see that her method of
+expressing herself is more cautious than usual, for she takes the name
+of _Mrs. Amond_ for herself and _Mr. Ashton_ for Sir John, while Mr.
+Campbell is _Duncan_, Mr. Erskine, _Key_, and Mr. Haldane, _Humphray_.
+
+
+LETTER XVIII
+
+ July 29.
+ Dearest Creature,
+
+ It’s impossible to express the trouble and
+ uneasyness Mrs. Amond has been in since the last misfortune, which
+ you know of long ere now both from Duncan and her; and to add to
+ her trouble she had not heard from Mr. Ashton for two months, for
+ yours of the 3 and another of the 12 of July only came to her hand
+ last night. I can assure you, both were most acceptable and gave her
+ that quiet of mind which she had not felt of a long time. Duncan told
+ me in his last letter he was to writ to you, and he will inform you
+ better of that unlucky affair and how it now stands than I can doe.
+ But he has acted a winderful part, and has been so far successful to
+ delay it till Mr. Ashton be on a surer footing.... Who knows but it
+ may turn to Mr. Ashton’s advantage, and in the meantime I hop you
+ will soon get a good account of all ... which, if rightly managed,
+ will be of use. Key and Mrs. Amond has both been in pain how to
+ manage everything that could occasion the appearing of what they
+ were earnest to hide as long as Humphray had anything to do in the
+ country. At such a time it’s impossible to think all will succeed as
+ we wold have it; but with Duncan’s diligence we got more time for all
+ than could have been expected, and if it had not been for Duncan, Mr.
+ Ashton wold a been undone by one who has the same relation to Mr.
+ Ashton that Duncan has, but he acted the contrary part and pusht Mr.
+ Ashton’s ruin, and said it was to serve him and his family. How will
+ Mrs. Amond live with that man that has used her best friend so ill?
+ To be just to his wife, she thought it really was as he said; but his
+ actings in that particular has made him odious, and yet I intend to
+ be in good friendship with him, more for his ill than his good.
+
+ Key goes to his Country-house this week and intends to go from
+ thence to the Carse (Holland) by way of Airth (London) that he may
+ talk with Duncan, and then go and find Peter (Dr. Erskine) by whose
+ help only we are to expect something done. Mr. Ashton is doubtful if
+ it will doe. No body can say it will or it will not, but as things
+ now are, it seems absolutely necessare to try; and had Mr. Ashton
+ been attainted and the misfortun to follow, there could a been no
+ retrieving; and if Peter doe not secure it before Humphray return, we
+ will be in a very hard state. But there has been so many different
+ turns of providence in that affair, Mrs. Amond has hopes yet, tho’
+ when she reflects how many difficulties (there are) and perhaps that
+ of Mr. Ashton’s not being willing to agree to terms that may be askt,
+ she fears the worst. But her greatest concern is for Mr. Ashton, and
+ she begs if you do come to the Carse to meet Key or Peter that you
+ may take care not to come where you may be in danger, because the
+ Prints bears that Lord D.(uffus) was taken at Hamburg, and she had
+ rather all want to Pot before Mr. Ashton’s person were in the least
+ danger. It certainly was a right measure for Key to go and see Peter,
+ and the more that a near friend was sent to Peter’s master with a
+ view to prepossess Peter with an ill opinion of Ashton, Key, Duncan
+ and all the rest, that so they might play their own game; and when
+ they hear of Key’s going it will put that family (the Haldanes) mad.
+ Certain it is Humphray has made Peter great offers if he will get his
+ master to agree to what he desires.
+
+ I doubt not Duncan will supply you with money, for he is the only
+ person that can do it just now, and he has the effect, so write to
+ him freely.
+
+ Mrs. Amond was afraid you had been displeased with her for asking you
+ to leave your society. It was a hardship on her to ask you; but when
+ she thought how much was at stake, and the opportunity lost could
+ never be recalled except Kid had better success, she thought it right
+ to lay it before you; and your being content to yield to your friends
+ and her, makes her both wish and hop it may be done in the manner you
+ wold have it, and she will never wish you to doe anything that may
+ reflect on you or occasion you uneasyness.
+
+ If you saw what different affairs Mrs. Amond has every day you wold
+ see it’s impossible for her to leave this place, and indeed, as
+ things now are, she cannot leave it a day; so she has not the least
+ thought of coming tho’ she inclines it very much, but she could not
+ doe it without partly blaming herself, and all the world wold do the
+ same. And as she has always preferr’d Mr. Ashton’s interest to her
+ own satisfaction, she intends to continue in her duty till providence
+ sends her a happy opportunity of seeing that person who is so much
+ the object of her thoughts, and for whom she thinks she can never doe
+ enough; and it’s her satisfaction that, barring the vilainy of that
+ creature (Hamilton) which was no way her fault, all her matters had
+ been as well as could have been expected at such a time. Mr. Ashton’s
+ boys are well.
+ Dearest Life, Adieu.
+
+ I writ to Duncan last week to send you money that you might not be
+ obligt to wait for it in case you intended to leave the place. May
+ God preserve you and direct you in every particular, and for God’s
+ sake beware of coming where you may be in danger.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXI
+
+THE MATTER IS STILL FURTHER DELAYED, BUT OUR ANXIETIES CONTINUE
+
+
+“How often did I say to you in the old days, Barbara, that I had dark
+misgivings about the Silver Mine?” said my lady one day, resting her
+head upon her hand and looking weary and discouraged. “I knew not what
+it meant, but ever have I had the presentiment that it would be the
+cause of great misfortune, and behold it is come true!”
+
+It was now the middle of August, and the negotiations in London had
+advanced considerably, but in no very satisfactory manner for Sir
+John. The post had just arrived, and I had found my Lady Erskine deep
+in her letters, from which she very obligingly read me some extracts.
+The situation certainly gave rise to much anxiety. In spite of Sir
+David Dalrymple’s verdict, the Ministers had been advised by their own
+lawyers to ignore the Scottish law of mines as to confiscature, so that
+our hopes in that direction were undermined; and as each party, King,
+Ministers, and Commons worked secretly in the matter, it seemed that
+much time would be lost before any decision could be come to.
+
+“Dear madam,” cried I, in response to my lady’s remarks, “does not Mr.
+Campbell still have hope that it may turn to Sir John’s benefit? He has
+not lost heart, and why should we? He is determined to fight for it,
+and with the help of Mr. Erskine and Doctor Robin, may we not hope that
+something will be done?”
+
+“My heart is very heavy,” she sighed, “and oh, the time is long--long!
+If I had but the assurance, Barbara, that my dear life would be
+restored to me safe and sound, I would almost consent to give them the
+information they desire, and let them do their worst. The absence of
+Sir John is still the bitterest part of all.”
+
+“Courage, dear cousin!” I whispered, kneeling down beside her and
+encircling her with my arms, for the look in her eyes smote my heart,
+and I knew that I had no real comfort to give her. “Be patient a little
+longer and brave, madam, I pray.”
+
+“The many difficulties that lie in our path keep recurring to my mind,”
+she said, rousing herself a little, “and I go over them to myself
+again and again. We know now that, in spite of all Mr. Campbell’s
+care, the Scots law of mines is to go for naught. The Government is
+eagerly anxious to make Sir John an outlaw, and lay hands on all his
+belongings. They are determined to send down the commission to see
+what is in the matter, and thereby we incur great danger; ‘for,’ says
+Patrick Campbell, ‘if they find nothing where they imagine mountains
+of silver, they will be very angry, and say there is no reason why Sir
+John should get his pardon, seeing he has nothing to give in return;
+if, on the other hand, they stumble on something of value, scruples
+will at once be raised--why should it not all be seized and made use
+of in payment of the public debts? The ministers fear the clamour of
+the House of Commons in these days, and there are signs that my Lord
+Townshend is not so secure as he thinks.’ You see, Barbara, Sir John is
+‘between the devil and the deep sea,’ as the saying is, and nothing is
+less certain now than his pardon.”
+
+I held my peace, depressed beyond measure by what I had heard.
+
+“On the other hand,” she went on, “there are other difficulties which
+arise in my mind, knowing my dear husband as I do. Suppose the Prince
+of Wales prevails with his father to grant the remission, and the
+latter makes conditions too hard for Sir John to accept, what then? We
+are in a worse hole than before. Were they to insist upon his taking
+the oath of allegiance to King George, and renouncing all interest in
+his rightful King; or worse still, were they to question him in the
+hope of his turning spy, I am perfectly certain that Sir John would
+refuse to accept anything at their hands, and prefer rather to live and
+die an exile.”
+
+“And _you_ would rather that he did so, madam,” cried I.
+
+“Oh, without doubt, my dear, I would. I could not ask him to stain his
+honour, however much I should benefit. But can you wonder, child, that
+my heart is sore, thinking of all that may lie before us? Sir John is
+not a very young man, and my boys are ever in my thoughts.”
+
+And with that she left me, going upstairs as I suspected to her
+praying-closet, where she was wont to seek comfort and help in all her
+troubles.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+I will now tell you briefly of what took place at London, without
+waiting to describe the way in which each item of news reached us. The
+summer was nearly over, and it was fully a year since the beginning of
+that unlucky affair, which had brought nothing but loss and woe to so
+many. The unfortunate prisoners still lay in their dungeons, and from
+time to time we heard sorrowful tales of sickness and deaths among
+them. It had been decided, in a quite illegal way, that the Scots
+prisoners were to be tried at Carlisle in the autumn, chiefly, as we
+all knew, because no Scots jury could be trusted to condemn them;
+and this action greatly increased the rage and discontent against
+the Government, for all parties throughout the country acknowledged
+its injustice. Many blameless people were suffering privation, and
+bereavement, and bitter loss, and the state of our poor country was
+truly to be deplored. One piece of comfort my lady had, for old Colonel
+Erskine and his son, though still in the Fleet were, owing to the
+kindness of their friends, in good heart and fair health. Great hopes
+were held out of their final delivery (which indeed took place a couple
+of months later), seeing that nothing could be found against them.
+
+We were made anxious about this time by hearing that our little
+favourite, Lordy Erskine, was laid down with the small-pox, from which
+both his stepmother and her little daughter were suffering. He was
+indeed a most attractive child, and it was with great relief that
+we heard in good time of his complete recovery. And here I think I
+must tell you of Tommy’s spirited reply to General Stanhope, which,
+though you may have forgotten it, was much quoted at the time among
+his friends. When the Secretary one day, some weeks before the Earl of
+Mar left Scotland, was visiting Westminster School, his eye lighted
+on my young lord, and, being struck by his charming appearance, he
+inquired whose son he was. On being told, he went up to the boy, and
+asked him some questions as to how his studies were progressing. Tommy
+replied modestly, “Indifferently well.” Whereupon Mr. Stanhope, with
+what I must confess was very questionable taste, hoped that whatever my
+Lord Erskine learned at school, he would learn not to be a Rebel like
+his father. At that Tommy put his hands on his sides, and looking the
+General steadily in the face, said boldly, “Let me remind you, sir,
+that it is not yet decided _who_ are the Rebels!”
+
+As his aunt, Lady Jean, remarked when telling us the story, the
+Government might deprive him of his estates, but they could not rob him
+of his good sense and ready wit.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+The “Process of Outlawry” against Sir John was suddenly checked by
+the consideration that, although the Commissioners were sent to Alva,
+they might easily fail in their quest without the assistance of the
+owner. Mr. Campbell had taken care to enlarge upon Sir John’s wide and
+intimate knowledge of mining affairs, and indeed at that time he was
+one of the few gentlemen in Britain who had made the subject a matter
+of study. Having worked the coal upon his estate, and discovered the
+Silver Mine for himself, it was given out that he knew more of the
+geological conditions of the Ochil Range than any man living, and it
+occurred to Lord Townshend that to quarrel with the man that possessed
+such valuable knowledge was not the wisest policy; in fact, it might
+be compared to the folly of killing the goose that laid the golden
+eggs. He therefore, after consulting with the Prince of Wales--the
+King himself having gone over to Hanover on a holiday--sent for Mr.
+Campbell, and after some preliminaries, suggested that the best thing
+for all concerned was to persuade Sir John to return to Scotland to
+conduct the business himself. Mr. Campbell, always anxious to gain
+time, and to make things sure before committing his friends, said he
+would be obliged to lay the matter before Mr. Erskine, whom he was
+expecting immediately to visit him at London. My lord thereupon begged
+that Mr. Erskine be persuaded to call upon him on his arrival, to which
+proposition Mr. Campbell, nothing loth, agreed.
+
+My lady, in the midst of her anxiety, was amused to learn that when Mr.
+Erskine was introduced to the Secretary that gentleman asked him point
+blank what information he could give about his brother’s Mine. But the
+future Lord Justice Clerk was too good a lawyer to fall into so simple
+a trap. He answered very firmly that, as he understood the disclosure
+of that affair was to be made the condition of some favour shown to Sir
+John, until he was assured of the extent and certainty of the benefit,
+he must beg to be excused from giving them any information. This reply,
+which was only what might have been expected, threw the Minister back
+to where he had been; so after much consultation and discussion, it
+was at last agreed that the Prince of Wales should grant a protection
+to Sir John for his return to Britain, at the same time writing to the
+King in Hanover for a warrant for his pardon, which would be delivered
+to him, signed and sealed, upon his presenting himself to Lord
+Townshend. Mr. Erskine and Mr. Campbell were at great pains to have
+the conditions made as plain as possible, for, they affirmed, it would
+be useless to expect Sir John to take oaths, or to give information
+against his inclination. A promise was then made that full discovery of
+the Mine was all that would be required of him, and my Lord Townshend
+suggested that a letter to this effect be intrusted to Sir Harry
+Stirling, and that he should set out forthwith to find his uncle and
+lay the matter before him.
+
+We were all now able to breathe a little more freely, though our
+anxieties were by no means at an end. For close upon this came the
+news, that in spite of the promises of the Prince and the Minister,
+the Commissioners were still to be sent to spy out the land, and by no
+means would they be delayed until Sir John could send a reply. This
+excess of zeal was attributed to Haldane of Gleneagles, and as you can
+imagine, it did not tend to increase my lady’s love for that gentleman.
+However, backed by his friends in the House of Commons, Gleneagles was
+like to win his way, which prospect filled us with fear and trouble, as
+there was no saying what the result would be, should the Commissioners
+reach Alva before Sir John landed at London, and had his pardon in his
+hand.
+
+Sir Isaac Newton was now approached, it being suggested that he should
+himself head the party of inquiry, and make investigation of the mines.
+But fortunately as it turned out, this wise and learned man raised
+objections to this scheme, affirming that as he was not skilled in such
+matters he would be of little use, and suggesting rather that someone
+bred up to that kind of work be sent instead of him. He spoke of the
+King’s Silver Mines in Hanover, and gave it as his opinion that an
+expert from that country should be chosen. This meeting with general
+approval, an express was despatched abroad to summon one, Dr. Justus
+Brandshagen, who was said to be a skilled engineer of mines.
+
+This news enraged my Lady Erskine to such a degree that she could not
+contain her wrath, and as I was equally angry, we stormed together for
+several minutes till our feelings were somewhat relieved.
+
+“And who,” she cried with fine scorn, pointing to Mr. Campbell’s
+letter, “who do you suppose is appointed guide and assistant to this
+German miner? Who, but our good friend and late trusty servant, Mr.
+James Hamilton!”
+
+“Oh, madam,” cried I aghast, “’tis little short of an outrage! How will
+that man ever be able to look at you again? How dare he show his face
+within twenty miles of Alva? This indeed might be called adding insult
+to injury. I, for one, will never speak to him again.”
+
+“Alas! Barbara,” said my lady, with tears of anger in her eyes, “’tis
+but the fulfilment of all his hopes, the clear result of all his
+scheming. For money he betrayed us, for money he will return, and I
+doubt not he will be able to brazen it out, and even to justify his
+conduct in the eyes of some people.”
+
+An urgent letter was that day despatched to Mr. Erskine, begging him as
+he valued my lady’s friendship and his brother’s welfare, to lose no
+time in setting out for Holland, and having found Sir John (for we had
+not yet heard of his meeting with Sir Harry Stirling) to urge him with
+all the fervour and eloquence in his power to make no delay, but return
+at once to England, and secure the favour promised to him. How short
+a time lay before him none could tell, but it would be a monstrous
+wrong, now that the longed-for boon lay so near his grasp, to let it
+fail them through any lack of care. Should Sir John refuse to listen to
+reason, there was still the help of Doctor Robin and his master to fall
+back upon. “But oh,” she wrote, “do all you can to persuade him (and
+it’s _you_ that have the golden tongue) to listen to our wishes in the
+matter.”
+
+A speedy reply was returned to her, saying that Mr. Erskine was on the
+eve of starting for the Hague, and assuring her that she might have
+full confidence in his endeavours, seeing that in this, his wishes
+jumped with her own. It showed the more devotion to his brother’s case,
+that Mr. Erskine had left his young wife at Tinwald in a delicate
+condition, and indeed she was brought to bed of her eldest son, while
+her husband was still abroad.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+Nothing now was to be done but to await results, and all our minds were
+occupied by the question as to which should arrive first: Sir John in
+London to claim his pardon, or the Commissioners at Alva to make their
+investigations.
+
+In this matter I have always believed that Providence interfered in
+our behalf, and my lady, I know, agreed with me, for as we learned
+afterwards, when Dr. Brandshagen (how we hated the poor man’s name,
+though no blame attached to him,) was at last ready to set out
+for Scotland, having been delayed at London waiting for money and
+instructions, at first it took him five days to find a ship that would
+carry him and his effects to Leith, and when he sailed on the 20th of
+September, he encountered such tempestuous weather, that he was three
+weeks and two days on the way. Twice were they overtaken by storms,
+in which they lost a mast each time, and thrice were they driven upon
+sand-banks, so that it was not till the 15th of October that he arrived
+in Edinburgh, where he had a conference with the Earl of Lauderdale,
+John Haldane of Gleneagles, and a friend of the latter, Mr. Drummond.
+But by that time, I am glad to say, it was too late for the mischief
+they were meditating, as I shall show you in the next chapter.
+
+My lady wrote frequently to her husband during those trying weeks,
+but most if not all of her letters miscarried, for the last remaining
+one in the packet is a hasty fragment which I give you here. Short
+as it is, it serves to show you the state of the poor lady’s mind at
+this time, her one thought being the consent of Sir John to the terms
+proposed, and her fear that it would not be given in time.
+
+
+LETTER XIX
+
+ Dr. Sr.
+
+ Amond bids me tell you she had yours of the 25th of August, but
+ she regretes Ashton has not yet met with Sr. Harry S--g. He is yet
+ in quest of him, and she hops you will both accept of the proffers
+ that’s made, and soon let your friends know that you doe so. There
+ is people soon to be sent down in quest, and if it were possible you
+ could be here, it’s more in your power to manage with respect to the
+ Garden than any other mortall.... I shall writ all to Duncan and Key,
+ who will be more fit to advise you, for they seem not to be out of
+ hope of getting the pardon expected as soon as your answer comes. The
+ friends here say otherwise, and think H--y is gone to diswade you.
+ There must be no delay in the case as you regard your interest, but
+ be directed in the way and manner by Key and Duncan. God preserve and
+ direct you.
+
+ Our friends in the Fleet, I have good reason to think, will be safe,
+ but those here seem to have bitter things before them.... I am sorry
+ you have not got all my letters, but Ashton’s is a great consolation
+ in the midst of different troubles. Your children are well.
+
+ Dearest Creatur, let us have your answer soon, for these creatures
+ will be down in eight or ten days, and what I shall doe, God knows! I
+ am in great hast at present, but shall be more full next post.
+
+ So Dear, Adieu.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXII
+
+SHOWS SOMETHING OF THE TRIALS AND PERPLEXITIES OF OUR GOOD SIR JOHN
+OVER THE BUSINESS
+
+
+In the meantime Sir John himself had been passing through various
+anxieties of his own, though I can only give you a very brief account
+of his doings from the notes in my little diary, and the remembrance of
+his own conversation. It was not till long afterwards that I realised
+how much greater cause we should have had to tremble had we known more
+of the brave knight’s movements during these months of summer. I have
+told you how my lady’s heart was lightened by learning that he had
+at last taken his departure from Avignon. No doubt, dear soul, she
+regarded it as the tardy result of her wifely prayers and counsels.
+But had she known of the packet he bore with him, which, if discovered
+by the agents of King George, would have put an end to all hope of
+pardon for ever, what terrors she would have suffered, what anguish of
+anxiety she would have endured; and with good reason--for the King had
+entrusted to Sir John a letter to the King of Sweden, begging for his
+help in a new endeavour to recover his birthright.
+
+The news of the Forfeited Estates Bill, which had been passed, was
+a great blow to Sir John, for the thought that others should suffer
+through him was intolerable to his kind and honest heart, and he fully
+agreed with my lady’s dictum, that anything she could save out of
+the estate must go to the paying of private debts even to the last
+sixpence. When the news of the treacherous discovery of his Mine
+reached him, he was further distressed, realising all that it meant
+for him. As Mr. Campbell, in writing of this, had warned him that it
+might be necessary for some of his friends to go and consult with him
+as to a method of procedure, he, after confiding his troubles to his
+friend, the Earl of Mar, and receiving kind permission from the King,
+decided to go to Hamburg where he should be within easy reach of the
+Hague, and also in the way of meeting his brother, the doctor, who with
+his master, the Czar, was expected shortly in these parts.
+
+He accordingly set out from Avignon about the middle of July, going
+first to Brussels and then to Amsterdam, but upon finding there letters
+from home of the greatest importance, he hurried to Lubeck, where,
+after waiting some days, he was rejoiced to welcome his nephew, Sir
+Harry Stirling, who laid before him my Lord Townshend’s proposals,
+and explained the situation of things at home. Thinking that having
+got such lenient conditions there was no great press in making up
+his mind on the matter, Sir John, having written an account of it to
+my Lord Mar, proceeded on his errand to Hamburg, where he found that
+General Hamilton, with whom he was ordered to consult on the King’s
+affairs, was not in that place, and indeed was at too great a distance
+to communicate with him. He met instead the agent of the Swedish King,
+Colonel Sparre, and accepting his offer to bring him to Sweden under
+cover of his own passport, he went with him to Travemunde, only to find
+it in possession of a small Russian garrison, which was nevertheless
+strong enough to bar the way to suspected travellers, Russia and Sweden
+being at enmity at that time. He was for some days weather-bound in
+a small town on the Elbe about forty miles from Hamburg, which he
+described as a “miserable nasty hole, where the inhabitants did nothing
+but drink bad beer, smoke bad tobacco, and chatter in a tongue which
+he could not understand.” Cut off from all letters, and chafing at
+the delay, he fell into a fit of depression, he told us after, that
+bordered on despair. But the weather clearing at last, he made his way
+back to Hamburg, where he found a letter from my Lord Mar, bidding him
+give up the notion of going to Sweden at this time.
+
+As he had learned from Colonel Sparre that though the King of Sweden
+was favourable to King James, many of his statesmen were not, and that
+according to Sparre’s opinion it was not a good time to approach him on
+the subject, Sir John felt less regret in giving up the mission than
+he otherwise might have done. He remained some days longer at Hamburg,
+in hopes of hearing from Mar in reply to his letter about his private
+business, and when it reached him he was pleased to find it contained
+a very kind and gracious message from the King, to the effect that
+his Majesty was glad to hear of the probability of Sir John’s success
+in his own affairs, and said that now he could do nothing in what was
+intrusted to him, that was to be his chief concern. These generous
+words, as you will imagine, warmed the heart of Sir John, for he was
+in a strait between two strong desires, namely: the furtherance of the
+King’s success, and the welfare of his own family; or to put it in my
+Lord Mar’s words, he was “in a nice situation ’twixt honour on the one
+side and interest on the other.”
+
+He went on to say, “The world is malicious enough always to put the
+worst construction on things, so a man who values his reputation ought
+to think well in such a case, and do what he really thinks right.”
+
+It cost Sir John no little pain to give up, here and now, all thought
+of helping in the Cause to which he was so much devoted; for he knew
+very well that once returned to Scotland he would be carefully watched,
+and only in covert and secret ways could his assistance again be given.
+It was a trial also to his pride to think how he might be pointed at as
+a turn-coat and a renegade, who took the King’s favours and rejoiced in
+his confidence, only to throw him over and desert him in the end. To a
+man of honour the situation was indeed extremely difficult, and when it
+is remembered that Sir John had besides a warm and affectionate heart
+towards the King, it is easy to imagine how he was torn in two, at the
+thought of thus parting from his friends.
+
+However, his calmer judgment told him there was but one thing to be
+done, and that the happiness of those depending on him must be his
+first care. To make up in some degree for his desertion from active
+service on the King’s behalf, he had written to his brother, the
+doctor, hoping to enlist him in the Cause, and begging him to do his
+utmost to gain the Czar’s help and interest in the same. Through Sir
+Harry Stirling he received full confirmation of his hopes, for Dr.
+Robin wrote that he and his master heartily wished King George at the
+Devil, and the latter regretted that he was too far away to be able to
+send him there. The Czar was also anxious and willing to assist Sir
+John in his own affairs, if Mr. Campbell’s proposals were likely to
+fail, a promise which accorded well with Sir John’s inclinations, for
+he felt it would be easier to accept a ton of assistance from the Czar
+of Russia, than one ounce of favour from the Elector of Hanover.
+
+He had by this time made his way, after being much delayed by storms,
+to Amsterdam, which he reached on the 29th of September, and here, a
+few days later, Mr. Erskine found him. Sir John’s delight at meeting
+with his brother was much dashed by the latter’s assurance that his
+departure for England, with scarce a day’s delay, was the only course
+open to him if he wished to benefit by the efforts of his friends on
+his behalf. It was in vain he pleaded his master’s needs, his own
+desire to meet with Doctor Erskine, and the necessity of at least
+waiting for returns to his letters from my Lord Mar. He had not heard
+from Avignon now for five weeks, and he was at heart somewhat uneasy
+as to the reason of the silence. The Earl might have some cause for
+displeasure, thinking that after all Sir John should not prefer his own
+advantage to the King’s, or his letters anent the business with the
+Czar might have miscarried, and all his work would go for naught.
+
+To none of this would Mr. Erskine listen. He informed Sir John that
+it would be now almost a race between himself and the Commissioners
+who were on their way to Alva, if indeed not already there. Should
+they reach the mine before Sir John had secured his pardon, they might
+decide to put such conditions on the latter that it would never be
+accepted. Mr. Erskine offered to stay for a time in Holland, and
+as far as in him lay, to take his brother’s place. He would see or
+correspond with Sir Harry and the doctor, and all communications
+with Avignon might be carried on through him as if he were Sir John
+himself. In another way he reminded him, he might really be benefiting
+the King’s cause by his immediate departure. If he refused, after
+receiving the offer of such easy terms, to return home at once, my
+Lord Townshend might suspect that there was something stirring in the
+King’s affairs to keep him on the Continent, and would cause his agents
+to be more vigilant among them, which at the present juncture would
+not be convenient. But if so trusted a friend of the Earl of Mar were
+permitted to leave the party, it would seem to suggest that matters
+were not in a good way, and their hopes of present success very low.
+
+In fact the “golden tongue” did its work, and so eloquently did it
+speak that at length Sir John was convinced of his brother’s wisdom,
+and agreed to all that he proposed. Immediately upon this he wrote two
+letters to the Earl of Mar with full explanations of his plans and his
+difficulties, his hopes and fears, but unfortunately these letters
+were delayed in the transit, as the earl’s to himself had been, and
+there followed some weeks of pain and distrust between the friends.
+On the 8th of October, Sir John, “with a very heavy heart,” set sail
+for England, and the news being carried to Avignon, without the true
+explanation of his departure, the company there were plunged in wrath
+and dismay, and even for a few days entertained doubts of their late
+companion’s honesty. A letter from Mr. Erskine to my Lord Mar a little
+later cleared up the mystery and restored tranquillity to their minds,
+but the stories followed Sir John to England, and it grieved him not a
+little to have suspicion thrown upon his loyalty, by those who should
+have known him better.
+
+It was, to be sure, a surprising thing for friends and foes alike to
+see Sir John Erskine, whom all supposed to be in exile, and in high
+danger of being attainted, walking openly in the streets of London, in
+company with this or that member of the Government. Courteous, genial
+and debonnaire as ever, he did not look like a proscribed outlaw, still
+less like a deserter turned spy, and many were the stories invented
+and circulated before the real truth of the matter leaked out. When it
+became known, I think there were few who did not rejoice and wonder,
+for the story of the Silver Glen was like a fairy-tale, and I suppose
+that Sir John was the only man in Britain who had been bribed to accept
+his Remission from King George.
+
+The interview with my Lord Townshend was entirely satisfactory. No
+oaths were exacted, no questions asked. The pardon was duly signed,
+sealed, and delivered on the 22nd day of October, and on the 27th Sir
+John set out post for Scotland, with relief in his heart, and “a broad
+seal in his pocket.”
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXIII
+
+THE STORY ENDS IN PEACE AND SUNSHINE, AND I TAKE LEAVE OF MY KIND
+READERS
+
+
+I will leave you to imagine the joy and thankfulness at Alva when
+the news of Sir John’s arrival at London reached us, for no words of
+mine can express it; and when it was known that the pardon was an
+accomplished fact, and that the good knight was on his way home, the
+happy excitement rose to the highest pitch.
+
+What joy it was to see my lady’s altered mien, to hear the thrill in
+her voice and watch the smiles trembling round her mouth! The little
+boys were wild with delight at the prospect of seeing again their
+much-loved father; and there was not a neighbour nor a tenant on the
+place, who did not rejoice in the good news and sympathise with our
+happiness.
+
+Mr. Patrick Campbell was to accompany Sir John on his journey from
+London, and his wife came over from Monzie to meet them both. Old Lady
+Alva was with us, and also Aunt Betty, while at my lady’s invitation my
+Lord and Lady Wemyss arrived to join in the general welcome. How gay we
+were, how busy with preparations, how full of thankfulness and relief!
+Although the year was near November, it seemed to me as if we were
+bidding good-bye to the darkness of winter and preparing to welcome the
+summer; and Nature kindly did nothing to discourage me in the thought,
+for the sun shone warm and bright, and though the trees were casting
+their leaves they were not yet bare, and the gold and ruddy tints,
+softened by silver mists and purple shadows, still made the landscape
+lovely. Nothing was wanting to complete my satisfaction but the
+presence of my lover, and once or twice, I must own, my heart cried out
+in the midst of my happiness, “Would that he too were coming!”
+
+According to his agreement it was necessary for Sir John to stop in
+Edinburgh for an interview with Dr. Brandshagen, whose letters of
+instruction were that he should wait for the knight to show him his
+mines himself. By someone’s good management, I suppose, there had been
+a convenient delay in supplying the German with funds, so that he was
+obliged to remain where he was till he received them; but Sir John,
+having expressed his readiness with all courtesy to carry out his part
+of the bargain at any moment, there was nothing now left for him to do
+but to hasten homewards, whither his heart, I doubt not, had already
+flown.
+
+He had been so thoughtful as to send an express to my lady from
+Edinburgh to prepare her for his arrival, and the next afternoon we
+were all assembled with beating hearts to listen for the farthest sound
+of horse’s feet.
+
+“My papa will be here in plenty of time for my birthday,” cried little
+Hal, as he ceased his jumping about the room and climbed into my lap.
+“I am a luckier boy than Charles. Does Sir John know that I am grown so
+big, Cousin Barbe?”
+
+I could scarce listen to the child’s chatter nor answer it, but when
+Charles put his hand upon my shoulder, and whispered, “How I wish he
+were bringing Captain Anthony!” I turned and kissed him on the cheek,
+with a sudden pain in my heart.
+
+At last--at last we heard them coming--the galloping growing nearer
+and nearer, the shouts of the country-folk assembled along the road
+becoming louder and more distinct.
+
+“Hurrah! hurrah!” “Long life to Sir John!” “Glad to see ye hame again!”
+“Welcome, welcome!” we could indeed distinguish the words for we
+were now standing at the door, my lady with a son in each hand, her
+mother-in-law beside her, we others pressing round, and the servants
+just behind. The tears were running down the old lady’s cheeks, and
+Aunt Betty was sobbing loudly, her kerchief to her eyes; but I looked
+at my lady’s quiet face, and though it was pale, I was struck by the
+lovely light that shone there. “Sure,” thought I, “no husband returning
+home was ever greeted by a sweeter, truer wife!”
+
+And then the cavalcade swept into sight, and we caught our breath, and
+a low sound that was neither laugh nor cry, but partook of both, broke
+from the lips of all.
+
+Sir John rode first, his head bared in the sunshine, his face alight
+with joy, and our eyes were fixed upon him. Almost before he reached
+the door he checked his horse, and dismounting quickly, turned with
+hands outstretched. It was as if he saw one face alone in all that
+crowd, as if he cared for the welcome of but one voice. His mother
+uttered his name in loving, trembling tones; his boys ran forward
+gleefully to clasp his knees; but he did not speak nor heed them till,
+without a word, my lady staggered to his arms and was clasped in a long
+embrace.
+
+And then, I knew not why, the unbidden tears came to my eyes, and
+turning away to hide them, I encountered a sudden shock. Was I
+dreaming? Oh, what did it mean, and how had it happened? Or were my
+eyes playing me false? I dashed the tears away and looked again. And
+there close at my side, his face aglow with feeling, his eyes dim with
+their mighty love, stood my dear Anthony, so tall and brave and strong
+and full of joy, that, in spite of the publicity, I followed my lady’s
+example and threw myself into his arms.
+
+I emerged from them to be greeted with sympathetic laughter and a
+shower of questions. “Where did he come from?” “Did you know, Barbara;
+were you expecting him?” “Why did you not tell us?” But dazed with my
+surprise and happiness, I could only look from him to them and back
+again.
+
+Sir John came to my rescue with a great kind laugh that did me good to
+hear.
+
+“No, no, I can answer for it. Barbara knew nothing of this. But when I
+met the young gentleman at York a night or two ago, and he confided to
+me that he was on his way to my house, I very naturally asked him to
+join my party and go along with us, thinking I should be none the less
+welcome here for bringing him in my train.”
+
+You will know then that Barbara’s cup of happiness was full to the
+brim, and when my dear lady said, out before them all,
+
+“It wanted only this to make the day perfect; none but myself know how
+good, how brave and patient our Barbara has been. I think she is being
+rewarded for all her unselfish love to me!”
+
+Well, when she spoke thus, my cup overflowed.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+It was indeed a perfect day, an earnest of others as perfect to follow!
+How strangely pleasant it was at dinner to see Sir John again in his
+place, his hospitable smile showing us all what pleasure the meeting
+gave him. How sweet to see my lady’s tremulous happiness, and the
+almost wistful way she hung upon her husband’s words. Old Lady Alva
+sat near him and Betty upon the other side; Mr. Campbell and his wife
+were together, “for,” said he, “we have been so many weeks separate
+that we are as good as lovers again.” My Anthony sat at my lady’s left
+hand, (my Lord Wemyss being on her right), and Barbara by his side. The
+little boys were admitted to the banquet to their vast delight, and
+even poor Aunt Betty’s face was wreathed in smiles. It would indeed
+have been difficult to find a happier party in all Scotland.
+
+When dessert was on the table and the servants gone, Sir John brought
+out of his pocket the immediate cause of our peace and contentment.
+
+You have all seen it--the great document with the portrait of King
+George in the left-hand corner, and the “broad seal” attached--the
+Remission, or Pardon, without which we could never have welcomed Sir
+John to his home, nor indeed enjoyed any real happiness. With what awe
+and interest we gazed upon it, as we listened to Mr. Campbell’s story
+of the wonderful part he had played in procuring it. Each point in
+the narrative was fraught with thrilling meaning to us, who through
+all those weary months had waited in uncertainty for this happy
+consummation. How we smiled and sighed as we recalled our hopes and
+fears, and thanked God in our hearts that all such anxiety was laid to
+rest at last.
+
+When the conversation had again become general my Anthony turned to me,
+and whispered,
+
+“I also bear in my pocket a document which means nearly as much to me
+as that other to Sir John;” and under cover of the table he presently
+slipped into my lap a letter addressed to me in an unknown hand. I
+need scarcely tell you that I apprehended its purport as soon as I saw
+it, and smiled my silent agreement. It was as I surmised, from Mr.
+Fleming’s parents, welcoming me with warm approval as the future wife
+of their dear son, and agreeing very kindly to leave all arrangements
+for our marriage in the hands of my guardians, Sir John and Lady
+Erskine. My Anthony’s pardon had been easy to arrange, his father
+having many friends at court. But he was under oath never to take up
+arms against King George as long as he lived, for which reason, he told
+me, laughing, it was a mercy that most of his life would be passed away
+from Britain, so that he was not likely to be tempted in that way again.
+
+I remember telling him how glad I was that my husband was to be a
+civilian, making his living peacefully by the pen instead of the sword,
+so that I should not be obliged to go in fear of my life every time
+there was a war. How little did I then think that after thirty years he
+should again become a soldier, and win for himself honour and a Title,
+fighting in the service of the East India Company against Governor
+Dupliex in the Carnatic. Still stranger would it have been to know that
+his being wounded and disabled in these same wars should contribute
+to my peace of mind, but so it was, for the misfortune put an end to
+his soldiering, and brought us back to England, thus proving itself a
+blessing in disguise.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+And now, my dears, the story I set out to tell you is done. Like
+all human histories it is a mingling of joy and sorrow, of laughter
+and tears, and perhaps, looking at the hidden heart of things, the
+tears predominate. But it were not wise to end a tale like this upon
+a tragic note. God veils in mercy the future from our eyes, else were
+it not possible properly to enjoy His many blessings; and so I am glad
+to leave my dear Lady Erskine at this bright and peaceful season of
+her life, to see her as I love best to remember her, standing in the
+sunshine, the haunting fear gone from her eyes, and the sweet light of
+loving welcome transfiguring her face.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+For more than three months I have been living in the past, seeing the
+friends of my girlhood, and listening to the tones of their voices.
+At times I have raised my eyes from the paper before me, dazed and
+bewildered to find myself alone--an old woman with my life behind me,
+and so many of those dear ones gone. Now the Summer is over, the Autumn
+days are drawing in; no longer does the mavis sing in the garden, and
+as I write these lines, a moaning wind arises and whirls the leaves
+across the darkening lawn. But far overhead in the pale sky the stars
+are coming out; they speak to my heart of Heavenly Consolation, and as
+I thank God that I am not left desolate, I hear my dear Sir Anthony’s
+step outside upon the stair.
+
+And so, my dears, adieu.
+
+
+THE END
+
+
+W. JOLLY & SONS, PRINTERS, ABERDEEN
+
+
+
+
+_POPULAR NOVELS BY MAY WYNNE_
+
+Author of “Henry of Navarre,” “A Maid of Brittany,” &c.
+
+In Crown 8vo, Cloth gilt. Price 6s. each
+
+
+A KING’S TRAGEDY
+
+ BY
+ MAY WYNNE
+ Author of “Henry of Navarre,” &c.
+
+“Miss May Wynne has enhanced her reputation, already firmly established
+by a splendidly-written romance, founded upon Scottish history relating
+to the fifteenth century. The troublous times after the return of
+James I. of Scotland to his throne from captivity in England are
+interestingly dealt with. The local colouring is graphically given and
+the internecine troubles between the Highland Clans, their modes of
+warfare and the horribly vindictive spirit in which their raids and
+forays were carried out are related in a manner which is faithfully
+true to both history and tradition. The loves and adventures of Sir
+Alan Kennedy and his brother David are made the medium through which
+the interest of the reader is centred and retained through a most
+charming book.”
+
+ _Liverpool Daily Post._
+
+
+THE GOAL
+
+ By the Author of “Henry of Navarre,” &c.
+
+_The STANDARD says--_
+
+“‘The Goal’ with its pleasant studies of village friendships, its
+sincere love of beautiful country sights and scenes, its delicate
+portraiture and its characters will win many true and warm admirers....
+The scene between two children and the gossipy old maid is in its way
+quite a triumph. Miss Wynne’s sketches of girls are done with great
+charity, sweetness and charm.”
+
+
+ LONDON:
+ DIGBY, LONG & Co., 18, Bouverie St., Fleet St., E.C.
+
+
+
+
+Transcriber’s Notes
+
+• Italics represented with _underscores_.
+
+• Small caps converted to ALL CAPS.
+
+• Illustrations relocated close to relevant content.
+
+• Obvious typographic errors silently corrected. No corrections made
+ to the quoted letters as the author seems to intend to represent the
+ letter writer’s original with errors intact.
+
+• Variations in hyphenation and spelling have been kept as in the original.
+
+• Footnote numbered and relocated next to relevant paragraph.
+
+
+*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 76963 ***
diff --git a/76963-h/76963-h.htm b/76963-h/76963-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..36fc6a3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/76963-h/76963-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,14934 @@
+<!DOCTYPE html>
+<html lang="en">
+<head>
+ <meta charset="UTF-8">
+ <title>
+ The silver glen | Project Gutenberg
+ </title>
+ <link rel="icon" href="images/cover.jpg" type="image/x-cover">
+ <style>
+
+body { margin: 0 10%; font-family: serif; }
+
+h1,h2,h3,h4,h5,h6 {
+ text-align: center; /* all headings centered */
+ clear: both;
+}
+
+h1 { line-height: 1.5em; }
+h2 { margin-top: 4em; margin-bottom: 1em; }
+
+p {
+ margin: 0;
+ text-align: justify;
+ text-indent: 1.5em;
+}
+
+.footnotes p { text-indent: 0; }
+
+.normal { font-weight: normal; }
+
+.chap-title {
+ font-variant: small-caps;
+ font-weight: bold;
+ text-align: center;
+ text-indent: 0;
+ margin: 1.5em 4em 1.5em 4em;
+}
+
+.no-indent { text-indent: 0; }
+
+.letter-indent { text-indent: 9em; }
+.letter-indent-plus { text-indent: 11em; }
+.letter-indent-less { text-indent: 5em; }
+
+.mtq {margin-top: .25em;}
+.mth {margin-top: .5em;}
+.mt1 {margin-top: 1em;}
+.mt1h {margin-top: 1.5em;}
+.mt2 {margin-top: 2em;}
+.mt2 {margin-top: 2em;}
+.mt2 {margin-top: 2em;}
+.mt4 {margin-top: 4em;}
+.mt6 {margin-top: 6em;}
+
+.mb6 { margin-bottom: 6em; }
+
+.pr1 { padding-right: 1em; }
+.pr2 { padding-right: 2em; }
+.pr4 { padding-right: 4em; }
+.pr6 { padding-right: 6em; }
+.pr8 { padding-right: 8em; }
+
+.ptq { padding-top: .25em; }
+
+.fs80 { font-size: 80%; }
+.fs90 { font-size: 90%; }
+.fs120 { font-size: 120%; }
+.fs150 { font-size: 150%; }
+.fs200 { font-size: 200%; }
+
+.ltsp1 { letter-spacing: .1em; }
+.ltsp2 { letter-spacing: .2em; }
+
+.blackletter { font-weight: bold;
+ font-family: "Old English Text MT", "Lucida Blackletter",
+ "Noto Serif Display Black", "Luminari", serif
+}
+
+.preface { font-size: 90%; }
+
+hr {
+ width: 33%;
+ margin-top: 2em;
+ margin-bottom: 2em;
+ margin-left: 33.5%;
+ margin-right: 33.5%;
+ clear: both;
+}
+
+hr.tb {width: 45%; margin-left: 27.5%; margin-right: 27.5%;}
+hr.chap {width: 65%; margin-left: 17.5%; margin-right: 17.5%;}
+@media print { hr.chap {display: none; visibility: hidden;} }
+
+hr.r35 {width: 35%; margin: .2em 32.5%; }
+
+div.chapter, div.front, div.transnote {page-break-before: always;}
+h2, h3, .nobreak, div.section {page-break-before: avoid;}
+
+
+table {
+ margin-left: auto;
+ margin-right: auto;
+}
+table.toc { border-collapse: collapse; max-width: 80%; font-size: 90%; }
+td { vertical-align: top; }
+
+.tdl { text-align: left;}
+.tdr {text-align: right;}
+.tdc {text-align: center;}
+.tdpn { vertical-align: bottom; text-align: right; }
+.toc .tdl { padding-left: 1em; }
+
+.pagenum {
+ position: absolute;
+ left: 92%;
+ font-size: small;
+ text-align: right;
+ font-style: normal;
+ font-weight: normal;
+ font-variant: normal;
+ text-indent: 0;
+ color: #888;
+} /* page numbers */
+
+
+blockquote { margin: 1em 3em; }
+
+.bt {border-top: 2px solid;}
+
+.adbox { margin: 2em; max-width: 80%; border: 2px solid black;
+ padding: 1.5em; }
+.adboxtitle {
+ margin-top: .5em;
+ text-align: center;
+ text-indent: 0;
+ font-size: 150%;
+}
+.adboxcopy { margin-top: 0.5em; font-size: 80%; }
+
+.center {text-align: center; text-indent: 0; }
+.right {text-align: right;}
+.smcap {font-variant: small-caps;}
+.allsmcap {font-variant: small-caps; text-transform: lowercase;}
+.bold { font-weight: bold; }
+.underline { text-decoration: underline; }
+
+figcaption {font-weight: bold;}
+figcaption p {margin-top: 0; margin-bottom: .2em; text-align: inherit;}
+
+/* Images */
+
+img {
+ max-width: 100%;
+ height: auto;
+}
+img.w100 {width: 100%;}
+
+.figcenter {
+ margin: 1em auto;
+ text-align: center;
+ page-break-inside: avoid;
+ max-width: 100%;
+}
+
+/* Footnotes */
+.footnotes {border: 1px dashed; padding: 1em; margin: 1em auto; }
+
+.footnote {margin-left: 8%; margin-right: 5%; font-size: 0.9em;}
+
+.footnote .label {position: absolute; right: 84%; text-align: right;}
+
+.fnanchor {
+ vertical-align: super;
+ font-size: .8em;
+ text-decoration:
+ none;
+}
+
+/* Poetry */
+.poetry-container {display: flex; justify-content: center;}
+.poetry-container {text-align: center;}
+.poetry {text-align: left; margin-left: 5%; margin-right: 5%;}
+
+/* Transcriber's notes */
+.transnote {background-color: #E6E6FA;
+ color: black;
+ font-size:small;
+ padding:0.5em;
+ margin-bottom:5em;
+ font-family:sans-serif, serif;
+}
+
+
+/* Illustration classes */
+.illowp50 {width: 50%;}
+.x-ebookmaker .illowp50 {width: 100%;}
+ </style>
+</head>
+<body>
+<div style='text-align:center'>*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 76963 ***</div>
+<p class='center'>This ebook was created in honour of Distributed Proofreaders’ 25th Anniversary.</p>
+
+<figure class="figcenter illowp50" id="cover" style="max-width: 125.8125em;">
+ <img class="w100" src="images/cover.jpg" alt="Book cover">
+</figure>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="front">
+
+<figure class="figcenter illowp50" id="i_frontspiece" style="max-width: 62.5em;">
+ <img class="w100" src="images/i_frontspiece.jpg" alt="">
+ <figcaption>
+ <p class='right normal'><i>From an Oil Painting.</i></p>
+
+ JOHN ERSKINE OF ALVA.
+ </figcaption>
+</figure>
+</div>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="front">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_i">[i]</span></p>
+
+<h1>
+ THE<br>
+ <span class='fs150 ltsp2'>SILVER GLEN</span>
+</h1>
+
+<p class='center blackletter fs150 ltsp1'>A Story of the Rebellion of 1715</p>
+
+<p class='center mt2 ltsp1'>
+ <i>AS TOLD BY BARBARA, LADY FLEMING, IN THE<br>
+ YEAR 1755; AT THE REQUEST OF HER<br>
+ KINSMAN, SIR HENRY ERSKINE.</i>
+</p>
+
+<p class='center mt2'>BY</p>
+<p class='center fs150'>BESSIE DILL</p>
+
+<p class='center fs90 mth'>AUTHOR OF</p>
+<p class='center fs80 mtq'> “MY LADY NAN,” “THE FINAL GOAL,” ETC., ETC.</p>
+
+<p class='center mt6'>LONDON</p>
+<p class='center fs150 bold ltsp1'>DIGBY, LONG &amp; CO.</p>
+<p class='center'>18 Bouverie Street, Fleet Street, E.C.</p>
+<p class='center fs90 mth'>1909</p>
+</div>
+
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="front">
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_ii">[ii]</span></p>
+<div class='poetry-container'>
+<div class='poetry'>
+<p class='center mt6 fs80'>To</p>
+<p class='center mt1 fs80'>MRS. ERSKINE-MURRAY AND HER FAMILY</p>
+<p class='center mt1 fs80'>This Book is affectionately</p>
+<p class='center mt1 fs80'>Dedicated</p>
+<p class='right fs80 mt1 mb6'>B. D.</p>
+</div></div>
+</div>
+
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_iii">[iii]</span></p>
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CONTENTS">
+ CONTENTS
+ </h2>
+</div>
+
+
+<table class='toc'>
+<tr>
+<th colspan='3'></th><th class='tdr'><span class='allsmcap'>PAGE</span></th>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td colspan='2'><a href='#INTRODUCTION'><span class="smcap">Introduction.</span></a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Telling of some old Letters, and the origin of
+ the writing of this Book</td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_7'>7</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td><span class="smcap">Chapter</span></td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_I'><span class="allsmcap">I.</span></a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Shows how Barbara Stewart left school</td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_12'>12</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_II'>II.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>How Barbara came home to Rosyth for the last
+ time </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_18'>18</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_III'>III.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Of my new Guardian, and the beginning of all
+ her kindness </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_24'>24</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_IV'>IV.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>I go to Alva, and become a member of a very
+ charming household </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_30'>30</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_V'>V.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>I hear of the Silver Glen for the first time
+ </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_37'>37</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_VI'>VI.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Introduces several characters who are all more or
+ less interesting </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_43'>43</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_VII'>VII.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>I become aware that something important is
+ afoot </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_55'>55</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_VIII'>VIII.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>I go to Dysart and there learn some Scottish
+ History </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_64'>64</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_IX'>IX.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>We meet one morning a very courtly gentleman,
+ and have news of the King’s coming </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_73'>73</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_X'>X.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Back at Alva we become still more involved in
+ affairs </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_82'>82</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XI'>XI.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Sir John prepares for action. Barbara goes out
+ to dine, and hears many strange things </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_90'>90</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XII'>XII.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Tells of the only occasion upon which I met the
+ Earl of Mar, also of how my Lady Erskine
+ stole down the turret-stairs in answer to a knock </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_99'>99</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XIII'>XIII.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Shows how a woman’s actions are ofttimes misunderstood,
+ and how Betty signalled to a
+ passenger in a boat </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_108'>108</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XIV'>XIV.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Tells how Mistress Betty had a brilliant notion,
+ and how it was carried out </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_116'>116</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XV'>XV.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>In which Betty and Barbara behave very
+ foolishly, and the latter is introduced to Mr.
+ Anthony Fleming</td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_125'>125</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_iv">[iv]</span>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XVI'>XVI.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Tells of various matters to be found in the
+ History-books, and of a romantic tale which
+ is not </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_136'>136</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XVII'>XVII.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Shows how we are swept into the stream of
+ events </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_149'>149</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XVIII'>XVIII.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Tells of a dark hour, and of a great awakening
+ </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_160'>160</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XIX'>XIX.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Shows how the Cause suffers many reverses; and
+ how Mr. Anthony Fleming says “Thank
+ you!” </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_171'>171</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XX'>XX.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Mr. Fleming rides away from Alva; The King
+ lands, and Sir John returns to Scotland not
+ quite in the manner he intended </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_181'>181</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXI'>XXI.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Tells of the coming of the King to Perth, and
+ what ensued thereafter </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_189'>189</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXII'>XXII.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>How we hear tidings that make our hearts ache,
+ and ill prepare us for the great surprise </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_197'>197</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXIII'>XXIII.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Tells of further sad doings, and of the beauty
+ and burden of the Spring </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_208'>208</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXIV'>XXIV.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>My Lady hears from Sir John, and I pay my
+ third visit to Dysart </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_217'>217</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXV'>XXV.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Tells of an unexpected meeting and a glad
+ surprise for Barbara </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_226'>226</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXVI'>XXVI.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Barbara is accused of cruelty and indiscretion</td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_238'>238</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXVII'>XXVII.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Shows how slowly the time passes when the
+ heart is heavy </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_254'>254</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXVIII'>XXVIII.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Tells of the good fortune for Betty and of the evil
+ deeds of the Parliament </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_268'>268</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXIX'>XXIX.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>The Calamity falls, and my Lady attends her
+ sister’s wedding in very low spirits </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_282'>282</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXX'>XXX.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>The affair of the Mine in the Mountain is much
+ discussed in London, but with no comforting
+ results </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_292'>292</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXXI'>XXXI.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>The matter is still further delayed, but our
+ anxieties continue </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_300'>300</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXXII'>XXXII.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>Shows something of the trials and perplexities
+ of our good Sir John over the business </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_308'>308</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td class='tdc'>”</td>
+<td class='tdr'><a href='#CHAPTER_XXXIII'>XXXIII.</a></td>
+<td class='tdl'>The story ends in peace and sunshine, and I
+ take leave of my kind readers </td>
+<td class='tdpn'><a href='#Page_314'>314</a></td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_v">[v]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="PREFACE">
+ PREFACE
+ </h2>
+</div>
+
+<div class='preface'>
+<p>The Letters of Lady Erskine of Alva which appear in this tale are at
+once its chief interest and the origin of its being; for my desire in
+writing “The Silver Glen” is to make known to a wider circle the
+vivid story of which they are the outcome. My conviction that they
+would prove as attractive to others as to myself induced the late Mr.
+Erskine-Murray, among whose family-papers they are preserved, to
+give me his kind permission to use them.</p>
+
+<p>To weave a romance around the names of persons who have really
+lived, and whose descendants are still in existence, is a liberty which
+calls for an apology on the part of the author. With the exception of
+Barbara Stewart, Anthony Fleming and the younger David Pitcairn
+none of the principal characters in the following story are wholly
+fictitious; but I trust, that as I have kept very closely to facts, no serious
+cause of offence can be found. Most of the incidents described are
+matters of history, and the narrative is purposely told in a plain and
+simple manner, as much as possible in keeping with the tone of the
+Letters.</p>
+
+<p>Among the books from which I have obtained information, and in
+some cases, borrowed freely, I may mention Professor Terry’s useful
+and interesting volume, <i>The Chevalier de St. George and the Jacobite
+Movements</i>; <i>The Memoirs of the Master of Sinclair</i>; Rae’s <i>History of
+the Rebellion</i> (1718); <i>Scotland and Scotsmen of the 18th Century</i>, by
+Ramsay of Ochtertyre; and the <i>Calendar of the Stuart Papers belonging
+to His Majesty at Windsor Castle</i> (Vol. II. and III.) In the Eighth
+Report of the Historical Manuscripts Commission also, there are
+numerous details on the subject of Sir John Erskine’s Silver Mines.</p>
+
+<p>In view of the new light recently thrown upon the Character of
+James (The Old Pretender), a fact very clearly brought out by Mr.
+Andrew Lang in his <i>History of Scotland</i> (Vol IV.) it is particularly
+interesting to note the remark of Lady Erskine in Letter XVI.: “There
+is one advantage,” she writes to her husband, “of being with Kid (<i>i.e.</i>,
+James), that you will live mighty regular and get no ill examples.”</p>
+
+<p>My warmest thanks are due, in the first place, to the late Mr. Erskine-Murray
+for his kind permission to use these Letters; I should also like
+to record my gratitude to Miss Johnstone of Alva, to the Rev. Robert
+Paul, F.R.S.A., Dollar, N.B., and to the Rev. A. Thomson Grant,
+Chaplain at Wemyss Castle, who have all in different ways assisted
+me, as well as to the Faculty of Advocates at Edinburgh for their
+courtesy in allowing me to read in their Library. Except for the
+punctuation, and the omission of a sentence occasionally where the
+meaning is obscure, Lady Erskine’s Letters are reproduced as they were
+written.</p>
+
+<p class='right pr2'>
+ B. D.</p>
+</div>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="front">
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_vi">[vi]</span></p>
+</div>
+
+<div class='poetry-container'>
+<div class='adbox'>
+
+<p class='center fs120'>
+<i>NOVELS BY BESSIE DILL</i>
+</p>
+
+<p class='adboxtitle'><span class="smcap">My Lady Nan</span></p>
+
+<p class='adboxcopy'>“A daintily written eighteenth century romance. The story is
+thoroughly entertaining.”—<i>Daily Express.</i></p>
+
+<p class='adboxcopy'>“A charming tale.”—<i>The Times.</i></p>
+
+<p class='adboxcopy'>“A very pretty tale, written with a light and powerful touch.”—<i>The
+Guardian.</i></p>
+
+<p class='adboxcopy'>“Written with a dainty efficiency which is very attractive. A charming
+tale.”—<i>Liverpool Courier.</i></p>
+
+<p class='adboxtitle'><span class="smcap">The Final Goal</span></p>
+
+<p class='adboxcopy'>“As fascinating a romance as one could lay hands on, and will enhance
+the reputation of the writer. There is a genuine literary ring about the
+whole book. It is a book to read and enjoy.”—<i>The Scotsman.</i></p>
+
+<p class='adboxcopy'>“An altogether delightful story.”—<i>Liverpool Daily Courier.</i></p>
+
+<p class='adboxtitle'><span class="smcap">The Lords of Life</span></p>
+
+<p class='adboxcopy'>“An excellent and well written book. ‘Van,’ the charming Scottish
+heroine, with that unfortunate possession, ‘a temperament,’ who leaves her
+northern home at the Manse, for Anglo-Indian life, is more than usually
+interesting.”—<i>Pall Mall Gazette.</i></p>
+
+<p class='adboxcopy'>“The story of a governess’s life, artistically told, and with a fidelity to
+nature which makes it appear as if a slab out of the living world had been
+set before us, we were watching the actions and reading the thoughts of
+the people of it. The story is told with a tragic passion which reminds one
+of Jane Eyre.”—<i>Sheffield Daily Telegraph.</i></p>
+
+<p class='adboxcopy'>“A grand story, the charm of the book is in the development of character,
+the refining of the gold of a girl’s joyful innocence in the fire of experience.”—<i>Leeds
+Mercury.</i></p>
+
+<p class='adboxtitle'><span class="smcap">The Story of Bell</span></p>
+
+<p class='adboxcopy'>“The story is simply and touchingly told, and retains the reader’s
+sympathy and interest to the end.”—<i>Pall Mall Gazette.</i></p>
+
+<p class='adboxcopy'>“The story is a masterpiece ... a story with a great and noble
+purpose, which we cannot read without feeling all the better.”—<i>Christian
+Journal.</i></p>
+</div></div>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_7">[7]</span></p>
+
+<p class='center mt4 fs200 ltsp2 bold'>
+ THE SILVER GLEN
+</p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="INTRODUCTION">
+ INTRODUCTION
+ </h2>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>A few days ago, as I sat in my pleasant parlour looking
+out on one of the fairest prospects in this our fair land of
+England, my cousin, Sir Henry Erskine, who hath been
+spending some days at our house, entered the room with
+his quick soldier-like step, and came to a halt, as he would
+say, at my side.</p>
+
+<p>“See here, cousin!” he cried, holding out to me a
+packet of papers, “there is something here that will interest
+you. These letters were given me by my Uncle Charles,
+my Lord Tinwald, t’other day when I was visiting at Alva
+House, and I have but just looked into them. They
+were written, I find, by my mother of blessed memory
+to Sir John, while he was abroad in exile for his misdeeds,
+as one may say now, in the year 1716.”</p>
+
+<p>I caught at the papers with a cry, half of delight and
+half of tender sorrow, for if Henry’s voice had softened
+as he mentioned his mother’s name, ’twas no more than
+her due, who was ever the wisest and most loving of
+parents; and if to him, the thought of her represented all
+that is sweetest and best in womanhood—as one may
+suppose, seeing he hath not yet crowned perfection
+by taking unto himself a wife—to me it did no less, being
+as I was the object of her most tender care and kindness
+at a time in my life when I sorely needed both.</p>
+
+<p>The sight of those thin broad sheets, covered with the
+fine clear writing which had once been so familiar to me,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_8">[8]</span>
+brought the tears to my eyes. Sure they were well worn,
+those ancient letters, having been borne in Sir John’s
+wallet, no doubt, for many a weary month, and since lain by
+in some desk or chest at Alva House for safety; and at
+the sight of the seal on the back, so carefully broken
+that the wax still retained on many of the sheets its
+perfect imprint, a vision of my dear lady folding and
+sealing with trembling haste one of these same precious
+letters, came so clear to my mind, that almost I thought
+I heard her voice calling to me as in the days of old.</p>
+
+<p>“See, Henry,” I said softly, pointing to the seal, “how
+well I remember the ring she ever used. Too large for
+her slender hand, she wore it on a long gold chain around
+her neck. Your father, Sir John, had used it when writing
+to her before they were wed, and, sweet woman that she
+was, she would never have any other for the letters that
+passed between them. ‘For, Barbara,’ said she to me
+once, and I can still see her smile, ‘the legend is so true,
+that ’twould be folly to take to another.’”</p>
+
+<p>Together we bent over the faded wax, and Henry laid
+his lips upon it gently. There has ever been a spirit of
+poetry and chivalry in this stalwart soldier, whom as a little
+child I had so often held upon my knee.</p>
+
+<p>“A heart embossed, and round it the words, ‘<i>Vous y
+regnez seul</i>.’ True, indeed!” said he with a smile; “Sir
+John reigned there alone, and even her children were in
+her heart but little subjects to their rightful king.”</p>
+
+<p>“Sure, my dear, you lost nothing by that,” I cried, “for
+happier children, or a kindlier home I never did see. The
+love that filled my lady’s heart was a bounteous fire that
+brightened and warmed all who approached her. Sweet
+soul! I thank God still for having known and loved her.”</p>
+
+<p>Saying this I turned my eyes again upon the letters in
+my hands, and so potent was the spell of the first few
+words I read, that my mind leapt back across a gulf of
+forty years, and left my body sitting blind and deaf in the
+chair in my sunny English parlour.</p>
+
+<p>A sudden laugh from Sir Henry brought my wits home
+again.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_9">[9]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Cousin Barbara,” he cried, “I have been speaking to
+you for some minutes and not one word have you heard
+of my discourse. Nay, dear cousin, do not apologise.
+The love you bore my mother hath ever been a tie between
+her children and yourself, and I know well that your
+tender heart is filled with regretful memories at sight of
+these letters writ by her hand.”</p>
+
+<p>“She was indeed the dearest woman-friend I ever had,”
+said I. “Alas! too early lost.”</p>
+
+<p>“And for that very reason,” said he, “I made my bold
+request, which, as you did not hear it, I must needs repeat.
+Will you not, for the love you bore those that are passed
+away, and a little for the love of us who remain, write out
+for our instruction and profit, your recollections of that
+troublous time, with something also of your own romance,
+and the strange story of the Silver Glen which I have so
+often heard from you as a boy?”</p>
+
+<p>My gaze went past him out of the window, across miles
+of green pasture and softly waving foliage to the silver
+shining of the Severn beyond. Far, far away the hills of
+Wales rose into the sky, the day being clear and bright.
+Close to the house the flowers were blooming very sweet and
+fragrant, for the month was June, and in the shrubbery behind
+the garden, the blackbirds and thrushes sang their best.</p>
+
+<p>“Of course, if you should think it too great a labour—”
+Sir Henry broke in upon my musings, but I held up my
+hand to stop him.</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, cousin,” I cried, “’twould be what is called ‘a
+labour of love’ surely. I was but thinking how little fit I
+am to be the chronicler of those exciting times. I will not
+be so mock-modest as to pretend to consider myself unfit
+in the matter of appreciating your dear mother’s character
+and conduct, for few had the opportunities to know and
+esteem her that I had. But I am truly no historian, and
+the tale will be written from my own point of view, which
+needs must be a narrow one. I have, I believe, upstairs
+hidden away in the corner of some ancient chest, a diary
+of that same year writ in a girlish hand. By help of this,
+and by reading, since you permit it, these sacred letters, I
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_10">[10]</span>
+promise you I will do my best endeavour to give you a
+true and full account of the events that took place in your
+home, and among your family, when you were an innocent
+small boy of four or five years old. But consider a little
+how long a time has passed. My youth with all its fears
+and follies, its joys and sorrows, is far away. I have
+wandered back and forth upon the earth, knowing many
+changes and living in distant lands, for a wife, as you know,
+must ever be ready to follow her husband; and if now in
+the evening of my life I can sit placidly at this sunny
+window looking out upon the Severn Sea, and know that
+my dear and kind spouse is no further away than in the
+next room, or in the garden, or at the home-farm, I thank
+God very humbly in my heart, Who has brought me to this
+peaceful place by a way that I knew not, and little
+expected to find. Dear Henry, I am but a garrulous old
+woman, and what I want to say is, that if my memory of
+those distant days is grown a little dim, and certain things are
+gone from my mind never to return, I must pray you to forgive
+me, and put it down, not to foolishness, but to old age.”</p>
+
+<p>Whereupon Sir Henry rallied me upon my fears, and
+laughed at me for calling myself old, who am scarce more
+than a dozen years his senior, and kissing my hand in the
+gallant way he has, he left me sitting by the window with
+these old letters in my lap.</p>
+
+<p>And suddenly, after a long silence, a single mavis burst
+into song, and trilled and throbbed so exquisite a melody
+that I held my breath to listen. For there were many
+years of my life in which I did not hear that lovely music,
+and now a mavis never sings in the long sweet twilight but
+my thoughts fly out to my lost dear, Catherine, Lady
+Erskine (for a reason that I hope to tell you by-and-bye),
+and it seemed strange that when my mind was so full of
+her, the bird that I always think of as hers should start to
+make music beside me. But I have often noticed in my
+changeful life, the little happenings that link our minds
+with the past and the future, with facts on earth and
+aspirations in Heaven, with human hopes and divine
+longings, so that the scent of a flower, or a child’s laugh,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_11">[11]</span>
+or a glorious sunset, or a sudden happiness, may lift our
+hearts, before we know it, right into the presence of God.</p>
+
+<p>All letters it seems to me must in a greater or less
+degree be the exponents of the writer’s mind. Of some, indeed,
+we might say that they mirror very clearly the character
+and disposition of their authors, and more especially when
+exchanged between two close and loving friends without
+fear of outside criticism, or any thought of possible
+publicity. Most truly is this the case in the letters before
+me. So intimate and natural they are that I almost shrink
+from exposing them to the eyes of strangers, however kind
+and sympathetic these may be; and yet they can but
+excite the warmest affection and admiration in all minds,
+being the outpourings of a loyal, loving and courageous
+heart. They were written in haste oftentimes, in doubt
+and fear and terrible anxiety, but not once does the brave
+spirit falter nor the love in them grow cold or dim.</p>
+
+<p>Now it is true that, as I said to Sir Henry, my view of
+those far-off events of my girlhood, besides having grown
+somewhat dim, must be but a narrow one, for I lived as it
+were in the midst of the story, and could not know at the
+time many facts and results that were afterwards made
+plain to all. To such as may care to read my simple
+narrative, which, if plain and unstudied, is yet true and I
+think not wanting in interest, I must say at once that
+my sole reason in undertaking the task is my desire to
+make more widely known among her descendants, namely,
+my dear God-daughter, Barbara; her niece, Christian,
+poor Charles’s little girl, and Sir Henry, who will I hope
+marry and have a family of his own, as well as to my own
+dear daughter and her children—the character of the
+sweet and noble woman who was the friend of my youth.</p>
+
+<p>I therefore make no apology for leaving to the writers of
+history many details of that unhappy time; only so far as
+it touched upon the lives and happiness of those I loved
+does it concern me. And so, with no more than a humble
+regret that my skill is not more worthy of my theme, I take
+up my pen to begin this story of the so-called Rebellion in
+the year seventeen hundred and fifteen.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_12">[12]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_I">
+ CHAPTER I
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>
+ SHOWS HOW BARBARA STEWART LEFT SCHOOL
+ </p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>’Twas in the early hours of a dark December morning in
+the year 1714 that I was awakened suddenly by the
+cautious opening of the chamber door, and saw with
+blinking eyes the bare room where I slept with three of
+my school companions. The wavering flicker of a candle
+carried by a cautious hand showed me the night-capped
+heads upon their pillows, the bare walls, the uncarpeted
+floor, the staring, black, uncurtained window, and, the
+sight arousing no interest in my mind, I closed my eyes
+against the intruding light. Little Miss Gordon, the
+youngest girl in the school, who slept in the bed with me,
+raised a protesting arm across her face, and called out in
+accents sleepy and petulant, “Oh, Betsy, take that horrid
+light away. ’Tis not morning yet, I am but just fallen asleep!”</p>
+
+<p>Now it has always been my custom to awake up instantly
+with all my senses on the alert. I say it not to boast, though
+the faculty hath served me well once or twice in my life, for
+some are born so, just as others are drowsy-heads from
+the cradle to the grave; but this being my habit, I had
+seen with the first opening of my eyes that it was not
+Betsy, the maid, who had entered our room, but no less
+a personage than Mistress Marget Lindsay, the younger
+of the two sisters who kept a boarding-school for young
+ladies in Paterson’s Court, off the Lawnmarket in Edinburgh.
+Now, Mistress Marget, besides being the younger
+of our school-mistresses, was the one least feared by their
+pupils; I had almost said the best loved, but in those
+days (I know not if it be so still), anything so gentle as
+love scarce entered into the training of young ladies at
+school. That she had a kind heart, however, I have
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_13">[13]</span>
+been sure ever since that dark, winter morn, as, shading
+the candle with her hand, she came quickly to my bed-side
+and bent down to discover if I were still asleep.</p>
+
+<p>“Miss Stewart, my dear—Barbara. Are you awake?”
+she cried softly.</p>
+
+<p>I sat up in bed and untied my cap-strings, the better to
+hear what she had to say.</p>
+
+<p>“I am awake, madam; what is it you want of me?
+Sure, ’tis not time yet for me to be at my exercises!” said
+I, a little alarmed at the gravity of her face.</p>
+
+<p>She shook her head and sat down beside me on the bed.</p>
+
+<p>“No, no, child; do not be alarmed! And yet I fear
+I have news that will disquiet you. A man-servant has
+come from Rosyth to take you home. You must rise at
+once and attire yourself for the journey.”</p>
+
+<p>“A man-servant?” I repeated, obediently putting one
+foot out of bed. “Old Robert, belike. Oh, Mistress
+Marget!” I cried, stopping suddenly, “pray tell me at
+once what is wrong.”</p>
+
+<p>With the truest kindness the good woman did not
+attempt to turn my thoughts aside from their fear. She
+answered immediately and without circumlocution.</p>
+
+<p>“Your grandfather, Miss Stewart, has met with an
+accident, and ’tis feared he cannot live. He would see
+you, dear bairn, before he dies.”</p>
+
+<p>There may be some who think this stern announcement
+to a young maid of sixteen somewhat wanting in tenderness
+and compassion. They may consider that to hint at
+a possible calamity, mentioning a severe illness or the like,
+but holding out hopes of a speedy recovery, would have
+been the kinder way. If so, I cannot agree with them.
+The progress of “preparing the mind” of any poor creature
+to receive a blow hath always seemed to me both cruel and
+useless. In many cases, the more sudden the shock, the
+more strongly is the mind braced to bear it for the moment;
+and so it was in my own case. I leapt from my bed
+and began hurriedly to put on my clothes.</p>
+
+<p>“My grandpapa dying, and asking for me? Oh, Mistress
+Marget, I must hasten; I pray you, assist me with this
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_14">[14]</span>
+lace. Will you not kindly tie these strings? Hath Robert
+brought the carriage? Ah no! the snow is too deep. I
+am to ride pillion? Yes, I must wear my thickest shawl and
+hood. Oh, do not hinder me, dear madam, I must be going
+now; I cannot keep Robert waiting another moment.”</p>
+
+<p>“My dear Miss Stewart,” said my mistress, quietly detaining
+me while she tied a thick veil over my face, and
+searched for scarf and mits, “Robert is in the kitchen
+being warmed and fed. The good creature was almost
+lifeless from the cold. And do you think, my dear girl,
+that my sister would suffer you to leave her house at this
+hour fasting? There is no speed in such senseless haste as
+you know, and while I admire your courage and fortitude,
+and the eagerness you exhibit to do your grandfather’s
+behest, I must counsel you, my dear, to remember that
+patience is one of the highest virtues a woman can possess,
+and self-control is another.”</p>
+
+<p>Tears rose in my eyes, not so much at the rebuke as in
+rebellion against it; for Barbara Stewart was ever hot and
+hasty in those young days, and indeed hath scarce yet
+learned to exercise the virtues extolled by good Mistress
+Marget in all the years that she hath lived. But chafe
+as I would at the delay, I was forced to go into the
+parlour, where the elder sister Lindsay, hastily attired, and
+with a shawl over her night-cap, waited for me in the
+candle-light with hot chocolate and buttered oatcake.</p>
+
+<p>I think the strangeness of that morning scene, and the
+unwonted consideration with which I was treated, took
+my mind a little from the gravity of the situation. I
+know that it was not till I was mounted behind Robert,
+and clinging to the broad belt he wore as we paced along
+the stony street, that it entered into my head to ask him
+for news of my poor grandpapa. It was then that I
+heard how, in riding not many days before, his horse had
+slipped upon a piece of ice, and had thrown the poor
+gentleman with such violence that an old wound, got
+near twenty years before at the siege of Namur, had
+opened, and inflammation having set in, the doctor now
+gave little hope of his recovery.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_15">[15]</span></p>
+
+<p>“I’m thinkin’, mem, the Colonel’s juist waitin’ tae bid
+ye gude-bye,” said honest Robert very sadly.</p>
+
+<p>The news made me grave and sober enough—sorrowful,
+too, and fearful, for my good grandpapa had been indulgent
+beyond the common, and, besides him, I knew of no
+other relative that I possessed in the world. My father,
+his only son, had been one of Webb’s most gallant officers,
+and had married in Flanders, after the Peace of Ryswick,
+Mademoiselle Jeanne de St. Pierre, the orphan niece of
+the French admiral of that name; for, as you know, love
+and peace grew and flourished between private individuals
+of the rival nations even while their countries were at
+daggers drawn. My mother, besides possessing wit and
+beauty, had a small fortune of her own, and she and my
+dear father lived very happily together, sometimes in
+Brussels, in Paris, or in London. But he, dying of fever,
+induced by wounds which he received at the taking of
+Liège in 1702, left his young widow and little daughter
+to the care of Colonel Stewart of Rosyth House in the county
+of Fife. My mother, fragile and broken-hearted, survived
+his death little more than a year. Thus, before I had
+reached my sixth birthday, was I bereft of both my
+parents.</p>
+
+<p>Brought up with care and kindness in my grandpapa’s
+commodious house on the shore of the Forth, I had been
+sent at the age of thirteen to the Seminary for Young
+Ladies of Good Family, kept by the sisters Lindsay, and
+had just completed my third year in that select and
+fashionable school.</p>
+
+<p>Such in brief was the story of my life down to that
+dismal winter morning which found me riding behind
+Robert Guthrie, my grandfather’s old servant, along the
+bare road that leads from Edinburgh to the Queen’s
+Ferry. Very bleak and cold it was, for the sun was not
+yet risen, and a chill wind blew right in our faces out of
+the north-west. The ground was covered with snow, and,
+though at another time I might have noticed with pleasure
+the purity of its whiteness in contrast to the grey sky and
+the black waters of the Firth (for all my life I have had
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_16">[16]</span>
+open eyes and heart to the beauties of the earth) this
+day my mind was too full of anxious cares to allow me
+any such consolation. I was cold and cheerless enough
+with the nine miles ride when we reached the Hawse Inn,
+where we alighted to wait for the ferry-boat to take us
+across to the coast of Fife, and the good landlady bustled
+out with a cup of hot spiced claret to take the chill out
+of my bones, as she said. She brought me in to the
+warm fireside, and with many kind commiserating words
+she sought, in the fulness of her heart, to lighten my
+gloom. She had heard from Robert Guthrie how Colonel
+Stewart lay at the point of death, and, in her motherly
+way, she pitied the poor girl who was so soon to be left
+alone in the world. I thanked her with what courage I
+could muster, but when she saw that I could scarce
+restrain the trembling of my lips, she very wisely left me
+to myself and busied herself about her household tasks.</p>
+
+<p>Almost at the moment when we stepped on board the
+ferry-boat, the sun, which was now some way above the
+horizon though wrapped in clouds, struggled forth from
+the enveloping mists, and in a very short time changed
+the aspect of the landscape from dismal gloom to
+sparkling radiance.</p>
+
+<p>Before we were half-way across the Frith I was so far
+roused from my abstraction to note this change, and
+whether it was that, the day being a sort of landmark
+between the old life and the new, all impressions received
+then upon my mind retained a peculiar distinctness, I
+know not; but this I know, that though I have made the
+same crossing many scores of times since, whenever I think
+of the passage of the Forth, I see it as I saw it that winter
+morning. The noble river flowing between its ever widening
+shores sparkled in the early light, reflecting on its
+bosom the blue of the sky, broken here and there by little
+white waves that seemed to laugh to each other as they
+raced out to sea. The grey stone houses of the little town
+we had just left, with their red-tiled roofs, looked
+picturesque, all huddled down together to the water’s edge.
+Westward as I gazed, the tall thin masts of vessels moored
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_17">[17]</span>
+at Charlestown and Borrowstownness, stood up slender and
+distinct in the clear air; and far away as a dream-like background
+the peaks of the majestic mountains, Ben Lomond,
+Ben Ledi, Ben Muich Dhui, their summits crowned with
+gleaming snow, towered towards the pale blue sky. Near at
+hand, the fishing craft putting out from either coast, shot up
+their sails to catch the freshening breeze, and over all the
+sea-gulls flew restlessly, or dived into the water with wild,
+musical cries, their white wings gleaming in the sunlight.</p>
+
+<p>For a moment I forgot my grief in the freshness and
+beauty of the morning, and turned for a sympathetic
+word from my companion, but at sight of his face I refrained.
+The old man was standing not far from where I
+sat, one hand upon the bridle of his horse, his head drooping,
+and his dim blue eyes fixed on vacancy. His kindly,
+weather-beaten face was very sorrowful, and I knew that he
+was looking far back into the past, when he and his
+beloved master had been young, for Robert had followed
+my grandfather to the wars, and they had been through
+many hardships and shared some triumphs together. Into
+my light and girlish mind came the thought that here was
+a grief ten times greater than my own, and in presence of
+it I felt strangely small and insignificant. Sandy, the
+horse, too used to the ferry-boat to be disturbed by the
+crossing, seemed to divine his old friend’s trouble in the
+curious way dumb animals have, for he rubbed his soft
+cheek against the groom’s shoulder with an affectionate,
+caressing motion.</p>
+
+<p>My heart went out to the old man in his sorrow, and
+when two slow tears welled out of his eyes and rolled
+down his wrinkled face, I started up, impulsive as I too
+often was, and ran to his side to comfort him.</p>
+
+<p>“Dinna greet, Robbie!” I cried, though softly, that the
+boatmen should not hear. “Dinna greet! I canna bear
+to see ye. You and me’ll aye be friends!”</p>
+
+<p>He turned and smiled at my words, and I thought the
+smile was sadder than the tears.</p>
+
+<p>“Eh, my bonnie wee leddie!” he said, as if I had been
+still but a bairn, “it’s Robbie has got a sair heart the day.”</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_18">[18]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_II">
+ CHAPTER II
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>HOW BARBARA CAME TO ROSYTH FOR THE LAST TIME</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>Rosyth House stood (for alas! it stands no longer, having
+been burned to the ground in the year 1727, on the very
+day that his present Gracious Majesty came to the throne),
+on the high ground above the Forth, about a mile and a
+half from the landing place at the North Ferry. A quarter
+of a mile further west, the ancient castle of the same name
+stands on a promontory stretching out into the sea, so near
+the water that at high tide it is wholly surrounded and cut
+off from the shore, except for an artificial stone causeway
+connecting it with the mainland.</p>
+
+<p>My grandfather, who was a distant cousin of the Laird
+of Rosyth, had got leave, upon retiring from active
+service, to build a house upon his land; but the latter,
+having some years before I was born disposed of his
+estate to a gentleman of the name of Drummond, it
+was understood that Colonel Stewart had only a life-rent
+of the same, his heirs being to receive a fair sum of
+money in lieu thereof at his death. This arrangement,
+though little to his liking at the time, grieved him less after
+the death of his son, my father, and although he could
+not feel the loving pride in keeping up the place that
+a man expends upon his own, still the cultivation of his
+grounds and garden had been a source of pleasure and
+solace to him in the latter years of his life. The house
+was comfortable and commodious, and sheltered from
+the winds, so that the shrubs and trees he had taken
+pains to plant had well grown up around it; and from
+the windows there was at all times a fair view of the
+waters of the Frith with the ships passing up and down,
+and beyond them the low green coast of the Lothians.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_19">[19]</span></p>
+
+<p>Beautiful or plain, it was the only home I had ever
+known, and for that reason very dear to me; and as we
+rounded the bend of the road that skirts St. Margaret’s
+Hope, and the familiar landmarks came into view, the
+tears rushed to my eyes and ran down my cheeks, as I
+thought that in a few short days it would shelter me no more.
+The half-formed fears of extreme youth are perhaps harder
+to endure than our later forebodings, being intensified
+by the sharpness of imagination and the uncertainty of
+ignorance as well. With my outward senses I took in
+all the beauty of the morning: the blue sky and the
+dancing waves, the sparkle of the snow so dazzling in
+its country purity, and the wild glad cries of the sea-gulls
+never still; but my heart was cold and very heavy, because
+for the first time in my life I feared the future with the
+dull aching fear that I suppose only a helpless woman
+can ever know.</p>
+
+<p>At the door of Rosyth House, Robert dismounted
+stiffly and lifted me to the ground. The noise of Sandy’s
+hoofs could not have been heard on the snow-covered
+approach, but my feet had scarce touched the threshold
+when the door was pulled quickly open and I found
+myself in the arms of my kind old nurse.</p>
+
+<p>“What news, woman?” cried Robert Guthrie, hoarsely
+before I could speak, for Phemie was his wife, though
+many years his junior, and had been, as long as I could
+remember, the prop and stay of our household. She
+looked at him over my shoulder, and shook her head
+sadly.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, wheesht, my bairn, wheesht!” she crooned above
+my head, for I had burst out crying, and she drew me
+into the lobby and softly shut the door. “There, there,”
+she went on tenderly, “I’ll no’ stop ye; just greet yer
+fill, and syne ye’ll feel a’ the better for’t.”</p>
+
+<p>As she spoke she led me into the parlour where was
+a bright fire burning, very pleasant to the chilled little
+traveller, and a basin of her own famous chicken-broth
+was steaming on the table. And very soon, warmed, fed
+and comforted by the excellent creature, I felt the deadly
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_20">[20]</span>
+weight at my heart lighten, and the future, in spite of its
+impending bereavement, did not appear altogether hopeless.
+So wonderful is the power of human sympathy, and the
+touch of a warm, kindly hand upon our own.</p>
+
+<p>Upstairs in his chamber Colonel Stewart lay dying,
+and thither Phemie conducted me as soon as she considered
+me capable of bearing myself with dignity and
+self-control.</p>
+
+<p>“Be a woman, my dear lamb, for yer gran’pa’s sake!”
+she whispered, as she led me to his door. “The Colonel’s
+far through, his time is gey short.”</p>
+
+<p>The room was bare and empty for the bed-chamber
+of the master of the house, but the old soldier had ever
+treated himself with a certain austerity bred of early days
+of hardship in the field; and his wife, my grandmother,
+being long dead, there had been none to interfere with
+his love of simple things. His bed had neither tester
+nor hangings, and there was no carpet on the floor nor
+curtains at the window. One of the shutters was partially
+closed to soften the glare from the snow, but the winter
+sunshine brightened the room and showed me the face
+of my grandfather on the pillow, very white and worn, and
+with closed eyes. He opened them as we approached,
+and smiled as his glance fell on me.</p>
+
+<p>“Ah, Barbara, my child!” he cried, and my heart gave
+a hard throb at the weak tones of his voice. “You have
+come, I am glad you are here. ’Tis a cold journey from
+Embro’ in the winter-time. Has the bairn had her
+noon-chin?” he enquired of Phemie, for he was ever
+kindly and courteous, and wondrous thoughtful about
+small things, unusually so for a man, as I now know. On
+being assured that I was neither cold nor hungry, he
+motioned me to sit by him, and signified to Phemie that
+he wished to be alone with me.</p>
+
+<p>“Go you and see to the comfort of your gudeman, and
+tell him I thank him for bringing the wee leddy home in
+time.”</p>
+
+<p>When she was gone, “My dear Barbara,” said he, “this
+is as unexpected as most of the blows of Fate, but as Fate
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_21">[21]</span>
+is only another name for the Hand of God, it behoves us
+to bow to its dictates. I hope I know how to die as a
+soldier and a Christian should, but ’tis hard to leave a
+woman-bairn alone in the world.”</p>
+
+<p>The thin, tired voice with which my dear grandpapa spoke
+touched my heart with sorrow even more than the words
+he said. I laid my hand on his, so brown and wrinkled,
+and turned away my face that he might not see my tears.</p>
+
+<p>After a pause he went on.</p>
+
+<p>“You are, my dear girl, the only child of two only
+children, and I myself had neither brother nor sister.
+Your relatives are therefore few and distant. There are in
+France some cousins of your late dear mother, but seeing
+I know them not, I have no mind to send you so far
+seeking a home. Dost remember thy mother, dear
+bairn?”</p>
+
+<p>I nodded doubtfully.</p>
+
+<p>“I have mind of her face,” I said, “and how soft and
+white her hands were—much softer than my good Phemie’s,
+I always thought,—and I mind the way she kissed me and
+held me in her arms.”</p>
+
+<p>Colonel Stewart sighed.</p>
+
+<p>“Poor bairn, you were but a babe when she died. A
+great loss, Barbara! Your mother was a notable woman.
+But I’m wondering if you have any mind of a friend of
+hers—the Honourable Catherine Sinclair, to wit, from
+Dysart, that used to come a great deal about Rosyth at
+that time?”</p>
+
+<p>I peered far back into my childish memories, and then I
+smiled.</p>
+
+<p>“Was she a lady in a blue gown?” I cried, “with a
+string of pearls round her neck? She was very merry and
+kind, and talked French with my mother. She told me to
+call her Cousin Katie.”</p>
+
+<p>“Very like, very like,” said my grandfather, “though
+I cannot swear to the colour of her gown. But she was
+a blithe, happy creature, and very fond of your mother,
+Barbara.”</p>
+
+<p>“Yes, sir.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_22">[22]</span></p>
+
+<p>“It is to her that I look to befriend you, child, when I
+am gone. Your father and she were cousins in the fourth
+degree through their mothers, and her father, my Lord
+Sinclair, for old friendship’s sake, may be willing to give
+you a home at the Hermitage at Dysart, for so his house
+is called, until you are of an age to choose your own place
+of abode.”</p>
+
+<p>Here he stopped again and pointed feebly to a bottle of
+cordial that stood with a glass upon the table. I hastened
+to pour some out and held it to his lips, trembling
+inwardly lest he should faint from weakness, or die with
+me alone in the room. My fears, however, were not
+realised, for after a few minutes’ silence he spoke again.</p>
+
+<p>“The year after your dear mother died, Catherine
+Sinclair was wedded to Sir John Erskine of Alva, a
+gentleman of old and noble family, greatly respected in
+the country. His mother was Mistress Christian Dundas
+of Arniston, a clever and pious woman who is still living.
+Though the younger Lady Alva has not been here since
+her marriage, I have met her at her father’s house, where
+she comes frequently to stay, and have been greatly
+attracted by her kindliness and good sense. There are
+some wild tales abroad about her husband, Sir John, but
+though he is impulsive and reckless in certain directions,
+I take him to be as honest and kind-hearted as he is witty
+and pleasant in company.”</p>
+
+<p>Again he paused to gather strength, and I watched a
+sunbeam that had strayed to the wide fire-place, and seemed
+to play at fighting with the flames that flickered somewhat
+feebly round the half-charred log. I took no interest in
+sunbeam or fire at the time, and yet it all comes back to
+me as if I had seen it but yesterday.</p>
+
+<p>“Your fortune, Barbara,” said my grandfather, so
+suddenly that I started, “is not small. You are no
+penniless lass, thank God! and your affairs are safe in
+the hands of my good friends and lawyers, Messrs
+Carmichael &amp; Dymock, Writers to the Signet in Embro’.
+Two days back I writ a letter to my Lady Erskine at
+the Hermitage, where I believe her now to be, giving her
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_23">[23]</span>
+all particulars and information concerning my affairs.
+Her brother-in-law, Charles Erskine, a shrewd lawyer,
+will assist her in any difficulty, and I have appointed these
+two your guardians until the time you shall come of age,
+or marry.”</p>
+
+<p>“Yes, sir,” I murmured, as the low voice ceased; and as
+if he had come to an end of all that was in his mind,
+he turned his head aside and fell into a light slumber.</p>
+
+<p>During the night the inflammation and fever increased,
+and towards evening of the next day he died. His last
+look and words were for his faithful comrade and servant.
+He had been lying unconscious for some hours, or so it
+seemed, and we had thought that he would pass without a
+sign, but suddenly he opened his eyes and fixed them on
+Robert Guthrie standing at the foot of his bed.</p>
+
+<p>“It’s marching orders I’ve got, Rob,” he said, in a
+stronger voice than could have been expected, “and I
+maun leave you behind. But you’ll follow, my man, as
+soon as you’re able.”</p>
+
+<p>And Robbie, speechless with grief, brought his hand to
+the salute, and standing thus motionless he watched his
+old master die.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_24">[24]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_III">
+ CHAPTER III
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>OF MY NEW GUARDIAN, AND HER KINDNESS</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>The snow was very deep and still falling on the day of my
+grandfather’s funeral, and many of his friends and
+neighbours who would willingly have honoured Colonel
+Stewart by following him to the grave, were unable to win
+through the drifts to Inverkeithing. Had the roads been
+more passable they would, Phemie told me, have thought
+little of riding twenty, thirty, or even fifty miles to foregather
+at Rosyth House, partly out of friendship for the dead
+man no doubt, but also because such meetings are a means
+of seeing friends and hearing news in a quiet and not over
+populous neighbourhood.</p>
+
+<p>For the honour of the house, our good Phemie saw to
+it that the board was well-spread in the dining-room, and
+that roast and boiled meats in plenty, and the best of my
+poor grandpapa’s cellar, were set forth before the hungry
+mourners. But out of pity for the orphan girl, whom they
+knew to be alone in the house, the gentlemen were
+wondrous considerate, and neither sat long over their
+meat, nor indulged freely in wine-drinking. The names of
+some of these kindly men, as retailed to me by Phemie, are
+still clear in my memory. There were Mr. Moubray of
+Culcarnie, or Cockairney as it is now called; Sir John
+Henderson of Fordell; and the Earl of Moray from
+Donibristle Castle. Sir Alexander Bruce, he that was now
+Earl of Kincardine, came from Broomhall; and Sir
+Robert Blackwood, that not long before had purchased the
+estate of Pitreavie, rode with him to show respect to the
+old Colonel’s memory.</p>
+
+<p>I was sitting in an upper chamber, disconsolate enough,
+and growing rather weary of the murmur of voices below,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_25">[25]</span>
+when I heard what seemed to be the bustle of an arrival at
+the front door.</p>
+
+<p>“Some late comer,” I was thinking, with girlish bitterness,
+“just in time to join the feast,” when my door opened, and
+I heard a pleasant voice say softly, “Nay, I thank you, I
+would see the young lady alone,” and rising from my seat
+I was confronted by a lady still wrapped in her travelling
+cloak, who came forward quickly, pushing back the hood
+from her face.</p>
+
+<p>“My poor Barbara,” cried she, “to think that a girl
+should be alone on such a day as this! I would have given
+twenty pound to have been with you earlier, my bairn,
+but I will explain the delay by-and-bye. Didst think
+thyself forsaken by all kind friends, my little Barbara, as
+well ye might?”</p>
+
+<p>Then putting her hands on my shoulders, and holding
+me from her, she smiled.</p>
+
+<p>“Nay! not little Barbara now, but tall Barbara, bonny
+Barbara, winsome Barbara. Even with so sad a face you
+mind me of your mother, child, but never, oh never, will
+you be as beautiful as she.”</p>
+
+<p>Without speaking I drew her to the settle by the fire. I
+knew very well who she was—my lady in the blue gown,
+with the merry voice and the kind smile, the “Cousin
+Katie” of my childhood, my new guardian, Lady Erskine.
+And then she fell to talking of my loss, and praised my
+dear grandpapa for a kindly and courteous gentleman, a
+brave and honourable soldier, a man of wisdom and
+intellect, polished and mellowed by contact with the
+world. I know not now all she said of him, but when she
+ended, I felt that it was a proud thing to be the granddaughter
+of such a man, even although he had borne no
+high-sounding title, nor held any great position as the
+world counts greatness.</p>
+
+<p>After a thoughtful silence between us, she took my hand
+in hers and smiled brightly.</p>
+
+<p>“And now for my explanation and apology, Barbara. I
+was indeed expected at the Hermitage a sennight since, as
+Colonel Stewart had heard, but alas! what should befall
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_26">[26]</span>
+but that my youngest son should be ailing—no serious
+sickness, thank God! but one of those childish bouts of
+heats and chills, when the little head is heavy and the
+active limbs grow weak, and the poor bairn lacks nothing
+but to lie in its minnie’s lap. I fear you will blame me,
+Barbara; I am held by my own sisters to be a weak and
+foolish mother in that I let my children see how much I
+love them. Alack! I cannot hinder my love from having
+its way, and when a bairn is sick, and weak, and helpless,
+what better place can be found for it than its mother’s
+arms?</p>
+
+<p>“Ah, I see you agree with me, my dear, I have nothing to
+fear from your censure. Well, my little Harry held me in
+Alva with his tiny hands, though had I known the truth of
+what was happening here, I own I would have tried to
+break away a little sooner. I arrived at Dysart only last
+night, found your poor grandpapa’s letter awaiting me
+there, and learned the sad news that he was to be buried
+to-day. All my brothers are from home, and my lord is an
+old man unfit to venture out in such a storm; otherwise,
+my dear, some of my family would have been present at the
+funeral. But when I thought of you, poor child, alone and
+friendless in your sorrow, I could not wait another day
+before I came to you.”</p>
+
+<p>“Indeed, cousin,” I said, “I am most grateful and glad
+to see you. But I know not how your horses had power to
+drag you through the drifts. Did not the wheels stick
+often?”</p>
+
+<p>“I did not come on wheels, my dear, or I should never
+have reached you.”</p>
+
+<p>“What, did you ride then?” I cried, astonished.</p>
+
+<p>“No, no, I sat in my coach and kept as warm among
+my wraps as possible.”</p>
+
+<p>Then, seeing my perplexity, she added,</p>
+
+<p>“Have you never heard how in colder countries than
+Scotland the people ride about in winter in sleighs, that
+glide over the surface of the snow without making any
+deep ruts as wheels would? You must know that my
+husband’s youngest brother, Dr. Robert Erskine, is private
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_27">[27]</span>
+physician to that great man, Peter, the Czar of all the
+Russias, and lives with him in Moscow, the capital of his
+kingdom. Well, when brother Robin writes about the
+sleighing and the comfort and convenience of it, and how
+smoothly they rush along, Sir John, my husband, claps
+his hand to his forehead and cries out, ‘Just the thing for
+Scotland! we’ll try it when the first snow comes!’ Oh,
+Barbara!” cried my lady with sparkling eyes, “there
+never was such a man as mine for trying new inventions,
+they are verily the delight of his life. So he writes to
+Russia for instructions as to the method, and gets a drawing
+from his brother how it’s done, and then when next the
+snow lies deep, off come the wheels of our lightest
+coach, and ’tis placed on runners and becomes a sleigh.”</p>
+
+<p>“And now, my dear Barbara,” said my lady, after I had
+asked many eager questions and received most kind
+replies, “now we must talk business. How old are
+you, my dear?”</p>
+
+<p>“I shall be seventeen, madam, in February.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, you are a woman grown. Too old to go back to
+school, eh?”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, madame!” I cried, “if only I need not return!”</p>
+
+<p>“Ah! you have not much love for the blackboard and
+the ruler; or is it the virginal and tambour-stitch that you
+are weary of?”</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, cousin, I love my lessons, and my dear grandpapa
+was, as you know, a learned gentleman. We read many
+books together that Mistress Lindsay and her sister, I am
+sure, never saw. He made me study French and talk it
+with him all my life, that I might not forget my mother’s
+tongue. The sisters Lindsay could teach me no more of
+that than I knew. I like to play on the virginal and sing,
+and my satin-piece and sampler were the best in the school.
+I can walk a minuet and sweep a curtsey with the best, and—and—in
+fact, madam, I know not what more they can
+teach me!”</p>
+
+<p>To this conceited speech, my lady replied with a smile
+and the quiet remark,</p>
+
+<p>“You had a more fortunate up-bringing than many
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_28">[28]</span>
+country maids, my dear. Never forget what you owe to
+your good grandfather’s care. But still, I think,” she
+continued, “though not quite for the reasons you give,
+that you have been long enough at school, and now as to
+the question of a home.”</p>
+
+<p>“My grandpapa thought,” I ventured timidly, “that
+perhaps my Lord Sinclair, your father——”</p>
+
+<p>“Yes,” she interrupted, “he writ me of that in his letter.
+But the Hermitage is not the home I should choose for
+you. My lord is old, and my sisters are often away from
+home. You would scarce be happy at the Hermitage,
+Barbara; do you think you could be happy with me?”</p>
+
+<p>“With you, madam?” I cried.</p>
+
+<p>“At Alva,” she replied. “There are the two little boys,
+you know, Charles and Henry—very good-humoured
+children, though I, their mother, say it. They keep us
+stirring I can tell you, and dear little companions they are.
+Charles is not yet six years old, he is called after his
+paternal grandfather; little Henry, my father’s namechild, is
+just turned four. There was another, Barbara——”</p>
+
+<p>She paused, and her eyes took that deep, still look that
+I have seen in the eyes of other mothers of dead children.</p>
+
+<p>“Little Jamie, my bonnie baby! God only lent him to us
+for a few months, not quite a year, then He took him back
+again. Ah, Barbara, to see your baby lying dead—that
+makes a wound in a mother’s heart that the good God
+himself cannot wholly heal; indeed, I think He knows
+better than to try. But let us not speak of these sad
+things. Do you think you could live happy with us at
+Alva?”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, very gladly indeed, madam,” I cried. “But Sir
+John—he has not been asked. He knows nothing as yet
+of my dear grandfather’s death.”</p>
+
+<p>“My dear,” said Lady Erskine, and the light in her
+face made even me, a young girl, wonder, “Sir John is my
+husband, and master in his own house truly, but he is still
+my lover, my best friend, my kindest companion, and no
+wish that I express doth he ever gainsay. Whether it be
+that I never wish for anything that could displease him I
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_29">[29]</span>
+know not, but I am very sure that I have only to tell him
+the truth about you, and to say that I desire you to live
+with us, for him to receive you at Alva with the warmest,
+most fatherly of welcomes. His brother, Charles, is, as
+you know, appointed your other guardian, and it is meet
+and right you should share our home.”</p>
+
+<p>And so, in short, it was arranged, and more besides, for
+before she left Rosyth that day, my Lady Erskine had
+talked with Robert and Phemie, and prayed them in her
+gracious way, to accompany me to Alva House.</p>
+
+<p>“If Robert will take charge of the stables,” she said,
+“he will be doing Sir John a kindness, and find enough to
+occupy his time; and as for you, my good Phemie, I ask
+nothing better than to install you as head of my nursery,
+where you may keep an eye on my turbulent little lads, and
+watch over your own young lady as well.”</p>
+
+<p>Not all of her kind intentions were carried out, however,
+for alas! old Robert had contracted so grievous a chill
+standing bare-headed in the snow-storm by Colonel
+Stewart’s grave, that a mighty inflammation of the lungs
+set in, and before ten days were past the good old man
+was laid at the feet of his beloved master.</p>
+
+<p>“I kent weel hoo it wad be!” said Phemie sadly, yet
+with a certain pride in her tones. “Robbie was aye that
+set upon the maister, he just couldna bide wantin’ him!”</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_30">[30]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_IV">
+ CHAPTER IV
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>I GO TO ALVA</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>It hath often been a matter of surprise to me, as well as of
+great thankfulness, that a beneficent Providence should have
+cast my lot with friends so large-hearted and generous as
+Sir John Erskine and his dear lady. I might so easily
+have been compelled to find a home with people of a very
+different type, kind and excellent no doubt, but ignorant,
+narrow and obscure. It might have been my fate to live
+with a family of austere manners, of rigid life, of homely
+interests, like so many families at that time in Scotland,
+which indeed would have ill-accorded with my own disposition,
+and who knows what disastrous results might have
+ensued? With such people, and I have met with many in
+my life, ’twould have been scarce possible for me to live
+happily, nor, I suppose, would they have found me to their
+taste any more than I them. For looking back upon my
+early life and character I know that I was but an undisciplined
+girl, needing firm but gentle guiding, spoiled by
+indulgence no doubt, impulsive, hot-headed, and rash,
+inheriting from my mother a strain of gaiety and light-heartedness
+calculated to lead me into temptation, and
+withal impatient of control. Still to be just to myself, I
+must allow that I was affectionate, honest, and fearless, and
+so capable of strong attachment to one whom I admired
+and loved as I did my Cousin Catherine, that any sacrifice
+made for her or hers seemed easy, and her simplest word
+was enough to check me, so eager was I at all times for her
+approbation.</p>
+
+<p>My dear husband, who knows me, I think, as no other
+human being ever did, tells me sometimes that one of my
+chief characteristics (he is too kind to call it a fault), is to
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_31">[31]</span>
+idealise where I love. I believe he is right; but though it
+lays me open now and then to his friendly ridicule, I
+would not have it otherwise. It is a power (though some
+regard it as a weakness), which raises the standard of life
+for those who possess it. It closes their eyes to the mean
+side of human nature, for except where love and admiration
+are possible they take little concern; it gives wings to the
+hopeful heart that lift it high above the quagmires of
+despair, and it opens to faithful eyes a secret window in
+Heaven that lets a little of the holy light shine forth upon
+the dark things of the earth. And if we seldom realise
+our ideals, what then? Are we any the worse for having
+sought them? No more than is the lark, who, having
+mounted half a mile towards the sun, sinks back singing to
+his lowly nest, only to rise again to-morrow.</p>
+
+<p>I had no sooner set eyes upon Sir John Erskine, than I
+understood, in a dim and girlish way, the meaning of that
+light which I had seen upon his wife’s face when she spoke
+of him to me. There was that in his big and burly form,
+as he stood at the door of his house to welcome us, in the
+kindly lines of his face and the humorous gleam of his eye,
+in the hearty tones of his great manly voice that had yet a
+thrill of tenderness in them, that caused me to realise, as
+far as a young maid may, that here was a man that no
+woman and very few men could dislike. I have heard
+since that day, God knows, many evil things about Sir John,
+not one half of which I believe. I know him to have been a
+careless liver, gay, reckless and imprudent, more witty than
+wise, and as wild in his speculations and inventions as any
+foolish gambler. I know what misfortunes his conduct
+brought to his family, and I cannot but blame him for
+many things that he did, and yet with it all he was a much
+loved man, one whom his friends excused even while they
+accused him, a man who never did a cowardly action, nor, I
+firmly believe, ever spoke an unkind word—in short, a man
+of genius wanting ballast, but possessing a most generous
+nature, and a charm of manner that won all hearts, even
+those that were fain to reprove him.</p>
+
+<p>To me, Barbara Stewart, the orphan girl who had but
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_32">[32]</span>
+little claim upon him, he was kind beyond all telling, and
+if my lenient view of his character be somewhat inspired
+by grateful remembrance, who can blame me?</p>
+
+<p>I can see him now as he appeared to me on that late
+winter afternoon, lifting his wife over the snow-sprinkled
+threshold into the lighted hall, and kissing her hands with
+tender courtesy while she clung to his arm for a moment,
+her sweet face raised to his. But before I had time to do
+more than cast a glance of timid curiosity round, she turned
+and drew me forward.</p>
+
+<p>“And this is Mistress Barbara Stewart,” cried Sir John,
+holding out his hand in kindest greeting. “I bid you
+welcome to Alva, my dear young lady, and trust you will
+find with us a happy home. Our family and yours have
+intermarried more than once in by-gone years, so I beg of
+you to look upon me now and always as your loving kinsman
+and faithful servant.”</p>
+
+<p>With that he made me a very low bow, which I answered
+with a deep but modest curtsey, trying in faltering, girlish
+words to express my thanks for his goodness. But the
+strangeness of my surroundings and perhaps the fatigues
+of the long, cold journey well-nigh overcame my composure,
+and I cast my eyelids down to hide the rising tears. My
+lady came to my rescue, and taking my hand in hers,
+began to lead me towards the staircase.</p>
+
+<p>“Poor Barbara,” said she, “is quite exhausted; her
+very lips are stiff with cold. She will answer your courteous
+speeches better, my life, when she hath drunk a cup of hot
+wine, and sat awhile beside the fire; and here are our little
+lads waiting to kiss her hand.”</p>
+
+<p>Looking up, I saw descending slowly towards us two of
+the bonniest boys it had ever been my lot to meet. The
+elder, whose fair face was lighted up with eager excitement,
+looked ready to fly to his mother’s arms, had it not been
+that his steps were hampered by the less active movements
+of his younger brother whose hand he carefully held.
+Golden-haired and blue-eyed, with strong and sturdy limbs,
+little Charles appeared to me a child to rejoice the hearts
+of parents and friends alike; but charming as he was, it
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_33">[33]</span>
+was to the pretty baby, Hal, that my whole heart went out
+upon our first meeting. He looked at me from a pair of
+eyes so large and dark that I named him “Harold Beaux-yeux”
+on the spot, and after a moment’s grave contemplation
+of me, his little face broke into a winning and
+bewitching smile, and he suffered me, stranger as I was, to
+take him in my arms, with the most gracious air of dignity
+in the world.</p>
+
+<p>You may judge if Barbara did not speedily forget her
+loneliness and fatigue as she pressed the lovely child to
+her heart, and how soon the happy prattle of both the
+little lads gave her the blessed sense of feeling perfectly at
+home.</p>
+
+<p>Limited as my experience was, I very quickly discovered
+that the manner of living at Alva House was greatly in
+advance of the general rule in Scotland at that time. Not
+only was the restless genius of Sir John continually engaged
+in schemes for beautifying and embellishing his estate, but
+the appointments inside the house showed culture and
+refinement which could only have been acquired by contact
+with the world beyond our narrow borders. The walls of
+the public rooms were set in panels and hung with pictures,
+there were carpets and rugs upon the floors—a luxury by
+no means common even in the houses of the rich—curtains
+of foreign tapestry hung over the doorways and before the
+windows, and silken cushions and pieces of rich embroidery
+added beauty to the furnishings. My lady drank her tea
+at “the four hours” out of dainty chinay cups brought
+from overseas, and the house was full of beautiful and
+curious objects fetched home by Sir John and others from
+Paris, Holland and London, or things of stranger, wider
+interest sent by Doctor Robin Erskine from his far-off
+home in Moscow.</p>
+
+<p>The winter months went swiftly, and, when in the middle
+of February the snow had left the ground, Sir John was
+constantly employed with his men at the work so dear to
+his heart, namely: making walks and terraces about the
+house, improving the garden, and laying out the policies to
+the best advantage. Having gathered some small interest
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_34">[34]</span>
+in such matters from my dear grandfather, I was ever
+ready to accompany my kind host in his tours of inspection,
+especially as my lady, having contracted a cold in the
+latter end of January which still confined her to the house,
+was unable to be his companion, a source of grief at all
+times to her whose happiest moments were those spent by
+her husband’s side.</p>
+
+<p>“Go you with him, Barbara!” she would cry with a
+smile. “Oh, go, and listen to his talk, but don’t forget the
+lonely and jealous wife who would fain be taking your
+place!”</p>
+
+<p>To say truth, Sir John proved himself an entertaining
+comrade, and since he was pleased to remark that I had
+an intelligence for outdoor matters beyond my years, he
+would discourse to me about his plans and schemes for
+hours together.</p>
+
+<p>“You must understand, Barbara,” he said one day,
+“that although I have little liking for the English or their
+manners, and, so far as seeking good company goes, would
+infinitely rather take ship and sail to France than step into
+my coach and be carried to London, yet I cannot but
+allow that in matters of agriculture and husbandry, in
+farming, forestry, and all country lore, our southern
+neighbours are many years ahead of us.”</p>
+
+<p>“Will you please to tell me about England, Sir John,”
+I said, partly from genuine interest in his talk, and partly,
+I doubt not, with unconscious feminine guile because I
+saw that it pleased him to have a listener.</p>
+
+<p>“Since 1707,” he went on, “the year, as you are aware,
+of the political union of the two countries, a union which
+has scarce yet proved very happy for Scotland, but which
+I have strong hopes may yet be the making of her
+commercial fortune, and aid greatly in the general
+amelioration of her people—well, since the Union, I and
+many others, as members of Parliament have been obliged
+to ride yearly to London; and passing as I do, so many of
+the seats of the nobility and gentry, I was at first struck with
+amazement, then with shame, and finally with envy that
+gave birth to emulation, to think that within a few
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_35">[35]</span>
+hundred miles of these, our land—with far greater natural
+beauty to boast of—should be left so wild, so bare, so
+uncultivated. My kinsman and neighbour, the Earl of
+Mar, has indeed shown a noble example at his house at
+Alloa, and it will give my lady pleasure to take you there
+one day to see his gardens. They are laid out in the
+Dutch taste, and are modelled on those at Hampton Court,
+which, as you know, was the favourite residence of King
+William. My lord gives constant employment to something
+like a dozen men under a master-gardener, and he
+has of late years planted a large number of forest-trees.
+But though his zeal for this sort of work is great, and his
+taste remarkable, he cannot be persuaded to take so much
+interest in the enclosing of pastures, or the dressing and
+enriching of his fields, as I could wish.”</p>
+
+<p>“Is the cultivation in England finer than ours?” I
+asked.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, beyond all comparison!” quoth Sir John. “It
+would astonish you, my dear Barbara, to see upon a June
+day, the rich waving foliage of trees that stretch for miles
+along the smooth and pleasant highways, the well-tilled
+fields divided by blossoming hedges, the comfortable inns,
+the neat cottages with their little gardens well filled with
+flowers and fruit. One receives an impression of peace,
+comfort and prosperity which is very pleasing, and as I
+said before, it seems strange to think that the two countries
+lie close to each other, and that their climates are not so very
+different. It irks me the more,” he went on, “in that
+Scotsmen themselves are acknowledged by all foreigners to
+be more learned, wise and polite than the English, and
+where many an English country squire would be barbarous,
+ignorant and rude, a Scotsman of the same station displays
+all the accomplishments of a well-bred gentleman. Yet in
+matters of such importance as those I have mentioned
+our country is not to be compared with theirs.”</p>
+
+<p>“Pray, Sir John,” cried I, “are not the farmers very
+grateful to you for instructing them in more civilised
+methods?”</p>
+
+<p>He laughed, a great merry laugh. “Indeed, my dear,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_36">[36]</span>
+they are not. They would fain dig up my trees and burn
+my hedges, as hath been done already on some estates,
+only I believe the love they bear to my lady holds them
+back. They grumble monstrously at ‘Sir John’s new-fangled
+ways,’ and say that the trees do but eat the good
+out of the land, and the hedges harbour birds that devour
+their grain. For some winters back I have fed my
+beasts on clover-grass, red clover made into hay, which
+the creatures relish and fatten on; but my tenants call it
+English weeds, and prefer their old method of crushed
+whin and dried bracken for winter fodder. Great and
+powerful is the old devil, Ignorance, Barbara, and most
+devoutly do some folk cling to his feet and worship
+him.”</p>
+
+<p>“And what, Sir John, will enlighten them?” said I.</p>
+
+<p>“Nothing but intercourse with the outside world, which,
+by degrees, will become easier and more general. Only
+by seeing others living in better condition than himself
+will the Scots peasant be moved to try to improve his
+own lot.”</p>
+
+<p>“I am glad you are planting trees,” cried I. “They
+are lovely and lovable, and their shelter and shade are
+most pleasant.”</p>
+
+<p>“Ay,” said Sir John, “but all do not think alike on
+this subject, for one of my tenants said to me but
+yesterday, ‘If the Lord had ettled tae hae trees in the
+carse, Sir John, wad He no’ hae planted them there
+Himsel’?’ And when I made answer that, as the Lord
+had not caused us to be born with houses on our backs
+like the snail, doubtless He meant us to dwell upon the
+bare hillside, the good old man looked at me sorrowfully,
+and humbly begged my honour not to blaspheme. Now,
+what,” said Sir John, with a shrug of his shoulders, “can
+you make of a mind like that, Barbara?”</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_37">[37]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_V">
+ CHAPTER V
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>I HEAR OF THE SILVER GLEN FOR THE FIRST TIME</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>I can bring to mind one morning when my lady, having
+recovered from her indisposition, called me to her and
+proposed that we should walk through the grounds and
+see what had been done about the place. The little boys,
+tired of the nursery in which they had been prisoners
+during a week of rain, came running and shouting by our
+side. The sunshine made the fresh world golden; the
+sky was blue and cloudless, and the wide carse seemed
+to be a cup filled with opal-tinted air, rimmed by the
+distant hills. The blackbird and the mavis led the
+concert with their love-songs, and frequently we stopped
+to listen to their notes. In the garden walks near the
+house the deep yellow crocuses opened their hearts to
+the sun, and the green spikes of the hyacinths pushed
+through the brown earth, giving promise of beauty and
+fragrance to come.</p>
+
+<p>“The spring is a lovesome time,” quoth my lady,
+smiling happily on flowers and birds and children.
+“When the earth renews herself after her winter torpor
+I want to live for ever. I feel that every year we ought
+to have the power like her to grow young and fresh
+again; but, alas!” she sighed, “this is not so. We fade
+like the leaves and drop off and are forgotten. Others
+arise in our place, but we ourselves return again never.”</p>
+
+<p>“You will live for fifty happy years, at least, cousin,”
+I cried, “and will come again in your children’s children
+for many generations. It is impossible that you can
+ever be forgotten!”</p>
+
+<p>She smiled at me and shook her head. “You must
+bear with my moods, dear bairn, for, when you know me
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_38">[38]</span>
+better, you will find in me a strange commingling of light
+and darkness, of gaiety and gloom. Sir John, who by
+nature looks ever on the bright side of things, tells me
+that I love to contemplate the clouds only. I know not
+how it is, but even my happiness gives me pain, and I
+enjoy all pleasures so keenly that the very enjoyment
+ofttimes leaves me tired and sad.”</p>
+
+<p>I mind me of her words very well, because at the time
+they struck me with a great surprise. Of all the women
+I have seen and known my Cousin Catherine was the
+one with whom I most associated the idea of constant,
+gentle gaiety. The ready smile, the kindly word, with her
+were never wanting, and although I have seen her angry
+and disturbed enough when things went wrong and folks
+were stupid, or when any injustice done came to her
+knowledge, these moods were but the flashing of a summer
+storm that quickly passed and left the wonted serenity
+behind. That all her brightness covered unknown depths
+of seriousness, and that the spring of her laughter lay
+very near to tears, was an idea which, to my childish
+mind, was well nigh incomprehensible. Looking back
+across the years with wistful eyes—the years of chequered
+light and shade, of joy and pain, of strife and peace that
+have made up my life—I, grown older and wiser, know
+and understand the sweet, deep nature of my friend, as
+I never could have done while I was near her.</p>
+
+<p>“I have never seen you dumpish or melancholy,
+madam,” I murmured, half abashed by her words. “I
+took it that you were a very happy woman, cousin.”</p>
+
+<p>She laughed merrily at that.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, so I am, Barbara, one of the happiest in Scotland.
+Never heed my words, child; I was but dreaming aloud.”</p>
+
+<p>I looked into her face, relieved, (so sensitive are the
+young to the influences around them), and saw there a
+look that spoke of happiness indeed. The soft pink
+colour rose in her cheeks, and her eyes grew brighter
+and softer as she gazed in front of her. Following her
+glance, I caught sight of Sir John standing at the end of
+the long avenue, directing his men at their work.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_39">[39]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Why, there is your papa, my little sons,” she cried.
+“Now, see who can reach him first to kiss his hand. If
+Barbara would run with little Hal, perhaps it would be
+safer for the small feet.”</p>
+
+<p>At this, nothing loth, we three children (for I was little
+better than a child when it came to a frolic) ran off down
+the broad walk with shouts of glee, and, because of Baby
+Harry’s lagging steps, to which I had to pay heed, the
+race was won by Master Charles, very proud and triumphant.</p>
+
+<p>“Mama is here! mama is coming, papa!” he cried,
+“and she bids me kiss your hand. Will you walk with
+us, if you please, Sir John, and show Barbara the mavis’s
+nest we found before the rain began?”</p>
+
+<p>With a parting word to his men and a kindly smile
+to me, Sir John lifted little Hal to his shoulder and
+walked back with us to meet my lady.</p>
+
+<p>And here I may say that what my Lady Erskine had
+told me of her method with her children was perfectly
+true. There were more love and confidence between
+these little lads and their parents than was at all common
+in most families; and yet I did not find that the conduct
+of the children needed censure, nor that their characters
+suffered in any way. How was it possible when their
+lives were made so bright that their minds should not
+expand more readily than when surrounded by dread
+and gloom? Was their obedience not more spontaneous,
+and therefore more precious, because given through love,
+than when forced by fear of punishment? And was not
+the frank exchange of thought with older minds a
+constant advantage to their growing intelligence? And
+yet I know that young Lady Alva was regarded by many
+as a lax and indolent mother, seeing that she spared
+herself the trouble of correcting her little sons by harsh
+discipline and stern reproof.</p>
+
+<p>“When my own life is filled with so much brightness,
+Barbara,” she said to me one day, after a visiting neighbour
+had tried to bring her to a sense of her imperfections,
+“how can I fail to make my children happy too?” And
+she added in her sweet and pious way, “I do most truly
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_40">[40]</span>
+endeavour to lead my little ones to love their Heavenly
+Father through the love their earthly parents bare to them.
+But there are some folk, Barbara, who think it shame to
+talk of earthly love, and presumption to think of the
+heavenly, and with such I have no traffic in thought or
+sympathy at all.”</p>
+
+<p>Such, then, was the atmosphere in which these children
+were brought up, and I must own that two more innocent,
+sprightly, good-humoured little lads it would have been
+hard to find.</p>
+
+<p>But to return to the happy party on that sunny morning
+strolling in the broad walk. While little Hal was prattling
+from his father’s shoulder, my lady walking by her
+husband’s side, her hand locked in his, Charles skipping
+and running, now before, now behind, and Barbara as gay
+and careless as any, it suddenly occurred to me to make a
+somewhat forward remark.</p>
+
+<p>“Pray, Sir John,” I cried, “are you not a very rich man,
+to be able to give work to so many folk?”</p>
+
+<p>Looking back over my shoulder as I asked this question,
+I intercepted a glance between Sir John and my lady,
+which appeared to me full of mutual understanding.
+Instead of replying to me the gentleman said softly to his
+wife, “Shall we tell her the secret of the hills, my heart?”
+To which she replied in French,</p>
+
+<p>“I think she is to be trusted; but be careful of the children,
+my friend, for our eldest is ever ready to pick up information,
+and has not yet the discretion to withhold it from others.”</p>
+
+<p>“You must know, Barbara,” said Sir John in the same
+language, which he spoke with great fluency and address,
+“that what you say is true. I am indeed a wealthy man,
+so wealthy that all my schemes of policy for this place,
+though likely to cost a fortune, will not exhaust my
+resources. You have heard that I am the possessor of
+coal mines, which already yield me a good sum yearly;
+but now I am going to tell you of something more precious
+still to be found within the bowels of those dear, beautiful
+hills, of which you are so great an admirer. What do you
+say to silver, Mademoiselle, a vein of silver, forming a
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_41">[41]</span>
+mine so rich that it seems as if neither I nor my sons will
+ever come to an end of it!”</p>
+
+<p>“Silver!” I exclaimed, more astonished than I ever expected
+to be. “Silver in Scotland, Sir John? Why, I
+never imagined such a thing possible.”</p>
+
+<p>“Not only possible, but actually here,” rejoined the
+knight, “and some day you shall be taken to see it in
+working. Now that the frost is like to be out of the
+ground if this thaw continues, we can set in motion the
+engineers and miners, who, during the winter months, are
+perforce kept idle. Oh, there is no end to my dreams and
+imaginings about this ore, and what may be done with it—Why
+do you pull so hard at my hand, my lady?”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, my dear Sir John,” cried she, half laughing and
+half vexed; “your mine is like the milkmaid’s pail in the
+fable. Think of its fate, and of the disappointment of the
+poor dreamer, and do not let your hopes soar too high.”</p>
+
+<p>“Ta-ta-ta, my dear,” cried her husband, “now is not this
+just like you? No sooner do I begin about the glories of
+our future wealth, which is no dream, but founded on solid
+fact, than you tug at my hand, pull down your pretty lip,
+and cry, ‘Beware!’”</p>
+
+<p>“I care not for your scorn, dear husband,” said Lady
+Erskine seriously. “There is something within me
+stronger than I, which whispers forebodingly whenever this
+mine of yours is mentioned. I know not what it means,
+but if I believed these inner ghostly warnings, I should say
+that your silver is fated one day to bring us all ill-luck.”</p>
+
+<p>“But how many times, my life, have your warnings
+come to naught? Did you not say t’other day that you
+had a heavy presentiment of coming evil which concerned
+our eldest son, and the only thing that happened to him was
+the bruising of his fingers with the carpenter’s hammer. And
+when I was well-nigh lost in a storm crossing from France,
+two years since, were you not merry and gay in your father’s
+house, recking nothing of your poor spouse his danger?”</p>
+
+<p>My lady laughed, but she gave a little shiver. “Do not
+remind me of these horrors, I pray you. What I feel about
+the mine I cannot explain, and foolish though it may be,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_42">[42]</span>
+it has yet to be proved groundless. Look you, my dear,
+is it not possible for the precious metal suddenly to give
+out, and to leave you with all your projects on your hands,
+and nothing wherewith to meet them?”</p>
+
+<p>“Now, a truce to such gloomy forebodings!” cried Sir
+John gaily in English, and calling to Charles to lead the
+way to the mavis’s nest, he swung little Hal to the ground
+and bade him run with his brother, while their father would
+do his best to catch them.</p>
+
+<p>“Will you tell me, madam,” I said, as we walked more
+slowly behind, “why you bade Sir John speak French a
+little while back? Is the silver mine to be kept secret?”</p>
+
+<p>“Assuredly, my dear Barbara,” cried my lady in some
+alarm; “I understood you to have gathered as much from
+our method of talk. This, you must know, is one of our
+difficulties, and it is perhaps the chief reason why the subject
+lies so heavy on my mind. The affair is worked in
+secret, and kept private to our family, for should the knowledge
+of it slip out, there are not wanting those who could
+make trouble for Sir John. By an ancient act in Scots
+law, all ore found in the country must pay a heavy tax to
+the Crown; and as Sir John has no great mind to enrich
+the coffers of the Hanoverian, either in a public or private
+way, he hath hitherto managed to keep all knowledge of
+his mine well within his control, and the silver it yields in
+his own pocket. But alas! Barbara, a secret shared by
+many is no secret at all, and there is no end to the mischief
+that might ensue were you to let your tongue wag never so
+wisely on the matter.”</p>
+
+<p>“Believe me, dearest cousin,” I cried with some heat,
+“such a thing is far indeed from my intention. I would
+rather be dumb for the rest of my life than harm you or
+Sir John by one careless word. There is nothing I would
+not do to serve you and yours, madam, who have been so
+unspeakably kind to me. Pray, pray, believe me, and
+trust me as you would your own heart.”</p>
+
+<p>“What a fiery creature it is!” said my lady, smiling
+kindly, as she patted my flushed cheek. “Well—but all
+I ask of you, Barbara, is just a little discretion.”</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_43">[43]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_VI">
+ CHAPTER VI
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>INTRODUCES SEVERAL CHARACTERS</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>“Aunt Betty returns home to-day!” cried Charles one
+morning, as I came into their room to give my good
+Phemie greeting, “and I am to ride with the coach to
+fetch her, my mama says, and to be her little escort.”</p>
+
+<p>Now I had heard much from my Lady Erskine of her
+favourite sister Betty, and was looking forward with girlish
+eagerness mixed with diffidence (being troubled with the
+fear that the engaging young lady might not find me to her
+taste), to making her acquaintance. I therefore turned
+quickly to the child and clapped my hands.</p>
+
+<p>“How glad I am to hear it!” I cried. “She is very
+bright, and gay and pretty, is she not, your Aunt Betty?”</p>
+
+<p>The boy stared at me for a moment in surprise, and then
+he broke into a laugh.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, no, Cousin Barbara,” he cried. “Aunt Betty is
+dull and sad, and—but my mama does not allow me to say
+it—sometimes a little ill-humoured. We must be very
+gentle with Aunt Betty because she is old, but I must own
+to you that I do not love her very much.”</p>
+
+<p>“She gives me sugar-drops,” cried little Hal stoutly,
+“and for that I love her—sometimes!”</p>
+
+<p>My perplexity grew as I looked from one bright face
+to the other.</p>
+
+<p>“Whither do you ride to meet her?” I asked of Charles.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, all the way to Stirling!” he cried. “I may not
+be back till bed-time. I am a big lad now, cousin; I
+do not need to sleep during the day like my brother.”</p>
+
+<p>“But does not your Aunt Betty live at Dysart with my
+lord, your grandpapa?” I enquired, still much in a puzzle.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, yes!” they cried together, “the other Betty does,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_44">[44]</span>
+dear Betty, kind Betty! She it is who is bright and gay.
+But great-aunt Betty Erskine—well, you will see!”</p>
+
+<p>“She hath been spending some months,” went on
+Charles, “with her brother the Colonel, who you know
+is Governor of the Castle of Stirling. I love to go with
+him round the ramparts, and he took me once down into
+the dungeons, but—” with a faint note of regret—“there
+were no prisoners in them.”</p>
+
+<p>“Perhaps there will be some before very long,” I said
+to console him, little dreaming how soon my careless
+words were to come true.</p>
+
+<p>“Well, be very careful of your great-aunt, Cha, and we
+must all endeavour to make her happier when she comes.”</p>
+
+<p>My good opinion of my dear lady, already great, was
+much increased when I beheld her bearing towards her
+husband’s aunt, for with the direct ways of children, her
+sons had spoken nothing but the truth.</p>
+
+<p>Mistress Betty Erskine, who made her home for some
+months of the year at Alva, was not a cheerful inmate for
+any house. Her age, her infirmities, and a certain habit
+of looking on the worst side of everything, rendered her
+querulous and gloomy; and I watched with admiration,
+learning gradually to curb my own impatience and follow
+the example of the house, the gentle toleration with which
+the poor lady was treated. Sir John had ever a cheerful
+word with which to greet her. My lady bore her complainings
+with quiet kindness, and the little boys, as you
+have seen, were taught to behave to her with deference
+and respect. And surely ’tis a beautiful thing to see this
+kindly treatment of the old, for age, beyond a doubt, is
+a great misfortune, and one from which there is no escape
+but death. Sure, no one would choose to grow old, but
+would prefer to keep their youth and vigour unimpaired;
+and though many (unlike poor Aunt Betty,) give us fair
+and sweet examples of a cheerful old age, even towards
+these some patience is required, and every sympathetic
+art should be used that can console them.</p>
+
+<p>At last, however, “the other Betty” did arrive, and
+what a rush of fresh gaiety entered the house with her!
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_45">[45]</span>
+If my lady was the personification of peaceful cheerfulness,
+her sister was the very spirit of joyous merriment. The
+first made me think of a soft bright day in June, but
+the other was April and July in one, with at times a brisk
+touch of December. Such laughter, such kindness, such
+whims, such little tempers! And how the Honourable Betty
+contrived to be so charming with it all has puzzled wiser
+heads than Barbara’s.</p>
+
+<p>Even her own sister was sometimes astonished at her
+sayings and doings, her sudden gusts of anger, her sharp
+words, her fits of gloom, but before she had time to
+reprove her, Betty’s arms would be round her neck,
+and a gay laugh or a murmur of loving words would
+disarm her displeasure. Sir John watched them together,
+laughing at and with his sister-in-law, for they were fast
+friends and boon companions, although the knight teased
+her sometimes almost to the verge of tears. Her little
+nephews adored her, and any servant about the place
+would cheerfully have cut off a finger at her bidding.
+Even great-aunt Betty smiled a wintry smile at some of
+her gay sallies, and forgot to complain of the weather,
+or the country, or her own aches and pains, while Betty
+held the table at attention.</p>
+
+<p>I remember the day she came, a breezy, sunny, laughing
+April afternoon, when we were assembled in the parlour
+for “the four hours.” Suddenly there was a sound of
+horses’ feet stamping and scraping at the front-door, and
+a merry voice made itself heard above the din, calling
+out for Andrew, or Peter, to come and take the nags.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, tis Betty!” cried my lady rising, the pretty
+colour coming to her cheeks as it did so easily upon
+any excitement, and before I knew it we were both in
+the front-hall, watching the dismounting of a lady in a
+dark blue habit, assisted by a man in the garb of a
+gentleman, whose face I could not see. Another moment,
+and with a rush and a whirl she was in my lady’s arms,
+and saying a hundred merry, happy things in a breath.</p>
+
+<p>“I thought you would like me to take you by surprise,
+sister,” she cried, “and it was so long to wait till next
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_46">[46]</span>
+week, and I longed to be with you and to see Sir John
+before his departure, and the travelling-coach lacks repairs;
+so as the roads are good and the weather fine, my lord
+permitted me to ride horseback with, as you see, our
+good friend David for escort.”</p>
+
+<p>At this she beckoned with her hand to the young
+gentleman who stood on the threshold, and Sir John,
+coming up at that moment, he gave him hearty greeting.</p>
+
+<p>“Welcome, friend David!” he cried, laying his hand upon
+the other’s shoulder, “and so this wild girl as usual bids
+you drop all other duties, and act as mounted guard in
+her ladyship’s journeyings. Oh, ho! Mistress Betty, art
+never happy but with a train of followers all ready to do
+thy bidding.”</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, Sir John,” cried Betty, pouting, but holding
+up her cheek for him to kiss, “my train of followers
+this time is modest enough, though to be sure David
+Pitcairn is, for kindness and quickness, a host in himself,
+as the saying is. But when a poor girl hath only brothers
+who are ever too busy to attend her, and a father, loving
+and tender but infirm, must she refuse herself the comfort
+of a gentleman’s company upon the road, and be content
+with serving-men?”</p>
+
+<p>“Indeed!” cried the young gentleman, who had meantime
+been paying his respects to my lady, “Mistress
+Betty knows how willing all her friends are to serve her,
+and Sir John is aware that no duties could possibly stand
+in the way of a gracious command to attend her.”</p>
+
+<p>Now I may say here that I have seen Elizabeth Sinclair
+in many dresses and in various surroundings—in the ballroom,
+swimming and languishing through the minuet
+with infinite grace; in the garden gathering roses; in
+the still room, her white arms bare and her pink fingertips
+daintily busy; laughing and romping with the children,
+her hair ruffled, and her breath coming quick through
+parted lips; at her spinning-wheel in the twilight, silent
+and absorbed; and seated at the virginal, singing some
+old French song, her round chin uplifted and the candle-light
+forming a halo round her head; but fair and attractive
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_47">[47]</span>
+as she was in all these attitudes, I loved and admired
+the most to see her on horseback. Then, indeed, she
+appeared at her best—slim, graceful, joyous, a thing of
+life and motion swaying to every movement of the animal
+as though the same will inspired them both; and it is no
+marvel to me now to recall the adoring look with which
+young Mr. Pitcairn regarded her as he spoke. Even
+then, I, a girl but just waking up to the knowledge of
+life, thought ’twas writ plain in his face, how willingly
+he would ride with the lovely and seductive Betty through
+the wide world till life ended.</p>
+
+<p>But all this time I had been standing apart watching the
+newly arrived lady, shy, silent and doubtful, longing for
+a word, a look of recognition, but heavy at heart with the
+fear that she might find me too young, too trivial to notice;
+and then my lady’s kind voice said, “And this is Barbara.”</p>
+
+<p>Betty turned on me in her swift, light way.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, of course it is!” she cried, and her hands
+clasped mine, and her merry eyes were raised to my face,
+for she was several inches the shorter.</p>
+
+<p>“What a tall girl! and oh!—my dear Barbara, I swear
+it is not honest to steal a Scotswoman’s complexion of
+clear white and red, and add to it a foreigner’s charms of
+liquid dark eyes and hair nearly black.” Then pulling
+my face down, she whispered roguishly, “Dost know that
+thou art lovely, child, and I am almost jealous of thee?”</p>
+
+<p>So saying, she turned and followed her sister into the
+parlour, leaving me tingling with delight and confusion at
+hearing for the first time from the lips of another the
+thing that I had often hoped might be true.</p>
+
+<p>I think it was the next afternoon, for Mr. Pitcairn was
+with us, and I know that he had been bidden to lie at
+Alva for a couple of nights, that we made our excursion
+to the Silver Glen.</p>
+
+<p>There are, as you know, many lovely ravines in the
+Ochil Range, formed by the age-long working of the burns
+that, rising near the summit, tumble noisily down the
+sides by their self-made channels till they reach the quiet
+river that bears them to the sea. These mountain-streams
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_48">[48]</span>
+were ever a delight to me, and I could sit for hours upon
+a mossy stone watching the ever-changing water as it
+slipped past, now lying at rest in a quiet brown pool, anon
+breaking over the stones with a gurgling ripple, and then
+flinging itself down the steep rocks in a foaming cascade.
+And as I watched I listened to the voices that for me were
+never silent—three voices there were that talked, separately
+and altogether—a deep roaring bass, a soft middle voice,
+and a high tinkling treble; and what they said to me I
+cannot tell you, but perhaps some young maid, who has
+sat dreaming vague dreams to the sound of falling water,
+reading this may remember and understand.</p>
+
+<p>The Silver Glen lies not far from Alva House, and
+though small is very beautiful; and on this April day when
+the young leaves of the birch trees were fast beginning to
+shake themselves out of their winter wrappings and toss
+their graceful beauty in the sun, when the ground smelt
+sweet with new life, and the pale primrose and frail
+anemone were beginning to appear in the grass, it seemed
+to my foolish young mind a grievous thing that the place
+should be filled with busy workers, that heaps of ore and
+broken rock should lie in confusion beside the burn, and
+that the sound of pick and hammer should almost drown
+the music of the water.</p>
+
+<p>As we began to climb the hillside, Betty had turned to her
+friend, David, with an impressive gesture, and cried gaily,</p>
+
+<p>“Remember, sir, the secret of the hills must be guarded
+inviolate. Are you strong enough to keep silent?”</p>
+
+<p>They were standing a little apart, and no one but myself
+heard his reply. Looking deep into her eyes, he said in
+a low voice,</p>
+
+<p>“Betty, do you need to ask me that? You know that
+I am!”</p>
+
+<p>Just for one moment a shadow fell on her face, and her
+eyelids dropped. Then she gave a little laugh.</p>
+
+<p>“David, you are cruel to be so serious over a trifle!
+What is it that I know? Can you hold your tongue, ay,
+even in the torture-chamber, about what you are going to
+see here? Remember the head of my dear Sir John
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_49">[49]</span>
+is not safe should you or any of us babble, for is it not
+high treason to deprive the King of his revenues? Swear
+eternal silence, or else turn round and march straight home.”</p>
+
+<p>“Madam,” cried Mr. Pitcairn, becoming aware, as I
+think, of my presence, “I swear by the light of your own
+beautiful eyes never to divulge the secret of what you are
+about to show me.”</p>
+
+<p>With that we laughingly continued the ascent, and
+joined my lady who stood at the entrance of one of the
+long tunnels talking to a man whose back was turned
+to us. Sir John had gone on a little further to where
+some workmen were beginning to form a new opening.</p>
+
+<p>“Betty,” cried my lady on our approach, “here is
+James Hamilton returned. He hath been, as I told you,
+in Germany on an errand for Sir John, connected with the
+assaying of the ore. He is glad enough to get back, I trow.”</p>
+
+<p>I glanced at the man who stood smiling beside her.
+He was tall and had a handsome face, save that the eyes
+were too near together; and although he was dressed in
+the rough clothes of a common workman, he had the air
+and bearing of a gentleman. When he spoke his accent
+was refined, and his voice had a pleasant ring.</p>
+
+<p>“Yes, indeed, madam,” he answered, bowing low in
+reply to Betty’s greeting, and then to me as my lady
+pronounced my name. “I was not born for wandering.
+Travel in foreign lands does but endear my own the more
+to me.”</p>
+
+<p>“Tush, James!” cried Sir John, coming towards us,
+“what is this nonsense you talk? ’Tis but to make
+yourself acceptable in the eyes of the ladies, I dare swear.
+If Mr. Pitcairn and I were alone with you, doubtless we
+should hear another tale. Far be it from me to belittle
+Scotland, but there’s many a flaxen-haired Gretchen and
+blue-eyed Marie fair enough to delight the heart of man
+betwixt Rhine and Elbe, and I’m vastly mistaken if thou’rt
+the sort of fellow to go about with thine eyes shut to the
+beauties of nature.”</p>
+
+<p>“I vow,” cried Mr. Hamilton, laughing in his turn,
+“that I never, Sir John, in all my travels for the last two
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_50">[50]</span>
+months, had the good fortune to light on anything so fresh,
+so beautiful, so entrancing, as the group before me at this
+moment.”</p>
+
+<p>He swept us a courteous bow which included all three,
+but it seemed to me that his eye rested longest on Betty,
+and a little wicked jealous pang pinched my heart.
+Should I ever, I wondered, be so attractive as to draw the
+eyes of all men to me as seemed to be the way with Betty.
+Alas! what foolish, useless thoughts we suffer to lodge in
+our minds when we are young, to the exclusion often of that
+which is wiser, higher and infinitely more worthy.</p>
+
+<p>“La, Mr. Hamilton,” cried Betty, “you are vastly
+polite. But as you have already told us that nothing in the
+country pleased you, the compliment you pay us is not so
+exalted as it seems.”</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Hamilton turned to my lady.</p>
+
+<p>“There is one thing, madam, with which I can never
+keep pace,” he said, “travel as hard as I may, and that is
+Mistress Betty’s tongue!”</p>
+
+<p>“I must own ’tis a very nimble one,” said my lady,
+smiling. “And now, James, I want you to show the
+working of the mine to Mistress Stewart, who hath but
+lately come to live here. Give Mr. Hamilton your hand,
+my dear, and trust yourself to his guidance.”</p>
+
+<p>It was a strange thing to me to leave the green and
+sunny world behind, and to walk straight into the heart of
+the hill, where, in the stifling darkness, by the dim light of
+lanterns, men toiled and sweated with pick-axe and spade
+to wrest from the very entrails of the earth the treasure
+that was enabling Sir John to beautify and improve his
+estate. The passage through which we walked was narrow—I
+could lay a hand upon the walls on either side, and the
+foot-way was rough and slippery and precarious, so much
+so that I could scarce attend to what my guide was saying,
+as he explained the method of finding and extracting the
+silver. Here and there water oozed through the rock and
+dripped upon us as we crept along, and presently we came
+upon a deep hole or pit, where looking down I saw the
+forms of men bending to their work. So weird and goblin-like
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_51">[51]</span>
+they looked in that uncertain light that I shivered and
+drew hastily back. Upon that Mr. Hamilton caught me
+sharply by the arm with a quick word of warning, and
+glancing round I perceived with a thrill of horror that
+another opening or shaft, narrower but much deeper than
+the first, gaped darkly just behind me. So startled was I at
+the sight, that I clung to my companion’s arm in terror, and
+for a moment could neither speak nor move. Seeing this,
+Mr. Hamilton soothed me in a very kind and gentle way,
+and turning slowly he guided my footsteps back along the
+way we had come.</p>
+
+<p>“I must have your forgiveness, Mistress Barbara,” he
+said, “for having startled you by so suddenly clutching at
+your arm. But I feared that you might step too far the
+other way, and I did not, as you may imagine, wish to see
+the light of the loveliest eyes in all broad Scotland
+quenched in the darkness of the pit.”</p>
+
+<p>Now, had I been a few years older or more experienced,
+no doubt I should have treated this speech with the
+haughty displeasure it deserved, for the man was a stranger,
+and the young maid he addressed was the ward of his
+employers; but Barbara was in those days very young, very
+thoughtless and foolish, and the compliment pleased me,
+little feather-head that I was, because it was the first that I
+had ever received from one of the sterner sex. Here was a
+proof of the admiration that I longed for, and an opportunity
+of showing myself <i>the accomplished coquette</i>. The
+sunlight was glimmering on the dusky walls as we
+approached the entrance, so I tossed my head and replied
+in tones which I fondly hoped resembled those of the
+Honourable Betty,</p>
+
+<p>“La! Mr. Hamilton, you are monstrous kind, I am sure,
+to pay me such a pretty compliment. But how can your
+words be true, when you know that Mistress Betty is standing
+within a few yards of us?”</p>
+
+<p>“Mistress Betty!” he cried in low tones, and with a
+kind of soft amazement. “You cannot possibly think,
+madam, that any man of taste would glance at that
+charming lady while such an one as yourself was by?”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_52">[52]</span></p>
+
+<p>Now I have said that Barbara was silly, which is true;
+but she was not for all that an absolute fool, and inexperienced
+as she was, she had sense enough to see that this
+time the compliment was too gross to be genuine. So she
+laughed very merrily, and begged Mr. Hamilton not to talk
+any more nonsense.</p>
+
+<p>We proceeded for some way in silence, but just as we
+neared the full daylight the gentleman turned and spoke
+quickly and gravely in my ear.</p>
+
+<p>“The truth, madam, can never be nonsense,” he said.
+“For my part I would sooner have one glance from your
+dark eyes, and a smile from your exquisite lips, than all the
+sparkle and charm of Mistress Betty’s beauty and wit,
+great as these are.”</p>
+
+<p>Alas! for my fleeting discretion, how his words set my
+heart a-beating! When we stepped out upon the hillside into
+the wind and the sunshine, I knew that my cheeks were
+glowing, and my eyes shining with unwonted light.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, Barbara,” cried my lady, “you look fey!
+What didst see and hear within the hill to give thee such a
+colour, child?”</p>
+
+<p>I was silent in confusion, but Mr. Hamilton came to my
+rescue.</p>
+
+<p>“I regret to tell you, madam, that Mistress Barbara
+narrowly escaped falling down the shaft, and the little
+incident has no doubt shaken her nerve.”</p>
+
+<p>“How strange!” scoffed Betty, with a keen glance at me.
+“Now when I am frightened, sister, I turn as white as chalk:
+but to be sure, Barbara’s way is the more becoming!”</p>
+
+<p>That night after Phemie had left me—for the good
+creature would always attend me to my couch as in the old
+days—I heard a light tap at my chamber door, and opening
+it, I found Betty, in night-rail and slippers, standing on the
+threshold, her fair hair demurely braided ready for her cap.</p>
+
+<p>“I am coming in, Barbara,” she said, and walking past
+me into the room she seated herself in a chair, and left me
+standing before her.</p>
+
+<p>“Now,” she cried, lifting a finger at me, “confess!
+What did that man say to you to-day in the tunnel!”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_53">[53]</span></p>
+
+<p>Utterly taken aback I could only gaze at her, and
+gradually the remembrance of the words, which I had well-nigh
+forgotten, came back to me, and the colour
+deepened in my face.</p>
+
+<p>“Mistress Betty!” I cried, “what mean you?”</p>
+
+<p>“My good child,” she exclaimed, “do not try to
+deceive me, for it is useless. I know as well as if I had
+been by your side all the time that James Hamilton was
+saying something to you, as foolish as it was pretty, down
+there in the dark, and I wish to know what it was.”</p>
+
+<p>“But, madam,” I protested feebly, “I do not see why
+I should tell you!”</p>
+
+<p>“Hoity-toity!” cried she, “so the child has some spirit!
+And why not, pray? At so early a stage in the proceedings
+he can hardly have said anything you are ashamed to repeat.”</p>
+
+<p>This was attacking me upon another side, and finding it
+useless to fence with her, I weakly surrendered.</p>
+
+<p>“Ashamed!” I repeated, blushing hotly. “Why no,
+scarcely that; but standing here with you, Mistress Betty,
+the words seem to me senseless and vain, which by his side
+in the darkness yet gave me a certain pleasure.”</p>
+
+<p>“Ahem! I thought so. He praised your dark eyes, I
+suppose, and delicately gave you to understand that beauty
+such as yours is a new and rare thing in this country-side.
+Perhaps he told you that beside you I was not worth a
+glance. Was that it?”</p>
+
+<p>Amazed, I could only murmur. “But how, madam,
+could you know?”</p>
+
+<p>Betty lay back in her chair and laughed. “How do I
+know? Ah, Barbara, what an innocent you are. I know
+because I have been seventeen myself, though that was
+some time ago now; and because men are all cut out on
+one pattern, at least most of them; and because your eyes
+and your blushes called it aloud to all the world; and
+because compliments made to one maid are very much
+like compliments paid to another, and—oh, well, because
+I am a woman, and know a good many things without
+being told at all.”</p>
+
+<p>I stood, looking no doubt as much chagrined as I felt,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_54">[54]</span>
+till Betty had finished speaking, then I threw myself down
+on a settee a little way off, and cried petulantly.</p>
+
+<p>“But where is then the harm of a compliment, seeing
+they are so common? and why should I not be innocent
+in such matters—a girl but just out of school? ’Tis not
+quite kind of you to laugh so, Mistress Betty.”</p>
+
+<p>She was grave again at once, and answered gently.</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, child, it was wrong of me to mock, and having
+come to warn you, I have but succeeded in angering you.
+Forgive me, Barbara. James Hamilton is a handsome man,
+and a clever one; he is a scion of an old and noble
+house, and ’tis no shame to him but much to his credit
+that he works hard for his living. But, Barbara, I do not
+trust him; why, I know not. There is something in his
+nature antagonistic to my own. I mock and joke with
+him, but all the time my spirit is saying to his spirit, ‘Keep
+off, we are not friends!’ and if we lived together fifty
+years, at the end of that time we should still be strangers.”</p>
+
+<p>She spoke so gravely that I could not be offended; here
+was no womanish jealousy, no idle fault-finding, no carping
+at a laggard lover. I was wise enough to comprehend this,
+and I answered with a gravity equal to her own.</p>
+
+<p>“In what do you distrust him, madam?”</p>
+
+<p>Betty spoke more lightly.</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, that I can hardly tell you; but look you, my dear,
+you are young, and fair, and a fortune. ’Twould not be
+detrimental to James Hamilton’s ambitions to win a bride
+like yourself; but you are destined, I trust, for better things
+than that. During the summer you will see a good deal of
+this gentleman, and I beg of you not to let yourself be
+drawn into a net, out of which you might, later, long in
+vain to escape.”</p>
+
+<p>Without waiting for a reply, she jumped up and made
+for the door, crying,</p>
+
+<p>“Good-night! Forget not the words of wisdom, but do
+not allow them to disturb your slumbers.”</p>
+
+<p>She vanished behind the closing door, and I retired to
+bed, not quite so convinced of her wisdom as I ought to
+have been.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_55">[55]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_VII">
+ CHAPTER VII
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>I BECOME AWARE THAT SOMETHING IMPORTANT IS AFOOT</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>The days of spring fled swiftly and easily for me in my
+pleasant abode although nothing happened to mark their
+passage with any particularity. Less than a week after the
+arrival of Betty, Sir John, whose journey had already been
+delayed much beyond the usual time, by the state of the
+roads and the inclemency of the weather, took his departure
+for London, leaving behind him as I know now, though at
+the time I gave but little thought to the subject, a very
+lonely and disconsolate wife.</p>
+
+<p>Whatever burden that tender heart was forced to bear,
+it was hidden under an aspect of calm cheerfulness, and
+the healthful activity which so greatly distinguished my
+Lady Erskine. And indeed, I have often wondered how
+Alva House and estate would have held together, had its
+mistress given way to repining, or indulged herself in selfish
+grieving and idle brooding over her troubles. When, after
+a short stay, her sister returned to Dysart, she busied herself
+from morning till night both inside the house and about
+the place. I have often found her in the farm-yard before
+seven o’clock of a morning consulting with Mr. Rose, the
+grieve, as to the buying or selling of certain cattle, the
+condition of the young lambs, or the sowing of seeds in
+field or garden. Anxious to follow her husband’s lead in
+all things, she contrived with some trouble to keep the men
+at the walks which she longed to have completed before
+the knight’s return, and all questions regarding the planting
+of flowers or vegetables were submitted to her for arbitration.
+Besides all this, there were friends and visitors to be
+entertained, poor folk to be assisted, beggars to be fed;
+and sure never was house so famed for hospitality to rich
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_56">[56]</span>
+and poor alike, for scarce a day passed without guests in
+the dining-room, or pensioners in the kitchen. Placed so
+near the high-road that runs between Stirling and
+Dunfermline, and night and day was thronged with
+passers-by, it served as a convenient house-of-call from
+which none were sent empty away; and though some
+might feel inclined to grumble at the vast expenditure
+which this open-heartedness entailed, it never seemed to
+enter the minds of Sir John and his lady that any other
+manner of living was possible.</p>
+
+<p>Among the neighbours who lived within a few miles of
+Alva were many friendly gentlemen who, with their ladies,
+appeared to enjoy nothing better than to ride over
+and dine or sup with us, in order as they said, to cheer my
+Lady Erskine in her loneliness; and right welcome did she
+make them all, though at times I have fancied she had
+been as well pleased to be left in peace and quietness with
+her children. Living in the centre of a large circle of
+relations, her own and her husband’s families being largely
+represented in that part of the country, there was a constant
+coming and going among them, and as the roads grew more
+fit for travelling, my lady would occasionally spend a night
+or two from home with one or other of her numerous
+relatives. At Stirling Castle lived her husband’s uncle,
+Colonel Erskine, a kind and jovial old officer, and a vast
+favourite with all the younger generation. Not far off
+lived her eldest sister-in-law, the widowed Lady Ardoch,
+whose son, Sir Harry Stirling, was a frequent visitor at
+Alva. Another sister-in-law, her namesake, Catherine, was
+Mrs. Patrick Campbell of Monzie; while a third, Helen, was
+the wife of Mr. Haldane of Gleneagles. My lady’s eldest
+sister, Grizel, was married to Mr. John Paterson of
+Prestonhall, and a younger, Margaret, had lately become
+the wife of Sir William Baird of Newbyth. So with her
+home at Dysart still occupied by a kind father, and several
+brothers and sisters, you can imagine that there was much
+pleasant intercourse between them in those days.</p>
+
+<p>Sometimes we took the road to Edinburgh, where we
+passed a day or two with the Dowager Lady Alva, at her
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_57">[57]</span>
+house in Miln’s Square. The first time I went was when
+we carried Aunt Betty there on her yearly visit. It was
+then also I made the acquaintance of my guardian, Mr.
+Charles Erskine, one of the kindest men and most
+fascinating companions it has ever been my lot to meet.
+You will have come to the conclusion among yourselves
+that it is next to impossible for your cousin Barbara to
+have any word but of praise to say of any creature bearing
+the name of Erskine, and indeed it would ill become me
+to regard them in any other way. But the charm of
+manner, the kindliness and courtesy which distinguished Sir
+John, and his brothers, Charles and Robert, though of the
+last I can only speak from hearsay, were such as to have
+left a lasting impression, not only on the mind of a simple
+girl, but upon society in general.</p>
+
+<p>No words of mine are needed to establish the reputation
+of my Lord Tinwald, happily still among us; and though
+circumstances have prevented me seeing much of him since
+my marriage, I have heard from time to time of his
+honourable career, of his many virtues, and of the happy
+circle with which he is surrounded at Alva. Happy and
+kind and good, he was likewise in those far-off days busy
+with his work at the Bar, and rejoicing in the love of his
+pretty wife (his beloved Chrissy), and their baby daughter.
+I remember him very well as he appeared to me then,
+handsome and courtly, full of humour and liveliness, his
+face beaming with kindness, his manner winning, and his
+voice soft. He spoke with a slight natural lisp, which so
+became him that his brother, Sir John, often declared he
+would not part with it for a fortune, and of no man could
+it be said with more truth than of your Uncle Charles, that
+he knew how to suit his discourse to his audience; for
+among his colleagues in the courts, or with his little nephews
+in their nursery, he found ever the right words to speak,
+and the subject most congenial to his hearers.</p>
+
+<p>You will no doubt be wondering what effect the wise and
+kind words of Mistress Betty Sinclair, regarding modesty and
+discretion, had had upon the conduct of Barbara, and I am
+sorry to be obliged to tell you that although they were not
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_58">[58]</span>
+forgotten, the impression they had made very soon slipped
+from her mind. Although it was but seldom she saw Mr.
+Hamilton, except in the presence of my Lady Erskine, I
+can well recall that even thus he was able to convey in
+silent and unobtrusive manner, many hints of his admiration
+and respect, which inflamed her silly vanity and set
+her heart a-fluttering. There is nothing on earth so foolish
+as a young girl in her first encounters with the other sex, if
+she be unaccustomed to flattery and somewhat inclined to
+frivolity. I must honestly own that I cannot recollect any
+great breach of modesty on my part towards my admirer,
+but there is no denying that I practised upon him all the
+little feminine arts (such as soft glances and coy blushes,
+sudden frowns and scornful smiles), that many women are
+skilled in from their cradles. It pleased me to see him
+come and go, and to hear his voice speak my name, for in
+some subtle way he continued to let me know that, however
+much he was occupied by affairs with my lady, mine was
+the presence he regarded, and mine the eyes that his own
+were anxious to meet.</p>
+
+<p>Partly on account, I imagine, of this senseless attraction,
+and partly because my life at Alva seemed the perfection of
+simple happiness, I heard with some dismay that my lady
+was about to leave home for several weeks, taking me with
+her to my Lord Sinclair’s house at Dysart. Just at first I
+felt moved to protest against the plan and to beg her to
+leave me behind, but a moment’s reflection showed me that
+not only would such a course savour of great ingratitude,
+but that the request would be both foolish and useless, as
+it was not seemly that I should live in the house protected
+only by the servants.</p>
+
+<p>It gave me a certain satisfaction, however, to meet Mr.
+Hamilton that same evening, as I walked in the garden
+with little Charles for my companion. It was near the
+middle of May, and the blossom was thick on the fruit-trees,
+and the flowering shrubs were gay. The air was fragrant
+with scent, and a cuckoo was calling loudly from some
+secret place among the trees. The sun was gone behind the
+hill, though it was a long way yet from setting, and a soft
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_59">[59]</span>
+light breeze blew across the valley from the unseen river.
+I was chatting merrily with my little friend, when suddenly
+I heard a footstep behind me and turned to find James
+Hamilton close upon us. His hat was in his hand, and
+his eyes were full of a pleasant deference. Charles ran
+back a step or two to catch hold of his hand, and I must
+needs pause also, until they made up upon me.</p>
+
+<p>“This is sad news, Mistress Barbara,” he said in answer
+to my smile, “if it be true that we are to lose the light of
+life from Alva for a couple of weeks or more. Tell me if it
+is so, and give me, I pray you, some word of consolation.”</p>
+
+<p>“If by the light you prize so much, you mean my lady’s
+presence, Mr. Hamilton, ’tis true that you are to be left in
+darkness for some time, and the only consolation I can
+offer you is that I trust it will not be for ever.”</p>
+
+<p>He gave me a glance of half-comic reproach. “Cruel
+creature!” cried he, “’tis your pleasure to torment me.
+Great as is my respect and liking for her ladyship, ’twould
+be hypocritical to pretend that her absence will darken my
+sky. Do you not know, Mistress Barbara, who it is that I
+shall long for with a great longing?”</p>
+
+<p>I looked at him from under my eyelashes, and frowned
+as if perplexed.</p>
+
+<p>“Sure then there is only myself left,” I said slowly.</p>
+
+<p>“And I wish that you could be left!” he cried with
+fervour, “seeing that I am to remain at Alva. Well,
+Mistress Barbara Stewart,” he went on, as I declined to
+respond to this advance, “I wonder if you will find the
+Hermitage to your liking. There are gallants enough
+among my Lord Sinclair’s sons to please you, and if their
+time is not too much occupied with politics, they may even
+succeed in making you forget us altogether.”</p>
+
+<p>“Are the family at Dysart, then, so much interested in
+affairs of state?” I asked.</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Hamilton laughed.</p>
+
+<p>“Rather more than His Gracious Majesty, King George,
+would approve of. But I must be careful, madam, how I
+talk. Your inclinations and sympathies, no doubt, are in
+accord with your name.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_60">[60]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Nay, sir,” I cried, “I protest I know not what you
+mean. But as my lady is waiting for little Charles we
+must not linger now. Farewell, Mr. Hamilton; I daresay
+by the time we meet again you may have grown more
+serious-minded.”</p>
+
+<p>“Farewell, madam!” he replied, with a bow. “By the time
+we meet again we shall all, doubtless, have become wiser.”</p>
+
+<p>I scarce can tell you when it first dawned on my mind
+that, with regard to political matters, something stirring was
+afoot. I had heard since coming to Alva, some talk about
+the King in Lorraine and his chances of success, from the
+various visitors who frequented the house, and many a bowl
+of punch was brewed, from which we ladies were given a glass
+to drink to the downfall of the usurper, and the establishment
+of the rightful heir. I had listened in a vague way to
+the toasts and the jokes, for many a gay laugh was raised
+among them, and I, smiling too, had not thought it worth
+my while to discover if they were serious or no. But one
+afternoon when my lady had driven to Stirling to visit the
+wife of Sir Hugh Paterson of Bannockburn, I heard some
+talk that was grave enough to set me thinking.</p>
+
+<p>Lady Jean was, as you know, sister to my lord, the
+Earl of Mar, and at this time she had staying with her
+in the house, her nephew, Thomas—“Lordy Erskine” as
+we often called him—a boy of some eleven or twelve years
+old. To our little Charles he was of course a great hero,
+being twice his age, and tall and strong for his years, and
+the two were now at play in the garden while I sat with the
+ladies in the parlour to drink a dish of tea. My lady
+had been enquiring after the health of my Lady Frances,
+Tommie’s step-mother, and her young daughter, a babe of
+a few months old, and Lady Jean was lamenting the fact
+that they were not yet able to come to Alloa.</p>
+
+<p>“But indeed, my dear,” she said, “all things seem
+unsettled, and I am gravely anxious about my brother and
+his projects. You know that his sympathies jump with
+our own, and yet it seems to me he inclines to ingratiate
+himself with the enemy. Were he to turn cat-in-the-pan
+now, I know not how our friends could bear it.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_61">[61]</span></p>
+
+<p>I saw my Lady Erskine’s fair face flush with displeased
+surprise.</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, Lady Jean,” she cried, “I’ll not believe it!
+Such a thing is not possible from the Earl. Why, I know
+that it is his dearest hope to bring the King back from
+exile, and our husbands, madam, have as you know, not
+hesitated to put their fingers in the pie.”</p>
+
+<p>“From which they will be lucky if they extract anything
+but a scalding!” said Lady Jean with a rueful smile.
+“My dear creature, have patience with me! Are you
+never yourself tormented with forebodings of evil when
+all the rest of the world is prophesying prosperity? That
+is my condition whenever I think on the subject so near
+our hearts, but it is useless to speak of it. We women
+must nurse our fears in silence.”</p>
+
+<p>“Indeed!” cried my lady, “Barbara Stewart here will
+tell you how apt I am to look on the dark side of the
+cloud on many occasions, but this thing <i>cannot</i> fail. We
+hear that the King of France is heart and soul for the
+Cause, and Charles of Sweden likewise, and with a General
+like the Duke of Berwick, and my Lord Bolingbroke for
+Councillor to King James, there is no fear this time of the
+project coming to naught.”</p>
+
+<p>“God grant it may be so!” sighed the other. “No
+woman in Scotland has the wish for the restoration of
+that family more at heart than I. Were it only for the sake
+of the poor, good, true-hearted Queen, who, blameless and
+innocent herself, has suffered so much and with such
+patience, I should desire it most warmly. But restoration
+means rebellion, and rebellion means war, and my woman’s
+heart trembles at the very thought.”</p>
+
+<p>“I try not to think too much of that,” Lady Erskine
+replied gravely. “As my father’s daughter I should be
+willing to give my best and dearest for the King, but if it
+means my parting with my husband, Lady Jean, or you
+with yours, then God help us both!”</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, nay!” cried Lady Jean, seeing the look in my dear
+lady’s eyes, “I meant not so to disturb your mind. We are
+both brave women, I take it, and can bear what Fate sends.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_62">[62]</span>
+But I dearly wish poor, foolish Anne had been reconciled
+to her brother before she died, when, despite the Act of
+Succession, I dare swear justice would have been done
+without our having to fight for it.”</p>
+
+<p>But here my lady thought it wise to send me from the
+room, on the pretext of finding Charles for our return
+home, and what further was said upon the matter I know
+not.</p>
+
+<p>Now I should like to say here that ’tis prodigiously
+uneasy for me to write of those days, and the events that
+happened, and the people that took part in them, without
+permitting the influence of later knowledge to colour my
+narrative. Therefore it must be forgiven me if my tale
+appears to halt in some places, and to be over-particular in
+others. More especially must this be the case in speaking
+of the characters of the actors in this drama I am endeavouring
+to describe, with some of whom I came in contact,
+though of many I can but speak from hearsay.</p>
+
+<p>After all, I would ask, how is it possible to know with
+accuracy the inner motives of any man’s actions? To his
+Maker alone, I am inclined to think, is this knowledge given.
+He, himself, is influenced by many happenings, urged
+on consciously and unconsciously by the words and even
+the thoughts of others, so that at times he regards his
+own doings with surprise, now astonished at his unlooked
+for success, now bitterly repenting his grievous mistakes;
+and if you tell me that by setting forth such a belief I try
+to rob men of their responsibilities to God and to their
+neighbours, I will only reply that it is possible we may not
+be so responsible for the good that we do and the evil that
+we commit, as we suppose. My dear grandpapa, who was
+a great admirer of the works of Mr. Shakespeare (a
+dramatist who has, I fear, gone somewhat out of fashion)
+was fond of quoting, among other of his wise sayings, that,
+“There is a Destiny that shapes our ends, rough-hew them
+how we will!” and to him, as also to me, this thought has
+oft brought comfort.</p>
+
+<p>It is a thought that is very apt to come to my mind in
+considering the character and conduct of the Earl of Mar.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_63">[63]</span>
+Saving once only, and for a short time, I never set eyes
+upon this gentleman, but his name was once as familiar in
+my ears as my own, and there is no man in the world of
+whom I have heard so much good and so much evil
+spoken. The kinsman and near neighbour of my guardian
+at Alva, of the same age, and with the same tastes, John
+Erskine, sixth Earl of Mar, was a man greatly beloved and
+trusted in his own country-side. By his opponents he has
+been called treacherous and shifty, by his rivals, ambitious
+and unscrupulous, and his conduct as statesman and as
+general has laid him open to the bitter attacks even of
+those whom he might have counted as his friends; but by
+his neighbours at home he was known to be affable and
+obliging, kind and helpful, never withholding assistance
+where it was desired in matters great or small, and doing
+all with so easy a grace as made his favours the more
+acceptable; for he asked nothing in return, and seemed to
+live only to gain the good-will and affection of all around
+him.</p>
+
+<p>At Alva House, as I can bear witness, he was admired
+and loved for his private, rather than for his public
+character. He hath long ago passed beyond the reach of
+human praise or blame, dying after long exile in a foreign
+land, and if his sins and mistakes were great, they brought
+him neither happiness nor reward. May his ashes rest in
+peace! I remember him as a kind and courteous gentleman;
+and his gardens at Alloa were a sight most beautiful to
+behold.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_64">[64]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_VIII">
+ CHAPTER VIII
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>I GO TO DYSART</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>Far as I have travelled and beautiful as are the countries I
+have seen, the fairest pictures that hang in the galleries of
+my memory are pictures of bonnie Scotland. To me it
+seems that in those far-off days of which I write the
+sunshine was brighter, the air more limpid, the shadows
+bluer, and the trees of a softer green than any I have seen
+in later years. But well my foolish heart knows ’tis but
+the glamour of distance, that enhanceth all beauty, lingering
+round the scenes of my youth, and the magic strength
+of early impressions that keeps them ever fresh in my mind.</p>
+
+<p>And yet it would be hard to deny that the prospect seen
+from the coast of Fife, looking southward, is one of the
+fairest of its kind in the world. How blue and sparkling
+was the water of the Frith on that May morning, as my
+lady and I approached the little town of Dysart; how white
+the foam of joyous wavelets that broke upon the rocks!
+Far away the great Bass and Berwick Law rose like twin
+fortresses side by side, and against the opposite coast the
+white sails of ships and small boats shone in the sunlight.
+Westward, where the slender masts of the shipping rose
+thickest, the town of Leith was hidden in its own blue
+smoke, but behind it the Lion kept watch over Edinburgh
+Castle, and the Pentlands melted faintly into the soft
+summer sky. Our road had followed the coast for some
+miles, and it had pressed heavy on my heart to come so
+near to my own dear home, and yet to pass it by. My
+kind cousin had known very well what was in my mind,
+and had laid her hand on mine with a mute pressure of
+sympathy at sight of grey Rosyth, with the ripples breaking
+round its feet. But the beauty of the day forbade me to
+be sad, and as we reached the Hermitage, I broke out into
+cries of delight and admiration which pleased my lady well.</p>
+
+<p>Mistress Betty and her youngest sister, Mary, were
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_65">[65]</span>
+waiting at the door to welcome us, and we were immediately
+shown into the presence of my Lord Sinclair, whose stately
+demeanour impressed, while his kindness of manner
+delighted me. His greeting of his daughter, Catherine,
+was all that a tender father’s could be, and her joy at
+seeing him again was as little restrained as if she had been
+still but a child. While she settled herself beside him for
+such converse as was most agreeable to them both, Betty
+and her sister bore me off between them, the former full of
+questions that awaited no answers, the latter, who was a delicate,
+gentle girl, silent and smiling and willing to be friendly.</p>
+
+<p>“We are a large family, my little Barbara,” cried the
+former, “and I trust that you have plenty of spirit to face it.
+Fortunately it is not here in full force at present, as Jamie
+is with his regiment abroad, and Matthew still at school;
+Grizel and Meg, as you know, are in homes of their own, so
+there remain only my eldest brother, John, Will, Harry and
+little Nannie here. Still, when we are met round the
+family-board, we make a goodly show; and as we are not
+silent people, it sometimes requires my lord’s sternest frown
+to quell the tempest of noise.”</p>
+
+<p>Later in the day, I met for the first time, that strange,
+and to me incomprehensible gentleman, your uncle, the
+Master of Sinclair. As his not too happy life came to a
+close some five years ago, he leaving no children to cherish
+his memory, I count myself free to make my comments
+upon his character, as otherwise I could not have done. It
+was difficult to believe when I looked upon this heavy,
+sullen-browed man, that he was the son of my handsome
+and courtly host, and brother to the sunny-faced ladies
+whom I loved. To me he ever appeared the one sour
+fruit upon a sweet and wholesome tree; and though seeing
+him in the bosom of his family, where his deference to my
+lord and his affection for his sisters predisposed me in his
+favour, there was about him, in his looks and in his words,
+such a scarce-veiled bitterness that I wondered at times
+they did not check him for it.</p>
+
+<p>My dear Elizabeth, I soon discovered, had a prodigious
+admiration for her brother, and took every occasion to extol
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_66">[66]</span>
+or excuse him even to me, of whom as an insignificant girl
+he took but little notice, leaving me therefore the more at
+leisure to observe him.</p>
+
+<p>“The Master hath not been one of Fortune’s favourites,
+Barbara,” she told me one afternoon, as we sat on the rocks
+below the house and watched the sea-gulls wheeling about
+after their evening meal. “My father, proud of his learning,
+for indeed he is passing clever, and a scholar of no mean
+degree, was opposed to his going into the army—a thing
+upon which my brother had set his heart. He set out for
+the Continent with scarce any money, and many and great
+were the hardships he endured. But a soldier he would be,
+and by degrees he won the friendship and esteem of his
+Grace, the Duke of Marlborough, so that when sorely
+slandered and in danger of his life, he stood his friend; and
+through him also was gained the favour of the Queen, who,
+by granting my brother his pardon, showed very plainly that
+she considered him not in fault.”</p>
+
+<p>Now I had heard from Aunt Betty Erskine the doubtful
+story of the Master’s quarrel with Captain Schaw and his
+brother, of the trial by Court Martial of Captain Sinclair,
+of his escape out of camp after being sentenced to death—an
+escape assisted, as most people surmised, by the great
+duke himself—of his terrible night ride through the forest to
+the sea-coast and safety, and of his arrival at the Hermitage,
+where he had some difficulty in convincing his father, the
+most honourable of men, of the integrity of his conduct.
+All this is a matter of history, and, I thereby betray no secrets.
+But as the ancient lady who recounted these things to me,
+had added many caustic remarks of her own as to the
+bullying, quarrelsome nature of the Master, and the
+probability of his having been wholly in the wrong, I found
+it difficult to answer Betty with the enthusiastic agreement
+she seemed to expect.</p>
+
+<p>“Do you not admire my brother, Barbara?” she cried,
+looking sharply at my embarrassed face. “What have you
+in your mind against him, child?” she asked hastily, as I
+strove to find an answer.</p>
+
+<p>“I am displeased with him to-day,” I answered, with a
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_67">[67]</span>
+childish petulance wholly feigned to cover my deceit,
+“because I heard him speak of my dear Sir John as—as an
+intolerable fool!”</p>
+
+<p>Betty laughed and sighed a little.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, Barbara,” she said then, “one of the strangest
+things in the world is the amount of enmity that exists
+between those who might so easily be friends. My brother
+was abroad when Catherine was married to Sir John, and I
+think he resented finding him coming and going as a son of
+the house, when he returned <i>under a cloud</i> as it were.
+That is the only reason I can think of in the beginning.
+He was also bitterly against the Union which Sir John
+supported, and now when more than half the country is
+anxious for its repeal, and my brother-in-law of Alva is
+strong for the Restoration which should bring it about, the
+Master, as you can understand, hath many a jibe ready to
+fling at those ‘waverers’ as he calls them. It grieves me
+much that they are not better friends, for Catherine, of
+course, supports her husband and is not best pleased at my
+brother’s attitude.”</p>
+
+<p>“Your family is strong for the King?” I questioned, not
+wishing to discuss the Master further.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, my dear,” cried Betty, clasping her hands, “that is
+another matter of dissension that hurts me to the very
+heart. You know that my lord was the only man of the
+Scottish nation who had courage to protest against the
+title of King William to the throne, and when none
+would listen to him he rose and left the Assembly. The
+matter goes very deep with him. For myself, I am willing
+to lay down my life almost for King James, and my sisters,
+Grizel and Catherine, are also of my mind. Of my
+brother James I cannot speak. He is Major in the Royal
+Scots Regiment of Foot and is a brave and able soldier,
+but I pray he may never have to use his gifts in fighting
+against the King. Will and Harry will do as my father bids
+them, and John is already deep in preparations among our
+neighbours. But many of those we know and love the
+best are bitterly opposed to our schemes, and we are
+obliged to be very secret regarding them.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_68">[68]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Your great-grandfather, I have heard, suffered imprisonment
+for King Charles,” I said.</p>
+
+<p>“Indeed he did; being taken at the Battle of
+Worcester, he was kept a prisoner for nine long years.
+But I rejoice to think the brave old man lived to see the
+Royal House restored and to rejoice in the King’s favour,
+who graciously made mention more than once of his
+gratitude to my lord.”</p>
+
+<p>“Ah!” cried I, “to suffer for those we love but binds
+the ties of affection closer. My dear Lady said this to me
+t’other day, but I scarce understood her words. ’Tis in the
+blood of your family to fight for the rightful King, and
+doubtless had my dear grandpapa lived I should have
+known more about it than I do now.”</p>
+
+<p>“He deemed you too young, child, to discuss such
+matters with you, but I know that he was one of the
+gentlemen, who, along with my father and many other
+noblemen, signed the memorial to the King of France,
+brought over to Scotland by one Captain Hooke, in the
+year 1707; and I have heard him tell how often and how
+longingly he had scanned the Frith from the windows of
+his house, hoping that early some summer morning he
+should see the King’s ships with sails full-set come boldly
+up the river to anchor in Leith harbour.”</p>
+
+<p>“And why came they not?” I asked, my heart beating
+at the tones of her voice, and the thought of my dear
+grandfather’s eagerness disappointed.</p>
+
+<p>“Alas! they came indeed, but after long delay. First
+’twas promised for the month of August, and our hopes
+were very high, but the summer and the autumn passed,
+and we had to bear our anxieties in patience through the
+winter, which was hard. Letters were written by one and
+another of the loyal lords and gentlemen asking the
+meaning of the delay, and begging the King for God’s sake
+to come speedily; but little satisfaction did they get. At
+last, in the Spring, the French King ordered the expedition
+to sail from Dunkirk, but even then there arose confusion
+and many difficulties, owing, it was said, to dissensions
+between the ministers of War and Marine. The expedition
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_69">[69]</span>
+was under command of the Comte de Forbin, an Admiral
+of skill and discretion, and into his careful charge the
+young King was delivered with all ceremony by the King
+of France. But if his own story is to be believed, and he
+hath spoken often with my brother of Alva on the matter,
+he had no great faith in his mission, nor in the sincerity of
+those who pretended to further it.”</p>
+
+<p>“What mean you by that, madam?” I asked.</p>
+
+<p>“Listen, my dear, and you shall hear. I suppose it is
+difficult for you, Barbara, to understand my heat and interest
+in this subject, but you have not been through it all as I was;
+you did not see and feel the fears and hopes, the sickening
+anxieties, the impatience and despair, and finally the wild
+and joyful exultation, when we heard that at last our young
+King was about to land on Scottish shores. My lord was
+kept supplied with the latest news by our good friend, Mr.
+Straton, in Edinburgh, who still works faithfully for the
+Cause, and you may be sure that, had the King landed, as
+was expected, close to our doors, my father would have
+been one of the first to welcome him. And to think that
+he actually came almost in sight of them, only to be
+snatched away again by a cruel fate!”</p>
+
+<p>“I can but dimly remember,” I cried, “the French
+ships in the Forth, and the firing of the guns, and how
+Phemie told me one morning that the King was come to
+his own. But I heeded it little at the time, being much
+taken up with a new puppy that Robert Guthrie had
+brought for me the day before, and after that it slipped
+from my mind and nothing occurred to bring it back again.
+I think shame now to be so ignorant and indifferent.”</p>
+
+<p>“Nay,” said Betty, “you were but a child, and Colonel
+Stewart was a discreet man. Indeed we were so much
+wounded and disappointed in our hearts that we spoke
+but little on the subject for years.”</p>
+
+<p>“But tell me more of the expedition, I beg, and why it
+failed and disappointed everybody,” said I.</p>
+
+<p>“Well, they set sail from France, in spite of stormy
+weather, and by God’s good Providence they eluded the
+English Fleet which was cruising about on the watch for
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_70">[70]</span>
+them, and sailing before a favourable wind they overreached
+their mark, for instead of making the entrance of
+the Frith, they found themselves on the fourth day off the
+coast of Scotland opposite to Montrose. They immediately
+put about and endeavoured to enter the river, but meeting
+with contrary wind and tide, they were obliged to anchor
+out yonder, Barbara, near the Isle of May. In the meantime,
+as soon as the Fleet had been pronounced ready to
+sail, the King had dispatched from France a trusty
+messenger in the person of Mr. Charles Fleming, brother
+to the Earl of Wigton, to prepare us for his arrival. He
+landed in Aberdeenshire at the house of the Earl of Errol,
+who, upon receiving the King’s instructions, instantly sent
+off a messenger to our good neighbour, Mr. Malcolm of
+Grange, who was to have a boat and pilots ready to go on
+board the first vessel that should give the signal—five shots
+was what had been agreed upon—after entering the Frith.
+This indeed we did, but before any use could be made of
+his directions, the sound of the firing of cannon came from
+the South, and Sir George Byng with the English ships of
+war was upon them. Admiral Forbin, with his precious
+charge on board, thought only of saving him and the
+treasure, and with some difficulty he escaped capture,
+returning to Dunkirk with the loss of but one vessel, the
+<i>Salisbury</i>, which after three hours’ engagement with the
+English, struck her colours.”</p>
+
+<p>“And what happened then?” cried I, eagerly.</p>
+
+<p>“Ah! then we fell into great depression. Many noblemen
+and gentlemen who had mounted their horses so gaily to ride
+to Edinburgh to receive the King, turned their faces sadly
+home again. From universal joy the town passed to distraction.
+Consternation reigned in many hearts, for none
+knew what the Government might do in revenge. As a
+matter of fact, many of these gentlemen, my dear father
+among them, were clapped into prison, and there remained
+for some weary months. But I believe they felt that less
+than the humiliation of their Cause and the disappointment
+of all their hopes, for these had risen very high, and our
+hearts had been full of exultation.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_71">[71]</span></p>
+
+<p>We sat for some time watching the fair evening light
+settle down over the scene. The sun was setting far away
+behind the Highland hills, but the soft reflections tinged
+the opposite coast, and veiled the distance in a golden
+mist. The sea-birds were still crying up and down in
+front of us; the sound of the waves had grown fainter with
+the out-going tide.</p>
+
+<p>The lovely picture pleased only my outward eye to-night,
+for I was thinking deeply of the tale out of the past that I
+had just heard from my companion. Some tone in her
+voice, more earnest than her wont, proved to me without
+doubt how deeply she had been stirred at the remembrance;
+and I knew that this pure loyalty was in her heart’s blood,
+and that her love for the exiled King would leave her only
+with life.</p>
+
+<p>“But, Betty,” I ventured at last, very softly lest I should
+disturb her brooding thoughts, “why did they not land the
+King at Montrose when there were no English ships in
+pursuit? Would it not have been better to come ashore
+anywhere, seeing the county was expecting them and only
+too glad to welcome them? I think Mr. de Forbin was a
+very foolish person.”</p>
+
+<p>Betty laughed heartily, and turned an approving glance
+upon me.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, little Barbara, you are asking the very questions
+that our disappointed lords and gentlemen asked themselves
+and others, and to which no answers have ever been
+given. The conclusion the wisest of them—my father being
+among them—came to was this: that King Louis had no
+mind at that time to allow the King to land in Scotland,
+but if the attempt raised an insurrection in this country,
+and recalled the Duke of Marlborough and some of his
+army from fighting against the French, it would serve
+Louis pretty well. It did not even do that, as you have
+seen; it only served to pain and humiliate some loyal and
+faithful people.”</p>
+
+<p>“I fear King Louis is not a friend to trust to,” cried I,
+with youthful impulsiveness.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, do not say that now, child,” cried Betty, “lest it
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_72">[72]</span>
+be an omen of evil. It is to his help and succour we are
+looking at this present moment, when we are again on the
+tip-toe of expectation. Ah! Barbara, if it fails this time I
+think our hearts will break. None but God can tell what
+countless prayers are rising from thousands of hearts in
+Scotland every day, that the rightful King may be restored,
+and our land be at peace, and prosper as it has never
+done before. But alas! will the prayers avail us anything?
+We prayed earnestly enough seven years ago, but our
+petitions were not answered then.”</p>
+
+<p>“Perhaps the answer is but long delayed,” cried I, “and
+is now close at hand. The King is seven years older and
+seven years wiser; King George cannot be called our
+rightful sovereign, whatever Queen Anne may have been.
+Oh, indeed, the time seems more propitious now than
+ever, and I hope, I hope, Betty, that I may see something
+of the struggle. How excited I feel! You have filled me
+with enthusiasm and loyalty for King James.”</p>
+
+<p>“Hush! child,” said Betty rising, for it was time to go
+home, “’tis no matter for excitement, but very sober
+thoughts and much prudence are needed. As for me, I
+wish the Restoration might be made without the struggle at
+all. Sometimes I long to be a man, to scheme, and plan, and
+fight for the Cause; but even a woman can do something
+that may not be altogether despised.”</p>
+
+<p>When we had climbed the rocky path that led from the
+shore to the grounds round the house, she turned and
+looked away across the Frith, and kissed her hand towards
+the south with a pretty gesture.</p>
+
+<p>“Come quickly, my King!” she cried, softly. “Come
+quickly, and be wise! There are no hearts in all the
+world so true as Scottish hearts, no memories so faithful to
+the past, no love so tender! Come soon, my King, and
+prove them!”</p>
+
+<p>And though she spoke the words with a little laugh, I
+saw that there were tears in her eyes.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_73">[73]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_IX">
+ CHAPTER IX
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>WE HAVE NEWS OF THE KING’S COMING</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>It pleased me to meet again at Dysart, Mistress Betty’s
+grave admirer, Mr. David Pitcairn, for that such he was I
+never hesitated in my mind to believe. I found that he
+was the nephew and adopted son of the worthy minister of
+the First Charge of Dysart (for there were then, as now,
+two churches in that place), who bore the same name.
+The elder Mr. Pitcairn was a man of great piety and
+learning, of most amiable character and uncommonly
+gentle manners. (I speak of him in the past tense, but I
+understand he is still living, though something over fourscore
+years of age.) He had previously been chaplain in
+Colonel Preston’s regiment, of which his elder brother was
+at one time an officer; and the latter being killed in action
+and leaving behind him a young widow and only son, the
+good gentleman had watched over them with tender
+kindness, and upon the death of the lady, ten years later,
+he made the orphan boy his own. Upon his being
+presented with the living by my Lord Sinclair, his nephew
+being then at the University of Edinburgh, his kind patron
+promised that when his education was completed the
+young man should have a post with him as overseer, or
+manager, of the workmen engaged in his lordship’s coal-pits
+and salt-pans round Dysart. This post he had now
+held for over five years, and living at the manse with his
+uncle, he had many opportunities of increasing his admiration
+for the fair Mistress Elizabeth. By her he was
+treated in a half familiar, half-cavalier manner, which aggravated
+even while it checked his ardour, and watching them
+both with bright, youthful eyes, I decided that love and
+liking were unequally armed for defence.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_74">[74]</span></p>
+
+<p>One morning we had ridden towards Kirkcaldy, Betty
+having ordered Mr. Pitcairn to meet us thereabouts, and
+accompany us on our promenade. Just outside the town
+we halted to wait for him, and turning our horses’ heads
+towards the sea, she was pointing to the view of the opposite
+coast. Hearing a horse’s feet on the stones behind us, she
+cried over her shoulder, without looking round: “At last,
+David! You did not expect to find us here before you.”</p>
+
+<p>“Faith, no indeed, Mistress Betty!” a strange voice
+replied, “nor did I look for so friendly a greeting from
+your High Mightiness.”</p>
+
+<p>At the first word Betty had turned with a great start, and
+the colour mounting to her face as I had never seen it. A
+very gallant and handsome gentleman, somewhat past his first
+youth, sat on horseback facing us with his hat in his hand,
+and a smile of very pleasant humour in his eyes. His long
+brown curls hung about a face of which the features still
+retained much beauty, and the voice with which he spoke
+had in it the rich tones of a kind and hearty nature. My
+poor Betty looked more taken aback than ever I had seen
+her, and she even faltered as she answered.</p>
+
+<p>“Indeed, my lord, the address was not meant for you,
+as your lordship very well knows, seeing I did not suppose
+you to be within four hundred miles of me. What brings
+your lordship so early into Fife?”</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, Mistress Bess, why will you use this haughty tone
+with me?” said the gentleman, very mildly. “You do
+yourself injustice, believe me, ever to let yourself be seen
+in so shrewd a character. But will you not present me to
+your fair companion?” he continued, turning to me with a
+smile. “Mayhap she will enlighten me as to the identity
+of the happy swain who bears my name, and has more than
+double my privileges.”</p>
+
+<p>“Mistress Barbara Stewart,” cried Betty, now a little
+recovered, “let me make you acquainted with the most
+noble the Earl of Wemyss, our next neighbour, the
+champion of the people, the upholder of all Whig principles,
+and the most devoted subject of his Hanoverian Majesty,
+King George.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_75">[75]</span></p>
+
+<p>The Earl acknowledged my bow with charming courtesy,
+but he turned to my sarcastic companion with a laugh full
+of goodnature.</p>
+
+<p>“What!” said he. “Still the old grievance? Still as
+staunch a Jacobite as ever—”</p>
+
+<p>But Betty interrupted him with a flash of fire in her eyes,
+and I did not wonder at the admiration which was plain to
+be seen in his own.</p>
+
+<p>“As staunch a <i>loyalist</i>—yes!” she cried, “and ever
+will be, my lord. But upon that subject we shall never
+agree. There is but one rightful King, just as there is but
+one God, and if you say otherwise you are deceiving yourself
+for the sake of your political ambitions. You can afford to
+laugh and jeer to-day, but wait, my lord, only wait! Is
+there not a word in the Scripture that saith, ‘Woe unto
+you that laugh now, for ye shall mourn and weep!’”</p>
+
+<p>Utterly taken aback by her vehemence, I sat still on my
+horse gazing at her heated face, and in much uneasiness as
+to how his lordship would take her rudeness. He was
+looking at her gravely but very kindly, while the naughty
+creature stormed and scolded like a common wife in the
+fish-market. And yet that is a coarse and untrue simile;
+for Mistress Betty Sinclair, even in her anger, spoke like a
+high-born lady, and ’twas but the fervour of her warm, true
+heart that made her words at once so free and so trenchant.</p>
+
+<p>The Earl moved his horse a step or two nearer, and, still
+uncovered, answered her gently.</p>
+
+<p>“If I tried to tell you how much I admire your loyal
+and faithful affection to that unfortunate house, Mistress
+Betty, you would but tell me I was mocking at you; and
+yet, believe me, no man could see and hear you and
+remain unmoved. Would to God I could think as you do
+upon the matter, for otherwise I fear you will never permit
+me to enjoy your friendship, though you know, I think,
+how much I desire it. But I have taken my stand upon the
+other side, and even you would not desire me to turn
+traitor.”</p>
+
+<p>I admired his brave and temperate words, and already he
+seemed to me a very perfect and chivalrous gentleman,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_76">[76]</span>
+but Betty tossed her head and turned her burning face
+away.</p>
+
+<p>“Why do you continually torment me?” she cried
+petulantly. “Why are you so sure that you are right?
+The day will come, and that speedily, when you may
+indeed want my friendship, and that of all the King’s
+faithful subjects, to put you right with His Majesty. Then,
+perhaps, you will find it easy to take the other side, my
+lord!”</p>
+
+<p>“Ah, Betty, Betty!” he cried, “why will you talk of
+such folly? King George is firm on the British throne,
+where the will of the people has placed him. The
+Chevalier de St. George had better remain where he is, for
+any attempt to dislodge the King will only prove disastrous
+to us all.”</p>
+
+<p>She fired up again.</p>
+
+<p>“The Elector of Hanover hath scarce had time to settle
+himself very comfortably on his stolen throne,” she
+answered, in a contemptuous tone, “and King James has
+more chance of regaining it than some may think. But,
+to be sure, my lord, ’tis not likely that you should believe
+this. You take no interest in our affairs, and ’tis as well
+that you should not.”</p>
+
+<p>And suddenly her own sunny smile broke through the
+clouds of petulance that had transformed her, and wheeling
+her horse beside that of the earl, she announced her
+intention of accompanying him along the road to Wemyss.</p>
+
+<p>“As for that lazy David,” she cried, “he does not
+deserve that we should wait for him!”</p>
+
+<p>Just at that moment Mr. Pitcairn joined us from a crossroad,
+and I judged he had some news to tell us, so eager
+was the expression of his face. He looked surprised at
+sight of his lordship, but greeted him very frankly and with
+great respect; and so we turned and rode back the way
+that we had come, Betty riding between the gentlemen,
+and chatting lightly in her wonted manner.</p>
+
+<p>Whatever had been the words upon David Pitcairn’s lips
+when he met us, it was plain they were not to be spoken
+in the present company. I noticed that he ever tried to
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_77">[77]</span>
+meet Betty’s eye, and though that in itself was nothing out
+of the common, yet there was in his countenance and
+manner a sort of suppressed excitement which convinced
+me that something unusual was afoot. Whatever it was,
+it was evident he did not desire to rouse the curiosity of
+my Lord Wemyss, for he conversed with him quietly on
+commonplace topics, and presently fell silent to listen to
+Betty’s discourse.</p>
+
+<p>As for me, although I was not discourteously left out of
+the conversation, I was too busy with my own speculations
+about this new actor on the scene to care whether they
+addressed me or no. I tried to recollect all I had heard
+concerning the Earl of Wemyss, and I was bound to
+confess he presented a more gallant and interesting figure
+than I had expected. I knew that he was a widower for
+the second time, and the father of two tall lads, as fine and
+promising as any in Scotland. But hearing this, I had
+settled in my mind that he was old and dull, most likely
+grave and sad, as would become a man who had been
+twice bereft of the wife of his bosom—so ran my childish
+thought; yet here he was, scarce older in appearance than
+David Pitcairn, as brave and handsome a knight as the
+most exacting maiden could desire, riding in the sunshine
+by the side of a lady who, for all her merry speeches, had
+been ready enough to flout him when first he startled her
+by appearing at her side.</p>
+
+<p>I stole a look at his face, and was bound to confess to
+myself that if sorrow had left its traces there they did but
+add to the attractiveness of his beauty. No man of heart,
+I knew, could have come through the great tragedy of his
+lordship’s early years, and remain untouched to sympathy
+and tenderness. As often as I had heard the tale of the
+young Countess’s death, my heart had thrilled in pity for
+her husband’s agony of suffering. You have no doubt
+been told ere now of how that lady, gentle, lovely, and
+pious, retired to her praying-closet one evening to engage
+in private devotion; of how her dress caught fire at the
+candle while she was on her knees; and how, before help
+could reach her, she was so terribly burned that, though
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_78">[78]</span>
+she lingered in great pain for some days, those who loved
+her best gave thanks aloud when they saw her eyes close in
+death. To be young, beautiful, and happy, adored by a
+tender husband, and the mother of two lovely babes, and
+yet to be torn from a life so bright by an accident so
+brutal, did it not require the fortitude of a good Christian
+to enable the young Earl to retain his reason when he
+remembered that this was the fate of the being he loved?
+Nothing, I think, but supreme faith in the Divine wisdom
+and love, which can somehow turn our cruellest sorrows
+into blessings, could have sustained any man under a trial
+so crushing. Yes, I felt certain my Lord of Wemyss was a
+good man, whatever Betty might think of his political
+errors, and deserved all the happiness that yet remained to
+him in life. Of his second Countess, an English lady from
+Northampton, I knew but little, save that, having no
+children of her own, she lavished all her tenderness on her
+husband’s little sons, bringing them up with such wisdom
+and kindness that they were regarded with admiration and
+delight by all who knew them.</p>
+
+<p>These thoughts and many more passed through my
+mind as we rode slowly along towards Wemyss Castle that
+bright May morning, but suddenly, when we were half-way
+between that place and Dysart, Mistress Bess took another
+whim, and pulling up abruptly, she bade his lordship good-morning,
+saying that she believed her father had need of
+her.</p>
+
+<p>Now, luckily for himself, the Earl appeared to have an
+abounding sense of humour and a vast amount of good
+temper to back it; for after the first moment, when a flicker
+of surprise crossed his face, he answered with placid
+courtesy the capricious young lady’s salute, adding, with a
+twinkle in his eyes which he did not try to conceal,</p>
+
+<p>“Ah, Mistress Betty, it is not every father who is so
+blest in his daughters as my Lord Sinclair.”</p>
+
+<p>Again the hot colour famed up in Betty’s cheeks, for the
+tone of his lordship’s address was unmistakable; but for
+once she had no words to answer him. Instead, she
+waved her hand as carelessly as she might, and turning
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_79">[79]</span>
+round, urged her horse to a gallop, so that Mr. Pitcairn
+and I had some ado to catch her up. As soon as we
+were abreast, the gentleman began in a hurried way,
+“Mistress Betty, I have news!” Betty turned to him
+quickly.</p>
+
+<p>“David! News—of him? Are they good or bad?”</p>
+
+<p>He bent his head. “He has left Bar-le-duc, and was
+on his way to the coast when the messenger left St. Malo.”</p>
+
+<p>“Where got you the news?”</p>
+
+<p>“From Mr. Malcome who crossed last night to Burntisland,
+he having spent some hours in Edinburgh with Mr. Harry
+Straton.”</p>
+
+<p>Betty drew a long breath; she had grown quite pale.</p>
+
+<p>“God save the King!” she cried softly “Oh, David,
+Barbara, to think that in a day or two he may be with us.
+Does it not seem too good to be true?”</p>
+
+<p>Then, turning in her saddle and shaking her whip in the
+direction of Castle Wemyss, she cried, exultingly,
+“So, my lord! I was talking folly just now, was I?
+King George is fixed without fear of dislodgment on the
+British throne; the Chevalier must stay where he is. Ah
+ha! we shall see. Oh, I did not dream when we set out
+this morning, Barbara, how joyfully we should return home.
+Let us hasten to bring the good news to my lord and
+Catherine.”</p>
+
+<p>That night, as my little diary reminds me, there was a
+supper-party held at the Hermitage where many of the
+neighbouring gentlemen (of whom I recollect the names of
+three or four: Mr. Malcome of Grange, Mr. Bethune, the
+Laird of Balfour, Harry Balfour of Dunbog, brother to the
+Lord Burleigh, and the Laird of Orrock, a gentleman of
+old though inconsiderable family, and a stanch supporter
+at all times of the Master of Sinclair) met round my Lord
+Sinclair’s table and discussed the news from France. The
+Reverend Mr. Pitcairn was there, grave and courteous as
+was his wont, taking no part in the discussion, but making
+his presence felt when any wise advice was needed. His
+nephew David was my partner, but I cannot remember
+that he had time to address to me one word, for Betty sat
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_80">[80]</span>
+opposite us, and her eyes, shining like stars, were bright
+enough to attract any man’s attention. The Master of
+Sinclair, more urbane than I had seen him, spoke much and
+with an air of authority, which, from his having seen service
+with the Duke of Marlborough, was allowed to him as his
+right. So far as we ladies could judge from the effect of
+his speeches on the other gentlemen, he seemed to have a
+certain military sense and knowledge, which was not unappreciated
+by them; and as for my dear Betty, she hung
+upon his words with affectionate admiration and regard.</p>
+
+<p>“’Tis hoped the King himself will land in Scotland,
+while the Duke of Ormond raises the West of England,”
+said Mr. Balfour.</p>
+
+<p>“I would rather, were it possible,” observed the Master,
+“that the Duke of Berwick headed the expedition. Let him
+land where he will, the young King is all unproved, and
+though his courage is well-known, his military skill would
+not advantage us much.”</p>
+
+<p>“Whoever may lead the affair,” said my lord, gravely,
+“let us be ready to receive them. The fault this time
+must not lie with us, and if the rising be but sufficiently
+advertised, I have little fear of the result.”</p>
+
+<p>“We mean to do our best in Fife, sir,” said his son,
+stoutly.</p>
+
+<p>“All Fife is ready to mount, my lord,” cried Mr.
+Malcome. “They do but need the assurance that the
+affair is genuine to bring them flocking to the King’s
+Standard.”</p>
+
+<p>“Perth likewise,” cried another, “and the Mearns and
+Aberdeen. As for the Clans, save the Laird of Grant with
+some thousand men, and the Laird of MacLeod, who is a
+young lad and not to be counted on, there is not a
+chieftain in the Highlands that is not against the present
+Government.”</p>
+
+<p>“All they want is a leader,” said Mr. Pitcairn,
+thoughtfully. “Courage, loyalty, self-sacrifice, these are
+there in plenty, but all may be useless for lack of the
+personal influence to weld them into the force that makes
+for victory.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_81">[81]</span></p>
+
+<p>“The Duke of Berwick would do it,” broke in the
+Master’s voice, “and I know not another who would. But,
+gentlemen, one part is clear before us: men, horse, arms
+and ammunition are all wanted, and cannot be got together
+at a day’s notice. Let us set about our preparations
+to-morrow, more especially with regard to providing the
+beasts, that whoever come among us we may have nothing
+to reproach ourselves withal.”</p>
+
+<p>This sentiment met with general acclamation, for the
+company was now in the mood to agree to anything that
+was proposed, and before a later stage was reached, which
+might prove a more disputatious one, my lady thought it
+well that we should withdraw.</p>
+
+<p>Before we departed, however, they insisted that we fill
+our glasses once more to honour the toast which Mr.
+Harry Balfour in a witty speech gave us.</p>
+
+<p>“Long life and success to the King!” he ended up
+gaily, raising his glass on high. “And dire confusion to
+all his enemies.”</p>
+
+<p>And I think I was the only one to notice how Betty
+drank but to the first part of that toast. As the second
+clause was added she gave a furtive glance at the speaker,
+and perceiving that no one regarded her, she softly replaced
+her glass upon the table.</p>
+
+<p>Now all that I have written about this one day might
+lead you to imagine that ’twas the beginning of great events,
+but alas! it is only given as an example of the many false
+hopes that were raised in us, and the many disappointments
+that ensued. In the words of Mistress Betty that morning,
+though she little meant them to express the truth, the news
+were “too good to be true.” The message was a false one;
+the King had not left France, and many weeks and months
+were to elapse before he landed upon Scottish shores.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_82">[82]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_X">
+ CHAPTER X
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>WE BECOME STILL MORE INVOLVED IN AFFAIRS</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>My Lady Erskine was by this time mighty anxious to be
+back at Alva, not only for the sake of her children, from
+whom she could never bear to be long parted, but also
+because she was in expectation soon to be welcoming home
+Sir John from London. Yielding to the request of Betty,
+that I should be left at Dysart still some weeks, she took
+her leave of us, intending first to visit her sister; Margaret,
+my Lady Baird, in her home at Newbyth, and also to pass
+some days with the family of Sir Peter Wedderburn at
+Gosford House. I think I cannot do better than transcribe
+here two of the letters which she wrote to her husband on
+her return home. They are full of domestic concerns, and
+of but little interest to a stranger, but they are loving and
+dutiful as my lady herself ever was, and show in some
+degree the cheerful, diligent spirit she commonly displayed.</p>
+
+<figure class="figcenter illowp50" id="i_83" style="max-width: 62.5em;">
+ <img class="w100" src="images/i_83.jpg" alt="">
+ <figcaption>
+ <p class='right normal'><i>From an Oil Painting.</i></p>
+ LADY ERSKINE OF ALVA.
+ </figcaption>
+</figure>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER I.</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>
+ “<span class="smcap">My Dearest</span>,
+</p>
+
+<p class='letter-indent'>I cannot omitt writting every post tho’ I
+have but little to say, except tell you thatt I begin now to be
+mighty impatient to have you home. All the members of
+Parlyment that I know I think is come already, and yett there
+is no word of your leaveing London. Doe nott think I blame
+you in saying so for I make no doubt of your coming as soon
+as ye can. Ye had need of a good coachman if ye travell with
+four horse wanting a postilion. Your folks are busy att the
+walks, butt since I came home, I find itt convenient to have
+seven carts going and eighteen men, and will continue that
+number if possible till itt’s ended. There is such a deepness of
+earth thatt itt is no easy work.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_83">[83]</span></p>
+
+<p>I told you in my last I was going to Stirling. Your uncle
+looks very well. He is surprised at your stay and longs to see
+you. I presst Lady Jean and Lordy Areskine to come to Alva
+some days, and the Colonel, butt they seemed to be so uncertain
+of their setting out for London, they could not leave
+Stirling. You desire to know what the Col. says about
+Meg’s marriage. He told me he wisht her all happyness, and
+he thought Sir Wm. had been very lucky, and he wondered
+my lord did not ask better terms. Sir Wm. said to me he
+was sure you wold not goe close by his door, and not come in,
+and they design to intercept you at Gosford if they can. Butt
+if I am to meet you at Edinr. if ye please so to order itt,
+I will do itt att Gosford, but if ye can come straight to Alva, I
+do not incline to stir from itt. Your sons are perfectly well
+and are my only comrads now. Dearest life, adieu.”</p>
+
+<p>
+ <span class="smcap">Alva</span>, <i>June 13</i>.
+</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>In the next letter, as you will see, there is a veiled allusion
+to the project on which all our thoughts were fixed,
+and the uncertainty of which had already caused its
+partisans much uneasiness. It is impossible now to
+imagine what little breath of dissension had blown between
+my lady and her kind brother, Mr. Charles Erskine, but
+sure I am that the words set down in some mood of passing
+vexation were never meant to be preserved or remembered.
+How often and how eagerly my lady turned to Mr. Erskine
+for help and advice in the sad days when she was “so
+unhappy as to want” her husband, and how willingly and
+kindly he spent himself in service for her and hers, you
+will see presently in her later letters.</p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER II.</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>
+ “<span class="smcap">My Dearest Life</span>,
+</p>
+
+<p class='letter-indent-plus'>I did not writ last post in hope I
+wold gett one from you forbidding mee to writ, but I got one
+of a different nature telling me ye was just goeing to my Lord
+Mar’s country house, which made me very thoughtful some
+hours after; that ye seem’d to have no guess when ye wold take
+your journey. I regrate your uneasyness of being obliged to
+wait so long upon what it seems is very uncertain, and I begin
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_84">[84]</span>
+now to fear will hardly be worth your while. I doe now wish
+you at home att anyrate.</p>
+
+<p>The black cattell is giving a great price here just now. The
+man that brought your stots was here yesterday inquiring if ye
+was for any this year. They held so well out att Aikenside last
+year he made no doubt ye wold take more. I know not what
+number ye wold incline to, so lett me know as soon as ye can.
+I am in uncertainty whether to buy cows for killing, and we’ll
+be sure to buy them dear att the end of the year if we want
+them. My being so undetermined will make things of that
+kind mighty uneasy to me, butt I cannott help itt.</p>
+
+<p>Your brother Charles has now been a fortnight in Edinr.,
+and tho’ I writ to him to send mee your letter he wold not doe
+itt, nor any reason for not doeing itt. I could hardly believe
+Charles wold have been so indifferent of mee for I am sure I
+never gave him any reason; but when he behaves after that
+manner comeing from you, I see what I might expect if ever I
+were so unhappy (as) to want you, which I hope in God will
+never bee.</p>
+
+<p>I am afraid all the sheep mercats will be over before I gett
+any account from you whether ye are to buy or not. The
+sheep is dear this year, they talk. I have sent your Gelding
+this day to Perth Fair, and bid them take ten Guineys for him
+before they bring him home. I was advised to doe so by
+people that understand horse, and had seen him at Edinr.
+He never look’t so well as he does att this moment, butt there
+is no help, part with him ye must, for he will never bee of use.</p>
+
+<p>I send you a letter from Gleneaglis. I am glad to hear
+from my sister. She has a letter from your Brother Robin.</p>
+
+<p>I am still fighting with John Harley and Mr Rose, to
+keep folks at the walks, butt I no sooner turn my back, or
+has anybody here I am oblig’d to wait on, butt something
+is done in opposition. The narrow walk has all the earth
+laid thatt itt wants, and the brode walk is pretty well advanc’d,
+butt the earth that was on the walks will not serve to make
+them up at the other end. Your turnip seed is come, and
+I will write to Monzie and get my directions how to use it.
+Dearest life, adieu. Your sons are well.</p>
+
+<p class='right pr2'>Yours.”</p>
+<p><span class="smcap">Alva</span>, <i>June 25</i>.
+</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>As I read the clear faint writing I can see her sitting
+in the room at Alva at her own scrutoire, the sweet scents
+and sounds of summer coming in at the open windows,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_85">[85]</span>
+and a smile on her face while writing, as she thinks
+how soon might she be seeing the knight’s stalwart form
+and kindly face, and listening to the voice she loved.
+Alas! almost before the summer flowers were dead my
+lady had ceased to smile, and for many and many a
+weary month all thoughts of her husband were mingled
+with anxiety, grief, and dread.</p>
+
+<p>It was about the middle of July when Sir John came
+home, and although his wife received him with her wonted
+tender welcome, and the little boys made his appearance
+the occasion of much joyful outcry, it was evident from
+the first that his mind was preoccupied, and he scarce
+gave his usual genial attention to home matters. For
+some days he was busy and hurried in his movements,
+riding often from home, and when in the house, being
+closeted with Mr. Peck, his secretary. The neighbours
+came and went even more than before, but now it was only
+the men who rode hastily to the door, spent a private
+hour with Sir John in his own room, and rode away
+again with scarce more than a civil word to my lady
+and myself. There was no merry-making when they
+met, no pledging each other with jest and laughter, no
+toasts called for. If they took a stirrup-cup at parting,
+twas drunk for the most part in silence, while a meaning
+glance passed from eye to eye, that in some way stirred
+my girlish heart to deep excitement. I was left much
+to myself and to the children in those days, for my
+lady went about with a serious face, attending on her
+lord, upon whom I saw her cast many a wistful look,
+but refusing to answer my questions when I would have
+asked her what was toward.</p>
+
+<p>At last one evening—I remember it well—we were
+seated at supper in the long twilight, when the sound
+of a galloping steed arrested our attention. The day
+had been sultry, and doors and windows stood open.
+Sir John laid down the knife with which he was carving
+and rose to his feet, looking across the table at his wife.
+My lady, with her eyes upon his face, turned pale though
+she uttered no word, and I, Barbara, forgetful of ceremony,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_86">[86]</span>
+and moved by the strange thrill that seemed to touch
+us all, ran to the window and leaned out. A man upon
+a smoking horse before the door was wiping his heated
+face with a napkin, and Andrew Short, Sir John’s faithful
+attendant, had just reached his side and was calling out
+for news. Too breathless to speak, the messenger drew
+from his breast a packet, and rolled, rather than dismounted,
+from his beast, which stood with panting sides
+and fore-legs outstretched, the picture of exhaustion. A
+stableman ran up and led him slowly away, and the rider,
+still staggering and breathing hard, came up the steps leaning
+on Andrew’s arm, the papers grasped in his hand.</p>
+
+<p>“’Tis a messenger, Sir John,” I cried, for all this had
+passed in a few moments. “He enters the house with
+Andrew; he bears a packet, doubtless for you.”</p>
+
+<p>The knight strode from the room and met the man
+in the hall who, seeing the master of the house, dropped
+upon one knee, and holding out the packet, muttered
+in a thick, hoarse voice—“From my Lord, the Earl of
+Mar, to the hands of Sir John Erskine of Alva. God save
+the King!”</p>
+
+<p>With this strange address delivered, ’twas evident that
+the poor man felt his task was accomplished, for he incontinently
+fell forward in a heap upon the floor, and
+lay in a kind of stupor.</p>
+
+<p>Having ascertained that the good fellow suffered from
+nothing but want of sleep, he having posted from London
+with the utmost speed, taking scarce any rest on the way,
+Sir John bade Andrew see to him, and calling upon Mr.
+Peck to follow him, he went into his room and shut and
+locked the door. I wrung my hands with impatience, for
+I would have given a good deal at that moment to be
+able to see through the walls, and as I turned I found my
+lady standing near. Her eyes also were fixed upon the
+closed door, and were full of a strange, unhappy light
+that set my heart aching. I went to her and laid my
+arm round her waist.</p>
+
+<p>“Dear madam!” I cried, “what is’t you fear? Will
+you not tell Barbara, who longs to comfort you?”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_87">[87]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Ah, little Barbara,” she answered, smiling sadly,
+“thou hast the will, but not the power to ease my heart.
+Something tells me that this,” and she glanced again at
+that baffling door, “is the beginning of sorrows, for
+whether we lose or win, my dear, there will be many tears
+shed and many hearts broken.”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, cousin!” I cried eagerly, “could I but see the
+despatch what would I not give! Do you not wish to
+be in Mr. Peck’s place, reading those all-important
+papers?”</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, my dear,” she said, quietly, “you must exercise
+patience as I do. The letter, whatever it contains is in
+cipher, and some time must pass before Sir John can get
+at its meaning. Mr. Peck and he may be closeted there
+till midnight, and after all, Barbara, there may be nothing
+that can be told to you or me.”</p>
+
+<p>“The King was landed, madam, I feel sure of it,
+and my Lord Mar is joining him at once. Oh, will he
+come to Alva, think you? I do so long to see him. If
+he visits with the Earl at Alloa he may indeed come here
+also. I wonder greatly what he is like, cousin?” I cried,</p>
+
+<p>“If you believe Sir John’s report, child, you will perhaps
+find the King different from your expectations of him.
+I will tell you what I have gathered. He is well favoured
+in face and figure, of staid and quiet demeanour, unselfish,
+gentle, and reasonable, but neither affable nor merry.
+That he is conscientious and kind-hearted I am convinced,
+but his life has been too full of misfortune for him ever
+to have accomplished his desires. He is a devoted and
+affectionate son, we know, and adored his young sister,
+the Princess Louisa—a gay and charming creature, whose
+death three years since he sorely mourned. With good
+councillors to aid him he will make a wise and tolerant
+Ruler, of that I have no doubt, and I pray God he be not
+led away by ill advice.”</p>
+
+<p>We went into the parlour and sat down together in
+the dim light. The business-room, or study, where Sir
+John was, being next to us, we could hear a faint murmur
+of voices through the wall, and gradually all other sounds
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_88">[88]</span>
+in the house ceased. My lady went on talking of the
+King in low tones, sometimes answering my questions,
+or telling me little anecdotes which she had heard and
+fondly remembered; for her husband being often in France,
+had met his Majesty more than once, besides hearing
+much concerning him from those who were continually
+about him. She spoke of his melancholy childhood, cast
+away in a foreign land; his elderly father, the poor exiled
+King, resigned to his fate and in ill-health; his mother, the
+Queen, devoted and patient, but perhaps not always wise;
+he, himself, now snubbed and restricted, now flattered
+and exalted, his hopes of restoration now raised to the
+highest pitch, and again laid low in the dust. Would it
+be strange, she asked, if the young man were indeterminate,
+timid, and depressed? For physical courage he certainly
+did not lack, as she reminded me how he charged repeatedly
+with his Cavalry in the battle of Malplaquet;
+and had it been left to his judgment, she thought the
+expedition under Admiral Forbin, in the year 1708, would
+not have been the failure it became.</p>
+
+<p>“I know it for a fact,” said my lady, “that his
+Majesty begged to be landed in Fife, in Aberdeen,
+anywhere, with but one attendant, as he would trust
+himself alone, he said, to the Scottish people; but he
+was not listened to. And yet I firmly believe that, had
+he come among us then in any guise, the country would
+have risen as one man, would have crowned him at
+Scone, and within a week he would have been dwelling
+as undisputed King in the Palace of Holyrood.”</p>
+
+<p>“That is what will happen now,” I cried eagerly.
+“Surely, oh surely, madam, this time he will succeed!”</p>
+
+<p>“Alas, Barbara, who can tell? It seems to me that
+in our party, for ten faithful men who have the King’s
+cause at heart, there are fifty to be found who care
+nothing for it, whose only thought is for power, or ease,
+or personal gain. They quarrel among themselves, they
+have jealousies that make their tempers childish; no
+man can trust his neighbour, and how can he then trust
+his country? If there were real love for the much wronged
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_89">[89]</span>
+Prince away there in France in each Scottish heart, were
+it but the size of a grain of mustard-seed, sure that love
+would bind the whole nation together, and make it so
+strong that we could rise in a great army and chase the
+Hanoverian out of England.”</p>
+
+<p>I made no reply, but I remembered her words afterwards,
+and have often considered them since, and in
+considering them have wondered; for many of the best
+and bravest in Scotland and England have thought as my
+lady did, and yet, good and true as they were and are,
+God has seen fit to give them no victory, but only
+disaster upon disaster, bringing to nought their loyal
+designs, and furthering the cause of those whom they
+distrusted.</p>
+
+<p>When we had sat for perhaps ten minutes silent, scarce
+seeing each other in the dusk, for it must have been
+close on ten of the clock, we heard the door of the
+business-room open, and next moment Sir John appeared
+in the room. My lady, who had started up, ran forward
+with a little cry, and he caught her in his arms.</p>
+
+<p>“Tell me, my life, what news?” she cried.</p>
+
+<p>“What, sweetheart, art not in bed?” he answered.
+“And all alone?” for me he did not see. Then he
+bent his head and whispered in her ear. She gave an
+exclamation, half-amazed, half-triumphant; but a moment
+after I heard a sob, and saw her lay her face upon his
+breast.</p>
+
+<p>So I stole away unheeded, and went to bed and to
+sleep with my curiosity still unsatisfied.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_90">[90]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XI">
+ CHAPTER XI
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>SIR JOHN PREPARES FOR ACTION, AND BARBARA
+ HEARS MANY STRANGE THINGS</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>Whatever tears bedewed the pillow of my dear Lady
+Erskine that night there was no sign of them in the
+morning. The household was early astir as usual, and
+at once the bustle of preparation seemed to spread from
+attic to cellar. Sir John was about to depart once more,
+and though I scanned my lady’s face for that look of
+foreboding and dissatisfaction that I expected to see, so
+well did she have her heart in control that no shadow of
+it appeared; indeed, there was an air of alertness about
+her manner of moving and speaking which took me by
+surprise. Instead of the fearful wife mourning over the
+prospect of her coming loneliness, there was the brave
+woman arming her husband, so to speak, for the battle,
+and sending him from her with words of cheer and glad
+prophecies of victory.</p>
+
+<p>At her request Sir John consented to make me a
+sharer of the news that had arrived the night before, and
+drawing me into his room he closed the door, and
+bidding me come close to him he said in a low voice,
+but with his wonted smile,</p>
+
+<p>“’Tis of vast importance, Barbara, this that we have
+heard. My Lord of Mar hath, only a few days back,
+got news from France; no less than a letter from the
+King, in which his Majesty tells him that for the sake of
+his honour he can no longer delay coming to Scotland.
+He will be at Dieppe the end of the month, a sennight
+from now, and the Rising, Barbara, the Rising is appointed
+for—nay, I will not name the exact date to you, child,
+but ’tis to be early in the coming month.”</p>
+
+<p>I held my breath and clasped my hands. “And will
+my Lord Mar fight?” I whispered.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_91">[91]</span></p>
+
+<p>“I wouldn’t be surprised,” said the knight with a laugh,
+“but he may be Commander-in-chief of the King’s army.”</p>
+
+<p>“Then you, Sir John, will be in the thick of it,” cried
+I. “Oh, for my lady’s sake, be good to yourself and
+go not in the front of the battle, cousin.”</p>
+
+<p>“Silly child!” he answered, and, indeed, I knew that I
+was silly ere ever the words were uttered. “Who thinks of
+dangers at a time like this? A man’s life is no more
+secure for hiding behind a hay-stack, which might catch
+fire at his back, when he ought to be facing the bullets.
+Depend on’t, we none of us die before our time, nor can
+we preserve our lives beyond it. ’Tis best not to take
+account of death, my lass, but to do our duty just
+where we find it.”</p>
+
+<p>The smile had left his face as he laid a kind hand on
+my shoulder, and for a moment my heart was so full that
+I found means to relieve it by an unuttered prayer for
+his safety. Then, not wishing to appear moved before
+him, I said, “Is the Duke of Ormond ready, too, sir?”</p>
+
+<p>I thought his face fell.</p>
+
+<p>“Of that I can scarce speak,” he said. “My lord is
+somewhat uncertain on this point; but I doubt not all
+will be right once they hear the King’s Standard is raised
+in the north.”</p>
+
+<p>And, Mr. Peck coming at that moment to the door,
+Sir John dismissed me hurriedly, though with his wonted
+kindness. I flew to my lady, and finding her calm and
+occupied in the contemplation of her husband’s hose,
+“Dear cousin,” I cried, “I know all; and now tell me
+what I can do, for I am dying of eagerness to help you.”</p>
+
+<p>“Then go,” she said at once, “and see about the
+making up of your mails, for Phemie is busy with the
+children’s things. We start for Dysart to-morrow.”</p>
+
+<p>At my exclamation of surprise she smiled. “You
+must know,” she went on, “that every year, in the month
+of August, I take my sons to their Grandfather’s house for
+the benefit of the sea-air and bathing. To our neighbours
+who are not with us our departure has, therefore, nothing
+out of the common; but to you I can say a little more.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_92">[92]</span>
+Sir John believes that the Earl of Mar will land in Fife.
+If he does, he will meet him there and perhaps follow him
+north, and, seeing that my Lord Sinclair is a man of some
+standing, and my brother in the midst of this affair, ’twill
+be easier for me to get news at the Hermitage than here
+at Alva. So he desires me to go there for a time and
+await the result of the Earl’s arrival; and, though I love
+best, when deserted, to be in my own house, Barbara,
+where every stone and tree speaks to me of Sir John,
+still, as it is his pleasure, I am glad to go. You will see
+Betty again, my dear, and that will content you also.”</p>
+
+<p>So, in little more than a month from leaving it, I
+found myself again at Dysart.</p>
+
+<p>In spite of our anxiety and excitement, which, with all
+our will, ’twas impossible to hide, the week that followed
+was a happy one. My Lady Erskine had her husband
+and children with her, and as she tenderly loved her father
+and sisters, she was in the midst of all that were dearest to
+her. Her brother, the Master, was for once in good
+humour and forebore to vex her by his sarcastic speeches
+to her husband. Indeed, Sir John and he were almost on
+friendly terms, for the knight, partly to please his dear
+lady, and partly, as I think, from a genuine appreciation
+of the younger man’s gifts, deferred to him as the eldest
+son of his host in a manner both courteous and kindly.
+It is true that in the last few weeks the conduct of the
+Master had gone far to establish his reputation for caution
+and diplomacy among his neighbours in the country. You
+must know that an order had come from Court to the
+sheriffs throughout England and Scotland that they should
+make search among the gentry, how many horses they had
+and if there were any signs of disaffection among them,
+their animals should be confiscated in the name of King
+George, as well as any arms found in their possession.
+I understand that the Master, with some difficulty, persuaded
+the zealous magistrate that this order could not
+apply to Fife, where all was quiet and orderly, but must be
+intended for England which was ever in a state of disturbance.
+He bade them look round upon his neighbours
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_93">[93]</span>
+and judge if they had among them all enough horses to
+form a troop, or indeed, any beasts fitted for war. No,
+he told them, nor had they even the proper saddles and
+bridles for fitting out Cavalry. It would be foolish, he
+warned them, to get themselves into disfavour by robbing
+poor, innocent gentlemen of their only means of getting
+about, and as for arms he could swear there were not two
+score of pistols in his corner of Fife.</p>
+
+<p>So skilful was his address, and so easy his manner, that
+for a time the good folk were persuaded to leave them in
+peace; but he suspected, as he told my lord, his father,
+that it could not be for long. All this Sir John Erskine
+knew and approved, and, indeed, he was generous enough
+to forget his brother-in-law’s ill-humours, and to take into
+consideration his military knowledge and real ability for
+management.</p>
+
+<p>But at last one night, early in the month of August, our
+tranquillity came to an end; and indeed, though we knew
+it not then, ’twas the end of all peace and happiness for
+many days to come.</p>
+
+<p>Sir John and my lady, the Master and Betty, were
+bidden to dinner to the house of Mr. Malcome of Grange;
+and his kind sister, Mistress Anne, seeing me at the
+Hermitage one day when she came to visit, and remembering
+my grandpapa and my parents, very cordially asked
+me to be of the party. The Master, who had business
+that day of a private nature some miles away, was late of
+arriving at the house, but late as he was our host was still
+later. Mistress Anne, having waited already for the guest,
+decided not to delay longer for the master, and telling us
+gaily that the dinner would be spoilt, not to talk of the
+cook’s temper, she made us sit down without him. I
+remember nothing about the meal except that when Mr.
+Malcome did arrive, which was not till we had been half-an-hour
+at table, he appeared to be in a very hilarious
+mood, and scarce eat anything, though he called for many
+toasts. His apologies for his discourtesy were vague
+though profuse, and he carried on his conversation in
+jerky phrases, quite unlike his wonted flowing style.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_94">[94]</span></p>
+
+<p>What was in the air, however, we did not discover till
+the feast was ended and most of the guests departed. As
+the party from Dysart were to lie that night at Grange,
+we alone remained, and were seated with Mistress Anne
+in the parlour, when her brother who had been seeing his
+guests away from the front door, entered the room,
+accompanied by Sir John and the Master of Sinclair.</p>
+
+<p>At once Mr. Malcome shut to the door, closed the
+shutters with their heavy iron bar, and extinguished some
+of the candles. Then beckoning to us ladies to come
+round him, he began to talk in a low voice.</p>
+
+<p>“Great news to-day, my friends! My lord, the Earl
+of Mar, is landed.”</p>
+
+<p>Sir John, my lady and myself were all eagerness at this,
+but showed no surprise. Mistress Malcome threw up her
+hands in amazement, Betty appeared puzzled, but the face
+of the Master grew as black as thunder.</p>
+
+<p>“My Lord of Mar?” he cried out harshly.</p>
+
+<p>“Just so!” continued Mr. Malcome, “he landed last
+night at Elie, not far from this very house, having come all
+the way from London, so he tells me, in a coal-barque. He
+was disguised as a common sailor, and wrought like one
+too, as the ship possessed but three seamen.”</p>
+
+<p>“What need of so much theatrical display?” interrupted
+the Master with a sneer.</p>
+
+<p>“To baffle our friends at Court,” was the reply, “where
+my lord took care to attend a levee the very night that
+he sailed.”</p>
+
+<p>“Does he come alone?” inquired Sir John.</p>
+
+<p>“He is accompanied by General Hamilton and Colonel
+Hay, also disguised, my lord travelling as Mr. Maule.
+’Twas cleverly arranged, and no mortal in London can as
+yet be aware of his movements. He has now gone to be
+with Bethune of Balfour, and from thence in a day or two
+he spurs north to Dupplin House.”</p>
+
+<p>“What means his coming, brother?” asked Mistress
+Malcome, still perplexed.</p>
+
+<p>“I will tell you, my dear; ’tis to pave the way for the
+coming of the Duke of Berwick—”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_95">[95]</span></p>
+
+<p>“The Duke of Berwick!” cried Betty, with sharp displeasure
+in her tones, “and why not the King?”</p>
+
+<p>“Because, Mistress Betty, it is not yet quite certain that
+the King may not have to go to England, and join with
+the Duke of Ormond there.”</p>
+
+<p>“Is England ready also?” asked my lady.</p>
+
+<p>“Yes, madam, and so is France. King Louis, as you
+know, is eager to help us. He hath promised us ten
+thousand men, of whose landing either in England or
+Scotland we may hear any day, with great store of arms
+and ammunition.”</p>
+
+<p>Darker and darker grew the Master’s face as he listened,
+and now he burst forth in his harshest and most scornful
+tones:</p>
+
+<p>“And pray, what hath my Lord of Mar to do with all
+this? Is it to be supposed that he who hath thrown
+himself under the feet of the Elector of Hanover, only to
+be kicked away as he deserved, will be trusted as a leader
+by the leal gentlemen of Fife? I wonder to hear you, sir,
+speak thus complacently of a man of my lord’s temper,
+upon whom no reliance can be placed! Did he not
+betray us over the Union, and will he not do it again?”</p>
+
+<p>This speech had the effect of altering the aspect of the
+company as may well be imagined. My lady and our
+kind hostess looked alarmed; Sir John turned to the
+Master and bade him curtly be silent, in a tone I had
+never heard him use before; Betty jumped up, and running
+to her brother put her white arm round his neck, and
+begged him for her sake to have patience. Mr. Malcome
+seemed uncomfortable, as well he might, while as for
+myself, Barbara, I sat entranced, absorbed and interested
+as if I were beholding some drama that was being enacted
+before my eyes.</p>
+
+<p>At length Mr. Malcome answered soothingly:</p>
+
+<p>“I believe that there is no reason to doubt the Earl’s
+good faith seeing he is prepared to give himself wholly for
+the Cause. As for the Union, I spoke of that to his
+lordship, and he owned very frankly that he had been in
+the wrong to do what he did, but that he hoped by his
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_96">[96]</span>
+future conduct to make amends to Scotland and to us,
+and in trusting him we should never repent it.”</p>
+
+<p>“Repent!” snarled the master, “and if we were ever
+such fools as to trust such a man, think you that repenting
+afterwards would retrieve it?”</p>
+
+<p>Again the other attempted to pacify him.</p>
+
+<p>“I have told him, my dear Master, of the daily fears
+we have been in, and of the struggle you have had to keep
+our horses; but I said also that the danger could not be
+staved off much longer.”</p>
+
+<p>“And what said he to that?” asked Sir John, who
+during the interview had spoken little, as one who scarce
+needed information on the subject in hand. “What said
+he to that?”</p>
+
+<p>“He said,” replied Mr. Malcome, “and I scarce know
+how to take it, ‘whenever they are pressed let them draw
+together and defend themselves.’”</p>
+
+<p>For a few moments there was dead silence and then the
+Master spoke, this time in a voice of icy coldness that had
+the sound of a sneer all through it. ’Twas this voice that
+so oft enraged and exasperated his brother, Sir John, and
+hearing it I justified my dear guardian for any expression of
+anger he had ever used towards Captain Sinclair.</p>
+
+<p>“Truly, we ought to thank my Lord of Mar for this
+precious piece of advice, for as such,” he said, “I regard it,
+seeing that in prospect of the coming of the Duke of
+Berwick, the Earl can scarcely consider himself in a
+position to <i>issue orders</i>. But I, for one, decline to take it.
+What! can it be imagined that the gentlemen of Fife are so
+rash and foolish as to gather themselves together like rats in
+a corn-yard, with the prospect of being worried by the
+terriers? Consider, sir, the facts that we already know.
+The Government are sending my Lord Duke of Argyle with
+his dragoons to Stirling, which alas! is but a few miles
+away. We hear that the Whig magistrates and burghers of
+Perth have made themselves masters of that town. Consequently,
+as they hold the Bridge of Earn, which is our only
+passage out of Fife, what is easier than to keep us
+prisoners here! My Lord Rothes, our worthy Sheriff, has
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_97">[97]</span>
+armed the whole mob of the county, who could readily
+surround and take us, or if fortune favoured us so far as to
+let us escape, who could assure us of a refuge in the
+Highlands? Which of us would be bold enough to make
+our way through the Athole Country, whose Duke would
+have vast pleasure in seizing us and delivering us up to
+the Government?”</p>
+
+<p>But Sir John could keep silence no longer, and his full
+mellow voice fell like balm upon my ears, now aching from
+the Master’s grating tones.</p>
+
+<p>“The Master of Sinclair,” he said, “knows me too well
+to imagine that I could for a moment call in question his
+courage or his honour; but it seems to me that thus to
+conjure up so many difficulties, where in fact there are none,
+is scarce the act of a brave and experienced officer.”</p>
+
+<p>“No difficulties?” cried out the master. “Call you the
+want of arms nothing?”</p>
+
+<p>“But arms are coming from France,” persisted Mr.
+Malcome. “Are they not promised already, and indeed
+may now be on the way. Arms, ammunition, men, money,
+there will be nothing lacking; and it doth surprise me not a
+little to find so hardy a young gentleman as the Master of
+Sinclair naturally is, turning so backward in an adventure
+of the sort.”</p>
+
+<p>“Hardihood is not necessarily folly, my good friend,”
+growled the Master. “But, to be sure, you are known as
+‘the honest laird,’ and what you say to the people they will
+stand by. But a day may come when not only Fife, but
+all Scotland, shall rue the landing of the Earl of Mar from
+his coal-barque at Elie last night.”</p>
+
+<p>This speech was followed by a prudent silence, and after
+a pause our host rose, and turning to the knight said
+courteously:</p>
+
+<p>“And now, Sir John, will you grant me a few minutes in
+private?”</p>
+
+<p>As they left the room, my lady and Mistress Anne
+followed to make some arrangement for the morrow, and
+thus we three, Betty, Barbara, and the Master were left
+alone.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_98">[98]</span></p>
+
+<p>“You do not trust the Earl of Mar, brother?” said
+Betty, somewhat timidly.</p>
+
+<p>“No more than I would trust a serpent not to sting me,
+were I fool enough to warm it in my bosom,” was his
+contemptuous reply.</p>
+
+<p>“My brother, Sir John, thinks different,” quoth she.</p>
+
+<p>“I know it well, my dear, and though I acquit the
+knight of being so great a knave as his kinsman, he is in
+my opinion no less of a fool.”</p>
+
+<p>At this my face burned hot, and I called out from my
+corner.</p>
+
+<p>“You do not like Sir John, Captain Sinclair; you are ever
+unjust to him.”</p>
+
+<p>He turned at that, surprised to hear so bold a speech
+from the girl who had sat dumb for the past hour, but he
+smiled stiffly. With all his ill-humour I have never seen
+him discourteous to a woman; and seeing that in after
+years he was twice married, both times to good and sensible
+women, it may be that there was a side to his character to
+which the world was a stranger. If this were not so, as I
+have often thought, my dear Betty could not have loved
+him so tenderly.</p>
+
+<p>“Your heat, Mistress Barbara, does credit to your
+heart,” he said, “and I blame you not for disagreeing with
+me. Sir John is my brother-in-law, it is true; but the
+nearness of our relationship, while it assures me of his
+virtues as a husband and a friend, does not blind my judgment
+to his character. The darling passion of his life is the
+attempting of desperate projects, and no matter how often
+he should fail, there is that buoyancy in his nature which
+will not suffer him to be convinced of his own insufficiency.
+He hath still the misfortune to imagine he is born to be a
+Great Man, and when all fails, nothing but want of wings can
+hinder him from undertaking the voyage of the moon.”</p>
+
+<p>He was not without discernment, the Master of Sinclair;
+and although at the time I bitterly resented his words, and
+believed that he spoke thus out of jealousy, I have since had
+reason to think that, robbed of its extravagance, his estimate
+of my kind guardian’s character was not altogether wrong.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_99">[99]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XII">
+ CHAPTER XII
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>TELLS OF THE ONLY OCCASION ON WHICH I MET
+ THE EARL OF MAR</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>Now I think it will be agreed that an idea which had sprung
+full-formed into my mind during my silent listening, with
+regard to the Master’s conduct, was not without weight. It
+seemed clear to me then, and grew, if possible, clearer in
+the light of after events, that his hatred and jealousy of the
+Earl of Mar were the cause of all his strange behaviour.
+He received the news of his landing, as we have seen, with
+surprise and scorn, and the first hint of that nobleman as a
+leader and commander roused his wrath to such a pitch,
+that from that moment he put little check upon his fury.
+Had the Duke of Berwick landed in place of the Earl, or
+had my Lord of Ormond arrived at the head of the
+expedition, it is my opinion that the Master of Sinclair
+would have raised no obstacles and seen no difficulties any
+more than our host of Grange himself. But his hatred of my
+Lord Mar was of old standing and well known to their
+friends, and his jealous spirit could not brook the notion of
+being under orders to the man he despised. From that
+day, although in obedience to my Lord Sinclair’s commands,
+he continued in the affair, his heart was not in it. He was
+thought to be but a lukewarm adherent, and when honour
+demanded that he should endeavour to hide his misgivings,
+support his Commander, and do nothing to foster dissensions
+in the camp, he made himself obnoxious to the Earl and
+his friends, raising up strife, frustrating plans, and sowing
+everywhere the seeds of mistrust and insubordination, which
+quickly sprang up and bore most bitter fruit.</p>
+
+<p>When it became known to him that Mr. Malcome had
+been charged with a private message from the Earl to Sir
+John, his jealous rage increased ten-fold, and from that day
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_100">[100]</span>
+onward in spite of the knight’s efforts to pacify him, which
+for his lady’s sake he most generously made, his bearing
+towards his brother-in-law was marked by scorn and bitterness,
+which, while it merely provoked Sir John, deeply
+annoyed my Lord Sinclair and grieved his whole family.</p>
+
+<p>In consequence of my Lord Mar’s message, whatever it
+may have been, Sir John did not next morning return
+with us to Dysart, but rode straight to the house of Mr.
+Bethune of Balfour, to interview the nobleman, and hear
+from him of his plans. Secret messages were sent to all
+the <i>honest</i> gentlemen in that part of the country to wait
+upon his lordship, but it was only by dint of stern
+commands from his father, and the loving entreaties of
+Betty herself, that the Master of Sinclair could be persuaded
+to attend on him. I believe that the Earl, from the first,
+treated Captain Sinclair with great kindness and deference,
+making inquiries of him about the state of feeling in the
+country, asking his advice, and otherwise behaving in a
+very frank and manly way. This, Sir John told my lady;
+and that at first the Master attempted to hide his gruffness
+and to respond in like manner, and Sir John, with his
+genial, sanguine nature, had great hopes that the rupture
+between them might be healed. As a further proof of his
+friendliness, my lord, in going to Dupplin House in
+Perthshire, the seat of the Lord Kinnoul, decided to come
+by Dysart in order to spend a few hours at the Hermitage,
+and pay his respects to my Lord Sinclair.</p>
+
+<p>This was the sole occasion upon which I saw the Earl of
+Mar, and I make no secret of the fact that his appearance,
+manners, and courteous behaviour quite won me over to the
+side of Sir John and my lady, who thought him one of the
+best and cleverest of men. As I have said before, I have no
+desire to dig too deep into the causes and motives of any
+man’s actions. All the world knows of the Earl’s mistakes,
+because the project he undertook failed; but so closely
+are we “bound up in the bundle of life,” as the Scripture
+saith, one with another, that it were impossible either at
+that time, or now, forty years after, to determine who else
+were at fault, or how many mistakes and errors went to
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_101">[101]</span>
+make up the whole. I suppose, that if the King’s Cause
+had prospered, and if he were now seated upon the throne
+of his forefathers instead of living in sad exile, not much
+would be heard of the incapacity of the Earl of Mar, or the
+motives, good or bad, which urged him on. Truly, as it
+saith again in the Book of Proverbs, “The lot is cast into
+the lap, but the whole disposing thereof is of the Lord.”
+And to those of you who, ten years back, witnessed the
+triumph of that brave young Prince as he rode gaily up
+the High Street of Edinburgh, with strong hopes in his
+heart of winning back the kingdom for his royal
+father, and who, later, mourned with him over these same
+hopes utterly cast down, this assurance from the pages of
+Holy Writ is the only comfort you could have. For
+myself, I was at that moment far away with my dear
+husband in the East Indies, so that only the rumours of
+Prince Charles Edward’s coming and going reached our
+ears; but as I heard of his charm, his courage, his
+successes, and in the next breath of his sufferings, his
+disappointments, and his failure, my tears fell for pity of
+the Lost Cause, just as they had done so many years
+before.</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>But what must you be thinking of this garrulous old
+woman, who lets her thoughts so wander from the path and
+her pen run away with her? I was telling you of the visit of
+the Earl to the Hermitage, and it all comes back to me
+very plain and clear. I had heard the Master say that my
+lord was a humpback, or at least deformed, but though I
+could perceive that one shoulder was slightly higher than
+the other, he carried himself with so much grace that it
+scarce detracted from his appearance. He was dressed
+very plain to avoid attention, but I thought for all that he
+looked the great gentleman he was. Upon my being
+presented to him, he saluted me very kindly on the cheek,
+as was then the custom, and told me that he knew my
+Grandpapa very well, saying also in a laughing tone that if
+I lived up to my name I must needs be happy to see him,
+and to know the reason of his coming. Upon which I
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_102">[102]</span>
+told him that I was very glad and thankful that the King
+had so good a friend, and at this he looked pleased and
+made me a low bow. He talked respectfully with my
+Lord Sinclair of the coming Rising, rallied Mistress Bess
+gaily on her enthusiasm, and answered very cordially my
+lady’s enquiries as to the health of his Countess and the
+welfare of their infant daughter. He took little Henry upon
+his knee, and calling Charles to his side told him of his
+friend, Tommy, who, he said, was now considered the bully
+of Westminster, for to that famous school Lordy Erskine
+had lately gone.</p>
+
+<p>“I like Tommy,” cried Charles, “he’s a great friend of
+mine!”</p>
+
+<p>“And I like Tommy too,” lisped Harry, not to be
+outdone, “he gives me a pick-a-back!”</p>
+
+<p>My lady bade the children not be troublesome, and sent
+them away to Phemie; but when was a mother’s heart not
+warmed by small attentions to her children, or how could
+any woman think ill of a man who thus fondled her little
+sons? I am sure that if my lady’s faith in the Earl had
+been in any way dimmed by her brother’s cruel suspicions,
+it burned bright and steady again after this visit to Dysart.</p>
+
+<p>Before he left us, and his stay was but brief, he drew
+from his bosom a portrait done in miniature, and, smiling,
+offered it to each of us in turn. We looked at it in silence.
+It was the face of the King. A face singularly attractive
+in its youthful grace, for the high forehead, the long, gentle,
+hazel eyes, even the lack of power in the full mouth and
+rounded chin, all helped to give it an air of sweetness which
+yet had a tinge of sadness in it; and while my heart was
+filled with a sudden strange yearning, I was not surprised
+to see tears in Betty’s eyes, as she lifted the miniature to
+her lips and reverently kissed it.</p>
+
+<p>And so with kind adieux, and hearty wishes for Godspeed
+in his venture, and gay waving of the hand, my Lord of
+Mar rode off to join his friends; and we watched him long
+upon the winding road, with smiles on our lips and prayers
+in our hearts, little dreaming that not one of us should
+ever look upon his face again.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_103">[103]</span></p>
+
+<p>Neither Sir John nor the Master of Sinclair was present
+at this interview, the latter having private affairs at the
+other side of the county, and my guardian being absent on
+one of the many secret missions which now occupied all his
+time. Several times he crossed to Edinburgh, returning
+the same day, for our agent there, Captain Harry Straton,
+was by now in the thick of business. On one of these
+occasions he brought back the discouraging news that the
+Duke of Ormond, had, on fear of being arrested, fled in
+haste from England, thus destroying our hopes in that
+direction; but it was thought that being now in France, he
+might combine with the King, and that on his return to
+England, the soldiers, by whom he was greatly beloved,
+would readily flock to his Standard. Sometimes Sir John
+was absent from Dysart many days together, being sent
+with important messages to gentlemen between Edinburgh
+and the Border, and even as far south as Dumfries and
+Galloway with despatches to the Earl of Nithsdale, and
+my Lord Kenmure.</p>
+
+<p>But that part of the business came to an end at last, and
+one night upon his return we learned the meaning of it all.
+My Lord Mar was holding a great <i>Tinchel</i> or Hunting of
+the deer, in his forest of Braemar, on the 26th day of
+August, and from near and far his <i>invited guests</i> were
+spurring north to join him. On the eve of departure, Sir
+John and the Master, though intending to ride together on
+the morrow, again broke out in dissension. ’Twas at
+supper, and some of our trusty neighbours were present.
+The Master, still smarting at the thought of Mar’s
+supremacy, threw doubts upon his wisdom in calling
+together so large a gathering which could not be kept
+private.</p>
+
+<p>“And what need for privacy,” cried Sir John, “when
+the country is ready to rise at our bidding?”</p>
+
+<p>“With the King still in France,” replied the Master,
+“Ormond fled from England, Argyle to take command
+in Scotland, and with six thousand Dutch troops ready
+to cross the sea to his assistance at a day’s notice, it seems
+to me that the quieter we make our plans the better.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_104">[104]</span></p>
+
+<p>“And to me it seems,” returned the other, “that enough
+time has been wasted, and the sooner the King’s Standard
+is openly raised, the more secure we shall stand.”</p>
+
+<p>And as all the company, including ourselves, were in
+agreement with this notion, and everyone weary of the
+repeated delays, the Master’s arguments were silenced,
+though I have no doubt his opinion remained the same.</p>
+
+<p>And now so many things crowd into my memory that I
+despair of setting the half of them down. I must leave it
+to history to tell you of that great meeting at Braemar,
+when noblemen and gentlemen from all parts of Scotland,
+from Caithness to the Border, and from Fife to the
+Western Isles, assembled to hear what the Earl of Mar had
+to tell them. What it was you know very well, and his
+manner of telling it. Also how, after enthusiastically
+agreeing to join the project—with, I fear, too little
+forethought or consideration—they dispersed to their
+homes in order to gather their forces together.</p>
+
+<p>Still the days went slowly by for us, hearing nothing
+from the north, and little from other sources, for in the
+absence of our men we saw, designedly, but little of our
+neighbours, and except for the two Pitcairns, uncle and
+nephew, had no communication with the outer world.</p>
+
+<p>My lady was growing anxious for news of her husband,
+and the strained look which I was to see so often in her
+kind eyes was beginning to show itself. When late one
+night, as we two were on our way to bed, after the rest of
+the household had retired, there came a sound of gentle
+knocking at the small door in the tower past which we
+must go to reach our rooms. The muffled sound at that
+hour, in the darkness (for we carried no light) was one to
+set our hearts beating, and I clutched at my cousin’s arm
+as we paused to listen. The knocking continued, and
+without a word my lady turned and began to go down the
+little flight of steps that led to the door.</p>
+
+<p>“Madam!” I cried softly, “be careful. Shall I call
+your brother, Mr. Will?”</p>
+
+<p>But my lady did not pause. She looked back at me up
+the winding stair, and the moonlight from the narrow
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_105">[105]</span>
+window fell upon her face; it was white, but she was
+smiling. I knew that in those days there was no time for
+foolish fears, and secrets, however they were carried, were
+not to be trusted to servants. There was nothing for my
+lady to do, but what she was doing, so I stood in breathless
+suspense and listened. Surely she would not open without
+a question to those without.</p>
+
+<p>Down below a bolt was drawn, and the door creaked
+slightly as it was shoved back. Then I heard a cry, and
+after that—silence. Trembling with fear and uncertainty
+I strained my neck to peer down the twisting stairway,
+holding my skirt up with one hand, and descending slowly
+step by step. It was not far to go, and suddenly I saw in
+the patch of moonlight that shone through the open door
+two figures that looked like one. ’Twas my lady in her
+husband’s arms. I laughed for very relief and joy, and
+they both looked up and smiled. My good Sir John was
+dusty and travel-worn, and his eyes were heavy with fatigue.
+He had ridden fast and far, and the hand he held out to
+me trembled, while his voice was weak and husky.</p>
+
+<p>“Didst ever know such a wench as mine, Barbara?” he
+cried softly. “Here she comes stealing down the turret-stair
+in the moonlight to open the door to a lover belike,
+only to discover her husband!” and he laughed below his
+breath.</p>
+
+<p>“My dearest life!” cried my lady, her face all smiles,
+“would I not know your knock among a thousand?
+Come, come, we must close the door and get you
+something to eat, for you must be well-nigh starving.”</p>
+
+<p>“Drink first, sweetheart!” laughed the knight. “There’s
+no room in this throat of mine for meat to pass down till
+some of the dust has been washed out of it.”</p>
+
+<p>Softly he shut and bolted the door, and taking off his
+riding-boots to carry them in his hand, he stole behind us
+up the stairs and into the dining-hall on the left. Once
+there he flung himself into an arm-chair and stretched his
+weary limbs with a great sigh. In a few minutes we had
+collected food and wine from the buttery and the pantry,
+and it was with a feeling of relief, as intense as though the
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_106">[106]</span>
+terrible thirst had been my own, that I watched the huge
+tankard filled and emptied.</p>
+
+<p>“And now, my dearest,” cried my lady, when her lord
+had demolished half a cold pasty and much bread and
+cheese, “why come you so late and in secret? What
+news do you bring? Are they good or bad?”</p>
+
+<p>Sir John’s face was grave. “Mayhap you have heard,”
+quoth he, “the King of France is dead.”</p>
+
+<p>“The King!”</p>
+
+<p>“Dead?”</p>
+
+<p>“Ay, dead as mutton! And the power in the hands of
+a Regent, who, I know well enough, whatever my Lord of
+Mar may say, is not well affected to our cause.”</p>
+
+<p>My lady seated herself beside him.</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, we have heard nothing. No news have come
+from Edinburgh this sennight. All our friends are from
+home as you know, and David Pitcairn has thought it well
+to bide quiet and attend to business.”</p>
+
+<p>“Betty’s business?” cried the knight, and my lady
+laughed.</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, my dear; Betty’s business would be the King’s,
+as you very well know, and if he is to be of use to us later,
+he must not draw suspicion on himself too soon.”</p>
+
+<p>“Right and true!” said Sir John. “He may help us
+all by-and-bye; David’s a wise lad and can hold his
+tongue.”</p>
+
+<p>“So we have heard nothing,” continued my lady. “But
+this death of King Louis is a terrible loss to us. What says
+the Earl?”</p>
+
+<p>“He insists,” said Sir John, “that the Duke of Orleans
+is as much in favour of the Restoration as the old King was,
+and that his death is no loss, but rather a gain to the cause.
+But I know the Regent better than he, and I hope for no
+help from him. Indeed, if he do nothing to hinder us,
+twill be less than I expect of him.”</p>
+
+<p>“And now, Sir John,” I cried, “will you not tell us why
+you come thus, in such haste and privacy, to tell us what
+all the world must know in a day or two?”</p>
+
+<p>He laughed and called me a “saucy minx.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_107">[107]</span></p>
+
+<p>“To say truth, Mistress Barbara, your humble servant
+is a bit of a coward, and I must own that I stole here
+to-night under cover of the darkness (though the moon
+shines cruelly bright for conspirators), because I hoped to
+avoid my eldest brother-in-law, whose jibes and sneers I
+can ill brook in my present disturbed state of mind. He
+left the north some days ago. Is he at home?”</p>
+
+<p>My lady smiled, and fondled his hand like one humouring
+a child.</p>
+
+<p>“No,” she said, “but he may return to-night, and you
+will see him most like at breakfast.”</p>
+
+<p>“That will I not,” cried he, “for by breakfast-time I
+must be far from here. Only a few hours’ sleep, and then
+up and off again. Come, my lady, this food has made a
+new man of me; now to bed, for I must be on the road by
+five o’ the clock, and ’tis now half on midnight.”</p>
+
+<p>A shadow fell over her face.</p>
+
+<p>“And whither now?” she asked. “I had hoped you
+could remain a few days with us.”</p>
+
+<p>“To Edinburgh,” he cried, “no less! For by the end
+o’ the week, I trust the Castle and all its supplies will be in
+my Lord Drummond’s hands.”</p>
+
+<p>My lady was again all eagerness and poured forth
+question after question as to the time and the method
+of taking so important a stronghold, but Sir John only
+kissed her and put her off in his usual light-hearted style,
+and soon after we crept stealthily up to our rooms.</p>
+
+<p>“I dreamed my papa came and kissed me in the night,”
+said little Charles to me next morning. “I thought it was
+true, and told Phemie that Sir John was returned, but
+when I asked my mama, she laughed and said I must
+have dreamed it.”</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_108">[108]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XIII">
+ CHAPTER XIII
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>SHOWS HOW A WOMAN’S ACTIONS ARE OFTTIMES
+ MISUNDERSTOOD</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>The very next day, being the tenth of September, came Mr.
+Malcome to visit us, with news both good and bad. The
+Master had not yet returned home, so that we were
+ignorant of what had passed since Sir John left the north.
+Four days before, our visitor told us, the Earl of Mar had
+set up the King’s Standard at Braemar, proclaiming him
+King of Scotland, England, France and Ireland. They
+were making arrangements for doing likewise in many of
+the larger towns, such as Aberdeen, Dunkeld, Brechin, and
+Montrose, and hoped before long to take Perth out of the
+hands of the Whigs and make that place their headquarters.
+The affair, said Mr. Malcome, was spreading
+like fire in the heather (an ill-sounding simile, thought I)
+and he believed there would be a rousing welcome for
+King James when he arrived.</p>
+
+<p>“And what of Edinbro’?” asked my lady anxiously,
+for where her treasure was, there also was her heart.</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Malcome gave a long, slow whistle, and turned to
+my Lord Sinclair.</p>
+
+<p>“Have you not heard, my lord?”</p>
+
+<p>The old lord shook his head. “Nothing as yet,” he said.</p>
+
+<p>He drew a little nearer us, and sank his voice almost to
+a whisper.</p>
+
+<p>“A fiasco, my lord, an utter failure, the stupidest piece
+of bungling that ever was perpetrated.”</p>
+
+<p>“But how, sir, did it fail?” cried my lady, with wide,
+anxious eyes.</p>
+
+<p>“Strangely enough, madam, through the treachery of a
+woman,” sighed Mr. Malcome. “A woman got hold of the
+scheme, my lady, and, as was natural, the thing slipped out.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_109">[109]</span></p>
+
+<p>“For shame, sir!” cried Betty, her cheeks flaming.
+“Do you mean to insinuate that a woman cannot keep a
+secret—that women are more often traitors than men?
+How dare you speak so, Mr. Malcome?”</p>
+
+<p>Our guest was too old a friend to take umbrage at Mistress
+Betty’s wrathful tone. He sighed again but offered no apology.</p>
+
+<p>“Tell us all you know, sir, I beg,” said my lady.</p>
+
+<p>“Madam,” said he, “I name no names. If they are
+not known to you now, they will be public property soon.
+But ’tis reported that a certain young officer who had
+charge of this scheme, not satisfied to be alone in his
+family on our side, engaged his brother, a certain physician
+in Edinbro’, to join in with him. The latter, madam, has a
+wife, who seeing her husband very melancholy, as weighed
+down by his knowledge of the secret, begged him with
+wifely solicitude to unburden his mind to her. The
+gentleman not able to resist her wiles confessed his
+anxiety, whereupon the lady, whose sympathies unfortunately
+lay on the other side, sent an anonymous despatch
+to my Lord Justice Clerk. Sir Adam Cockburn, worthy
+man, communicated with Colonel Stuart, the Governor; the
+plot was frustrated, the Castle was saved, or rather—lost!”</p>
+
+<p>“And what of the conspirators?” we cried.</p>
+
+<p>“Most escaped, but two or three fell into the hands of
+the Town-band, which the Lord Provost had sent out to
+patrol the town.”</p>
+
+<p>“Tell me, sir, have you seen my husband, Sir John?”
+cried my lady. “Was he with Mr. Straton last night?”</p>
+
+<p>“Madam, he was, but this morning he rode north again
+with the news of our misfortune to the Earl of Mar.”</p>
+
+<p>She sighed even as she smiled.</p>
+
+<p>“Here is a woman,” she cried, laying her hand on her
+bosom, “who is traitor enough to the Cause to wish that
+her husband were not so useful a man. ’Tis mighty
+uneasy at times, my friend, to balance the scales betwixt
+love and honour; and though I am very sorry that our
+project has failed, I cannot as a wife, blame that lady who
+doubtless loves her husband as much as I do mine, and
+wished to save him in spite of himself.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_110">[110]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Madam,” said the discreet Mr. Malcome, “there are
+always two sides to a question, if not more; and besides,
+the story may not be true.”</p>
+
+<p>After this, many rumours came to our ears without
+greatly affecting our daily life, though my lady lived from
+hour to hour in the hope of despatches from her husband,
+and Betty and the rest of the household were never weary
+of gathering news from every conceivable source.</p>
+
+<p>One day the Rev. Mr. Pitcairn, having gone on some
+errand to Edinburgh, came back with the news that the
+Duke of Argyle had arrived from London, and was gone to
+Stirling to take up his quarters there. General Wightman
+had been for some weeks now in the Castle, and his troops,
+some 1800 strong, lay encamped in the King’s Park. Old
+Colonel Erskine had not yet been superseded as Governor
+of the Castle, it being well known that the majority of that
+family were in favour of the Government, though his
+affection for Sir John and my Lady of Alva drew his
+sympathies in the other direction. Old Lady Alva belonged
+to a staunch Whig family, and her son Charles at
+that time seemed in full sympathy with her, so that neither
+from them, nor from Aunt Betty did my lady, as she told
+me, look for help or pity did things go wrong with Sir
+John. But, as you know, in such affairs it is the common
+rule for families to be divided amongst themselves, and at
+present there was no thought of misfortune.</p>
+
+<p>The town of Perth fell into possession of the King’s men
+about the middle of September in a very simple manner,
+for the Tory burghers, having sent privately to Colonel
+Hay to let him know that they were ready to revolt against
+the magistrates, who were Whigs, if he could bring a
+sufficient force to back them up, that gentleman, with
+about forty horse, shortly afterwards appeared before the
+town (though on the wrong side of the river), and his
+friends, seizing the boats without any resistance from the
+town, brought them all across the Tay. The Whigs who
+were, we were told, terrified by the report of the approach
+of the Earl of Mar with some thousands of Highlandmen,
+very meekly gave up their arms to their adversaries, and
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_111">[111]</span>
+took no more active part in opposition than to ride post to
+Edinburgh to inform the Government of what had happened.</p>
+
+<p>To Perth, therefore, by degrees came flocking the
+noblemen and gentlemen with their followers, who had
+agreed to join my Lord Mar. The young Earl of
+Strathmore, a fine and gallant gentleman, with two hundred
+of his men, was the first to arrive, and following him came
+the Earl of Southesk with about the same number. My
+Lord Panmure, that brave and staunch old hero, brought
+with him an hundred Highlandmen, and two hundred from
+the Lowlands. My Lord Nairne and his son came likewise;
+while the Master of Sinclair at the head of the Fifeshire
+gentlemen, of whom he had assumed a kind of unofficial
+command, rode away from home with our Godspeeds in his
+ears to join this gallant company.</p>
+
+<p>After the departure of that gentleman, we had more news
+from headquarters than most people, I suppose; for the
+Master, being a great scribe, thought little of penning more
+than one long letter of an evening. So that my lord, his
+father, and his sister Betty, were constantly receiving
+despatches. I cannot but own that the picture he drew
+was far from encouraging. The Earl of Mar was not yet
+come to Perth, nor General Hamilton with his troops, and
+every man did what seemed right in his own eyes. The
+lack of order and discipline to a man accustomed to the
+ways of tried soldiers must indeed have been vexatious,
+and even making allowance, as we all half laughingly did,
+for the trend of the Master’s temper and the <i>sharpness of
+his pen</i> there was much in his accounts to make my lord
+shake his head, and keep us all somewhat anxious.</p>
+
+<p>One thing that greatly annoyed him was the indifferent
+way in which some of the gentlemen, who ought not to
+have exposed themselves, rode about the country alone on
+the smallest excuse. They were constantly returning home
+on one pretext or another, generally on the plea of getting
+fresh supplies of money; spending perhaps a night or two
+away from camp, and returning with the utmost carelessness
+in broad daylight. Again and again the Master told us he
+had warned them that they would be kidnapped, and at
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_112">[112]</span>
+last what he predicted really happened. Our friend, Sir
+Thomas Bruce, riding home on some such errand, was
+taken by a party of dragoons, under Lord Rothes, near to
+the town of Kinross, and carried prisoner to Leslie House.</p>
+
+<p>“And serve him right!” cried Betty indignantly, when
+we heard of it. “He should have listened to my brother’s
+warning.”</p>
+
+<p>About this time we heard that the Earl of Sutherland
+had landed at Leith from England, and had sailed north
+to his own county, of which he had lately been made Lord-lieutenant,
+to raise the Clans in that neighbourhood in
+favour of the Government. This dashed our spirits a little,
+but we had soon reason to be glad of it.</p>
+
+<p>One evening about six o’clock, we were walking in the
+wood that borders the shore between the Hermitage and
+the grim old Castle of Ravenscraig which was now being
+allowed to fall into decay. My lady walked in front with
+young Mr. Pitcairn at her side, and little Charles ran before
+her, Betty and myself following. It had been a still, bright
+day, such as we often get in the end of September in
+Scotland, and scarcely a ripple rose to break upon the
+rocks. The sun was out of sight behind us, but its full
+light shone upon the water, and the distant coast seemed
+very far away. Some boats were in the Frith, but the air
+was so light that their sails were almost useless; for though
+they filled enough to bear the little crafts gently onward, in
+most of them the boatmen had taken to the oars.</p>
+
+<p>Suddenly Betty stood still, her keen eyes fixed on one of
+these tiny barks, which seemed to be steering towards us;
+it was as yet too far off for me to make out its occupants,
+but my companion had the eyes of a hawk.</p>
+
+<p>“Sister!” she cried, “the boat, do you see it?”</p>
+
+<p>My lady turned and stood beside us, looking where she
+pointed.</p>
+
+<p>“Surely, Bess, I see it—what then? ’Tis but a fishing-boat
+going out for the night.”</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, my dear,” laughed Betty, “there you are wrong.
+Can you not see? They are making signals.” And snatching
+her kerchief from her neck she waved it above her head.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_113">[113]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Take care, my woman!” cried her sister, catching at
+her arm, “that is a dangerous thing to do. You know
+not who it is, Betty. Do you want every Tom, Dick, and
+Harry to land at the Hermitage? One would take you for
+a child at times, so rashly do you act.”</p>
+
+<p>But Betty’s cheeks were red and her eyes bright with
+excitement, while she still gazed eagerly at the boat.
+Presently, when the little bark was heading for the
+harbour just below us, and we could all see in it the figure
+of a man in a travelling-cloak, she twisted her kerchief
+again round her neck and began to walk quickly forward.</p>
+
+<p>“You may trust me, my dear Catherine,” she said, “I
+know their signals. ’Tis one of our party, though I know
+not who, as yet. Let us meet him at the stair-foot.”</p>
+
+<p>We passed down the rough-hewn stone steps that led to
+the harbour, David Pitcairn leading and Betty close behind.
+As the boat touched, the traveller, who was now on his feet,
+sprang out, and, with hat in hand, stood looking up at us.</p>
+
+<p>“Why?” cried my lady, “’tis Mr. James Murray! You
+were right, Bess, ’tis a friend indeed. Welcome home, sir!
+Are you but newly from France?”</p>
+
+<p>The last words were added in a whisper, as the young
+man bent to kiss her hand. He nodded silently, and
+turned to fee his boatmen (very liberally, to judge from
+the satisfaction on their faces). They handed him up a box,
+which David with a laugh, and in spite of the other’s
+protest, swung upon his shoulder, and we all started again
+for the house.</p>
+
+<p>“Was it you, Mistress Elizabeth, who answered my
+signal?” asked the traveller. “I was surprised to find you
+could see mine from so far. Had I not caught sight of
+you ladies in the wood, I should not have ventured, I fear,
+to approach the house.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why not, Mr. Murray? My lord will be over-joyed to
+see you,” cried Betty. “’Tis many months since you left
+us. How is the King? Is this your first return?”</p>
+
+<p>“Yes, madam, I have been in France since April, and
+come now with good news for the Earl of Mar. I arrived
+in Edinburgh this morning, disguised, having travelled by
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_114">[114]</span>
+way of England; but when I left France, his Majesty was
+well and in good spirits.”</p>
+
+<p>“Then, indeed, you are welcome to us all,” cried my lady,
+and with this we were come to the front door, and our
+guest was ushered in with every expression of hospitality.</p>
+
+<p>Supper was hurried forward, and entertainment of the
+best was bestowed upon the traveller. I had gathered that
+this Mr. Murray was second son to the Viscount of
+Stormont, and a trusted friend of King James. We
+learned now that his Majesty had appointed him Secretary
+of State for the affairs of Scotland, and while we knew that
+he carried the Royal Commission to the Earl of Mar, he
+whispered, under seal of solemn secrecy, that he brought
+also a Patent creating him a Duke. This news was greeted
+with all joy and approval, and we drank to the health of
+the Duke of Mar.</p>
+
+<p>“Pray, sir,” said the elder Mr. Pitcairn, for David had
+been sent in haste to bid his uncle to supper, “can you
+give us any news of the King’s movements?”</p>
+
+<p>“I give you my word, sir,” was the reply, “that his
+Majesty is resolved to cross very shortly; but the roads in
+France are all guarded, and it will not be without difficulty
+that he reaches the coast. My Lord Stair would not be
+grieved overmuch were his Majesty to fall into the hands
+of some convenient highwayman.”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh!” cried Betty, in horror, “you cannot mean, sir,
+that he wishes for his death?”</p>
+
+<p>“That, Mistress Betty, is a harsh manner of speaking,
+but the Ambassador certainly thinks that King James is in
+the way.”</p>
+
+<p>“God preserve him,” breathed the minister, “from the
+hands of wicked men.”</p>
+
+<p>“Amen!” cried my lord. “And what, sir, is being done
+in the way of material assistance, for of that we have
+heard a vast deal, though nothing has been seen.”</p>
+
+<p>“When I left France, my lord, there were ships in the
+ports of Havre, St. Malo, and other places, twelve ships
+of war in all, with several swift frigates being loaded with
+great store of ammunition—small arms, shells, bullets, and
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_115">[115]</span>
+some pieces of artillery, while soldiers and officers in
+abundance only waited their orders to embark.”</p>
+
+<p>“God be praised!” cried my lord, “this sounds like
+reality at last. If only they do not delay, but strike, as
+the saying is, while the iron is hot.”</p>
+
+<p>“And what of the Duke of Berwick?” asked his younger
+son, William.</p>
+
+<p>Here Mr. Murray looked uncomfortable and made no
+reply for a moment, but presently he said he feared there
+had been trouble between the King and his half-brother,
+of which he could give no details, but he now believed
+the Duke would not take part in the expedition at all.</p>
+
+<p>“The more’s the pity!” he added, “for there is no
+doubt that he is a good and brave man, as well as a skilful
+general.”</p>
+
+<p>It is needless to say that we were all very much cast
+down at this news, for our opinion of the Duke had always
+been that of Mr. Murray, and we had been led to hope
+great things from his assistance. We talked the matter
+over, and again fell back upon the hope that the Duke
+of Ormond, though inferior in skill, might take his place
+in England. We discussed it far into the night, until my
+lady, rising, protested that Mr. Murray must have some
+rest, seeing he intended starting in search of the Earl of
+Mar, whose whereabouts was uncertain, early the next day.</p>
+
+<p>But on the morrow as we sat at breakfast a despatch
+was brought in from the Master of Sinclair, which saved
+the important messenger any unnecessary delay. The
+Earl, he said, had arrived at Perth with a large following
+of Highlanders the day before. The companies already
+in the town were drawn out on the North Inch to receive
+him, and our informant added that my Lord Mar had
+already begun to stick thorns in his (the Master’s) side,
+by his arrogant assumption of authority and infallibility.
+As her brother could not mention this nobleman’s name
+without some sign of irritation, my lady smilingly suppressed
+this addition, and assuring Mr. Murray of our
+delight in having had the good fortune to waylay and
+entertain him, we bade him a hearty adieu.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_116">[116]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XIV">
+ CHAPTER XIV
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>TELLS HOW MISTRESS BETTY HAD A BRILLIANT NOTION, AND
+ OF HOW IT WAS CARRIED OUT</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>It seemed to us all in those days that Fortune was playing
+a game of <i>see-saw</i> with us and our hopes. No sooner
+were we elated by some piece of good luck, than something
+happened of the reverse order to cast us down into the
+depths of depression. Two days after the visit of Mr. James
+Murray, news was sent to Mr. Harry Straton in Edinburgh
+that, following hard upon his track, came one, Mr. Ezekiel
+Hamilton to wit, with very evil tidings. The Regent,
+Orleans, to whom we had been told to look for help, had
+proved himself the very reverse, for he had caused the
+ships, of which Mr. Murray had spoken with such confidence,
+to be unloaded of all the arms and ammunition,
+and it was added that Admiral Byng had leave from him
+to search all ships coming from Havre and other ports
+to Scotland. Here was a blow to our hopes, and we were just
+where we had been, or perhaps a little lower in the scale
+of unhappiness in consequence of the severity of our
+disappointment.</p>
+
+<p>“Ah!” sighed my lady, “you see my dear Sir John
+was right. He mistrusted the Regent, and indeed feared
+he would do us harm. Was ever king so unjustly treated,
+or surrounded by so much treachery!”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh,” cried Betty, “would to God I could do something
+to help! How terrible it is to be a weak woman
+in times like these! Come, Barbara, let us at least get
+to horse, and ride out and hear some news. I shall go
+mad if I stay cooped in the house another hour.”</p>
+
+<p>Nothing loth, I did as she bade me, and we were soon upon
+the road. She had refused to take a servant, “for,” said she,
+“if we hear any secrets we must keep them to ourselves.”</p>
+
+<p>“We are not like to hear many, my dear,” said I, “for
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_117">[117]</span>
+there is no one to tell them to us. See, as far as I can
+look along the road, there is not a soul in sight. How
+far shall we go? ’tis getting late to be out alone!”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, fear not, child!” cried Betty, shortly. “Naught
+can happen to us here, where all the world knows us.
+Pray do me the favour to be silent. I wish to think.”</p>
+
+<p>It was a quiet bright evening, with the first touch of
+frost to make the air keen upon our faces. On and on we
+rode till the houses of Burntisland came in view. When
+we were near the town, Betty pulled her horse to a walk,
+and pointing to the harbour, bade me look at a little ship
+anchored in the roadstead.</p>
+
+<p>“I wonder whence it comes and what it contains,” said
+she idly; and I wondered at her interest, for there were
+several vessels in the harbour, and ships were constantly
+coming and going in the Frith, so that there was nothing
+to distinguish this in any particular way.</p>
+
+<p>Not deeming it prudent to go into the town, as the
+evening was darkening down and we two women alone,
+Betty stopped at a little inn at the entrance of the street,
+where the wife was one Janet Spiers, who had formerly
+been cook-maid at the Hermitage. Rapping on the door
+with her whip-handle, Betty soon brought the good
+woman out, who, on seeing the quality of her visitors,
+overwhelmed us with kind requests to come in and rest.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, Jenny,” said Betty, “we do not mean to alight;
+’tis close on seven o’clock and the days are growing short.
+We did but ride this way to take the air, and being so near
+your house I stopped to ask for your gudeman.”</p>
+
+<p>“Thank ye kindly, Mistress ’Lizabeth,” said the woman,
+“he’s real weel. The hoast was sair on him a while back,
+but sin’ the hairst he’s ta’en up fine.”</p>
+
+<p>They chatted together for a few minutes, and upon my
+remarking on the number of ships in the harbour, Janet
+Spiers pointed to the very vessel which had attracted the
+attention of Betty a short while back, and asked her if she
+knew what it contained.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, no,” said Betty, “nothing very valuable I should
+say.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_118">[118]</span></p>
+
+<p>The woman tossed her head with a contemptuous smile.</p>
+
+<p>“Ye wad wonder!” she cried. “What think ye,
+Mistress Betty? There’s fire-arms intilt, and pouther and
+bullets and a’, and what for? To send awa’ north to my
+Lord Sutherland for him tae arm his men and gar them
+fecht for the English King. Set him up indeed! I’m for
+King Jamie, ye ken, my leddy, as ye are yersel’.”</p>
+
+<p>“Arms!” cried Betty, in great surprise, “arms and
+ammunition! But where do they come from, and what do
+they here?”</p>
+
+<p>“Weel, weel,” said Janet Spiers, “they were shipped at
+Leith frae the Castle at Edinbro’, but the chiel that’s
+maister o’ the ship is a Bruntisland man. He lives down
+bye in the close there, forenent the quay. He’s been awa’
+this three weeks, and as he kent the gudewife was near her
+time, he couldna think tae sail awa’ north without spierin’
+for her. Aweel, she was brocht tae bed o’ a fine laddie this
+morn, and naethin’ wad satisfy the creatur (a spoilt quean
+she is), but keep her man by her for a wee. An’ he,
+honest man, was sweer tae leave her, and sae, there he is,
+and there’s his ship, and there’s nae hurry aboot sailing,
+that I can see.”</p>
+
+<p>“How long will he stay, think ye, Jenny?” said Betty,
+and I could hear a thrill of excitement in her voice.</p>
+
+<p>“Till the morn’s nicht at the full o’ the tide, onyway,”
+said the other, “an’ maybe langer.”</p>
+
+<p>“And how many stands of arms did they tell you the
+ship contained?” she asked.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh,” said Jenny, doubtfully, “twa-three thoosan’,
+maybe.”</p>
+
+<p>“Dear me!” cried Betty, “my Lord Sutherland will be
+lucky to get them. Well, Jenny, we must say good-night,
+and ride fast to get home before the darkness falls. Come,
+Barbara.”</p>
+
+<p>And away we went again upon the homeward road, while
+the land behind us darkened, and the first bright star
+shone out above us in the pale sky.</p>
+
+<p>So fast rode Betty that I was soon out of breath and
+called out to her to stop, but she only urged her beast to
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_119">[119]</span>
+the utmost, and left me to follow some way behind. What
+had come to her I wondered; could she be afraid of the
+approaching night? But no, fear and Betty were not well
+acquainted, and I soon dismissed the thought. My dear
+friend was full of whims, and her mind I knew was greatly
+disturbed. I did my best to keep up with her, and bent
+my attention on the road we had to follow. It was almost
+dark when we came abreast of the Town-House of Dysart
+(for straight into the town we had ridden), and the place
+was nearly empty. Betty stopped abruptly and seemed to
+be considering what to do next. A man came out of
+Quality Street and turned towards us, and in the dim light
+we both recognised Mr. David Pitcairn.</p>
+
+<p>“David, oh, <i>David</i>!” cried Betty, not loud but with an
+intensity of feeling in her tone which would have carried
+her words much further, and in a few quick strides he was
+beside us.</p>
+
+<p>How clearly I remember his appearance as he stood
+there with his hand upon her horse’s neck, and his fine face
+lifted to hers in the twilight. So well I knew the devotion
+that filled his soul, though none had told me of it, that I
+felt sure, whatever she asked of him, he would then and
+there consent.</p>
+
+<p>“Dear David,” said Betty, “you are the very man I was
+hoping to see,” and my heart contracted at the words,
+knowing what they must mean to him. “I have a project,
+’tis formed within the last half-hour. There is something
+you must do for me—nay, not for me, for the King, David—and
+if you love me you will not refuse.”</p>
+
+<p>Ah! Betty, was it kind to put it thus? But what woman
+would have refrained from using her sweetness as a lure in
+a like case?</p>
+
+<p>“If I love you, Betty!” said he, very gravely. “Have
+I ever refused you anything you required of me?”</p>
+
+<p>Even at that moment I saw her falter. Was she putting
+him to a test too hard?</p>
+
+<p>“Then walk with us along the shore, where no envious
+ears can overhear us. Oh! David, such a chance, such
+good fortune as never could have been expected! I can
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_120">[120]</span>
+scarce restrain myself from laughing aloud. But we must
+be quiet. It must be kept secret; no one shall know but
+you, and Barbara, and my lord. ’Tis better so.” So fast
+she talked, and appeared so excited, that I almost feared
+her agitation would overcome her, but by-and-bye when we
+were beyond the houses she spoke more quietly.</p>
+
+<p>“Listen, David. There is lying outside the harbour of
+Burntisland at this moment, a ship filled with arms and
+ammunition intended for the Earl of Sutherland in the
+north. You can guess what he means to do with them.
+There they are now for anyone to take, for the master,
+poor fool, is grinning over the cradle of his new-born son;
+and the crew, I dare swear, are as pleasantly, if less
+innocently, employed about the town. Now we must, by
+hook or by crook, get those arms for our own. Three
+thousand stands, David, and much powder and bullets,
+think what a haul! Is it not splendid?”</p>
+
+<p>“Magnificent!” said David, smiling. “But do you
+propose my boarding the vessel alone in the night, and
+bearing them away on my back, Betty?”</p>
+
+<p>“Nay!” she cried, reproachfully, “I am not so foolish.
+But this I propose: my brother, the Master, must be told
+of it; he will know what to do. He will come with a troop
+from Perth, and take them by force if necessary. But it
+must be done at once, and in as secret a way as possible.
+The ship will sail to-morrow at midnight, with the tide.
+Someone—you, dear David, must go this night to Perth,
+carrying a despatch from me, which I will write presently;
+and you must ride in hot haste, so as to be there by daybreak,
+and lose no time in waking my brother and telling
+him of the matter. He may have to consult my Lord of
+Mar, but no one, I think, will be so mad as to neglect this
+great opportunity.”</p>
+
+<p>David walked along slowly, his eyes on the ground. He
+was between us, and I listened for his answer as eagerly as
+Betty. To my surprise it was long of coming, and my
+companion, still more astonished, broke out again impatiently.</p>
+
+<p>“You will not refuse, David! ’Tis not so hard a task.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_121">[121]</span>
+A night in the saddle cannot mean much to you. Why do
+you hesitate? I thought—”</p>
+
+<p>Then he lifted his head and looked at her in quiet
+wonder.</p>
+
+<p>“Do you mean to say you doubt me, Betty! I was but
+thinking out my best road. And my horse has been out
+all day.”</p>
+
+<p>So, I suppose, had he, but Betty did not notice the
+admission.</p>
+
+<p>“You shall have the best horse in my lord’s stables!”
+she cried, joyfully. “You shall choose for yourself. Oh
+no, I did not doubt you, David. I <i>knew</i> you would do it.
+There is no one more faithful and true.”</p>
+
+<p>And she cast upon him a look so sweet and kind that I,
+not knowing the secrets of this wayward woman-heart,
+began to think for the first time that, for her patient squire,
+the reward he wished might not be quite impossible. He
+lifted the little hand that hung down beside him, and
+raised it to his lips.</p>
+
+<p>“And what shall my payment be?” he asked.</p>
+
+<p>But even as if he scorned his own question, he hurried
+forward to push open the gate, and Betty rode up to the
+house in silence.</p>
+
+<p>My Lord Sinclair was sitting down to supper when we
+entered the hall, but his daughter, in her impetuous way,
+swept him with her into a little room which stood empty,
+and beckoning to David and myself, she bade us enter and
+shut the door. It did not take long to acquaint my lord
+with our story, and he was heartily pleased to approve of
+Betty’s plan. The sole objection that he made was that
+nothing should be written; papers were dangerous, and
+Mr. Pitcairn might be waylaid, and even searched.</p>
+
+<p>“Let the message go by word of mouth,” said he.
+“David has brains enough to deliver it as you give it to
+him, and my son knows him too well to doubt that he
+comes from us.”</p>
+
+<p>So it was arranged. David was to sup at the Hermitage,
+going after to his uncle at the Manse to acquaint him with
+his intended venture. A good horse was to be provided
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_122">[122]</span>
+for him, and as soon as it was dark enough, which would be
+by ten of the clock, he was to ride out of the town and make
+his way to Perth. By riding all night, but keeping to
+unfrequented ways, he would come there by five or six in
+the morning, and he had instructions to find out the
+Master’s lodging, and rouse him at once to receive the news.</p>
+
+<p>You may imagine, at supper there were at least two of us
+with little appetite, and my lady chid her sister for having
+ridden too far and tired both herself and me. As soon as
+possible I escaped upstairs, and right glad was I when my
+cousin joined me, to find that the secret had been imparted
+to her. Indeed, I believe it might have been discussed
+openly before all the house without any harm done, the
+entire household being too faithful to my lord’s interests
+to breathe a word that would endanger any of them.</p>
+
+<p>As we sat and talked in the half-dark, for the room was
+lighted but by one small taper, we heard the sounds of
+preparation in the stable-yard, for upon that my window
+looked. I opened the casement and we leaned out. A
+horse, ready saddled, stood there with a groom beside him!
+By the feeble light of the lanthorn hung on the wall we
+could see his grand form, and the proud lift of his head, as
+his nostrils snuffed the cold night air.</p>
+
+<p>“’Tis La Flèche!” my lady whispered, “the best horse
+my lord has left.”</p>
+
+<p>Out of the low doorway leading from the kitchens came
+David Pitcairn, booted and spurred, but with his hat
+in his hand. Behind him tripped Betty, and with a word
+dismissed the groom, who shuffled back into the stable.
+As Mr. Pitcairn stood ready to mount, Betty came close
+to him, and spoke in a tone so low that it did not reach us.
+When he answered her she took something from her bosom
+and held it out to him in her open hand. The light gleamed
+on a little gold heart, and I recognised a trinket that she
+was fond of wearing. With a smile she let him take it, and
+with a smile he raised it to his lips. Just then the town-clock
+struck ten. He caught hold of both her hands and
+kissed them lingeringly, swung himself into the saddle, and
+waving his hat with a cheerful “good-bye,” rode out into the
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_123">[123]</span>
+darkness. For some minutes we listened to the sound of
+the horse’s hoofs growing fainter in the distance, and then we
+drew back into the room and closed the window.</p>
+
+<p>My lady sighed. “Poor David!” she said softly.</p>
+
+<p>“I wish,” cried I, “that Betty could be kinder to him,
+madam.”</p>
+
+<p>“Alas! child,” said she, “Bess is already far too kind,
+and yet I know she means no harm. She loves him in
+every way but one, and he worships her with body, heart,
+and soul, as it is not good for any woman to be worshipped.”</p>
+
+<p>“You think she would not marry him?” I asked. My
+lady laughed, but not unkindly.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, no!” she said. “I do not always understand my
+sister (I think at times she scarce understands herself) but
+I am ready to wager my life’s happiness that she will never
+be David Pitcairn’s wife.”</p>
+
+<p>And at that moment the subject of our talk knocked at
+the door and entered.</p>
+
+<p>Her face was very pale, and her eyes burned bright with
+excitement. She came in quietly, and sat down by us in
+silence. My lady put out her hand, and laid it affectionately
+on her shoulder. By the glad, uplifted look
+upon her face, we knew that she was deeply moved.</p>
+
+<p>By-and-bye she spoke gravely, almost solemnly.</p>
+
+<p>“Sister! Barbara! is it not strange that, after all, my
+passionate desire to do something for the King has been
+gratified? Do you not see the hand of God in it? What
+led us to ride in the direction of Burntisland this evening,
+when we might as easily have gone the other way? What
+prompted me to ask for Janet Spiers’ gudeman, who, I
+knew, had lost his cough a month since; and above all,
+what induced the woman to talk to us about that little
+ship? Oh, will it not be wonderful if, by my means, the
+Government Army is defeated, and the Country turned so
+loyal that when the King comes home he will have
+nothing to do but ride to Holyrood and receive the
+loving homage of a united people.” She waved her hands
+in a sort of delighted ecstasy, and ended with a laugh so
+joyous that we were fain to join with her.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_124">[124]</span></p>
+
+<p>“God grant your beautiful dream comes true, my Betty!”
+cried my lady, kissing her. “’Twas well thought out, your
+plan, and can hardly fail. My brother is the man to
+attempt the enterprise, and seeing that arms and ammunition
+are the things most needed, he will move heaven and
+earth to get them. Let us think now of David Pitcairn
+riding through the night, and pray that no harm may befall
+him.”</p>
+
+<p>“Dear, faithful David!” murmured Betty. “I would
+trust him with all I possess.”</p>
+
+<p>“Except yourself!” said my lady slyly.</p>
+
+<p>“I do not possess myself, sister!” said Betty, somewhat
+sharply. “Let us go to bed and try to sleep off some of
+our excitement. It will soon be Sunday morning, and I
+fear Mr. Pitcairn will have but an inattentive listener in
+me, if I am calm enough to go to Kirk to-morrow.”</p>
+
+<p>And soon after we parted, and went to bed with our
+various thoughts and dreams.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_125">[125]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XV">
+ CHAPTER XV
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>IN WHICH BETTY AND BARBARA BEHAVE VERY FOOLISHLY</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>And now I am going to relate an adventure so foolish and
+freakish that, looking back upon it from the standpoint of
+discreet years, I cannot but wonder how my friend Betty
+ever thought of proposing it, or how Barbara could be so
+ready to join in it. But I fear it has been in all ages, and
+will continue to be so, that young girls take delight in
+doing many things which in after years they regard as impossible,
+and which they would certainly prevent their own
+daughters from doing if they could. And so the world
+goes on, and each must sow her little crop of experiences,
+and reap her own harvest of wisdom, or mourn over the
+doubtful fruits of folly.</p>
+
+<p>That our folly brought forth no great bitterness was due
+to the kindness of Providence, rather than to any credit of
+our own. Indeed, while I condemn my own act in yielding
+to Betty’s request, I cannot but remember our adventure
+with a warm stirring at my heart, for a certain thing
+happened then that had an after-effect upon my whole life.</p>
+
+<p>It was upon Saturday night, you will remember, that
+David Pitcairn left us to ride to Perth, and the next day
+being Sunday, we had much ado to attune our hearts and
+minds to the sacred duties of the day, for our thoughts
+would fly to the Earl of Mar’s army, and back again to the
+little ship outside Burntisland harbour. While we all felt
+the strain of an anxious and almost sleepless night, my
+poor Betty’s nervous tremors were pitiful to behold, the
+more so that such a condition was very foreign to her
+nature, and quite unlike her wonted liveliness. My lady,
+who was ever a fragile, delicate woman, had so great a
+control over herself that she appeared at times the stronger
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_126">[126]</span>
+of the two; but so sympathetic was she towards her sister
+that I feared at times they might betray themselves.</p>
+
+<p>Anxious or not, it behoved us all to go to church, and to
+bear ourselves as if nothing unusual were afoot. But I fear
+that the pious and learned discourse of good Mr. Pitcairn
+bore little fruit in our hearts that day. We were waiting
+we knew not for what, and even among ourselves had little
+to say save interjections of wonder and longing.</p>
+
+<p>It seemed as if the day would never pass. After dinner
+we took the little boys to the rocks below the wood, Phemie
+being gone to church, and there told them tales and let
+them play quietly. But as the afternoon waned, a strong
+wind rose and blew from the north-west, and as it grew
+colder and colder we made a retreat to the house.</p>
+
+<p>As I descended from my room to supper I heard the
+sound of the turret door opening, and light steps coming up
+the twisted stairway made me pause to see who was there.</p>
+
+<p>It was Betty, her cheeks rosy with the cold, her hair
+wind-tossed, her eyes bright. When she saw me she
+laughed and clutched my hand.</p>
+
+<p>“Come to my room directly after supper!” she
+whispered. “I have a little thing to tell you.”</p>
+
+<p>It was evident that something had happened to raise her
+drooping spirits, and my lord nodded approval when he
+heard her laugh as we sat down to table, while my dear
+lady looked pleased though surprised to see that her sister’s
+appetite had returned. For myself, I could scarce swallow
+a bite, being in a state of excitement half fearful, half
+pleasant, throughout the meal, not being able to fix in my
+mind upon any possible reason for her recovered gaiety.
+I waited with the utmost impatience till we were closeted
+together in Betty’s room, and then demanded eagerly what
+had happened.</p>
+
+<p>She laughed a gay, reckless little laugh, and drew me
+down upon the settee beside her. “Nothing has happened
+yet, my little Barbe,” she cried, “but something is going to
+happen soon. Look you, child,” she went on more
+seriously, “I am about to ask a great thing of you, and if
+you are doubtful, or afeared, tell me now and I will say no
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_127">[127]</span>
+more. Can you undergo some discomfort, run some risks,
+and trust yourself to me for a few hours? Tell the truth
+sincerely.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, Betty,” I cried, “you know I love you dearly,
+and would do a good deal to pleasure you, but is it fair to
+make me give my promise without telling me what you
+would be at?”</p>
+
+<p>She looked at me a moment in silence. “You do not
+answer me as David did,” she said slowly.</p>
+
+<p>“Frankly, dear Betty, is there anyone else in the world
+who would?” I asked smiling.</p>
+
+<p>“You are growing up mighty fast, Barbara,” was all she
+answered, and for a few moments she sat in silence.</p>
+
+<p>“Hark ye, my dear,” she roused herself to say, “I mean
+to trust you. I cannot bear one hour longer of this
+suspense than I can help, and I mean to ride forth at daybreak,
+and find out, if possible, what has taken place at
+Burntisland.”</p>
+
+<p>“At daybreak?” I cried, incredulous, “but why not
+wait till after breakfast?”</p>
+
+<p>“And have all the world know?” she answered. “Why,
+Barbara, we must not be seen. There is always the possibility
+that some wind may carry the news to Stirling,
+where my Lord of Argyle and his dragoons lie in wait. What
+would be easier for them than to intercept the Master and
+his Command, either on their way hither, or on the return
+journey? You see I know nothing, and this ignorance is
+torture to me. If David is returned he is probably as
+ignorant of what happened after he left Perth as I am.
+My brother may have started at once, and may be busy
+even now at the harbour, or he may have waited till the
+dusk fell, and be at this moment on the road. In that
+case I may just see him to-morrow, which would be a consolation
+in itself, and get a word of approbation from him
+for my part in this affair, which of course no one else must
+know.”</p>
+
+<p>I suppose I looked as doubtful as I felt, for she went on
+persuasively.</p>
+
+<p>“I only wish for your company, my dear; there is
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_128">[128]</span>
+naught for you to do. Michael, the groom, will ride with
+us, and if necessary be our protector. I want to see for
+myself what has been done, and to find out about my
+brother. We shall wear masks and hoods, but indeed if
+any strangers are about the town they will be those busy
+with the boats, and the townsfolk would never think of
+molesting us.”</p>
+
+<p>“When do you mean to start?” I asked, with a sigh
+and a smile together.</p>
+
+<p>At that she kissed me and called me her dear, and her
+kind obliging friend, and promised me all manner of
+favours, including her abiding love, which was the only one
+I cared about. Then she told me how she had already
+arranged everything, hoping, nay believing, that I would
+be as agreeable as she had always found me. At four of
+the clock we were to rise and dress, and slipping down the
+turret-stair, let ourselves out by the door already mentioned.
+Michael was instructed to lead the horses quietly, one by
+one, outside the gate, so that those in the house should
+not be roused by the sound of our starting. She had
+placed a pitcher of milk outside her window on the sill to
+keep it fresh, and she had carried some bread up from the
+supper-table, so that in the morning we should not ride
+out fasting. When all was expounded, she promised to
+awaken me lest I should lie too late, and bade me go
+straight to bed, and to sleep soundly.</p>
+
+<p>In the dark chill hour before the dawn, with the stars
+still shining in the sky, and a cold wind stinging our faces
+and whipping the black waters of the Frith into foamy
+crests, I own I did not think so well of the expedition;
+but Betty possessed what few women have—determination
+enough to carry a project through in spite of every obstacle,
+and as I had committed myself to her guidance, I rode on
+beside her in dogged disregard of discomfort, while Michael,
+the groom, jogged in the rear.</p>
+
+<p>Just before we came in sight of the town she drew near
+to me and, speaking in her most persuasive tones, divulged
+what was really the most important part of her enterprise.</p>
+
+<p>“I have been thinking,” said she, “that were we to draw
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_129">[129]</span>
+near the town on horseback, we should attract too much
+attention. Gentlewomen are not given to riding abroad at
+this hour; so, Barbara, if you do not mind, we will dismount
+by yonder dyke, and Michael will hold the horses
+under cover of it for half-an-hour or so, while we go quickly
+into the town to see and hear what we can. What say
+you, my dear?”</p>
+
+<p>Knowing that whatever I said ’twould make little
+difference, and being too loyal to allow her to go alone, as
+well as too timorous to stay behind, I murmured my agreement
+with her plan; and a few minutes later we dismounted,
+and adjusting our masks, and drawing our plaids about us,
+head and shoulders, in such a way that it were impossible
+for anyone to know us for gentle or simple, we advanced
+quickly towards the opening of the street which was at that
+moment silent and empty.</p>
+
+<p>As we came near a corner we heard the steps and voices
+of approaching men, and without a moment’s hesitation
+we drew into the shadow of a doorway and waited for them
+to pass. To our dismay, however, they paused close by our
+hiding-place, and continued their conversation in voices
+that betrayed to us that they were well-to-do townsfolk.</p>
+
+<p>“Ay!” said one, “’tis a sad mischance for poor Jock
+Wilson, but I would ha’ thought the loon had as muckle
+sense as to ken what he was aboot. It looks a’most as if
+he’d left his ship and a’ it contained, just for anyone that
+liked to help himsel’.”</p>
+
+<p>“Man!” said the other, “’twas a gran’ venture! To
+come a’ the way frae Perth in the night, and hae the work
+done afore folks were oot o’ their beds. He’s a dour man,
+the Maister o’ Sinclair, but when there’s a thing tae be
+done, he’s the man for it. But I’m wonderin’, Andrew, hoo
+the deevil he cam’ tae hear o’ Jock Wilson’s boat. He
+hasna been at Dysart this week back and mair, and the
+thing wasna kent afore yestreen.”</p>
+
+<p>“Weel, weel!” said the first, “the Cause has its friends
+in the Kingdom o’ Fife if anywhere in Scotland, and there’s
+ways and means o’ getting knowledge. The Government
+made nae secret of what they were aboot, but they didna
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_130">[130]</span>
+reckon on Mistress Wilson’s lyin’-in. That was the cause
+o’ the mischief, Jamie; a wumman at the bottom o’t, as
+usual.” And with a laugh at his own jest the speaker
+moved on up the street, while his companion entered the
+house exactly opposite to our doorway. Betty drew near
+me and seized my arm.</p>
+
+<p>“You heard, Barbara,” she whispered; “the thing has
+succeeded. My brother came from Perth early this morning,
+and is even now busy at the harbour. Oh, how I wish I
+could see him, if only to tell him how proud I am of his
+achievement! Come, child, I must go on! No one will
+molest us, there will be other women about by this time,
+and I fancy the town is too excited over what has taken
+place to have room for notice of us.”</p>
+
+<p>Quickly we stole into the street and hurried on. We
+met some people and heard snatches of talk, but no one
+spoke to us, though one or two eyed us curiously. Suddenly,
+on rounding a corner, we found ourselves in an open space
+in which were a number of people, all talking excitedly
+and in loud voices. Involuntarily we stopped, and in
+turning round to retrace our steps we collided with a young
+gentleman who was moving in our direction. He was
+dressed in uniform, and looked as if he had but just
+staggered out of the adjoining tavern, as indeed he had.</p>
+
+<p>“Beg pardon, my dear,” he said in a thick voice, lurching
+near us and trying to peer under the folds of our plaids.
+“Hullo! masks, by Jove! Who’d ha’ thought it at this
+hour?” and he looked first at Betty and then at me, as if
+not certain whether to hold us or to let us pass.</p>
+
+<p>“Excuse me, sir,” said Betty, in her haughtiest tone.
+“Can you direct me to the Master of Sinclair?”</p>
+
+<p>“Sinclair, by gad! Direct you to Sinclair? No, I
+can’t, and I wouldn’t if I could. Blesh my life, why
+should I? Sinclair’s done nothing for me; rather keep
+you to myself, my chuck.”</p>
+
+<p>No words can express the horror that crept over me
+at this man’s look and tone. I had seen often enough a
+gentleman in his cups. ’Twas not thought so much of a
+disgrace as to be a matter of great concern to a woman.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_131">[131]</span>
+But though I instinctively shrank from any man when
+fuddled and bemused with wine, never in my life had
+the like condition aroused in me such a sense of loathing.
+His eyes were heavy, yet insolent; his face was flushed,
+and his loose lips wore a foolish smile. His words, as
+they dropped from his slippery tongue, now came in a
+rush, now halted painfully; and his breath, which was
+foul with wine, sickened me as he puffed it in my face.</p>
+
+<p>“If you cannot be civil, sir,” cried Betty, enraged, but
+not the least dismayed, “pray, let us pass.”</p>
+
+<p>“Don’ want to let you pass,” stammered our tormentor.
+“Too lovely, by half! Come, lift your mask, my dear.
+Ball’s over, ’s time to sup.” And with that he advanced
+to seize her; but Betty quickly slipping on one side, the
+creature lost his balance and fell prone in the mud. In
+falling, he clutched hold of my plaid, and, dragging it
+off my head, dislodged my mask, which broke from its
+fastening and fell at my feet. Not wishing to escape at
+the expense of leaving my warm covering in the hands
+of this wretch, and unable to wrench it from his grasp,
+I stood still and called piteously to Betty, who had sped
+a little way along the street, believing me close behind
+her. In terror lest she should get out of sight, and still
+more lest the man should succeed in rising to his feet, I
+was standing thus, my heart beating in my throat, my
+head bare, and tears of fright in my eyes, when another
+officer stepped out of the tavern-door, and stared in
+amazement at the figures before him.</p>
+
+<p>Only for a moment did he remain inactive (while I,
+with a curious throb of relief, realised that a helper was
+at hand), then, as if reading the whole in my white and
+horror-stricken face, he strode towards us, and, with a
+sharp rap of his cane, loosed the hold of those rude hands
+upon my dress. Standing stiff and tall above his recumbent
+comrade, he asked in a very stern voice, “What
+does this mean, Mr. Wallace?”</p>
+
+<p>The other struggled to his feet; but his fall, instead
+of sobering him, appeared to have left him still more
+fuddled, and also a little aggressive.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_132">[132]</span></p>
+
+<p>“I say, Tony,” he muttered, “tha’s my prize. Wha’
+d’ you want here? No, by Jove, ’s the other one I
+want—the brown-haired filly, where’s she gone? Asked
+for the Master of Sinclair, she did. Pretty game, that, for
+his Mastership to play, making assin—assig—nashus with
+lovely ladies—six ’clock in the morning—”</p>
+
+<p>“You fool!” broke in Betty’s voice, and I found her
+at my elbow. “The Master of Sinclair is my brother.
+Perhaps you, sir, if you are not also drunk at six o’clock
+in the morning, can direct me to him.”</p>
+
+<p>The officer saluted her with grave respect. “I have
+had the honour of being presented to you, Mistress
+Sinclair,” he said, “at the house of the Earl of Wigton.
+My name is Anthony Fleming, and I am very much at
+your service.”</p>
+
+<p>Betty gave a gasp of relief.</p>
+
+<p>“I remember you very well, Mr. Fleming,” she said,
+“now that I have time to look at you, and I am grateful
+to you for appearing thus opportunely to our help. Can
+you tell me whether my brother is still in the town?
+Having heard a rumour of his coming from Perth last
+night, my friend and I—let me present you to Mistress
+Barbara Stewart—rode over this morning to have speech
+with him, and I was asking this <i>gentleman</i> to direct
+me to him, when he forgot himself.”</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Wallace was now standing somewhat sheepishly
+with his back against the wall of the house, and Betty
+glanced at him scornfully and turned away. As for me,
+I was still trembling, and the tears which I had before
+restrained kept brimming to my eyes.</p>
+
+<p>“Madam,” said Mr. Fleming, and his eyes sought
+mine with a kind and pitying glance, “I cannot sufficiently
+express my regret for the annoyance and trouble
+you have had, and my brother-officer will, I am sure,
+think and say the same when he is come to himself. I can
+only, in his name, humbly beg your pardon. I fear your
+friend is still suffering. If there is anything I could do—”</p>
+
+<p>“If you will direct us to my brother,” cried Betty,
+impatiently, “’tis all I ask now.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_133">[133]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Madam,” said he, “I greatly regret that that is
+impossible. The Master of Sinclair, after some splendid
+work, which I should like to tell you of if there were
+time, quitted the town soon after four o’clock, and,
+having left Mr. Wallace and myself in command of some
+troopers he has installed in the Castle, is already well
+on his way back to Perth.”</p>
+
+<p>Betty’s face fell at this, although his words had pleased
+her. She was about to reply when a great crowd of
+turbulent people, sailors and fishermen, accompanied by
+women of the lowest sort, came reeling down the street
+with shouts and laughter. Some of the men hustled me
+rudely aside, whereupon Mr. Fleming sprang to my
+assistance, and, putting his arm round my shoulders,
+stood thus to protect me until the crowd had passed.</p>
+
+<p>“Pray, take us out of this, Mr. Fleming,” cried Betty
+imploringly. “Right sorry am I that I ever brought
+myself or my companion into such a mess; but I cannot
+be too thankful that you found us. Come, Barbara, I
+am ready to go home and confess my sins and eat any
+amount of humble-pie.”</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Anthony Fleming bent down to look at my face
+before he freed me from his protecting arm. “Are you
+able to walk, madam?” he enquired very kindly. “Will
+you not lean upon my arm?” But so comforting and
+strength-giving had been his support that I was able to
+smile back at him and assure him I felt perfectly well.
+He helped me to adjust my plaid, and upon Betty’s
+informing him where we should find our horses, in a
+very few minutes he had us clear of the town, and was
+walking between us along the open road.</p>
+
+<p>“Tell me now, if you please, sir,” cried Betty, “what
+my brother has been doing, and what brought him from
+Perth in such haste?” for, as she told me later, she did
+not wish it to be known that she had had a hand in
+the matter.</p>
+
+<p>“You must know, madam,” said our guide, “that
+yesterday, very early in the morning, the Master of
+Sinclair was called out to the South Inch to see a certain
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_134">[134]</span>
+messenger, who had ridden all night from this place to
+inform him that there was a ship lying in the Frith
+containing arms and ammunition from the Castle of
+Edinburgh which had been shipped at Leith, to be sent
+north for the use of the Earl of Sutherland. The master
+of this vessel, he was told, was come ashore to see his
+family, and did not intend to put to sea for another
+four-and-twenty hours. Here was a chance, if the right
+man could be found, to supply ourselves with weapons
+and bullets, of which we stand greatly in need. Your
+brother was fired by the notion, and, bidding his friend
+rest, and return home privately, keeping the matter secret,
+he went off to the Earl of Mar and acquainted him with
+the story. I must own that my lord delayed some
+hours in issuing the order, and I, meeting the Master
+of Sinclair at one Hardy’s, a vintner in Perth, he told
+me what was toward, and said that if he got the Command
+he hoped that I would ride with him. Finally, the order
+being given in writing at last, we left the town by five
+o’clock, a company of fourscore horse. We came by
+cross-roads and by-paths, avoiding towns and villages,
+and got here a little after midnight. The Master posted
+sentries about the town to avoid surprises, and himself
+went to the harbour and very easily seized some of the
+boats there. In these we rowed out to the ship and,
+though the wind and tide were against us, succeeded in
+bringing her in. Your brother, madam, stood in the water
+up to the middle of the leg and received the arms into his
+own hands. Of these there were but three hundred—”</p>
+
+<p>“Three hundred!” cried Betty, so sharply that I feared
+she would betray herself.</p>
+
+<p>“Three hundred wanting one,” continued Mr. Fleming,
+“and we had expected two or three thousand. ’Twas a
+great disappointment I must own; but later we seized the
+arms of another big ship in the harbour, and took also
+those of the Town-guard, and as they are now lodged, with
+the ammunition we got, in the Castle which we are left to
+guard, I think you may be satisfied with your brother’s
+work, madam.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_135">[135]</span></p>
+
+<p>“I wish there had been more,” she murmured discontentedly.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, madam, so do we; but ’tis better than nothing,
+and when the news of the Master’s exploit is brought to the
+King, I’ll wager his Majesty will be prodigiously pleased.”</p>
+
+<p>By this we had reached the rough dyke behind which
+our steeds were ambushed, and were preparing to mount.
+Betty, who had listened to Mr. Fleming’s words with a
+smile of approval, gave him her hand with a grateful look.</p>
+
+<p>“His Majesty knows how to appreciate all his faithful
+subjects,” she said softly, “and among them I am glad to
+count Mr. Anthony Fleming.”</p>
+
+<p>He bowed over her hand before raising it to his lips.
+Betty was looking her brightest, I noticed, in spite of the
+cold, the agitation, the fatigue, while Barbara, I felt sure,
+was at her worst; and I remember regretting to have been
+seen at a disadvantage by this particular gentleman, who,
+although he had been unknown to me half-an-hour before,
+seemed more of a friend than many with whom I was well
+acquainted.</p>
+
+<p>“I count it a special mercy,” said Betty, as we rode
+away, “that we fell in with that young man. Do you not
+think there is something very attractive in his face?”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, yes,” cried Barbara, quickly. “I am sure it is
+the kindest face in the world.”</p>
+
+<p>And from that day to this she has seen no reason to
+alter her opinion.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_136">[136]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XVI">
+ CHAPTER XVI
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>TELLS OF VARIOUS MATTERS TO BE FOUND IN THE
+ HISTORY-BOOKS, AND OF A ROMANTIC TALE
+ WHICH IS NOT</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>I have often thought that our mad escapade would not
+have been passed over so lightly had the news we brought
+been less satisfactory. My lord was never, I believe, made
+aware of the depths of our folly, and only to my dear lady
+did I dare to relate our morning’s adventures, and from her
+received the chiding I so richly deserved. To one other
+was the affair confided by Betty, namely, to David Pitcairn.
+She told him in my presence the same afternoon, and
+greatly was I astonished to see him so much roused. For
+a moment or two he could scarcely speak, and it was some
+time before we were able to understand the reason of his
+displeasure. When at last ’twas explained, I felt that he
+had reason on his side, and even Betty appeared struck
+by his words.</p>
+
+<p>He had accomplished his task on the Saturday night
+without hindrance, arriving in Perth early on Sunday
+morning, and arranging, as we knew, an interview with the
+Master. He now told us that, after the latter had acquainted
+the Earl of Mar with the good tidings, my lord expressed
+a desire to see for himself the bearer of them, and the
+Master of Sinclair had followed Mr. Pitcairn about the
+town until he could set his lordship’s wishes before him.
+At first our friend David demurred, saying he could tell my
+lord no more than he had already divulged, but finally he
+consented, and was borne to the Earl’s presence; but beyond
+the fact that my lord had received him graciously, and
+asked him a number of questions as to the size of the ship
+and the quantity of arms on board, we got little out of him
+on that point.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_137">[137]</span></p>
+
+<p>“He asked me,” said David, “if it were possible to ride
+from Perth to Burntisland avoiding towns and villages, and
+when I told him yes, ‘Then,’ said he, ‘will you act as
+guide to the convoy?’ But upon my informing him that
+the Master of Sinclair and Mr. Malcome knew the country
+every whit as well as I, he said, ‘Very well, perhaps there
+was no need of a guide.’”</p>
+
+<p>David left Perth at ten o’clock, and having rested for
+some hours at the house of a friend about half-way home,
+was able to join the expedition when it was within three
+miles of its goal. He was full of praise for the Master
+and for one or two of the gentlemen who accompanied
+him, among whom it pleased me to hear him mention
+Mr. Fleming, but the rabble they commanded were, he
+said, some of the worst that could be imagined. Sentries
+were placed about the town, but no sooner were the
+officer’s backs turned, than these undisciplined Highlanders
+left their posts and scampered off to the taverns and
+wine-shops, and there had ensued such rioting and
+confusion as had made of the town a perfect pandemonium.
+How we had escaped much worse injury and
+insult than we suffered he could not imagine, “except,” as
+he said, with a look at Betty both angry and tender, “it
+was true that a special Providence guarded daft folk and
+bairns.”</p>
+
+<p>Indeed I shuddered at some of the things he told us,
+among them the fact that the drunken men, upon being
+called to order by their officers, the latter narrowly escaped
+being shot by these wretches, many of whom could not
+understand a word of any language but the Gaelic.</p>
+
+<p>“I thank my stars,” said David, “that I have nothing
+to do with such a crew, and since they left the town in the
+morning we have heard sad tales of their raiding the
+country-side, and plundering the poor folk on their way
+back to Perth.”</p>
+
+<p>I cannot but say that our spirits were much dashed by
+this intelligence, and our triumph did not seem quite so
+brilliant as it had appeared that morning. For some hours
+after it left me sad, and Betty very thoughtful.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_138">[138]</span></p>
+
+<p>But events were hurrying forward, and in the next few
+days much was accomplished for the Cause. We heard
+with delight that the Master of Sinclair had been sent into
+Fife with a body of horse, both to seize any arms that
+could be found, and also to set up the King’s Standard in
+the small towns round the coast. This he accomplished
+with ease, beginning at Cupar, and going from St. Andrews
+to Kirkcaldy, he took possession of each town in the name
+of the King, thus making our party masters of the whole of
+the north coast of the Firth of Forth. To the grief and
+chagrin of Betty, her brother did not present himself at
+home for more than a passing call of a few minutes, so
+that she was not able to hear nor to give any news. But
+to our great joy, Sir John, who was riding in the Master’s
+Command, decided to return to Dysart instead of proceeding
+at once to Perth, and surprised us by appearing one
+evening about supper-time, well and hearty and with news
+to tell.</p>
+
+<p>It was from him that we learned of the designed project
+of sending a large body of men across the Frith to the
+Lothians, so that they might march south, and eventually
+join the rising in Northumberland.</p>
+
+<p>’Twould take too long were I to tell you of the exciting
+days that followed, while boats were chartered in all the
+small fishing villages, and secretly brought to Crail from
+whence the crossing was to start. Mr. Harry Crawford it
+was that had the bringing of the boats together, and as
+there were upwards of two thousand men to be conveyed,
+you can imagine that the task was no light one. Now as
+there were several ships of war lying at Leith, and the
+custom-house smacks were constantly moving about in the
+Frith, my Lord of Mar ordered that a small number of
+men should march to Burntisland and make a feint of
+embarking there, to attract the attention of the Government
+boats. Meanwhile, protected by a screen of Cavalry under
+the command of Sir John Erskine and Sir James Sharp,
+the main body got off under cover of night, from Crail and
+Elie and Pittenweem. As a certain number were obliged
+to wait till the next night, however, the design was made
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_139">[139]</span>
+known by spies to the Government ships, which immediately
+set sail to intercept them. Fortunately a contrary wind
+detained them, so that only one of our boats was taken,
+but several were forced to return to the coast of Fife.
+One company of three hundred men under command of
+my Lord Strathmore, with the Laird of Barafield as his
+Lieutenant, was obliged to land on the Isle of May, where
+they were detained for several days. When threatened by
+the ships of war, they made a most determined stand, and
+the young earl, himself scarce more than a schoolboy,
+behaved in a heroic manner. Not only did he hold his
+men in check when some of them were for surrendering,
+but he exhibited the greatest courage and self-denial during
+their detention; and when the opportunity came at length
+of getting off in boats to return to Crail, he was the last to
+leave the island. How our hearts kindled when we heard
+of his brave conduct from the Master, who had for this
+young nobleman an unbounded admiration.</p>
+
+<p>The success of this project, and the landing of our men
+on the coast of Haddington, threw the good people of
+Edinburgh into such a state of panic that the Lord Provost
+at once ordered out the City Guards, the Trained Bands,
+and the new Levies of Volunteers for the defence of the
+city and the prevention of any disturbance therein. He
+also took the precaution to send an express to the Duke of
+Argyle at Stirling, who without delay marched post-haste to
+the Capital accompanied by three hundred chosen dragoons.
+As the Highlanders, under the brave Brigadier Mackintosh,
+had marched to Leith and entrenched themselves in the old
+citadel there, his Grace, who had left his cannons, gunners,
+mortars and bombardiers all behind at Stirling, could do
+little to dislodge them, save calling upon them as rebels to
+lay down their arms and surrender, upon pain of High
+Treason. This they very resolutely refused to do, and the
+Duke not being able to make a better of it, retired to
+Edinburgh to begin preparations.</p>
+
+<p>Mackintosh, however, having managed to send off two
+letters to my Lord Mar, by the cunning expedient of
+pretending to fire upon the boats that bore them, as though
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_140">[140]</span>
+he mistook them for the enemy, that nobleman ordered a
+body of horse under command of my Lord of Drummond
+to march from Perth upon Stirling, so as to draw, if possible,
+the Duke of Argyle from pursuit of the Highlanders in the
+Lothians. As the Master of Sinclair was one of that party,
+we heard later of how the matter was carried out, how they
+rode in heavy rain and bitter cold to Dunblane, did
+nothing there, and marched back to Perth on hearing of
+the arrival of Argyle at Stirling. I have no doubt, knowing
+my lady’s brother so well, that he did his best to set them
+right in no very agreeable way; howbeit I have heard since
+then some trenchant remarks on the supine behaviour of
+the Earl of Mar on this occasion, so I am aware that the
+Master was not angry altogether without cause. A General
+with more self-confidence, it was said, would have occupied
+Stirling ere the Duke had time to reach it. As for
+Mackintosh of Borlum, he entrenched himself first at
+Seton House, where he remained some days; but shortly
+afterwards, having received answers to his letters from my
+Lord Mar, he pushed on towards Kelso, and later as you
+know, crossed over into England. An incident took place
+on his march south which, coming to the ears of my Lady
+Erskine, greatly grieved her. This was the plundering of
+Hermiston House, the seat of her uncle, Dr. Sinclair, who
+had incurred the resentment of the Jacobite party very
+early in the rising. The fierce old Brigadier would even
+have set fire to the place, but being dissuaded from this
+extreme measure by some of the gentler spirits, he gave
+permission to the Highlanders to sack the house, who
+readily plundered it of every valuable thing that could be
+carried away. Such strange and vexatious doings take
+place in a country when it is divided against itself.</p>
+
+<p>The events which I have mentioned took place rapidly
+one after another, but did not in any way affect our lives at
+Dysart, save that from early morn till late night we existed
+in a turmoil of excitement, never knowing what should
+transpire, and expecting all manner of wonderful things to
+happen, from the arrival at our door of King James himself,
+to the willing abdication of King George in London.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_141">[141]</span></p>
+
+<p>One morning, however, a despatch was brought to my
+lady, which proved to be from Sir John in Perth, in which
+he recommended her to leave her father’s house and return
+to Alva, where, he said, were many things requiring her
+care. This my lady, at all times ready to obey her lord,
+was very willing to do, and although it grieved us all to
+leave our kind friends at Dysart, we knew that our visit,
+already lengthy, could not last for ever. By order of the
+Earl of Mar, as Sir John writ in his letter, an officer from
+the garrison at Burntisland Castle, with a small company,
+was to escort my lady’s carriage all the way to Alva, in
+order to prevent, as he said, any surprise or discourtesy
+from the Dragoons of Argyle who constantly patrolled the
+roads; and although the precaution turned out to be wholly
+unnecessary, my lady was flattered by the attention, and
+pleased at the kindness of the thought.</p>
+
+<p>The officer told off for this honorary duty was, to my
+great relief, our friend, Mr. Anthony Fleming.</p>
+
+<p>“What should I have felt,” I murmured to Betty, on his
+arrival at the door of the Hermitage, “had it been Mr.
+Wallace?”</p>
+
+<p>“Less confidence in the security of your journey than
+you do now, I suppose,” was her shrewd reply. “But I am
+grieved that our good friend should be soaked to the skin,
+while the other is warm and dry in barracks.”</p>
+
+<p>The season had indeed set in very wet, and our chief
+difficulty in returning to Alva lay in the badness of the
+roads which made our progress extremely slow. The
+rain poured down without ceasing, and several times
+our heavy coach stuck fast in the clogging mud; and
+our escort, instead of keeping the enemy at bay with
+swords and pistols, were obliged to dismount, and by dint
+of their united strength extricate us from the ruts. At such
+times we inside the coach could hear Mr. Fleming’s firm,
+pleasant voice as he directed and encouraged his men, and
+once he rode up to the carriage window to apologise to
+my lady for the delay.</p>
+
+<p>This civility struck her as so unnecessary that she
+laughed very heartily as she replied, “Nay, my dear Mr.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_142">[142]</span>
+Fleming, I feel rather that it is my place to apologise to
+you for obliging you to employ your soldiers in so trivial a
+manner. Confess that you would rather they should encounter
+half a hundred dragoons, and rout them at the point
+of the sword!”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, madam,” he answered, with his kind eyes smiling
+at us both, “a soldier learns very early in his career to call
+nothing in the way of duty <i>trivial</i>. The rain is unavoidable,
+the roads are bad; let us trust the weather is too
+inclement to allow of Argyle’s scouts delaying us any
+further.”</p>
+
+<p>“That,” said my lady, as he turned away, “is a young
+man who will go far, if God spares his life through these
+turmoils. My lord speaks well of him, my dear husband
+regards him with affection, and even my brother, the
+Master, has nothing spiteful to say of him.”</p>
+
+<p>How my heart warmed at his praise perhaps it would be
+foolish to mention, for, as you will see, the young gentleman
+was at this time scarce even to be called an acquaintance.
+But ’tis true that some are our friends from the first look and
+word, and no thought but of kindness and sympathy ever
+enters our minds concerning them. Because of his timely
+help to me that morning in Burntisland, I looked upon Mr.
+Fleming with a peculiar feeling of respect and gratitude,
+with which was mingled an almost unconscious trust in his
+goodness and truth. That our instincts in these matters
+occasionally mislead us, many poor women have had bitter
+proof, but to you who know what my life has been, I do
+not require to say that in Barbara’s case no such mistake
+was made.</p>
+
+<p>“Mr. Fleming,” said I, “is kinsman to the Earl of
+Wigton, is he not, madam?”</p>
+
+<p>“Ay,” she answered, “he is, and but for an untoward
+accident would one day be in the Earl’s place.”</p>
+
+<p>“Indeed, madam,” cried I, more for the pleasure of
+hearing my friend spoke of, than from any great curiosity
+about his family. “What accident was that, pray?”</p>
+
+<p>“’Tis a romantic tale,” said my lady, “and sorrowful
+too, as romance is apt to be, but I will tell it you to beguile
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_143">[143]</span>
+the tedium of this weary road, seeing we cannot fall asleep
+like Phemie and my little sons.” And she eyed the
+sleeping children fondly.</p>
+
+<p>“You must know,” she went on, “that the present
+Earl’s grandfather had seven sons, of whom five died unmarried.
+William, the fifth son, succeeded his eldest
+brother John, whose only child was a daughter, Lady Jean,
+married to Lord Panmure. But the fourth brother,
+Tom, who died nearly fifty years ago, left a son who
+is the father of our friend here, Mr. Anthony. This Thomas,
+I have heard my lord say, was one of those pleasing but
+irresponsible persons who are said to be no one’s enemy
+but their own. He was handsome, gay, and clever, but
+selfish, thoughtless, and wanting in ballast. It seems he
+made the acquaintance of a young lady, the daughter of
+a respectable merchant in London, and either by false representations,
+or specious promises, induced her to run away
+with him, intending, as he solemnly averred afterwards, to
+make her his lawful wife at his earliest convenience. He left
+her after a few months in a small village in Hampshire, while
+he returned to London, and entered again into all his
+social pleasures; but letters passed constantly between
+them, and the forsaken girl seems to have believed
+thoroughly in his integrity, for she made no complaint to
+her family, being satisfied to trust and be patient. At last,
+however, she knew it would be fatal to delay further, and
+for the sake of her unborn child she wrote to her lover
+a passionate appeal desiring him to return at once and
+right her in the eyes of the world. There must have been
+something in this letter that touched the heart of Thomas
+Fleming, for directly upon receipt of it, he set off post-haste
+for Hampshire. But alas! within twenty miles of
+London his chaise was overturned, and he himself so badly
+injured that he was unable to pursue his journey. Being
+carried into a friendly house upon the road, he learned
+from the surgeon that he had not many hours to live.
+His grief and sorrow were great, not so much, as he said,
+for his own sake, though life was sweet to him, as for the
+sake of the woman who had trusted him, and the child
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_144">[144]</span>
+that he would never see. Whatever there was of good
+and noble in the poor man, came out in these last hours
+of his life. He implored those round him to send swift
+messengers first to his brother William, who fortunately
+at that time was living in London, and also to the father
+of the poor girl he had wronged. They obeyed the
+summons without delay, and were lucky enough to reach
+the house in time to hear his full confession, and to
+promise their help and protection to her who was in the
+sight of Heaven his wife. The poor father who was
+bowed down with grief ever since the loss of his daughter,
+was so touched with the genuine remorse and repentance
+of the dying man that he accorded him his forgiveness
+in a very Christian spirit, which allowed the other at least
+to die in peace.”</p>
+
+<p>“And what of the poor lady?” I asked, much moved
+by this tale of love and wrong. “Did she also forgive the
+wretch?”</p>
+
+<p>“Alas! my dear, she loved him,” said my lady.</p>
+
+<p>“But one is almost thankful to know that she did not live
+long to suffer the consequences of his perfidy. The shock of
+his death was too much for her, and three days after the
+birth of her little son she passed quietly away. She had
+the comfort, however, of knowing that her child was safe
+in the care of his grandfather and uncle. The old Earl
+also, who was still alive, acknowledged the boy, and
+sanctioned his bearing the name, though to be sure the
+bar sinister prevents him ever inheriting the title. He
+carries on the business of his maternal grandfather in
+London, and is now a man of wealth and standing. He
+married the only daughter of a Suffolk baronet—a beauty
+and a fortune—and Anthony Fleming is their son.”</p>
+
+<p>The close of this interesting tale brought us to Tillicoultry,
+the little village nearest to Alva on the eastern
+side, and soon afterwards we found ourselves at home.</p>
+
+<p>We were received at the door by Mr. Peck, John Harley
+and Mr. Rose, all very glad and thankful to see my lady
+returned, for many untoward events were happening, and
+they had been sore perplexed how to conduct themselves
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_145">[145]</span>
+in her absence. The country-side was in a sad state it
+seemed, for the Government soldiers made free with the
+property of the inhabitants, no matter on which side their
+sympathies might be. Mr. Rose had already lost some
+considerable quantity of fodder, as well as numerous hens
+and ducks; also sheep and cattle not being safe in the
+fields, he had been obliged to drive them all within the
+enclosures near the house, and had men set to guard them
+night and day.</p>
+
+<p>“And indeed, my lady,” said Mr. Peck, “the enemy
+are so cautious and their plans so well-laid that the whole
+neighbourhood can do little against them, for they place
+their sentries so skilfully that not once have they been
+discovered nor surprised in their depredations.”</p>
+
+<p>This was not a cheerful aspect of things to be presented
+to us on our return home, and no doubt my lady’s heart
+sank as she realized what was before her. It was not however
+her way to sit down and bemoan her troubles, and she
+busied herself in giving orders for the comfort of our
+rain-drenched escort, who were to rest for some hours at
+Alva before taking the road back to Burntisland. Indeed,
+as the rain had somewhat abated and it promised to be a
+clear moonlight night, Mr. Fleming remarked that, with
+her ladyship’s permission, the later they were of starting
+the better. With this my lady agreed, and on her telling
+the young gentleman that she would be glad of his company
+at supper, we dispersed to our various occupations and
+duties.</p>
+
+<p>A little before the time for that meal, having arranged
+the things in my chamber, and assisted Phemie in getting
+the children’s affairs in order, I came downstairs and
+entered the dining-hall, expecting to find my lady already
+there. The table was set, but the room was lit only by
+the flames from the coal-fire, which threw long shadows
+across the wall and ceiling. On entering the room I
+thought it had been empty, but as I turned to leave it, a tall
+form rose from the seat at the corner of the hearth, and
+Mr. Fleming’s voice spoke my name. I came forward
+again slowly.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_146">[146]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Will you not give me the pleasure of your company,
+Mistress Barbara,” he said, “for the few minutes before
+supper. Although this is the third time we have met, I do
+not think you have ever done me the honour to address
+me.”</p>
+
+<p>“Then, indeed, sir,” said I, forgetting my shyness,
+“you may well wonder at my manners. But it has been
+my great desire ever since our first troubled meeting, to
+offer you my heartfelt thanks for your kind assistance that
+morning.”</p>
+
+<p>He stood looking down at me very kindly, and yet his
+face bore an expression which I did not understand.</p>
+
+<p>“Were it not that it gave me the pleasure of an introduction
+to you, madam,” he said, “I could heartily wish
+that you had never needed it.”</p>
+
+<p>“Truly,” said I, “’twas not a pleasant experience, but I
+must own I brought it upon myself. ’Twas a madcap
+adventure at best, and since we have known more fully the
+risks we ran, both Mistress Betty and I have had the
+grace to be ashamed of our temerity.”</p>
+
+<p>“Indeed, the risks were much greater than you thought,”
+he answered gravely. “I can only be thankful that I
+arrived upon the scene when I did.”</p>
+
+<p>“I had never in my life been really frightened before,”
+said I, “but when I felt that man’s hot breath on my
+cheek as he fell, clutching my plaid with his hands, I
+thought I should have died of terror.”</p>
+
+<p>“Faugh!” exclaimed Mr. Fleming, “I cannot bear to
+think of it!”</p>
+
+<p>“And when I lifted my eyes and saw you,” I continued,
+but steps now sounded without, and a servant entered
+the room, bearing candles which he placed upon the board.
+I moved a little further from the fireplace, but Mr. Fleming
+made a step forward and stopped me.</p>
+
+<p>“Yes,” he said eagerly, “when you saw me—what
+then?”</p>
+
+<p>“I knew I need fear no longer,” said I simply.</p>
+
+<p>He took my hand and kissed it gravely.</p>
+
+<p>“That, madam, is a speech that any man may be proud
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_147">[147]</span>
+to hear from a woman. I thank you, and I shall never
+forget it.”</p>
+
+<p>Among those bidden to supper by my lady on this first
+night came Mr. James Hamilton, and as at this moment
+he entered the room his eyes lighted immediately on me,
+and he came smiling up to greet me.</p>
+
+<p>“Welcome back to Alva, Mistress Barbara Stewart!” he
+cried, bowing before me. “The winter is approaching, ’tis
+true, but you bring the light and warmth of summer in
+your train.”</p>
+
+<p>Now a few months back this fulsome speech would
+doubtless have pleased me well, and set me trying to answer
+the gentleman in the same vein, but to-night it seemed
+mere empty compliment—too blatant to be in good taste—and
+it vexed me that Mr. Fleming, who was standing near,
+should hear it. I tried to answer coldly, but Mr. Hamilton
+was at once too good-humoured and too conceited to
+believe himself snubbed; he therefore took my scorn for
+coquetry, and redoubled his attentions. Mr. Fleming, after
+waiting for some minutes, as if wishing to continue our
+conversation, evidently considered himself dismissed and
+strolled off to the other side of the room. As he was
+placed on my lady’s right hand at supper, and I sat at the
+other end of the table, I had no further opportunity of
+speaking to him, and was obliged to conceal my chagrin as
+best I might. Mr. Hamilton plied me with friendly
+questions, to which I made random answers, and before the
+end of the meal I fell so silent that my lady, believing me
+worn out, withdrew as soon as possible, taking me with her
+from the room. In the hall outside she kissed me kindly
+and bade me go at once to bed.</p>
+
+<p>Half-an-hour later, while I still lingered over my disrobing,
+I heard below the sounds of our escort departing.
+Softly I opened my casement, and having extinguished the
+taper, I leaned out. The moon was hidden and I could
+see but little. I heard the trampling of the horses, the
+gruff tones of the men, the jingling of the bridles, and an
+occasional laugh. Next came the voice of Mr. Fleming
+bidding my lady adieu, and his quick spurs ringing on
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_148">[148]</span>
+the stones of the court-yard. Then I heard the order to
+mount, the heavy swing of the men into their saddles, the
+horses’ hoofs striking the stones as the troop moved off into
+the night. The moon sailed out from behind the clouds,
+and just then their Captain turned and looked back at the
+house. In an agony of startled modesty I shrank away
+from the window, and crouched upon the floor until the
+sound of their going had died away. As I knelt to say my
+prayers, I remember wondering if I should ever see Mr.
+Anthony Fleming again—I believe I prayed that God
+would bless him whether I did or no.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_149">[149]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XVII">
+ CHAPTER XVII
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>SHOWS HOW WE ARE SWEPT INTO THE STREAM OF EVENTS</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>We had scarce been at home a day, when we seemed to
+be drawn into the current that was setting towards active
+warfare, whether we would or no.</p>
+
+<p>Not content with doing her best to guard her own
+property, my Lady Erskine was diligent to lend what help
+she could to our party in various ways. Having heard
+from her brother at Perth of an expedition being sent,
+under Major Graham, to levy a cess, as it was called, in
+Dunfermline, which, being a Whiggish town, was not too
+ready to pay taxes to King James, she sent out scouts from
+among her trusted servants, who were to pick up information
+in a private way, and had orders from her to act
+according to what they heard. My Lady Alva being much
+beloved by the country-folk, and on good terms with
+all her neighbours, her people had little difficulty in
+learning the doings of both parties, and acted with
+no little discretion in several emergencies. On this
+occasion the force from Perth made the mistake of taking
+their way among the hills so as to avoid the direct road,
+and in so doing passed “under the nose,” as the Master
+put it, of the small garrison placed by the Duke of
+Argyle in Castle Campbell above the little village of Dollar.
+The reason of this detour we were never able to understand,
+for, as a natural consequence, news of the expedition was
+immediately sent to the Duke at Stirling, who ordered
+Colonel Cathcart with a party of dragoons to start at once
+for the threatened town. This coming to my lady’s ears,
+she despatched a trusty servant on a fleet horse to warn
+Major Graham of the movements of the enemy; and we
+all awaited his return with some anxiety, which greatly
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_150">[150]</span>
+increased when three days had passed and the worthy man
+had not returned home. My lady was making up her
+mind to send a second messenger after the first, when early
+in the morning of the fourth day, poor Andrew arrived at
+the house, hungry and cold and much crest-fallen. Upon
+my lady bidding him into her presence, and asking the
+reason of his tardy return, he told a tale which caused
+his mistress much chagrin, and covered the narrator
+himself with confusion.</p>
+
+<p>Colonel Cathcart, it seems, had reached the town before
+him, but not caring to enter it until the middle of the
+night, he with his dragoons lay without the walls in the
+dark, sending spies hither and thither to bring him word
+as to how things were within. Into this watchful company
+poor Andrew, all unwittingly, fell; and while they did not
+ill-treat him they took from him his horse, and by dint of
+threats compelled him to act as guide to those who would
+enter the town. This they did about two o’clock in the
+morning, and as it seems the gentlemen were all abed,
+and the watch very carelessly kept, the enemy were among
+them before they were aware. Some few were killed, and
+Colonel Cathcart took eighteen gentlemen prisoners. He
+did not wait to follow up his success, but the result was
+the same as if he had done so, for the startled invaders
+waited not to reason or to fight, but fled from the place
+on horse or on foot until all were escaped in various
+directions. Our poor Andrew was carried back to Stirling
+by the dragoons, kept in durance for two nights and a day,
+and on disclosing his name and occupation was liberated
+early on the second morning and bidden to make his way
+home.</p>
+
+<p>I think I have never seen my lady so angry as she
+became upon the recital of this shameful tale. The carelessness
+and indifference of the King’s officers, sent upon
+so important a mission, appeared to her criminal in a high
+degree. Such waste of life and loss of property, where a
+little foresight and military precision would have saved all,
+rankled in her mind and set her brain and heart on fire.
+But angry as she was, it did not prevent her making the
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_151">[151]</span>
+attempt to save another party sent on a like errand, under
+Lord George Murray, a week or two later, and this time
+her interference was crowned with success. Our good
+Andrew was again her emissary; and he not only
+succeeded in reaching the town in time to warn Lord
+George of the approach of the dragoons, but made the
+attempt by his own observation to further benefit our
+party a little. He returned to Alva without delay, and in
+high disgust informed his mistress that his entry into
+Dunfermline had been all too easy, for not a single sentry
+was set, and no opposition was made, nor question put
+to the visitor. My lady shared the good man’s righteous
+indignation.</p>
+
+<p>“Are they <i>all</i> fools in my Lord Mar’s army?” she
+exclaimed in great vexation. “Sure, never was so much
+negligence shown, or such ignorance allowed to flourish.
+I heartily wish we might take an example by the enemy,
+who, as you know, place sentries in all the passages of the
+hills within two miles of this house, when taking away my
+corn and straw. This news of their carelessness shall
+reach the Earl’s ears before many hours are over, for I
+shall write a letter to my brother this very day, with the
+request to have it shown at headquarters.”</p>
+
+<p>Which she accordingly did, and sent it to the Master
+by a sure hand; but whether it produced the effect she
+desired, we had no opportunity of judging.</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>One afternoon in the beginning of November, having
+returned from walking abroad with Phemie and the little
+boys who were anxious to visit their favourite haunts
+before the winter set in, I found my dear Lady Erskine
+seated in her own room with a letter in her lap and the
+traces of tears upon her face. I ran to her, eager to know
+the reason of her grief, but she would not suffer me to
+condole with her.</p>
+
+<p>“Indeed, I am but a foolish woman, my dear,” she
+said with a smile, though her voice quivered, “and not
+fit to be the wife of an officer immersed in affairs. Here
+is Sir John sent off to France at very short notice, and
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_152">[152]</span>
+Heaven knows when we shall see him again! I ought to
+feel glad and proud that he is trusted with business of so
+great moment; but I must own the thought of being
+without him for so many weeks is very bitter to me.”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, and to me too, madam!” I cried foolishly. “The
+house is not the same without him. Pray, cousin, is this
+important business a secret, or may I know what it is?”</p>
+
+<p>“’Tis not to be talked of to all and sundry,” my lady
+replied, “but you may see here what he says for your
+own satisfaction,” and she gave me the letter, pointing to
+these words which Sir John had written. “<i>Having orders
+from Mar to presse the King’s coming, and the sending
+over officers, arms and ammunition, and in particular to
+inform Earl Bolingbroke how much all these are wanted.</i>”</p>
+
+<p>“An onerous task truly,” sighed my lady, “and I pray
+God he may succeed; and above all that he may be kept
+from harm, and brought safe back to us who love him.”</p>
+
+<p>“Amen!” cried I fervently, greatly impressed by the
+importance of Sir John’s mission, and realising full well my
+lady’s sorrow at being thus parted from her husband.</p>
+
+<p>“I think the heaviest end of my burden,” said she,
+“lies in the fact that under the circumstances his letters to
+me may be long delayed, and mine may never reach him.
+You see here he was despatched upon the 28th October,
+and ’tis now the 6th day of November, yet this letter has
+never left Britain. Situated as we are, Sir John being an
+agent in the Jacobite interests, he cannot trust his papers
+and despatches to the common post nor, can I address
+letters openly to him, who has reason for keeping his
+movements private. This, Barbara, I foresee, will constitute
+one of my worst troubles in the coming time. It is no
+little relief for one so indeterminate as myself to be able to
+pour out my difficulties on paper to him who is my best
+friend, and to be certain of receiving sympathy and counsel
+and safe advice in return.”</p>
+
+<p>“Sir John does not say when he will return, madam?”
+I asked.</p>
+
+<p>“Alas! child, he probably knows as little about that as
+we do. My only comfort is, that for the moment he is out
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_153">[153]</span>
+of danger, should the Earl of Mar decide to give battle as
+my brother in his last epistle gives a hint of.”</p>
+
+<p>“He talked of the Earl coming south did he not?”</p>
+
+<p>“Ay, he intends to cross over the Forth above Stirling
+into the Lowlands, and so march into England to join the
+friends there. My brother, to be sure, sees a hundred
+difficulties and dangers, the chief being the impossibility of
+making use of the fords in face of the enemy, for the Duke
+of Argyle has them very well guarded, and as we heard
+yesterday has cut the bridge of Doune which is the only
+way to reach them; how it will end, I know not. The
+country is already bare and destitute, and the poor folk
+reduced almost to beggary. They tremble at the rumours
+of a horde of wild Highlandmen being let loose upon them,
+for brave and loyal as the clansmen are, Barbara, they are
+a rough and undisciplined set, and were it for nothing else
+but to satisfy their hunger they must needs make raids
+upon many of the peaceful farms and cottages.”</p>
+
+<p>“Truly,” said I soberly, “civil war is a grievous thing,
+and the working out of King James’s Restoration is not quite
+the exciting romance I foolishly pictured it.”</p>
+
+<p>“They are to march from Perth by Dunning,
+Auchterarder and Dunblane,” said my lady, “so that we
+are luckily not in the direct route. But with several
+thousand horse and foot sweeping along in one direction,
+many will spread out over the hills and may even be
+diverted into this road to reach the south, should their
+passage of the Fords of Forth prove impossible. We can
+but take all precautions for the safety of the stockin’, and
+be you very careful, child, to keep close to the house these
+days lest any harm befall you.”</p>
+
+<p>Not the least of the troubles for the country folk at this
+time was the wintry weather which now began, for a frost
+so severe and so continuous set in, that their privations
+were greatly increased. On the night of the tenth there
+was a slight sprinkling of snow, which was only the forerunner
+of the heavy storms that all that winter continued
+to fall. Aunt Betty Erskine, who was with us, suffered
+much from the cold, which with the sad state of matters in
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_154">[154]</span>
+the country afforded her ample grounds for grumbling and discontent;
+but my lady bore it all with exemplary patience,
+her mind in truth being fully occupied with other matters.</p>
+
+<p>We were living in a state of expectation, not unmixed
+with dread, for no one knew what might take place next.</p>
+
+<p>My Lord Mar and his army could not, we judged,
+remain much longer inactive at Perth. Indeed there were
+already impatient voices heard condemning him for the lack
+of energy, or the excess of caution, which kept him from
+coming to issues with the Duke of Argyle. The latter nobleman
+was lodged in his own house at Stirling (the Earl of
+Stirling’s mansion, as it was still called, tho’ it had now
+belonged to the Argyle family for about fifty years) at the
+head of the Castle Wynd, and his forces lay in the King’s
+Park. His design was to prevent the Insurgents getting
+besouth Forth, and being a good General he kept himself
+well informed by his spies and scouts of all the
+movements going on at Perth.</p>
+
+<p>I need not tell you now, who are by no means ignorant
+of the history of your country, that the remembrance of
+those November days and all that occurred in them is
+fraught with humiliation to me. The Battle of Sheriffmuir
+has long ago become a word of scorn in the ears of Whig
+and Jacobite alike. The tears caused by its tragedy (for
+no battle is wanting in that element) were scarcely dried,
+ere the humour of it struck the common people, who,
+whatever our English friends may say (and I have often
+heard the Scots accused of melancholy and gloom) are not
+slow to perceive the comic side of a thing. It became the
+subject of much ribald rhyme, and the great men engaged
+on either side were not spared by the rhymsters. But
+without stopping to give you my comments on this unlucky
+affair, I will try to tell you what happened in our own small
+sphere, in which I well remember we experienced as much
+excitement, terror, anxiety and amazement, as if we had
+been witnesses of the entire drama.</p>
+
+<p>On Saturday afternoon, the 12th day of November, one
+of my lady’s messengers, who were posted secretly among
+the hills and on the roads, came in hot haste to say that a
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_155">[155]</span>
+mighty host, horse and foot, was on the road between
+Auchterarder and Dunblane. Scarcely had we realised
+the significance of these tidings, when another arrived with
+the news that the Duke of Argyle had marched out from
+Stirling about noon, and was also approaching Dunblane
+from the other side. What consternation ensued among us!
+Were they each aware, we wondered, of the other’s
+proximity, or would they fall upon each other without
+warning? My lady, whose faith in my Lord Mar’s skill as
+a General was not so great as she could have wished, felt
+tolerably certain that the meeting, if it occurred, would
+come as a surprise to their side at least. She therefore sent
+off a trusty man, a shepherd, swift of foot and well
+acquainted with the hills, to find her brother who was with
+the Earl, and deliver him a letter in which she gave him as
+much information as possible of Argyle’s movements. This
+the shepherd, Allan Maclean, had orders to deliver to the
+Master of Sinclair only if he found the army dangerously
+near Dunblane and all unwarned. The messenger
+despatched, my lady set us all to work, preparing food,
+baking bread, brewing cordials, looking out old garments,
+and in every way she could think of making ready for
+emergencies should a battle be fought in our neighbourhood.</p>
+
+<p>It was quite dark and about nine of the clock when
+Allan returned, not having reached Lord Mar’s army. He
+had been told by several of the country folk upon the roads
+that my Lady Kippendavie had already sent to warn them
+early in the afternoon, and the leaders had decided to
+bivouack for the night in a hollow place near the little
+village of Kinbuck. Here, as we were told afterwards by the
+Master, eight thousand men were packed into so small a
+space, that “it could not,” he wrote, “be properly said they
+had a front or a rear, more than it can be said of a barrel of
+herrings.” By the kindness of Providence it did not occur
+to my Lord of Argyle to plan an attack that night, otherwise,
+as our informant told us, the entire force might have
+been slaughtered almost before they could defend themselves.
+The horses were picketted in the small kailyards
+of two farm-houses, while the officers found quarters where
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_156">[156]</span>
+they could in house or barn. It was a bitter cold night,
+the frost being very hard, and many a time I waked to
+think of the poor men of both armies shivering under the
+stars. But such privations were common, I knew, in time
+of war, and worse would surely follow.</p>
+
+<p>The next day being Sunday, we rose with mingled
+feelings, not knowing what the day might bring forth.
+Very early came a lad with a message for my lady from
+the minister, to say that, “There wad be nae Sabbath the
+day.” This meant, as you know, that the church was not
+open, and that no services were held either at Alva or in
+any of the neighbouring parishes, the people all being gone
+out to <i>see the battle</i>. To my lady, ever of a serious and
+pious nature, this proceeding did not commend itself.</p>
+
+<p>“For where,” she asked, “was it more fitting we should
+spend our time, or carry our burdens on such a day, than
+into the House of God?”</p>
+
+<p>But as the ministers were gone after their flocks, no bells
+were rung and the church doors remained closed.</p>
+
+<p>As the hours wore on, we heard from time to time items
+of news which gave us some idea of the proceedings taking
+place within a few miles of the house. A spur of the
+Ochils, as you will remember, lies between Alva and
+Dunblane, but by climbing the hills a good view could be
+had of all the country round. On a clear winter day, such
+as this was, one could see for many miles, and it was plain
+to our watchers that about noon the two armies had met
+on the rising ground of Sheriffmuir and that the fighting
+had begun. The noise of the cannon and fusils was
+plain to be heard in the frosty air, and sent panic into
+our hearts, for we were new to the idea of war; and now
+that the worst had come, I, for one, was no more anxious
+for the destruction of the Government troops than of those
+on our own side. Oh, indeed I fear that little of the world’s
+fighting would have been done had it been left to the
+women to decide, and yet I know not in truth if they could
+have devised any better method for settling many difficulties.</p>
+
+<p>With my lady’s leave, I climbed the hill in company with
+Mr. Rose, the grieve, and sat there during the short
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_157">[157]</span>
+afternoon, my eyes fixed upon the distant scene in a strange
+turmoil of hope and fear. Little could I see save the
+smoke of the guns, and masses of men moving or running
+among the undulating hills, in what seemed a very aimless
+way. But the noise of the firing, the clash of steel, the
+wild hoarse cries of the Highlanders as they rushed on their
+foes, made strange clamour in the peaceful upper air of
+that un-Sabbathlike Sunday afternoon. It would require
+the pen of a person skilled in warfare to explain the
+movements of both armies from so great a distance, for to
+me it was mostly confusion, and I scarce knew what I
+expected to see when I begged to be allowed to climb the
+hill. Perhaps I imagined a mighty host from the north
+rushing furiously upon the Government troops, so that in
+the course of an hour or so they should be completely
+annihilated, or only a remnant left to cry quarter, as the
+Earl of Mar pushed triumphant on to Stirling Castle. If
+so, I was mightily disappointed, for as dusk fell it seemed
+that the fighting ceased; both parties appeared to stand
+at gaze, motionless themselves, but watching for the
+movements of the other. Then Argyle’s men were seen
+to draw off along the road to Dunblane, and the Earl of
+Mar’s army marched slowly away northwards towards Ardoch.</p>
+
+<p>“Is it finished?” I cried to Mr. Rose, rising to my feet.
+“Is this all? Which side has won? Will they fight again
+to-morrow?”</p>
+
+<p>For so quickly had the end come, that I was plunged in
+amazement and perplexity, and could scarce realise that I
+had been witness of a genuine battle.</p>
+
+<p>The grieve shook his head doubtfully.</p>
+
+<p>“Deed, missy, I couldna say,” he answered. “But it’s
+time ye were back in the hoose wi’ my lady, I’m thinkin’.”</p>
+
+<p>And stiff with the cold, and burdened with a dull
+weight of apprehension which I did not understand, I made
+my way down the hill which was now shrouded in darkness.</p>
+
+<p>I found the house in the deepest gloom, for to my
+surprise not a lantern or taper had been lit, and as I
+mounted the stairs I heard the sound of loud weeping
+coming from one of the rooms of which the door was open.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_158">[158]</span>
+I entered quickly and a curious scene met my eyes. My
+lady was seated upon a couch, little Hal whimpering on her
+knees, while Charles leant against her side and gazed
+fearfully up in her face. Phemie stood silent and grim
+beside her, while all the other women of the house, some
+in attitudes of despair upon the floor, some supporting each
+other in their arms, were sobbing and wailing as if the last
+day had come. My lady’s face was a study, so white, so
+set, so stern, and with eyes fixed in a stare so fateful, that
+for a moment my heart was in my mouth, as the saying is,
+and I imagined nothing less than that the awful tidings of
+the death of Sir John had reached her. At the thought
+I rushed into the room, crying out,</p>
+
+<p>“For Heaven’s sake, madam, what is amiss? Pray,
+Phemie, bid those women hold their peace, and tell me
+what has happened. Is it Sir John? Why looks my lady so?”</p>
+
+<p>While Phemie tried to quiet the maids, my lady turned
+to answer me, and the effort seemed to break the frozen
+spell that held her, for the tears welled up in her eyes and
+rolled down her face.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, Barbara, did you not see—have you not heard?
+The battle is over and Argyle hath vanquished Mar, whose
+army is broken and fleeing to the hills. The Cause is lost,
+my girl, and we are undone. The kindest thing to do now
+is to stop the King from coming over, and did I but know
+where to address Sir John, I would send a despatch to
+France this very night.”</p>
+
+<p>Utterly bewildered I tried to put into sane words what
+I had just witnessed from the hill, but as I spoke I felt that
+I was not convincing my audience.</p>
+
+<p>“A battle there was surely, madam,” I said, “but indeed
+there was no rout of my Lord Mar’s army. It drew off when
+the dusk fell as orderly as the other, and if I am not mistaken
+they have but retired for the night to fight again to-morrow.”</p>
+
+<p>Even while they looked at me, trying to take in my
+words of hope, a clamour arose in the courtyard, and a
+great voice shouted, “Hurrah!” I flew to the window, and
+opening it wide, leaned out. A group of men holding
+torches were round the door, and among them I could see
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_159">[159]</span>
+the shepherd, Allan Maclean, who appeared to have but
+just arrived among them.</p>
+
+<p>“What news?” I cried. “What news, men? Is it Allan
+Maclean that has brought them?”</p>
+
+<p>The men looked up, and seeing that my lady had joined
+me, surrounded by the agitated women, they tossed their
+bonnets into the air, shouting,</p>
+
+<p>“Victory, my leddy, victory for my Lord Mar! A gran’
+fecht, and Argyle’s beaten! Lang live King Jamie, and
+doun wi’ German Geordie.”</p>
+
+<p>Now on hearing these cries, my lady turned and caught
+my hand, and we looked in each other’s faces, perplexed;
+and there was something so whimsical in the occurrence
+(also the relief of the reaction was so great), that we both
+burst out laughing, and stood there swaying to and fro till we
+became exhausted with our mirth and were obliged to stop.</p>
+
+<p>“Sure,” said my dear lady, wiping her eyes, “this is the
+strangest battle that ever was fought, where both sides
+claim the victory, and neither has suffered defeat. For
+the Stirling folk, we are told, are rejoicing over their success
+as heartily as Allan Maclean, and have already spread
+abroad about the town that my Lord Mar’s forces are
+utterly broken.”</p>
+
+<p>“That,” cried I, “I am convinced they are not; but
+how far the rest is true or untrue I fear we must wait till
+the morrow to learn. Oh, madam, ’tis pity that the field
+lies so far from us—there must be many wounded and
+dying. To think of them lying out in this bitter cold
+nigh breaks my heart. Pray God none of your own
+people are among them!”</p>
+
+<p>“Alas!” she sighed, “if all is not well with them, they
+are either dead or taken prisoners. But I would fain
+succour the others, even as you would, Barbara, were we
+not too distant here. To-morrow we must see what can
+be done. Ah, my dear, how could we laugh so heartily
+just now, when some of our kindest neighbours and friends
+may be lying stark and stiff on Sheriffmuir?”</p>
+
+<p>And I hope you will not despise us when you hear that
+upon that we both sat down and wept.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_160">[160]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XVIII">
+ CHAPTER XVIII
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>TELLS OF A DARK HOUR—AND OF A GREAT AWAKENING</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>Tidings we had upon the morrow in plenty, but no great
+certainty, for Rumour, many-mouthed, roamed the country-side,
+and each mouth had a different tale to tell. One
+thing was sure—<i>part</i> of each army had vanquished <i>part</i> of
+the other; that is to say, Mar’s left wing was put to flight
+by Argyle’s right, while his centre column had routed
+Argyle’s left. That it was a well ordered battle no man on
+either side dare affirm, and the confusion, the bad discipline,
+and the lack of strategic skill on the part of the insurgents,
+prevented the Earl of Mar, whose numbers were by far the
+larger, from recording a complete victory over the Government
+troops. Had he even returned to give battle on the
+morrow all might have been well; but owing partly to the
+desertion of many of the Highlanders from his ranks, partly
+to the lack of victuals, and a little, I fear, to dissensions
+among his chief officers, he remained inactive, and gradually
+drew off towards Perth, claiming the victory on his part,
+and leaving Argyle to proclaim it on his own.</p>
+
+<p>In the meantime, on this dark Monday, we heard heavy
+enough tidings from time to time. Some were said to be
+dead who were only taken prisoners, and others were
+thought safe whose corpses were found upon the field.
+Upwards of eighty officers and gentlemen were lodged as
+prisoners in Stirling Castle, while many also on the other
+side were carried off to Perth. We heard in the course of
+the day with real sorrow, of the death of the gallant young
+Earl of Strathmore, and of the brave Chief of Clanranald;
+and how, sore wounded, that fine old hero, my Lord
+Panmure, was a prisoner. Many other ill tidings came to
+us, for, as you know, we had friends on both sides in the
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_161">[161]</span>
+battle; and all day long the house was besieged by people
+of the poorer sort, with some tale to tell of death or disaster,
+of loss by battle, or by the thieving soldiers, making requests
+for meal or meat, clothing or money, or merely to pour into
+my Lady Alva’s ears some incident of harrowing importance.</p>
+
+<p>Soon after the noon-day dinner, little Charles called me
+to see a troop of some five hundred horse which were
+passing the house, going in the direction of Dunblane; and
+my lady desiring to know who they were, went cautiously to
+the gate, accompanied by her son and myself, and looked
+at the officers who passed to see if she might find any
+friends among them. Several went by without her recognising
+them, but at last came one who was well-known to
+her, namely, my Lord George Murray, who upon seeing
+my lady, saluted and came forward to speak with her.
+From him we learned that he, with the Laird of Inveruitie,
+had received orders to march from Burntisland with their
+battalions to join the Earl of Mar between Auchterarder
+and Stirling. They had come with what speed they could,
+but owing, I believe, to some delay in the message being
+delivered, they were arriving, as my lady told them, “a day
+behind the Fair.” Lord George questioned us eagerly
+upon what had taken place, and hoped that yesterday’s
+battle might only be the first of the campaign. He would
+not stop for refreshment, even though the servants were
+now appearing with jugs of small beer and bottles of claret,
+but must press on, as he said, in order to reach headquarters,
+wherever these might be, before the dusk fell.
+As my lady drew back she asked a question which I had so
+longed to put myself, that when the words fell from her lips
+I was startled by the quick throb of my heart.</p>
+
+<p>“Pray, is our friend, Captain Anthony Fleming, in your
+company?” she said. “We should like to salute him
+kindly.”</p>
+
+<p>Lord George was already riding off, and looked back to
+answer her.</p>
+
+<p>“Fleming? Anthony Fleming?” he called out. “No,
+madam, he left Burntisland on a special mission to my
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_162">[162]</span>
+Lord Mar a week since, and is in all probability over there
+now with the army. Adieu.”</p>
+
+<p>And the heavy horses went thudding and pounding past
+us, and for no reason at all my heart sank low, and the
+blood ebbed in my cheeks.</p>
+
+<p>“Poor Anthony!” murmured my lady, as we turned
+away, “God grant he has come safe out of it!”</p>
+
+<p>I could neither answer nor look at her, for all at once it
+seemed to me I saw my friend lying wounded, or perhaps
+dead, out there on the frozen morass. So clearly I
+pictured his face turned up to the sky, his kind eyes closed
+to all earthly light for ever, his strong arm lifeless by his
+side, that it seemed to me like a prophetic vision, or like
+the strange knowledge of current events, which the Highlanders
+call “second sight.” I shivered with a sort of fear,
+and having entered the house crept away upstairs to the
+nursery, where little Hal was playing, and my good Phemie
+sat placidly spinning, as if no such things as battles had
+ever been heard of. I sat myself down on the floor beside
+her, as I was used to do as a bairn, and leaned my head
+against her while I listened to the drowsy humming of the
+wheel. She stopped for a moment to lay her kind hand
+upon my hair.</p>
+
+<p>“What ails my lamb the day?” she said, tenderly, and
+at the touch and tone, so truly motherly, the tears rose in
+my eyes and dropped down into my lap. Harry, who had
+stopped playing, came running up, and putting his soft arms
+round my neck, bade me “not to greet.”</p>
+
+<p>“She’s sorry about the battle, Phemie,” said the dear
+little fellow, “and the poor shotted soldiers and the hurt
+horse and all. How glad I am that my papa is not in
+Scotland—he would have been in the fight, and perhaps
+have got shotted too.”</p>
+
+<p>The baby speech, and the loving clasp of the little arms,
+comforted me strangely, and when a few minutes later I
+heard my lady’s voice calling me, I ran downstairs quite
+cheerful again, and asked what I could do for her. She
+stood in the hall with a basket in her hand, and Charles
+beside her wrapped in his winter cloak.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_163">[163]</span></p>
+
+<p>“I have heard but now, Barbara,” said she, “that Alison
+Macdonald, the herd’s wife, is sick and in need of some
+comforts. She is alone in bed in the hut, but the key is
+hid in the thatch (you are tall and can reach it). So many
+are coming and going that I cannot spare one of the
+servants to send to her, yet I cannot let the poor woman
+starve, for her husband, you know, went to Dunfermline on
+an errand this morning, and cannot be back till late. I
+fear the snow will shortly be coming down heavily, so,
+although I scarce like to ask you to go a yard from the
+house to-day, if you keep to the road till you come to the
+glen, I do not think any one will molest you. ’Twill not
+take more than half-an-hour, going and returning, and my
+brave little Charles will be your protector.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, yes, Cousin Barbara,” cried the child smiling,
+“I will not let anyone touch you, and I am to carry the
+can of broth.”</p>
+
+<p>The herd’s bothie stood about half-way up a small glen
+that lay parallel with and next to the Silver Glen. The
+stream which ran through it was a mere trickle, except
+when a great rain flooded the hills, and the trees and shrubs
+were mostly stunted and of little beauty. I left the house
+with few misgivings for the road was quiet, and if there
+were any fugitives hiding from the soldiers of Argyle they
+would, we knew, keep to the hills and not frequent the
+highways.</p>
+
+<p>We met no soul on our short journey, and found the
+poor woman, as my lady had said, alone in the hut and
+very thankful to see us. I did what I could for her comfort:
+built up the fire of coal and peat till it glowed cheerfully
+upon the hearth, gave her some of the broth, and
+under her directions placed the other things within her
+reach. Then promising that someone should come to her
+in the evening, in case her husband might be detained,
+we left her much cheered, and locking the door again,
+departed.</p>
+
+<p>It was now about four of the clock, and evening was
+approaching. In the glen it was darker because of the
+close growing trees, and we were obliged to walk carefully
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_164">[164]</span>
+for the path was steep and narrow. A slight snow had
+fallen, and the frost held the ground like iron. Among
+the grasses at the edge of the burn were fringes of ice,
+though the running water itself was not yet frozen. A chill
+wind had sprung up and was moaning among the almost
+leafless trees.</p>
+
+<p>Suddenly little Charles, whose hand I held, stopped
+short, and shrinking nearer to me pointed, and whispered,</p>
+
+<p>“What is that, cousin?” I looked, and my heart stood
+still, for lying on the snowy ground a little way from the
+path, and half hidden by a low-growing bush, was the body
+of a man. My first impulse was to run, as far and as fast
+as possible from the dreaded object; but my second, I am
+glad to say, conquered my first, and bidding Charles stay
+where he was, I stepped over the frozen grass, and bending
+down, examined the recumbent figure. He was lying on
+his back, with his face upon his arm as if he slept, but it
+was turned towards me, and with a sharp cry I sprang back.
+Charles, in whom curiosity was ever greater than fear, ran
+to my side and seized my hand.</p>
+
+<p>“Is he dead, cousin? Is it a soldier? Oh, Heavens!
+’tis Captain Anthony,” and without a pause the boy dropped
+on his knees and shook the shoulder nearest him with both
+hands.</p>
+
+<p>“Charles, Charles!” I cried, “stop for pity’s sake!
+Perhaps the poor man is dead. Oh, what shall we do if he
+is?”</p>
+
+<p>“He is not dead, cousin,” cried Charles. “He lives, I
+am sure of it. See, his chest moves as he breathes. But
+he is very cold, and oh look! there is blood upon his coat.”</p>
+
+<p>Half sick with terror I looked where he pointed. The
+officer had been wounded on the shoulder, and his sleeve
+being saturated with blood had frozen as stiff as a board.
+I touched his face, it was cold and very white, but sure
+enough I could see the feeble rise and fall of his chest, and
+I knew that Charles was right. A moment’s reflection
+showed me what I must do.</p>
+
+<p>“Would you be afraid, dear Cha, to run to the house
+alone,” I said, “and tell them to bring men to carry Mr.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_165">[165]</span>
+Fleming down. They must bring a board of some kind for
+he is badly wounded. Go straight to my lady and tell her
+the poor gentleman is unconscious—<i>unconscious</i>, Charles,
+will you remember that word? Say that Barbara is
+watching beside him; she will know what to order. Can
+you do this, my dear?”</p>
+
+<p>The little lad looked up in my face, then down the
+lonely path that was quickly growing darker, then at the
+wounded soldier in the grass.</p>
+
+<p>“Ay, Cousin Barbara, I can. Am I not your protector?”
+he said.</p>
+
+<p>“You are!” I cried, as I kissed him, “my brave protector
+and kind helper. And remember, dearest Cha, you are
+going to save Captain Anthony’s life.”</p>
+
+<p>With that he darted off, and left me alone in the
+darkling glen with my wounded friend and my anxious
+thoughts. I chafed his lifeless hands to bring some warmth
+to them, but with little result. I tried to raise his head,
+and succeeded in moving it a little and straightening out
+his unwounded arm; but the pallor of his face alarmed me
+much, for I knew not how long he had been lying there,
+nor how far his strength had ebbed. Oh, for a fire, for a
+surgeon, for brandy!</p>
+
+<p>At that thought I rose to my feet, and unwinding the
+plaid from my head and shoulders, I folded it over the
+unconscious man, and, regaining the path, began running up
+the glen as fast as the steepness and slipperiness of the way
+permitted. For among the comforts sent to Alison
+Macdonald, I had seen a little flask of the French brandy
+which my lady kept to dole out as medicine, and some of
+that brandy I was bound to have. I startled the poor
+woman half out of her wits by my abrupt entrance, but a
+few hurried words explained the matter, and she earnestly
+besought me to take the flask with me as the poor soldier
+needed it more than she. This I refused to do, but,
+pouring about half the contents into a cup, I locked the
+door once more, and for the fourth time retraced the
+narrow path.</p>
+
+<p>It was some time before I succeeded in forcing a little
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_166">[166]</span>
+of the spirit between the poor pale lips, but in spite of the
+trembling of my hands (caused as much by nervousness as
+by the cold), I persevered, and was at last made happy by
+the knowledge that some had been swallowed. Anxiously
+I continued my ministrations, too much occupied with my
+task to have room for thought, and at last to my intense
+joy the eyes opened, and the lips seemed to form some
+inaudible words. Had he recognised me I wondered, did
+he know who was so eagerly tending him, would mine be
+the first name he uttered on regaining consciousness?
+Again I held the cup to his lips, and this time he drank
+more freely. As the life-giving cordial went down he
+stirred a little, and opening his eyes again vaguely, he
+murmured, “Mistress Betty Sinclair.”</p>
+
+<p>Now at this date it is easy to smile at the shock of
+dismay these words caused me, but at the time I remember
+very well ’twas no matter for smiling. It struck me with a
+kind of sad irony, that I had looked upon this gentleman
+as my peculiar property. I had found him in dire straits,
+I had ministered to him with my own hands, I had
+perhaps brought him back to life, and for what? To hear
+him, with his first conscious thought, call for Betty
+Sinclair! I sat by his head on the chilly ground, too
+numb to feel the cold. I still chafed his hands, and
+offered him brandy, but it was done <i>with a difference</i>.
+The warm feeling of motherly protection, which moves a
+maid towards the man who attracts her, had fled. I would
+nurse him and watch him, and save him if I could, but it
+was to be for another, and as I thought thereon, I wept.</p>
+
+<p>Ah, foolish Barbara! thus to torture herself because of
+three little words. Where was her reason gone, her
+modesty, her pride? For full five minutes, I verily
+believe, they had fled from the stronghold of her mind,
+and during that period she abandoned herself to cold
+despair and helpless, gnawing jealousy.</p>
+
+<p>The sound of steps and voices in the distance brought
+me to myself. I wiped the tears from my face, and
+redoubled my efforts with so much success that by the
+time the men approached, Captain Fleming was well
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_167">[167]</span>
+enough to notice them, though of me he did not seem to
+be aware. Mr. Rose, and John Harley, Allan the shepherd,
+and Thomas, one of the stablemen, bearing a stretcher
+between them, came hurriedly up the glen, and with kind
+haste and skilful hands lifted the wounded man upon it.
+Mr. Rose carried a warm cloak which had been given him
+by my lady for the soldier’s use, but on catching sight of
+Barbara shivering in her house-dress he wrapped it round
+her shoulders, leaving her plaid where she had placed it.</p>
+
+<p>Just as they were starting Captain Fleming made an
+effort to speak, and Mr. Rose bent down to listen.</p>
+
+<p>“Whaur are we takin’ ye, sir? Just to Alva Hoose,
+whaur my leddy waits tae pit ye tae bed. You bide quiet,
+Mr. Fleming, ye’re in guid hands, and will be well cared
+for.”</p>
+
+<p>With a sigh of satisfaction the sick man closed his eyes,
+but as I walked soberly in the rear of the procession I was
+not able to see his face.</p>
+
+<p>My lady was too anxious as to the state of her unbidden
+guest to do more than lay her hand on my shoulder with a,
+“Well done, Barbara!” that warmed my heart. But
+upstairs in the nursery, to which I was at once dragged by
+Charles, we were regarded as hero and heroine by Phemie
+and little Hal. There I was treated to all sorts of petting
+and cossetting, to words of praise and wonder, to hot spiced
+wine, and a warm bath for my feet. So that, ere ten
+minutes had passed, I had well nigh forgotten my lonely
+vigil in the glen, and was ready to laugh at Harry’s wee
+face as he listened excitedly to his brother’s chatter. He
+told us of his quick run home, and how frighted he was at
+the dark; and how he had taken the grunting of a pig for
+a Highlander calling him, and had raced all the faster past
+the stye; and how Devon, the watch-dog, had seemed to
+know his step, for he stopped barking and crawled back
+into his kennel, and let my brave protector run straight in
+at the door.</p>
+
+<p>“And what did you do when I left you, Cousin
+Barbara?” he cried. “Were you terrible frighted without
+me?”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_168">[168]</span></p>
+
+<p>Whereupon I had to add my chapter to the tale, and
+relate my adventures with the brandy, receiving great credit
+from Phemie for my thoughtfulness, as I had probably, she
+said, saved the poor gentleman’s life.</p>
+
+<p>“And did he not open his eyes and see you?” asked
+Hal, “and say, ‘Fank you, Mistress Barbara?’”</p>
+
+<p>“Indeed he did not, Harold Beaux-yeux!” said I.
+“Poor Barbara was not even noticed.”</p>
+
+<p>“But did he say nuffin at all?” persisted the child.</p>
+
+<p>I rose up laughing, for the foolish mood had passed,
+and lifted the boy in my arms.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, yes, he did,” I cried. “He asked for your Aunt
+Betty Sinclair.”</p>
+
+<p>“Eh!” said Phemie grimly, “another of ’em!”</p>
+
+<p>And though this mysterious utterance pricked my heart,
+I laughed again, and joined in a game of romps with the
+children.</p>
+
+<p>But half an hour afterwards I stood outside a closed
+door, with my head against the panel, listening hungrily for
+a sound from within. The stillness terrified me, for I
+thought he must be dead. I longed to lift the latch and
+go in, but modesty and fear forbade me. How long I stood
+there I know not, but footsteps behind me in the passage
+made me turn my head, to see my lady approaching with
+a cup in her hand. She had not, as I was glad to know,
+perceived my attitude, and took it for granted that I had
+but just come. She signed to me to open the door, and
+we entered the room together. By the light of a dimly
+burning taper I caught sight of the form upon the bed.
+His head was bandaged, for there was a scalp wound
+under the hair which had started bleeding, and this made
+the pallor of his face more ghastly; his eyes were closed.
+I stole into the shadow of the curtain, and watched my
+lady as she bent over the bed and raised him on her arm
+to hold the cup of broth to his lips. He was not asleep,
+and thanked her gratefully as he drank it.</p>
+
+<p>“Are you in pain?” she asked, gently.</p>
+
+<p>“It will pass,” he answered in a weak voice, but cheerily.
+“’Twas worse upon the hillside.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_169">[169]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Mr. Peck, who is a clever surgeon, says you must not
+talk,” said my lady; “but if you have anything upon your
+mind, he thinks it will ease you to tell me if you are able.”</p>
+
+<p>His next words startled me, prepared as I was.</p>
+
+<p>“Is your sister Mistress Betty Sinclair, in the house with
+you, madam?” he asked.</p>
+
+<p>“Nay,” said my lady, “she is still at Dysart. Have you
+aught you wish me to tell her?”</p>
+
+<p>“’Twas your brother, the Master,” went on Mr. Fleming,
+“that told me she was here. He writ her a letter after the
+battle, a few lines only, thinking she and you, madam,
+would be anxious to know of his safety. When he found
+me wounded, he very kindly said that if I could find my
+way here I should be well cared for, and could join the
+army again in a few days when a little recovered from my
+wound. He gave me the letter, telling me to deliver it to
+Mistress Sinclair if she were here, or to you, madam, if she
+were not. He directed me how to come in order to avoid
+the enemy, but a small body of dragoons espied and chased
+me, and though I escaped them by great good luck, my
+horse was caught by a stray bullet, and shortly after the
+poor beast stumbled and fell, to rise no more. I came
+on foot, but missed my way in the dark and wandered far,
+and I know not how many hours I had been on the hillside
+when your searchers found me. The letter, madam, is in
+the inner pocket of my tunic, and that is all my task accomplished,
+save to offer my heartfelt apologies for giving
+you so much trouble.”</p>
+
+<p>Now this lengthy speech was faltered out, sentence by
+sentence, as the poor man’s strength allowed, but my lady
+waited patiently, believing rightly that when the tale was
+told his mind would be more at ease. Upon its conclusion
+she assured him that his apologies were unnecessary
+at such a time, and at his request she found the letter he
+had suffered so much in bringing.</p>
+
+<p>As for me, only one thing at that moment seemed important—the
+strange exclamation in the glen was accounted
+for. He had been bidden to find Betty Sinclair, and
+naturally her name came first to his lips. How simple it
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_170">[170]</span>
+was! Already my heart felt lighter, and as my lady moved
+to the door after bidding her patient try to sleep, I slipped
+from the shadow of the curtain and passed close to the
+bed. For one moment I paused and looked down upon
+him, and our eyes met. Oh! the glad light that sprang
+into his as he recognised me.</p>
+
+<p>“Barbara!” he whispered, and that was all; but the
+word was so fraught with tender gladness that my heart
+vibrated like a harp-string touched to music, and I could
+scarce restrain my tears. I held out my hand impulsively,
+and for a lingering moment our fingers touched. What
+magic lay in that brief handclasp not even the wisest of the
+ancients, I believe, could explain, but in the twinkling of
+an eyelid it changed my life for me. With a smile and
+a backward glance I passed on, and an instant later I was
+standing outside the door, a heedless girl no longer, but a
+glad, startled, loving, anxious woman.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_171">[171]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XIX">
+ CHAPTER XIX
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>SHOWS HOW THE CAUSE SUFFERS MANY REVERSES</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>My dear Lady Erskine was so wrapt in the perusal of her
+brother’s letter that she neither noticed my delay in
+quitting the bedroom, nor my agitation when I joined her.
+For a moment it seemed to me that the overwhelming
+emotion I had experienced must have left its mark upon
+my face, that my eyes would betray it, and my lips tremble
+forth their confession, without her saying one word. But
+the next instant it came to me, as a woman, that the sweet
+and agitating secret was not mine own, that indeed ’twas
+so vague and impalpable I scarce had the right to regard
+its existence, and with the marvellous self-control that
+comes to our sex in such crises, I closed the door behind
+me and slowly followed my lady to her room.</p>
+
+<p>The letter from the Master told us little that we had not
+already heard, except that it gave us the names of many
+friends who were taken prisoners to Stirling. Lord
+Strathallan among others, and his brother, Mr. Thomas
+Drummond, Colonel Walkinshaw, the Laird of Barafield,
+and Mr. Murray, younger, of Auchtertyre. He found
+time to lament in touching words the sad death of young
+Lord Strathmore, than whom a truer gentleman, or a braver
+soldier, never bore a sword. I give his words as he wrote
+them—</p>
+
+<p>“On our left the brave young Strathmore was killed. I
+can’t help wishing he had kept his promise to me to
+honour me with being under my command, and joyning
+my squadron. When he found all turning their backs,
+he seized the Colours, and persuaded fourteen, or some
+such number, to stand by him for some time, which
+drew upon him the enemie’s fire by which he was
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_172">[172]</span>
+wounded; and going off was taken and murdered by a
+dragoon—a mill-stone crushing a brilliant. He was the
+young man of all I ever saw who approached the nearest to
+perfection, and had a just contempt of all the little lyes and
+selfish tricks so necessary to some and so common among us.”</p>
+
+<p>He told us also that Mr. Irvine of Drum, “a young
+gentleman of good hopes, was ill wounded.” On the other
+side, my Lord Islay, the Duke’s brother, was sore hurt; and
+the Earl of Forfar was so badly wounded, that although he was
+taken prisoner by Mar, they could not carry him to Perth,
+but sent him back to Stirling, where alas! he died next day.</p>
+
+<p>The Master we learned in a later letter (and I beg you
+will forgive me if I confuse the information got at different
+times), toiled and moiled for hours with the cannon,
+wishing rather to bury them than to leave them a gift to the
+enemy; but eventually he was obliged to abandon most of
+them on the highroad to Ardoch, though some he did get
+to Perth. He lost his way in the darkness, and rode about
+the moor half the night, being indebted at last to the
+kindness of a gentleman, met by accident, who carried him
+to Urchell where he had a few hours’ sleep.</p>
+
+<p>Lord Panmure, of whose staunch courage I can never
+say enough, was, as I told you, taken prisoner, but being
+grievously wounded, was left in the hut of some peasants,
+where the good souls tended him kindly. He was but
+slightly guarded, and was soon rescued by his brother, Mr.
+Harry Maule, and taken to a safe place till he was a little
+recovered, when he rejoined the army at Perth.</p>
+
+<p>Indeed and indeed we had grounds enough for mourning,
+for not only were we grieved by all this loss and suffering,
+but our hearts were heavy because we knew not if the
+sacrifice was to bring its own reward; in other words, we
+had begun to fear that success was not to crown our efforts.</p>
+
+<p>“It is not, Barbara,” said my lady to me, “that I think
+the Cause unworthy, but it may be that God in His infinite
+wisdom has ordained that it shall not prosper.”</p>
+
+<p>And in how many minds this bitter doubt was growing
+up it would be difficult to tell, for except in the privacy of
+our own closets, no loyal tongue would give it voice.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_173">[173]</span></p>
+
+<p>But all this time my lady had no word from Sir John,
+and this, as you may imagine, did not ease her burden.
+Our patient, too, was causing her great anxiety, and for
+many days had been so ill that, by Mr. Peck’s orders, no
+one but himself and one of the women appointed as nurse,
+was allowed to enter his chamber.</p>
+
+<p>The secretary went about with a troubled face, and for a
+little time we feared the worst.</p>
+
+<p>What this meant to me I cannot tell you; but in those
+days I first learned the meaning of patience, not the meek
+and lifeless resignation of the placid mind, but the
+discipline of soul which forces an outward quiet, while the
+spirit within consumes itself in an agony of waiting. Ah!
+how many times in her life has Barbara had to endure the
+same fear, anxiety, and helpless longing; but at that time
+her heart was fierce and wild, and her nature all unused
+to pain. I had grasped my inheritance of happiness,
+only to have it wrenched from my hand. I had stood and
+gazed into Heaven, and the door had been shut in my
+face. What wonder that I struggled with indignation and
+surprise against this blow of Fate, and that many secret
+tears bedewed my pillow?</p>
+
+<p>It was a merciful relief to find very soon my hands and
+thoughts so occupied that my private troubles must be
+pushed and hidden out of sight. You must not imagine
+that Mr. Fleming was our only patient, for in all the great
+houses round the scene of the battle, kind hearts were
+moved to set up hospitals for the wounded, and you will
+readily believe that Alva was not behind the rest in this
+work of mercy. The men were mostly of the rank and
+file, for the officers were made prisoners; and though on
+both sides there was much leniency and courtesy shown,
+it was not to be expected in a conflict of this sort that
+gentlemen of influence could be trusted in the houses of
+their friends and sympathisers. A few of the worst cases
+Lady Erskine caused to be brought into the house, but for
+the most part the men were provided with accommodation in
+the barns and out-houses; and being sturdy fellows, not
+used to lying soft, nor to delicate fare, they very quickly
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_174">[174]</span>
+responded to the kindness of their rescuers, and were
+speedily healed of their wounds. One or two died, to our
+great sorrow, especially when, as in the case of two of the
+Highlanders, who had no English and could not make
+known to us more than their names, we were unable to
+learn their wishes or bear any message to their friends.</p>
+
+<p>I must not forget to tell you that outside our little world
+affairs had not been prospering. You will remember that
+after the battle the Earl of Mar drew off slowly to Perth,
+resting his exhausted army by the way, and taking three
+or four days to perform the journey. But, ere they reached
+the town, tidings were brought to the Earl of Seaforth that
+Inverness had fallen to my Lord the Earl of Sutherland,
+and he with General Gordon hurried north to prevent the
+victorious Earl from coming south to threaten Perth. Another
+bitter disappointment followed, for on Saturday the
+19th day of November, my Lord Mar, having reached the
+town, received there a despatch from Brigadier Mackintosh
+at Preston in Lancashire, stating how they had taken that
+town, and hoped on the morrow to march to Manchester.
+The Earl of Mar gave orders for what proved to be premature
+rejoicings, for he set the bells a-ringing; and next day,
+being Sunday, was made the occasion of a public thanksgiving.
+But alas! in the midst of their jubilation another
+messenger arrived from the same quarter with very sorry
+tidings to tell, namely: the surrender of Preston to General
+Wills, and the complete collapse of the rising in the north
+of England. Many of our bravest and most important
+leaders were thus taken prisoners and carried to London,
+among them the brave old Mackintosh, Lords Kenmure
+and Nithsdale, Lord Nairn and the Earl of Wintoun, also
+of Englishmen, the young and popular Earl of Derwentwater,
+my Lord Widdington, and Mr. Thomas Forster, a
+gentleman of Northumberland. I leave you to imagine
+the effect of this dismal news upon the already disaffected
+army at Perth. It did not take long for the tidings to
+spread, though to us it was first conveyed in a letter from
+the Master of Sinclair to his sister. Following hard upon
+this disaster came rumours of the approach of English
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_175">[175]</span>
+regiments from across the border, and of the arrival of the
+Dutch troops on our shores, and although these last did
+not come upon us for some weeks yet, the fear of their
+invasion filled our hearts with terror.</p>
+
+<p>In the midst of all this woe and trouble I can still recall
+two happy events which, oddly enough, fell upon the same
+day, the 5th of December, being just three weeks after
+the Battle of Sheriffmuir. Very early in the morning, my
+lady, coming to the door to give some order, descried in
+the wan light the figure of a man hurrying along the
+broad walk which gave upon the highroad. He was
+dressed in the rough garb of a common sailor, but his
+face when he came nearer was clean and intelligent, and
+he doffed his hat with a certain courtesy of manner not
+quite in keeping with the dress.</p>
+
+<p>My lady eyed him keenly, and demanded what she
+could do for him. He replied by taking a packet from
+his breast and holding it out before her eyes, but he did
+not utter a word. It was a letter addressed to herself, and
+in her husband’s writing. Most gladly did she seize
+it from him, asking eagerly how he had come by it, and
+a dozen other questions in a breath; but the man merely
+smiled and bowed, making signs as though he were dumb.
+Whether this was so or not, we were never able to discover,
+but all the time he was at Alva (and you may be sure he
+was well-fed and well-paid ere he left), he never spoke,
+nor made the least attempt at communicating with any.
+He departed as silently and mysteriously as he came, and
+we never, to my knowledge, heard of him again.</p>
+
+<p>Howbeit he had brought light and gladness into my
+lady’s heart and relief to the whole household, so that we
+were better attuned for the hearing of further good news
+in the assurance of Mr. Peck that Captain Fleming was
+now convalescent, and might receive visits from the inmates
+of the house. My lady, it is true, had seen him once or
+twice during the past week; but now she called me, and
+bidding me take Charles as companion, sent me into the
+sick-room with a cup of coffee for the invalid.</p>
+
+<p>Now you must know that ever since we had been
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_176">[176]</span>
+escorted home by Mr. Fleming and his troopers, our little
+lads had talked incessantly of “Captain Anthony”—how
+brave he was, how tall; what a great horse he rode,
+and how kind he looked when he smiled. Since
+our adventure in the glen, Charles had enacted the
+interesting scene many times in his play, he, himself, being
+the wounded soldier, and little Hal taking now the part
+of Cha, running breathless down the dark road, now of
+Barbara, ministering to the unconscious man alone. It
+was with feelings, therefore, of great and awe-struck delight
+that the boy put his hand in mine as I stood before the
+door of the bed-room, and at my bidding knocked. Upon
+our entering, I was relieved to find the gentleman up and
+sitting in a chair by the hearth. His face was pale and
+thin, for the fever had been high; but his eyes were clear
+and bright, and he held out his hand with a smile.</p>
+
+<p>“Forgive me, Mistress Barbara,” he cried, “that I
+cannot rise to greet you; and accept my best thanks for
+the kindness of your visit.”</p>
+
+<p>Charles walked up to him and shook him gravely by
+the hand.</p>
+
+<p>“I am pleased to see you, sir,” he said in his old-fashioned
+way, “and Cousin Barbara and I are very glad
+that we found you in the glen.”</p>
+
+<p>“Hush, Charles!” cried I. “Remember your mama said
+you were not to talk too much.”</p>
+
+<p>“This is not ‘too much,’ Barbe,” returned the boy,
+“and you know we <i>are</i> glad!”</p>
+
+<p>“Pardon me, madam,” said Mr. Fleming, when he had,
+at my bidding, drunk the coffee. “It will amuse me
+greatly and do me no harm if you permit your little cousin
+to explain himself. I imagined that I was found by some
+of my Lady Erskine’s men, sent out to look for stragglers
+in the hills.”</p>
+
+<p>I could only smile and give my permission, begging him
+at the same time to make all allowances for the childish
+narrator. I seated myself a little way off, and hoped that
+the child would say nothing I should regret; but at
+the same time I was not averse to the idea that my
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_177">[177]</span>
+friend should know to whom, in all probability, he owed
+his life.</p>
+
+<p>“You see, sir,” said Charles, standing by the chair,
+and putting his little hand on Mr. Fleming’s knee, “my
+mama had sent my Cousin Barbara with some comforts
+to a poor woman in the glen, and I was sent with her
+as her protector. There was nothing, truly, to protect her
+from, but there might have been, you know! And I was
+of some use too—of a great deal of use, wasn’t I, Barbe?
+For ’twas I that saw you first, sir, under the bush.”</p>
+
+<p>“Yes, indeed,” I said, “your sharp little eyes
+descried Mr. Fleming before mine did.”</p>
+
+<p>“Then Cousin Barbe went and looked at you, and at first
+she thought you were dead, but I knew you weren’t for I
+saw you breathing. And then she said would I be
+frighted to run back to the house alone for help, and I
+said ‘no;’ but I was, you know, a good deal frighted—’specially
+when the pig grunted, and I thought ’twas a
+Highlander after me! But I runned very fast, and got to
+the house all safe.”</p>
+
+<p>He stopped for breath, and his listener patted him on the
+head.</p>
+
+<p>“Bravo, little comrade! That is the true courage, to
+be a good deal frighted but still to go on. And what of
+Mistress Barbara left alone?”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh,” said Charles, “I think Barbara was frighted
+too, for you wouldn’t wake up; and it was very cold and
+dark, and she took off her plaid and put it over you, and ran
+all the way back to the hut for brandy, and made you, <i>made</i>
+you take some, and rubbed your hands, and—”</p>
+
+<p>“Come, that will do, my lad!” I exclaimed, my cheeks
+very hot, my heart beating quick, for my friend had turned
+to look at me, and there was that in his eyes which I found
+it not easy to meet.</p>
+
+<p>“Nay!” cried Charles, carried away by his own tale, “I
+have but one thing more to say. Do you know, Captain
+Anthony, she did all that, and you never—even—said
+‘Thank you!’”</p>
+
+<p>At that we both laughed heartily till the boy, not
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_178">[178]</span>
+comprehending, began to look uncomfortable, and Mr. Fleming,
+taking his hand, said seriously.</p>
+
+<p>“You must forgive me, Charles, as I can only hope your
+cousin does. But to make up for my rudeness, I mean to
+go on thanking her all my life—if she will let me!”</p>
+
+<p>The last words were uttered in a lower tone, and his eyes
+were again fixed on my face. Charles ran off to the
+window, some noise outside attracting him, and I took the
+opportunity to say as carelessly as I might,</p>
+
+<p>“You make too much, sir, of a trivial kindness, which
+any woman would have performed for a wounded man.”</p>
+
+<p>“No doubt, madam,” he answered gravely, leaning
+forward in his chair, “but that cannot lessen my gratitude,
+for my life is incomparably sweet and precious to me now.
+You gave it back to me, and were it not too early in our
+acquaintance, I would say I herewith offer it to you—nay,
+listen, madam! Ever since that first morning when I saw
+you, with your sweet face pale with terror, and your eyes
+appealing to any chivalry that was left in man, my one
+thought, outside my duty as a soldier, has been to be
+worthy to care for and protect you all through life, so that
+if my faithful love could shield you, you should never
+suffer fear or pain again.”</p>
+
+<p>I made no answer and my eyes were hid. “This, I
+know, is not the time to talk of such things,” he went on,
+“neither do I expect a prize so exquisite to fall into my
+hand at the first touch. Grant me but time, madam, to
+prove my honesty in the words of the motto of our house,
+‘<i>Let deed show</i>,’ and if Heaven be so kind as to preserve
+me in future dangers, give me leave to come to you again.”</p>
+
+<p>Did ever maid listen to such perfect wooing! Ah!
+Barbara, happy Barbara, did not that hour atone for all
+your pain? Even as I write, an old and faded woman, my
+heart gives a throb of bliss when I think of it. How good
+God is, how tender and loving, when He grants us, all
+undeserving as we are, our heart’s desire!</p>
+
+<p>I said not a word in answer, but rose and went to him
+and gave him both my hands. As he seized them and
+pressed them to his lips, a footstep sounded in the passage,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_179">[179]</span>
+and the next moment Mr. Peck entered, telling us in his
+kindly nervous way that he thought his patient would be
+the better of a rest.</p>
+
+<p>“Ah! Mr. Peck,” cried my dear Anthony gaily, “their
+visit has done me more good than all your medicines,
+though but for your kind and constant care, good friend, I
+should never have been able to profit by it.”</p>
+
+<p>Charles now came forward and looked at him inquisitively.</p>
+
+<p>“Are you going to be well very soon, Captain Anthony?”
+he said.</p>
+
+<p>“I hope so, little comrade,” was the reply. “You know
+there is much work to be done still for the King.”</p>
+
+<p>“Ay,” said Charles, “but I shall be sorry when you go
+away. My papa, Sir John, says in his letter that the King
+is coming to Scotland in a few days.”</p>
+
+<p>“God grant he be not too late!” groaned Mr. Peck, but
+we did not heed him, and taking a kindly leave of our
+friend we left the room.</p>
+
+<p>Four days later, my lady had the pleasure of another
+letter from Sir John, and wrote to him the following in reply.
+And here I may say that the fears she had expressed to me
+about their correspondence were justified, for this tender
+but cautious epistle missed Sir John at this time, and lay
+for two months at St. Germains, where he found it on the
+15th of February on his second visit to France.</p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER III</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>
+ “<span class="smcap">My Dearest Life</span>,
+</p>
+
+<p class='letter-indent-plus'>I received yours of the 20th and
+another of the 29th of Nov., which were both most acceptable,
+but they had both been long by the way, for it was the 5 of
+Dec. before I received the first. You are much mistaken in
+thinking I was displeas’d with you for leaveing this country.
+I doe assure you I thought it a lucky providence, and, tho
+I was in fear from not hearing from you, yett it was easy to
+bear in comparison of what terror I must have had if you
+had been in the danger some other of our freinds have been
+in. I suppose you know all our difficultys from better hands
+long ere now, and by that you may guess the torment and
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_180">[180]</span>
+fear and terrible horror I must be in for you and many others.
+If I had known your adress I had writ to you three weeks
+ago and beg’d of you to stay where you was till you saw how
+things would be. I writ to your Brother in hopes he would
+learn itt from some att Edinr., but he told me he could not,
+and you was soon expected, and I was so far from wishing
+you soon back, I was afraid to hear of your return. I pray
+God send a happy end to all, for I am just where I was and
+my hops are still very faint, that person you mention in
+yours not being come yett. Your children are very well, and
+all your other friends. I doe not wish to hear you are
+returned, but when you doe, pray God you may be saffe,
+which is the earnest wish of her who is intirely</p>
+
+<p class='right pr2'>
+ Yours.
+</p>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>Dec. 10.</p>
+
+<p>I am better than could be expected, all things considered.
+If you can have any reasonable pretence to stay, doe not
+come by any means. Mr. Peck gives you his most humble
+service, so does Aunt B. and I.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_181">[181]</span></p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XX">
+ CHAPTER XX
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>MR. FLEMING RIDES AWAY FROM ALVA. THE KING LANDS,
+ AND SIR JOHN RETURNS TO SCOTLAND NOT QUITE
+ IN THE MANNER HE INTENDED</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>On the evening of the day upon which we had visited
+Captain Anthony, Mr. Peck, with an anxious face, sought
+my Lady Erskine (but this unknown to me), and told her
+that he was troubled about his patient as the fever was
+again high, and perceiving, as he thought, that there was
+something on his mind to disturb him, his kind attendant
+had offered to bring my lady to him in order that he
+might confide in her.</p>
+
+<p>Going at once to his chamber, my lady begged to
+know if she could help him, upon which Mr. Fleming,
+as he told me after, with many misgivings and humble
+requests for forgiveness, made confession of what had
+passed between us that afternoon.</p>
+
+<p>He told her how from the first hour he saw Barbara
+Stewart her image had remained in his mind, although
+he had never dreamed of betraying his feelings thus early
+in their friendship. But gladdened by her dear presence,
+touched and surprised on learning of all she had done for
+him in the glen, perhaps a little weakened by his illness,
+he had allowed himself to speak.</p>
+
+<p>“Scarcely had she left the room, madam,” he said,
+“when my heart misgave me sorely, for it seemed to me
+I had abused your hospitality, and taken advantage of
+Mistress Barbara’s innocence and youth; but I fear I repent
+too late. Tell me if in any way I can repair my indiscretion.”</p>
+
+<p>My lady sat silent some time and then asked, “And
+what said Barbara?”</p>
+
+<p>“Madam,” he cried earnestly, “she said not a word.
+But she put her little soft hands in mine, and looked at
+me out of her dark eyes with a look so deep and tender
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_182">[182]</span>
+that for some moments I lost myself in the bliss of it, and
+forgot that she remained silent.”</p>
+
+<p>My lady sighed and smiled together.</p>
+
+<p>“Ah, dear heart!” she cried, “how well I remember!”
+And although he knew not what she meant, I know she
+was thinking of her own young days and the moment
+when Sir John first told her that he loved her.</p>
+
+<p>After a little she went on.</p>
+
+<p>“I am grieved that this should have happened at such
+a time. In a few days at most you must leave us, and
+what is before you, who can tell? My mind misgives me
+when I try to read the future, for after all, Mr. Fleming,
+wounds and death are not the only evils we have to fear.
+Barbara is so young—if you could have waited a while.
+However, there is no sense in crying over spilt milk, as
+the saying is, and what is done is done. Can I trust
+you, sir, to leave it where it is? I love the child as
+dearly as if she were my own sister,” (so my dear lady
+was kind enough to say) “and you may trust me to be
+tender with her; but it is not fitting there should be any
+formal contract between you. There is much to be
+considered, and the times are uncertain. You will not,
+therefore, see Mistress Stewart again except in my presence,
+but you take with you my fervent wishes for your health
+and happiness and a glad return.”</p>
+
+<p>Whatever Mr. Fleming’s desires might have been, he
+was forced to acknowledge my lady’s authority and bow
+to her decision in the matter. Nay, he could not but
+approve of the wisdom of her words, and the kindness of
+her interest in the motherless girl he loved. So, greatly
+comforted, and relieved of the burden of guilt that had
+oppressed him, he fell into a sound sleep, and awaked
+upon the morrow much refreshed and strengthened.</p>
+
+<p>To me, still lost in the wonder of my golden dream,
+and feeling strangely detached from the things of earth,
+my lady’s words were few. She touched lightly upon her
+knowledge of the position, and bade me not fear to confide
+in her, either now or at a future time, for, whatever
+happened, her love and sympathy were with me.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_183">[183]</span></p>
+
+<p>“But,” she added, “you are scarce more than a child,
+Barbara, and know not your powers and capacity. You
+may be greatly taken with our friend, to whom I am also
+much attracted; but time alone will prove the strength
+of your attachment, and I will not have you tied and
+bound by the whim of a passing mood, engendered
+by the most romantic circumstances, to what you might
+regret for your whole life.”</p>
+
+<p>With that she kissed me and sent me about some
+household task; but during the next few days I saw little
+of Captain Anthony, and that only with others in the room.</p>
+
+<p>By the end of the week he pronounced himself fit for
+travel, and late one evening he presented himself before
+us, booted and spurred and ready for the road. The
+children, who had grown to love their hero dearly, were
+much distressed to lose him, and little Hal broke down
+and cried, clinging to his hand on one side and to mine on
+the other. My lady, with kindly tact, busied herself at the
+far end of the room, and but for the child we were alone.</p>
+
+<p>“A token, Mistress Barbara,” whispered my lover imploringly.
+“Give me something of your own to keep by
+me—not as a remembrance, for that I shall not need, but
+as a pledge that you will be glad to see me returned.”</p>
+
+<p>I tore a knot of red ribbon from my dress and pressed it
+into his hand, which closed upon mine as he took it. The
+tears were very near my eyes, and I longed to shed them
+openly like little Harry. But time pressed, and my lady
+came forward to bid our guest farewell.</p>
+
+<p>“God keep you, my beloved!” he murmured.</p>
+
+<p>“And keep you too—for me!” I whispered back with
+trembling lips; and any woman who has seen the man she
+loved ride out to war, will understand what my thoughts
+were as I said it.</p>
+
+<p>A few minutes later we were all assembled at the door.
+Charles stood outside in the frosty night, holding the
+stirrup, and struggling manfully with his grief which he
+judged it childish to show. Mr. Peck was giving a last
+look to the horse, which a few days back he had purchased
+for the traveller. My lady handed him a packet to bear to
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_184">[184]</span>
+her brother, the Master, and pressed him again and again
+to be careful of his health. I stood with little Hal in my
+arms, and watched the scene as in a dream. Allan, the
+shepherd, who was to run by his side and show him the
+short cuts through the hills, now came forward, saying that
+it was time to start; and the next thing I remember is the
+sight of Captain Anthony in the saddle, his hat in his hand,
+a smile on his face, and a look in his eyes that I never
+forgot. A moment after he rode out of the court-yard, and
+the darkness swallowed him up.</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>I take blame to myself that I have writ so much about
+my private affairs, which cannot be of the same interest to
+you as to myself, but you must of your kindness forgive me,
+for it would truly have been impossible for me to tell the
+story of that sorrowful winter, without some particulars of
+this portion of my own history.</p>
+
+<p>After our guest’s departure the days grew darker and
+darker, for the tidings that came to us seemed to crush our
+hopes rather than raise them up. My lady wrote to Betty,
+bidding her come if possible to Alva to spend Christmas
+with us, but she sent back word that she was occupied at
+the sick-bed of her young friend, David, eldest son to their
+neighbour, the Earl of Wemyss, for the hapless youth was
+ill of a fever, and his father was absent in London. A few
+days later came the news of the young gentleman’s death,
+over which my lady grieved with heart-felt sorrow, for, from
+a charming child, he had grown into a bright and promising
+lad, and his early death at the age of sixteen was deplored
+by all who knew him.</p>
+
+<p>Very ill news came also from Perth, and no comfort was
+to be had from France. The big men in the Earl of Mar’s
+army were so busy quarrelling among themselves, that they
+seemed to have lost sight altogether of the Cause that had
+brought them together; and not the least of the trouble, to
+my lady’s mind, lay in the fact that the Master of Sinclair
+was at the head and front of the dissensions. Indeed she
+was sick at heart when she heard of her brother’s conduct,
+for you may be sure that rumour did not fail to make the
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_185">[185]</span>
+worst of it. It has always seemed to me that the Master,
+a man of strong character, and doubtless with an attractiveness
+of his own, might have influenced his friends to better
+issues, but instead of attempting the rôle of peace-maker,
+he did everything in his power to stir up strife. So many
+of the Fife gentlemen joined him, among them Sir James
+Kinloch, Sir Robert Gordon, Major Balfour, Mr. Ogilvie,
+and Mr. Smith of Methven, that they formed themselves
+into what was called the “Grumbling Club,” of which the
+Master of Sinclair was President. Their business was to
+find fault with everything that was done by my Lord Mar,
+to discourage the troops, to foretell disaster, and even
+privately, it was said, to open negotiations with the Duke
+of Argyle, with a view to capitulation. This last failed, for
+the letter written by the Master to the Duke was intercepted
+and brought to the Earl of Mar—an incident which, you
+may be sure, did not increase the love and confidence
+between these two. But later on, when the grumbling and
+the clamour grew louder, they went to their leader, and
+boldly demanded that he should carry out their design.
+This my lord, having news of the King’s coming, refused to do,
+and bade the grumblers have patience among themselves for
+a little longer. Indeed, I believe the poor gentleman was
+at his wit’s end what to do, not having the strength or
+capacity necessary to control his turbulent company.</p>
+
+<p>So ill did the Master behave that my Lord Sinclair, his
+father, having wind of the matter, writ him a very sharp
+letter, chiding him for his conduct and demanding an
+explanation; and when his son departed from Perth, in
+answer to this summons, ’tis said the grumbling ceased,
+but immediately upon his return it broke out again worse
+than ever. It appears that when at home he took solemn
+leave of his friends, making no secret of the fact that he
+expected nothing but defeat, and had no expectation of
+returning in triumph to Dysart.</p>
+
+<p>The Marquis of Huntly, who had never been very eager
+for the Cause, was “led by the nose” by this singular man,
+and seemed only too ready to enter into all his schemes.
+And although the Master told us proudly that Dr.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_186">[186]</span>
+Abercrombie, who had just returned from France, had
+brought him a personal message from the Queen, in which
+she thanked him for his services in seizing the ship at
+Burntisland, and promised that when she and her family
+could, she would not forget to show him favour, his heart
+remained untouched, and he made up his mind, coldly and
+deliberately, to desert the Cause. Granted that he believed
+it hopeless, that he disapproved the methods of his
+superiors, that he had come to the conclusion that the
+whole affair was a sad mistake, still his behaviour could
+not but alienate all loyal and honest men.</p>
+
+<p>The Duke of Argyle in the meantime, though the state
+of the roads kept him inactive at Stirling, for there was a
+prodigious deal of snow on the ground, did not altogether
+neglect his opportunities; for to our great distress we
+learned that he had bombarded and occupied Burntisland,
+and some of the Dutch troops having arrived he very soon
+had all the seaports of Fife in his hands. As most of the
+coal-pits lie in that district this was a serious loss, and
+added to the hardships of an already rigorous winter. The
+foreign soldiers over-ran the place, and food grew scarcer
+and dearer. Further north it was even worse; in the
+counties of Perth and Inverness, it was said, where the
+frost had stopped the working of the mills, there was
+scarcely a grain of meal to be had.</p>
+
+<p>In the midst of all this misery it is not to be supposed
+that we could eat our Christmas Goose with merry hearts,
+but sometime in the beginning of January a packet
+arrived for my lady, which in spite of everything could not
+fail to cheer us. It had been brought to Leith by ship, and
+sent forward by a safe hand, so that it had not been long
+delayed upon the road. It was a letter from her husband
+telling her that the King had sailed for Scotland at last.</p>
+
+<p>There had been many difficulties and hindrances placed
+in his way both by friends and enemies, the former being
+fearful for his safety, the latter desiring to intercept him.
+But after much delay, and being exposed to many hardships,
+he being obliged to travel the open roads on horse-back, and
+even to disguise himself in some of the towns, his Majesty
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_187">[187]</span>
+embarked at Dunkirk in a small ship with a few attendants,
+and must by this time, Sir John opined, have landed in
+Scotland. For himself he was waiting at Calais, detained by
+stress of weather, and by fear of the English men-of-war, which
+filled the channel. He had, he said, on board, much precious
+material, including “two valuable young men,” and he
+designed to land upon the east coast somewhat north of the
+Forth to avoid the risk of cruisers in the Firth. He prayed
+my lady, if she could by any means find it convenient, to
+meet him at Dysart, where he said, it would be easier for him
+to come than to Alva, and she would be well advised to leave
+home immediately upon receiving his letter, as he hoped his
+arrival should not be much behind it.</p>
+
+<p>He went on to say that the winter, which he heard was
+severe in Scotland, was equally so on the Continent. In
+country places in France and in the north of Spain, the
+wolves and bears, made bold by hunger, were prowling round
+the villages and towns, and some of the poor peasants had
+died of starvation, being unable to come through the snow
+to the market-towns for food. He ended by saluting his
+household kindly each by name, and sending merry
+messages to his little sons.</p>
+
+<p>Now all again was bustle and excitement in the house,
+for waiting and uncertainty are the hardest things on earth
+to bear, and the hopeful tone of Sir John’s letter, as well as
+the good news it contained, seemed to put a different
+complexion on our affairs. Now it was possible to hold
+up our heads, to look forward, to plan, to be joyful, and as,
+for my lady, any disaster were easier to bear than separation
+from her husband, she made ready with all haste to
+go to her father’s house as he had ordered. It was not so
+pleasant to me to be left behind with Aunt Betty and the
+children, but as my lady made no proposal of carrying me
+with her, I must needs make the best of the situation. I
+begged of her to be very prompt and regular in writing to
+inform us of anything that took place, and promising on
+my part to keep her informed of all that happened with us,
+we bade her adieu, and watched her depart, accompanied by
+the faithful Andrew, with very mingled feelings.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_188">[188]</span></p>
+
+<p>Before we had any news from Dysart, however, we heard
+through another source some very dismal tidings, which
+threw Aunt Betty into a state of great affliction, and
+brought my own spirits pretty low. Sir John, we heard, had
+indeed arrived on Scottish shores, but in a most untoward
+manner, for his ship had been wrecked not far from
+Dundee, and all the treasure and arms he was bringing
+were lost in the sea. Further, the messenger was not
+certain whether Sir John and his crew were alive or dead,
+and the consternation into which we were thrown for some
+hours was very great. Next day, however, came letters from
+my lady which went far to mitigate our grief. Sir John and
+all his companions were safe, and though much of the
+ammunition had been destroyed, for the ship was broke to
+pieces, the gold which he was bringing was safe. It was
+still in the hulk which lay on the sandbank where she
+stranded, and they had great hopes, if they could avoid the
+vigilance of the enemy, of getting all off.</p>
+
+<p>Sir John’s fellow-travellers, the “two valuable young
+men” he had mentioned, turned out to be the Marquis of
+Tynemouth (or Tinmouth), son to the Duke of Berwick,
+and therefore nephew to the King, and my Lord Talbot,
+an Irish peer. “The former,” wrote my lady, “is said by
+Sir John to be a very worthy young gentleman, and will
+recommend himself to all persons of merit.” As for
+herself, she was so thankful to Providence for preserving
+her husband’s life, that she had scarce time to mourn over
+his disaster, which nevertheless was a serious one. She
+told us that the King had arrived at Peterhead some weeks
+back, but promised to gather all news of the proceedings
+in the north from Sir John, and bring it home to Alva,
+whither she designed returning as soon after meeting with
+her husband as possible. Betty, she told us, had been
+very dumpish and melancholy all winter, being in great
+trouble and anxiety about the King’s affairs, and much
+exercised over the behaviour of her brother. She was now
+more cheerful, however, and would accompany her sister to
+Alva on her return, which she did some days later, when we
+welcomed them both, you may be sure, with great delight.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_189">[189]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXI">
+ CHAPTER XXI
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>TELLS OF THE COMING OF THE KING TO PERTH, AND
+ WHAT ENSUED THEREAFTER</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>It will be well for me now to give you shortly some account
+of the proceedings at Perth, which I learned from Mr.
+Fleming’s own lips some time after, though it would, I
+know, be easy for you to gather the facts from the history-books
+written about that period. And because I fear I am
+becoming tedious in my narrative, I will pass over many
+details and give you the bare outline of what took place,
+in order to carry on the story of my dear friends at Alva
+in a way that you will understand.</p>
+
+<p>When Captain Anthony Fleming, upon his return to
+Perth, sought out the Master of Sinclair in order to deliver
+to him my lady’s letter, and give him news of the family,
+he found to his dismay that he was gone. Seaforth, as we
+know, had hurried north after Sheriffmuir, and, as was the
+custom of the Highlanders after a battle, many of them
+had returned home. Now my Lord of Huntly was gone to
+save his estates from the Earl of Sutherland, and to get
+back the town of Inverness, so it was said; but we know
+that nobleman had decided to play his cards another way,
+for he made a truce with my Lord Sutherland, and later
+sent in his submission to Argyle, asking for pardon or
+protection from the Government. The Master of Sinclair,
+shortly after he left, had followed him, saying as his excuse
+that “having given so much umbrage to certain people in
+Perth, he could be of no more use to the Cause, which
+now was not only desperate, but sunk.” And so he
+deserted the foundering ship, thinking most of his own
+danger and the necessity of saving his precious skin. Mr.
+Fleming, like all other loyal gentlemen, had his own
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_190">[190]</span>
+opinion of such conduct, but though bitterly disappointed
+in the man who had ever been friendly to him, and to
+whom he felt he owed so much, he refrained from
+commenting upon it till long years after.</p>
+
+<p>In the midst of so much that was discouraging, an
+express one day arrived with the joyful news that the King
+was at hand, for a ship had appeared in the offing about
+the Height of Montrose, which had made <i>the signals</i>, viz.,
+the raising and lowering of a white flag on the topmasthead,
+and, being answered from the shore, had passed on northwards.
+At once the Earl of Mar began his preparations
+for going to receive his Majesty, and great joy ran through
+the entire community from the highest officers to the
+common soldiers, for all were weary of the delay, and
+looked forward to large reinforcements, and a speedy
+meeting with the enemy. A few days later a young gentleman,
+Lieutenant Cameron by name, who had accompanied
+the King from France, rode into Perth with the acceptable
+tidings that our long-looked for Sovereign had landed at
+Peterhead, and was awaiting an interview with the Earl of
+Mar and his companions. By great good fortune my lord
+commanded Mr. Fleming to ride with him in the capacity of
+Captain of his Guard of Horse, and the same day he, with
+my Lord Marischal, General Hamilton, and about thirty
+other gentlemen of quality, set out to go and attend him.
+The King, having lodged one night at Peterhead, and
+another at Newburgh House, had passed <i>incognito</i> through
+Aberdeen, and was now at Fetteresso, the principal seat
+of my Lord Marischal, and thither the party from Perth
+hastened, full of ardour and loyalty. I will give you Mr.
+Fleming’s own words as to his impressions upon first beholding
+his Majesty.</p>
+
+<p>“After having received the Earls of Mar and Marischal
+and the other noblemen within the castle, and conversed
+with them for some time, his Majesty expressed a desire
+to inspect the soldiers of the guard, who were drawn up in
+front of the house. You may imagine that, on being
+hurriedly prepared for this honour by General Hamilton,
+we sat our horses in great excitement, only restrained by
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_191">[191]</span>
+discipline. For my own part my heart beat high in my
+bosom, and all the loyal and chivalrous sentiments that had
+been nurtured in my mind from childhood rose up to
+welcome my rightful and much injured King. When he
+appeared at the door, looking pale and young and very
+weary, there came into my throat something that caught
+my breath—a spasm of love and yearning that the sight of
+no other man on earth could possibly bring—and at the
+moment when I brought my sword to the salute I knew I
+would gladly lay down my life for King James. A few
+minutes after I heard the voice of my Lord Mar loudly
+proclaiming him at the gate of the house, and, following
+my impulse, I waved my sword above my head, and shouted
+with all my strength, ‘God save the King!’—a shout in
+which both my soldiers and all others present willingly
+joined. His Majesty bowed, and a faint smile came to his
+lips, but oddly enough, and quite beyond my own volition,
+I found myself, as I watched him, repeating some dreary
+words, ‘<i>A stranger in a strange land</i>!’ He did not look
+glad to be among us; there was no response in his eyes to
+the welcome we gave him. He came to his own, and
+though they received him joyfully, it was as though he
+knew them not.”</p>
+
+<p>Was this, I have often wondered, the reason of it all—of
+the disappointment, the disillusion, the tragedy of his
+coming? My heart aches still to think of it. He was
+worn out with hardships and anxiety (those who knew
+what his life had been for the last three months know that),
+the weather was bitterly cold, his country—our country—lay
+in the inhospitable grasp of winter, and he had a price
+set upon his head. He felt ill in body, for on the next day
+he was taken with an aguish distemper which kept him
+from moving for several days, and uneasy in mind, for
+already he had doubts of the wisdom of his undertaking.
+We know that he was not born “under a dancing star” as
+Mr. Shakespeare’s “Beatrice” hath it, and for that reason
+much is to be forgiven him; but oh! we in Scotland need
+to be melted by a merry smile, or a kindly word, or a
+genial manner, or we may be taken by storm by something
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_192">[192]</span>
+more forcible than these; but let our coldness be met
+by coldness, our shyness by a greater shyness, or our
+enthusiasm by indifference, then the icy crust that covers
+our fire grows harder and harder, and the dour pride that oft
+makes the Scot a trouble to himself, as well as to others,
+forbids the breaking down of the barrier for ever. He
+lacked something, our poor King, that vital something
+which his uncle, King Charles II., and, as I understand, his
+son Prince Charles Edward (neither of them so just or so
+virtuous as himself), possessed to the full—the power to
+draw all hearts to him, to persuade the reluctant, to
+confirm the wavering, to inspire the doubtful with
+confidence—the personal human charm, without which no
+leader of men can achieve great things.</p>
+
+<p>Upon the recovery of his Majesty, he and his attendants
+came south by slow degrees to Brechin, to Kinnaird, to
+Glamis, and then to Dundee. At this place he was
+received with great enthusiasm by the populace, and sat
+for about an hour on horseback in the market-place, while
+the eager people flocked to kiss his hand. From Dundee
+he went to Fingask, the seat of Sir David Threipland,
+where he lay that Saturday night, and next day being
+Sunday he arrived at Scone, within two miles of Perth.</p>
+
+<p>Now, if the joy had been great at the news of the safe
+arrival of the King, with whom you must remember it was
+supposed were thousands of troops and much treasure, the
+disappointment and chagrin on learning that he came
+almost alone were great in proportion. And when it was
+discovered that neither he nor the Earl of Mar were
+moving actively in the matter of defending the town, or
+taking steps to meet the enemy, much discontent arose, and
+the whole place was in a state of dissatisfaction. My Lord
+Mar attempted to pacify them by spreading a fresh report
+of help coming from France; the presence of the young
+Lord Tinmouth, the Duke of Berwick’s son, was pointed to
+as a proof that the Regent was now inclined to the Cause;
+General Hamilton was again in Paris urging our necessity,
+and the Duke of Argyle’s men were wavering and deserting,
+it was said, day by day. The weather and the state of the
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_193">[193]</span>
+roads were also given as a reason for inaction, and there
+was much talk of the coming Coronation at Scone. But
+all this availed little, and when it transpired on the arrival
+of one of our spies from Stirling, that Argyle was
+reconnoitring the roads, and making preparations for
+having them cleared of the snow, with a view to laying
+siege to Perth, the excitement rose to fever-heat while the
+dissatisfaction gave place to joy. Was it conceivable that
+they should remain, they said, to be slaughtered like
+badgers in their holes without making a fight for it? No, it
+was impossible; they could remain no longer inactive, and
+at once preparations were begun for defending the town,
+planting guns, digging trenches, throwing up breast-works
+and the like, which gave the impatient people something to
+occupy their thoughts, though, as you know, the work was
+quite ineffectual, for the town would have been very easily
+taken had the Government troops advanced upon it.</p>
+
+<p>And now comes one of the saddest incidents in all this
+sad history; an instance of the cruelty of war upon the
+innocent, who must often suffer, though guiltless of either
+crime or provocation. I know not in whose brain the
+unhappy thought first had birth, and indeed, as Sir
+Anthony now tells me, the idea itself, from a strategic
+point of view, was not altogether a mistake. But to us it
+came as a shock so grievous that for a long time we could
+scarce bear to talk of it, and in that way, perhaps, we did
+both the thought and the action injustice.</p>
+
+<p>Upon a second attempt of the Duke of Argyle to view
+the roads from Dunblane to Auchterarder, which he made
+accompanied by General Cadogan, who we heard had
+been sent down from London for the very purpose of
+hastening the Duke’s movements, the leaders at Perth
+became so alarmed, having thought themselves secure
+while the severe weather lasted, that an order was given
+out, signed alas! by the King, for the burning of the
+villages of Auchterarder, Crieff, Blackford, Dunning and
+Muthill, with all corn and forage which could not be
+carried off, so as to lay waste the country between Stirling
+and Perth, in order to embarrass the Government troops.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_194">[194]</span></p>
+
+<p>Now to my mind, and to many others at the time, this
+cruel order was resultant of nothing but misery to those
+who had no right to suffer, for although it gave to Argyle’s
+men the inconvenience and discomfort of camping for two
+nights on the bare ground, it neither detained them in their
+progress, nor disordered their arrangements, seeing that
+on so short a march ’twas possible to carry both forage and
+vivers with them. We know that the King was most
+reluctant to sign the order, and that two days after he writ
+a letter to the Duke, begging him to employ a certain sum
+of money to be paid out of his own scant treasury, for
+compensating the unfortunate people so harshly deprived
+of their homes. The letter was, I am told, suppressed, but
+of the King’s regret and of his kind intentions I have never
+entertained the slightest doubt. Indeed, the Earl of Mar
+let it be widely known that his Majesty wished it given out,
+that if any of the poor folk pleased to come to Perth, they
+should be maintained and all care taken of them. Howbeit
+the deed was done, and many a long day would pass ere
+the memory of it should die away.</p>
+
+<p>And now in Perth the Council sat all night
+deliberating what should be done, and messengers were
+posting constantly between that place and Scone, for the
+great men could not come to an agreement. On one
+side was the military party, who, knowing the minds of the
+soldiers on the matter, were all for fighting and that at
+once. On the other side were the Earl of Mar and some
+of his friends, who said they were not willing thus to risk the
+safety of the King. It was suggested to the latter that the
+King’s presence was not necessary in a battle, and that if
+he were placed in security, his faithful adherents would
+prove their loyalty by fighting for him to the death.
+They were ready, they said, to die for him; but not to turn
+their backs like scoundrels and poltroons without striking a
+blow for him who had come so far to trust his person and his
+fortunes in their hands. Words ran high, and some of the
+Highlanders <i>ruffled</i> the great men in the open streets, and
+told them in plain terms that they were betraying the King
+rather than helping him. One who was thus accosted, a
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_195">[195]</span>
+friend of my Lord Mar’s, stopped to answer them, and Mr.
+Fleming heard this conversation pass between them.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, what would you have us do?” said the gentleman.
+“Do!” says the other. “What did you call us to arms
+for? Was it to run away? What did the King come
+hither for? Was it to see his people butchered by the
+hangman, and not strike a stroke for their lives? Let us
+die like men and not like dogs!” “What can we do?”
+cries the nobleman to these brave words. “Let us,” says
+the Highlander, “have a council of war, and let all the
+General Officers speak their minds freely, the King himself
+being present, and if it be agreed there not to fight, we
+must submit.”</p>
+
+<p>Some went further than this, for one bold chief threatened
+them, that the loyal clans would take the King from them,
+and then if he were willing to die like a Prince he should
+find that there were ten thousand gentlemen in Scotland
+who were not afraid to die with him.</p>
+
+<p>As some said one thing and some another, the tumult
+and disorder increased, till at last some of the wiser among
+the officers quieted the soldiers by assuring them there
+would be a council held that night, that the King begged
+them as his good friends to abide by what was then decided,
+as he was resolved himself to do: either to put it to the
+hazard and take his fate with them, or if otherwise advised
+to abide by that.</p>
+
+<p>Accordingly, the Grand Council met, and much was said
+on this side and much on that, but from what I was told by
+Mr. Fleming, it seemed that all the talk was only for show,
+for the meeting was adjourned without any decision having
+been come to. Next morning, however, a select number
+having been called together, the Earl of Mar confided to
+them in secret, that owing to many circumstances which he
+considered it inconvenient to divulge, he found it advisable
+not only to beat a retreat from Perth, but to put an end to
+their design for the time being. ’Twas whispered, he said,
+that there were traitors in the camp, men of high standing,
+who were already conspiring to seize upon the person of the
+King and deliver him up to the Duke of Argyle. It was
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_196">[196]</span>
+almost incredible, said the Earl, that such a thing could
+be; but with a free pardon and £100,000, even an honest
+Scotsman might be tempted. Finally, as the Duke was now
+within a few miles of Perth, it was absolutely necessary that
+we should evacuate the town.</p>
+
+<p>After this, said my informant, there was nothing more
+left but to acquiesce in the decision, though by many it
+was done with a very bad grace. That the King himself
+was sorely grieved, I make no doubt, and it was with a
+heavy heart, I trow, that he consented to leave Scone, and
+to follow his army across the Tay. That river being
+frozen hard they were able, horse and foot, to pass over as
+if upon dry land, and quickly as they had acted they were
+but just in time, for, expresses having carried the news of the
+retreat to the enemy, a body of dragoons entered the town
+the very next day. To the majority of our officers no
+further instructions had been issued than that the army was
+to retire upon Aberdeen, so that what followed after came
+upon them as a cruel surprise, and by many of them, I feel
+sure, ’twas never either understood or forgiven.</p>
+
+<p>And now, if you please, I must leave Head-quarters, and
+return to Alva to let you know how things were going there.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_197">[197]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXII">
+ CHAPTER XXII
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>HOW WE HEAR TIDINGS THAT MAKE OUR HEARTS ACHE,
+ AND ILL PREPARE US FOR THE GREAT SURPRISE</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>The short afternoon was closing in. The snow was
+falling steadily and soft, for there was no wind and the frost
+still held. We sat at work in the hall, being gathered there
+for warmth, for in this hard winter when so many poor
+were abroad, my lady thought shame to burn coal freely,
+choosing rather to give it away to her poorer neighbours,
+who, you may be sure, blessed her for the thought. She
+had bidden us bring our work and sit by her as she span,
+for she knew how restless and unhappy we were, and hoped
+perhaps to ease her own burdened heart by friendly and
+intimate talk.</p>
+
+<p>We had that day had news which moved my lady sadly.
+For General Cadogan, who shortly before had arrived at
+Stirling, having been sent from the Court in London to
+urge the Duke of Argyle to immediate action, had brought
+with him an order to deprive Colonel Erskine of the
+Command of the Castle, and to send him, together with his
+son, John, under a Guard to London, where he was to be
+lodged in the Fleet prison. The thought of the poor old
+gentleman being made to suffer the hardships of the long
+journey in this cruel winter weather, was very bitter to us
+all, and to be obliged to sit helpless and do nothing but
+talk, was, as Betty cried impatiently, the worst of it.</p>
+
+<p>“I am convinced,” my lady said, again and again, “that
+nothing can be found against them save their relationship
+to Sir John, and my Lord Mar’s friendship for the Colonel,
+and that, as you know, has lasted many years and is quite
+unconnected with this affair. ’Twould be unreasonable
+indeed to think it.”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, sister,” cried Betty vehemently, “do you think
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_198">[198]</span>
+those fools have any reason? If they had, would they not
+know that it is <i>they</i> who are in the wrong, and stop all this
+cruel opposition? But for poor Colonel Erskine I agree
+with all you say, and I must own I hope the good
+gentleman may be treated with all the care and respect he
+deserves.”</p>
+
+<p>“’Tis done to spite the Earl of Mar,” said my lady, “you
+may be sure. The Governorship has been in his family for
+hundreds of years, and my uncle holds it for him as his
+Lieutenant. I am not so blind as not to see they are in the
+right to make a change at such a time, but ’tis neither
+kind nor just to send a harmless old man to prison at such
+a distance, in weather like this.”</p>
+
+<p>“Who will take his place, madam, think you?” asked I.</p>
+
+<p>“’Tis an open secret that the Government will offer it to
+Lord Rothes,” said Betty. “That has long been talked in
+Fife.”</p>
+
+<p>“Well,” said my lady, “he is a humane and generous
+enemy; we have little to fear from him. If only they had
+confined the Colonel in Blackness or Edinburgh Castle,
+and saved him the horrors of that long journey to London.”</p>
+
+<p>And again the tears came to her eyes, for there was a
+tender friendship between these two, and my lady would
+have guarded the old man with a daughter’s care.</p>
+
+<p>There was nothing to say to comfort her, and we sat
+silent, weaving our sad thoughts into our work as women
+will, for each of us had, as you know, our private weight of
+woe. My own heart was away with the King’s army,
+wondering and pondering over the welfare of one of his
+least important officers; poor Betty, I knew, was following
+her brother in his ignominious flight, and my dear lady,
+besides her other troubles, had ever the fear for Sir John’s
+safety upon her mind.</p>
+
+<p>It was while we were sitting thus, wrapped in gloom,
+that a messenger arrived with news for my lady. With a
+sigh she bade him enter, fearing that, like Job, she was
+about to hear of disaster upon disaster. And so, indeed, it
+proved. This man was come to tell us how his Grace of
+Argyle had set the country people to work, to the number
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_199">[199]</span>
+of about two thousand, to clear the roads of the snow, so
+as to make it possible for his army to march to Perth; and
+scarcely was he finished speaking when there arrived one
+of our neighbours, Mr. Abercrombie of Tullibody I think it
+was, who broke to us the awful news of the burning of the
+villages. I will not shock you now by describing the way
+in which the deed was done, for officers, I suppose, are
+not wholly responsible for the actions of the soldiery, and
+sure I am that those who gave the order had no thought of
+thieving, or plundering from the poor people, whom they
+believed themselves obliged to render homeless; but neither
+was it necessary to take them by surprise at four o’clock in
+the morning, and turn them out of their beds in scant attire
+in the bitter cold. Long before Mr. Abercrombie, himself
+much moved, had come to an end of his recital, we
+sat horrified and with streaming eyes around him, seeing
+as he spoke the women with their infants, the feeble old
+men, the tottering children, hungry and naked, driven
+ruthlessly through the snow.</p>
+
+<p>“And who dare issue an order so monstrous?” cried
+Betty at last, being ever the first to find her tongue. “Who
+among our people could invent so diabolical a measure?”</p>
+
+<p>“Ah, madam,” said our guest sadly, “all is fair in war
+’tis said, and if we can embarrass the enemy we think little
+of the means taken to do so. The order was signed by
+the Chevalier himself, as was necessary, he being at the
+head of his army.”</p>
+
+<p>“I’ll not believe it!” cried Betty. “He is a humane
+and gentle prince. I’ll never believe he understood what he
+wished them to do.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, Bess, my dear,” said my lady, “’twas sure not by
+his good will ’twas done; but can you not see that if his
+General Officers advised it, the King must put his name to
+the order?”</p>
+
+<p>“Ay, sister,” wailed Betty, “and can <i>you</i> not see the
+folly of it, even apart from the cruelty? I say that they
+have betrayed their King. Who will believe in the
+reluctance of his Majesty? Who will ever know anything of
+it? Whatever happens now, this deed that has been done in
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_200">[200]</span>
+his name will cling to the memory of the people. Whenever
+he is mentioned their hearts will burn within them at the
+thought of it. Never, never will they do him justice, but
+will remember him only as the cause of their misery and
+ruin for ever.”</p>
+
+<p>My lady bowed her head sadly, and I wept the more,
+for Betty’s burning words fell upon our ears like a solemn
+prophecy, and we knew that her words were true. ’Twas
+indeed a miserable and mistaken act, long, long to be rued
+among us.</p>
+
+<p>“I hear,” said Mr. Abercrombie, “that the barony of
+Dalreoch, belonging to Mr. Haldane of Gleneagles, is
+utterly destroyed; straw and corn and fodder being
+heaped around the houses and then set alight, and the
+servants and farm people having barely escaped with their
+lives. They looked to find horses and cattle for their use,
+but those have long ago been carried off.”</p>
+
+<p>“I am sorry for my sister,” said my lady, “but they
+suffer only with the rest; and she at least has the comfort
+of knowing that her husband is on the safe side of the
+fence. We are told, sir, that the Duke is pushing on
+towards Perth. Is it known in that town of his approach?”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, without doubt,” replied our visitor, “and for some
+time they have been occupied fortifying the place; but I
+have private information, madam, that ’tis likely the army
+may retire to Aberdeen, rather than stay to be besieged in
+Perth. And after all this may be the safer method to draw
+Argyle further from his base.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, indeed, I am glad to hear this,” cried my lady,
+(for since the departure of her brother from Perth, we had
+heard but little news from that quarter); “they will fight
+him further north, and for one thing they will be nearer the
+sea, so that the troops when they arrive from France may
+be able to join them without delay.”</p>
+
+<p>I thought that Mr. Abercrombie looked dubious at the
+mention of troops, but he did not discourage my lady, and
+after some more talk, which I am bound to say he endeavoured
+to lead into a more cheerful channel, he went away.</p>
+
+<p>But it was impossible to hide from ourselves, and from
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_201">[201]</span>
+each other, that our hopes were very faint indeed and our
+fears greatly increased. We could talk and think of little
+save those poor, starving, suffering folk in the Stewarty of
+Strathearn, and many were the plans arranged by Lady
+Erskine to send them help of food and clothing, tho’ the
+poor about her own doors were numerous and necessitous
+enough.</p>
+
+<p>Meantime the enemy, having once begun to act, seemed
+bent on losing no more time. The great fall of snow,
+which was everywhere two or three feet deep, was followed
+by another hard frost, and the roads were thus rendered
+extremely difficult. But the Duke, urged on by his orders
+from Court, was only waiting for the arrival of some
+regiments from Glasgow, and artillery from Berwick and
+Edinburgh. The storm having delayed a train of artillery
+from England under Colonel Borgard, it arrived in the
+Roads of Leith late one Saturday afternoon, and marching
+with all possible speed to Stirling, reached that place in time
+to join the main army in its march northwards. Once
+again upon a Sunday could be seen the dark stream of
+horse, foot, and artillery winding slowly along the snowy
+road, and though the Duke went no further that day than
+to Dunblane, a detachment was sent forward to the Castle
+of Braco, which however they found deserted. And still
+we had to sit and nurse our fears in patience, and for a
+whole long week we suffered the martyrdom that women in
+all ages of the world have suffered, that of sitting at home
+and waiting.</p>
+
+<p>All sorts of rumours continued to fly about, and friendly
+neighbours came to discuss whatever they heard. There
+had been a battle—the King’s army was stricken—nay, the
+French troops had arrived in time and Argyle had had the
+worst of it. There had been no fight, but half the Highland
+chiefs had surrendered and asked for protection, indeed
+they had delivered the King’s person to his Grace of Argyle
+who was bringing him in triumph to Edinburgh; or again
+the King had been crowned at Scone, and upon hearing of
+it the greater number of Argyle’s soldiers, excepting always
+the Dutch troops, had deserted to the enemy. These and
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_202">[202]</span>
+other wild stories were afloat, to be listened to, frowned at,
+laughed over, and, for the most part, rejected, but nothing
+so wild and improbable as the truth ever entered our heads.</p>
+
+<p>It was not until Tuesday, the 7th of February, that the
+final blow came, and again it was Mr. Abercrombie that
+brought the news. The King’s army had evacuated Perth,
+it is true, and under General Gordon had retired upon
+Aberdeen; but the King, accompanied by the Earl of Mar,
+and one or two other noblemen, had embarked at Montrose
+three days before, and were now well on their way back to
+France.</p>
+
+<p>It was impossible to palliate or disguise the bitter fact,
+and our informant blurted it out in the shortest and plainest
+words. What terror we were in, what surprise and disappointment,
+what shame and chagrin we suffered, I will
+leave you to imagine. By degrees we learnt that there had
+been no council held by the General Officers before taking
+this step, that only a few intimates of my Lord Mar knew
+of it, and that the rest were full of rage and indignation,
+considering that they had been betrayed and abandoned to
+the enemy. That the King had been persuaded it was the
+best and wisest thing he could do, believing that with his
+removal the Rising would collapse, the army disperse, and
+the country become quiet, we could not of course have any
+doubt. But when all was said and done, the vengeance of
+the Government was still to be reckoned with, and he had
+left them to face it alone. It was not by my lady nor her
+sister that any censure was passed upon their beloved King,
+nor did they voice their opinion of my Lord Mar in any
+way to blame him. But those outside the house were not
+so discreet, and indeed it added to our pain to hear the
+free comments that were made upon the affair.</p>
+
+<p>In the meantime, where was Sir John; what had become
+of the Master of Sinclair, whose wisdom and foresight Betty
+now extolled to the skies; and what, oh, what of Barbara’s
+lover, too insignificant to all but herself to be worthy
+of mention in the general reports? I can tell you
+there were three sorrowful women at Alva in those days,
+and the saddest of all perhaps was my Lady Erskine, who
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_203">[203]</span>
+went about with folded lips and fear-haunted eyes, forcing
+herself to her daily tasks, as she told me after, “with a
+thousand pins and needles in her heart.”</p>
+
+<p>By degrees we heard fresh tidings: how General Gordon
+had abandoned Aberdeen, after occupying it for only two
+days; how the army, upon deciding that each man must
+shift for himself, had dispersed in various directions, promising
+however to come together again upon word received
+from the King; how many of the officers and noblemen
+had embarked in ships for France and Sweden; and how
+others, less fortunate, were hiding in the mountain-districts
+of the Highlands, expecting, as was natural, to be hunted
+by the Government troops, and waiting till they also could
+find ships to bear them to the Continent. But all this time
+not a word of our good Sir John. We watched my lady’s
+face grow whiter and more worn, and longed in our helplessness
+to comfort her.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, oh why, does he not contrive to send word to
+her?” cried Betty, the tears in her eyes. “He cannot be
+dead. I defy them to keep him prisoner; and if he be
+anywhere in Scotland he could surely have sent a messenger
+of some sort to Alva. But men are all alike, thoughtless
+and selfish, and have little care for the unfortunate woman
+at home once they have left them.”</p>
+
+<p>I forgave the bitterness of her tone knowing how her
+heart yearned after her eldest brother, for no news had been
+received for long, and her words applied equally to him.
+But the very next day relief came.</p>
+
+<p>We had but just finished dinner when a noise in the lobby
+attracted our attention, and Charles rising and running to
+the door called out: “’Tis Andrew! Oh, mama, Andrew
+Short is returned. And why did you not bring my papa
+home again, Andrew? Where is he?”</p>
+
+<p>Trembling and agitated we rose to greet him, for Andrew
+had been with Sir John, and we dreaded what his tidings
+might be. A sore-stricken and weary man was he that
+entered the room; so woe-begone his countenance, so shame-faced
+his mien that I for one feared the very worst.
+“Andrew, where is Sir John?” cried my lady, running up
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_204">[204]</span>
+to him, and looking in his face with such haggard anxiety in
+her eyes as touched the good fellow to the heart.</p>
+
+<p>“Sir John is safe, my leddy!” he said quickly, in a hoarse
+voice, “or ye never wad hae seen me here. But does yer
+leddyship ken whaur the King is, an’ his freend, the Earl o’
+Mar?”</p>
+
+<p>“Alas, yes! my good Andrew, and our hearts are heavy
+enough at the knowledge, and all it means to Scotland.
+But you are spent and hungry, and though you must satisfy
+me about Sir John, we will wait till you are warmed and
+fed before you give us further news. You have a letter for
+me, belike?”</p>
+
+<p>She looked at him eagerly, and her face fell when he
+shook his head.</p>
+
+<p>“Na, my leddy, nae letter. Sir John wadna trust a written
+line; but I was tae tell ye he sailed for France on the second
+day of this month, that was twa days <i>afore</i> the ither folk
+took their leave, ye ken, mem. And landed safe he is, I
+mak’ nae doot, by this time.”</p>
+
+<p>My lady sank down upon a chair, and covered her face
+with her hands for a little space.</p>
+
+<p>“Thank God!” she said at length, “he is at least
+beyond danger. But can you not tell me more, Andrew?
+Who sent him away, and for what purpose?”</p>
+
+<p>“My leddy,” said the man, “I canna tell ye mair than
+Sir John tellt me, and that was that he had orders tae sail
+for France from Montrose on the Thursday nicht, wi’
+despatches, he said, tae the Queen; that I was tae bide
+whaur I was for twa days, and then tae come hame as fast
+but as secret as I could manage it, and bring his love and
+kind respects tae yer leddyship, and tell ye he was gane awa’
+tae France.”</p>
+
+<p>And though we questioned him closely he had no more
+to tell us of the matter. After he had been sent away to
+rest and be fed, my lady looked at us uneasily.</p>
+
+<p>“I must send an express to Charles Erskine this very
+night,” she said, “to give him news of his brother. But
+why has Sir John sent me no instructions as to what he
+wishes me to do?”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_205">[205]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Indeed, sister,” said Betty, “it surprises me that Sir
+John did not acquaint you with his plans when you saw him
+at Dysart. It is impossible he did not know something of
+what was to happen, for he was ever in the confidence of
+my Lord Mar. Why did he not prepare you for this?”</p>
+
+<p>“God knows,” said my lady, in sad perplexity, gazing out
+of the window at the snow-clad world; “and He alone
+knows what will happen to us now.”</p>
+
+<p>“Perhaps if Sir John knew anything he was bound to
+secrecy,” cried I, who could not bear to hear my kind
+guardian blamed even by those who loved him. “But tell
+me, dear madam, what is’t you fear?”</p>
+
+<p>“Vengeance, Barbara,” she answered, with sombre
+earnestness, “the vengeance of the reigning house. Sir John
+is no longer a trusted agent of the rightful King, he is a
+Rebel, an Outlaw, an Exile; and who knows whether he may
+not be attainted, and all his estates forfeited to the Crown?”</p>
+
+<p>“What’s forfeited, mama?” cried little Charles. “Oh,
+I do want my papa to come home,” and at that my lady
+caught the boy to her breast, and broke into a fit of wild
+weeping, pouring out her anguish, poor soul, to us who
+wept with her, all the more freely that she had hitherto
+kept her feelings so well under control.</p>
+
+<p>But the express was sent that afternoon to Edinburgh,
+and the very next evening Mr. Erskine was with us. Kind
+and calm and cheerful, it is impossible to exaggerate the
+helpful influence he exercised upon us. He combated my
+lady’s fears, telling her that though it was impossible to
+know yet what parliament might or might not decide, he had
+great hopes that, as the Rebellion had not gone far, they
+would not act with extreme rigour. Again, he said,
+although Sir John had shown himself active in the Cause,
+he had many friends upon the other side, all of them in
+good odour with the Government; and everything that could
+be said or done in Sir John’s favour, to create a feeling of
+confidence, would, he knew, be willingly carried out. In
+the meantime he thought there was nothing to do but to
+wait quietly and see what should transpire. His one
+anxiety seemed to be that his brother, Sir John, in his
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_206">[206]</span>
+impulsive way, might decide at once to settle abroad and
+desire his wife to come to him with their children, and this
+he thought would be unwise, as it would mean abandoning
+his estate to whoever might be ready to seize it. Patience
+and silence were the two things he recommended, besides
+promising my lady all the help in his power whenever she
+should desire it. The letter of the thirteenth of February
+was written while Mr. Erskine was in the house with us,
+and in it you will see that my dear lady had schooled
+herself to write quietly and moderately. The very day
+before she wrote, poor Betty had been somewhat comforted
+by receiving a letter from her brother, who wrote to
+her on the eve of his sailing for France.</p>
+
+<p>He had, after many hardships, got as far north as Kirkwall
+in the Orkney Islands, and from thence to Stromness,
+where, with several others, he seized a ship with a French
+pilot on board and set sail for Calais. Her mind was
+therefore at rest about his person, though like my lady she
+dreaded on his account the impending <i>vengeance</i> which
+had all the horrors of the unknown.</p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER IV</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>
+ <span class="smcap">My Dearest Life</span>,
+</p>
+
+<p class='letter-indent-plus'>It was no small satisfaction to me in the
+present state of affairs to hear you was gone. It is what I
+shall bless God for while I live. Your servant’s return was
+the first account I had; tho’ my grief was unexpressable the
+thoughts of your safety did mitigate it very much. It was
+impossible but you did foresee what wold happen when I was
+with you, and if you did, you were much to blame not (to) tell
+me your thoughts of itt, and what methods should be taken for
+your private affairs. Charles is here just now and most kindly
+offers to doe all in his power, as I doubt not all your other
+friends will; but he expected I wold have had a method from
+you. Whether you did not imagin so suden an end, or would
+not give mee a sore heart befor the time, I know not.</p>
+
+<p>Now let me beg of you, as you regard me and your children,
+not to have any uneasy thoughts about us. I am not afraid of
+want of sober bread for them and myself; but as I told you the
+thoughts of your being in pinches is very Bitter, and the
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_207">[207]</span>
+prospect I must have of being absent from you for some time,
+and perhaps for ever, is what imploys my thoughts night
+and day. But why should I complain of what God in his wise
+providence has ordered as a just punishment for the abuse of
+many mercys. Let us then, my Dearest, submit with patience,
+and trust in that mercyful Father who has hitherto preserv’d
+you from so imminent dangers, that He will, in His own good
+time, give us a comfortable meeting, and to live as becomes
+the children of affliction, in endeavouring to set our hearts
+above the world and the vanitys thereof.</p>
+
+<p>I am most impatient to hear from you, and if ye knew what
+a relief it wold be to have a letter, you wold (have) writ the
+moment you landed. The person mine is directed to wold
+find a way to send one to me. I was heartily sorry you was
+not better provided with money, but if you please to take 100
+pound from Mr. Gordon, and make him draw on his correspondent
+at Edinr., I shall endeavour to have it ready on some
+day’s sight. I am to beg (you) earnestly to let me know
+what resolution you have taken as to the place of your abode,
+and not to be sudden in resolving, but to let me know what
+you intend, and I hop as you regard my quiet you will not doe
+anything till you have my consent. I must see what shape
+things will take here, before I can frame a resolution of seeing
+you.... There was a great consternation amongst your
+freinds att the departure of two great men that followed you,
+and I find the not acquainting them with it is thought hard.
+I hear they keep still together, but that cannot doe long, God
+help them! You are lucky in your misfortune that you have
+kind freinds that are both willing and capable to serve you,
+and I am hopeful by their means to be in a better state than
+many others, which is great deal more than we deserve.</p>
+
+<p>Now let me again beg of you to writ freely to me, and tell
+me every uneasy thought you have, and make youself as easy
+as possible, and put in practice the virtue of resignation which
+you have so often talkt of to me. The more frequently you
+writ I will be the easyer. Your children are well, but poor B.
+is in great affliction for her brother and talks of leaveing me.
+Charls and all freinds here salute you, and I am, my Dearest,
+Life,</p>
+
+<p class='right pr6'>
+ Yours,</p>
+ <p>
+ Fe. 13.
+</p>
+
+<p class='letter-indent-less'>I must say Charls makes all the kind offers to me
+that you can imagine.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_208">[208]</span></p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXIII">
+ CHAPTER XXIII
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>TELLS OF FURTHER SAD DOINGS, AND OF THE BEAUTY
+ AND BURDEN OF THE SPRING</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>The relief of pouring out her heart to her husband was, as
+my dear lady once told me, very great, and I think it a
+real mercy that she could not foresee how long her letters
+were to be of reaching him. That they eventually did so,
+their presence before me is proof; but many of them are
+endorsed as having been received many weeks, nay, months,
+after they were written. My lady was so anxious to set Sir
+John’s mind at rest about herself and their children, so
+troubled on the score of money for his sake, and so
+uncertain as to what his next movements might be, that
+you can picture to yourselves her distress at not hearing
+either from or of him week after week. In spite of her
+care in seeking to provide him with money, Sir John seems
+at first to have been in straits for want of it, and it will
+interest you to know that among these papers there is a
+letter from the Queen’s Private Secretary, Mr. Dicconson,
+endorsed—“Came with the bill of 600 livres,” which I
+shall copy here.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>
+ St. Germain<br>
+ Mar. ye. 6. 1716.<br>
+ <br>
+ Sir,
+</p>
+
+<p>I am ordered by the Queen to send you a small bill
+presuming you may be at present want of a little money, which
+her Majesty is troubled her circumstances will not permit her
+to make more considerable, but hopes she may be better able
+hereafter and that this might be a present supply. I beg you
+will please to do me the justice to believe that I am with all
+imaginable sincerity and esteem,</p>
+
+<p>
+ Your most humble and most obedient servant,<br>
+ <br>
+ (Signed) W. Dicconson.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_209">[209]</span></p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>I remember that when my lady heard of this thoughtful
+kindness on the part of her Majesty, who out of her poverty
+endeavoured to help all who were suffering through their
+loyalty to her son, she could not refrain from shedding
+tears.</p>
+
+<p>But this information came to Alva many weeks later.
+In the meantime, we hoped for letters from day to day,
+and had pain and anxiety enough in hearing of the many
+calamities that every hour came to our knowledge. Our
+hearts were wrung by the news of the sentence pronounced
+against Lords Kenmure, Derwentwater, Nithisdale and
+others; and eagerly did we await the result of the many
+petitions presented to the King for their reprieve. How
+we prayed in private, and spoke in public about them and
+the heart-broken wives, Ladys Kenmure, Derwentwater,
+and Nithisdale, who, braving the King’s displeasure, and
+in the case of the last, his determined wrath, in order to
+beg for mercy for their beloved husbands, made every
+effort to save them from death. How bitterly we wept on
+hearing of the executions that took place on Tower Hill
+one dreary day in the end of February. But no tears were
+of any avail; only the memory of two brave and innocent
+men lived long in the hearts of Scots and English alike.
+My Lord Kenmure died professing his loyalty to King
+James; and the young Earl of Derwentwater, much loved
+and long lamented, gave to the Sheriff on the scaffold a
+paper containing his dying profession of innocence. Part
+of this paper I copied in my little diary, and here I reproduce
+it for those who never saw it.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>“Wherefore if in this affair I have acted rashly it ought
+not to affect the innocent; I intended to wrong nobody, but
+to serve my King and Country, and that without self-interest,
+hoping by the example I gave to have induced others to do
+their duty. And God, who sees the secrets of my heart, knows
+I speak truth.... I die a Roman Catholic.... I freely
+forgive such as reported false things of me; and I hope to be
+forgiven the trespasses of my youth by the Father of Infinite
+Mercy into Whose hand I commit my soul.</p>
+
+<p>
+ (Signed) <span class="smcap">Jas. Derwentwater</span>.”
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_210">[210]</span></p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Such brave, gentle, innocently touching words! Do
+you wonder that they dared not bring the poor, headless
+body openly from London to the north, but had it carried
+thither by night, bringing him home by stealth to his
+weeping and distracted people, who believed that the wrath
+of Heaven would surely fall upon the doers of this awful
+deed. It was said that the Duke of Argyle, travelling to
+London, met the mournful procession on its way, and was
+so struck by the grief and despair of the people that he
+represented to the Government the unwisdom of their
+act, and thereby helped to turn their hearts to clemency.</p>
+
+<p>It was with a shock of relief and joy that we heard immediately
+after this of the escape of my Lord Nithisdale out
+of prison. Long years afterwards I was told the whole story
+of his brave wife’s devotion: how she made the journey from
+Scotland to London mostly on horseback, the snow, which
+often reached to her horse’s girths, having stopped the Stagecoach,
+and even the Common Post, south of York. In
+spite of this she arrived safe and sound at London, only
+to find that no one to whom she applied could give her
+any hope, and that even the doors of her husband’s prison
+were closed against her, unless she consented to share his
+confinement. This, for reasons of her own, she refused
+to do, but by bribing the guards she contrived to see him
+several times and confided to him her plans. When she
+presented her petition to the King, the latter refused so
+much as to look at her, but treated her in a way not much
+to his honour or credit. However, on the very eve of
+the execution, as you know, she contrived by the help of
+her maid (a faithful woman) to dress my lord in female
+clothes, and bring him out of the prison under the very
+eyes of the guard. It happened that the coach of the
+Venetian Ambassador was to go that night to Dover to
+meet his brother, who was arriving as his guest in England.
+Lord Nithisdale, attired in the Ambassador’s livery, joined
+the retinue, and by help of friends at Dover hired a boat
+which landed him safe at Calais. His lady’s brave work
+was not yet finished, for she journeyed back to Scotland,
+accompanied by her maid and one servant, lying at all
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_211">[211]</span>
+the smallest inns, and braving many hardships till she
+reached home. Before going to London, she had, with
+the help of the gardener, buried all the family papers; and
+knowing that search would soon be made, she contrived
+to secure every valuable document, and take them with
+her to Traquair, where her sister, the Countess, promised
+to preserve them. She then returned home, saw all her
+neighbours, and invited the magistrates to come and make
+the search for themselves; but next day before day-break
+she was off again to London as before. This conduct
+made the King so angry, that he said my Lady Nithisdale
+gave him more trouble and anxiety than any woman in
+all Europe. For a fortnight she lay concealed in London,
+and then escaped to France, where she joined her lord.</p>
+
+<p>These details, as you know, I only learned long after;
+but the happy fact of Lord Nithisdale’s escape, and the
+action of his heroic wife, were common talk among us at
+the time. My dear lady envied the latter her chance of
+doing and suffering for her husband, as what wife in like
+circumstances would not; for sure the harder part is to
+sit still and do nothing, with one’s heart alive for action.</p>
+
+<p>About this time came a letter from the dowager Lady
+Alva, offering a visit to her dear daughter-in-law, Catherine,
+which offer went exceedingly against my lady’s inclination.
+Not that she did not love her mother-in-law—and at
+another time would have welcomed her gladly to the
+house—but just now, with their political views so at
+variance from each other, she did not see how they could
+meet and talk with any show of cordiality and agreement.
+She could not bear, she said, to hear Sir John blamed,
+and she foresaw the dowager mourning over her son’s
+Rebellion, and drawing dark pictures of the future for
+herself and her little lads. At the same time she was
+resolved not to fail in duty to her husband’s mother,
+especially as by keeping friendly with her she might incline
+the favour of those in authority, for old Lady Alva was a
+determined Whig, and no shadow of doubt had ever
+touched her family.</p>
+
+<p>My lady’s brothers-in-law, Mr. Charles Erskine and Mr.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_212">[212]</span>
+Patrick Campbell of Monzie, were constant in their care
+and interest for all her concerns, and as she said herself,
+she was supported on all sides by the kindest of friends.
+To say truth, her bitterest trouble was the absence of her
+husband, and the uncertainty of the measures to be taken
+by Government against the Rebels. Then, too, she was
+sick at heart for the sufferings of others: the imprisonment
+of her uncle, Colonel Erskine; the grief of her sister Grizel,
+whose husband, Mr. Paterson, was also in exile; of Lady
+Kippendavie, Lady Keir, and many others; not forgetting
+poor Lady Jean, my Lord Mar’s sister, who besides her
+sorrow at her brother’s failure, was suffering from the
+like bereavement. No news came from the Master of
+Sinclair, but I think my lady’s heart was so turned against
+him by his conduct at Perth that she did not greatly care
+what became of him, though poor Betty spoke of him
+constantly with much affection and regret.</p>
+
+<p>And so the sad days went forward, and February wore to
+an end, and still my lady and poor Barbara had no word of
+cheer to lighten their hearts. The following letter is almost
+a repetition of the last, but I give it in its place, as to me it
+seems like my lady’s voice, alive and speaking.</p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER V</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>
+ My Dearest Life,
+</p>
+
+<p class='letter-indent-plus'>I have good reason to hop you arriv’d safe,
+since I hear all the three ships that went off at that time
+landed safely; but I am surprised you do not fall upon some
+way to let me hear from you. I cannot express my impatience
+to have a particular account where you are and where you
+intend to make your abode. I writ to you the 13th of this
+month; I hop it has come to your hand before this time. I
+told you in it to take 100 pound from Mr. Gordon and cause
+him to draw upon his correspondent in Edinr. for the money.
+I shall doe all that’s possible to get more again you want it.
+I am very easy as to my own particular or my boys; very
+sober things will serve us, and if you be well and easy in your
+mind and have what is necessare, I ought to be very thankfull.
+I must confess I have not minded my own misfortune. The
+miserys of others ha’s so much affected me, and the concern I
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_213">[213]</span>
+am in for my poor Uncle and Mr. P. and many others does so
+afflict me, I can think on nothing else, and whatever way I
+turn my thoughts I have nothing but dismall prospects before
+me. God Almighty support all of us under so bitter a calamity
+and give us the right use of it. We ought to submit with
+patience and trust in the mercy of Him who hath smitten us,
+and if we turn to Him as we ought, He will heal us in his own
+good time.</p>
+
+<p>I expect your mother here next week. You may imagine
+there will be no harmony in our conversation; but I am
+resolv’d to make the best I can of all things, and shal omit
+nothing that can be for your interest however uneasy it may
+be to myself, in hops when the best is made of your affairs the
+present circumstances can allow, we may have something to
+live (on) together in some retir’d place, till kind providence
+give a turn to bring us to our own; and if that never happen,
+when we come to dye it will be all the same whether we have
+liv’d in plenty or in more straitning circumstances.</p>
+
+<p>I think if things continue as they are I would leave Britain
+with a desire never to see it again. I am sometimes afraid
+you go to Moscoe without acquainting me; let me beg of you
+as you regard my life doe not think of it, at least for some
+time, and if after that you think it convenient I will go very
+chearfully with you to any corner of the earth; so I beg of
+you resolve to do nothing of that nature rashly, nor must you
+do it without acquainting me, and get my consent before you
+doe it. This I beg’d in my last, and I hope (for) your complyance
+if you either wish or expect ever to see me again.</p>
+
+<p>Your man, Andrew, came here some days ago, very well. I
+regrated he was not with you, but if you please to let me
+know if you desire to have him, I’ll endeavour to find some
+opportunity of sending him, and in the meantime I shall imploy
+him here. Charles and P. C. will do all in their power for
+manageing your affairs after the best manner, butt I fear
+there can be little done by any, because all is done by the
+folks who desire nothing so much as the utter ruin of this
+country, and it will be a general measure. All your friends
+will be at their country-seats, so if you write it must not be
+either to Charles or P. C. My sister, Betty, is here and gives
+you her kind service, as does poor Aunt Betty, who is in great
+affliction. Wishing my dear all manner of happyness.</p>
+
+<p class='right pr4'>I am in all sincerity,</p>
+<p class='right pr2'>yours.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_214">[214]</span></p>
+<p>Fe. 26.</p>
+
+<p>The friends you left together are all dispers’d; there is none
+Prisoners but Mephon (Methvine) and some others who gave
+up themselves. Your boys are very well.</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>At last the snow began to melt under the bright spring
+sun, and a soft wind blowing from the south-west brought a
+gentle rain upon its wings, which hastened the thawing of
+the hard ground. After a winter of such length and
+severity, it was indeed a glad thing to behold the earth,
+(wondrous green and fresh) pushing aside her wintry mantle
+and laying bare her bosom to the sky. Small things began
+to force their way through the surface of the ground, tender
+buds showed upon the trees, and after the long silence the
+birds in garden and glen took up their music, and sang the
+gladsome Life-March of the Spring.</p>
+
+<p>I walked one afternoon with my dear lady alone under
+the bare branches, and tried to beguile her from her sad
+thoughts by talk of the opening season which, last year, she
+had told me she so loved; but her face was pale and worn,
+and she answered me absently, though with her wonted
+gentleness. I knew her very spirit was weary, and I had
+no word of comfort to give her. Presently we sat down
+upon a wooden bench which the westering sun made warm
+with his beams, and tired of my own listless efforts at cheerfulness,
+I fell into a wistful silence. All at once a mavis on
+a branch behind us broke into song so sweet and thrilling
+that my lady clasped my arm to hold me still. Sudden
+and clear and short was his lay, and then after a slight pause
+he sang it over again. In the silence and the sunlight,
+with the cool scent of the damp earth in our nostrils, the
+bird’s singing seemed like the voice of the spirit of
+gladness bidding us take joy in the renewal of life. But
+strange to say it was not joy but pain that wrung my
+heart-strings, and my dear lady laid her head upon my
+shoulder and wept.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, Barbara,” she sighed at last, “that bird and his
+song, that last year I listened to so gladly, how it pierces
+my heart with its sweetness, and only makes my sadness
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_215">[215]</span>
+and loneliness more grievous. It raises in me such a
+longing for the sight of my dear husband’s face, that I feel
+at times the pain of it will kill me! How is it possible to
+live with a heart so heavy? The burden of it is sometimes
+greater than I can bear.”</p>
+
+<p>“I know, I know,” I murmured; for her words did so
+fully express my feelings that they seemed to come from
+my own heart, and indeed I thought that I felt and suffered
+even as she did, knowing little, in my ignorance, of the
+difference between us. For, as the tiny mountain-burn that
+tinkles down the glen is to the broad, full, swiftly-flowing
+river, so is the love of a maid for her untried lover to the
+love of a wife for her husband, the father of her children.
+Something of this thought must have come to my lady’s
+mind, for she turned to me very kindly.</p>
+
+<p>“Poor little Barbara! I am sure you think you do; and
+I fear you must have found me selfish and hard, in that I
+have spoken no word to you of Mr. Fleming, but I
+deemed it best, my dear, to keep silent, hoping you were
+learning to forget, or at least that you did not grieve
+too much.”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, cousin!” I cried, the barriers of my reserve breaking
+down before her sympathy. “He is ever in my
+thoughts. How could I forget? All day I think of him,
+and at night I dream such dreary dreams. If I could
+know where he is, or what has become of him, what would
+I not give? And I let him go so coldly, madam; he does
+not even know that I love him.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, as to that, my dear,” cried my lady, cheerfully,
+now bent upon comforting me, “I do not think you need
+have any concern. Words are not everything, Barbara,
+and I am sure you did not flout him.”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, madam,” I cried, “do you think I was too bold?
+I would not have him regard me too lightly, either.”</p>
+
+<p>My lady laughed. “Well, child, you are hard to please,
+and I must leave Mr. Fleming to tell you his opinion of
+you himself. I would we could have news of him again,”
+she sighed, “we know nothing since his return to Perth.”</p>
+
+<p>“Do you think, cousin, that he also will be in danger of
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_216">[216]</span>‘the vengeance?’” I asked timidly, for by this name we
+commonly spoke of the dreaded retribution.</p>
+
+<p>“I cannot say, my dear; but I hope as he is young, and
+has taken no prominent part, they will not make an example
+of him. His kinsman, the Earl of Wigton, is in
+Edinburgh Castle; but his father, as you know, is a rich
+and respected London merchant, who has probably friends
+at Court. I have asked my brother, Charles, to find out
+if possible what has become of him, but no news have
+reached him as yet.”</p>
+
+<p>I rose and turned my face away to hide my quivering lips.</p>
+
+<p>“It is hard to bear!” I cried.</p>
+
+<p>“My dearest,” she answered, “it <i>is</i> hard; and I want to
+tell you how greatly I admire you for your brave silence,
+hiding your own grief lest you should burden me the more.
+I cannot thank you enough for all you have done, and been,
+to me and mine at this time, but if ever I have a daughter,
+Barbara, I shall name her after you.”</p>
+
+<p>With that she kissed me very kindly (though I knew of
+no reason for her gratitude), but almost immediately she
+broke out weeping again.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, hark to my promises,” she sobbed, “foolish woman
+that I am! To talk of future children when I know not
+whether I be not already a widow—God forgive me! I
+scarce knew what I was saying.”</p>
+
+<p>And then I took to comforting her in turn (but you
+know she kept her promise three years later, when my dear
+god-daughter was born). Her second breakdown was so
+violent and so unusual, that at first I was alarmed for her
+health, but by-and-bye she quieted herself, and even
+smiled as she dried her eyes.</p>
+
+<p>“Just for this once, Barbara, I have let myself weep my
+fill, and now I feel the lighter for it. ’Twas the mavis
+set me going, and I suppose it is not the first time that a
+bird’s song has caused a full heart to overflow.”</p>
+
+<p>I never forgot the words, nor the scene; and that is the
+reason why always in my mind I connect the mavis’ singing
+with my dear Lady Erskine and her troubles, as I told you
+at the beginning of this story.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_217">[217]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXIV">
+ CHAPTER XXIV
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>MY LADY HEARS FROM SIR JOHN, AND I PAY MY THIRD
+ VISIT TO DYSART</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>I have given you so much of woe and weeping that I begin
+to fear you must be weary of so dismal a tale, and I am
+quite glad to tell you now of a little lull in the tempest,
+and of a gleam of sunshine that shot through the clouds.
+It was a very little thing that caused it truly; nothing more
+important than a letter which arrived from Sir John at
+last, but it brought the colour back to my lady’s cheek, and
+the light to her eyes for a time.</p>
+
+<p>The whole household was gladdened by the news of his
+safety, for he was at Paris awaiting the bidding of the King
+to attend him at Avignon, in good health and spirits; and,
+though chagrined at the sudden ending of all their endeavours,
+was hopeful that at some future time their efforts
+should be crowned with success.</p>
+
+<p>I have here a small fragment of the journal which he
+kept on his voyage from Scotland, of which I will give you
+the first extract, and the last.</p>
+
+<p>
+ “Journal from the 2nd Feb., 1716.<br>
+ <br>
+ Montrose.
+</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>2nd “Att night received my orders for going to france with
+dispatches to the Queen, the Regent, and E. Bolingbroke
+from the King, and to the last also from the D. of Mar.</p>
+
+<p>9th “By 11 at night I gott to St. Germains. the Queen
+was not well and laid to sleep. I delivered my letters and
+other commissions to the Queen, who, about 12 o’clock,
+ordered me to goe immediately to Paris and look after E.
+Bolingbroke.”</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Of his further movements at that particular time no record
+has been kept. The letter to his wife was like himself,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_218">[218]</span>
+frank and cheerful, hopeful and kind; with regrets for the
+sorrows and misfortunes of others, but no word of grudging
+or bitterness about his own lost labours. Even the
+servants imbibed courage from hearing of it, and the
+kind neighbours who asked discreet questions of my lady
+scarce needed a reply after looking at her face.</p>
+
+<p>To add to our comfort, Mr. Charles Erskine, who was
+again expected at Alva, being prevented coming for some
+days, wrote to my lady telling her of news he had got
+from the north of those whom my lady calls in her letters
+to her husband his “fellow-travellers.” These were my
+Lord Tinworth, the Duke of Berwick’s son, with his
+uncle, Colonel Bulkeley, my Lord Talbot and my Lord
+Edward Drummond; and as my lady had been exceedingly
+anxious on the score of the first-named, whom Sir John
+had praised much as a fine, modest, and engaging youth,
+we were relieved, though somewhat disturbed, to learn
+what was become of him. A company of gentlemen,
+including the above, and amongst whom were the Marquis
+of Tullibardine, Earls of Marischall, Southesk and
+Linlithgow, Viscounts Kilsyth, Kingston and Dundee,
+Lords Pitsligo, Rollo and Burleigh, having gone to
+Peterhead in hopes of finding a ship, were obliged to
+return owing to the presence of a man-of-war near at
+hand. They had then made their way westward towards
+the other coast, where ships were expected to take them
+off to France, and at present, it was supposed, were in
+hiding among the mountains. “Among the names,”
+wrote Mr. Erskine, “of the junior officers who accompanied
+them I find that of your late guest, for whom you
+were enquiring, Mr. Anthony Fleming.”</p>
+
+<p>So the worst part of our anxiety was passed. Sir John
+and my dear Mr. Fleming lived; and although months
+must pass before we could think of seeing them, or
+perhaps hearing aught of them, it was no longer agony
+to name them in our prayers, and ask God to protect
+them from further danger.</p>
+
+<p>My lady answered the welcome letter in a much more
+cheerful strain than before.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_219">[219]</span></p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER VI</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p class='right pr2'>
+ March 12.
+</p>
+
+<p>Yours of the date 20 of Fe. was most acceptable to me. I
+delayed answering my Dearest Life some days, expecting
+Charls here, that I might learn a little from him what were
+people’s opinions as to our present state ... but now I blame
+myself for delaying, and tho’ I still expect Charls I have no longer
+patience. I hop by the letters I have writ you will be easy
+as to me and your boys. I must own the miserys of others
+has so much affected me that I did not think on my own
+misfortune in such a manner as I wold at another time, and
+being absent from you is what affects me most; but since
+God has been so mercyfull to me in preserving your Life and
+giving you freedom and liberty to enjoy yourself in a good
+country, and at the same time affords what is needfull both
+for you and your family, I would be very unworthy to
+complain. Let things come to the worst, I make no doubt
+of getting a suitable allyment ... and there can nobody
+lose a groat by you, so you may be easy on that score.
+Your servants are all here, very well, which occasions me a
+greater family than is convenient; but justice and gratitude
+obliges me to itt, and it’s what I know you wold approve.... I
+have not heard of your drawing for 100 pound as I
+have twice desir’d you. I can tell you there is a fund for
+200 more, so there is no need for you to straiten yourself or
+denye yourself what is either convenient or proper for you.
+I think you are in the right to go to a cheap place, but I
+could wish you had some of your neighbours and friends,
+who by this time are in the same country with you; it would
+make the time pass more agreeably.</p>
+
+<p>There is no Prisoners yet except such as have given
+themselves up, and I am in no pain about them. I have
+converst with some of your neighbours since they were
+disperst; but there never were people so much confounded nor
+in such despair as they were in when they knew of the
+departure of these people, and all blame your friend, and
+think they might have done the same thing, and done it
+with a better Grace.</p>
+
+<p>All the Lords went to the Highlands, and the clans design
+to defend themselves. I hear the forces are now ordered to
+go to the Highlands. Many went to Orkney, and there ha’s
+taken ship. Your fellow-travellers and others, of which
+number there were 70, went to Peterhead, and could not
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_220">[220]</span>
+get away, were obligt to return and join with the clans.
+They will be exposed to hardships, but in such a case there
+is no help.... You tell me you have something in your
+head that could make us live easy, but it is not fit to write....
+Well, I do not doubt but we shall again live happy
+together, and in the meantime I shall do all in my power
+for your interest, and shall denye myself the pleasure of
+seeing you till my being here can be no longer of use. I
+shall always prefer your interest to pleasing myself. Let me
+know if you want A. S—t sent to you.... I forgot to tell
+you P. C. is gone for London eight days agoe. There are
+some people here afraid of a war breaking out with France,
+and in that case I wish you had money remitted before that
+happened. I shall be uneasy for not hearing from you, and
+in fear you should be sent messages to Britain, which I beg
+of you, for God’s sake, as you regard my quiet and life, not
+to undertake. I take Charls’ advice and P. C.’s in all your
+concerns, and they are both in as great concern for you and
+the interest of your family as it’s possible for you to imagine.
+I believe all your other friends will do what’s in their power
+when there is occasion. Let things come to the worst, I
+have no doubt but we shall have a reasonable competence for
+us and our children without being obligt to anybody. Ye
+know I always look to the dark side of the cloud, and when
+I say so there is good grounds for believing it.</p>
+
+<p>For some time past the singing of the mavis increast my
+grief, but now I am come to take some pleasure in the fields,
+and to bless God you have the same liberty and priviledge
+which is a great comfort to me. I begin now to put things to
+rights about your Hedges and Ditches, and shall take care to
+keep all right while I am here; and if it should so happen I
+must leave it, I hope it will fall in a friend’s hand. Mr. R.(ose)
+labours your own farm, so, in spite of all, that will afford somewhat
+to my subsistance.</p>
+
+<p>I am better now than I used to be when all things were
+more to my mind. I mean as to my health; and since you
+express such concern for me, and think my health for your
+interest, I shall doe what’s reasonable to preserve it. Your
+children are well. Your mother will be here this week....
+May my Dearest be as happy as I wish him. God grant him
+the right use of all his troubles, patience, and submission, and
+preserve him from all evil.</p>
+
+<p class="right pr4">
+ Yours, Dear Life, Adieu.
+</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_221">[221]</span></p>
+
+<p>On the back of this letter I find a post-scriptum in
+Betty’s hand-writing; ’tis writ in the vein she used so often
+in speaking to Sir John—half serious, half flippant and
+wholly affectionate, for she too, was in better spirits since
+the arrival of my guardian’s letter.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>
+ “Dear Sir John,
+</p>
+
+<p class='letter-indent-plus'>Of all things I believe you least want my
+good wishes; however, to please myself I offer them, and that
+with all the sincerity and fervour, inclination and gratitude can
+oblige me to. I thank God all my friends is not alike unlucky.
+I am in great fear about them, if the divisions amongst the
+great people don’t do them service. I pray God for a good
+meeting. In the meantime</p>
+
+<p class="right pr6">I am, my Dr. Sir J.</p>
+<p class="right pr4">Your most faithful</p>
+<p class="right pr2">Female Counciler.</p>
+<p class="right pr4">B.”</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>I remember very well the day upon which the dreaded
+advent of the Dowager Lady Alva was expected. The
+snow was melted on the low-lying land, though it still lay
+on the hills, where however it was disappearing fast; and
+my lady came in her own travelling-coach from Edinburgh,
+having crossed the Forth at the Queen’s Ferry. I must
+own that I stood somewhat in awe of the stately dame,
+whom I had seen but seldom, and perhaps the anxiety of
+my dear lady communicated itself to me. As for Betty,
+who was a particular favourite of the dowager, she
+expressed no concern; but she told me after how unhappy
+she had felt on her sister’s account.</p>
+
+<p>At last a servant ran to tell us that the coach was
+approaching the house, and my lady, taking her boys one
+in each hand, went to the door and stood upon the
+threshold to welcome her with all honour. Aunt Betty,
+Betty Sinclair, and Barbara stood just behind, and the
+chief servants were grouped in the background, for nothing
+must be omitted of respect and observance in the reception
+of Sir John’s mother. When the carriage drew up, the
+men-servants having descended from the rumble and
+opened the door, little Charles at his mama’s bidding ran
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_222">[222]</span>
+forward, and placing himself in front of the step begged
+his grandmother to lean upon his support in her descent.
+This the old lady very good naturedly did, and by the aid
+of her woman who rode with her, seemed to throw all her
+weight on the child’s shoulder, which pleased him very
+much. As she approached the door, my lady stepped
+forward and kissing her cheek, bade her kindly welcome
+to Alva.</p>
+
+<p>Whatever may have been Lady Erskine’s fears and
+doubts she hid them under a simple, natural manner, and
+it was not till the dowager was seated in the parlour, with
+Harry on a footstool at her feet, and Charles holding her
+mittened hand, that my lady ventured to say, and then her
+voice trembled a little,</p>
+
+<p>“I would rather, madam, as you know, that Sir John
+were here to welcome you himself, but in his absence you
+must let my little sons take his place.”</p>
+
+<p>“Indeed, my dear daughter,” said the old lady cheerfully,
+“I am aware that my son cannot be in two places at once,
+and as he has chosen to absent himself from Alva, I must
+e’en make the best of it; in the meantime you and the
+little lads will do very well.”</p>
+
+<p>Surprised and relieved my lady smiled.</p>
+
+<p>“It is good of you, madam, to come to us just now.
+Many would think it right to avoid the house of a Rebel.”</p>
+
+<p>“My dear Catherine,” said the dowager gravely, “my
+son is my son, and whatever he does he will never be less
+to me. I think it right, however, to say before my grandchildren,
+my sister Elizabeth, and your young friends, that
+I consider Sir John has acted wrongly, and I pray God he
+may be led to see the error of his ways; but for all that, I
+have no doubt but he is honest, and as he has been
+unfortunate, it ill becomes us to triumph. I do not wish
+to hear where he is, but I trust you have good news of
+him, my dear.”</p>
+
+<p>And so this dreaded meeting was over, and old Lady
+Alva by her kindliness and good sense set everyone at their
+ease. She would not listen to Aunt Betty’s complaints and
+mournings, nor did she allow her to prognosticate evil, as
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_223">[223]</span>
+had been her depressing habit of late. The house increased
+in cheerfulness because of her presence, and my dear lady
+had in her a firm supporter through all her troubles.</p>
+
+<p>This being so, it was proposed that Betty should return
+to Dysart for a time taking me with her, as my lady was
+anxious to have news of her father. The old lord was
+grieving sorely over the downfall of his hopes; and the exile
+of his son, which, it was feared, might be permanent, added
+to his anxieties and cares. The state of Scotland was
+indeed to be deplored. From Stirling to Inverness there
+was nothing but desolation, for it was as if a marauding
+army had swept it bare. “The Dutch,” as one gentleman
+wrote, “have not left a chair, or a stool, nor a barrel, nor a
+bottle, <i>enfin</i> nothing undestroyed, and the English troops
+very little more merciful.” General Cadogan had been
+ordered north to the Highlands to hunt for the Rebel
+Lords, and to bring the clans into subjection; but before
+going he sent out invitations to the ladies of Edinburgh to
+a Ball. Oh, how my poor Betty raged and stormed when
+she heard of this outrage, for so she considered it!
+“How,” she cried, “could women think of dancing when
+half the country was mourning in desolation?” They might
+rejoice that the Rising had failed, but to dance and play
+over its grave was a heartless and monstrous thing to do,
+and she longed to go straight to the General and give him
+her mind on the subject. She called him Nero from that
+day forward, and never could she hear him mentioned
+without some bitter word.</p>
+
+<p>The Duke of Argyle, “having gloriously finished the most
+laborious and hard campaign that ever was known” (so the
+prints had it) had set out for London, leaving Cadogan
+in command, but we did not know (nor he either, poor
+gentleman) that he was actually deprived of his post as
+Commander-in-Chief in favour of his subordinate; and even
+we, against whom he had fought, regretted this step, for his
+Grace had proved himself a very generous and tender
+enemy; and from all we could gather, his humiliation came
+through the jealousy of his rival, the Duke of Marlborough,
+in whom, as you know, we never put any great trust.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_224">[224]</span></p>
+
+<p>It was in the coach on our road to Dysart that Betty
+spoke out to me of her terrible grief and disappointment.
+I had found her very unlike herself during this visit to
+Alva, silent and melancholy, but knowing what ample
+reason she had for low spirits, I had passed it without
+comment. It was when she caught sight of the ships in
+the Forth that she began to speak.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, Barbara!” she sighed, “to think how high our
+hopes were when last I passed this way, and now it is all at
+an end. My heart is nearly broken!”</p>
+
+<p>I had no words to comfort her, I could only listen.</p>
+
+<p>“Do you remember last May how confident we were?
+What gay visions danced before our eyes! How we
+believed in those who have since proved so frail and feeble,
+and scorned those who spoke of dangers and defeat, and
+were bitterly angry if any hinted at failure! Why has God
+dragged us through such humiliation; what has been
+gained? Why did He let us attempt this thing if He
+meant only to overthrow us in the end? It is cruel—cruel,
+I say. I would not so have treated those who
+trusted me!”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, Bess, my dear, your words are wild!” I cried,
+but she went on unheeding.</p>
+
+<p>“And oh, that poor unhappy King, how my heart bleeds
+for him! He is innocent, but he will be blamed; honest,
+but they will call him a traitor; kind-hearted, but they will
+remember him as a monster; courageous, but he is already
+branded as a coward. No man was ever so bamboozled,
+so entangled, so misguided. And Barbara,” she added,
+darkly, “I know who led him astray. I know whom we
+have to thank for the humiliation, the anger, the bitter grief
+and suffering; and tho’ I will name no names, in my heart
+I feel that my poor brother was right, though he too is a
+sufferer in spite of his wisdom.”</p>
+
+<p>I knew very well what she meant, and told her I agreed
+with her, though it was hard, I said, to believe that all our
+trouble had come from <i>one</i> man’s mismanagement.</p>
+
+<p>“Ay,” she answered doubtfully, “I catch your meaning,
+and perhaps the causes are numerous and far-reaching, but
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_225">[225]</span>
+I keep my opinion of one man’s worth, and I could name
+a dozen who could have brought the affair to a more
+successful issue.”</p>
+
+<p>“Think you, Betty,” I asked, “that your brother, the
+Master, will be attainted, and poor Sir John, and Mr.
+Paterson and Lady Jean’s husband? I am in great grief
+for them.”</p>
+
+<p>“No one can tell yet what will be done,” she said, “but
+if it is so, I feel if I should like to leave Britain, and never
+see or speak to one of my Whig neighbours again. I used
+to like my Lord Rothes very well, but I love the old
+Colonel, and cannot bear to think of him in the Fleet,
+while my lord is Governor of Stirling Castle.”</p>
+
+<p>“What says my Lord Wemyss?” I ventured. “Have
+you seen him since the departure of the King?”</p>
+
+<p>“No,” cried Betty, very proudly. “He writ me a letter
+full of gratitude, thanking me in very kind words, I must
+own, for my care of his poor young son—oh, Barbara, I did
+so grieve to see him die! But ’twas just after the King’s
+landing and my mind was fixed upon him. <i>Afterwards</i> my
+lord wrote again asking if he could be of help to us in our
+misfortune, which so riled me (for my heart was very sore)
+that I answered him with hot and bitter words.”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, Betty!” I cried, “I am sure he meant it kindly.”</p>
+
+<p>“Very likely,” she replied, “but there are times when
+even kindness is unkind. Let us not talk of my Lord
+Wemyss; there are other subjects more agreeable.”</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_226">[226]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXV">
+ CHAPTER XXV
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>
+ TELLS OF AN UNEXPECTED MEETING, AND A GLAD
+ SURPRISE FOR BARBARA</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>We found the household at the Hermitage very dull and
+dumpish; they seemed like people who had received a
+shock from which they had not yet recovered. My lord
+spoke little, and looked to my eyes many years older and
+feebler than when I saw him last. David Pitcairn came
+about the house as usual, making himself useful to the old
+man, whose younger sons, being engaged in affairs of their
+own, could not be much with him; and Mistress Mary,
+who was never very healthy, was staying with her sister at
+Newbyth.</p>
+
+<p>The only news of interest that reached us, consisted in
+the reports from time to time of the safe arrival in France,
+or Sweden, or Holland, of this or that fugitive about whom
+we had been in anxiety. But so far we had heard nothing
+of the Marquis of Tynemouth and his friends, and my mind
+was divided between fears of the hardships they must be
+enduring among the mountains, and hopes that they were
+already far away in a safe country. My Lord Huntly had
+given himself up and made terms for himself with the
+Government, but the Earl of Seaforth, whose name was
+coupled with his as a traitor to the Cause, had in reality
+withdrawn his submission, and was now retired to the Isle
+of Lewis with his men.</p>
+
+<p>A few days after our arrival at Dysart there was a
+great storm of rain, which lasted so continuously that the
+last shred of snow disappeared from the earth. It was in
+truth the ushering in of the summer, early though it was,
+for from that time the weather never went back, but continued
+bright, warm and genial, with light winds and occasional
+life-giving showers, all through that year. It seemed as if
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_227">[227]</span>
+it had been sent to compensate us for the long and terrible
+winter, for the summer of 1716 proved one of the most
+bounteous seasons within the memory of man.</p>
+
+<p>While it lasted, however, the rain was dreary enough, and
+day after day we looked out upon a grey and sullen sea,
+shut in by mists and low hanging clouds from any view of the
+opposite coast; and night after night we listened to the rain
+beating on our window-panes, and thought of our friends,
+perhaps in want of shelter, and dreamed pitiful dreams
+which haunted us in our waking hours. It was a dreary
+week at Dysart.</p>
+
+<p>One night after supper, as I went to my chamber to fetch
+some work, I was stopped by the sound of low, continuous
+knocking at the door I have told you of at the foot of the
+turret-stair. It brought to my mind that night when my
+dear lady recognised her husband’s knock, and ran, in spite
+of my terror, to open to him; but so much had passed
+since then, that though I was startled, I had no sense of
+personal fear, knowing well that none but friends, and
+generally those in distress, would come to the house that
+way. For this reason I did not hesitate, but placing my
+taper in a niche of the wall, went hurriedly down the
+twisted stair, and paused for a moment at the back of the
+door. The rain was still falling though not so heavy, and
+behind the clouds there was a waning moon whose light
+came dimly through the grated window above me. I drew
+back the bolt cautiously and lifted the latch. The door
+was pushed open from without, and a man entered
+quickly, shutting it behind him.</p>
+
+<p>“Forgive me, madam!” he whispered, “but there is
+danger.”</p>
+
+<p>I fell back against the wall, dumbfoundered, for the man
+was none other than Anthony Fleming.</p>
+
+<p>For a few moments we gazed at each other in silence,
+and then without warning I flung my arms about him and
+lifted my face to his. He kissed me like one in a dream.</p>
+
+<p>“You!” I gasped. “You—and <i>here</i>! I thought you
+were over seas. Oh, thank God you are safe. Last night
+I dreamed that I found you again, wounded and nigh to
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_228">[228]</span>
+death, and my pillow was wet when I awoke. Whence
+came you? You are not ill? Oh, how I have prayed that
+God would send you back, and now you are come, out of
+the mist and rain, straight to my arms. How good He is—how
+good! But you—you did not know I loved you, dear
+heart; I let you go so coldly. I have longed, oh longed,
+to tell you the truth; will you believe it now? I am yours
+for ever and ever; no one on earth shall ever come
+between us.”</p>
+
+<p>And then my breath gave out and the tears came, and I
+laid my face upon his breast, trembling and weeping.</p>
+
+<p>As for him he spoke no word; but he held me in his
+arms, closer and closer, as if he would keep me there for
+ever, and I felt his kisses on my hair, and heard the great
+throbs of his heart beating against my arm.</p>
+
+<p>At that moment there was no room in all my being for
+anything but joy and thankfulness; but sometimes in
+looking back upon this scene, I have been troubled and
+have blushed hotly, as a woman will even in solitude,
+remembering my bold and free surrender. Did Mr.
+Fleming hesitate to speak, because of it, deeming my
+conduct perhaps unmaidenly? I have never dared to ask
+him, but I trust he has forgotten it long ago.&#x2060;<a id="FNanchor_1_1" href="#Footnote_1_1" class="fnanchor">[1]</a></p>
+
+<div class='footnotes'>
+<div class="footnote"><p><a id="Footnote_1_1" href="#FNanchor_1_1" class="label">[1]</a> I have not forgotten it, my sweet wife, nor shall, “while memory
+holds her seat.” ’Twas a moment to thank God for, and only a sense of
+my own unworthiness kept me silent.</p>
+
+<p class='right pr1'>
+ A. F.
+</p></div></div>
+
+<p>Whatever it boded I could not bear his silence. I have
+heard that women mostly love to voice their emotion, while
+with men it often renders them speechless.</p>
+
+<p>“Will you not speak to me, Anthony?” I said. “Will
+you not say you are glad to see me?”</p>
+
+<p>I had lifted my face to look at him, and though the
+light was dim, for the first and only time in my life I saw
+tears in my dear love’s eyes.</p>
+
+<p>“Glad, sweetheart?” he murmured, “’tis like getting
+into Heaven.”</p>
+
+<p>And after that I did not mind the silence. It lasted but
+a minute, and then he unclasped my hands, and putting
+me from him, gazed at me intently.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_229">[229]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Is my Lady Erskine here?” he said. “Tell me,
+Barbara, who is with you in the house?”</p>
+
+<p>I told him, still speaking low, and then asked him what
+was the danger he feared.</p>
+
+<p>“Tis not for myself, dear love, though I suppose it
+extends to us all. But there is one whose life is infinitely
+precious, for whom I came to beg shelter. I know my
+Lord Sinclair is as safe as he is kind, and Mistress Betty is
+well reputed among us for her loyalty. It is—”</p>
+
+<p>“Stop!” I cried. “Do not tell me here. Let us
+hasten to Betty’s boudoir that she may hear the news first,
+whatever they are. Oh, come, I cannot bear to delay a
+moment.”</p>
+
+<p>Breathless with excitement and anxiety, I had almost
+forgotten my own share in the event, but stopped at the
+door of Betty’s room to give my friend a smile and a
+kindly look. Then I opened the door and entered hurriedly.
+Betty was sitting by the fire, and on seeing us rose quickly.
+Her face, which at first was fixed in surprise, flushed
+suddenly when she recognised her visitor, and she came
+forward to meet him with hands outstretched.</p>
+
+<p>“You, Mr. Fleming?” she cried. “How come you
+here, and whence? We have been much exercised about
+your safety, but thought you were gone to France some
+days ago. Are you alone?”</p>
+
+<p>“Madam,” said Mr. Fleming, “I am not, and I will tell
+you in a few words why I am here. It is the young
+Marquis of Tinmouth and his uncle for whom I beg shelter.
+They are in hiding in a wood about a quarter of a mile
+from the house. I am sent to acquaint my Lord Sinclair
+with the matter, and if it is safe I am to return at once and
+tell them.”</p>
+
+<p>Oh, how my dear Betty’s eyes lit up with joy! To think
+that there was still a chance for her to show her loyalty,
+and do some little thing for the Cause; to receive the King’s
+young relative and keep him safe, to plan and further his
+escape. All this appealed to her keenly and set her blood
+a-tingling with pleasure. Bidding us wait where we were
+she ran to give her father the news, and when we were
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_230">[230]</span>
+alone, I was able to look at my dear with calmer eyes, and
+to see, alas! how worn and thin he had become.</p>
+
+<p>“Worse, far worse, than when you departed from Alva,”
+cried I.</p>
+
+<p>He laughed a little. “And small wonder, Sweet; when
+one has spent some weeks in the mountains, exposed to
+hunger and cold and wind and rain, and burdened by the
+dread of capture, it is not easy to keep flesh on one’s bones,
+or preserve a fresh and ruddy countenance.”</p>
+
+<p>“Have you been without proper shelter ever since the
+departure of the King?” I asked in amazement.</p>
+
+<p>“Most of the time,” he answered. “We could not get
+away from Peterhead, because of a man-of-war which kept
+watch to prevent us. We went to Castle Gordon, where
+we spent a few days, and then with the other lords withdrew
+westward. I will not tell you of all our trials, my dearest;
+but though our young master bore them all with a very
+cheerful spirit, we could see that they were telling on his
+strength. He is not much more than a boy, and has never
+known what hardship and exposure mean. At last it was
+decided that he should try to make his way south to
+Edinburgh, I being sent as guide; so, travelling by night and
+hiding by day, we were directed to this house, whence we
+hope to get shipped to France. I knew that if the family
+were at home we should be taken care of, but I little
+guessed the blessed welcome that was waiting here for me.”</p>
+
+<p>And with that he put his arm again around me, and we
+stood gazing into the fire in blissful silence, till Betty’s step
+was heard returning.</p>
+
+<p>I will leave you to imagine how the old house woke up
+that night from its melancholy. Very quickly Mr. Fleming
+was despatched to bring in the weary wanderers, and meanwhile
+rooms were made ready to receive them, great fires
+lighted to warm them, and garments brought from every
+wardrobe in the house to replace their worn and sodden
+clothing. A great supper was quickly prepared, for good-will
+made all hands work fast, and in the hearts of men and
+women alike pity for the fugitives brought the desire to
+help and comfort them. It was thought safer to let them
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_231">[231]</span>
+enter by the turret-door; but my lord received them at the
+top of the winding stair, and himself conducted the young
+Marquis to his chamber, where with the aid of a warm bath
+and dry clothing, the young gentleman was able to make
+himself more comfortable than he had been, I should
+imagine, for many weeks past.</p>
+
+<p>When he entered the dining-room with his host, attired
+in a suit of purple velvet with ruffles of lace, belonging to
+one of Betty’s brothers, we could scarce take our eyes off his
+face, even in performing our lowest curtseys, so charmed
+were we with his gallant bearing and his modest and
+pleasant looks. When Betty very prettily bade him welcome
+to her father’s house, and said how honoured they were at
+the trust reposed in their family, he blushed like the boy he
+was, and stammered out that the honour was his alone.
+He looked at the well-spread board, the blazing fire, the
+lighted room, and giving a little laugh he said, with a slight
+foreign accent that rendered his speech very attractive,</p>
+
+<p>“If you could know the contrast, madam, of my surroundings
+this night with those of the last few weeks, you
+would understand very well that the gratitude is all on my
+side.”</p>
+
+<p>“What horrors you must have endured, my lord,” cried
+Betty. “Oh, I fear you will bear away with you but a
+bitter remembrance of our inhospitable country.”</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, madam,” he answered with a graceful gesture,
+“you have set aside that possibility for ever. But here,”
+he went on, “is my good uncle, Colonel Bulkeley, who has
+shared my vicissitudes; and I need not introduce to you
+our faithful friend, Captain Anthony Fleming, without
+whom we should, I fear, have been still longer in reaching
+this haven of refuge.”</p>
+
+<p>These gentlemen now entered the room, and it was with
+great joy that I noticed the improvement in Mr. Fleming’s
+looks, who, now that he had performed his toilette,
+seemed neither so ill nor so haggard as I had thought him.
+Thin he was and worn with his hardships, but the glad look
+in his eyes gave him an air of restfulness and satisfaction
+which had before been wanting.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_232">[232]</span></p>
+
+<p>Colonel Bulkeley was a tall, stout man with a full, high-coloured
+face. ’Twas difficult to believe that he had
+endured the same trials that had left the younger men so
+thin and pale. With my foolish woman’s caprice, I took
+an instant dislike to the brave Colonel, though he made his
+bow to us very low, and addressed Betty in a courteous
+and gentlemanly way. Still there was about him an air of
+dogged superiority, which, coupled with a somewhat hectoring
+manner, made him a man of uneasy temper for other
+men to deal with. And even that first night as we sat
+through supper, I found myself wondering how this
+person came to be related to the young Marquis of
+Tinmouth, than whom it would have been difficult to
+find a more sweet-tempered, modest and agreeable young
+man.</p>
+
+<p>They told us now more particularly of their adventures,
+taking the precaution to speak French while the servants
+were in the room, and gave us to understand that the
+country-people, in the districts through which they had
+passed, were all well-affected towards the King. Most of
+them, it must be owned, blamed the Earl of Mar for their
+misfortunes, and for the disastrous ending of our hopes; for
+they held a firm belief that King James could have recovered
+them from the troubles brought about by the
+Union, and caused Scotland to enjoy a peace and prosperity
+to which she had long been a stranger. The fugitives had
+been directed from one house or cottage to another, and
+the poor folk, as well as the rich, had, they said, given them
+ungrudgingly of their scant provisions, besides sheltering
+them from observation during the daylight.</p>
+
+<p>It was with a very thankful heart that Barbara laid her
+head upon her pillow that night, but for some time she
+could not sleep for joy of thinking of the safety of her
+friend, and wonder that the same roof should shelter them
+both. The rain still beat on the window, but she heeded
+it no longer, or only to give a passing thought of pity to
+any poor wanderers still abroad; and though she knew that
+in a day or two at most the dreaded parting must come
+again, she put the knowledge away from her as only the
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_233">[233]</span>
+young can do, and hugged her present happiness close to
+her heart.</p>
+
+<p>On the following day we held a council as to the best
+manner of assisting our friends in their project of leaving
+Scotland. And though one would have thought that in the
+presence of his host, Colonel Bulkeley should have withheld
+his own opinion, and paid a graceful deference to what was
+proposed, I cannot tell you that it was so. Several times that
+gentleman contradicted my lord without apology, and was
+for insisting that his plan, namely, to go himself to Burntisland,
+and there charter a ship to carry them to France, was
+the best that could be thought on. This my lord denied, saying
+very truly that the Government was keeping strict watch
+on all the ports in the Forth, and in so small a place the risk
+he ran of being recognised was too great, and it was a relief to
+me when Betty very gently, but firmly backed his opinion.</p>
+
+<p>“You have placed yourselves in our care, sir,” said she
+with a smile, “and you must, if you please, leave it to us to
+get rid of you.”</p>
+
+<p>She spoke so sweetly that no man without rough
+discourtesy could have withstood her, and turning to my
+Lord Tinmouth she went on.</p>
+
+<p>“This, my lord, is our project. To send a trusted
+messenger to Edinburgh to acquaint Captain Straton of your
+lordship’s presence. He is in communication with all the
+honest seamen who traffic between this country and the
+Continent, and it is to him we must leave the final
+arrangements of your departure. The friend we have in
+view is one who has already aided the King’s Cause, and
+who, being often engaged in ordinary business for my
+father between this and Edinburgh, can go and come
+without suspicion being aroused.”</p>
+
+<p>“Madam,” said the young Marquis, when she had
+finished, “I am ready to put myself and my affairs in your
+hands, knowing well that your loyal and kindly concern for
+all the King’s friends will lead you to do the best you can
+for us, and I am sure that my uncle,” turning courteously
+to Colonel Bulkeley, “will be satisfied with any arrangements
+that you make.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_234">[234]</span></p>
+
+<p>The gallant Colonel was obliged for the moment to
+acquiesce and we heard no more of his objections at that
+time, but later we were told, both by Captain Straton and
+David Pitcairn, that he put forward many difficulties and
+found much fault even with those who were doing their best
+to be serviceable to him.</p>
+
+<p>The trusted messenger of whom Betty spoke was, of
+course, the faithful David, who, on arriving at the house
+the next morning, was informed of what had taken place,
+and readily consented to undertake the part allotted to
+him. Some days passed, however, before anything could be
+settled, for the authorities were very vigilant at that time to
+prevent the escape of any rebels, and the Marquis of
+Tinmouth was a prize worth capturing. Many projects
+were brought forward and abandoned, and several ships’
+masters, being interviewed, either declined the job, or
+found themselves so closely watched that it was impossible
+for them to undertake it.</p>
+
+<p>You may be sure that Barbara, for one, did not chafe at
+the delay, for the presence of her lover in the house was
+like sunshine to her; and in the peaceful hours they spent
+together, the young love that was as yet but a tender
+plant was nurtured and cultivated between them, till it
+grew into the perfect thing that has comforted and
+beautified their whole lives. You must not forget that
+there was in our intercourse a strain of that pathetic doubt
+as to the ultimate fruition of our happiness, which
+chastened our joy and tinged it with a wild, sweet pain.
+We spoke of the future at times with confidence and
+faith, but would check ourselves sharply at the thought
+that it might never be ours. Still, for the most part, I
+think that the high spirits and hopes of youth forbade us
+to despair, and the shadow of parting for an indefinite
+time, while it wrung our hearts with grief, served to draw
+us more closely together, and make a grave and steadying
+back-ground to our present bliss.</p>
+
+<p>My dear Betty, who was in our confidence and greatly
+in sympathy with us both, spent her time in cultivating
+the acquaintance of my Lord Tinmouth, who, she assured
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_235">[235]</span>
+me, amply fulfilled the expectations she had entertained
+of him. His manners were so modest and so charming,
+his conversation so sensible and diverting, as to make
+him a very pleasant inmate of the house. My Lord
+Sinclair found him also a companion to his mind, and
+was surprised at his knowledge of books, his youthful
+judgment, and his attention to business. In fact it would
+be impossible to describe the general favour he met with,
+from old and young of both sexes, for the qualities of his
+mind and person.</p>
+
+<p>We four spent many agreeable hours in Betty’s boudoir,
+while we ladies bent over our tambour-frames, and the
+gentlemen entertained us with an account of their
+adventures, or descriptions of the life in France and
+Holland. My Lord Tinmouth spoke one day, in his
+frank and boyish manner, of the match which was being
+arranged for him with a Spanish young lady of the highest
+quality and a great fortune, no less than the sister of the
+most noble Duke of Varagua. He told us that he had
+of course never seen the young lady, but was informed that
+she was pretty and amiable, and a portrait was being
+painted of her to send him for his gratification.</p>
+
+<p>Forgetting to whom I spoke, I raised my head sharply
+from my work.</p>
+
+<p>“And are you satisfied, my lord, to bind yourself for
+life to a lady whom you have never seen, and who may
+prove not at all to your taste?”</p>
+
+<p>“Why yes, madam,” he answered, smiling at me
+pleasantly: “the friends who have arranged the marriage
+are certain to have chosen well, and you must remember
+that the same doubt and uncertainty exist for Doña Inez
+as for myself. It is possible she may not be pleased
+with me.”</p>
+
+<p>“I think there is not much danger of that,” said Betty,
+looking at him very kindly, “and you forget, Barbara,
+<i>autre pays, autre mœurs</i>; young ladies in France and
+Spain are never allowed to choose for themselves in so
+weighty a matter as matrimony.”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh,” I sighed, with a look at my Anthony, who
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_236">[236]</span>
+was watching me, “but I think it is by far the best
+way.”</p>
+
+<p>I saw a flicker of doubt pass over my lord’s young face,
+and his smile was a little wistful as he said, “It must be
+wonderfully pleasant, to be sure!”</p>
+
+<p>“Ay, but it has its disadvantages, my lord!” cried
+Betty, briskly. “Even young people are not always
+infallible. I prophesy that your marriage will be a very
+happy one, and I only wish I could think we might see
+you and Doña Inez together one day in Scotland.”</p>
+
+<p>“And I on my part, madam, can promise, that for any
+friend of yours who comes to Spain, my house will ever be
+open and my welcome of the warmest.”</p>
+
+<p>At last the summons came for our guests to be ready
+on the morrow, to go disguised into Edinburgh, and take
+up their abode in the house of a faithful servant of Captain
+Straton. The latter gentleman was indisposed, which
+added to the difficulties of the case; and being in great
+concern for the safety of the young Marquis (who, by the
+way, went by the name of Mr. Barnes), he spent many
+days and nights in nervous anxiety, till he could form a
+plan that would finally and quietly dispose of him and his
+friends. Our good David Pitcairn came and went, untired
+and undismayed, taking his commands from Betty as
+usual, making at the same time his own sagacious
+suggestions, and amply repaid for all his trouble by the
+kindness of her smile, and the gratitude in her eyes.</p>
+
+<p>The gentlemen were to cross the Firth under cover of
+the darkness, and my lord’s own boatmen were to row
+them over. My dear Anthony and I had made our
+adieux in private before the hour of starting, and nothing
+remained for us but the last embrace, a choking sigh, a few
+whispered words, and, on my part, I fear, some tears that
+would not be suppressed. The household, led by Betty,
+made no secret of their regret at parting with “Mr. Barnes,”
+who took leave of his host and hostess with words of the
+most courteous gratitude. We felt as sad as though parting
+with a long-loved friend, and for his sake even included
+Colonel Bulkeley in our affectionate lamentations. It was
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_237">[237]</span>
+a still, moonless night. The three, accompanied by David,
+crept down the rugged steps to the water; and as we,
+watching from above, saw the boat, propelled by muffled
+oars in strong accustomed hands, steal out upon the black
+water and disappear in the darkness, I know not if Betty’s
+sigh or mine were the deepest.</p>
+
+<p>Three days later we hailed the return of David Pitcairn
+with relief. He had had orders from Betty to stay with
+our friends till the last, and early that morning he had
+seen them safe on board a Dutch ship, which sailed from
+Leith about one or two o’clock, and, as we learned later,
+landed them safely in Holland, from which they made their
+way to France. He did not forget to tell us that Mr.
+Straton had fallen under the spell of young “Mr. Barnes,”
+even as we did, while his dislike of poor Colonel Bulkeley
+appears to have exceeded our own.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_238">[238]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXVI">
+ CHAPTER XXVI
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>BARBARA IS ACCUSED OF CRUELTY AND INDISCRETION</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>The day after this we returned to Alva, bearing with us a
+request from my Lord Sinclair to his daughter Catherine,
+that she would come and make her abode with him in the
+meantime, and in the absence of his eldest son, help him
+in the management of his estate. This my lady, though
+greatly touched by the old gentleman’s trust in her, knew
+was impossible, for indeed her presence was required at
+Alva for many reasons, and she judged rightly that her first
+duty was to her husband and his affairs. So far as our own
+case was concerned things were growing easier, for after representing
+as strongly as she could, the wrongs she had
+suffered in the loss of cattle, fowls, and fodder, to those
+whose influence might be exercised in her favour, my lady
+was relieved of this burden in the surest way possible.
+Her brother-in-law, Mr. Haldane of Gleneagles, though
+strongly against the Rebellion, and keen about all measures
+for punishing the offenders, yet suffered his family affection
+to mitigate his severity in the case of Sir John’s family. It
+was by his means that General Cadogan was prevailed upon
+to grant a protection to my Lady Erskine to prevent her
+being plundered any further, and her nephew, Mr. James
+Haldane, arrived one day from Edinburgh to give notice of
+the same to Lord Rothes at Stirling Castle. This, as you
+can imagine, was a vast relief; and as the same privilege
+was extended to my Lady Jean at Bannockburn, and to
+Lady Keir, our hearts were set at rest on their account
+also.</p>
+
+<p>Now I must tell you that some time back, when she first
+began to have doubts of the wisdom and ultimate success
+of the Rising, my Lady Erskine had conceived a secret
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_239">[239]</span>
+project which, with great good sense, she kept as much as
+possible to herself and a few friends. Since the Battle of
+Sheriffmuir the working of the Silver Mine had been given
+up, on account of the danger of discovery from any of Argyle’s
+men who then over-ran the hills. But after hearing from
+Sir John in the beginning of the year, my lady sent one
+day for Mr. Hamilton, and after pledging him to secrecy,
+and telling him she believed in his loyalty to her and her
+house, enough to trust him with an important matter, she
+divulged her plan for securing the riches of the Mine.</p>
+
+<p>She made him overseer of four miners (though up till
+now he had but superintended the smelting of the ore),
+and these he set to work in the mine, which work,
+being underground and well watched, was kept very
+private.</p>
+
+<p>As the ore was lifted it was stored in casks, hogsheads,
+or barrels, which were buried in a vast hole that my lady
+caused to be dug on the north-west side of the house just
+by the gate. They had managed in this way to hide some
+forty tons of ore, when one morning Mr. Hamilton appeared
+at the house to say that, so far as he could see, the
+vein they were working had given out, and he wished to
+know if Lady Erskine advised any further excavation to be
+made. As this would have entailed a good deal of expense,
+my lady, after consulting with Mr. Erskine, decided that
+at present the work should be given up, which she did
+with the more ease of mind that certain rumours had got
+abroad of untold riches to be found on Sir John’s estate.
+The great hole in the broad walk having attracted some
+attention, she made it known that ’twas only one of Sir
+John’s mad notions, which was not likely to be of much
+use, and this according with the country people’s opinion
+of my guardian’s projects, the gossip soon died down, and
+we hoped the danger was past. I believe that with the
+treasure they collected my lady had framed the notion of
+being able, when the time was ripe, to purchase Sir John’s
+full pardon from the King, and in this idea Mr. Erskine
+and Mr. Campbell encouraged her. It was necessary, however,
+to keep its very existence private, until all danger of
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_240">[240]</span>
+the knight’s being attainted was past, seeing that, if his
+name appeared upon the Black List, his whole estate was
+forfeit to the Crown. In the event of this happening, my
+lady then designed to unearth the casks, and by disposing
+of the contents in a profitable manner, to be able to follow
+her husband to the Continent, where they might live comfortably
+with their children for the rest of their lives.</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>About a week after our return from Dysart, I was walking
+one morning with little Hal down the glen, where by
+Heaven’s kind providence I had found my dear Anthony,
+when Mr. Hamilton met us, and accosted me with his
+usual cordiality. Now, to tell the truth, I had almost forgotten
+that I had ever had even a slight interest in this
+young gentleman; and though when we met we were
+friendly enough, my heart being fully occupied by the
+thought of another, it left me very indifferent to strangers.
+I was therefore surprised when he said rather abruptly,</p>
+
+<p>“I have something of a private nature to say to you,
+Mistress Barbara; can you not send the child away?”</p>
+
+<p>“What!” cried I, laughing, with no thought of what was
+coming, “have you a secret to divulge? Run, Hal, and
+gather some of those pretty anemones for Cousin Barbara.”</p>
+
+<p>“I suppose you have by now,” said Hamilton, “discovered
+the meaning of my words last summer as to your
+gaining wisdom about many things.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, yes,” I answered slowly, thinking of all that I had
+gained since then, “I fancy we are all a year wiser.”</p>
+
+<p>“And sadder?” said he.</p>
+
+<p>“Ah, no!” I cried, softly, “not sadder.”</p>
+
+<p>“Are you then,” he exclaimed eagerly, “on the other
+side? Have you seen the folly of that mad attempt; do
+you realise the character of the man you imagined had
+come to rule us? Are you relieved at the issue of events?
+How glad I am, Mistress Barbara, to find you so sensible.”</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, sir,” cried I, quite startled out of my private
+thoughts; “I protest I do not understand you.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, mistress,” said he, puzzled in his turn, “if you
+are not saddened by the failure of the Rising, it must
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_241">[241]</span>
+needs be because you think it a lucky providence that it
+did not succeed. What else can you mean?”</p>
+
+<p>“The Rising! Forgive me, Mr. Hamilton, I was
+thinking of other things. But how,” said I, “can you
+possibly imagine that I am not grieved to the heart by
+the terrible happenings of the past six months, and bitterly
+disappointed at the departure of the King? Can I know
+of the sufferings and imprisonment of so many good
+friends, the deaths, the losses, the anxiety; can I watch
+my dear lady’s sad face day after day, with the knowledge
+of the pain she bears in her brave heart, and not be
+saddened myself? I should indeed be callous beyond
+belief were such a thing possible!”</p>
+
+<p>“Nay, madam,” he said, “I pray you to believe I had
+no such thought. I myself am grieved enough for the
+calamities that have been brought upon the country,
+both public and private; but I hoped that you did at
+last see how wrong and mistaken was the Rebellion, and
+what a miserable dastard is the man whom they sought
+to put upon the throne of Britain.”</p>
+
+<p>“Stop!” cried I, “I will not hear the King slandered.
+Misled, mismanaged, he certainly was, but dastard—no!”</p>
+
+<p>“But can you believe he would make a good king?”
+cried he. “Would not his accession plunge us into all
+the horrors of Romanism? You cannot deny, madam,
+that the Chevalier is a Papist at heart.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, what else would you expect him to be?” cried I.
+“And Pretender as he is called, he has never pretended
+to be willing to give up his religion for the sake of a
+crown, as another might have done. He is honest, and
+devoted to his Church, as a good man should be; but
+he is no bigot either, for I have heard from Sir John that
+he has a very liberal and open mind towards his Protestant
+subjects, and I do not believe he would ever interfere
+with their religion were he reigning over us.”</p>
+
+<p>“I must beg leave to differ from you, Mistress Barbara,”
+replied Hamilton. “I have seen some friends who met
+the Chevalier in the north, and were bitterly disappointed
+in him. Did he not refuse to have <i>Grace</i> said at his table
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_242">[242]</span>
+by any but his own private chaplain, though there were
+both Presbyterian and Episcopalian clergymen present?”</p>
+
+<p>“Why,” returned I, “I think little of that. I doubt if
+his Hanoverian Majesty would tolerate the benediction
+of a Romish priest at the Royal table, though many of
+them are his subjects.”</p>
+
+<p>“Certainly he would not!” cried Mr. Hamilton.
+“’Twould be a monstrous wrong if he did!”</p>
+
+<p>“And if one man is to be upheld for his narrowness,
+because he acts from a sense of right, why not another?”
+cried I hotly. “Oh, I have no patience with such
+prejudice! This cry about Religions is used but to mask
+other things—politics, social ambition, party strife and
+personal rancour.”</p>
+
+<p>By this time, walking slowly, with little Hal running
+backwards and forwards round us, we had reached the
+garden, which lay bare and orderly in the sunshine, with
+only a few of the early spring flowers showing themselves
+in the borders. When I looked at Mr. Hamilton’s face
+after my last speech, I found he was smiling.</p>
+
+<p>“You are a brave and stout partisan, Mistress Barbara,”
+said he, “and I should find it difficult to move you. As
+it is, Providence hath ordained that the present dynasty
+be established in Britain—”</p>
+
+<p>“For the time being,” murmured I.</p>
+
+<p>“And we must needs bow to that decree,” he went on
+unheeding. “This, however, was not what I wished to
+talk of. Will you pardon me for allowing myself to wander
+so far from the subject at my heart, for indeed it is the chief
+thought in my life at present, and has been for long.”</p>
+
+<p>“Pray, go on,” said I, somewhat coldly, for I was
+ruffled by our discussion, and felt now more out of
+sympathy with my companion than before.</p>
+
+<p>“It is now a year since first I saw you, madam, and I
+make no secret of the fact that I was more struck by
+your appearance than by that of anyone I ever met.
+Since then all I have seen and heard of you confirms my
+first impressions. You are the most charming woman
+in the world, madam, and I beg you to be my wife.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_243">[243]</span></p>
+
+<p>Surprise, chagrin, and anger filled my breast, mingled
+with a certain shame that I should have permitted this
+man to go so far. I fear my reply was both pert and
+rude.</p>
+
+<p>“You must think a vast deal of yourself, sir, if you
+imagine you are worthy to be the husband of the most
+charming woman in the world!”</p>
+
+<p>He laughed good-naturedly; he was too dense to
+notice the disdain in my voice.</p>
+
+<p>“No one on earth is really worthy to hold that position,
+madam; but I beg you to believe that I shall count myself
+lucky should you dream of giving it to me.”</p>
+
+<p>“I fear,” said I shortly, “that that is impossible.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why impossible?” he cried, only half understanding.
+“My family, madam, is as good as yours; my present
+occupation is not to last for ever. I mean to establish
+myself well, and gain a position that even you will not
+disdain to share. Let me go to my lady this evening,
+Barbara, and get her consent to our union.”</p>
+
+<p>How different—ah, how different was this man’s wooing!</p>
+
+<p>“Pardon me, sir,” I answered, “I cannot be your wife.
+Oh, will you not understand and leave me in peace!”</p>
+
+<p>I spoke impatiently, for I wanted to be rid of him.
+He stood before me, his face very white and set.</p>
+
+<p>“Listen, Barbara Stewart,” he said. “There is more
+depending on your consent than you think. If you reject
+me thus you will regret it, not so much for your own
+sake as for some of the friends you love so well. Consider
+well, my girl, before you decide. You would not care to
+bring disaster upon this house. After to-day ’twill be
+too late.”</p>
+
+<p>Angry, but scarcely alarmed, I drew myself up.</p>
+
+<p>“Do you dare to threaten me, sir?” I cried. “What
+mean you? Or no, I do not care for your meanings;
+what you have said is enough. If you think Barbara
+Stewart would marry one who would stoop to injure any
+human-being of set purpose and design, you know her very
+little. I am indifferent to your threats, for I do not
+believe in your power to do much harm.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_244">[244]</span></p>
+
+<p>In scorn and indignation I turned away, and calling to
+little Henry I walked towards the house. James Hamilton
+followed.</p>
+
+<p>“Is it thus you despise an honest man’s love, mistress?”
+he said hoarsely. “Oh ho, my Lady Disdain, but the
+day may come when you will wish that you had listened
+more kindly. You think lightly of my power; you shall
+see by-and-bye what it can do. Barbara!” he said, and his
+voice broke as he laid his hand upon my arm. “You will
+not be so cruel!”</p>
+
+<p>“Sir,” said I, stopping and speaking more gently, “I
+have answered you, and I would beg you now to leave me.
+In that you have honoured me by your regard, I thank
+you. If I have hurt you, I ask your forgiveness; but a
+woman’s love is not to be won by methods such as yours,
+and I must own that your speeches this morning have put
+me greatly out of sympathy with you as a friend.”</p>
+
+<p>I looked in his face, but found it hard to read. There
+was an expression of regret certainly, mingled with discomfort
+and doubt; but my woman’s instinct told me well
+enough that behind this was no wounded heart of despairing
+lover, and not even his next words moved me to belief.</p>
+
+<p>“Then farewell, mistress,” he said in a low voice; “you
+have broken my life in two. Henceforth we go separate
+ways. Heaven grant you tenderness to know how cruelly
+you have used me!”</p>
+
+<p>Angered again by this accusation, I bowed to him without
+reply, and walked away towards the house with the child
+clinging to my hand.</p>
+
+<p>Seated at work next morning in the parlour, we were
+listening amused to the chatter of the little boys, when
+Charles gave a great sigh and exclaimed, “How I wish
+my papa would come home! I do weary to see him.”</p>
+
+<p>“So do I, too!” cried Henry, with a sigh to match his
+brother’s. “Tell me, mama, how many years is it since
+my papa went away?”</p>
+
+<p>My lady put down her work to pat the curly head at
+her knee, and sighed herself, though she laughed at the
+childish question.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_245">[245]</span></p>
+
+<p>“The months are years to us who love him, are they
+not, Hal?” she said. “We must pray God to send him
+back to us very soon.”</p>
+
+<p>“I do,” cried Charles. “Last night I said in my
+prayers, ‘Please, God, let my papa come home before
+the trees are green.’ That will be very soon now, mama,
+will it not?”</p>
+
+<p>Just then came a knock at the door, and one entered
+to say that Mr. Hamilton waited without, desiring to speak
+to her ladyship.</p>
+
+<p>“Very well, bid him come in!” said my lady; but on
+hearing that he had something of a private nature to
+communicate, she rose with a perturbed look and hurried
+from the room.</p>
+
+<p>It was half-an-hour before she returned, and when she
+did so, ’twas with a vexed and ruffled countenance. She
+dismissed the children abruptly, and standing in front of
+me, cried,</p>
+
+<p>“Well, Barbara, do you know the mischief you have
+wrought?”</p>
+
+<p>Trembling and surprised, I dropped my needle and
+looked at her.</p>
+
+<p>“Madam,” I stammered, “I am sorry; but you know
+yourself, cousin, that I could not listen to Mr. Hamilton’s
+proposals.”</p>
+
+<p>“And yet you encouraged him; you led him to believe
+his suit was not in vain! You drew him on, only to have
+the triumph of rejecting him. Was this the part of a
+modest maiden, Barbara?”</p>
+
+<p>Wounded to the quick, and with the tears starting to
+my eyes, I yet answered her with some spirit.</p>
+
+<p>“If Mr. Hamilton has told you this, madam, he has
+done me great injustice. A year ago, I own, I wished him
+to admire me—foolish girl that I was, all new to intercourse
+with men—and accepted his small attentions with
+a kind of pleasure. But since our return from Dysart last
+October, I have never given him a look that he could
+construe into interest of the faintest sort. I beg you to
+believe, cousin, that Mr. Hamilton is a man it is not easy
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_246">[246]</span>
+to flout. He thinks the whole world has as high an
+opinion of him as he himself has; and if he has made up
+his mind to establish himself in any woman’s favour, he
+would be so firm in the belief of his success that the news of
+his failure would come as a great shock to his pride.”</p>
+
+<p>I dried my eyes, for as I spoke my anger returned.</p>
+
+<p>“And even if his accusations were true, I take it, madam,
+that ’tis not the part of a chivalrous gentleman to blame a
+woman for his own conceited blunder. I have nothing
+but contempt for the man. I never wish to speak to him
+again.”</p>
+
+<p>“’Tis not likely that you will,” returned my lady,
+gloomily; “he leaves Alva to-day.”</p>
+
+<p>“Leaves Alva?” cried I. “But how can he go and
+abandon his work? How can he leave you alone?”</p>
+
+<p>“’Twill make it very uneasy for me,” she replied; “but
+there is no more to be said. He is like a man wrong in
+the head, and was neither to hold nor to bind, as the
+saying is. I talked till I was tired, but his mind was made
+up; he could not stay where he might see Mistress Stewart
+any day. His heart was broken, he repeated, his life
+spoiled.”</p>
+
+<p>“Pray, madam,” I entreated, “will you forgive me for
+my share in this new trouble, and say you believe I am
+not so much to blame! I cannot be happy to lie under
+such an imputation in your eyes. I regret more than I
+can say the annoyance it causes you, but I cannot heartily
+believe that Mr. Hamilton is so greatly afflicted as he
+pretends. All the time he was talking to me yesterday, I
+felt that his speech did not ring true; ’twas as if he were
+working himself into a passion to make an effect.”</p>
+
+<p>While I was speaking I was considering in my mind the
+wisdom of repeating to my lady the threatening language
+the man had used; but having no particular belief in it, and
+not wishing to disturb her unnecessarily, I held my peace.
+She pondered my last words for some time, and when she
+spoke again, her voice had lost its coldness.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, Barbara,” she said, “to say truth, I doubted the
+man myself. He was too violent, he talked too much.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_247">[247]</span>
+At first I was so put about at the prospect of his leaving me
+that I did not stop to reason, but now that I am calm
+again, I acknowledge you are right to despise the way
+James has behaved. So far as the Mine is concerned I
+can trust him to be silent, and for his work I have
+no doubt I shall find a successor. There is not much
+to be done at present in any case, so perhaps after all he
+will not be missed. Forget about him, child; he has taken
+himself out of our life in a pet. ’Tis not likely he will
+enter it again.”</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>“Ah!” cried Betty when she heard of it, “do you not
+see now that I was right? Did I not warn you, Barbara,
+of what he was capable, and tell you to be on your guard
+with him? Well, thank heaven, he has done no harm, and
+as my sister says, I do not suppose we shall ever see
+him again. But, though I never liked the man, I am
+amazed, I must own, at his ingratitude.”</p>
+
+<p>And so James Hamilton departed from Alva, hiding his
+treachery under a very flimsy cloak, for, as you know, his
+love for Barbara was only a blind, and his despair a mere
+pretence to allow him to escape and work his wicked will.</p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER VII</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>I begin to be impatient to hear from my Dear Life. This
+is the fourth letter I have writ, and I have got but one. If
+you are well I am very happy, but I have many melancholy
+dreams about you which is occasioned by anxious concern to
+have you easy in your mind, and satisfied with your present
+state, which indeed is a great tryal but such as God in His
+providence thinks fit to send us, and it is no small mercy in so
+general a calamity that you are preserved and will have what
+may make us live comfortably together. I must own it is not
+easy for me to be at so great a distance from you, nor can I
+have any prospect yet how soon I can be with you, until some
+settlements be made in affairs here, which will take a
+considerable time. I am doing in the meantime what is for
+your interest.</p>
+
+<p>As for old W.’s work I am obligt to give it up yesterday,
+until we be in a state of more freedom than we are at present,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_248">[248]</span>
+and people began to suspect that there was something in it
+more than ordinary that I continued it so long. My counsel
+determined me in doing so, and they have some projects in
+vein to secure all. I hope they will not all fail ... it’s
+lucky for us P.C. is at London, and will be there for a great
+while. His wife is gone home to lye, and designs to take her
+two eldest children to London with her against June.</p>
+
+<p>Your mother is here and is very concerned about you, and
+is very thankful you got so early off. In short, that supports
+her in all the difficulties that occur, as it does me, for the
+violence cannot always last, tho’ in the meantime it’s very hard
+upon those that are in their hands. I am in great fear for J.
+Paterson, for I am told that base wretch, Jock Muir, says his
+house was the place of their meeting which makes his friends
+afraid. I pity my poor sister, and when I think of her I think
+my own sufferings easy. In short I am not to be pityed for
+anything but being absent from you, for your friends have a
+particular regard and concern for me, and Charls omits nothing
+that can be for your interest, and I believe your sister Nell will
+make her spouse (Mr. Haldane) do all that’s possible for you
+att Court, and I hear he is much in favour at present. But
+that family distinguish themselves in violence at present, tho’
+as to your particular (case) I believe they will do all that’s
+possible. Your nephew, James, was here the other day, and
+procured a protection for my house and all things I am
+concerned in, which makes me easy. In the meantime I
+believe there is some care taken to hinder your being denounct,
+but I fear it will not doe, but if it could be done it would be an
+advantage; but be it as it will there shall none of your stockin’
+be lost.</p>
+
+<p>If your brother Robin come to Holland with his master,
+Charls has some thoughts of coming there, and desiring you to
+meet them if you can do it with safety. Some people here
+think it would be easy for Robin’s master to procure your
+pardon, which I think should be done if possible; tho’ you
+did not return to Britain for some time the interest of your
+family and the present circumstances of your affairs require it,
+but when your brothers and you meet you can talk freely of
+that and other things.</p>
+
+<p>Andrew (Argyle) has lost the command of the troops here,
+and Mr. Beggar (Cadogan) has got it. I wish Andrew had
+known it sooner for it’s talkt Beggar had it seven weeks before
+Andrew left this Country, and yesterday Mr. Beggar went
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_249">[249]</span>
+northwards. Perth, Aberdeen, and Inverness are to be
+fortified. If the common people who are still under arms will
+now come to surrender they are to be allowed to go home, and
+I hear some of the Clans have done so. In that case their
+Heads will doe well to take care of themselves.... Colonel
+Pary, and Mr. Balfour have given up themselves, my Lord
+Rollo and several others of like degree, which is very surprising.
+There came an order to the common prisoners either to choose
+to stand their tryal or be sold to the plantations. I hear that
+most have chosen rather to stand their tryal than live slaves.
+Your fellow-travellers came south and were taken care of. I
+doubt not you will hear of them soon. All our neighbours are
+safe. Your boys are well and nothing shall be wanting that’s
+fit for them; for their education I hop, one way or other, you
+shall doe it to your own mind.</p>
+
+<p>I am in great grief for Kid (the King) and your freind Mill
+(Mar), tho’ I think he is the only cause for all my sufferings,
+but I find he is blamed by all sides. How far it’s just I know
+not, but I shall never blame him, tho’ in my heart I cannot
+but think he should not have taken such an affair upon him
+without positive orders from Kid. However, in the meantime,
+I could wish for your own sake you wold not be near Kid or
+Mill, because that may be a hindrance to some projects which
+we have in view; and since you may doe yourself and family
+prejudice and can do them no service, it is but common
+prudence to do so.</p>
+
+<p>I long to hear from my Dearest Life. May you be happy
+always, and remember the only way to be kind to me is to take
+care of yourself. I got a proposal from my father to come to
+keep house to him, and bring my boys with me, or he will
+come and board with me; but he wants me to manage his
+estate in his son’s absence, both which proposals I have
+rejected; and he says he will goe abroad. Where it will end I
+know not.</p>
+
+<p>Charles salutes you and Betty, and your sons offer their
+humble duty to you, and</p>
+
+<p class="right pr6">I am ever yours,</p>
+<p class='right pr2'> my Dearest Soul.
+</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER VIII</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p class='right pr1'><i>March 23.</i></p>
+<p>
+ <span class="smcap">My Dearest Life</span>,
+</p>
+
+<p class='letter-indent-plus'>I received two of your letters this week which
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_250">[250]</span>
+were most acceptable, one without a date, and the last of the
+16th of March. By both I see all my letters have miscarry’d,
+which does not a little vex me. You was not eight days out of
+Britain when I writ first, and this is the fifth I have writ. I
+have been so lucky to receive three letters from you, which is
+no small comfort; but by your not receiving mine you have not
+drawn for 100 pound I desired you to take from your factor,
+and that you should be straitened is what I am very much
+afraid of. Pray doe not want what is fit for you, for I hope in
+God I shall always have (means) to supply you till I be so
+happy (as) to see you again, which is what I very much long
+for; and my absence from you is the only suffering I have,
+but that I ought to submit to with cheerfulness when you are
+well and out of danger. I must own the thought of your
+safety has been a great support to mee, and as to other
+particulars in my own affairs, the grief and concern I had for
+others made me very easy about them, and hitherto there has
+nothing happened in my little affairs that could make me
+uneasy. I am still in my own house and looking carefully to
+all things, and am so much of your mind, however dark things
+may look at present, that both this place and the other
+(Cambuswallace) may be possesst by you and yours, that I
+have planted trees this season, and made up all the wants in
+your hedges, and shall not omit to doe everything that can be
+for your interest.</p>
+
+<p>Mr. R(ose) labours your own farms this year. As to your
+debts of all kinds all care has been taken, and as I told you
+before not one can lose a groat by you so you may be easy.
+My being so much a stranger to your debts makes it a little
+uneasy, but a little time will put that over. There is not a
+thing I doe were it never so trifling, but I consult first whether
+my friend would approve of this; and I daresay you would if
+you saw my actings approved of, the most part if not all.
+Your brother has been twice here, and does in every respect
+act the part of a kind friend, and does not omit the least thing
+that can be either useful or agreeable to me.</p>
+
+<p>I send you one enclosed from your mother. She is indeed
+a kind woman, and tho’ she disapproves what you have done,
+yet she cannot bear to have you blamed and reflected on, and
+is as cheerful as ever I saw her, for she thinks there will be
+favour got one way or other, and the family will be preserved.
+And she hopes this may be a means to make you serious,
+which I pray God it may, for afflictions are not sent in vain.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_251">[251]</span>
+I pray earnestly that we may all have the right use of them,
+and that seeing the uncertainty of all human things we may
+seek what is more lasting.</p>
+
+<p>I am in hops our two good friends att London will not be in
+danger. My poor sister writes they have few enemies, and if
+her spouse is banished she will send for her children to goe
+with him. There is many gentlemen given up themselves,
+which I wonder much at. I think they have had no
+encouragement to do so. Your fellow-travellers will be in
+their own country again by this time, and a great many of
+your friends. Poor Polmaise is dead. All your servants are
+well. Some people think the clans can keep out a year,
+others are afraid of them. There is no accounts yet since
+Mr. Beggar went north. Your servant, Andrew S——t, came
+safe here two months agoe; I writ to you of him before, and
+desired to know if I should send him to you. If anything
+can be done for you, it is not fit you be with Kid and Mill;
+and since you cannot serve them, it’s but a reasonable
+prudence not to give new provocations. P.C. is att London,
+and will not fail to doe all that can be done, and your sister
+Nell’s spouse I hear is much in favour. But they are very
+violent tho’ I doubt not their good-will to you. Your children
+are well. There shall be nothing wanting that’s fit for them,
+and as for their education, I hop you shall do that yourself,
+for if ever I be put from this place, I’ll come and bring them
+with me; but I must own I do not expect to leave this place,
+and I rather think you will be allowed to return, for things
+cannot always continue, as they have been violent long, so the
+contrary may now be hoped for.</p>
+
+<p>I blame you much that you do not tell me more of Kid, for
+I have a great concern for him and great pity. As to my
+health I am rather better than usual. The season is good,
+and I am much in the fields, sometimes employed in business,
+and thinking on the unhappy state of many different people
+at other times, and reflecting on the mercy’s I daily meet with,
+which are such as I should never forget, for I am not to be
+pitied for anything but my being absent from you, which if I
+suffer patiently God may in a little time give me the comfort
+of being with you again.</p>
+
+<p>I think you should read much; I will recommend Monsieur
+Paskal’s Thoughts to you, which I doubt not you will like.
+Wishing my dear soul all manner of happiness, I am in all
+sincerity,</p>
+
+<p class='right pr4'>
+ Yours.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_252">[252]</span></p>
+
+<p>Your friend Bess salutes you kindly. Pray be so kind to
+me (as) to take good care of your self, and write frequently
+when you see I doe not miss one.</p>
+
+<p>
+ Apri. 4.
+</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER IX</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>
+ My Dearest Life,
+</p>
+
+<p class='letter-indent-plus'>I am uneasy you have never got any of my
+letters and I am much afraid you are in want of money. I
+have writ six letters since you left Britain, and in every one of
+them beg’d (you) to cause your factor to draw upon his correspondent
+for 100 pound. Pray do not want what is
+necessare nor be afraid of want, for I hop we shall always
+have enough. I am told things have a better aspect of late
+and I am hopfull our friends att London will be safe. As to
+the fortunes, if things should come to the worst, I hop we shall
+still have what will give us what is needful for Life. In the
+meantime I am as easy at home as I can be when absent from
+you. I must own that is the greatest part of my suffering but
+I dare not allow myself to think of itt. When I consider how
+mercifully you have been preserved, and that you have a good
+country and liberty, the sad state of many good people has
+hitherto affected me so much, I thought myself happy in comparison.
+Your friends have been very careful to doe me all
+manner of kindness, and I am very sure I am to be as little
+pityed as any in my state. I have had 3 of your letters which
+gave me great comfort. I wish both of us may be thankful
+for every degree of mercy we meet with, and submitt with
+chearfulness to what Providence orders for us.</p>
+
+<p>I was some time perfectly incapable of doeing anything
+being so much overwhelmed with greif, but saw soon the folly
+and fault of giving way to it, and am now doing all I can to be
+usefull to you in your present circumstances. I hope God will
+bless my indeavors for I shall endeavor to doe the best without
+anxiety which I have been too long liable to. I shall be glad
+to hear you are well in your country retreat, and are contented
+with your present state. Your mother has been here, and
+writ to you in my last letter. She is both cheerfull and easy.
+Her concern was great till you was gone, but she has none now,
+for she does not doubt your family will be preserved and she
+hopes this will make you good.</p>
+
+<p>I told you in my last old W.’s work was given up; it went
+off, and we thought it a good opportunity because of impertinent
+people talking, and both Ch. and P.C. have several
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_253">[253]</span>
+projects in vein to secure itt. How or what way things will be
+no body can yett guess, but if you are preserv’d I fear nothing.
+For your boys I have not the least concern or fear they will
+ever want. They are young, and there may be many changes
+before they are men.</p>
+
+<p>I have planted trees and put all the hedges to rights, and
+shall not fail to take all manner of care that nothing you have
+done be lost. I find my Counsel think I have too much land
+in my own hand, and they incline I should let out in Tenantry
+the place I do not live at. I must own I think I have more to
+do than I can well manage, but I fear you will lose all you
+have laid out, and it will not give so much now to let it as it
+might do sometime afterwards; but I have no money to lay out
+on improvements, but I would be glad to have your own
+opinion. You will laugh at this way of writing, but I have
+some faint hope you will never be attainted, having ’scapt the
+first brunt. You will hear many of your friends is gone to
+Holand, some are yet in this country.</p>
+
+<p>I hear Rob Roy’s house is burnt and his cattle caryed off by
+a party. He thought fit to wait for them in a wood, and, they
+talk, has killed a great many. I am sorry for it. I have heard
+nothing of Mr. Beggar, but nobody doubts but he will have
+work enough this summer.</p>
+
+<p>Pray write often and oblige me, for all you have writ comes
+very safe to my hand. I told you before P. C. is att London,
+and I believe you may have no doubt but he will serve you. I
+hear his friend, Andrew, is very great at Court and is a great
+Countryman. I hope God will bless their endeavors.</p>
+
+<p>I am angry you never mention Kid or Mill for I have a
+great desire to hear of them, but I do not wish you to be with
+them in case it would stop what your friends is earnest to have
+done for you here. Your boys are well and want much to see
+you, and ask me how many years it is since their Papa went
+away. Dearest Life, wishing you all happiness.</p>
+
+<p class='right pr4'>
+ Adieu.</p>
+
+<p>Apr. 13.</p>
+<p class='letter-indent-less'>
+ I am very well in my health.</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_254">[254]</span></p>
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXVII">
+ CHAPTER XXVII
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>SHOWS HOW SLOWLY THE TIME PASSES WHEN THE HEART IS HEAVY</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>You will notice, I have no doubt, a great sameness in
+these interesting letters, and frequent repetitions of the
+sentiments and facts they contain. The reason of this, as
+you will readily understand, was the fear my lady had that
+Sir John might not receive them, so that she felt compelled
+to inform him of whatever interested them most in every
+epistle she penned. It would be easy to curtail them,
+giving you only extracts, and so save you the tedium of
+reading the same things so often; but in reproducing them
+as they were writ I feel that I am only doing justice to my
+dear lady’s memory, for by this means alone can you, her
+descendants, realise the weariness of her life, the flagging
+of her hopefulness, the constant burden that weighed on
+her mind during those long, monotonous weeks. Her
+spirits, as you will see, varied, as a woman’s are apt to
+do with her varying moods. Some days she would be
+full of cheerfulness, saying that an end to all our troubles
+must soon be coming, and busying herself with her affairs
+as if her beloved husband were returning to Alva the
+very next week; at other times she would be heavy and
+sad, moving about the house in silence, and only by a
+great effort making answer to those who conversed with
+her. The news of Sir John’s safety and freedom did
+indeed lift a weight from her heart, and for some days she
+even laughed and sang as she made herself busy in her
+usual way; but this lightness could not long be maintained,
+and the prospect of seeing her husband grew more and
+more uncertain.</p>
+
+<p>Our fears for the good old Colonel and his son, still
+prisoners in the Fleet, were now allayed as nothing could
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_255">[255]</span>
+be found against them, and there seemed to be every hope
+that after a time they would be released. Mr. Patrick
+Campbell, our kind and constant friend, had means of
+seeing them frequently, and kept my lady informed of their
+welfare.</p>
+
+<p>The news of the escape of the brave old Brigadier
+Mackintosh and several of his friends from Newgate, which
+reached us some time in May, was hailed with triumph,
+not unmixed with amusement, when we learned that this
+sturdy veteran had knocked down his gaoler with his fists;
+and after disarming the sentinel, they opened the gates
+and let themselves out into the streets, afterwards escaping
+(save one or two who were unluckily recaptured) to
+France. Some weeks later occurred the escape of Colonel
+Walkinshaw of Barafield from the Castle of Stirling, which
+we learned enraged the Earl of Rothes very much. But
+these things are matters of history, you will say, and enter
+not into our story.</p>
+
+<p>And all this time it may be asked where was Sir John
+and how was he faring?</p>
+
+<p>Excellently well, if we may believe the hints given us
+in the few extracts of letters from him which I have seen,
+and the scraps of news about him, confided to me at the
+time by my lady, and entered in my little day-book.</p>
+
+<p>You will see that his faithful wife believes that he is
+living quietly and privately, with no thought of further
+entangling himself in the King’s affairs; but she constantly
+urges him to leave the neighbourhood of his Majesty and
+the Earl of Mar, in order to prove to the authorities at
+home that he truly repents him of his misdeeds, and is therefore
+a fit subject for the clemency of King George. And all
+the time if we had but known it, Sir John was busily
+engaged in furthering his master’s interests by every means
+in his power, although I am certain he did not contemplate
+bringing disaster upon his wife and family.</p>
+
+<p>In the beginning of April, he, accompanied by his
+brother-in-law, left Paris by water-coach for a town called
+Auxerre, which was finally reached in a covered cart.
+From there, as it was quite out of the way of diligences
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_256">[256]</span>
+or even ordinary post-road, they hired horses to ride to
+Beaune, a small village in a wine-growing district from
+which was obtained the excellent <i>vin de Pomar</i>, or <i>Beaune</i>,
+which is still famed among the wines of Burgundy. In
+one of his letters Sir John tells my lady how he drinks
+her health daily, though abstemiously, in this cheap and
+pleasant beverage; he also gives an amusing account of
+Mr. Paterson’s difficulties with the French language, the
+latter being almost a stranger to its use.</p>
+
+<p>After about three weeks in this place, Sir John, upon the
+King’s summoning him, repaired to Avignon where his
+Majesty held his meagre court, and from then onwards
+through the summer his time seems to have been occupied
+with political affairs. This, as you are aware, he kept
+from my lady’s knowledge, but rumours reached her from
+time to time through other sources, which greatly disturbed
+her and kept her in a state of constant anxiety.</p>
+
+<p>“What,” she said to me once, “is the use of all our
+endeavours to obtain Sir John’s pardon, and prevent his
+being attainted, if he continues to mix himself up in the
+affairs of the poor King? I cannot see that one man’s
+help, or the want of it, can make much difference at the
+present juncture; and I am convinced that if my husband
+were free to confide his private affairs to his Majesty, he
+would be told to consider his family interests rather than
+continue any longer in this employment.”</p>
+
+<p>“Perhaps the story of Sir John’s being sent to Spain is
+false,” said I, to comfort her.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, ’tis very like!” she answered, “people must always
+be talking. But it shows us, Barbara, what I have ever
+felt, the strong difference between men and women. Were
+my dear life to express the lightest wish regarding my
+conduct, would I not hasten to do it, no matter how cross
+it might be to my inclination? But not all my pleadings,
+I fear, will have any effect on Sir John to make him alter
+his present way of living.”</p>
+
+<p>“Ah, madam!” I cried, eager as ever for my guardian’s
+justification, “’tis a hard thing to be torn by divided duties,
+especially when affection bears a part in each. But I do
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_257">[257]</span>
+fervently believe our good Sir John will decide to give up
+the King, if this is the only alternative, rather than bring
+you and your children to misery.”</p>
+
+<p>“Would to God he would hesitate no longer!” she
+cried. “He may make up his mind too late, and end by
+falling between two stools, as the saying is.”</p>
+
+<p>“There is still,” she went on after a while, “the hope of
+help from his brother, Robin, who is very great with his
+master. I think ’twould be easy for him to move the Czar
+to ask for Sir John’s pardon; but this, as you know, would
+not alter the inclination of the Parliament if they were
+determined to have him attainted, and my fear is, that
+believing him still a servant of King James, they may
+hasten to do it. I pray God to have us all in his keeping,
+and order everything for our good; but my heart at times is
+very heavy, Barbara, and the waiting is long.”</p>
+
+<p>It was about this time that the little boys fell ill with the
+chincough, or whooping-cough, and though at first it
+seemed they were both to get pretty easy off, the trouble
+increased, and little Hal especially was brought very low.
+Fortunately the weather was mild and almost summer-like,
+though but the beginning of May, so that there was every
+chance for the children in that particular, and with Phemie’s
+care and skill to depend on, my lady did not allow herself
+to be unduly agitated about them. Still she was an anxious
+and tender parent, and the sight of her youngest child, with
+white face and heavy eyes, oppressed and spent after a fit
+of the cough, caused her many a pang, I trow, for to have
+anything serious happen to her precious little sons in the
+absence of their father, would have well-nigh broken her
+heart.</p>
+
+<p>Early in this month Betty was obliged to go back to
+Dysart, intending as she said to return very shortly, but
+this, as events turned out, she was unable to do. Old
+Lady Alva was still with us, as kind and pleasant a dame
+as it would be possible to find. Her cheerful, placid spirit
+was of the greatest benefit to her daughter at this time, and
+though she interfered in nothing that was being done, she
+was ever ready to give her help and advice when asked.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_258">[258]</span></p>
+
+<p>As for Barbara, she had been made happy by receiving
+a letter from her friend, Mr. Fleming, who was safely arrived in
+France, and was now staying with some good friends of his
+father’s in Paris. He had great hopes, he said, of getting
+his pardon, through his parent’s friends in the Government,
+and was already contemplating falling in with his father’s
+suggestion that he should get him employment in the
+service of the East India Company. As this would entail
+his leaving Britain and living in a distant land for the most
+part of his life, he thought it proper to advertise me of his
+prospects, and get my mind on the matter.</p>
+
+<p>Glad and relieved as I was to know him safe and well,
+this news, as you can imagine, threw me into some
+agitation, for it implied the readjustment and arranging of
+my whole life, and my woman’s heart trembled at the
+notion. There is surely nothing in life so wonderful nor so
+beautiful, if we regard it rightly, as the simple trust
+displayed by a young maid in giving up herself to the sole
+care of the man she loves, forsaking all other to cleave to
+him, leaving friends and home and childhood’s scenes to
+accompany him to any corner of the globe, the future all
+unknown, alone, but for him, in the whole world. And
+yet I suppose that ever since Rebecca, trusting only to
+hearsay, came willingly to Isaac, it has been the way of
+women, and ordered by God; and men too often, I fear,
+regard it as a natural proceeding, and the faith that it
+implies no more than their due.</p>
+
+<p>However that may be, I did not feel it would be right
+to attempt to dissuade Mr. Fleming from falling in with his
+father’s wishes; for nothing was nearer to my heart, as you
+may guess, than the desire to stand well in the eyes of my
+Anthony’s parents, so that they might find nothing of
+which to disapprove in their dear son’s choice. He begged
+my permission and that of Lady Erskine, to make them
+acquainted with our mutual love, so that, upon his obtaining
+his pardon, our betrothal might at once be made public.</p>
+
+<p>To this, my lady, after consulting with Mr. Erskine (who
+was again at Alva), gave her consent, but added that in the
+event of Mr. Fleming’s going to the Indies, she must beg,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_259">[259]</span>
+for the sake of my youth, that he should not insist upon
+my accompanying him. In three or four years’ time, she
+said, I would be of age, and being older, more fit to hold
+my own against the extremities of the Eastern climate; Mr.
+Fleming also would be accustomed to the country, and
+more fit to make me comfortable in my new life when I
+went out to him.</p>
+
+<p>I cannot say that Barbara, young, impulsive and not too
+patient, at once agreed to her kind friend’s proposals.
+Indeed it took some days of consideration and counsel to
+bring her to reason, and some nights of sleepless anxiety
+and not a few tears, before she could bring herself to face
+the prospect with equanimity. The sorrow of parting, the
+long absence from each other, the distance that would
+separate us, and the dangers and risks of the long voyage—all
+these combined to make a burden that was not easy to
+carry. But of this I said very little in my reply to my lover,
+knowing that his own heart would understand it too well.
+I only stipulated very strongly that I should see him once
+more, and talk over everything with himself, before his
+departure from Britain.</p>
+
+<p>And so with hopes and fears the days were intermingled,
+and the summer was at hand, and the trees were growing
+green, but there was no word yet of Sir John’s coming
+home.</p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER X</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>I think it very hard I can never hear my Dearest Life has
+got any of my letters, tho’ this is the seventh I have writ, and
+in every one desired you to draw a bill for 100 pounds. Your
+not doeing it makes me conclude you have never got one, and
+since you left Paris I have never heard from you at all. I
+must own my hearing from you so seldom is a great uneasiness
+and occasions me many fears, tho’ I must own I should trust to
+the kind providence of God who has hitherto wonderfully
+preserved you. All things as to the settling the affairs of this
+unhappy country are still undetermined, and our own countrymen
+cannot agree about it, which is our misfortune. What
+will be the issue God knows, but we are not without fears of
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_260">[260]</span>
+hard usage, nor altogether without hop that in time they may
+relent and use us more Christianly.</p>
+
+<p>I hear of our friends att London frequently. I am hopful
+they are in no danger as to their lives, and it’s generally talkt
+there will not be much more blood taken. In the meantime I
+am living very easyily at home managing as formerly, but
+have enough to do to keep all right, and have great difficulty
+in getting up the rents, tho’ care must be taken to pay the
+annual rents and prevent diligencies being done. I am very
+lucky in two friends which take much of the burden off me,
+and all is done that can be in the present circumstances. I
+am easy in everything in comparison to the anxious care and
+concern I have about your person, and the different thoughts
+you will have upon not hearing what state I am in.</p>
+
+<p>Your boys has had the chincoch but are better. The season
+here has been extraordinary, for since the breaking of the
+storm there has not been an ill day; the fields are much
+frequented by me, and how to manage my ground to the best
+advantage is much my study. I shall not fail to observe as
+much as possible all you have done in both places....</p>
+
+<p>Some of your friends are so unjust (as) to blame me for your
+going out, and the reason they give for it is I should have
+acquainted the Government with your design. But since I am
+innocent and never did anything but what was my duty with
+regard to you, I must let them be saying and bear that with
+other things. I cannot frame a notion to myself what state we
+will be in, but in the general I have no fears of want, and I am
+sure nobody will lose by you. These things I have good
+ground to believe, let things come to the worst; but the longer
+things are of being settled the longer I shall be deprived of
+the happyness of seeing you, for my being here is absolutely
+necessare till we see the utmost and procure something by help
+of friends for me and my children if they do go to the Height
+of Rigour.</p>
+
+<p>I have no other work in hand without doors but plowing,
+this two months past, for some impertinent folks was like to be
+uneasy, and P. C. is at London who has several schemes in
+vein; whether any will succeed at this present juncture I
+cannot guess, but Providence will preserve you and all your
+concerns, I hop, in spite of all your enemies. All your friends
+here are well, some blaming you and others pitying you, but
+all your near relations will do for you what lyes in their power.
+Your sister Ca. has a son call’d after her father; I am going to
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_261">[261]</span>
+see her this week. I am very impatient to hear from you.
+The three letters you writ before you left Paris came safe to
+my hand, but I have had none since. My health is pretty
+good considering how many difficult things I have to disturb
+me, but if you be preserved I hop to get over all other
+difficulties in time.</p>
+
+<p>As to the clans they are all coming in and giving up their
+arms. There is none of your neighbourhood given up
+themselves.</p>
+
+<p>Betty salutes you, and I am Dear, Soul, in all sincerity,
+May 1st.</p>
+
+<p class="right pr2">
+ Yours.
+</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER XI</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>It is but three day since I wrote to my Dearest Life, but
+haveing had the pleasure of one from you last night of 15 of
+Ap., new stile, by another hand, I am resolved to lett no
+opportunity slip, hoping that some one of my letters may come
+to your hand. This is the eighth I have writ, and tho’ by your
+last you tell me you had not heard from me, I am hopful they
+are not all mis-carryed, but by your leaving Paris they are
+longer a-coming to your hand. It is no small satisfaction to
+me that you are well and at freedom, and the thoughts of it
+support me under every other difficulty. Tho’ I must own the
+common misfortune has been so greivous that I cannot express
+it, and then every particular person that I ever knew or heard
+of makes deep impression upon me, so that I was not capable of
+having a right thought. But after some time I found I could
+not live after that way, and made myself incapable to serve
+you. I resolv’d to imploy myself in doing in your affairs what
+was fit in the present juncture, and as the old saying is, indeavour
+to make the best of an ill bargain. But I have been
+many days without speaking, except when business obligt me
+to it.</p>
+
+<p>I told you in my last our friends att London are well, and
+we are not afraid of their lives being in danger. What will
+come of all the misfortunate people God knows, but many have
+foolishily given up themselves and Glengary among the rest,
+who is now at Perth. It’s talkt they are all to be tryed. I am
+still at home managing after the old manner but with many
+difficultys, being perfectly a stranger to your debts, and every
+frikish body arresting the rents, and one difficulty no sooner
+off but another occurs; but I doubt not to get over all these,
+and in time, which it’s probable I will have now, if the Parlyment
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_262">[262]</span>
+rise soon as it’s expected, without any more bills of
+attainder, to get this year’s rent. Your farms are plowed and
+the last of the Barley sow’d this day. I may ask you when
+you was so soon done. There has been no other work without
+doors for two months past, because upon many reasons it was
+inconvenient. I have planted trees here, and if things go
+tolerably easy I intend to plant both here and in the other
+place in the latter season. I tell you all this that you may not
+think I despair of your having peaceable possession of your
+own, tho’ I cannot yet see by what means. We hear of an
+interview of many crown’d heads, and some people think your
+pardon may be easily obtained by your Brother, the Dr., and
+his master’s means, but if ever you obtain it that way, your
+abode must be in another place. Ch. has some thoughts of
+going over to see his Brother, and wold appoint you to meet
+him if ye could do it with safety. I must own if it be practicable
+for your friends to obtain a pardon, you should accept of it,
+however cross it may be to your own inclination. Consider
+your children and me, and prevent the utter ruin of your family.
+And I daresay neither Kid nor Mill will think it wrong for you,
+since you cannot serve them in your present circumstances, to
+doe what is so material for your interest.</p>
+
+<p>Your boys have been very ill of the chincoch but are better.
+I hope they will get over it very soon.... I expect to see Ch.
+soon here. P. C. is at London, and your sister, Nell, is gone
+to the Bath. All your friends are well. The uncertainty of
+my letters coming to your hand makes me say less than I
+incline. Pray draw for money when you please, but it seems
+you are in no want, for you never mention it. Wishing you,
+my Life, all manner of happyness, I am in all sincerity</p>
+
+<p><i>May 4th.</i></p>
+<p class='right pr4'>Yours.</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER XII.</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>I received one from my Dearest Life of the 17 Ap. which
+was most acceptable. I am sorry you should be in such pain
+and uneasyness by your not hearing from me, and I should
+never forgive myself if I had occasioned it by my neglect, but
+I assure myself you will not think me capable of omitting anything
+than can contribute to your quiet. This is the tenth
+letter I have writ and all different hands, in hops some wold
+be so lucky (as) to come your length. I have had the pleasure
+of getting all yours, which I reckon no small mercy. I have
+told you in all my letters to be easy about me and your
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_263">[263]</span>
+children; wee have what is necessare for us, and I have good
+ground to think will always have; let things come to the
+worst we will have enough and what we ought to be content
+with, in so general a calamity. My greatest suffering is being
+absent from you; but when I think upon the danger and imprisonment
+of many others, some of (them) my good friends, I
+dare not complain. I must own your being at freedom and
+out of the hands of your enemies, has supported me under the
+many difficultys, and if you are well and easy in your mind, I
+shall endeavour to submit chearfully to whatever God in his
+providence shall order; and very often the fears of what may
+happen is greater than the suffering itself, as I doubt not is
+the case with the most part of the distrest people at this time.
+The delay and the uncertainty occasions the most dreadful
+apprehensions their fancy can suggest. Tho’ at other times I
+was too ready to put the dark side of the cloud to my view,
+yet I think it’s impossible things can long continue in so violent
+a way. I doe very much regret the suffering of Kid and your
+freind, and of all the rest in generall; but God in his wise
+providence has ordered it, and his visible hand in disappointing
+all our hops should make us wait his time with patience,
+and indeavour to make the best use of so great afflictions,
+which is most justly sent us as a punishment for our many
+faults and abuses of many mercys; and if this thought would
+make us live better lives, it’s very probable our time of suffering
+might be shortened.</p>
+
+<p>I am still at home managing after the old manner, have
+labour’d both your farms, and getting in rents, tho’ with great
+difficulty. There is nothing omitted that can be done for your
+interest, and I am very lucky in two freinds who do all for me
+that’s in their power.</p>
+
+<p>You are not yet attainted, and I hop will not be this session
+of Parlyment; but I am afraid if you continue in that place
+where you are now it will make them more violent, and tho’
+your being in another place will not be so agreeable to you,
+yet I persuade myself you will cross your own inclination
+since you can do your friends no service, and may ruin your
+family. I doe not let anybody know where you are because
+I have some hop, with the help of Dr. Robin, your brother,
+and his master, to get your pardon, that you may be allowed
+to come home and live quietly. I believe the first thoughts
+of this kind will be very disagreeable to you; but consider
+mee and your children and every particular circumstance, and
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_264">[264]</span>
+then I am sure you must be of my mind. This is the opinion
+of those friends that did not condemn your going out, and
+have your interest as much at heart as their own. I wold not
+wish you to doe a mean or dishonorable thing, and I am sure
+were it fit to be free with Kid and Mill in every particular
+they wold desire you to accept, if ever that pardon could be
+obtained by your freinds. Pray, write freely to me your
+opinion in this particular, for I have greater fears you will
+not accept than that itt will not be obtain’d, and if you are
+positive against itt I will never attempt itt. I heard from
+London you was gone a message to Spain, but they must
+always be talking.</p>
+
+<p>I am doeing no work without doors just now. All our
+plowing is over some weeks agoe, and our work is all laid
+aside except such as is in and about the House. I have
+planted trees this season, and design to plant them in the
+latter season.</p>
+
+<p>Your children are just such as you wold wish them, very
+good-humor’d. I am getting one to teach them. They have
+both the chincoch, but I hop the worst is over. My friend,
+Bess, has left me. Your mother is here just now; she is
+very concern’d about you, but has no such fears for the
+family as I have seen her have for a trifle.</p>
+
+<p>I cannot yet have any vein how or what way I am to doe;
+but if once things were settled, if you doe not get home, I will
+certainly come to you and bring my young folks with me,
+which will not doe so well as that I mention in the other side.
+In the meantime, hope the best, take good care of yourself,
+and let me hear frequently from you.</p>
+
+<p>I writ in all my letters to make your factor draw for money
+on his correspondent at Edinr. for your use. I hop I shall
+have to supply you what you have use for. As to your
+servants, they have all been here since you left the country,
+and Andrew came safe, so you need not be uneasy. As to
+your debts of all kinds, due care is taken that no body lose by
+you, and nobody can lose a grott. I wish everybody had
+the same mitigations of their sufferings that I have; but the
+hearing of the necessities of others, and not being in a
+condition to help them, touches me very sensibly, which
+makes me wish I could be far from hearing itt. Wishing
+you all manner of happyness, I am, my Dearest, in all
+sincerity,</p>
+
+<p class='right pr2'>Yours.</p>
+
+<p> May 14.</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_265">[265]</span></p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER XIII</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>I received yours of the 26th of Ap., which my Dearest Life
+may imagine was most acceptable to know you had once got
+some of my letters, and that you was easy in your mind upon
+that score, which you have all the reason in the world to be.
+You was much to blame that (you) did not mention money
+in any of your former letters, because if I had known the
+maner of sending money, you had got it long ere now.
+Having some money att London, I have ordered your Bill
+of 50 pounds that you have drawn to be pay’d there, and
+shall write to my freind there to remitt the other 50 after the
+best and cheapest manner. For all the money I could raise
+here out of your estate, and otherways by the help of friends,
+will not satisfy uneasy Debtors for annual rents and principal
+sums to prevent diligences being done, and itt is done in
+such maner that the money laid out that way will stand good
+upon the worst event that can happen. But if you will
+please to let me know what sum you incline to have soon, it
+shall be had as far as either your freinds or my credit can goe.
+In a little time we hop to have your affairs put in a clear
+way, which, so soon as it is done, you shall know, and shall
+be dispos’d of by your order, or as you think most proper.
+Ch. A(reskine) is here just now, and is thinking and laying
+out himself on every way that seems most for your interest;
+and it’s his opinion, and it seems to him the only way to
+make your affairs easy, to abstract yourself from your freinds
+for some time, by which means you may scape the fury and
+rage of the folks in present power; for you’ll not doubt but
+they have good intelligence who are with, or makes their
+abode with——. Nor is it impossible in a little time you
+may be at more freedom, with less harm to your family, not
+being yet attainted, which gives us a Breathing to put things
+in a better way. Your remaining at a certain place will no
+doubt hasten a sentence which will put us out of all capacity
+of medling with anything that belongs to you, but by indirect
+and not so successful methods. So as you regard your own
+interest and my quiet I expect your complyance in this
+matter; and if it were not absolute necessity, you may be
+assured I wold not ask you to cross your own inclination in
+anything, and much less in taking you from company that
+must be agreeable to you in a strange country.</p>
+
+<p>If you have got the rest of my letters you will know that Mr.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_266">[266]</span>
+Nabit does not imploy old W. or any of his profession at
+present, because it was likely to prove uneasy.... It is yet
+impossible to tell what money Mr. Nabit will be worth; his
+reputation among the common sort is so high that nobody
+credits it.... Your youngest boy is brought very low with the
+chincoch which fears me, but I hope with tender care ...
+he will get the better of it, for ye know I am easily alarm’d.
+Nothing shall be wanting, and I hope in God the children shall
+be preserved while they are under my care, and will give us
+all a happy meeting which is the thing in the world I most
+earnestly wish.... Your mother is here. She writ you some
+time agoe, and till she knows that is come to your hand she
+will not write again. I am pretty much imploy’d, which keeps
+me from thinking so much as my temper and present state
+does incline me ... I heard from London last Post. There
+can be no evidence got against our two friends that is in the
+Fleet, which is no small mercy. Bess is at home, but will
+return here. Be sure to write freely your mind as it comes in
+your head of anything you would have done, and you will
+always find those two friends I formerly mentioned and myself
+devoted to serve you in every respect.</p>
+
+<p class='right pr4'>I am, Dr. Life, in all sincerity</p>
+<p class='right pr8'>Yours.</p>
+<p>May 20.</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER XIV</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>It is three weeks now since I heard from my Dearest Life
+and I begin to be very impatient. I expect to hear from you
+every fortnight, and when I doe not I am apt to fancy you are
+either gone some message, or are not well, for all your friends
+in the Government has had you gone to Sweden; and if I had
+not heard from your self I should have been too ready to
+believe it. Your friend P. C. writ to me from London. He was
+not a little uneasy he had not heard from you, by which I
+reckon he has writ to you. I writ three posts ago to desire
+him to remit the other 50 pound I mentioned in my last, and
+did incline to send more, but as I told you at this term all had
+enough to doe. But I doubt not in a little time to have more
+money at London for the effects are gone from this, and it will
+be cheaper to send it from thence; and P. C. being to stay
+there for a long time, when you think fit write to him and he
+will be sure to answer you, for I doubt not he has let you
+know how to direct him.</p>
+
+<p>I have hitherto been pretty lucky in my little affairs, and in
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_267">[267]</span>
+a little time we will give you a good account of them, if they
+let me alone from Bills of Attainder. I wold be glad to know
+your opinion whether it’s proper for your Brother R. to cause
+his master interpose with the present powers now when they
+are to have an interview, or in what manner he should doe it;
+whether to ask a gift of your Life-Rent, and a little article put
+in to secure all to yourself, tho’ you did not come home for some
+time, for I fear you wold not incline; but whether you do or
+not you will live the better (if) your estate be secured. I am
+sure so far you will be of my mind, and if this Act of
+Parlyment pass and you be attainted, no body can be sure of
+anything; and it excluded the payment of all debts since the
+24 of June last, so that both for your own sake and others, if so
+fair an opportunity offer it should not be neglected, and if it
+be agreeable to you, and you signify your opinion to Charles,
+he will go over to Holland on purpose. This I have often
+heard him say. I have writ to you on this subject before, so,
+as soon as you can, let me have your opinion.</p>
+
+<p>Your nephew, James Haldane, is to be resident at that court
+where your Brother R. is so great. Your mother is still here,
+and tho’ we are of very different sentiments, we live in good
+friendship and easy. Your boys are now perfectly recovered,
+which is no small mercy to me, and if my Dearest is well and
+easy in his mind, I have more than I deserve. Our friends
+are still in the Fleet, and there can be no evidence got against
+them.</p>
+
+<p>I must confess when I walk abroad and remember all your
+different projects, and how pleased I have been to find you in
+some of these walks, I cannot help being uneasy till I think
+you are at liberty and well, and luckyer as to other circumstances
+than the most part of people, then I blame myself for
+unthankfulness. Your old freind Barafeild made his escape
+out of the Castle of Stirlin last week, which enrag’d the new
+Governor very much. I shall be obligt to see my father this
+week; but I cannot persuade myself to visit these great folks,
+tho’ it certainly is fit for me to keep in with all, and they
+profess great friendship for me and regret for your family, tho’
+none for yourself. I can at some times be a politician, so at
+present I think interest will prevail with me to keep in with
+all.... Be so kind to write frequently, for it’s impossible to
+express my anxiety about you. Dearest Life, I am ever</p>
+
+<p>June 4. 1716.</p>
+<p class='right pr2'>Yours.</p>
+<p>I am healthyer than you or anybody could expect.</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_268">[268]</span></p>
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXVIII">
+ CHAPTER XXVIII
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>
+ TELLS OF THE GOOD FORTUNE FOR BETTY, AND OF THE
+ EVIL DEEDS OF THE PARLIAMENT</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>Towards the end of May my lady, becoming alarmed at
+the weakness of her youngest son, determined, though
+somewhat against her inclination, to send him and his
+brother to their grandfather’s house for the benefit of the
+sea-air and the change. Not being at liberty just then to
+leave Alva, she arranged that the little boys should go in
+charge of myself and Phemie, knowing that every care
+would be taken of them, and that all love and attention
+would be shown them to make up to them for her absence.</p>
+
+<p>It was a great pleasure to me to revisit Dysart, where I
+had always met with such kindness; and little Charles,
+delighted as children are at the prospect of a change,
+skipped and shouted on his way to the carriage with no
+thought of regret at leaving his mother behind. When
+Phemie would have rebuked him for his seeming heartlessness,
+my lady merely smiled and bade her pay no heed.</p>
+
+<p>I found my dear Betty looking brighter and happier than
+I had seen her for many months, and though I could find
+no cause in my own knowledge to account for the change,
+I must confess I took great pleasure in the same.</p>
+
+<p>A light broke in upon my denseness, however, when I
+found that scarce a day passed without a visit from my
+Lord Wemyss, who on some pretext or other generally
+found opportunity to put himself in Betty’s way. Sometimes
+he came to bring her a flower grown in his garden,
+sometimes to consult with my lord on this subject or that,
+sometimes, I used to think, merely to tell us what a fine
+day it was; but, whatever the excuse, he made himself
+prodigiously agreeable when he came, and though Betty
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_269">[269]</span>
+never suffered me to move from her side during his visits,
+I noticed that while she still sharpened her wit against him
+in playful scorn, she treated him with more gentleness and
+kindness than I had ever seen her use before.</p>
+
+<p>The weather was now most beautiful, and as much as
+possible we spent the days out of doors. Charles from the
+first showed himself perfectly recovered from his ailment,
+and very soon little Hal showed signs of picking up
+strength; and from watching with languid interest from
+Phemie’s arms his brother’s gambols, began to desire to
+join in them, and from day to day made rapid progress
+towards complete recovery. ’Twas a great pleasure to be
+able to write the good news to Alva, and my lady promised
+shortly to come and see for herself the happy change that
+had taken place.</p>
+
+<p>One morning, as we sat idly on a bench in the narrow
+wood above the water and watched the children at play
+below us, our constant visitor joined us, and gave us a
+kindly good day. The pretty colour rose in Betty’s cheeks
+as she made room for him beside us, and my lord, who
+seemed as ever in a blithe and pleasant humour, made her
+a compliment on the return of her gay spirits and sprightly
+looks.</p>
+
+<p>“The winter is gone, Mistress Betty, with all its darkness
+and sadness, and you are blossoming again like the new
+summer flowers.”</p>
+
+<p>“The flowers that blossom now knew nothing of the
+winter,” sighed Betty, ever ready for an argument; “but
+we—can we ever forget?”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, yes!” cried my lord, “’tis the noble mind that
+rises above its disappointments, and sees in them only
+the working out of a wisely guided Destiny.”</p>
+
+<p>“Ah, my lord,” said Betty, “’tis easy for you to talk;
+but when the disappointment is our own, it is harder to
+soothe it with such bare philosophy.”</p>
+
+<p>For a moment he was silent, for he knew well of what
+she was thinking.</p>
+
+<p>“And did not I, too, suffer the loss of many hopes this
+last December?” he asked gently.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_270">[270]</span></p>
+
+<p>The tears sprang to Betty’s eyes as she turned to him
+with an impulse of sympathy.</p>
+
+<p>“Pray, my lord, forgive me! You know how I feel for
+you there. But it was to the other subject I thought you
+referred.”</p>
+
+<p>“I know, I know,” he answered, “but ’tis all one.
+Neither public nor private sorrows are we fitted to bear
+without recourse to ‘such bare philosophy’ as you call it,
+madam; but I prefer the name of Christian resignation.”</p>
+
+<p>Then, turning to me, he said in a lighter tone, “And
+when, Mistress Barbara, will it please you to honour my
+house with a visit? There is some ancient armour which,
+if you care for such things, would please you, and the
+Castle itself is not without historic interest.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, my lord,” cried I, greatly delighted with his
+suggestion, “I do assure you there is nothing I should
+more enjoy. Of all things I wish to see the room where
+Queen Mary first met my lord Darnley—the beginning of
+all her woes.”</p>
+
+<p>“And of many other people’s as well,” said Betty.
+“Who knows the difference it would have made to us all
+had the poor lady married some man more worthy of
+her?”</p>
+
+<p>My lord laughed.</p>
+
+<p>“She was a wilful woman, madam, and would have had
+her way in any case. But now, when will you bring
+Mistress Barbara to Wemyss? Will you both honour me
+by riding there to-morrow afternoon and drinking a dish of
+tea with me?”</p>
+
+<p>To this we readily assented, and after a little further talk
+my lord departed.</p>
+
+<p>“It seems, my dear Betty,” said I, when his footsteps
+had died away, “that you have forgiven his lordship.”</p>
+
+<p>She turned her face to me with a doubtful smile, “And
+does it seem to you, dear Barbara, that his lordship has
+forgiven me?”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, yes!” said I, laughing, “if you feel the need of
+forgiveness.”</p>
+
+<p>Nothing could exceed the kindness and courtesy of my
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_271">[271]</span>
+Lord Wemyss next day as he conducted us over his great
+house, showing everything that he thought would please us,
+from the dungeons where the unhappy prisoners once had
+languished, to the beautiful portrait of his first wife painted
+in miniature. Tea was served to us in the historic chamber
+which I had expressed the curiosity to see, and while we
+were drinking it, the Earl turned suddenly to me.</p>
+
+<p>“Do you not think it a pity, Mistress Barbara, that a
+house like this should be without a mistress?”</p>
+
+<p>“Indeed, my lord, I do,” I responded readily; “but I
+make no doubt your lordship could find one without much
+difficulty.”</p>
+
+<p>“Alas!” said he, but with a twinkle in his eye, “the
+only one I want sees fit to raise a barrier around herself,
+through which I find it very hard to make myself seen or
+heard.”</p>
+
+<p>“Can I not help to remove it, my lord?” said I
+mischievously, attempting to rise from the couch whereon
+we sat facing him; but to my dismay I found my dress
+clutched firmly by the hand of Betty, who was looking
+into her empty tea-cup as if to read her fortune there.</p>
+
+<p>“Can two live together except they be agreed?” she
+asked in a low voice.</p>
+
+<p>My lord leant forward in his chair and looked at her
+earnestly. He seemed in no way embarrassed by my
+presence, and seeing that Betty desired my support, I
+thought it best to remain where I was.</p>
+
+<p>“The cause of disagreement,” he said, “is gone. You
+accused me once of triumphing over your distress; that,
+my dear Betty, I could not do. I grieved with and for
+you in every fresh disappointment. But the whole affair
+was a blunder, and seeing that it was so, I set my face
+against it. My heart is not unloyal to that unfortunate
+prince, and were it only a personal matter I should certainly
+prefer James to George as a King; but of the Rising I
+could not approve, and in that it failed I recognise the
+hand of a wise Providence. These are the words of an
+honest man, madam. Have you aught to object to in
+them?”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_272">[272]</span></p>
+
+<p>Betty laid her cup and saucer on the table, and turned
+to look out of the window, so that I saw nothing but one
+rosy ear.</p>
+
+<p>“I shall always cherish the hope that he may return,”
+she said softly.</p>
+
+<p>“Be it so,” replied the Earl; “hope does no one any
+harm.”</p>
+
+<p>“I shall never pretend loyalty to the Hanoverian,” she
+cried, turning her face to us.</p>
+
+<p>“I have no doubt, madam, he will be able to live
+without it.”</p>
+
+<p>A smile curved her lips; his good humour was imperturbable.</p>
+
+<p>“You think me foolish, frivolous, fickle,” she sighed,
+“and easily led away.”</p>
+
+<p>“I think you loyal, and tender, and true!” he answered,
+“and what can a man want more?”</p>
+
+<p>With that he glanced at me, and seeing that my dress
+was now free I slipped away, and going through an open door
+and down a passage, found myself presently in the garden.
+Here I busied myself among the flowers till, some time
+later, hearing Betty’s voice I ran to meet her, and putting
+my arms about her whispered, “Was all well?”</p>
+
+<p>To this she replied, “He is to see my father to-morrow,”
+and my heart rejoiced, for the look in her eyes was one
+of peace.</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>It was indeed a matter for rejoicing to all Betty’s friends,
+for my Lord Wemyss was, as you know, a man of sense
+and honour, very agreeable, and still remarkably handsome.
+An express was despatched by my Lord Sinclair to Alva
+begging my lady’s attendance, as in all things he relied
+upon her judgment and valued her opinions; and I make
+no doubt that her wise advice was asked and taken in the
+important matter of settlements. That she was as much
+surprised as pleased at the news, I saw clearly, for so
+effectually had Betty hid her feelings even from this tender
+friend and sister, that my lady had had no hope of any
+alliance so satisfactory for the capricious young madam.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_273">[273]</span>
+Even now she was inclined to think it merely a matter of
+convenience and worldly policy on the part of a woman
+disappointed in her ambitions, and feeling at war with Fate.</p>
+
+<p>Arrangements were made for the signing of the settlements,
+and Mr. Erskine was summoned from Edinburgh
+to look after the lady’s interests. The wedding was to take
+place in less than three weeks, and the future Countess
+very graciously asked me to stand as one of her bridesmaids.</p>
+
+<p>“If only Sir John were here,” she cried, “and my poor
+brother, I should be perfectly happy.”</p>
+
+<p>“Were Sir John here,” said my lady smiling, “you
+would have to bear some teasing upon various subjects.
+He would ask you, Bess, what you meant to do with all
+your other swains—David Pitcairn for one.”</p>
+
+<p>“I would bear that gladly,” said Betty, “for the pleasure
+of his good company; but since he is sure to think my
+choice a piece of caprice, you may remind him that I love
+to be comfortable and lazy, and that at Wemyss there are
+plenty of easy-chairs to lounge in, so that I expect to
+live very well, whatever my friends may say.”</p>
+
+<p>Her sister looked at her kindly but gravely. Her idea
+of happiness did not consist in bodily comfort, and fond
+of Betty as she was, she sometimes had doubts of her
+sincerity.</p>
+
+<p>When the latter left the room, she sighed.</p>
+
+<p>“I trust my poor Bess has some stronger reason for
+expecting a happy life than that she gives us, Barbara.”</p>
+
+<p>“Dear madam,” I assured her, yet surprised that she
+should need the explanation, “she was but jesting. Betty
+is, believe me, as much in love with my Lord Wemyss as
+I am with my Anthony, and I think has been for long.
+’Twas the affair of the Rising that kept them apart, and
+since its failure she has been very sore; but at last her
+pride is broken down, and she allows herself to acknowledge
+the Earl’s goodness and patience.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, if that is the case,” cried my lady, “no one can
+be more heartily glad than I. Poor Betty has suffered
+cruelly in this sad year, and she deserves some happiness
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_274">[274]</span>
+as her reward for her faithful services to the King. I hope
+she will indeed be comfortable. But what, my dear
+Barbara, will become of the other David. ’Tis hard for
+him, and I know not what he will do.”</p>
+
+<p>Indeed this question had risen in my own mind often
+enough, and I had not been able to supply an answer, for
+David Pitcairn was one friend who could not be expected
+to rejoice at the prospect of Betty’s marriage. He came
+and went as usual, faithful, pleasant, and kind; and however
+much he suffered, he did not allow it to appear.</p>
+
+<p>Once, upon my lady offering him a word of sympathy,
+he threw up his head with a smile.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, madam,” he said, “it is kind of you to think of
+me, but my love for Mistress Betty was not founded on
+hope. Long ago I realised that this day must arrive for
+me, and I am only glad that she has chosen where she is
+likely to find happiness.”</p>
+
+<p>My lady regarded him with secret admiration.</p>
+
+<p>“You think she will be happy?”</p>
+
+<p>“I have no doubt of it, madam, since she loves her
+husband,” he replied.</p>
+
+<p>But brave and unselfish as this good man was, it was not
+to be expected he should waste his life in contemplating his
+lost mistress’s happiness with another, and much as she
+valued his friendship, this was the last thing Betty desired.
+Before the end of the year, David Pitcairn did what many
+another gallant man has done, carried his wounded heart
+to the wars, and endeavoured to fill his life with fresh
+interests and new ambitions. He got a Commission in the
+1st Royal Scots Regiment of Foot, of which my lady’s
+brother, James, was at this time Major, and in which in
+after years both Charles and little Hal became officers.
+He lived to see Betty’s grandson succeed his father as Earl
+of Sutherland at the age of fifteen, and died at London
+only four years ago, beloved and lamented by a large
+circle of friends. He never married.</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>It had not taken me many minutes upon my lady’s
+arrival at Dysart to perceive that something far removed from
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_275">[275]</span>
+Betty’s marriage was occupying her thoughts, and though
+for her sister’s sake she strove to be cheerful and put
+away her melancholy, it was impossible not to see that she
+was troubled in her mind. At last when the marriage
+contract had been drawn up, and all their plans talked over,
+she broke it to us that she was in much anxiety about her
+husband’s affairs. An Act of Parliament had been passed,
+which put it out of the King’s power to grant any portion
+of the forfeited estates to their unfortunate owners, so that
+should Sir John be attainted, a calamity that he had up
+till now very narrowly escaped, all their projects of private
+negotiations for his pardon must be abandoned. Besides
+this a Commission had been appointed to inquire into the
+particulars of every rebel family’s goods and chatels; to spy
+and probe their innermost affairs, with the power of citing
+anyone they pleased, whether closest friend or meanest
+servant, to appear and give information about the private
+property of each of these unfortunate gentlemen. All
+money got in this way, it was ordered, must go into the
+Treasury for the payment of the public debts; whereas anything
+owing to individuals by the owners of these same
+forfeited estates was to be ignored, and the poor people
+must suffer loss through no fault of their own, nor by the
+intention of their patrons.</p>
+
+<p>All this was a cause of great grief to poor Lady Erskine for
+many reasons. Not only was she keenly disappointed at the
+shattering of her hopes of buying her husband’s pardon,
+but she now lived in terror of the Commissioners discovering
+the value of the Silver Mine through some of those they
+examined, and this she felt would be the end of all. Then
+the thought of any having to suffer through her family was
+very bitter to her, and if she lost not only her estate but
+their secret source of wealth as well, how was this injustice
+to be avoided? Above all, her heart and soul were
+shaken by constant terrors for her husband’s safety. Placed
+as she was at a distance from him, and only too well aware
+of his light-hearted disregard of consequences, she longed
+to hear he was living anywhere away from the ill-fated King
+and his companions, believing this to be the first necessity
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_276">[276]</span>
+for his safety. The uncertainty whether he would consent
+to this measure preyed upon her mind day and night,
+and between her fear of their enemies and her reluctance
+to force him against his inclination, her burden seemed at
+times like to weigh her to the earth.</p>
+
+<p>“I still hope,” she said to me, “that Sir John may
+escape being attainted, seeing that up to the present his
+name has been kept out of the Bills; and I know that Mr.
+Haldane and his brother, and certainly Patrick Campbell
+as well, are working in every possible way to prevent it.
+But when these Commissioners arrive at Alva, and make
+enquiries of all and sundry about this person and that, think
+you that should a rumour of the garden” (for so we spoke
+of the mine) “come to their ears, and what is to hinder it,
+seeing it is at the mercy of so many needy people, they
+will not find in this an excuse for seizing Sir John’s possessions
+and adding them to the list of forfeitures? My heart
+is very heavy, Barbara, and at times I feel ready to sink
+under my fears.”</p>
+
+<p>I would have given much to be able to comfort her, but
+could say very little to restore her confidence. I left her
+alone to pour out her heart in a letter to her husband, for
+faint as this consolation was, it was still the dearest she
+possessed.</p>
+
+<p>The next day being the 12th of June we left Dysart for
+Alva, and before we returned for the wedding, a still greater
+calamity had overtaken our affairs, and our hearts were
+heavier than ever.</p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER XV</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p class="right pr2">
+ (Dysart.)
+</p>
+
+<p>I had the pleasure of hearing from my Dearest Life some
+days agoe, but it had been long by the way, which gave me
+some pain about you; and tho’ it was but three days writ after
+what I got last, it was three weeks longer a coming to my
+hand. I must own you are most kind and obliging in writing
+so frequently, and it is the only real satisfaction I have at
+present, for tho’ I endeavor all I can to make the best of my
+misfortune, yet at some times I am perfectly like to sink under
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_277">[277]</span>
+it; and the probability of so long and continued afflictions, and
+which is most uneasy to me to be absent from you without
+having any prospect of having it in my power to come to you,
+together with the concern I have for my friends in the Fleet,
+and many good people who are suffering; and I find the
+greatest favour that’s expected is banishment.</p>
+
+<p>As to your own particular you are not yet attainted, so I hop
+will scape this session of Parlyment, but if ever you are
+attainted all you could once call your own is irrecoverably lost.
+There is such acts of Parlyment passing as people cannot
+expect to save anything; nay, even old tailys are in danger,
+and yours the more (as) it is not registrate. The King can
+give no gift to any without any act of Parlyment, and
+all goes for the public Debts. And these persons that
+are on the Commission have ample power to doe what they
+please, and make such narrow inspection in the forfeit estates
+that they can call any person they please before them, and
+take their oaths about the particulars of every family, and if
+they doe not appear they can fine them of a considerable sum.</p>
+
+<p>I once expected your Brother R. and his master was to be
+at the Hague, but now it’s believed they are to be att Isla
+Chapel (Aix la Chapelle) but this act puts me out of any hop of
+a gift to him of your Liberent, and to (have) had a little clause
+put in favour of Mr. Nabit (the mine.) You see, my dear Soul,
+the present state of affairs, and that all our projects that way is
+gone. I am told by some you very narrowly missed being
+putt in the last Bill of Attainder, and it’s affirm’d that your not
+being put in was owing to P.(atrick) H.(aldane).</p>
+
+<p>If you still remain where you are att present it’s impossible
+you can scape being attainted as soon as the Parlyment sits
+down, whereas if you were in another place, some of your
+friends might prevent your being put in with a better countenance,
+and if you do not, I am convinced they will never
+attempt it. You see by all this that no other person can be
+interpos’d; that if Mr. Amond (Sir John) does not incline to
+comply to any conditions that would be propos’d, let him stay
+abroad and get his money remitted to him; and if either his
+Brother R. by his master’s friendship, or any other way, can be
+fal’n on to prevent his being attainted be done, until the term
+of years mentioned by the Parlyment be expired, which is from
+this present time till the year 1719.... I have not any hope
+now but by preventing your being attainted if possible, which
+can never doe if you persist in your resolution of staying where
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_278">[278]</span>
+you are. It’s my duty to let you know this and desire you
+may consider seriously what sad state you will bring your
+family to, and to beg you may not do what you may for ever
+repent. Some regard I think should be had to me and your
+children, tho’ for my own particular I had rather suffer
+hardships than desire you to do what is against your inclination;
+but as a mother I must have regard to them so far as to let
+you know my opinion, and if ye doe not follow it, I cannot help
+it, but shall endeavour to submit with patience.</p>
+
+<p>I am not a little sensible how far it’s uneasy to break off
+from so agreeable a society, and when perhaps duty and
+inclination both bind you; but in their present state I see not
+what any one man can doe, and the fewer sufferers the better.
+And every body will not have that hope or expectation you
+may have, but if your Brother Robin doe come to Isla Chapel,
+it would be a good pretext to visit him. This is sufficient on
+this head, and I shall be glad to have your opinion as frankly
+and resolutely as I have given my advice.... I came to
+my father’s some days agoe about a marriage which will not
+be disagreeable to you. Bess is to be C——ess of W——ms,
+which is a satisfaction to all her friends. The terms is this
+day agreed on, and tho’ they are not what I either could a
+wisht or expected, yet my father and other friends after making
+proposals of altering found it would not doe, and has gone into
+what his tutors for the time advised. She has not far to goe,
+and in case you should not understand she has a great many
+easy chairs in which she may loll. I goe home to-morrow
+and return here in a fortnight. You was very kindly
+remembered by your new friend and he regrates he has
+you not here at this time. You may be sure I am glad
+of the thing, but I am in such a continu’d Dump I did not
+incline to be at the wedding, but I cannot shun it. C. A. was
+here to be the Lady’s Lawyer.... Countess Bess salutes
+you kindly and wishes you were here, tho’ she shou’d bear all
+you could say now as to D. P. I see not what can become of
+him.... God help me, for I labour under many difficultys
+and many fears. I did not intend to let you know so much,
+but at some time it will come out.</p>
+
+<p>As to sending you money it’s agreed ... it’s cheapest from
+London, and I hope soon to have effects there to answer your
+demands. Write to P. C., who is there and will doe it. He
+writ to me he should remit the 50 pound I mentioned in my
+last, and pray write to him for what you have occasion, for he
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_279">[279]</span>
+will answer you whether the effects be come to his hands or
+not, but he cannot miss to have them soon.</p>
+
+<p>I see so many difficultys in sending A. S(hor)t that it cannot
+doe. I think I have answered all your questions in yours
+of the 22 of Ap. Wishing my Dearest all manner of happyness
+I am ever,</p>
+
+<p class="right pr2">
+ Yours.
+</p>
+
+<p>Your mother and sons are well. We drank Mr. Kid’s health
+yesterday and all his friends. God preserve you.</p>
+
+<p>June 11.</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Back at Alva we were forced to wait with what patience
+we possessed to see what would next befal, but a week later
+my lady wrote again to Sir John in much the same strain
+as her former letter, so that you can see nothing new had
+occurred so far. Having received one from him, dated
+29th of May, she was now to be deprived of the comfort of
+hearing anything of her husband for several weeks, which
+as you can imagine did not lessen her fears nor lighten her
+burden.</p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER XVI.</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p>
+ My Dearest Life,
+</p>
+
+<p class='letter-indent-plus'>Yours of the 29 of May was forwarded by
+our friend att London, which you may be sure was most
+welcome to me since there can be nothing so agreeable as to
+hear you are well, and at the same time to hear of two people
+whose welfare I am much interested in. I went airly abroad
+this morning to visit my labourers, and it was so hott I began
+to think how much more it must be so with you. I pray God
+you may agree with it.</p>
+
+<p>There is one advantage of being with Kid, that you will live
+mighty regular and get no ill examples. I wish from my heart
+all had the same thoughts of him you have, but I am not
+altogether without hope that will come and justice be done
+him; tho, as things have been of late I do not expect to see it.
+But who would a thought six months agoe Andrew wold lose
+his post of being Commander-in-Chief in this Country, and
+that Mr. Beggar wold have it. His Master has made him
+very bad returns for his fidelity, but I hop he shall use all his
+faithful servants after that manner.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_280">[280]</span></p>
+
+<p>I writ to you from my father’s house in relation to the Bill
+that’s passing on the forfeitures. My friend writes from
+London he thinks all personal Debts in danger. Some only
+thinks those since the 24 of June last. I must own it is so
+horrid I can scarce believe it, but if it is so it will ruin many,
+and to think that anybody will lose by you is really terribly
+uneasy, particularly C.(harles) A.(reskine). If it is so I shall
+do my endeavour to pay all so far as it can goe, and trust to
+Providence who has hitherto been bountyful to us, and I am
+sure you will agree with me. I was in hops things wold in
+time have a more favourable aspect, but it’s impossible human
+invention can contrive things worse than all the measures they
+have taken. I find by the Ladys att London getting their
+jointure and daughters provided, we may expect the same. If
+any here gets it, I make no doubt of it, for I happen to be much
+in the Whig’s favour. I know nothing I have done to merit it
+but being silent. In the meantime I live in peaceable
+possession of all, haveing Mr. Beggar’s protection, and by the
+advice of the above mentioned friend, by degrees I am to sell
+all my Stock and prepare for the worst. I must own it was
+what I was mighty unwilling to do, but I am now convinct it’s
+the best way by much.</p>
+
+<p>As to Mr. Nabit, I am sorry I have not writ so fully as you
+might understand. His fame was like to rise high, and at the
+same time there was never less ground for it. I make no doubt
+that going down would have turn’d to account in time, but that
+was a certain giving out of money ... it was thought by all
+the Counsell the saffest course, and the only way to make
+people think it was an idle project of Mr. Amond’s. How far
+it will be of use that way I know not, but so many poor Dogs
+has it at their mercy it will be wonderful if it do not break out.
+I am positive however it was right to give up. James Hamilton
+went away three months agoe, for he turn’d wrong in the head
+and would not stay.... I told you in my last of my sister
+Bess’ marriage, which is to be very soon, and I must goe to it.
+It’s to their neighbour W——ms. I hope she will be very
+happy, and I take it as a reward for her faithful service to Kid.
+He is really a good-humour’d man, but too much upon the easy
+lay. C. A. is to be at the weddin’. I showed him your letter
+in relation to A. S——t, about his coming but he did not
+think it proper to send him for the reasons you mentioned.</p>
+
+<p>As to my second Farm I still keep it, and am putting two
+lime-kilns just now on it. I ride there frequently. Perhaps
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_281">[281]</span>
+I may set up my habitation there and farm it myself, but I
+think if ever I leave this place I will not stay in Britain. Your
+children are well and in good heart. Ha is perfectly recover’d.
+Your mother is well, and she and I live easily together, tho’
+none can be of more different sentiments; but she disaproves all
+the violent measures, and is very concern’d for you and
+thankful you are well; but she knows not where you are, or
+she would be griev’d. I wish very often to be with you, my
+Dear Soul, but as long as I can doe your service here I will
+never have a thought of it; and I have saved more than any
+in my circumstances has done, and never fail to represent
+when I am injur’d, which makes me live easy, when many
+other good honest people are oppresst. My paper sinks so
+much I fear you will have difficulty to read it.... P.(atrick)
+H.(aldane) is one of the comishioners on the forfeitures.
+Buchan and Munroe of Faulds are the Scots. Wishing your
+good company and you all manner of real happiness, I am, my
+Dearest, ever Yours.</p>
+
+<p>As to remitting money, I told you before it’s easyest from
+London, and I lay it on my friend entirely who would doe that
+as well as I could wish and all things else, for he helps all in
+distress and it’s his aim to do good</p>
+
+<p class='right pr6'>
+ Dearest Life, Adieu.</p>
+<p>
+ June 18. Alva.
+</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_282">[282]</span></p>
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXIX">
+ CHAPTER XXIX
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>
+ THE CALAMITY FALLS; AND MY LADY ATTENDS HER SISTER’S
+ WEDDING IN VERY LOW SPIRITS</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>The sweet June days went slowly past, and we, occupied
+in various ways, rejoiced in the hot bright weather and
+the growing beauty of the country. The garden was fair
+with flowers, and all the wide domain lay fresh and well-ordered
+under a cloudless sky. To be sure the faint cool
+breezes of morning, laden with the scent of growing and
+blossoming things, the hot, still noons, the tranquil
+evenings and the clear, tender twilights, stirred in my heart
+a longing so great as to be almost pain, that the one
+without whom my life would for ever be incomplete, should
+enjoy their beauty with me; and looking into the face of
+my dear Lady Erskine in those days and noting the wistfulness
+in her eyes, I felt that she shared my unrest. For
+the summer days brought no fresh news from France for
+either of us, and it was hard to be cheerful, with that
+great impenetrable silence closing us in.</p>
+
+<p>“He will write to me for his birthday, be sure,” said
+my lady. “I have never known him fail to send a few
+lines on that day when it happens that we have been
+parted. Were I sure of his welfare and safety, I should
+be easy at not hearing from him; but though he is a kind
+and tender husband, Barbara, he is a man of great energy
+and almost reckless courage, and you know I have many
+dark dreams of the dangers into which he may be thrusting
+himself on behalf of the beloved Cause.”</p>
+
+<p>“It is the waiting that is so hard to bear, madam,” said
+I, sadly, “and the lack of news. To write to one who
+is far off and to receive no reply, is like knocking at a
+closed door behind which is nothing but a silence that
+terrifies the heart.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_283">[283]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Poor child!” said she, kindly, “you are young to
+suffer such pain. But do not forget that all our ways are
+ordered by a wise Providence, and if we bear our trials
+with patience, they will surely turn to blessings when the
+time of probation is past. I can see before me a long and
+happy life for my dear Barbara, who for all her courage
+and sweetness deserves an ample reward.”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, madam!” cried I, “you are too good to say so.
+I constantly remind myself how light is my trial compared
+with yours; but after all it does not comfort me much
+to know that my dearest friend is sadder than I.”</p>
+
+<p>“Truly,” she answered, “my burden must needs be the
+heavier, for the thought of the children’s loss is added to
+my own, were anything to happen to their father. And
+since I think there is no fear of death or dishonour for
+Anthony Fleming, a little further patience and brave
+hopefulness are all that are needed to support you, my
+dear. As for Sir John, God help us! for I know not
+what is to happen next.”</p>
+
+<p>It was truly with more pain for her than for myself that
+I saw each post arrive bringing no packet from France,
+and though Mr. Campbell wrote frequently, and gave my
+lady all the news that was going in London, the longed-for
+letter failed to arrive, and fear was added to anxiety.</p>
+
+<p>The morning of Sir John’s 41st birthday dawned as fair
+and as full of promise as all that had gone before. A few
+white clouds in the sky only made the blue more deep and
+perfect, a light breeze from the south blew across the fields
+between us and the river, the distant mountains were
+veiled in silver mist that by-and-bye the sun would
+disperse; it was impossible to feel wholly sad on such a
+summer day.</p>
+
+<p>We walked in the garden, the Dowager leaning on her
+daughter’s arm, the children running races and shouting
+in pure glee. I had plucked a large cabbage-leaf, and
+having gathered a number of the first ripe strawberries to
+fill it, I brought them to my lady for her approval.</p>
+
+<p>“Why,” she cried, “this is good luck! The first
+strawberries to be gathered on Sir John’s birthday, that
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_284">[284]</span>
+is what we have always desired. Come, children, and
+taste them; they are your Papa’s favourite fruit.”</p>
+
+<p>Seating themselves on a garden-bench the ladies proceeded
+to feed the children, who, nothing loth, devoured
+the luscious berries with smiles of pleasure.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh,” cried Charles, at last, “how I wish Sir John
+were here to taste them! Do you remember, mama, I
+used to think my papa would be home before the trees
+were green, and now the roses are here, and the strawberries
+are ripe. Oh, why doesn’t the King send him
+back?”</p>
+
+<p>“Courage, my grandson,” said the old lady, cheerfully,
+“let us hope he will be here at the time of the Barley
+Harvest.”</p>
+
+<p>“Or before the leaves are off the trees,” cried I.</p>
+
+<p>“Or at least before the snow comes,” sighed my lady.</p>
+
+<p>“Then he will be here for <i>my</i> birthday!” cried little
+Hal triumphantly, his beautiful eyes alight with joy; and
+his mother kissed the eager face uplifted to her, and
+murmured, “God grant it!”</p>
+
+<p>At that moment we heard the distant sound of a horse
+galloping towards the house, and instantly our interest
+quickened, for the pace spoke of haste, and in those days
+haste meant news of importance.</p>
+
+<p>“’Tis an express!” cried I, with a wild but foolish hope
+that it brought tidings of my lover.</p>
+
+<p>“’Tis a letter from Sir John!” cried my lady. “He
+has remembered—he must have directed Patrick Campbell
+to express it from London being anxious I should receive
+it this day.”</p>
+
+<p>Her colour rose and her eyes sparkled. She went
+hurriedly from us to secure the precious missive without
+delay, looking back over her shoulder with a joyous smile!
+Alas! it was many weeks before I saw her look so happy
+again.</p>
+
+<p>“God bless her, and grant the news be good!” said the
+dowager, as she took my arm and followed slowly. “My
+son’s wife is indeed a lovable woman, Barbara.”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, madam,” cried I, “there is not a thought in her
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_285">[285]</span>
+heart that is not good and sweet. How glad I am the
+letter has come to-day!”</p>
+
+<p>Before ten minutes were passed, I retracted my eager
+words, for by that time my dear lady, and with her the
+whole household, were plunged in the most distracting grief.</p>
+
+<p>Having followed her to the house we arrived in time to
+see her standing in the hall, eagerly tearing open the letter
+which had just been put into her hand, the little boys
+clinging to her skirts, and waiting for the tit-bits of news
+she often doled out to them from their father’s letters.</p>
+
+<p>As we entered she gave a loud cry, and crushing the
+letter in her hand, she raised her face and gazed at us for
+an instant with a look so wild and terrified that it made my
+heart stand still. The next moment she turned and went
+into the parlour, where we found her seated by her scrutoire,
+looking the picture of despair.</p>
+
+<p>Sick with anxiety I dropped the old lady’s arm and ran
+to embrace her, begging her in the tenderest way to let us
+know the cause of her misery. Old Lady Alva, though
+trembling in every limb, carefully shut the door, and
+managed to reach a seat near her daughter-in-law, into
+which she sank, pale and breathless.</p>
+
+<p>With her usual thought for others, my lady, seeing how
+much she was moved, put out a shaking hand towards her
+and said, though her lips were white and stiff, “Sir John is
+safe, madam, so far as I know. This letter is not from
+France.”</p>
+
+<p>“Can you let us know the cause of your agitation, my
+daughter?” said the old lady, gently. “Thank God
+my son is not concerned! But if you are at liberty to
+divulge the tidings you have received I shall be further
+gratified.”</p>
+
+<p>“Indeed, madam,” sighed my lady, “I see no reason
+why they should be kept secret. They are, alas! but too
+widely known. Oh, woe is me! that I should have been
+so grossly deceived by that villain. Ah, Barbara, would
+that we had never trusted him!”</p>
+
+<p>“Whom do you mean, cousin?” cried I, still too
+frighted to think clearly. “Who has betrayed us?”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_286">[286]</span></p>
+
+<p>“Who, but that base wretch, James Hamilton, whom I
+trusted with all the knowledge and information about the
+Mine that I had myself. Did I not make him overseer in
+my latest transactions, and did he not know I was trusting
+him with the most precious things in life—my husband’s
+safety and honour? Oh, that such baseness should exist,
+and in a man, too, with good blood in his veins!”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, what hath he done?” cried I trembling.</p>
+
+<p>“Listen, my dear, and you shall hear,” said my lady,
+taking up the letter in her lap, and smoothing it out. “‘I
+am bound to tell you some news,’ says Mr. Campbell,
+‘which I know will greatly disturb you, and which in an
+unexpected way bids fair to upset our plans. You will be
+surprised to hear that there is lately come from Scotland,
+one, James Hamilton, who, though I have not yet seen him,
+I take to be the same who was lately employed by Sir John
+in his <i>garden</i>. This fellow, through cupidity, or desire of
+fame, I imagine, though I take it he is acting a very
+treacherous part, brought with him to London some
+specimens of ore; and having made inquiries as to the best
+method of proceeding, and fearing I presume to employ his
+friends in such a matter, went straight to my Lord Mayor,
+and there made an affidavit of what he knew about the
+Mine. I am credibly informed that he made no secret of
+anything. He spoke frankly of his position at Alva, saying
+that he was at first employed only in smelting the ore, but
+he saw it brought up from the mine in great abundance,
+and he believes there are still several rich veins unexplored.
+He further said that after Sir John went out in the
+Rebellion, he was employed by his lady in digging out as
+much ore as possible, stowing it in old barrels, etc., and
+burying it within the grounds of the house—the very spot
+is located. In fact there is nothing wanting in his tale,
+and the reason he gives for this disclosure is, forsooth, that
+he knew it must come out when the Commissioners came
+down to Alva, and he believed it right that His Majesty’s
+Ministers should have previous knowledge, and be able to
+deal with so important a business as it deserves. You will
+see now that all our plans have been knocked on the head,
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_287">[287]</span>
+and other strings must be pulled in order to work the affair
+in a suitable manner. I beg of you not to let yourself be
+too downcast, for I do not yet despond of arranging some
+settlement, which, with Sir John’s consent must work to his
+and your advantage. I have written to him and trust he
+will be brought to see the matter in the same light as myself.
+In the meantime, you, my dear lady, will, I know,
+have many qualms of doubt, but of one thing you may be
+certain, that both I and all your friends will do our best to
+extricate our good Sir John from the difficulties into which,
+through no fault of his own, nor of yours, he has fallen.’”</p>
+
+<p>My lady dropped the letter, and for some minutes we sat
+staring at each other in blank dismay. A thought struck
+me sharply.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, cousin,” I cried, “I believe I am to blame in not
+telling you of Mr. Hamilton’s threats that day before he
+left, but they seemed to me so idle I thought them not
+worth repeating. Perhaps—oh, perhaps if you had known
+them, you might have foreseen this calamity.”</p>
+
+<p>“Tell us now, child, what he said,” exclaimed the
+dowager.</p>
+
+<p>“Why, madam, his words were wild. He asked me
+very abruptly to be his wife, and upon my informing him
+that such a thing was impossible, he spoke in a violent way:
+said I would regret it for ever if I did not give my consent.
+More was depending upon it than I thought, but not so
+much on my own account as for the sake of the friends I
+loved. Oh, madam, do you think he would have
+abandoned his wicked scheme had I accepted him?”</p>
+
+<p>My lady was thinking deeply.</p>
+
+<p>“’Tis just possible,” she replied, “if, as I take it, he was
+actuated by a desire for gain. Had he been sure of you
+and your fortune, Barbara, he might have foregone his
+wicked betrayal of us.”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh!” cried I, the tears pouring down, “would to God
+I could have given him my fortune, if it would have saved
+him from this terrible crime. But how could anyone
+foresee such villainy, or dream of such an end as this?”</p>
+
+<p>For a time I wept, unrestrained, fearing that in her heart
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_288">[288]</span>
+my dear lady was blaming me for helping to bring about
+this disaster, but after a few minutes she bade me kindly to
+dry my tears.</p>
+
+<p>“Comfort yourself, my dear girl,” she said, “I do not
+believe you are so much to blame as you think. James
+Hamilton must have nursed his deceit for many months,
+and worked well in secret to carry out his wicked scheme.
+His frenzy about you three months ago was, I feel sure,
+worked up to give him the excuse he desired of leaving
+Alva; for once Satan had entered his heart to make him
+play the part of Judas, no influence could have softened
+him, no love restrained him. Alas! alas! to think how
+Sir John trusted him, and now he is ready to betray his
+master, as the other Judas did, for paltry silver.”</p>
+
+<p>And with that the full tide of her fear and anguish
+swelled in her heart, and she bowed her head upon her
+hands and wept.</p>
+
+<p>Over this terrible event we talked long and earnestly, but
+little satisfaction could be gained. The future was all
+uncertain, for what the Parliament would decide to do was
+still unknown, and though we suggested to each other
+various ways out of the difficulty, not one seemed wholly
+satisfactory. As we were due at Dysart that week for the
+wedding, my lady looked forward to meeting Mr. Erskine
+and taking his counsel on the matter. But I must own
+that the gaiety of the occasion, which ought to have been
+without stint, was greatly dimmed by the heavy anxiety we
+carried about in our breasts. Try as we would to be light-hearted
+and careless, “Mr. Nabit’s affair,” as my lady calls
+it, was the uppermost thought in our minds, and the
+treachery of Hamilton cast a cloud over all our pleasure.</p>
+
+<p>My lady, being much occupied, sent me with the
+children and Phemie to Dysart a couple of days in advance,
+she herself arriving with Aunt Betty on the very morning
+of the wedding-day. My dear Betty made a beautiful and
+happy bride, and my Lord Wemyss with his handsome
+person and pleasant manners won great favour from all her
+friends.</p>
+
+<p>I was somewhat surprised to see David Pitcairn among
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_289">[289]</span>
+the guests (his Reverend uncle performing the ceremony),
+his grave courtesy as genuine as ever, his kind eyes following
+Betty just as of yore. I think he had steeled himself to
+this last encounter as a kind of sacrificial farewell, for the
+very next day he left Dysart, and though he returned there
+from time to time, I, for one, never saw him again.</p>
+
+<p>A few days after the wedding the Earl and Countess
+invited us all to Wemyss, where we spent a week very
+happily, for it was impossible not to be affected by
+company so merry and good-humoured. On the night
+before we left we were sitting at supper, the servants having
+left the room, and stories were told and toasts drunk with
+much gaiety, for as it was but a family party there was little
+reserve required.</p>
+
+<p>My lord stood up with a full glass, and gave “The King!”</p>
+
+<p>The young Countess rose to her feet, her face flushed,
+her eyes sparkling. There was a crystal water-jug before
+her on the table, and with a graceful movement she passed
+her glass above it.</p>
+
+<p>“Ay, the King!” she cried, “with all my heart—God
+bless him!”</p>
+
+<p>With a little laugh my lady followed her example, and I,
+nothing loth, did likewise. The Earl looked amused but
+disapproving.</p>
+
+<p>“What, ladies, treason at my table? Tut, tut, this will
+never do.”</p>
+
+<p>“My lord,” said Betty, smiling at him very sweetly, “in the
+brightest moment of our hopes last year, I would not drink
+confusion to the King’s enemies because you, my lord,
+were one of them. You would not have me less loyal now
+to the unfortunate Prince over the water, who is far from
+being the enemy of any of us?”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, Betty,” replied my lord, “as to that you must
+please yourself. I wish the poor man no ill, so ’tis no harm
+to drink his very good health. But you must forgive me,
+madam, if I say I cannot but rejoice at his failure, for had
+he succeeded in his design, your adorable head would
+have been so turned that you would never have looked my
+way again.”</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_290">[290]</span></p>
+
+<p>And then in quieter tones he gave the toast of “Absent
+Friends,” and smiles died away and the light laughter was
+hushed, for there was not a soul in the room that night that
+was not yearning over loved ones far away.</p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER XVII</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p class='right pr2'>
+ (Wemyss.)</p>
+<p>
+ <span class="smcap">My Dearest Life</span>,
+</p>
+
+<p class='letter-indent-plus'>I delay’d writing in hops to have heard from
+you, butt it is more than a month since I had that pleasure,
+and it was just when you was 41, so you may judge what a
+pain it is to me. Now that our London friend can convey
+our letters, it surprises me there is none. I pray God you may
+be well.</p>
+
+<p>I had a letter from our friend at London, and he tells me
+he has writ to you of the discovery James H. has made of
+Mr. Nabit’s affair. It has griev’d me very much, and it is no
+small satisfaction that it has not failed by any neglect of
+mine, but he certainly designed to commit the villainy and
+went away with that veiu, for nothing I could do could make
+him stay. God in his wise providence has order’d it, and I
+must submit, but it is a great tryal. I have done already what
+was fit to do upon such ane exigence, and my friend will doe
+all in his power at London, but what will be the end of it God
+knows! I am not altogether without hope, tho’ I must own my
+grounds are but small. I dare not write so plainly to you of
+it as I incline, lest it should mis-carry and doe ane injury on
+that particular, but I think it a lucky providence it went off,
+and I hope it shall never come on till it do it (with) the right
+owner. God in wise providence thinks fit to try us many
+different ways. I pray God make us both have the right use
+of them, and seeing the vanity and emptiness of all things in
+this world, we may seek what is more lasting and durable.</p>
+
+<p>Bess was married Wednesday last, and after I had order’d
+my unlucky affair the best I could, I came to my father’s that
+morning. Now I am at her own house, where I could have
+been merry and blithe, but now melancholy prevails so much
+that I cannot express it. And yet I cannot help thinking this
+cannot last; but at another time I am ready to despair, and
+my being absent from you without any prospect of meeting is
+the bitterest part of all. But I ought to be resigned in that and
+every other particular, and wait the Lord’s time with patience.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_291">[291]</span></p>
+
+<p>Your boys are well and my health is better now than it used
+to be, tho’ my toyl has been great and my mind much
+disturbed. The earl and his wife salutes you and wishes
+often for you here, and remembers with great respect your
+good company.</p>
+
+<p>I cannot frame a notion now but everything will be unlucky,
+but that is a fault. Aunt Betty is here and is in great concern
+for all that may affect you. Hope the best and trust in God,
+for what he sends is certainly best for us. Dearest Life, let
+me hear from you, and endeavor to make your misfortuns as
+easy as possible. I can say no more just now but that I hope
+the person who comes shall never see far in Mr. Nabit, but
+you shall know. Write to our friend at London when you want
+money, for that is the only way I can supply you. Melancholy
+increases when I either write or speak on this subject, so I’ll
+end. Wishing you all patient submission and intire trust in
+God, who is able and ready to help us if we be not wanting to
+ourselves. May (He) ever preserve you and send you His
+blessing is the earnest wish of her who is ever</p>
+
+<p class="right pr2">
+ Yours.
+</p>
+
+<p>July 8.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_292">[292]</span></p>
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXX">
+ CHAPTER XXX
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>
+ THE AFFAIR OF THE MINE IN THE MOUNTAIN IS MUCH
+ DISCUSSED AT LONDON, BUT WITH NO COMFORTING
+ RESULTS</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>I have now to tell you of a period of great heaviness and
+anxiety to all those concerned in Sir John’s affairs.
+Many a time in after days have I heard my dear lady say,
+that these three months which followed our return from
+Dysart were the longest and darkest of all that weary year.</p>
+
+<p>The danger of my kind guardian’s ruin now seemed
+tenfold more imminent, for public attention having been
+brought to bear upon his affairs and himself placed in a
+position too prominent to be secure, it was impossible to
+know what would next befall. At first we at Alva scarcely
+realised how much was being made of the affair at London,
+but as the days went on, bringing my lady many letters
+from Mr. Campbell describing the development of events,
+it was soon made clear that the matter was considered a
+very serious one indeed. Mr. Charles Erskine was much
+with us, and many a long and serious talk my lady had
+with him. Sir Harry Stirling of Ardoch, who was also in
+her confidence, frequently added his counsel to these
+discussions, and being a sensible and energetic man,
+greatly in favour with Sir John, his presence gave my lady
+courage, and helped a little to ease her burden.</p>
+
+<p>The story of the “Silver Mine in the Mountain,” as it
+was called, had excited a huge interest among the
+authorities, for you may be sure that not only were the
+reports of its wealth exaggerated, but it was seriously
+affirmed that the whole range of the Ochils was teeming
+with precious metals, and it only needed a skilled engineer
+of mines to discover the treasure. As, by an old Scots
+Act of 1592, a tenth part of all ore found in Scotland
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_293">[293]</span>
+belonged by right to the Crown, there was some reason in
+the eagerness of the Government to learn the truth of the
+matter, and the affair was mentioned in the House of
+Commons, discussed in the Cabinet, and indeed brought
+before King George himself by my Lord Townshend, the
+Secretary of State.</p>
+
+<p>The King, who had had some knowledge of mining in his
+native country, where silver was found to some extent, was
+monstrously interested in the news, and demanded that my
+Lord Townshend should bring him an exact report, first of
+the value of the ore, and secondly of the extent and richness
+of the veins yet to be worked. The ore having been
+submitted to Sir Isaac Newton, the Master of the Mint, he
+sent in a report to my lord, which though satisfactory in
+its way, only served to inflame their greedy desires, for Sir
+Isaac affirmed that “the ore was exceeding rich, a pound
+weight avoirdupois holding 4/2 in silver;” moreover he
+added that the silver was of the purest quality, holding
+neither gold nor copper.</p>
+
+<p>As to a knowledge of the mines themselves, my Lord
+Townshend informed the King that he had no means of
+gaining this without sending someone into Scotland to
+examine the locality, and as Sir John was not yet attainted,
+and the property still in the hands of his lady, that, said my
+lord, would be a doubtful proceeding. Upon this his
+Majesty asked if there were no other way of getting the
+information, whereupon it was proposed to send for Mr.
+Haldane of Gleneagles, who, being connected with Sir
+John’s family, and at the same time much in favour at
+Court, would be a likely person to supply them with what
+they needed.</p>
+
+<p>The result of this combination was that one morning my
+lady received an express from Mr. Haldane, which, when
+she had perused it, threw her into the utmost consternation.
+Indeed her rage and grief were like to make a breach
+between them for good, for he wrote to her in a way which,
+instead of furthering his ends, helped to frustrate them
+altogether. I am willing to believe that this gentleman
+meant nothing but kindness to Sir John, and was indeed
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_294">[294]</span>
+rather proud of his part in the affair, thinking he was
+serving the family in the best manner possible; but he and
+my lady did not see the thing in the same light. He told
+her that the King had graciously commanded him to write
+to her instead of sending down officers to ask her questions;
+that it was therefore absolutely necessary she should inform
+him of all particulars connected with the mine, its probable
+extent, what they had got out of it, and particularly what
+knowledge she had of any acts connected with its
+possession, with which Sir John may have acquainted her.
+His Majesty, he said, was inclined to clemency, and were
+her reports satisfactory he had promised to sign a pardon
+permitting Sir John to return to Scotland and resume
+occupation of his estates, provided the mines were worked
+openly, and a proper share of the precious metal confirmed
+to the Crown. This Mr. Haldane considered a fair and
+merciful concession, and he advised my lady to keep
+nothing back but to rely on his Majesty’s generosity; for
+if she failed to comply with his demands in every particular,
+the King would cause Sir John’s name to be put in the
+next bill of attainder, and my lady and her family would be
+treated with the height of rigour.</p>
+
+<p>Now you can well understand that to a person of my
+lady’s spirit such a letter would but act as an incentive to
+defiance. I can remember to this day how proudly she
+drew herself up, her eyes flashing and the ready colour
+rising to her cheek.</p>
+
+<p>“Is it to be imagined,” she cried, “that I shall comply
+with such a demand as that? If Sir John is not yet
+attainted he is a free man, and an honest gentleman, with
+full right to do what he will with his own. No creature on
+earth, be he King or Prime Minister, has any title to call
+him to account for any part of his possessions; no, nor any
+right to peer and pry into his affairs. Let them send their
+officers, vile wretches, to make enquiries, I care not, but ’tis
+little they will get out of me! Comply, indeed! As soon
+would I give up my house to the first comer and beg my
+bread, with a child in each hand, from door to door!”</p>
+
+<p>“What will you tell him?” I asked.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_295">[295]</span></p>
+
+<p>“I shall tell him, Barbara, nothing but the truth, you
+may be sure of that. But it will not be all the truth,” she
+added, with a laugh that betrayed her bitterness. “Do
+they deserve open dealings from me? Is it not a fine thing
+to write to a woman behind her husband’s back, ordering
+her to betray his interests without a word to or from himself?
+Oh, I shall never forgive Gleneagles for this! I
+could not have believed him capable of such treachery. I
+am certain his good wife, my sister Nell, can know nothing
+of it; but how can I ever be friendly again with her spouse?”</p>
+
+<p>“Will you consult Mr. Erskine,” I said, “before you
+write?”</p>
+
+<p>My lady remained for some time gazing thoughtfully on
+the ground.</p>
+
+<p>“I think,” she said at length, “it will be wiser to write
+at once having consulted no one. Who knows what
+dangers lurk for those who befriend us as well as for ourselves?
+If Charles were here, or Harry Stirling, I would
+talk the matter over with them, but I cannot conceive that
+anything they might say would alter my mind, and if the
+King is angry it were better not to involve my friends.”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, dear madam,” cried I, in childish fear. “You
+will not say aught to anger the King?”</p>
+
+<p>“Why, Barbara, as to that we must take our chance, but
+I fear my reply will scarce appear conciliatory to him and
+his friends. I shall say that ’tis true Sir John has found
+silver on his estate (that fact can no longer be concealed),
+but to no great amount; indeed the vein he was
+working hath already given out, and I am in doubt
+whether any more will be found. I shall say that I can
+give him no information of any kind, that I know nothing
+of acts or treaties, but that I should esteem it a truly
+unfriendly action if any were sent down here to investigate
+matters in the absence of Sir John. I will remind him
+that my husband is not yet attainted, and in the meantime
+I have full control of all his property and estates, so that
+no steps can be taken without my consent.”</p>
+
+<p>Some such reply as this was forthwith written and
+despatched that day, my lady still burning with indignation
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_296">[296]</span>
+and full of wrath. But I think she repented her
+haste and heat—though not her decision—when, a few
+days later, she heard from Mr. Campbell. Her letter,
+he told her, had greatly enraged the others, and Mr.
+Haldane, acting always in the King’s interest, agreed with
+my Lord Townshend that nothing now remained but to
+make out the order of inquiry and send a Commission from
+the Government to Scotland without delay. To ease my
+lady’s mind on this score, Mr. Campbell assured her
+that he had in his mind something which would delay
+this scheme, hoping, indeed, to prevent it altogether.</p>
+
+<p>Sick at heart as my lady was, and torn with fears of all
+kinds, she yet believed so strongly in Mr. Campbell’s
+good sense and kindness that his promises comforted her
+not a little, and enabled her to bear with some semblance
+of patience the uncertainty and delay of the next few
+weeks. Mr. Erskine, as I said, came frequently from
+Edinburgh to see her, and nothing could exceed his
+kindness and diligence on her behalf.</p>
+
+<p>She was now busily employed in removing from their
+hiding-place near the house the barrels and casks of ore,
+and bestowing them safely in a spot, of which none but
+herself, and Mr. Erskine, and the men employed had any
+knowledge. As the strictest secrecy was to be preserved,
+the work was done during the night, and great ingenuity
+must have been used, for not a creature ever discovered
+nor attempted to divulge the matter.</p>
+
+<p>On our asking what means Mr. Campbell was employing
+to delay the sending of the Commission, Mr. Erskine told
+us that by the advice of Sir David Dalrymple, the Lord
+Advocate, he had brought to their notice the old Scots
+law which enacted that minerals found on any man’s
+estate were not to be included in confiscated property;
+so that, even supposing Sir John were attainted, the
+Government would have no more interest in his mines
+than a small share in the profits. This consideration
+made them pause, for they were determined to get the
+most out of it that they could, and yet were reluctant
+about ignoring the law in a way that would probably
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_297">[297]</span>
+enrage all Scotland. However, the delay was precious
+to our interests, and when one day Mr. Erskine informed
+my lady that he had decided to go to Holland next month
+to meet with his brother, Dr. Erskine, and learn what
+could be done for Sir John by the influence of the Czar, her
+heart was greatly lightened and hope again asserted itself.</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Erskine was to go first to his country house, Tinwald,
+in Dumfriesshire, and from there to London, that he might
+consult with Mr. Campbell before setting out for the Hague.
+As it turned out, this step was the best he could have taken,
+for, as you will see later, he also was instrumental in delaying
+the Commission, although, owing to the zealousness of
+Mr. Haldane, and some others, to serve the King, it was
+found impossible to dispose of it altogether.</p>
+
+<p>Not having had any word of Sir John for nigh two
+months, my lady was getting very downcast as to what
+had become of him, and her fears were not lessened by
+reading in the papers that my Lord Duffus had been
+arrested at Hamburg, and was now in prison. Thoughts
+of her husband’s danger haunted her night and day, and
+we were all greatly relieved when one evening towards the
+end of July two letters reached her from Sir John, which set
+her immediate fears to rest. More than anything else was
+she thankful to hear that her husband was no longer in the
+company of the exiled King, though if she could have
+known the business he was then employed in, I warrant she
+would have thought she had room enough for fears.</p>
+
+<p>In her reply to those letters you will see that her method
+of expressing herself is more cautious than usual, for she
+takes the name of <i>Mrs. Amond</i> for herself and <i>Mr. Ashton</i>
+for Sir John, while Mr. Campbell is <i>Duncan</i>, Mr. Erskine,
+<i>Key</i>, and Mr. Haldane, <i>Humphray</i>.</p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER XVIII</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p class='right pr1'>
+ July 29.</p>
+<p>
+ Dearest Creature,
+</p>
+
+<p class='letter-indent-plus'>It’s impossible to express the trouble and
+uneasyness Mrs. Amond has been in since the last misfortune,
+which you know of long ere now both from Duncan and her;
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_298">[298]</span>
+and to add to her trouble she had not heard from Mr. Ashton
+for two months, for yours of the 3 and another of the 12 of
+July only came to her hand last night. I can assure you,
+both were most acceptable and gave her that quiet of mind
+which she had not felt of a long time. Duncan told me in
+his last letter he was to writ to you, and he will inform you
+better of that unlucky affair and how it now stands than I
+can doe. But he has acted a winderful part, and has been so
+far successful to delay it till Mr. Ashton be on a surer footing....
+Who knows but it may turn to Mr. Ashton’s advantage,
+and in the meantime I hop you will soon get a good account
+of all ... which, if rightly managed, will be of use. Key
+and Mrs. Amond has both been in pain how to manage
+everything that could occasion the appearing of what they
+were earnest to hide as long as Humphray had anything
+to do in the country. At such a time it’s impossible to think
+all will succeed as we wold have it; but with Duncan’s
+diligence we got more time for all than could have been
+expected, and if it had not been for Duncan, Mr. Ashton
+wold a been undone by one who has the same relation to
+Mr. Ashton that Duncan has, but he acted the contrary
+part and pusht Mr. Ashton’s ruin, and said it was to serve
+him and his family. How will Mrs. Amond live with that
+man that has used her best friend so ill? To be just to his
+wife, she thought it really was as he said; but his actings
+in that particular has made him odious, and yet I intend to
+be in good friendship with him, more for his ill than his good.</p>
+
+<p>Key goes to his Country-house this week and intends to
+go from thence to the Carse (Holland) by way of Airth
+(London) that he may talk with Duncan, and then go and
+find Peter (Dr. Erskine) by whose help only we are to expect
+something done. Mr. Ashton is doubtful if it will doe. No
+body can say it will or it will not, but as things now are, it
+seems absolutely necessare to try; and had Mr. Ashton been
+attainted and the misfortun to follow, there could a been no
+retrieving; and if Peter doe not secure it before Humphray
+return, we will be in a very hard state. But there has been
+so many different turns of providence in that affair, Mrs.
+Amond has hopes yet, tho’ when she reflects how many
+difficulties (there are) and perhaps that of Mr. Ashton’s not
+being willing to agree to terms that may be askt, she fears
+the worst. But her greatest concern is for Mr. Ashton, and
+she begs if you do come to the Carse to meet Key or Peter
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_299">[299]</span>
+that you may take care not to come where you may be in
+danger, because the Prints bears that Lord D.(uffus) was
+taken at Hamburg, and she had rather all want to Pot before
+Mr. Ashton’s person were in the least danger. It certainly
+was a right measure for Key to go and see Peter, and the
+more that a near friend was sent to Peter’s master with a view
+to prepossess Peter with an ill opinion of Ashton, Key, Duncan
+and all the rest, that so they might play their own game; and
+when they hear of Key’s going it will put that family (the
+Haldanes) mad. Certain it is Humphray has made Peter great
+offers if he will get his master to agree to what he desires.</p>
+
+<p>I doubt not Duncan will supply you with money, for he is
+the only person that can do it just now, and he has the effect,
+so write to him freely.</p>
+
+<p>Mrs. Amond was afraid you had been displeased with her
+for asking you to leave your society. It was a hardship on
+her to ask you; but when she thought how much was at
+stake, and the opportunity lost could never be recalled except
+Kid had better success, she thought it right to lay it before
+you; and your being content to yield to your friends and her,
+makes her both wish and hop it may be done in the manner
+you wold have it, and she will never wish you to doe anything
+that may reflect on you or occasion you uneasyness.</p>
+
+<p>If you saw what different affairs Mrs. Amond has every day
+you wold see it’s impossible for her to leave this place, and
+indeed, as things now are, she cannot leave it a day; so she
+has not the least thought of coming tho’ she inclines it very
+much, but she could not doe it without partly blaming herself,
+and all the world wold do the same. And as she has always
+preferr’d Mr. Ashton’s interest to her own satisfaction, she
+intends to continue in her duty till providence sends her a
+happy opportunity of seeing that person who is so much the
+object of her thoughts, and for whom she thinks she can
+never doe enough; and it’s her satisfaction that, barring the
+vilainy of that creature (Hamilton) which was no way her
+fault, all her matters had been as well as could have been
+expected at such a time. Mr. Ashton’s boys are well.</p>
+
+<p class="right pr8">Dearest Life,</p>
+<p class='right pr2'>Adieu.</p>
+
+<p>I writ to Duncan last week to send you money that you
+might not be obligt to wait for it in case you intended to leave
+the place. May God preserve you and direct you in every
+particular, and for God’s sake beware of coming where you
+may be in danger.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_300">[300]</span></p>
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXXI">
+ CHAPTER XXXI
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>
+ THE MATTER IS STILL FURTHER DELAYED, BUT OUR
+ ANXIETIES CONTINUE</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>“How often did I say to you in the old days, Barbara,
+that I had dark misgivings about the Silver Mine?” said
+my lady one day, resting her head upon her hand and
+looking weary and discouraged. “I knew not what it
+meant, but ever have I had the presentiment that it would
+be the cause of great misfortune, and behold it is come
+true!”</p>
+
+<p>It was now the middle of August, and the negotiations
+in London had advanced considerably, but in no very
+satisfactory manner for Sir John. The post had just
+arrived, and I had found my Lady Erskine deep in her
+letters, from which she very obligingly read me some
+extracts. The situation certainly gave rise to much
+anxiety. In spite of Sir David Dalrymple’s verdict, the
+Ministers had been advised by their own lawyers to ignore
+the Scottish law of mines as to confiscature, so that our
+hopes in that direction were undermined; and as each
+party, King, Ministers, and Commons worked secretly in
+the matter, it seemed that much time would be lost
+before any decision could be come to.</p>
+
+<p>“Dear madam,” cried I, in response to my lady’s
+remarks, “does not Mr. Campbell still have hope that it
+may turn to Sir John’s benefit? He has not lost heart,
+and why should we? He is determined to fight for it,
+and with the help of Mr. Erskine and Doctor Robin, may
+we not hope that something will be done?”</p>
+
+<p>“My heart is very heavy,” she sighed, “and oh, the
+time is long—long! If I had but the assurance, Barbara,
+that my dear life would be restored to me safe and sound,
+I would almost consent to give them the information they
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_301">[301]</span>
+desire, and let them do their worst. The absence of Sir
+John is still the bitterest part of all.”</p>
+
+<p>“Courage, dear cousin!” I whispered, kneeling down
+beside her and encircling her with my arms, for the look
+in her eyes smote my heart, and I knew that I had no real
+comfort to give her. “Be patient a little longer and brave,
+madam, I pray.”</p>
+
+<p>“The many difficulties that lie in our path keep
+recurring to my mind,” she said, rousing herself a little,
+“and I go over them to myself again and again. We
+know now that, in spite of all Mr. Campbell’s care, the
+Scots law of mines is to go for naught. The Government
+is eagerly anxious to make Sir John an outlaw, and lay
+hands on all his belongings. They are determined to send
+down the commission to see what is in the matter, and
+thereby we incur great danger; ‘for,’ says Patrick Campbell,
+‘if they find nothing where they imagine mountains of
+silver, they will be very angry, and say there is no reason
+why Sir John should get his pardon, seeing he has nothing
+to give in return; if, on the other hand, they stumble
+on something of value, scruples will at once be raised—why
+should it not all be seized and made use of in payment
+of the public debts? The ministers fear the clamour of
+the House of Commons in these days, and there are signs
+that my Lord Townshend is not so secure as he thinks.’
+You see, Barbara, Sir John is ‘between the devil and the
+deep sea,’ as the saying is, and nothing is less certain now
+than his pardon.”</p>
+
+<p>I held my peace, depressed beyond measure by what I
+had heard.</p>
+
+<p>“On the other hand,” she went on, “there are other
+difficulties which arise in my mind, knowing my dear
+husband as I do. Suppose the Prince of Wales prevails
+with his father to grant the remission, and the latter makes
+conditions too hard for Sir John to accept, what then?
+We are in a worse hole than before. Were they to
+insist upon his taking the oath of allegiance to King
+George, and renouncing all interest in his rightful King;
+or worse still, were they to question him in the hope of his
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_302">[302]</span>
+turning spy, I am perfectly certain that Sir John would
+refuse to accept anything at their hands, and prefer rather
+to live and die an exile.”</p>
+
+<p>“And <i>you</i> would rather that he did so, madam,” cried I.</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, without doubt, my dear, I would. I could not
+ask him to stain his honour, however much I should
+benefit. But can you wonder, child, that my heart is sore,
+thinking of all that may lie before us? Sir John is not a
+very young man, and my boys are ever in my thoughts.”</p>
+
+<p>And with that she left me, going upstairs as I suspected
+to her praying-closet, where she was wont to seek comfort
+and help in all her troubles.</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>I will now tell you briefly of what took place at London,
+without waiting to describe the way in which each item of
+news reached us. The summer was nearly over, and it was
+fully a year since the beginning of that unlucky affair,
+which had brought nothing but loss and woe to so many.
+The unfortunate prisoners still lay in their dungeons, and
+from time to time we heard sorrowful tales of sickness and
+deaths among them. It had been decided, in a quite
+illegal way, that the Scots prisoners were to be tried at
+Carlisle in the autumn, chiefly, as we all knew, because no
+Scots jury could be trusted to condemn them; and this
+action greatly increased the rage and discontent against the
+Government, for all parties throughout the country acknowledged
+its injustice. Many blameless people were
+suffering privation, and bereavement, and bitter loss, and
+the state of our poor country was truly to be deplored.
+One piece of comfort my lady had, for old Colonel Erskine
+and his son, though still in the Fleet were, owing to the
+kindness of their friends, in good heart and fair health.
+Great hopes were held out of their final delivery (which
+indeed took place a couple of months later), seeing that
+nothing could be found against them.</p>
+
+<p>We were made anxious about this time by hearing that
+our little favourite, Lordy Erskine, was laid down with the
+small-pox, from which both his stepmother and her little
+daughter were suffering. He was indeed a most attractive
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_303">[303]</span>
+child, and it was with great relief that we heard in good
+time of his complete recovery. And here I think I must
+tell you of Tommy’s spirited reply to General Stanhope,
+which, though you may have forgotten it, was much
+quoted at the time among his friends. When the Secretary
+one day, some weeks before the Earl of Mar left
+Scotland, was visiting Westminster School, his eye lighted
+on my young lord, and, being struck by his charming
+appearance, he inquired whose son he was. On being
+told, he went up to the boy, and asked him some questions
+as to how his studies were progressing. Tommy replied
+modestly, “Indifferently well.” Whereupon Mr. Stanhope,
+with what I must confess was very questionable taste,
+hoped that whatever my Lord Erskine learned at school,
+he would learn not to be a Rebel like his father. At that
+Tommy put his hands on his sides, and looking the General
+steadily in the face, said boldly, “Let me remind you, sir,
+that it is not yet decided <i>who</i> are the Rebels!”</p>
+
+<p>As his aunt, Lady Jean, remarked when telling us the
+story, the Government might deprive him of his estates,
+but they could not rob him of his good sense and ready wit.</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>The “Process of Outlawry” against Sir John was suddenly
+checked by the consideration that, although the Commissioners
+were sent to Alva, they might easily fail in their
+quest without the assistance of the owner. Mr. Campbell
+had taken care to enlarge upon Sir John’s wide and intimate
+knowledge of mining affairs, and indeed at that time he was
+one of the few gentlemen in Britain who had made the
+subject a matter of study. Having worked the coal upon
+his estate, and discovered the Silver Mine for himself, it was
+given out that he knew more of the geological conditions of
+the Ochil Range than any man living, and it occurred to
+Lord Townshend that to quarrel with the man that
+possessed such valuable knowledge was not the wisest
+policy; in fact, it might be compared to the folly of killing
+the goose that laid the golden eggs. He therefore,
+after consulting with the Prince of Wales—the King himself
+having gone over to Hanover on a holiday—sent for
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_304">[304]</span>
+Mr. Campbell, and after some preliminaries, suggested that
+the best thing for all concerned was to persuade Sir John
+to return to Scotland to conduct the business himself. Mr.
+Campbell, always anxious to gain time, and to make things
+sure before committing his friends, said he would be obliged
+to lay the matter before Mr. Erskine, whom he was expecting
+immediately to visit him at London. My lord
+thereupon begged that Mr. Erskine be persuaded to call
+upon him on his arrival, to which proposition Mr. Campbell,
+nothing loth, agreed.</p>
+
+<p>My lady, in the midst of her anxiety, was amused to learn
+that when Mr. Erskine was introduced to the Secretary
+that gentleman asked him point blank what information he
+could give about his brother’s Mine. But the future Lord
+Justice Clerk was too good a lawyer to fall into so simple
+a trap. He answered very firmly that, as he understood the
+disclosure of that affair was to be made the condition of
+some favour shown to Sir John, until he was assured of the
+extent and certainty of the benefit, he must beg to be
+excused from giving them any information. This reply,
+which was only what might have been expected, threw the
+Minister back to where he had been; so after much
+consultation and discussion, it was at last agreed that the
+Prince of Wales should grant a protection to Sir John for
+his return to Britain, at the same time writing to the King
+in Hanover for a warrant for his pardon, which would be
+delivered to him, signed and sealed, upon his presenting
+himself to Lord Townshend. Mr. Erskine and Mr.
+Campbell were at great pains to have the conditions made
+as plain as possible, for, they affirmed, it would be useless
+to expect Sir John to take oaths, or to give information
+against his inclination. A promise was then made that full
+discovery of the Mine was all that would be required of
+him, and my Lord Townshend suggested that a letter to
+this effect be intrusted to Sir Harry Stirling, and that he
+should set out forthwith to find his uncle and lay the
+matter before him.</p>
+
+<p>We were all now able to breathe a little more freely,
+though our anxieties were by no means at an end. For
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_305">[305]</span>
+close upon this came the news, that in spite of the promises
+of the Prince and the Minister, the Commissioners were
+still to be sent to spy out the land, and by no means
+would they be delayed until Sir John could send a reply.
+This excess of zeal was attributed to Haldane of Gleneagles,
+and as you can imagine, it did not tend to increase my
+lady’s love for that gentleman. However, backed by his
+friends in the House of Commons, Gleneagles was like to
+win his way, which prospect filled us with fear and trouble,
+as there was no saying what the result would be, should the
+Commissioners reach Alva before Sir John landed at
+London, and had his pardon in his hand.</p>
+
+<p>Sir Isaac Newton was now approached, it being suggested
+that he should himself head the party of inquiry, and make
+investigation of the mines. But fortunately as it turned
+out, this wise and learned man raised objections to this
+scheme, affirming that as he was not skilled in such matters
+he would be of little use, and suggesting rather that someone
+bred up to that kind of work be sent instead of him.
+He spoke of the King’s Silver Mines in Hanover, and gave
+it as his opinion that an expert from that country should
+be chosen. This meeting with general approval, an express
+was despatched abroad to summon one, Dr. Justus
+Brandshagen, who was said to be a skilled engineer of mines.</p>
+
+<p>This news enraged my Lady Erskine to such a degree
+that she could not contain her wrath, and as I was equally
+angry, we stormed together for several minutes till our
+feelings were somewhat relieved.</p>
+
+<p>“And who,” she cried with fine scorn, pointing to Mr.
+Campbell’s letter, “who do you suppose is appointed guide
+and assistant to this German miner? Who, but our good
+friend and late trusty servant, Mr. James Hamilton!”</p>
+
+<p>“Oh, madam,” cried I aghast, “’tis little short of an
+outrage! How will that man ever be able to look at you
+again? How dare he show his face within twenty miles of
+Alva? This indeed might be called adding insult to
+injury. I, for one, will never speak to him again.”</p>
+
+<p>“Alas! Barbara,” said my lady, with tears of anger in her
+eyes, “’tis but the fulfilment of all his hopes, the clear result
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_306">[306]</span>
+of all his scheming. For money he betrayed us, for money he
+will return, and I doubt not he will be able to brazen it out,
+and even to justify his conduct in the eyes of some people.”</p>
+
+<p>An urgent letter was that day despatched to Mr. Erskine,
+begging him as he valued my lady’s friendship and his
+brother’s welfare, to lose no time in setting out for
+Holland, and having found Sir John (for we had not yet
+heard of his meeting with Sir Harry Stirling) to urge him
+with all the fervour and eloquence in his power to make no
+delay, but return at once to England, and secure the favour
+promised to him. How short a time lay before him none
+could tell, but it would be a monstrous wrong, now that
+the longed-for boon lay so near his grasp, to let it fail them
+through any lack of care. Should Sir John refuse to listen
+to reason, there was still the help of Doctor Robin and his
+master to fall back upon. “But oh,” she wrote, “do all
+you can to persuade him (and it’s <i>you</i> that have the
+golden tongue) to listen to our wishes in the matter.”</p>
+
+<p>A speedy reply was returned to her, saying that Mr.
+Erskine was on the eve of starting for the Hague, and
+assuring her that she might have full confidence in his
+endeavours, seeing that in this, his wishes jumped with her
+own. It showed the more devotion to his brother’s case,
+that Mr. Erskine had left his young wife at Tinwald in a
+delicate condition, and indeed she was brought to bed of
+her eldest son, while her husband was still abroad.</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>Nothing now was to be done but to await results, and all
+our minds were occupied by the question as to which
+should arrive first: Sir John in London to claim his pardon,
+or the Commissioners at Alva to make their investigations.</p>
+
+<p>In this matter I have always believed that Providence
+interfered in our behalf, and my lady, I know, agreed with
+me, for as we learned afterwards, when Dr. Brandshagen
+(how we hated the poor man’s name, though no blame
+attached to him,) was at last ready to set out for Scotland,
+having been delayed at London waiting for money and
+instructions, at first it took him five days to find a ship that
+would carry him and his effects to Leith, and when he sailed
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_307">[307]</span>
+on the 20th of September, he encountered such tempestuous
+weather, that he was three weeks and two days on the way.
+Twice were they overtaken by storms, in which they lost a
+mast each time, and thrice were they driven upon sand-banks,
+so that it was not till the 15th of October that he arrived
+in Edinburgh, where he had a conference with the Earl of
+Lauderdale, John Haldane of Gleneagles, and a friend of
+the latter, Mr. Drummond. But by that time, I am glad to
+say, it was too late for the mischief they were meditating, as
+I shall show you in the next chapter.</p>
+
+<p>My lady wrote frequently to her husband during those
+trying weeks, but most if not all of her letters miscarried, for
+the last remaining one in the packet is a hasty fragment
+which I give you here. Short as it is, it serves to show
+you the state of the poor lady’s mind at this time, her one
+thought being the consent of Sir John to the terms
+proposed, and her fear that it would not be given in time.</p>
+
+<div class='section'>
+<h3>LETTER XIX</h3>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p class='no-indent'>
+ Dr. Sr.
+</p>
+
+<p>Amond bids me tell you she had yours of the 25th of August,
+but she regretes Ashton has not yet met with Sr. Harry S—g.
+He is yet in quest of him, and she hops you will both accept
+of the proffers that’s made, and soon let your friends know that
+you doe so. There is people soon to be sent down in quest,
+and if it were possible you could be here, it’s more in your
+power to manage with respect to the Garden than any
+other mortall.... I shall writ all to Duncan and Key, who will
+be more fit to advise you, for they seem not to be out of hope
+of getting the pardon expected as soon as your answer comes.
+The friends here say otherwise, and think H—y is gone to
+diswade you. There must be no delay in the case as you
+regard your interest, but be directed in the way and manner
+by Key and Duncan. God preserve and direct you.</p>
+
+<p>Our friends in the Fleet, I have good reason to think, will be
+safe, but those here seem to have bitter things before them....
+I am sorry you have not got all my letters, but Ashton’s is a
+great consolation in the midst of different troubles. Your children
+are well.</p>
+
+<p>Dearest Creatur, let us have your answer soon, for these
+creatures will be down in eight or ten days, and what I shall
+doe, God knows! I am in great hast at present, but shall be
+more full next post.</p>
+
+<p class="right pr2">
+ So Dear, Adieu.</p>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_308">[308]</span></p>
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXXII">
+ CHAPTER XXXII
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>
+ SHOWS SOMETHING OF THE TRIALS AND PERPLEXITIES OF
+ OUR GOOD SIR JOHN OVER THE BUSINESS</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>In the meantime Sir John himself had been passing
+through various anxieties of his own, though I can only
+give you a very brief account of his doings from the notes
+in my little diary, and the remembrance of his own
+conversation. It was not till long afterwards that I realised
+how much greater cause we should have had to tremble
+had we known more of the brave knight’s movements
+during these months of summer. I have told you how my
+lady’s heart was lightened by learning that he had at last
+taken his departure from Avignon. No doubt, dear soul,
+she regarded it as the tardy result of her wifely prayers and
+counsels. But had she known of the packet he bore with
+him, which, if discovered by the agents of King George,
+would have put an end to all hope of pardon for ever,
+what terrors she would have suffered, what anguish of
+anxiety she would have endured; and with good reason—for
+the King had entrusted to Sir John a letter to the King
+of Sweden, begging for his help in a new endeavour to
+recover his birthright.</p>
+
+<p>The news of the Forfeited Estates Bill, which had been
+passed, was a great blow to Sir John, for the thought that
+others should suffer through him was intolerable to his
+kind and honest heart, and he fully agreed with my lady’s
+dictum, that anything she could save out of the estate must
+go to the paying of private debts even to the last sixpence.
+When the news of the treacherous discovery of his Mine
+reached him, he was further distressed, realising all that it
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_309">[309]</span>
+meant for him. As Mr. Campbell, in writing of this, had
+warned him that it might be necessary for some of his
+friends to go and consult with him as to a method of
+procedure, he, after confiding his troubles to his friend, the
+Earl of Mar, and receiving kind permission from the King,
+decided to go to Hamburg where he should be within easy
+reach of the Hague, and also in the way of meeting his
+brother, the doctor, who with his master, the Czar, was
+expected shortly in these parts.</p>
+
+<p>He accordingly set out from Avignon about the middle
+of July, going first to Brussels and then to Amsterdam, but
+upon finding there letters from home of the greatest importance,
+he hurried to Lubeck, where, after waiting some
+days, he was rejoiced to welcome his nephew, Sir Harry
+Stirling, who laid before him my Lord Townshend’s
+proposals, and explained the situation of things at home.
+Thinking that having got such lenient conditions there
+was no great press in making up his mind on the matter,
+Sir John, having written an account of it to my Lord Mar,
+proceeded on his errand to Hamburg, where he found that
+General Hamilton, with whom he was ordered to consult
+on the King’s affairs, was not in that place, and indeed was
+at too great a distance to communicate with him. He met
+instead the agent of the Swedish King, Colonel Sparre, and
+accepting his offer to bring him to Sweden under cover of
+his own passport, he went with him to Travemunde, only to
+find it in possession of a small Russian garrison, which was
+nevertheless strong enough to bar the way to suspected
+travellers, Russia and Sweden being at enmity at that time.
+He was for some days weather-bound in a small town on
+the Elbe about forty miles from Hamburg, which he
+described as a “miserable nasty hole, where the inhabitants
+did nothing but drink bad beer, smoke bad tobacco, and
+chatter in a tongue which he could not understand.” Cut
+off from all letters, and chafing at the delay, he fell into a
+fit of depression, he told us after, that bordered on despair.
+But the weather clearing at last, he made his way back to
+Hamburg, where he found a letter from my Lord Mar, bidding
+him give up the notion of going to Sweden at this time.</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_310">[310]</span></p>
+
+<p>As he had learned from Colonel Sparre that though the
+King of Sweden was favourable to King James, many of his
+statesmen were not, and that according to Sparre’s opinion
+it was not a good time to approach him on the subject,
+Sir John felt less regret in giving up the mission than he
+otherwise might have done. He remained some days
+longer at Hamburg, in hopes of hearing from Mar in reply
+to his letter about his private business, and when it reached
+him he was pleased to find it contained a very kind and
+gracious message from the King, to the effect that his
+Majesty was glad to hear of the probability of Sir John’s
+success in his own affairs, and said that now he could do
+nothing in what was intrusted to him, that was to be his
+chief concern. These generous words, as you will imagine,
+warmed the heart of Sir John, for he was in a strait between
+two strong desires, namely: the furtherance of the King’s
+success, and the welfare of his own family; or to put it in
+my Lord Mar’s words, he was “in a nice situation ’twixt
+honour on the one side and interest on the other.”</p>
+
+<p>He went on to say, “The world is malicious enough
+always to put the worst construction on things, so a man
+who values his reputation ought to think well in such a case,
+and do what he really thinks right.”</p>
+
+<p>It cost Sir John no little pain to give up, here and now,
+all thought of helping in the Cause to which he was so much
+devoted; for he knew very well that once returned to
+Scotland he would be carefully watched, and only in covert
+and secret ways could his assistance again be given. It was
+a trial also to his pride to think how he might be pointed
+at as a turn-coat and a renegade, who took the King’s
+favours and rejoiced in his confidence, only to throw him
+over and desert him in the end. To a man of honour the
+situation was indeed extremely difficult, and when it is
+remembered that Sir John had besides a warm and affectionate
+heart towards the King, it is easy to imagine how
+he was torn in two, at the thought of thus parting from his
+friends.</p>
+
+<p>However, his calmer judgment told him there was but
+one thing to be done, and that the happiness of those
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_311">[311]</span>
+depending on him must be his first care. To make up in
+some degree for his desertion from active service on the
+King’s behalf, he had written to his brother, the doctor,
+hoping to enlist him in the Cause, and begging him to do
+his utmost to gain the Czar’s help and interest in the same.
+Through Sir Harry Stirling he received full confirmation of
+his hopes, for Dr. Robin wrote that he and his master
+heartily wished King George at the Devil, and the latter
+regretted that he was too far away to be able to send him
+there. The Czar was also anxious and willing to assist
+Sir John in his own affairs, if Mr. Campbell’s proposals
+were likely to fail, a promise which accorded well with Sir
+John’s inclinations, for he felt it would be easier to accept
+a ton of assistance from the Czar of Russia, than one ounce
+of favour from the Elector of Hanover.</p>
+
+<p>He had by this time made his way, after being much
+delayed by storms, to Amsterdam, which he reached on
+the 29th of September, and here, a few days later, Mr.
+Erskine found him. Sir John’s delight at meeting with his
+brother was much dashed by the latter’s assurance that his
+departure for England, with scarce a day’s delay, was the
+only course open to him if he wished to benefit by the
+efforts of his friends on his behalf. It was in vain he
+pleaded his master’s needs, his own desire to meet with
+Doctor Erskine, and the necessity of at least waiting for
+returns to his letters from my Lord Mar. He had not
+heard from Avignon now for five weeks, and he was at
+heart somewhat uneasy as to the reason of the silence.
+The Earl might have some cause for displeasure, thinking
+that after all Sir John should not prefer his own advantage
+to the King’s, or his letters anent the business with the
+Czar might have miscarried, and all his work would go for
+naught.</p>
+
+<p>To none of this would Mr. Erskine listen. He informed
+Sir John that it would be now almost a race between
+himself and the Commissioners who were on their way to
+Alva, if indeed not already there. Should they reach the
+mine before Sir John had secured his pardon, they might
+decide to put such conditions on the latter that it would
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_312">[312]</span>
+never be accepted. Mr. Erskine offered to stay for a time
+in Holland, and as far as in him lay, to take his brother’s
+place. He would see or correspond with Sir Harry and the
+doctor, and all communications with Avignon might be
+carried on through him as if he were Sir John himself. In
+another way he reminded him, he might really be
+benefiting the King’s cause by his immediate departure.
+If he refused, after receiving the offer of such easy terms,
+to return home at once, my Lord Townshend might
+suspect that there was something stirring in the King’s
+affairs to keep him on the Continent, and would cause his
+agents to be more vigilant among them, which at the
+present juncture would not be convenient. But if so
+trusted a friend of the Earl of Mar were permitted to leave
+the party, it would seem to suggest that matters were not
+in a good way, and their hopes of present success very low.</p>
+
+<p>In fact the “golden tongue” did its work, and so
+eloquently did it speak that at length Sir John was convinced
+of his brother’s wisdom, and agreed to all that he
+proposed. Immediately upon this he wrote two letters to
+the Earl of Mar with full explanations of his plans and his
+difficulties, his hopes and fears, but unfortunately these
+letters were delayed in the transit, as the earl’s to himself
+had been, and there followed some weeks of pain and
+distrust between the friends. On the 8th of October, Sir
+John, “with a very heavy heart,” set sail for England, and
+the news being carried to Avignon, without the true
+explanation of his departure, the company there were
+plunged in wrath and dismay, and even for a few days
+entertained doubts of their late companion’s honesty. A
+letter from Mr. Erskine to my Lord Mar a little later
+cleared up the mystery and restored tranquillity to their
+minds, but the stories followed Sir John to England, and
+it grieved him not a little to have suspicion thrown upon
+his loyalty, by those who should have known him better.</p>
+
+<p>It was, to be sure, a surprising thing for friends and foes
+alike to see Sir John Erskine, whom all supposed to be in
+exile, and in high danger of being attainted, walking openly
+in the streets of London, in company with this or that
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_313">[313]</span>
+member of the Government. Courteous, genial and debonnaire
+as ever, he did not look like a proscribed outlaw,
+still less like a deserter turned spy, and many were the
+stories invented and circulated before the real truth of the
+matter leaked out. When it became known, I think there
+were few who did not rejoice and wonder, for the story of
+the Silver Glen was like a fairy-tale, and I suppose that Sir
+John was the only man in Britain who had been bribed to
+accept his Remission from King George.</p>
+
+<p>The interview with my Lord Townshend was entirely
+satisfactory. No oaths were exacted, no questions asked.
+The pardon was duly signed, sealed, and delivered on the
+22nd day of October, and on the 27th Sir John set out
+post for Scotland, with relief in his heart, and “a broad
+seal in his pocket.”</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="chapter">
+
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_314">[314]</span></p>
+
+ <h2 class="nobreak" id="CHAPTER_XXXIII">
+ CHAPTER XXXIII
+ </h2>
+ <p class='chap-title'>
+ THE STORY ENDS IN PEACE AND SUNSHINE, AND I TAKE
+ LEAVE OF MY KIND READERS</p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='no-indent'>I will leave you to imagine the joy and thankfulness at
+Alva when the news of Sir John’s arrival at London
+reached us, for no words of mine can express it; and when
+it was known that the pardon was an accomplished fact,
+and that the good knight was on his way home, the happy
+excitement rose to the highest pitch.</p>
+
+<p>What joy it was to see my lady’s altered mien, to hear
+the thrill in her voice and watch the smiles trembling
+round her mouth! The little boys were wild with delight
+at the prospect of seeing again their much-loved father;
+and there was not a neighbour nor a tenant on the place,
+who did not rejoice in the good news and sympathise with
+our happiness.</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Patrick Campbell was to accompany Sir John on his
+journey from London, and his wife came over from Monzie
+to meet them both. Old Lady Alva was with us, and also
+Aunt Betty, while at my lady’s invitation my Lord and
+Lady Wemyss arrived to join in the general welcome.
+How gay we were, how busy with preparations, how full of
+thankfulness and relief! Although the year was near
+November, it seemed to me as if we were bidding good-bye
+to the darkness of winter and preparing to welcome
+the summer; and Nature kindly did nothing to discourage
+me in the thought, for the sun shone warm and bright, and
+though the trees were casting their leaves they were not yet
+bare, and the gold and ruddy tints, softened by silver mists
+and purple shadows, still made the landscape lovely.
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_315">[315]</span>
+Nothing was wanting to complete my satisfaction but the
+presence of my lover, and once or twice, I must own, my
+heart cried out in the midst of my happiness, “Would that
+he too were coming!”</p>
+
+<p>According to his agreement it was necessary for Sir John
+to stop in Edinburgh for an interview with Dr. Brandshagen,
+whose letters of instruction were that he should wait for
+the knight to show him his mines himself. By someone’s
+good management, I suppose, there had been a convenient
+delay in supplying the German with funds, so that he was
+obliged to remain where he was till he received them; but
+Sir John, having expressed his readiness with all courtesy
+to carry out his part of the bargain at any moment, there
+was nothing now left for him to do but to hasten
+homewards, whither his heart, I doubt not, had already
+flown.</p>
+
+<p>He had been so thoughtful as to send an express to my
+lady from Edinburgh to prepare her for his arrival, and the
+next afternoon we were all assembled with beating hearts
+to listen for the farthest sound of horse’s feet.</p>
+
+<p>“My papa will be here in plenty of time for my
+birthday,” cried little Hal, as he ceased his jumping about
+the room and climbed into my lap. “I am a luckier boy
+than Charles. Does Sir John know that I am grown so
+big, Cousin Barbe?”</p>
+
+<p>I could scarce listen to the child’s chatter nor answer
+it, but when Charles put his hand upon my shoulder,
+and whispered, “How I wish he were bringing Captain
+Anthony!” I turned and kissed him on the cheek, with a
+sudden pain in my heart.</p>
+
+<p>At last—at last we heard them coming—the galloping
+growing nearer and nearer, the shouts of the country-folk
+assembled along the road becoming louder and more
+distinct.</p>
+
+<p>“Hurrah! hurrah!” “Long life to Sir John!”
+“Glad to see ye hame again!” “Welcome, welcome!”
+we could indeed distinguish the words for we were now
+standing at the door, my lady with a son in each hand, her
+mother-in-law beside her, we others pressing round, and
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_316">[316]</span>
+the servants just behind. The tears were running down
+the old lady’s cheeks, and Aunt Betty was sobbing loudly,
+her kerchief to her eyes; but I looked at my lady’s quiet
+face, and though it was pale, I was struck by the lovely
+light that shone there. “Sure,” thought I, “no husband
+returning home was ever greeted by a sweeter, truer wife!”</p>
+
+<p>And then the cavalcade swept into sight, and we caught
+our breath, and a low sound that was neither laugh nor
+cry, but partook of both, broke from the lips of all.</p>
+
+<p>Sir John rode first, his head bared in the sunshine, his
+face alight with joy, and our eyes were fixed upon him.
+Almost before he reached the door he checked his horse,
+and dismounting quickly, turned with hands outstretched.
+It was as if he saw one face alone in all that crowd, as if he
+cared for the welcome of but one voice. His mother
+uttered his name in loving, trembling tones; his boys ran
+forward gleefully to clasp his knees; but he did not speak
+nor heed them till, without a word, my lady staggered to
+his arms and was clasped in a long embrace.</p>
+
+<p>And then, I knew not why, the unbidden tears came to
+my eyes, and turning away to hide them, I encountered
+a sudden shock. Was I dreaming? Oh, what did it
+mean, and how had it happened? Or were my eyes
+playing me false? I dashed the tears away and looked
+again. And there close at my side, his face aglow with
+feeling, his eyes dim with their mighty love, stood my dear
+Anthony, so tall and brave and strong and full of joy, that,
+in spite of the publicity, I followed my lady’s example and
+threw myself into his arms.</p>
+
+<p>I emerged from them to be greeted with sympathetic
+laughter and a shower of questions. “Where did he
+come from?” “Did you know, Barbara; were you expecting
+him?” “Why did you not tell us?” But dazed with
+my surprise and happiness, I could only look from him to
+them and back again.</p>
+
+<p>Sir John came to my rescue with a great kind laugh that
+did me good to hear.</p>
+
+<p>“No, no, I can answer for it. Barbara knew nothing of
+this. But when I met the young gentleman at York a
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_317">[317]</span>
+night or two ago, and he confided to me that he was on his
+way to my house, I very naturally asked him to join my
+party and go along with us, thinking I should be none the
+less welcome here for bringing him in my train.”</p>
+
+<p>You will know then that Barbara’s cup of happiness was
+full to the brim, and when my dear lady said, out before
+them all,</p>
+
+<p>“It wanted only this to make the day perfect; none but
+myself know how good, how brave and patient our Barbara
+has been. I think she is being rewarded for all her unselfish
+love to me!”</p>
+
+<p>Well, when she spoke thus, my cup overflowed.</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>It was indeed a perfect day, an earnest of others as
+perfect to follow! How strangely pleasant it was at dinner
+to see Sir John again in his place, his hospitable smile
+showing us all what pleasure the meeting gave him. How
+sweet to see my lady’s tremulous happiness, and the almost
+wistful way she hung upon her husband’s words. Old Lady
+Alva sat near him and Betty upon the other side; Mr.
+Campbell and his wife were together, “for,” said he, “we
+have been so many weeks separate that we are as good as
+lovers again.” My Anthony sat at my lady’s left hand,
+(my Lord Wemyss being on her right), and Barbara by his
+side. The little boys were admitted to the banquet to
+their vast delight, and even poor Aunt Betty’s face was
+wreathed in smiles. It would indeed have been difficult to
+find a happier party in all Scotland.</p>
+
+<p>When dessert was on the table and the servants gone,
+Sir John brought out of his pocket the immediate cause of
+our peace and contentment.</p>
+
+<p>You have all seen it—the great document with the
+portrait of King George in the left-hand corner, and the
+“broad seal” attached—the Remission, or Pardon, without
+which we could never have welcomed Sir John to
+his home, nor indeed enjoyed any real happiness. With
+what awe and interest we gazed upon it, as we listened to
+Mr. Campbell’s story of the wonderful part he had played
+in procuring it. Each point in the narrative was fraught
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_318">[318]</span>
+with thrilling meaning to us, who through all those weary
+months had waited in uncertainty for this happy consummation.
+How we smiled and sighed as we recalled our
+hopes and fears, and thanked God in our hearts that all
+such anxiety was laid to rest at last.</p>
+
+<p>When the conversation had again become general my
+Anthony turned to me, and whispered,</p>
+
+<p>“I also bear in my pocket a document which means
+nearly as much to me as that other to Sir John;” and
+under cover of the table he presently slipped into my lap a
+letter addressed to me in an unknown hand. I need
+scarcely tell you that I apprehended its purport as soon as
+I saw it, and smiled my silent agreement. It was as I
+surmised, from Mr. Fleming’s parents, welcoming me with
+warm approval as the future wife of their dear son, and
+agreeing very kindly to leave all arrangements for our
+marriage in the hands of my guardians, Sir John and Lady
+Erskine. My Anthony’s pardon had been easy to arrange,
+his father having many friends at court. But he was under
+oath never to take up arms against King George as long as
+he lived, for which reason, he told me, laughing, it was a
+mercy that most of his life would be passed away from
+Britain, so that he was not likely to be tempted in that way
+again.</p>
+
+<p>I remember telling him how glad I was that my husband
+was to be a civilian, making his living peacefully by the
+pen instead of the sword, so that I should not be obliged
+to go in fear of my life every time there was a war. How
+little did I then think that after thirty years he should
+again become a soldier, and win for himself honour and a
+Title, fighting in the service of the East India Company
+against Governor Dupliex in the Carnatic. Still stranger
+would it have been to know that his being wounded and
+disabled in these same wars should contribute to my peace
+of mind, but so it was, for the misfortune put an end to his
+soldiering, and brought us back to England, thus proving
+itself a blessing in disguise.</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>And now, my dears, the story I set out to tell you is
+<span class="pagenum" id="Page_319">[319]</span>
+done. Like all human histories it is a mingling of joy and
+sorrow, of laughter and tears, and perhaps, looking at the
+hidden heart of things, the tears predominate. But it were
+not wise to end a tale like this upon a tragic note. God
+veils in mercy the future from our eyes, else were it not
+possible properly to enjoy His many blessings; and so I am
+glad to leave my dear Lady Erskine at this bright and
+peaceful season of her life, to see her as I love best to
+remember her, standing in the sunshine, the haunting fear
+gone from her eyes, and the sweet light of loving welcome
+transfiguring her face.</p>
+
+<hr class="tb">
+
+<p>For more than three months I have been living in the
+past, seeing the friends of my girlhood, and listening to the
+tones of their voices. At times I have raised my eyes from
+the paper before me, dazed and bewildered to find myself
+alone—an old woman with my life behind me, and so
+many of those dear ones gone. Now the Summer is over,
+the Autumn days are drawing in; no longer does the mavis
+sing in the garden, and as I write these lines, a moaning
+wind arises and whirls the leaves across the darkening lawn.
+But far overhead in the pale sky the stars are coming out;
+they speak to my heart of Heavenly Consolation, and as I
+thank God that I am not left desolate, I hear my dear Sir
+Anthony’s step outside upon the stair.</p>
+
+<p>And so, my dears, adieu.</p>
+
+<p class='center mt2 fs120'><span class="smcap">The End</span></p>
+
+<div class='poetry-container'>
+<p class='center mt6 fs80 bt ptq'>&nbsp;&nbsp; W. JOLLY &amp; SONS, PRINTERS, ABERDEEN &nbsp;&nbsp;</p>
+</div>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="front">
+<p><span class="pagenum" id="Page_320">[320]</span></p>
+</div>
+
+<p class='center'><i>POPULAR NOVELS BY MAY WYNNE</i></p>
+<p class='center fs80'>
+ Author of “Henry of Navarre,” “A Maid of Brittany,” &amp;c.
+</p>
+<p class='center bold'>
+ In Crown 8vo, Cloth gilt. Price 6s. each
+</p>
+
+<p class='center fs200 bold ltsp1'>A KING’S TRAGEDY</p>
+
+<p class='center fs80'>BY</p>
+
+<p class='center bold'>MAY WYNNE</p>
+
+<p class='center fs90'>Author of “Henry of Navarre,” &amp;c.</p>
+
+<p class='mth bold'>“Miss May Wynne has enhanced her reputation,
+already firmly established by a splendidly-written
+romance, founded upon Scottish history relating
+to the fifteenth century. The troublous times
+after the return of James I. of Scotland to his
+throne from captivity in England are interestingly
+dealt with. The local colouring is graphically
+given and the internecine troubles between the
+Highland Clans, their modes of warfare and the
+horribly vindictive spirit in which their raids and
+forays were carried out are related in a manner
+which is faithfully true to both history and tradition.
+The loves and adventures of Sir Alan
+Kennedy and his brother David are made the
+medium through which the interest of the reader
+is centred and retained through a most charming
+book.”</p>
+
+<p class='right'>
+ <i>Liverpool Daily Post.</i>
+</p>
+
+<p class='center fs200 bold ltsp1 mtq'>THE GOAL</p>
+
+<p class='center fs80'>By the Author of “Henry of Navarre,” &amp;c.</p>
+
+<p class='no-indent bold'><span class='underline'><i>The STANDARD says—</i></span></p>
+
+<p class='bold'>“‘The Goal’ with its pleasant studies of village
+friendships, its sincere love of beautiful country
+sights and scenes, its delicate portraiture and its
+characters will win many true and warm admirers....
+The scene between two children and
+the gossipy old maid is in its way quite a triumph.
+Miss Wynne’s sketches of girls are done with great
+charity, sweetness and charm.”</p>
+
+<div class='mt1'>
+<hr class='r35'>
+<hr class='r35'>
+</div>
+
+<p class='center mt1 bold'>LONDON:</p>
+
+<p class='center bold fs120'>DIGBY, LONG &amp; Co., 18, Bouverie St., Fleet St., E.C.</p>
+
+<hr class="chap x-ebookmaker-drop">
+<div class="transnote mt2">
+ <h2 class="mt1h" id="Transcribers_Notes">
+ Transcriber’s Notes
+ </h2>
+
+<ul>
+<li>Illustrations relocated close to relevant content.</li>
+
+<li>Obvious typographic errors silently corrected. No corrections made
+ to the quoted letters as the author seems to intend to represent the
+ letter writer’s original with errors intact.</li>
+
+<li>Variations in hyphenation and spelling have been kept as in the
+ original.</li>
+
+<li>Footnote numbered and relocated next to relevant paragraph.</li>
+</ul>
+</div>
+
+<div style='text-align:center'>*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK 76963 ***</div>
+</body>
+</html>
+
diff --git a/76963-h/images/cover.jpg b/76963-h/images/cover.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..31560ac
--- /dev/null
+++ b/76963-h/images/cover.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/76963-h/images/i_83.jpg b/76963-h/images/i_83.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4428ce8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/76963-h/images/i_83.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/76963-h/images/i_frontspiece.jpg b/76963-h/images/i_frontspiece.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..94dead3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/76963-h/images/i_frontspiece.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3c6f56d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #76963 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/76963)